9.25. Subscriber Management Command Reference

9.25.1. Command Hierarchies

Note:

Enhanced Subscriber Management is supported on the redundant chassis model only.

9.25.1.1. ANCP Commands

config
ancp
ancp-policy name
egress
rate-adjustment adjusted-percent
rate-modify agg-rate-limit
rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
rate-monitor kilobit-per-second [alarm]
rate-reduction kilobit-per-second
rate-adjustment adjusted-percent
rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
rate-monitor kilobit-per-second [alarm] [log]
rate-reduction kilobit-per-second
[no] port-down
[no] disable-shcv [alarm] [hold-time seconds]
entry key ancp-string customer customer-id multi-service-site customer-site-name ancp-policy policy-name
entry key ancp-string sap sap-id ancp-policy policy-name
— no entry key ancp-string customer customer-id multi-service-site customer-site-name
— no entry key ancp-string sap sap-id

9.25.1.2. GSMP Configuration Commands

Note:

The commands listed in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

config
— service
— vpls service-id [customer customer-id] [create] [vpn vpn-id] [m-vpls] [b-vpls | i-vpls]
— no vpls service-id
[no] vprn service-id [customer customer-id] [vpn vpn-id] [m-vpls]
gsmp
[no] group name
ancp
[no] oam
description description-string
hold-multiplier multiplier
[no] idle-filter
keepalive seconds
— no keepalive
[no] neighbor ip-address
description description-string
local-address ip-address
priority-marking dscp dscp-name
priority-marking prec ip-prec-value
[no] shutdown
[no] shutdown
[no] shutdown

9.25.1.3. Authentication Policy Commands

config
— aaa
isa-radius-policy name [create]
— no isa-radius-policy name
radius-coa-port {1647 | 1700 | 1812 | 3799}
[no] authentication-policy name
accept-script-policy policy-name
description description-string
fallback-action accept [force-probing]
fallback-action user-db user-db-local-user-name [force-probing]
calling-station-id {mac | remote-id | sap-id | sap-string}
[no] circuit-id
[no] dhcp-options
[no] dhcp6-options
[no] mac-address
nas-port-id [prefix-string string] [suffix suffix-option]
nas-port-type [value]
[no] remote-id
password password
— no password
ppp-user-name append domain-name
ppp-user-name default-domain domain-name
ppp-user-name replace domain-name
ppp-user-name strip
pppoe-access-method {none | padi | pap-chap}
access-algorithm {direct | round-robin}
fallback-action accept
fallback-action user-db local-user-db-name
hold-down-time seconds
retry count
— no retry
router router-instance
router service-name
— no router
server server-index address ip-address secret key [hash | hash2] [port port] [coa-only]
— no server server-index
source-address ip-address
timeout seconds
— no timeout
radius-server-policy radius-server-policy-name
server server-index address ip-address secret key [hash | hash2] [port port-num] [coa-only] [pending-requests-limit limit]
request-script-policy policy-name
send-acct-stop-on-fail {[on-request-failure] [on-reject] [on-accept-failure]}
user-name-format format [mac-format mac-format]
user-name-format format append [domain-name] [mac-format mac-format]
user-name-format format append domain-name
user-name-format format default-domain domain-name [mac-format mac-format]
user-name-format format replace domain-name [mac-format mac-format]
user-name-format format strip [mac-format mac-format]

9.25.1.4. Call Trace Commands

configure
location {cf1 | cf2}
[no] disable
size-limit limit-value
— no size-limit
max-files-number number
primary-cf cflash-id
trace-profile profile-name [create]
— no trace-profile profile-name
applications [connectivity-management] [radius-auth] [radius-acct] [python] [ludb] [msap]
applications all
[no] debug-output
description description-string
— no description
events {none | public-only | all}
live-output {ip-address | fqdn} [port port] [router {router-instance | service-name service-name}]
size-limit limit-value
time-limit limit-value

9.25.1.5. RADIUS Accounting Policy Commands

config
[no] custom-record
[no] override-counter override-counter-id
e-counters [all]
— no e-counters
i-counters [all]
— no i-counters
[no] queue queue-id
e-counters [all]
— no e-counters
i-counters [all]
— no i-counters
ref-override-counter ref-override-counter-id
e-counters [all]
— no e-counters
i-counters [all]
— no i-counters
ref-queue queue-id
ref-queue all
— no ref-queue
e-counters [all]
— no e-counters
i-counters [all]
— no i-counters
description description-string
fallback-action accept
fallback-action user-db local-user-db-name
— no fallback-action accept
[no] host-accounting [interim-update]
[no] circuit-id
[no] framed-route
[no] ipv6-address
[no] mac-address
[no] nas-port
[no] nas-port-id
[no] nas-port-type
[no] remote-id
[no] sla-profile
[no] sub-profile
[no] subscriber-id
[no] user-name
[no] wifi-rssi
queue-instance-accounting [interim-update]
access-algorithm {direct | round-robin}
retry count
— no retry
router router-instance
— no router
server server-index [address ip-address] [secret key] [port port] [pending-requests-limit limit]
— no server server-index
source-address ip-address
timeout seconds
— no timeout
radius-server-policy radius-server-policy-name
session-accounting [interim-update] [host-update]
session-id-format {description | number}
update-interval minutes
update-interval-jitter absolute seconds

9.25.1.6. RADIUS Route Download Commands

configure
— aaa
route-downloader name [create]
— no route-downloader name
base-user-name user-name
default-metric metric
default-tag tag
description description-string
download-interval minutes
max-routes routes
— no max-routes
password password [hash | hash2]
— no password
radius-server-policy policy-name
retry-interval min minimum max maximum
[no] shutdown

9.25.1.7. Diameter Policy Commands

9.25.1.7.1. AAA Diameter Peer Policy Commands

config
— aaa
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name [role {client | proxy}] [create]
— no diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name
applications {[gx] [gy] [nasreq]}
connection-timer connection-time
description description-string
ipv6-source-address ipv6-address
origin-host origin-host-string
origin-realm origin-realm-string
peer name [create]
— no peer name
address ip-address
— no address
connection-timer connection-time
destination-host destination-host-string
destination-realm destination-realm-string
preference preference
— no preference
[no] shutdown
transaction-timer seconds
transport tcp port port
— no transport
watchdog-timer seconds
proxy
mcs-peer ip-address sync-tag name
— no mcs-peer
router router-instance address ip-address
— no router
[no] shutdown
python-policy [32 chars max]
router service service-name
router router-instance
— no router
source-address ip-address
transaction-timer transaction-time
vendor-support {three-gpp | vodafone}
watchdog-timer wd-time

9.25.1.8. Subscriber Management Diameter Application Policy Commands

configure
diameter-application-policy application-policy-name [create]
— no diameter-application-policy application-policy-name
application {gx | gy | nasreq}
description description-string
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name
gx
avp-subscription-id origin [type type]
ccrt-replay-interval [interval]
[no] include-avp
[no] an-gw-address
calling-station-id [type {llid | mac | remote-id | sap-id | sap-string}]
[no] ip-can-type
nas-port binary-spec
— no nas-port
nas-port-id [prefix-type {none | user-string}] [prefix-string prefix-string] [suffix-type {circuit-id | none | remote-id | user-string}] [suffix-string suffix-string]
nas-port-type [type]
[no] rat-type
user-equipment-info [type ue-info-type]
mac-format mac-format
— no mac-format
gy
avp-subscription-id origin [type type]
mac-format mac-format
— no mac-format
max-attempts count
max-attempts infinite
[no] reporting
validity-time seconds
volume credits {bytes | kilobytes | megabytes | gigabytes}
— no volume
[no] shutdown
out-of-credit-reporting {final | quota-exhausted}
vendor-support {three-gpp | vodafone}
[no] include-avp
3gpp-charging-id {auto | esm-info | id}
3gpp-imsi {circuit-id | imsi | subscriber-id}
— no 3gpp-imsi
[no] 3gpp-nsapi
3gpp-rat-type value
[no] address-avp
called-station-id [64 chars max]
charging-rule-base-name category-map-name
ggsn-address {ipv4 | ipv6}
nasreq
[no] include-avp
calling-station-id [type {llid | mac | remote-id | sap-id | sap-string}]
[no] circuit-id
nas-port binary-spec
— no nas-port
nas-port-id [prefix-type {none | user-string}] [prefix-string [8 chars max]] [suffix-type {circuit-id | none | remote-id | user-string}] [suffix-string [64 chars max]]
nas-port-type [type]
[no] remote-id
mac-format mac-format
— no mac-format
password password
— no password
user-name-format format
user-name-operation operation [domain domain-name]
on-failure [failover {enabled | disabled}] [handling {continue | retry-and-terminate | terminate}]
— no on-failure
tx-timer seconds
— no tx-timer

9.25.1.9. Category Map and Credit Control Policy Commands

config
category-map category-map-name [create]
— no category-map category-map-name
description description-string
activity-threshold kilobits-per-second
category category-name [create]
— no category category-name
credit-type-override {volume | time}
default-credit volume credits bytes | kilobytes | megabytes | gigabytes
default-credit time seconds
description description-string
entry entry-id [create]
action drop
action forward
action http-redirect url
— no action
description description-string
match [protocol protocol-id]
— no match
dscp dscp-name
— no dscp
dst-port {lt | gt | eq} dst-port-number
dst-port range start end
— no dst-port
fragment {true | false}
icmp-code icmp-code
— no icmp-code
icmp-type icmp-type
— no icmp-type
ip-option ip-option-value [ip-option-mask]
— no ip-option
multiple-option {true | false}
option-present {true | false}
src-ip {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask}
— no src-ip
src-port {lt | gt | eq} src-port-number
src-port range start end
— no src-port
tcp-ack {true | false}
— no tcp-ack
tcp-syn {true | false}
— no tcp-syn
entry entry-id [create]
action drop
action forward
— no action
description description-string
match [next-header next-header]
— no match
dscp dscp-name
— no dscp
dst-port {lt | gt | eq} dst-port-number
dst-port range start end
— no dst-port
icmp-code icmp-code
— no icmp-code
icmp-type icmp-type
— no icmp-type
src-ip {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask}
— no src-ip
src-port {lt | gt | eq} src-port-number
src-port range start end
— no src-port
tcp-ack {true | false}
— no tcp-ack
tcp-syn {true | false}
— no tcp-syn
entry entry-id [create]
action drop
action forward
action http-redirect url
— no action
description description-string
match [protocol protocol-id]
— no match
dscp dscp-name
— no dscp
dst-ip {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask}
— no dst-ip
dst-port {lt | gt | eq} dst-port-number
dst-port range start end
— no dst-port
fragment {true | false}
icmp-code icmp-code
— no icmp-code
icmp-type icmp-type
— no icmp-type
ip-option ip-option-value [ip-option-mask]
— no ip-option
multiple-option {true | false}
option-present {true | false}
src-port {lt | gt | eq} src-port-number
src-port range start end
— no src-port
tcp-ack {true | false}
— no tcp-ack
tcp-syn {true | false}
— no tcp-syn
entry entry-id [create]
action drop
action forward
— no action
description description-string
match [next-header next-header]
— no match
dscp dscp-name
— no dscp
dst-ip {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask}
— no dst-ip
dst-port {lt | gt | eq} dst-port-number
dst-port range start end
— no dst-port
icmp-code icmp-code
— no icmp-code
icmp-type icmp-type
— no icmp-type
src-port {lt | gt | eq} src-port-number
src-port range start end
— no src-port
tcp-ack {true | false}
— no tcp-ack
tcp-syn {true | false}
— no tcp-syn
pir pir-rate
pir max
— no pir
out-of-credit-action-override {continue | block-category | change-service-level}
policer policer-id {ingress-only | egress-only | ingress-egress}
— no policer policer-id
queue queue-id {ingress-only | egress-only | ingress-egress}
— no queue queue-id
rating-group rating-group-id
credit-exhaust-threshold threshold-percentage
credit-type {volume | time}
credit-control-policy policy-name [create]
— no credit-control-policy policy-name
credit-control-server diameter policy-name
default-category-map category-map-name
description description-string
error-handling-action {continue | block}

9.25.1.10. Filter Commands

config
filter
copy {ip-filter | mac-filter | ipv6-filter} src-filter-id [src-entry src-entry-id] to dst-filter-id [dst-entry dst-entry-id] [overwrite]
dhcp6-filter filter-id [create]
— no dhcp6-filter filter-id
default-action bypass-host-creation [na] [pd]
description description-string
entry entry-id [create]
— no entry entry-id
action bypass-host-creation [na] [pd]
action drop
— no action
option dhcp6-option-number {present | absent}
option dhcp6-option-number match hex hex-string [exact] [invert-match]
option dhcp6-option-number match string ascii-string [exact] [invert-match]
— no option
ip-filter filter-id [create]
— no ip-filter filter-id
default-action drop | forward
description description-string
entry entry-id [create]
— no entry entry-id
action drop | forward
— no action
log log-id
— no log
match [next-header next-header]
— no match
dscp
— no dscp
dst-ip
— no dst-ip
— no dst-port
— no icmp-code
— no icmp-type
src-ip
— no src-ip
— no src-port
— no tcp-ack
— no tcp-syn
group-inserted-entries application application location location
renum old-entry-id new-entry-id
scope exclusive | template
— no scope
shared-radius-filter-wmark low low-watermark high high-watermark
sub-insert-radius start-entry entry-id count count
sub-insert-credit-control start-entry entry-id count count
sub-insert-shared-radius start-entry entry-id count count
sub-insert-wmark [low percentage] [high percentage]
ipv6-filter ipv6-filter-id [create]
— no ipv6-filter ipv6-filter-id
default-action drop | forward
description description-string
entry entry-id [create]
— no entry entry-id
action drop | forward
— no action
log log-id
— no log
match [next-header next-header]
— no match
dscp
— no dscp
dst-ip
— no dst-ip
— no dst-port
— no icmp-code
— no icmp-type
src-ip
— no src-ip
— no src-port
— no tcp-ack
— no tcp-syn
group-inserted-entries application application location location
renum old-entry-id new-entry-id
scope exclusive | template
— no scope
shared-radius-filter-wmark low low-watermark high high-watermark
sub-insert-radius start-entry entry-id count count
sub-insert-credit-control start-entry entry-id count count
sub-insert-shared-radius start-entry entry-id count count
sub-insert-wmark [low percentage] [high percentage]

9.25.1.11. BGP Peering Policy Commands

Note:

The commands listed in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

config
bgp-peering-policy policy-name [create]
— no bgp-peering-policy policy-name
[no] as-override
auth-keychain name
authentication-key [authentication-key | hash-key] [hash | hash2]
cluster cluster-id
— no cluster
[no] connect-retry seconds
[no] damping
description description-string
— no description
disable-communities [standard] [extended]
export policy-name [policy-name...(up to 5 max)]
— no export
hold-time seconds
— no hold-time
import policy-name [policy-name...(up to 5 max)]
— no import
keepalive seconds
— no keepalive
local-address ip-address
local-as as-number [private]
— no local-as
local-preference local-preference
loop-detect {drop-peer | discard-route | ignore-loop| off}
— no loop-detect
med-out {number | igp-cost}
— no med-out
min-as-origination seconds
multihop ttl-value
— no multihop
[no] next-hop-self
[no] passive
peer-as as-number
preference preference
— no preference
prefix-limit limit [log-only] [threshold percent]
— no prefix-limit
[no] remove-private
ttl-security min-ttl-value
— no ttl-security
type {internal | external}
— no type

9.25.1.12. Explicit Subscriber Mapping Commands

config
entry key sub-ident-string [sub-profile sub-profile-name] [alias sub-alias-string] [sla-profile sla-profile-name]
— no entry key sub-ident-string

9.25.1.13. IGMP Policy Commands

Note:

The commands listed in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

config
igmp-policy policy-name [create]
description description-string
— no description
egress-rate-modify [egress-rate-limit | scheduler scheduler-name]
[no] fast-leave
import policy-name
— no import
max-num-groups max-num-groups
max-num-sources max-num-sources
max-num-grp-sources [max-num-grp-sources]
mcast-reporting-dest dest-name
opt-reporting-fields [host-mac] [pppoe-session-id] [svc-id] [sap-id]
[no] shutdown
per-host-replication [uni-mac | mcast-mac]
query-interval seconds
redirection-policy policy-name
static
[no] group ip-address
version version
— no version
sub-mcac-policy policy-name
— sub-profile
sub-mcac-policy policy-name

9.25.1.14. Host Lockout Commands

Note:

The commands listed in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

config
host-lockout-policy policy-name [create]
— no host-lockout-policy policy-name
description description-string
host-key {mac}
— no host-key
lockout-reset-time seconds
lockout-time [min seconds] [max seconds]
config
— service
vprn service-id [customer customer-id]
— no vprnservice-id
[no] interface ip-int-name
[no] sap sap-id
host-lockout-policy policy-name
subscriber-interface ip-int-name [fwd-service service-id fwd-subscriber-interface ip-int-name] [create]
— no subscriber-interface ip-int-name
sap sap-id [create]
— no sap sap-id
host-lockout-policy policy-name
config
— service
vpls service-id [customer customer-id] [vpn vpn-id]
[no] interface ip-int-name
[no] sap sap-id
host-lockout-policy policy-name
[no] subscriber-interface ip-int-name [fwd-service service-id fwd-subscriber-interface ip-int-name] [create]
[no] sap sap-id
host-lockout-policy policy-name
config
— service
[no] vpls service-id [customer customer-id] [vpn vpn-id] [m-vpls]
sap sap-id [split-horizon-group group-name] [create] [capture-sap] [eth-ring ring-index]
— no sap sap-id
host-lockout-policy policy-name

9.25.1.15. Host Tracking Policy Commands

config
host-tracking-policy policy-name [create]
— no host-tracking-policy policy-name
description description-string
egress-rate-modify agg-rate-limit
egress-rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name

9.25.1.16. PIM Policy Commands

config
pim-policy policy-name [create]
— no pim-policy policy-name
description description-string

9.25.1.17. Router Advertisement Policy Commands

config
router-advertisement-policy name [create]
[no] dns-options
[no] include-dns
rdnss-lifetime seconds
rdnss-lifetime infinite
force-mcast {ip | mac}
max-advertisement seconds
min-advertisement seconds
mtu bytes
— no mtu
[no] prefix-options
[no] stateful
[no] on-link
preferred-lifetime seconds
preferred-lifetime infinite
valid-lifetime seconds
valid-lifetime infinite
[no] stateless
[no] on-link
preferred-lifetime seconds
preferred-lifetime infinite
valid-lifetime seconds
valid-lifetime infinite
reachable-time milli-seconds
retransmit-time milli-seconds
router-lifetime seconds
router-lifetime no-default-router

9.25.1.18. SLA Profile Commands

config
[no] sla-profile sla-profile-name
category-map category-map-name [create]
— no category-map category-map-name
category category-name [create]
— no category category-name
idle-timeout timeout
idle-timeout-action {shcv-check | terminate}
description description-string
egress
[no] ip-filter filter-id
qos sap-egress-policy-id [vport-scheduler | port-scheduler] [force]
— no qos
queue queue-id
— no queue queue-id
avg-frame-overhead percent
high-prio-only percent
mbs size [bytes | kilobytes]
— no mbs
rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
— no rate
stat-mode stat-mode
— no stat-mode
policer policer-id [create]
— no policer policer-id
cbs size [bytes | kilobytes]
— no cbs
mbs size [bytes | kilobytes]
— no mbs
packet-byte-offset {add bytes | subtract bytes}
rate {max | kilobits-per-second} [cir {max | kilobits-per-second}]
— no rate
stat-mode stat-mode
— no stat-mode
report-rate agg-rate-limit
report-rate scheduler scheduler-name
report-rate pppoe-actual-rate
report-rate rfc5515-actual-rate
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
[no] host-limits
ipv4-arp max-nr-of-hosts
— no ipv4-arp
ipv4-dhcp max-nr-of-hosts
— no ipv4-dhcp
ipv4-overall max-nr-of-hosts
ipv4-ppp max-nr-of-hosts
— no ipv4-ppp
ipv6-overall max-nr-of-hosts
ipv6-pd-ipoe-dhcp max-nr-of-hosts
ipv6-pd-overall max-nr-of-hosts
ipv6-pd-ppp-dhcp max-nr-of-hosts
ipv6-wan-ipoe-dhcp max-nr-of-hosts
ipv6-wan-ipoe-slaac max-nr-of-hosts
ipv6-wan-overall max-nr-of-hosts
ipv6-wan-ppp-dhcp max-nr-of-hosts
ipv6-wan-ppp-slaac max-nr-of-hosts
lac-overall max-nr-of-hosts
overall max-nr-of-hosts
— no overall
[no] remove-oldest
[no] ip-filter filter-id
qos sap-ingress-policy-id [shared-queuing | multipoint-shared | service-queuing] [force]
— no qos
queue queue-id
— no queue queue-id
high-prio-only percent
mbs size [bytes | kilobytes]
— no mbs
rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
— no rate
stat-mode {v4-v6}
— no stat-mode
policer policer-id [create]
— no policer policer-id
cbs {size [bytes | kilobytes] | default}
— no cbs
mbssize [bytes | kilobytes]
— no mbs
packet-byte-offset {add bytes | subtract bytes}
rate {max | kilobits-per-second} [cir {max | kilobits-per-second}]
— no rate
stat-mode stat-mode
— no stat-mode
report-rate agg-rate-limit
report-rate scheduler scheduler-name

9.25.1.19. Subscriber Identification Policy Commands

config
[no] sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name
entry key app-profile-string app-profile app-profile-name
— no entry key app-profile-string
description description-string
script-url dhcp-primary-script-url
— no script-url
[no] shutdown
script-url dhcp-secondary-script-url
— no script-url
[no] shutdown
entry key sla-profile-string sla-profile sla-profile-name
— no entry key sla-profile-string
entry key sub-profile-string sub-profile sub-profile-name
— no entry key sub-profile-string
script-url dhcp-tertiary-script-url
— no script-url
[no] shutdown

9.25.1.20. Auto-Generated Subscriber Identification Key Commands

Note:

These commands are supported on the 7450 ESS in mixed mode.

config
ipoe-sub-id-key sub-id-key [sub-id-key...(up to 4 max)]
ppp-sub-id-key sub-id-key [sub-id-key...(up to 5 max)]

9.25.1.21. Auto-Generated Subscriber Identification Key Service Commands

Note:

Refer to the Layer 2 Services and EVPN Guide: VLL, VPLS, PBB, and EVPN and Layer 3 Services Guide: Internet Enhanced Services and Virtual Private Routed Network Services for further services commands.

config
— service
— vprn
— subscriber-interface ip-int-name
— group-interface ip-int-name
— sap sap-id
— sub-sla-mgmt
def-sub-id use-auto-id
def-sub-id use-sap-id
def-sub-id string sub-id
— no def-sub-id
— vpls
— sap sap-id
— sub-sla-mgmt
def-sub-id use-auto-id
def-sub-id use-sap-id
def-sub-id string sub-id
— no def-sub-id
— ies
— subscriber-interface ip-int-name
— group-interface ip-int-name
— sap sap-id
— sub-sla-mgmt
def-sub-id use-auto-id
def-sub-id use-sap-id
def-sub-id string sub-id
— no def-sub-id
— subscriber-management
— msap-policy msap-policy-name
— sub-sla-mgmt
def-sub-id use-auto-id
def-sub-id use-sap-id
def-sub-id string sub-id
— no def-sub-id

9.25.1.22. Subscriber MCAC Policy Commands

config
sub-mcac-policy sub-mcac-policy-name [create]
— no sub-mcac-policy sub-mcac-policy-name
description description-string
[no] shutdown
unconstrained-bw mandatory-bw mandatory-bw

9.25.1.23. Subscriber Profile Commands

For information about configuring accounting policies, refer to the SR OS 7450 ESS and 7750 SR System Management Guide.

config
accu-stats-policy policy-name [create]
— no accu-stats-policy policy-name
description description-string
— [no] entry direction direction type type id id
[no] sub-profile subscriber-profile-name
accu-stats-policy policy-name
ancp
ancp-policy name
egress
rate-adjustment adjusted-percent
rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
rate-monitor kilobit-per-second [alarm]
rate-reduction kilobit-per-second
rate-adjustment adjusted-percent
rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
rate-monitor kilobit-per-second [alarm]
rate-reduction kilobit-per-second
[no] collect-stats
description description-string
— egress
agg-rate-limit agg-rate [queue-frame-based-accounting]
avg-frame-size bytes
encap-offset [type type]
lag-per-link-hash class {class} weight weight
policer-control-policy policy-name
max-rate {kilobits-per-second | max}
— no max-rate
min-thresh-separation size [bytes | kilobytes]
priority level
mbs-contribution size [bytes | kilobytes] [fixed]
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
scheduler scheduler-name rate [pir-rate] [cir cir-rate]
— no scheduler scheduler-name
— no host-tracking-policy policy-name
description description-string
egress-rate-modify agg-rate-limit
egress-rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
hsmda
agg-rate-limit agg-rate
qos policy-id
— no qos
wrr-policy weight
— no wrr-policy
packet-byte-offset {add add-bytes | subtract sub-bytes}
queue queue-id [create]
— no queue queue-id
mbs size [bytes | kilobytes]
— no mbs
rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
— no rate
rate {max | kilobits-per-second}
— no rate
slope-policy hsmda-slope-policy-name
stat-mode {v4-v6}
— no stat-mode
wrr-weight weight
— no wrr-weight
qos policy-id
— no qos
queue queue-id
stat-mode {v4-v6}
— no stat-mode
policer policer-id [create]
stat-mode {v4-v6}
— no stat-mode
igmp-policy policy-name
policer-control-policy policer-control-policy-name
max-rate {rate | max}
— no max-rate
min-thresh-separation size [bytes | kilobytes]
priority level
mbs-contribution size [bytes | kilobytes]
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
scheduler scheduler-name rate [pir-rate] [cir cir-rate]
— no scheduler scheduler-name
pim-policy policy-name
— no pim-policy policy-name
policy name1 [name2] [name3] [name4] [name5]
— no policy
entry key sla-profile-string sla-profile sla-profile
— no entry key sla-profile-string
sub-mcac-policy policy-name
[no] vport-hashing
volume-stats-type {ip | default}

9.25.1.24. IPoE Session Policy Commands

config
ipoe-session-policy policy-name [create]
— no ipoe-session-policy policy-name
description description-string
session-key sap mac [cid] [rid]
session-timeout timeout

9.25.1.25. Multi-Chassis Redundancy Commands

config
peer ip-address [create]
— no peer ip-address
authentication-key [authentication-key | hash-key] [hash | hash2]
description description-string
bfd-enable service service-id interface interface-name dst-ip ip-address
— no bfd-enable
discovery-interval interval-1 [boot interval-2]
keep-alive-interval time-interval
tunnel-group group-id [create]
— no tunnel-group group-id
peer-group group-id
— no peer-group
priority priority
— no priority
[no] preempt
[no] shutdown
[no] mc-lag
keep-alive-interval interval
lag lag-id lacp-key admin-key system-id system-id [remote-lag lag-id] system-priority system-priority
— no lag lag-id
[no] shutdown
[no] ring sync-tag
[no] debounce
dst-ip ip-address
— no dst-ip
interface ip-int-name
— no interface
service-id service-id
— no service-id
[no] path-b
[no] range vlan-range
[no] path-excl
[no] range vlan-range
[no] ring-node ring-node-name
dst-ip ip-address
— no dst-ip
interval interval
— no interval
service-id service-id
— no service-id
[no] shutdown
src-ip ip-address
— no src-ip
src-mac ieee-address
— no src-mac
vlan [vlan-encap]
— no vlan
[no] shutdown
[no] l3-ring sync-tag
[no] debounce
dst-ip ip-address
— no dst-ip
interface ip-int-name
— no interface
max-debounce-time max-debounce-time
service-id service-id
— no service-id
[no] ring-node ring-node-name
dst-ip ip-address
— no dst-ip
interval interval
— no interval
service-id service-id
— no service-id
[no] shutdown
src-ip ip-address
— no src-ip
src-mac ieee-address
— no src-mac
vlan [vlan-encap]
— no vlan
[no] srrp-instance srrp-id
[no] shutdown
[no] shutdown
source-address ip-address
[no] sync
[no] igmp
[no] igmp-snooping
[no] ipsec
[no] mc-ring
[no] mld-snooping
pim-snooping [saps]
port [port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [create]
— no port [port-id | lag-id]
range encap-range [sync-tag sync-tag]
— no range encap-range
[no] shutdown
[no] srrp
[no] sub-host-trk
[no] sub-mgmt
tunnel-group tunnel-group-id sync-tag tag-name [create]

9.25.1.26. SHCV Policy Commands

config
shcv-policy name [create]
— no shcv-policy name
description description-string
— no description
source-ip-origin {interface | vrrp}
action {alarm | remove}
— no action
interval minutes
— no interval
retry-count [retry-count]
[no] shutdown
timeout seconds
— no timeout
trigger trigger-type
retry-count [retry-count]
[no] shutdown
timeout seconds
— no timeout
vpls
source-ip ip-address
— no source-ip
source-mac ieee-address
— no source-mac
— service
ies service-id
interface ip-int-name
subscriber-interface ip-int-name
group-interface ip-int-name
shcv-policy name
shcv-policy name
vpls service-id
— sap
vprn service-id
interface ip-int-name
subscriber-interface ip-int-name
group-interface ip-int-name
shcv-policy name
shcv-policy name

9.25.1.27. Subscriber Management Service Commands

9.25.1.27.1. VPLS Subscriber Management Configuration Commands

config
— service
[no] vpls service-id [customer customer-id] [vpn vpn-id] [m-vpls]
sap sap-id [split-horizon-group group-name] [create]
— no sap sap-id
host-limit max-num-hosts
— no host-limit
min-auth-interval min-auth-interval
[no] shutdown
diameter-application-policy policy-name [create]
— no diameter-application-policy policy-name
host [ip ip-address [mac mac-address]} [subscriber-sap-id | subscriber sub-ident-string [sub-profile sub-profile-name [sla-profile sla-profile-name [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile app-profile-name] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id]
— no host [ip ip-address [mac mac-address]
— no host all
host-connectivity-verify source-ip ip-address [source-mac ieee-address] [interval interval] [action {remove | alarm}] [timeout retry-timeout] [retry-count count]
[no] sub-sla-mgmt
def-app-profile default-app-profile-name
def-sla-profile default-sla-profile-name
def-sub-id string sub-ident-string
def-sub-id use-sap-id
— no def-sub-id
def-sub-profile sub-profile-name
multi-sub-sap number-of-sub
[no] shutdown
non-sub-traffic sub-profile sub-profile-name sla-profile sla-profile-name [subscriber sub-ident-string]
sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name
sap sap-id [create] [capture-sap]
description description-string
ipoe-session-policy policy-name
user-db local-user-db-name
— no user-db
[no] shutdown

9.25.1.27.1.1. Capture SAP Configuration Commands

config
— service
[no] vpls service-id [customer customer-id] [create]
sap sap-id [create] [capture-sap]
cpu-protection policy-id [mac-monitoring] | [eth-cfm-monitoring [aggregate] [car]]
[no] description
dhcp-python-policy policy-name
dhcp6-python-policy policy-name
dhcp-user-db local-user-db-name
dhcp6-user-db local-user-db-name
dist-cpu-protection policy-name
dynamic-services-policy dynsvc-policy-name
[no] shutdown
host-lockout-policy policy-name
group-interface ip-int-name
msap-policy msap-policy-name
service service-id
— no service
pppoe-policy pppoe-policy-name
— no pppoe-policy pppoe-policy-name
pppoe-python-policy policy-name
pppoe-user-db local-user-db-name
rtr-solicit-user-db local-user-db
[no] shutdown
track-srrp srrp-id
— no track-srrp
trigger-packet [dhcp] [pppoe] [arp] [dhcp6] [ppp] [rtr-solicit] [data]

9.25.1.27.2. Managed SAP Policy Commands

config
msap-policy msap-policy-name [create]
— no msap-policy msap-policy-name
cpu-protection policy-id [mac-monitoring]
description description-string
— no dist-cpu-protection policy-name
anti-spoof {ip-mac | nh-mac}
— no anti-spoof
egress
qos policy-id
— no qos
qos policy-id [shared-queuing | service-queuing]
— no qos
expiry-time expiry-time
import policy-name
— no import policy-name
max-num-group max-num-groups
max-num-sources max-num-sources
max-num-grp-sources [max-num-grp-sources]
— no max-num-grp-sources [max-num-grp-sources]
lag-link-map-profile link-map-profile-id
[no] sticky
def-app-profile app-profile-name
def-inter-dest-id {string string | use-top-q}
def-sla-profile sla-profile-name
def-sub-id use-auto-id
def-sub-id use-sap-id
def-sub-id string sub-id
— no def-sub-id
def-sub-profile sub-profile-name
multi-sub-sap [limit limit]
non-sub-traffic sub-profile-name sla-profile sla-profile-name [subscriber sub-ident-string] [app-profile app-profile-name]
sub-ident-policy policy-name
host-limit max-num-hosts
— no host-limit
min-auth-interval min-auth-interval
arp-reply-agent [sub-ident]
dhcp
lease-populate [nbr-of-leases]
[no] option
action dhcp-action
— no action
circuit-id{ascii-tuple | vlan-ascii-tuple}
remote-id {mac | string string}
— no remote-id
[no] sap-id
[no] service-id
[no] string
[no] system-id
emulated-server ip-address
lease-time [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds] [radius-override]
— no lease-time
[no] shutdown
egress
qos policy-id
— no qos
qos policy-id [multipoint-shared | service-queuing]
— no qos
[no] fast-leave
import policy-name
— no import
max-num-groups max-num-groups
mcac
if-policy mcac-if-policy-name
— no if-policy
policy policy-name
— no policy
level level-id bw bandwidth
— no level level-id
number-down number-lag-port-down level level-id
— no number-down number-lag-port-down
unconstrained-bw bandwidth mandatory-bw mandatory-bw
mvr
from-vpls service-id
— no from-vpls
query-interval seconds
robust-count robust-count
[no] send-queries
version version
— no version
split-horizon-group group-name

9.25.1.27.3. VPRN Subscriber Interface Configuration Commands

Note:

The commands listed in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

config
— service
— vprn service-id [customer customer-id]
— no vprn service-id
subscriber-interface ip-int-name [create]
subscriber-interface ip-int-name [create] fwd-service service-id fwd-subscriber-interface fwd-int-name
— no subscriber-interface ip-int-name
address {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask} [gw-ip-address ip-address] [populate-host-routes]
— no address
description description-string
python-policy name
emulated-server ip-address
lease-time [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds] [override]
— no lease-time
[no] shutdown
relay-proxy [release-update-src-ip] [siaddr-override ip-address]
server server1 [server2...(up to 8 max)]
— no server
[no] shutdown
[no] ipoe-linking
[no] ipoe-session
session-limit session-limit
ipv6
address ipv6-address/prefix-length [pd] [wan-host] [track-srrp srrp-instance] [holdup-time milli-seconds]
— no address ipv6-address/prefix-length
[no] auto-reply
default-dns ipv6-address [secondary ipv6-address]
link-local-address ipv6-address
prefix ipv6-address/prefix-length [pd] [wan-host] track-srrp srrp-instance [holdup-time milli-seconds]
— no prefix ipv6-address/prefix-length
prefix ipv6-address/prefix-length [pd] [wan-host]
[no] dhcp6
filter filter-id
— no filter
pd-managed-route [next-hop {ipv4 | ipv6}]
[no] proxy-server
client-applications [dhcp] [ppp]
preferred-lifetime [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
preferred-lifetime infinite
rebind-timer [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
renew-timer [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
server-id duid-en hex hex-string
server-id duid-en string ascii-string
server-id duid-ll
— no server-id
— no shutdown
valid-lifetime [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
valid-lifetime infinite
python-policy name
— no relay
description description-string
source-address ipv6-address
link-address ipv6-address
server ipv6-address [ipv6-address...(upto 8 max)]
— no server
client-applications [dhcp] [pppoe]
[no] shutdown
[no] dns-options
[no] include-dns
include-dns seconds
rdnss-lifetime infinite
force-mcast [ip] [mac]
max-advertisement seconds
min-advertisement seconds
mtu bytes
— no mtu
[no] autonomous
[no] on-link
preferred-lifetime seconds
preferred-lifetime infinite
valid-lifetime seconds
valid-lifetime infinite
reachable-time milli-seconds
retransmit-time milli-seconds
router-lifetime seconds
router-lifetime no-default-router
[no] shutdown
inactivity-timer [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
inactivity-timer infinite
client-application [ppp-v4]
default-pool pool-name [secondary pool-name]
server server-name
— no server
[no] shutdown
[no] shutdown
unnumbered [ip-int-name | ip-address]
— no unnumbered

9.25.1.27.4. VPRN Subscriber Interface Group Interface Commands

Note:

The commands listed in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

config
— service
— vprn service-id [customer customer-id]
— no vprn service-id
subscriber-interface ip-int-name [fwd-service service-id fwd-subscriber-interface ip-int-name] [create]
— no subscriber-interface ip-int-name
group-interface ip-int-name [create]
group-interface ip-int-name [create] lns
group-interface ip-int-name [create] wlangw
— no group-interface ip-int-name
host-limit max-num-hosts
— no host-limit
min-auth-interval min-auth-interval
sap-host-limit max-num-hosts-sap
[no] shutdown
[no] arp-populate
arp-timeout seconds
[no] shutdown
description description-string
dhcp
client-applications {[dhcp] [pppoe]}
description description-string
gi-address ip-address [src-ip-addr]
— no gi-address
lease-populate [nbr-of-entries]
[no] option
[no] sap-id
[no] service-id
string text
— no string
[no] system-id
emulated-server ip-address
lease-time [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds] [override]
— no lease-time
[no] shutdown
relay-proxy [release-update-src-ip] [siaddr-override ip-address]
server server1 [server2...(up to 8 max)]
— no server
[no] shutdown
[no] trusted
host-connectivity-verify [interval interval] [action {remove | alarm}] [timeout retry-timeout] [retry-count count] [family family]
host-limit max-num-hosts
— no host-limit
icmp
[no] mask-reply
param-problem [number seconds]
redirects [number seconds]
— no redirects
ttl-expired number seconds]
— no ttl-expired
unreachables [number seconds]
policy-accounting template-name
ip-mtu octets
— no ip-mtu
[no] shutdown
description description-string
force-auth [cid-change] [rid-change]
force-auth disabled
— no force-auth
ipoe-session-policy policy-name
min-auth-interval [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
min-auth-interval infinite
radius-session-timeout {backwards-compatible | ignore | absolute}
sap-session-limit sap-session-limit
session-limit session-limit
user-db local-user-db-name
— no user-db
[no] shutdown
[no] ipv6
rdnss-lifetime seconds
rdnss-lifetime infinite
inactivity-timer [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
min-auth-interval [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
— no shutdown
— no user-db
client-application [ppp-v4]
default-pool pool-name [secondary pool-name]
ipv6
client-application [ppp-slaac] [ipoe-wan] [ipoe-slaac]
server server-name
— no server
server server-name
— no server
[no] shutdown
[no] mac ieee-address
min-auth-interval min-auth-interval
policy-control diameter-policy-name
[no] ppp
description description-string
policy ppp-policy-name
— no policy
session-limit session-limit
[no] shutdown
user-db local-user-db-name
— no user-db
[no] pppoe
anti-spoof pppoe-anti-spoofing-type
— no anti-spoof
description description-string
policy ppp-policy-name
— no policy
sap-session-limit sap-session-limit
session-limit session-limit
[no] shutdown
[no] proxy-arp-policy policy-name [policy-name...(up to 5 max)]
redundant-interface red-ip-int-name
[no] sap sap-id
accounting-policy acct-policy-id
— no accounting-policy [acct-policy-id]
anti-spoof {ip | ip-mac | nh-mac}
— no anti-spoof
app-profile app-profile-name
atm
egress
traffic-desc traffic-desc-profile-id
encapsulation atm-encap-type
traffic-desc traffic-desc-profile-id
oam
[no] alarm-cells
[no] collect-stats
default-host ipv4-prefix/mask | ipv6-prefix/prefix-length next-hop ipv4-address | ipv6-address
— no default-host ipv4-prefix/mask | ipv6-prefix/prefix-length
cpu-protection policy-id [mac-monitoring]
default-host ip-address/mask next-hop next-hop-ip
— no default-host ip-address/mask
description description-string
egress
[no] agg-rate
rate {max | rate}
— no rate
filter ip ip-filter-id
filter ipv6 ipv6-filter-id
— no filter [ip ip-filter-id] [ipv6 ipv6-filter-id]
— no filter
[no] qos policy-id
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
expiry-time expiry-time
import policy-name
— no import
max-num-group max-num-groups
max-num-sources max-num-sources
max-num-grp-sources [1 to 32000]
filter ip ip-filter-id
filter ipv6 ipv6-filter-id
— no filter [ip ip-filter-id] [ipv6 ipv6-filter-id]
— no filter
match-qinq-dot1p {top | bottom}
qos policy-id [shared-queuing]
— no qos policy-id
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
multi-service-site customer-site-name
static-host ip ip/did-address [mac ieee-address] [create]
— no static-host [ip ip-address] mac ieee-address
— no static-host all [force]
— no static-host ip ip-address
ancp-string ancp-string
app-profile app-profile-name
inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id
route {ip-prefix/length | ip-prefix netmask} [create]
— no route {ip-prefix/length | ip-prefix netmask}
retail-svc-id service-id
rip-policy policy-name
— no rip-policy
[no] shutdown
sla-profile sla-profile-name
sub-profile sub-profile-name
subscriber sub-ident
— no subscriber
[no] single-mac
[no] shutdown
[no] sub-sla-mgmt
def-app-profile default-app-profile-name
def-sla-profile default-sla-profile-name
def-sub-id use-auto-id
def-sub-id use-sap-id
def-sub-id string sub-id
— no def-sub-id
def-sub-profile sub-profile-name
multi-sub-sap subscriber-limit
[no] shutdown
non-sub-traffic sub-profile sub-profile-name sla-profile sla-profile-name [subscriber sub-ident-string]
sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name
[no] shutdown
[no] srrp srrp-id
[no] bfd-enable service-id interface interface-name dst-ip ip-address
description description-string
gw-mac mac-address
— no gw-mac
keep-alive-interval interval
message-path sap-id
monitor-oper-group group-name priority-step step
[no] policy vrrp-policy-id
[no] preempt
priority priority
[no] shutdown
wpp
initial-app-profile app-profile-name
initial-sla-profile sla-profile-name
initial-sub-profile sub-profile-name
lease-time [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
— no lease-time
portal router router-instance name wpp-portal-name
— no portal
portal-group portal-group-name
user-db local-user-db-name
— no user-db

9.25.1.27.5. IES Subscriber Management Configuration Commands

Note:

The commands listed in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

config
— service
ies service-id [customer customer-id] [vpn vpn-id]
[no] interface ip-int-name

9.25.1.27.5.1. IES Interface Commands

address {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask} [gw-ip-address ip-address] [populate-host-routes]
— no address
[no] arp-populate
arp-timeout seconds
cflowd [acl | interface]
— no cflowd
description description-string
dhcp
client-applications {[dhcp] [pppoe]}
description description-string
gi-address ip-address [src-ip-addr]
— no gi-address
lease-populate nbr-of-leases
[no] option
action {replace | drop | keep}
— no action
circuit-id [ascii-tuple | ifindex | sap-id]
— no circuit-id
[no] remote-id
relay-proxy [release-update-src-ip] [siaddr-override ip-address]
server server1 [server2...(up to 8 max)]
— no server
[no] shutdown
[no] trusted
host-connectivity-verify [source {vrrp | interface}] [interval interval] [action {remove | alarm}] [timeout retry-timeout] [retry-count count]
icmp
[no] mask-reply
redirects [number seconds]
— no redirects
ttl-expired number seconds]
— no ttl-expired
unreachables [number seconds]
[no] loopback
[no] mac ieee-address
[no] proxy-arp-policy policy-name [policy-name...(up to 5 max)]
[no] sap sap-id

9.25.1.27.6. IES Subscriber Interface Commands

Note:

The commands listed in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

config
— service
ies service-id [customer customer-id] [vpn vpn-id]
subscriber-interface ip-int-name [create]
subscriber-interface ip-int-name [create] fwd-service service-id fwd-subscriber-interface fwd-int-name
— no subscriber-interface ip-int-name
[no] address {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask}
description description-string
dhcp
gi-address ip-address [src-ip-addr]
— no gi-address
relay-proxy [release-update-src-ip] [siaddr-override ip-address]
[no] shutdown
[no] ipoe-session
session-limit session-limit
ipv6
default-dns ipv6-address [secondary ipv6-address]
default-dns ipv6-address [secondary ipv6-address]
link-local-address ipv6-address
prefix ipv6-address/prefix-length [pd] [wan-host] track-srrp srrp-instance [holdup-time milli-seconds]
— no prefix ipv6-address/prefix-length
prefix ipv6-address/prefix-length [pd] [wan-host]
[no] dhcp6
pd-managed-route [next-hop {ipv4 | ipv6}]
[no] proxy-server
client-applications [dhcp] [ppp]
preferred-lifetime [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
preferred-lifetime infinite
valid-lifetime [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
valid-lifetime infinite
rebind-timer [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
renew-timer [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
server-id duid-en hex hex-string
server-id duid-en string ascii-string
server-id duid-ll
— no server-id
— no shutdown
python-policy name
[no] relay
description description-string
source-address ipv6-address
link-address ipv6-address
server ipv6-address [ipv6-address...(upto 8 max)]
— no server
client-applications [dhcp] [ppp]
[no] shutdown
[no] dns-options
[no] include-dns
rdnss-lifetime seconds
rdnss-lifetime infinite
force-mcast [ip] [mac]
max-advertisement seconds
min-advertisement seconds
mtu bytes
— no mtu
[no] autonomous
[no] on-link
preferred-lifetime seconds>
preferred-lifetime infinite
valid-lifetime seconds
valid-lifetime infinite
reachable-time milli-seconds
retransmit-time milli-seconds
router-lifetime seconds
router-lifetime no-default-router
[no] shutdown
inactivity-timer [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
inactivity-timer infinite
client-application [ppp-v4]
default-pool pool-name [secondary pool-name]
server server-name
— no server
[no] shutdown
ipv6
client-application [ppp-slaac] [ipoe-wan] [ipoe-slaac]

9.25.1.27.7. IES Subscriber Interface Group Interface Commands

Note:

The commands listed in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

config
— service
ies service-id [customer customer-id] [vpn vpn-id]
[no] subscriber-interface ip-int-name
[no] group-interface ip-int-name
host-limit max-num-hosts
— no host-limit
min-auth-interval min-auth-interval
sap-host-limit max-num-hosts-sap
[no] shutdown
[no] arp-populate
arp-timeout seconds
[no] shutdown
description description-string
dhcp
description description-string
filter filter-id
— no filter
gi-address ip-address [src-ip-addr]
— no gi-address
lease-populate nbr-of-leases
option
action {replace | drop | keep}
— no action
circuit-id [ascii-tuple | ifindex | sap-id]
— no circuit-id
[no] remote-id
[no] sap-id
[no] service-id
string text
— no string
[no] system-id
relay-proxy [release-update-src-ip]
server server1 [server2...(up to 8 max)]
— no server
[no] shutdown
[no] trusted
host-connectivity-verify [interval interval] [action {remove | alarm}] [timeout retry-timeout] [retry-count count] [family family]
icmp
[no] mask-reply
param-problem [number seconds]
redirects [number seconds]
— no redirects
ttl-expired number seconds]
— no ttl-expired
unreachables [number seconds]
ip-mtu octets
— no ip-mtu
[no] shutdown
description description-string
force-auth [cid-change] [rid-change]
force-auth disabled
— no force-auth
ipoe-session-policy policy-name
min-auth-interval [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
min-auth-interval infinite
radius-session-timeout {backwards-compatible | ignore | absolute}
sap-session-limit sap-session-limit
session-limit session-limit
user-db local-user-db-name
— no user-db
[no] shutdown
ipv6
[no] auto-reply
client-application [ppp-v4]
default-pool pool-name [secondary pool-name]
[no] ipv6
client-application [ppp-v4]
server server-name
— no server
server server-name
— no server
[no] shutdown
[no] loopback
[no] mac ieee-address
[no] pppoe
description description-string
ppp-policy pppoe-policy-name
— no ppp-policy
sap-session-limit sap-session-limit
session-limit session-limit
[no] shutdown
[no] proxy-arp-policy policy-name [policy-name...(up to 5 max)]
ipv6
rdnss-lifetime seconds
rdnss-lifetime infinite
[no] sap sap-id
accounting-policy acct-policy-id
— no accounting-policy [acct-policy-id]
anti-spoof {ip | ip-mac | nh-mac}
— no anti-spoof
atm
egress
traffic-desc traffic-desc-profile-id
encapsulation atm-encap-type
traffic-desc traffic-desc-profile-id
oam
[no] alarm-cells
[no] collect-stats
cpu-protection [mac-monitoring] | [eth-cfm-monitoring [aggregate][car]]
default-host ip-address/mask next-hop next-hop-ip
— no default-host ip-address/mask
description description-string
egress
[no] agg-rate
rate {max | rate}
— no rate
filter {ip ip-filter-id | ipv6 ipv6-filter-id}
— no filter [{ip ip-filter-id | ipv6 ipv6-filter-id}]
qos policy-id
— no qos
policer-control-policy policy-name
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
filter ip ip-filter-id
— no filter
match-qinq-dot1p {top | bottom}
qos policy-id [shared-queuing]
— no qos
policer-control-policy policy-name
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
[no] multi-service-site customer-site-name
static-host ip ip/did-address [mac ieee-address] [create]
static-host mac ieee-address [create]
— no static-host [ip ip-address] mac ieee-address
— no static-host all [force]
— no static-host ip ip-address
ancp-string ancp-string
app-profile app-profile-name
inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id
[no] route {ip-prefix/length | ip-prefix netmask}
[no] route ipv6-prefix/prefix-length [metric metric-value]
rip-policy policy-name
— no rip-policy
[no] shutdown
sla-profile sla-profile-name
sub-profile sub-profile-name
subscriber sub-ident
— no subscriber
[no] shutdown
[no] sub-sla-mgmt
[no] sub-sla-mgmt
def-app-profile default-app-profile-name
def-sla-profile default-sla-profile-name
def-sub-id use-auto-id
def-sub-id use-sap-id
def-sub-id string sub-id
— no def-sub-id
def-sub-profile sub-profile-name
multi-sub-sap subscriber-limit
[no] shutdown
non-sub-traffic sub-profile sub-profile-name sla-profile sla-profile-name [subscriber sub-ident-string]
sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name
[no] shutdown
[no] srrp srrp-id
[no] bfd-enable service-id interface interface-name dst-ip ip-address
description description-string
— no description
gw-mac mac-address
— no gw-mac
keep-alive-interval interval
message-path sap-id
monitor-oper-group group-name priority-step step
— no message-path
[no] policy vrrp-policy-id
[no] preempt
priority priority
[no] shutdown
srrp-enabled-routing [hold-time hold-time]
tos-marking-state {trusted | untrusted}
[no] urpf-check
wpp
initial-app-profile app-profile-name
initial-sla-profile sla-profile-name
initial-sub-profile sub-profile-name
lease-time [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
— no lease-time
portal router router-instance name wpp-portal-name
— no portal
portal-group portal-group-name
user-db local-user-db-name
— no user-db

9.25.1.27.8. Service Subscriber Interface, Group Interface IPoE Command

9.25.1.27.8.1. VPRN Group Interface Commands

config
— service
— vprn service-id [customer customer-id]
— no vprn service-id
— ies service-id [customer customer-id]
— no ies service-id
subscriber-interface ip-int-name [fwd-service service-id fwd-subscriber-interface ip-int-name] [create]
— no subscriber-interface ip-int-name
group-interface ip-int-name [create]
group-interface ip-int-name [create] lns
group-interface ip-int-name [create] wlangw
— no group-interface ip-int-name
[no] ipoe-session
description description-string
force-auth [cid-change] [rid-change]
force-auth disabled
— no force-auth
ipoe-session-policy policy-name
min-auth-interval [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
min-auth-interval infinite
sap-session-limit sap-session-limit
session-limit session-limit
[no] shutdown
user-db local-user-db-name
— no user-db

9.25.1.27.9. RIP Commands

configure
rip-policy policy policy-name [create]
— no rip-policy policy-name
authentication-key authentication-key | hash-key [hash | hash2]
authentication-type {none | password | message-digest | message-digest-20}
description description-string
local-user-db local-user-db-name [create]
— no local-user-db local-user-db-name
ppp
host host-name [create]
— no host host-name
rip-policy policy-name
— no rip-policy
ipoe
host host-name [create]
— no host host-name
rip-policy policy-name
— no rip-policy
configure
— service
— ies|vprn
[no] subscriber-interface ip-int-name
[no] group-interface ip-int-name
[no] sap sap-id
static-host ip ip/did-address [mac ieee-address] [create]
static-host mac ieee-address [create]
— no static-host [ip ip-address] mac ieee-address
— no static-host all [force]
— no static-host ip ip-address
rip-policy policy-name
— no rip-policy
— vprn
[no] rip
[no] group name
[no] neighbor ip-int-name
configure
— router
[no] rip
[no] group name
[no] neighbor ip-int-name

9.25.1.27.10. VPort Commands

Refer to the SR OS Interfaces Guide for further information on card, Media Dependent Adapter (MDA), MCM (MDA Carrier Module), CMA (Compact Media Adapter) and port provisioning.

config
— port port-id
access
egress
vport vport-name [create]
— no vport vport-name
rate {max | rate}
agg-rate-limit limit
description description-string
host-match dest string [create]
— no host-match dest string
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduling-policy-name
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name

9.25.1.27.11. Redundant Interface Commands

Note:

The commands listed in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

config
— service
ies
[no] redundant-interface ip-int-name
address {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask} [remote-ip ip-address]
— no address
[no] description description-string
[no] shutdown
[no] spoke-sdp sdp-id:vc-id
egress
filter [ip ip-filter-id]
vc-label ingress-vc-label
— no vc-label [ingress-vc-label]
filter [ip ip-filter-id]
— no filter
vc-label ingress-vc-label
— no vc-label [ingress-vc-label]
[no] shutdown
config
— service
— vprn
[no] redundant-interface ip-int-name
address {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask} [remote-ip ip-address]
— no address
[no] description description-string
[no] shutdown
[no] spoke-sdp sdp-id:vc-id
egress
filter [ip ip-filter-id]
vc-label ingress-vc-label
— no vc-label [ingress-vc-label]
filter [ip ip-filter-id]
— no filter
vc-label ingress-vc-label
— no vc-label [ingress-vc-label]
[no] shutdown
config
— service
— sdp sdp-id [gre | mpls]
— no sdp sdp-id
port [port-id | lag-id]
— no port
pw-port pw-port-id [vc-id vc-id] [create]
— no pw-port pw-port-id
description description-string
egress
shaper
int-dest-id int-dest-id
— no int-dest-id int-dest-id
vport vport-name
— no vport vport-name
encap-type {dot1q | qinq}
— no encap-type
[no] shutdown
vc-type {ether | vlan}
— no vc-type
vlan-vc-tag vlan-id
config
— service
— ies service-id [customer customer-id] [vpn vpn-id]
— vprn service-id [customer customer-id]
— no vprn service-id
— interface ip-int-name [create] [tunnel]
— no interface ip-int-name
[no] ipv6
[no] urpf-check
mode {strict | loose | strict-no-ecmp}
— no mode
[no] subscriber-interface ip-int-name
group-interface ip-int-name [create]
group-interface ip-int-name [create] lns
group-interface ip-int-name [create] wlangw
— no group-interface ip-int-name
[no] ipv6
[no] urpf-check
mode {strict | loose | strict-no-ecmp}
— no mode

9.25.1.27.12. Wireless Portal Protocol (WPP) Commands

config
— aaa
wpp
portal-group portal-group-name [create]
— no portal-group portal-group-name
description description-string
[no] portal router router-instance name wpp-portal-name
[no] shutdown
config
— router
wpp
portal wpp-portal-name address ip-address [create]
portal wpp-portal-name
no portal wpp-portal-name
retry-interval milliseconds
secret secret [hash | hash2]
— no secret
[no] shutdown
version version
— no version
[no] shutdown
config
— service
— vprn service-id [customer customer-id]
— no vprn service-id
wpp
portal wpp-portal-name address ip-address [create]
portal wpp-portal-name
no portal wpp-portal-name
retry-interval milliseconds
secret secret [hash | hash2]
— no secret
[no] shutdown
version version
— no version
[no] shutdown
config
— service
— ies service-id [customer customer-id] [vpn vpn-id]
— vprn service-id [customer customer-id]
— no vprn service-id
subscriber-interface ip-int-name [create]
— no subscriber-interface ip-int-name
group-interface ip-int-name [create]
— no group-interface ip-int-name
wpp
initial-app-profile app-profile-name
initial-sla-profile sla-profile-name
initial-sub-profile sub-profile-name
lease-time [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
— no lease-time
portal router router-instance name wpp-portal-name
— no portal
portal-group portal-group-name
[no] shutdown
user-db local-user-db-name
— no user-db
[no] shutdown
config
local-user-db local-user-db-name [create]
— no local-user-db local-user-db-name
— ipoe
— host host-name [create]
— no host host-name
wpp
initial-app-profile app-profile-name
initial-sla-profile sla-profile-name
initial-sub-profile sub-profile-name
portal router router-instance name wpp-portal-name
— no portal
portal-group portal-group-name
restore-disconnected {restore | no-restore}

9.25.1.27.13. Multiple PPPoE Session QoS Commands

config
— qos
— sap-egress policy-id
parent-location {default | sla}
— scheduler-policy name [create]
— tier 1
parent-location {none | sub | vport}
config
— port
— ethernet
— access
— egress
— vport name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
config
— subscr-mgmt
— sla-prof
— egress
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
scheduler scheduler-name rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
configure
— subscriber-mgmt
— authentication-policy name
— include-radius-attribute

9.25.1.27.14. Multicast Listener Discovery (MLD) Commands

For more information about MLD commands, refer to the Multicast Routing Protocols Guide.

config
— subscr-mgmt
mld-policy mld-policy-name [create]
— no mld-policy mld-policy-name
description description-string
egress-rate-modify agg-rate-limit
egress-rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
[no] fast-leave
import policy-name
— no import
max-num-groups max-num-groups
max-num-grp-sources [1..32000]
max-num-sources max-num-sources
query-interval seconds
redirection-policy policy-name
static
[no] group grp-ipv6-address
[no] source ipv6-address
[no] starg
version version
— no version

9.25.1.28. Show Commands

show
— aaa
diameter-peer-policy [peer-policy-name]
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name peer peer-name [statistics]
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name client-side-peer-ip ip-address port tcp-port [statistics]
isa-radius-policy policy-name
isa-radius-policy policy-name associations
radius-server-policy policy-name [acct-on-off]
radius-server-policy policy-name associations
radius-server-policy policy-name msg-buffer-stats
radius-server-policy policy-name statistics
radius-server-policy [acct-on-off]
wpp portal-group name
wpp [portal-group name] [host ip-address] hosts
show
— pw-port
pw-port [pw-port-id] [detail]
pw-port sdp [sdp-id]
pw-port sdp none
show
— qos
port-scheduler-policy [port-scheduler-policy-name] [association]
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name network-policy network-queue-policy-name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name sap-egress policy-id
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name sap-egress policy-id
sap-egress [policy-id] [association | detail]
sap-ingress [policy-id] [association | match-criteria | detail]
customer customer-id site customer-site-name [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name] [detail]
sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
subscriber sub-ident-string [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
— subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [detail]
scheduler-name scheduler-name
scheduler-policy [scheduler-policy-name] [association | sap-ingress policy-id | sap-egress policy-id]
customer customer-id site customer-site-name [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
vport port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name]
sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
sla-profile sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name]
shared-queue shared-queue-policy-name [detail]] ]
mc-ring peer ip-address ring sync-tag ring-node [ring-
show
multi-chassis mc-lag
multi-chassis sync
mc-ipsec addr [tunnel-group grp-id]
mc-ring peer ip-address statistics
mc-ring peer ip-address [ring sync-tag [detail | statistics]]
mc-ring peer ip-address ring sync-tag ring-node [node-name [detail | statistics] ]
mc-ring global-statistics
show
— router
radius-proxy-server server-name
radius-proxy-server server-name cache
radius-proxy-server server-name cache hex-key hex-string
radius-proxy-server server-name cache string-key string
radius-proxy-server server-name cache summary
radius-proxy-server server-name statistics
wpp
wpp [portal wpp-portal-name] [host ip-address] hosts
wpp portal wpp-portal-name
wpp statistics
show
— service
active-subscribers [summary]
credit-control credit-control [subscriber sub-ident-string]
credit-control out-of-credit [action action] [summary]
filter [subscriber sub-ident-string] [origin origin]
hierarchy [subscriber sub-ident-string]
host-tracking [subscriber sub-ident-string]
host-tracking [subscriber sub-ident-string] detail
host-tracking [subscriber sub-ident-string] summary
host-tracking [subscriber sub-ident-string] statistics
groups [group group-ip-address]
groups group group-ip-address] detail
groups group group-ip-address] summary
igmp [subscriber sub-ident-string][detail]
pcc-rule [subscriber sub-ident-string]
subscriber sub-ident-string
subscriber sub-ident-string detail
subscriber sub-ident-string mirror
subscriber sub-ident-string sap sap-id sla-profile sla-profile-name
subscriber sub-ident-string sap sap-id sla-profile sla-profile-name detail
subscriber sub-ident-string sap sap-id sla-profile sla-profile-name mirror
id service-id
arp-host [wholesaler service-id] [sap sap-id | interface interface-name | ip-address ip-address[/mask] | mac ieee-address | {[port port-id] [no-inter-dest-id | inter-dest-id inter-dest-id]}] [detail]
arp-host statistics [sap sap-id | interface interface-name]
arp-host summary [interface interface-name]
— dhcp
lease-state [wholesaler service-id] [sap sap-id | sdp sdp-id:vc-id | interface interface-name | ip-address ip-address[/mask] | chaddr ieee-address | mac ieee-address | {[port port-id] [no-inter-dest-id | inter-dest-id inter-dest-id]}] [detail]
statistics [sap sap-id] | [ sdp [sdp-id[:vc-id] ]]
gsmp
neighbors group [name] [ip-address]
sessions [group name] neighbor ip-address] [ port port-number] [association] [statistics]
host [sap sap-id] [wholesaler service-id] [port port-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [detail]
host [sap sap-id] [wholesaler service-id] [port port-id] no-inter-dest-id [detail]
host summary
host [detail] wholesaler service-id (VPRN only)
interface [{[ip-address | ip-int-name] [interface-type] [detail] [family]} | summary]
ipoe
session [sap sap-id] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [interface ip-int-name | ip-address] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [no-inter-dest-id] [ip-address ip-prefix[/prefix-length]] [port port-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sap-session-id sap-session-index] [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
summary
managed-hosts type {aaa | data-triggered} [ip ip-address] [mac ieee-address]
slaac
host [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host interface interface-name [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host mac ieee-address [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host ipv6-address ipv6-prefix [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host sap sap-id [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
subscriber-hosts [sap sap-id] [ip ip-address[/mask]] [mac ieee-address] [sub-profile sub-profile-name] [sla-profile sla-profile-name] [detail]
sdp sdp-id pw-port [pw-port-id]
sdp sdp-id pw-port
sdp sdp-id pw-port [pw-port-id] [statistics]
sdp [consistent | inconsistent | na] egressifs
sdp sdp-id keep-alive-history
sdp far-end ip-address | ipv6-address keep-alive-history
sdp [sdp-id] detail
sdp far-end ip-address | ipv6-address detail
subscriber-using [service-id service-id] [sap-id sap-id] [interface ip-int-name] [ip ip-address[/mask]] [mac ieee-address] [sub-profile sub-profile-name] [sla-profile sla-profile-name] [app-profile app-profile-name]
show
— subscriber-mgmt
accu-stats subscriber subscriber-id
accu-stats-policy policy-name [associations]
accu-stats-subscribers [subscriber sub-ident] [sub-profile name]
ancp-string [policy-name]
ancp-string policy-name association
ancp-string ancp-string
ancp-string customer customer-id site customer-site-name
ancp-string sap sap-id
authentication policy-name association
authentication [policy-name]
authentication [policy-name] statistics
authentication coa-statistics
category-map [category-map]
category-map category-map subscribers
ccrt-replay [session-id session-id] [diameter-application-policy name]
ccrt-replay summary
— errors
mac all | ieee-address | unknown
sap all | sap-id
sdp all | sdp-id:vc-id
host-lockout-policy policy-name association
host-lockout-policy policy-name
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state sap sap-id [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [circuit-id circuit-id] [sap sap-id] [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [mac ieee-address] [sap sap-id] [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [remote-id remote-id] [sap sap-id] [summary]
igmp-policy policy-name association
igmp-policy policy-name
ipoe-session-policy ipoe-session-policy-name association
local-user-db local-user-db-name association [dhcp] [ppp] [l2tp] [radius] [pppoe] [dhcp6] [capture-sap] [rtr-solicit] [wpp] [ipoe]
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-host ipoe-host-name
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-all-hosts
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-unmatched-hosts
local-user-db [local-user-db-name]
local-user-db local-user-db-name ppp-all-hosts
local-user-db local-user-db-name ppp-host pppoe-host-name
local-user-db local-user-db-name ppp-unmatched-hosts
msap-policy [msap-policy-name [association]]
pcc-rule monitoring-key key detail
pcc-rule rule-id id detail
pcc-rule rule-name rule-name
pcc-rule rule-name rule-name detail
pcc-rule summary
pcc-rule monitoring-key key
radius-accounting-policy name association
radius-accounting-policy name statistics
sla-profile [sla-profile-name [association]]
statistics iom (slot | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics mda (mda | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics port (port-id | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics pw-port (pw-port | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics sla-profiles
statistics sub-profiles
statistics system [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
steering-profile steering-profile-name
sub-ident-policy [sub-ident-policy-name [association]]
sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name script {primary | secondary | tertiary}
sub-profile [sub-profile-name [association]]
show
files [running | finished] [detail]
ipoe
session [name trace-name] [detail]
session sap sap mac mac [{circuit-id circuit-id | remote-id remote-id}] [detail]
trace [name trace-name]
status
trace-profile [detail]
trace-profile profile-name

9.25.1.29. Monitor Commands

monitor
— service
subscriber sub-ident-string sap sap-id sla-profile sla-profile-name [base | ingress-queue-id ingress-queue-id | egress-queue-id egress-queue-id] [interval seconds] [repeat repeat] [absolute | rate]

9.25.1.30. Clear Commands

clear
— call-trace
— ipoe
session sap sap mac mac [{circuit-id circuit-id | remote-id remote-id}]
trace trace-name
— subscriber-mgmt
accu-stats active-subs no-accu-stats-policy
accu-stats active-subs sub-profile profile-name
accu-stats inactive-subs
accu-stats subscriber subscriber-id
— ancp
ancp-sub-string string
authentication [policy-name]
authentication coa-statistics
ccrt-replay diameter-application-policy name
errors
idle-only-msap msap-policy-name
msap-policy msap-policy-name [idle-only]
peakvalue-stats iom (slot | all) [recursive]
peakvalue-stats mda (mda | all) [recursive]
peakvalue-stats port (port-id | all)
peakvalue-stats pw-port (pw-port | all)
peakvalue-stats system [recursive]
radius-accounting [policy-name]
statistics sla-profile {sla-profile-name | all}
statistics sub-profile {sub-profile-name | all}
— service
id service-id
arp-host { mac ieee-address | sap sap-id | ip-address ip-address[/mask] }
arp-host [port port-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id | no-inter-dest-id]
arp-host statistics [sap sap-id | interface interface-name]
ipoe session [sap sap-id] [interface ip-int-name | ip-address] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [no-inter-dest-id] [ip-address ip-prefix[/prefix-length]] [port port-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sap-session-id sap-session-index]
ipoe session all
msap msap-id
msap-policy msap-policy-name
subscriber sub-ident-string
— qos
sla-profile sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name]
clear
— router
srrp
interface subscriber-interface [id srrp-id]
statistics interface subscriber-interface [id srrp-id]
clear
— aaa
route-downloader name [vprn vprn] [family family]

9.25.1.31. Debug Commands

debug
ipoe
trace sap sap-id [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace mac ieee-address [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace circuit-id circuit-id [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace remote-id remote-id [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
— no trace [sap sap-id] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id]
— no trace name trace-name
debug
[no] diameter
dest-realm realm
— no dest-realm
detail-level level
diameter-peer peer [psm-events]
— no diameter-peer-policy policy
avp-match id
— no avp-match id
avp avp-id type type [ascii | hex] value value
— no avp avp-id
message-type [ccr] [cca] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
[no] shutdown
diameter-peer peer [psm-events]
message-type [ccr] [cca] [cer] [cea] [dwr] [dwa] [dpr] [dpa] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
message-type [ccr] [cca] [cer] [cea] [dwr] [dwa] [dpr] [dpa] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
origin-realm realm
debug
— service
— id service-id
arp
[no] arp-host
[no] ppp
[no] circuit-id circuit-id
[no] event
dhcp-client [terminate-only]
l2tp [terminate-only]
— no l2tp
local-address-assignment [terminate-only]
ppp [terminate-only]
— no ppp
[no] mac ieee-address
[no] msap msap-id
[no] packet
detail-level {low | medium | high}
[no] dhcp-client
discovery [padi] [pado] [padr] [pads] [padt]
— no discovery
mode {dropped-only | ingr-and-dropped | egr-ingr-and-dropped}
— no mode
ppp [lcp] [pap] [chap] [ipcp] [ipv6cp]
— no ppp
[no] remote-id remote-id
[no] sap sap-id
[no] username username
— subscriber-mgmt
authentication [policy policy-name] [mac-addr ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id]
[no] sub-ident-policy policy-name
[no] script-output
— router
[no] srrp
[no] events [interface ip-int-name]
[no] packets [interface ip-int-name]
[no] radius
detail-level {low | medium | high}
packet-type [authentication] [accounting] [coa]
radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction]
radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction encoding-type]
radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction encoding-type] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
— no radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type]
— no radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] {address | hex | integer | string} attribute-value
— no radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type]
— no radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] {address | string} value attribute-value
[no] server-address ip-address
[no] wpp
[no] packet
detail-level detail-level
[no] portal wpp-portal-name
[no] packet
detail-level detail-level

9.25.1.32. Tools Commands

— dump
— debug
— diameter
mc-endpoint peer ip-address
mc-ring peer ip-address [ring sync-tag]
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
sync-database [peer ip-address] [sdp sdp-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
— perform
— aaa
route-downloader start [force]
force-switchover tunnel-group local-group-id
sync-database-reconcile [peer ip-address] [sdp sdp-id [sync-tag sync-tag]] [application application]
sync-database-reconcile [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id [sync-tag sync-tag]] [application application]
downgrade target-version target [reboot]
coa [nas-port-id attr-string] [framed-ip-addr ip-address] [alc-ipv6-addr ipv6-address] [delegated-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length] [framed-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]] [alc-serv-id serv-id] [acct-session-id attr-string] [alc-subscr-id attr-string] [alc-brg-id attr-string] [alc-client-hw-addr mac-address] [attr attribute [attribute...(up to 5 max)]] [attr-from-file file-url] [from-server attr-string] [router-or-service attr-string] [debug]
credit-reset sap sap-id subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset sap sap-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset svc service-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
edit-ipoe-session sap sap-id mac mac-address [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id]
eval-ipoe-session [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [mac mac-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
edit-ppp-session sap sap-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
edit-ppp-session svc-id service-id [user-name user-name][mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
edit-slaac-host sap sap-id ipv6-address ipv6-prefix [mac ieee-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
edit-slaac-host svc-id service-id ipv6-prefix [mac ieee-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
eval-lease-state sap sap-id ip ip-address [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
eval-lease-state svc-id service-id ip ip-address [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
eval-ppp-session [svc-id service-id] [user-name user-name] [sap sap-id] [ip ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
eval-ppp-session [svc-id service-id] [user-name user-name] [sap sap-id] mac mac-address [session-id session-id] [ip ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
eval-slaac-host [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [ipv6-address ipv6-prefix] [mac ieee-address]
forcerenew svc-id service-id {ip ip-address[/mask]> | mac ieee-address}
forcerenew {interface interface-name | sap sap-id | sdp sdp-id:vc-id} [ip ip-address[/mask] | mac ieee-address]
local-user-db local-user-db-name
ipoe
host-lookup [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id-ascii] [sap-id sap-id] [service-id service-id] [string vso-string] [system-id system-id] [option60 option-60-ascii] [circuit-id circuit-id-ascii] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [option60-hex option60-hex] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [ip-prefix ip-prefix/ip-prefix-length]
ppp
authentication user-name user-name password password [circuit-id circuit-id] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [sap-id sap-id] [service-name service-name]
host-lookup [circuit-id circuit-id] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [sap-id sap-id] [service-name service-name] [user-name user-name]
re-ident-sub old-sub-ident-string to new-sub-ident-string
eval-msap{policy msap-policy-name | msap sap-id}
remap-lease-state old-mac ieee-address mac ieee-address
remap-lease-state sap-id [mac ieee-address]

9.25.2. Triple Play Subscriber Management Configuration Commands

9.25.2.1. Triple Play Subscriber Management Configuration Commands

9.25.2.1.1. Generic Commands

description

Syntax 
description description-string
no description
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>accu-stats-policy
config>subscr-mgmt>authentication-policy
config>subscr-mgmt>host-tracking
config>subscr-mgmt>pim-policy
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>egress>ip-filter>entry
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>ingress>ip-filter>entry
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group
config>log>accounting-policy
config>service>vprn>redundant-interface
config>service>ies>redundant-interface
config>service>ies>subscriber-interface
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>dhcp
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
config>service>vprn>subscriber-interface
config>service>vprn>sub-if>dhcp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>dhcp
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group>neighbor
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-session-policy
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy
config>sub-mgmt>credit-control-policy
config>sub-mgmt>host-lockout>policy
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-mcac-policy
config>aaa>route-downloader
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
config>aaa>wpp>portal-groups
config>aaa>wpp>portal-groups>portal-group
config>port>ethernet>access>egress
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
config>call-trace>trace-profile
Description 

This command creates a text description stored in the configuration file for a configuration context.

The description command associates a text string with a configuration context to help identify the context in the configuration file.

The no form of this command removes any description string from the context.

Parameters 
description-string—
Specifies a text string describing the entity. Allowed values are any string up to 80 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

shutdown

Syntax 
[no] shutdown
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>primary
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>secondary
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>tertiary
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vpls>gsmp
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group>neighbor
config>service>vprn>redundant-interface
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp
config>service>vprn>subscriber-interface
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>dhcp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
config>service>ies>subscriber-interface
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>dhcp
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
config>service>ies>redundant-interface
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>arp-host
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group>neighbor
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>wpp>portals
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-lag
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
config>service>ies>sub-if>dhcp
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-mcac-policy
config>aaa>route-downloader
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>proxy
config>aaa>wpp>portal-groups
config>aaa>wpp>portal-groups>portal-group
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>data-trigger
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>data-trigger
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

The shutdown command administratively disables the entity. When disabled, an entity does not change, reset, or remove any configuration settings or statistics. Many entities must be explicitly enabled using the no shutdown command.

The shutdown command administratively disables an entity. The operational state of the entity is disabled as well as the operational state of any entities contained within. Many objects must be shut down before they can be deleted.

Unlike other commands and parameters where the default state is not indicated in the configuration file, shutdown and no shutdown are always indicated in system generated configuration files.

Shutting down a subscriber interface on a 7750 SR will operationally shut down all child group interfaces and SAPs. Shutting down a group interface on a 7750 SR will operationally shut down all SAPs that are part of that group-interface.

The no form of the command puts an entity into the administratively enabled state.

Default 

no shutdown

subscriber-mgmt

Syntax 
subscriber-mgmt
Context 
config
Description 

This command enters the context to configure subscriber management entities. A subscriber is uniquely identified by a subscriber identification string. Each subscriber can have several DHCP sessions active at any time. Each session is referred to as a subscriber host and is identified by its IP address and MAC address.

All subscriber hosts belonging to the same subscriber are subject to the same hierarchical QoS (HQoS) processing. The HQoS processing is defined in the sub-profile (the subscriber profile). A sub-profile refers to an existing scheduler policy (configured in the configure>qos>scheduler-policy context) and offers the possibility to overrule the rate of individual schedulers within this policy.

Because all subscriber hosts use the same scheduler policy instance, they must all reside on the same complex.

9.25.2.1.2. ANCP and GSMP Commands

ancp

Syntax 
ancp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) parameters.

ancp-policy

Syntax 
ancp-policy name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp
Description 

This command creates an Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) policy. The policy is associated with either the ANCP string (static case) or subscriber-profile (dynamic case) and defines the behavior of the hosts belonging to these profiles.

ANCP polices control rates and subscribers based on port-up/port-down messages from the access node. When configured, the 7450 ESS or 7750 SR should stop SHCV to a host that is part of a port defined to be down (by port-down message). When the node receives a port-up message for a port that was in port-down, state the node will initiate the SHCV process immediately to verify connectivity.

When ANCP is used with Enhanced Subscriber Management, the ANCP string last associated with the subscriber will be used. All hosts of a subscriber will be updated with the new ANCP string.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the ANCP configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Configures the ANCP policy name up to 32 characters in length

ancp-policy

Syntax 
ancp-policy name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>ancp
Description 

This command specifies an existing Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) policy to associate with the subscriber profile. The policy is associated with either the ANCP string (static case) or subscriber-profile (dynamic case) and defines the behavior of the hosts belonging to these profiles.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the ANCP configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing ANCP policy name up to 32 characters in length

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress ANCP policy parameters.

rate-adjustment

Syntax 
rate-adjustment adjusted-percent
no rate-adjustment
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy>ingress
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy>egress
Description 

This command configures a rate adjustment for the scheduler. The rate-adjustment command should be used when the rate returned by the DSLAM is calculated with different encapsulation than the 7450 ESS or 7750 SR. The node will adjust the rate by the percent specified as:

DSLAM_RATE*adjust-rate/100 — rate-reduction.

The no form of the command removes the adjusted percentage from the configuration.

Parameters 
adjusted-percent—
Specifies a rate adjustment for the scheduler
Values—
1 to 200

 

Default—
100

rate-reduction

Syntax 
rate-reduction kilobit-per-second
no rate-reduction
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy>ingress
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy>egress
Description 

This command defines a constant rate reduction to the rate specified by the DSLAM. The rate-reduction command should be used if the node should adjust the rate to a value that is offset (for example by a fixed multicast dedicated bandwidth) compared to the total available on the DSLAM.

When set, the rate will be:

DSLAM_RATE*adjust-rate/100 — rate-reduction

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

rate-monitor

Syntax 
rate-monitor kilobit-per-second [alarm]
no rate-monitor
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy>ingress
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy>egress
Description 

This command configures the rate monitor level.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
kilobit-per-second—
Specifies the rate, in kilobits, below which the system will generate an event
alarm—
When the monitored rate is below the configured value the system generates an alarm (trap) to the management system. The trap includes the rate as well as the ANCP policy name and the ANCP string.

rate-modify

Syntax 
rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
no rate-modify
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy>ingress
Description 

This command configures ingress rate modify scheduler parameters.

The no form of the command removes the scheduler name from the configuration.

Parameters 
scheduler-name
Specifies a scheduler name up to 32 characters in length

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress ANCP policy parameters.

rate-modify

Syntax 
rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
rate-modify agg-rate-limit
no rate-modify
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy>egress
Description 

This command configures egress rate modify scheduler parameters.

Parameters 
agg-rate-limit—
Specifies that the maximum total rate for all subscriber egress queues for each subscriber associated with the policy.
scheduler-name—
Specifies a scheduler name up to 32 characters in length

port-down

Syntax 
[no] port-down
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure the actions taken on port-down.

disable-shcv

Syntax 
[no] disable-shcv [alarm] [hold-time seconds]
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp-policy>port-down
Description 

When this command is configured, the node will suspend SHCV for the hosts defined with this ANCP policy until the access node sends a port-up message. When the hold-time parameter is used, the node will suspend SHCV for the period of time defined. If the hold-time parameter is not defined the node will suspend SHCV until a port-up message is received.

If the optional alarm flag is used the node should send a SHCV alarm before suspending.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no disable-shcv

ancp-static-map

Syntax 
ancp-static-map
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure a static ANCP name map.

Default 

ancp-static-map

entry

Syntax 
entry key ancp-string customer customer-id multi-service-site customer-site-name ancp-policy policy-name
entry key ancp-string sap sap-id ancp-policy policy-name
no entry key ancp-string customer customer-id multi-service-site customer-site-name
no entry key ancp-string sap sap-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ancp>static-map
Description 

This command configures an ANCP name. When ANCP is configured to provide rate adaptation without the use of enhanced subscriber management, this command will define how to map an ANCP key (usually the circuit-id of the DSLAM port) to either a SAP and a scheduler name (when a Multi-Service Site (MSS) is not used) or a customer, site and scheduler name when MSS is used.

Different ANCP names may be used with the same SAPs or customer ID/MSS combinations to allow schedulers within the policy to be mapped to the ANCP names. An ANCP string and SAP combination may reference only one ancp-policy. An ANCP string and customer and site-name combination may reference a single ancp-policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
ancp-string—
Specifies the ASCII representation of the DSLAM circuit-id name up to 63 characters in length
customer-id
Specifies the associated existing customer ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

customer-site-name
Specifies the associated customer’s configured MSS name up to 32 characters in length
policy-name
Specifies an existing ANCP policy name up to 32 characters in length
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition

9.25.2.1.2.1. VPRN GSMP Configuration Commands

Note:

The commands in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

gsmp

Syntax 
gsmp
Context 
config>service>vpls
config>service>vprn
Description 

This command enters the context to configure GSMP connections maintained in this service.

Default 

not enabled

group

Syntax 
[no] group name
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp
config>service>vprn>gsmp
Description 

This command specifies a GSMP name. A GSMP group name is unique only within the scope of the service in which it is defined.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies a GSMP name up to 32 characters in length

ancp

Syntax 
ancp
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ANCP parameters for this GSMP group.

dynamic-topology-discover

Syntax 
[no] dynamic-topology-discover
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group>ancp
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group>ancp
Description 

This command enables the ANCP dynamic topology discovery capability.

The no form of this command disables the feature.

Default 

dynamic-topology-discover

oam

Syntax 
[no] oam
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group>ancp
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group>ancp
Description 

This command enables the GSMP ANCP OAM capability to be negotiated at startup of the GSMP connection.

The no form of this command disables the feature.

Default 

no oam

hold-multiplier

Syntax 
hold-multiplier multiplier
no hold-multiplier
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp
config>service>vprn>gsmp
Description 

This command configures the hold-multiplier for the GSMP connections in this group.

The no form of this command removes the multiplier value from the GSMP configuration.

Default 

no hold-multiplier

Parameters 
multiplier—
Specifies the GSMP hold multiplier value
Values—
1 to 100

 

idle-filter

Syntax 
[no] idle-filter
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group
Description 

This command when applied will filter out new incoming ANCP messages while the subscriber DSL-line-state is idle. The command takes effect at the time that it is applied. Existing subscribers already in idle state are not purged from the database.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no idle-filter

keepalive

Syntax 
keepalive seconds
no keepalive
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group
Description 

This command configures keepalive values for the GSMP connections in this group.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no keepalive

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the GSMP keepalive timer value in seconds
Values—
1 to 25

 

neighbor

Syntax 
neighbor ip-address [create]
no neighbor ip-address
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group
Description 

This command enters the context to configure a GSMP ANCP neighbor parameters.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IP address of the GSMP ANCP neighbor

local-address

Syntax 
local-address ip-address
no local-address
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group>neighbor
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group>neighbor
Description 

This command configures the source ip-address used in the connection towards the neighbor. The local address is optional. If specified the node will accept connections only for that address in the service running ANCP. The address may be created after the reference but connections will not be accepted until it is created. If the local address is not used, the system accepts connections on any interface within the routing context.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no local-address

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the source IP address to be used in the connection toward the neighbor

priority-marking

Syntax 
priority-marking dscp dscp-name
priority-marking prec ip-prec-value
no priority-marking
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group>neighbor
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group>neighbor
Description 

This command configures the type of priority marking to be used.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no priority-marking

Parameters 
dscp-name—
Specifies the DSCP code-point to be used
Values—
be, cp1, cp2, cp3, cp4, cp5, cp6, cp7, cs1, cp9, af11, cp11, af12, cp13, af13, cp15, cs2, cp17, af21, cp19, af22, cp21, af23, cp23, cs3, cp25, af31, cp27, af32, cp29, af33, cp31, cs4, cp33, af41, cp35, af42, cp37, af43, cp39, cs5, cp41, cp42, cp43, cp44, cp45, ef, cp47, nc1, cp49, cp50, cp51, cp52, cp53, cp54, cp55, nc2, cp57, cp58, cp59, cp60, cp61, cp62, cp63

 

ip-prec-value—
Specifies the precedence value to be used
Values—
0 to 7

 

persistency-database

Syntax 
[no] persistency-database
Context 
config>service>vpls>gsmp>group
config>service>vprn>gsmp>group
Description 

This command enables the system to store DSL line information in memory. If the GSMP connection terminates, the DSL line information will remain in memory and accessible for RADIUS authentication and accounting.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no persistency-database

9.25.2.1.2.2. BGP Peering Policy Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

bgp-peering-policy

Syntax 
bgp-peering-policy policy-name [create]
no bgp-peering-policy policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures the name of the BGP peering policy.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the BGP peer policy name up to 32 characters in length

advertise-inactive

Syntax 
[no] advertise-inactive
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command enables the advertising of inactive BGP routers to other BGP peers.

By default, BGP only advertises BGP routes to other BGP peers if a given BGP route is chosen by the route table manager as the most preferred route within the system and is active in the forwarding plane. This command allows system administrators to advertise a BGP route even though it is not the most preferred route within the system for a given destination.

The no form of this command disables the advertising.

Default 

no advertise-inactive

aggregator-id-zero

Syntax 
[no] aggregator-id-zero
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command is used to set the router ID in the BGP aggregator path attribute to zero when BGP aggregates routes. This prevents different routers within an AS from creating aggregate routes that contain different AS paths.

When BGP is aggregating routes, it adds the aggregator path attribute to the BGP update messages. By default, BGP adds the AS number and router ID to the aggregator path attribute.

When this command is enabled, BGP adds the router ID to the aggregator path attribute. The no form of the command used at the global level reverts to default where BGP adds the AS number and router ID to the aggregator path attribute.

Default 

no aggregator-id-zero to BGP adds the AS number and router ID to the aggregator path attribute.

as-override

Syntax 
[no] as-override
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command replaces all instances of the peer's AS number with the local AS number in a BGP route's AS_PATH.

This command breaks BGP's loop detection mechanism. It should be used carefully.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no as-override

auth-keychain

Syntax 
auth-keychain name
no auth-keychain
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the BGP authentication key for all peers.

The keychain allows the rollover of authentication keys during the lifetime of a session.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no auth-keychain

Parameters 
name
Specifies the name of an existing keychain, up to 32 characters, to use for the specified TCP session or sessions

authentication-key

Syntax 
authentication-key [authentication-key | hash-key] [hash | hash2]
no authentication-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the BGP authentication key.

Authentication is performed between neighboring routers before setting up the BGP session by verifying the password. Authentication is performed using the MD-5 message-based digest. The authentication key can be any combination of letters or numbers from 1 to 16.

The no form of the command removes the authentication password from the configuration and effectively disables authentication.

Default 

no authentication-key — Authentication is disabled and the authentication password is empty.

Parameters 
authentication-key—
The authentication key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 255 characters in length (unencrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).
hash-key—
The hash key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 342 characters in length (encrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).

This is useful when a user must configure the parameter, but, for security purposes, the actual unencrypted key value is not provided.

hash—
Specifies the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.

cluster

Syntax 
cluster cluster-id
no cluster
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the cluster ID for a route reflector server.

Route reflectors are used to reduce the number of IBGP sessions required within an AS. Normally, all BGP speakers within an AS must have a BGP peering with every other BGP speaker in an AS. A route reflector and its clients form a cluster. Peers that are not part of the cluster are considered to be non-clients.

When a route reflector receives a route, first it must select the best path from all the paths received. If the route was received from a non-client peer, then the route reflector sends the route to all clients in the cluster. If the route came from a client peer, the route reflector sends the route to all non-client peers and to all client peers except the originator.

For redundancy, a cluster can have multiple route reflectors.

Confederations can also be used to remove the full IBGP mesh requirement within an AS.

The no form of the command deletes the cluster ID and effectively disables the Route Reflection for the given group.

Default 

no cluster — No cluster ID is defined.

Parameters 
cluster-id—
Specifies the route reflector cluster ID is expressed in dot decimal notation
Values—
Any 32 bit number in dot decimal notation. (0.0.0.1 to 255.255.255.255)

 

connect-retry

Syntax 
connect-retry seconds
no connect-retry
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the BGP connect retry timer value in seconds.

When this timer expires, BGP tries to reconnect to the configured peer.

The no form of the command used at the global level reverts to the default value.

Default 

120 seconds

Parameters 
seconds—
The BGP Connect Retry timer value in seconds, expressed as a decimal integer
Values—
1 to 65535

 

damping

Syntax 
[no] damping
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command enables BGP route damping for learned routes which are defined within the route policy. Use damping to reduce the number of update messages sent between BGP peers and reduce the load on peers without affecting the route convergence time for stable routes. Damping parameters are set via route the policy definition.

The no form of the command used at the global level disables route damping.

When damping is enabled and the route policy does not specify a damping profile, the default damping profile is used. This profile is always present and consists of the following parameters:

Half-life:

15 minutes

Max-suppress:

60 minutes

Suppress-threshold:

3000

Reuse-threshold

750

Default 

no damping — Learned route damping is disabled

disable-4byte-asn

Syntax 
[no] disable-4byte-asn
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command disables the use of 4-byte ASNs. It can be configured at all 3 level of the hierarchy so it can be specified down to the per peer basis.

If this command is enabled 4-byte ASN support should not be negotiated with the associated remote peer(s).

The no form of the command resets the behavior to the default which is to enable the use of 4-byte ASN.

Default 

no disable-4byte-asn

disable-client-reflect

Syntax 
[no] disable-client-reflect
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command disables the reflection of routes by the route reflector to the group or neighbor. This only disables the reflection of routes from other client peers. Routes learned from non-client peers are still reflected to all clients.

The no form re-enables client reflection of routes.

Default 

no disable-client-reflect — Client routes are reflected to all client peers.

disable-communities

Syntax 
disable-communities [standard] [extended]
no disable-communities
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures BGP to disable sending communities.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no disable-communities

Parameters 
standard—
Specifies standard communities that existed before VPRNs or 2547
extended—
Specifies BGP communities used were expanded after the concept of 2547 was introduced, to include handling the VRF target

disable-fast-external-failover

Syntax 
[no] disable-fast-external-failover
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures BGP fast external failover.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no disable-fast-external-failover

export

Syntax 
export policy [policy...]
no export
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the export policies to be used to control routes advertised to BGP neighbors.

When multiple policy names are specified, the policies are evaluated in the order they are specified. A maximum of five (5) policy names can be configured. The first policy that matches is applied.

Note:

If a non-existent route policy is applied to a VPRN instance, the CLI generates a warning message. This message is only generated at an interactive CLI session and the route policy association is made. No warning message is generated when a non-existent route policy is applied to a VPRN instance in a configuration file or when SNMP is used.

The no form of this command removes all route policy names from the export list.

Default 

no export — BGP advertises routes from other BGP routes but does not advertise any routes from other protocols unless directed by an export policy.

Parameters 
policy—
Specifies a route policy statement name up to 32 characters in length

hold-time

Syntax 
hold-time seconds
no hold-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the BGP hold time, expressed in seconds.

The BGP hold time specifies the maximum time BGP waits between successive messages (either keepalive or update) from its peer, before closing the connection.

Even though the router OS implementation allows setting the keepalive time separately, the configured keepalive timer is overridden by the hold-time value under the following circumstances:

If the specified hold-time is less than the configured keepalive time, then the operational keepalive time is set to a third of the hold-time; the configured keepalive time is not changed.

If the hold-time is set to zero, then the operational value of the keepalive time is set to zero; the configured keepalive time is not changed. This means that the connection with the peer is up permanently and no keepalive packets are sent to the peer.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no hold-time

Parameters 
seconds—
The hold-time, in seconds, expressed as a decimal integer. A value of 0 indicates the connection to the peer is up permanently.
Values—
0, 3 to 65535

 

import

Syntax 
import policy [policy...]
no import
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the import policies to be used to control routes advertised to BGP neighbors. Route policies are configured in the config>router>policy-options context. When multiple policy names are specified, the policies are evaluated in the order they are specified. A maximum of five (5)policy names can be specified. The first policy that matches is applied.

The no form of this command removes all route policy names from the import list.

Default 

no import — BGP accepts all routes from configured BGP neighbors. Import policies can be used to limit or modify the routes accepted and their corresponding parameters and metrics.

Parameters 
policy —
A route policy statement name up to 32 characters in length

keepalive

Syntax 
keepalive seconds
no keepalive
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the BGP keepalive timer. A keepalive message is sent every time this timer expires.

The keepalive value is generally one-third of the hold-time interval. Even though the OS implementation allows the keepalive value and the hold-time interval to be independently set, under the following circumstances, the configured keepalive value is overridden by the hold-time value:

If the specified keepalive value is greater than the configured hold-time, then the specified value is ignored, and the keepalive is set to one third of the current hold-time value.

If the specified hold-time interval is less than the configured keepalive value, then the keepalive value is reset to one third of the specified hold-time interval.

If the hold-time interval is set to zero, then the configured value of the keepalive value is ignored. This means that the connection with the peer is up permanently and no keepalive packets are sent to the peer.

The no form of the command used at the global level reverts to the default value.

Default 

30 seconds

Parameters 
seconds—
The keepalive timer in seconds, expressed as a decimal integer
Values—
0 to 21845

 

local-address

Syntax 
local-address ip-address
no local-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

Configures the local IP address used by the group or neighbor when communicating with BGP peers.

Outgoing connections use the local-address as the source of the TCP connection when initiating connections with a peer.

When a local address is not specified, the 7750 SR OS uses the system IP address when communicating with IBGP peers and uses the interface address for directly connected EBGP peers. This command is used at the neighbor level to revert to the value defined under the group level.

The no form of the command removes the configured local-address for BGP.

The no form of the command used at the group level reverts to the value defined at the global level.

The no form of the command used at the neighbor level reverts to the value defined at the group level.

Default 

no local-address

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the local address

For IPv4, the local address is expressed in dotted decimal notation. Allowed values are a valid routable IP address on the router, either an interface or system IP address.

For IPv6, the local address is expressed in semi-colon hexadecimal notation. Allowed values is an interface or a system IP address.

Values—

ipv4-address:

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

 

local-as

Syntax 
local-as as-number [private]
no local-as
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures a BGP virtual autonomous system (AS) number.

In addition to the AS number configured for BGP in the config>router>autonomous-system context, a virtual (local) AS number is configured.The virtual AS number is added to the as-path message before the router’s AS number makes the virtual AS the second AS in the as-path.

This configuration parameter can be set at three levels: global level (applies to all peers), group level (applies to all peers in peer-group) or neighbor level (only applies to specified peer). Thus, by specifying this at each neighbor level, it is possible to have a separate as-number per EBGP session.

When a command is entered multiple times for the same AS, the last command entered is used in the configuration. The private attribute can be added or removed dynamically by reissuing the command.

Changing the local AS at the global level in an active BGP instance causes the BGP instance to restart with the new local AS number. Changing the local AS at the global level in an active BGP instance causes BGP to re-establish the peer relationships with all peers in the group with the new local AS number. Changing the local AS at the neighbor level in an active BGP instance causes BGP to re-establish the peer relationship with the new local AS number.

This is an optional command and can be used in the following circumstance:

Provider router P is moved from AS1 to AS2. The customer router that is connected to P, however, is configured to belong to AS1. To avoid reconfiguring the customer router, the local-as value on router P can be set to AS1. Thus, router P adds AS1 to the as-path message for routes it advertises to the customer router.

The no form of the command used at the global level will remove any virtual AS number configured. The no form of the command used at the group level reverts to the value defined at the global level.

The no form of the command used at the neighbor level reverts to the value defined at the group level.

Default 

no local-as

Parameters 
as-number—
The virtual autonomous system number, expressed as a decimal integer
Values—
1 to 65535

 

private—
Specifies the local-as is hidden in paths learned from the peering

local-preference

Syntax 
local-preference local-preference
no local-preference
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command enables setting the BGP local-preference attribute in incoming routes if not specified and configures the default value for the attribute. This value is used if the BGP route arrives from a BGP peer without the local-preference integer set.

The specified value can be overridden by any value set via a route policy.

The no form of the command at the global level specifies that incoming routes with local-preference set are not overridden and routes arriving without local-preference set are interpreted as if the route had local-preference value of 100.

Default 

no local-preference

Does not override the local-preference value set in arriving routes and analyze routes without local preference with value of 100.

Parameters 
local-preference—
The local preference value to be used as the override value, expressed as a decimal integer
Values—
0 to 4294967295

 

loop-detect

Syntax 
loop-detect {drop-peer | discard-route | ignore-loop | off}
no loop-detect
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures how the BGP peer session handles loop detection in the AS path.

Note:

Dynamic configuration changes of loop-detect are not recognized.

The no form of the command used at the global level reverts to default, which is loop-detect ignore-loop.

Default 

loop-detect ignore-loop

Parameters 
drop-peer—
Sends a notification to the remote peer and drops the session
discard-route—
Discards routes received with loops in the AS path
ignore-loop—
Ignores routes with loops in the AS path but maintains peering
off—
Disables loop detection

med-out

Syntax 
med-out {number | igp-cost}
no med-out
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command enables advertising the Multi-Exit Discriminator (MED) and assigns the value used for the path attribute for the MED advertised to BGP peers if the MED is not already set.

The specified value can be overridden by any value set via a route policy.

The no form of the command used at the global level reverts to default where the MED is not advertised.

no med-out

Parameters 
number—
Specifies the MED path attribute value, expressed as a decimal integer
Values—
0 to 4294967295

 

igp-cost—
Specifies that the MED is set to the IGP cost of the given IP prefix

min-as-origination

Syntax 
min-as-origination seconds
no min-as-origination
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the minimum interval, in seconds, at which a path attribute, originated by the local router, can be advertised to a peer.

The no form of the command used at the global level reverts to default.

Default 

15

Parameters 
seconds—
The minimum path attribute advertising interval, in seconds
Values—
2 to 255

 

min-route-advertisement

Syntax 
min-route-advertisement seconds
no min-route-advertisement
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the minimum interval, in seconds, at which a prefix can be advertised to a peer.

The no form of the command reverts to default values.

Default 

30 seconds

Parameters 
seconds—
The minimum route advertising interval, in seconds, expressed as a decimal integer
Values—
1 to 255

 

multihop

Syntax 
multihop ttl-value
no multihop
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the time to live (TTL) value entered in the IP header of packets sent to an EBGP peer multiple hops away.

This parameter is meaningful only when configuring EBGP peers. It is ignored if set for an IBGP peer.

The no form of the command is used to convey to the BGP instance that the EBGP peers are directly connected.

The no form of the command reverts to default values.

Default 

1 (EBGP peers are directly connected)

64 (IBGP)

Parameters 
ttl-value—
Specifies the TTL value, expressed as a decimal integer
Values—
1 to 255

 

next-hop-self

Syntax 
[no] next-hop-self
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the neighbor to always set the NEXTHOP path attribute to its own physical interface when advertising to a peer.

The no form of the command disables the command.

Default 

no next-hop-self

passive

Syntax 
[no] passive
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command enables the passive mode for the BGP neighbors.

The no form of the command disables the passive mode.

Default 

no passive

peer-as

Syntax 
peer-as as-number
no peer-as
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the autonomous system number for the remote peer. The peer AS number must be configured for each configured peer.

The no form of the command removes the as-number from the configuration.

Default 

No AS numbers are defined.

Parameters 
as-number—
Specifies the AS number for the remote peer
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

preference

Syntax 
[no] preference preference
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the route preference for routes learned from the configured peer(s).

The lower the preference the higher the chance of the route being the active route. The OS assigns BGP routes highest default preference compared to routes that are direct, static or learned via MPLS or OSPF.

The no form of the command used at the global level reverts to default value.

Default 

170

Parameters 
preference—
The route preference, expressed as a decimal integer
Values—
1 to 255

 

prefix-limit

Syntax 
prefix-limit limit [log-only] [threshold percent]
no prefix-limit
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of routes BGP can learn from a peer.

When the number of routes reaches 90% of this limit, an SNMP trap is sent. When the limit is exceeded, the BGP peering is dropped and disabled.

The no form of the command removes the prefix-limit.

Default 

no prefix-limit

Parameters 
log-only—
Enables the warning message to be sent at the specified threshold percentage, and also when the limit is exceeded. However, the BGP peering is not dropped.
percent—
The threshold value (as a percentage) that triggers a warning message to be sent
limit—
The number of routes that can be learned from a peer, expressed as a decimal integer
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

remove-private

Syntax 
[no] remove-private
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command allows private AS numbers to be removed from the AS path before advertising them to BGP peers.

The OS software recognizes the set of AS numbers that are defined by IANA as private. These are AS numbers in the range 64512 through 65535, inclusive.

The no form of the command used at the global level reverts to default value.

Private AS numbers are included in the AS path attribute.

Default 

no remove-private

type

Syntax 
[no] type {internal | external}
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command designates the BGP peer as type internal or external.

The type of internal indicates the peer is an IBGP peer while the type of external indicates that the peer is an EBGP peer.

By default, the OS derives the type of neighbor based on the local AS specified. If the local AS specified is the same as the AS of the router, the peer is considered internal. If the local AS is different, then the peer is considered external.

The no form of the command used at the group level reverts to the default value.

Default 

no type

Type of neighbor is derived on the local AS specified.

Parameters 
internal—
Configures the peer as internal
external—
Configures the peer as external

ttl-security

Syntax 
ttl-security min-ttl-value
no ttl-security
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>bgp-prng-plcy
Description 

This command configures the TTL security parameters for incoming packets.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ttl-security

Parameters 
min-ttl-value—
Specifies the minimum TTL value for an incoming BGP packet
Values—
1 to 255

 

9.25.2.1.3. Call Trace Commands

call-trace

Syntax 
call-trace
Context 
config
Description 

This command enters the context to configure parameters related to the call trace debugging tool

location

Syntax 
location {cf1 | cf2}
Context 
config>call-trace
Description 

This command specifies the compact flash (CF) configuration to store call trace files.

disable

Syntax 
[no] disable
Context 
config>call-trace>location
Description 

When configured, the specified compact flash will not be used by call-trace.The no form of this command enables the compact flash for use by call-trace.

Default 

no disable

size-limit

Syntax 
size-limit limit-value
no size-limit
Context 
config>call-trace>location
Description 

This command limits the total size of call-trace files on the specified compact flash card.The no form of this command removes the size restriction.

Default 

1000

Parameters 
limit-value—
Specifies the total size of call-trace files on the specified compact flash card, in Mbytes
Values—
1 to 65536

 

max-files-number

Syntax 
max-files-number number
Context 
config>call-trace
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of files call-trace can create.

Default 

200

Parameters 
number—
Specifies the maximum number of all call trace log files stored on all compact flash cards together
Values—
1 to 1024

 

primary-cf

Syntax 
primary-cf cflash-id
Context 
config>call-trace
Description 

This command specifies which compact-flash will be used as the primary CF for call-trace operation.

Default 

cf1

Parameters 
cflash-id—
Specifies the compact flash card to be used as the primary local storage location to save the generated call trace log files
Values—
cf1, cf2

 

trace-profile

Syntax 
trace-profile profile-name [create]
no trace-profile profile-name
Context 
config>call-trace
Description 

This command creates a profile that can be applied to a specific trace job.

Default 

none

Parameters 
profile-name—
Specifies the unique name of the call trace profile

applications

Syntax 
applications [connectivity-management] [radius-auth] [radius-acct] [python] [ludb] [msap]
applications all
Context 
config>call-trace>trace-profile
Description 

This command enables tracing of messages and events for the specified applications.

Default 

applications all

Parameters 
all—
Enables tracing of all packets and events.
connectivity-management—
Enables tracing for connectivity protocols, such as DHCP, ARP, and DHCPv6, and events related to connectivity management; for example, migrant or data-triggered host creation, idling, or session timeout.
ludb—
Enables tracing of local user database lookups.
msap—
Enables tracing of MSAP creation events.
python—
Enables tracing of Python script execution.
radius-acct—
Enables tracing of messages and events related to RADIUS-based accounting.
radius-auth—
Enables tracing of messages and events related to RADIUS authentication, including CoA and Disconnect.

debug-output

Syntax 
[no] debug-output
Context 
config>call-trace>trace-profile
Description 

This command enables output to the debug log. Traced messages are decoded as text and sent to debug logging. This allows for real-time debugging but is not recommended on live systems because of the decode overhead.

This command disables logging to the compact flash. The debug-output and live-output commands are mutually exclusive.

The no form of the command disables output to the debug log.

Default 

no debug-output

events

Syntax 
events {none | public-only | all}
Context 
config>call-trace-trace-profile
Description 

This command configures whether captured traces include events that occurred on the SR OS router, such as mobility and idle-timeout.

Default 

events none

Parameters 
none—
Specifies that no events will be traced.
public-only—
Specifies that only events that are readable by everyone will be traced.
all—
Specifies that all events will be traced, including events that are encrypted for use by customer support only. Encrypted events are not readable by end-users.

live-output

Syntax 
live-output {ip-address | fqdn} [port port] [router {router-instance | service-name service-name}]
no live-output
Context 
config>call-trace>trace-profile
Description 

This command specifies a live output destination for this trace. When configured, captures will not be stored locally but sent (over UDP) to the server in the specified routing context. The destination can be specified as either an IP address or a DNS FQDN. The live-output and debug-output commands are mutually exclusive.The no form of this command disables live output streaming.

Default 

no live-output

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server to stream to.
fqdn
Specifies the FQDN that represents the server in DNS.
port
Specifies the UDP port on which the server will be listening.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

Default—
29770
router-instance
Specifies the router instance in which the live output will be forwarded.
service-name
Specifies the name of the Layer 3 service in which the live output will be forwarded.

size-limit

Syntax 
size-limit limit-value
Context 
config>call-trace>trace-profile
Description 

This command specifies a maximum of how big a trace may grow before it is stopped.

Default 

10

Parameters 
limit-value—
Specifies the maximum data volume generated by a single call trace job to the output in megabytes. After reaching the limit the call trace job for a given host is automatically terminated.
Values—
1 to 1000

 

time-limit

Syntax 
time-limit limit-value
Context 
config>call-trace>trace-profile
Description 

This command specifies how long a trace may run before it is stopped.

Default 

86400

Parameters 
limit-value—
Specifies the maximum duration of a single call trace job in seconds. After reaching the limit the call trace job for a given host is automatically terminated.
Values—
1 to 604800

 

9.25.2.1.4. RADIUS Policy Commands

isa-radius-policy

Syntax 
isa-radius-policy name [create]
no isa-radius-policy name
Context 
config>aaa
Description 

This command enters the context to configure an ISA RADIUS policy.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the identifier of this ISA RADIUS policy up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword used to create the ISA RADIUS policy. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

radius-coa-port

Syntax 
radius-coa-port {port-number}
no radius-coa-port
Context 
config>aaa
Description 

This command configures the system-wide UDP port number that RADIUS is listening on for CoA and Disconnect messages

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

3799

Parameters 
port-number
Specifies the udp port number for RADIUS CoA and disconnect messages
Values—
1647, 1700, 1812, 3799

 

authentication-policy

Syntax 
authentication-policy name [create]
no authentication-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command creates the context to configure RADIUS server parameters for session authentication. The policies can be applied to an IES or VPRN interface, or a VPLS SAP.

The no form of the command removes the RADIUS server configuration for session authentication.

RADIUS servers can be configured for three different applications:

  1. For authentication of dynamic Triple Play subscriber sessions, under config>subscr-mgmt>authentication-plcy
  2. For 802.1x port authentication, under config>system>security>dot1x>radius-plcy
  3. For CLI login users, under config>system>radius
Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the profile. The string is case sensitive and limited to 32 ASCII 7-bit printable characters with no spaces.
create—
Keyword used to create the authentication policy. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

pim-policy

Syntax 
pim-policy policy-name
no pim-policy policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command adds an existing PIM policy to this subscriber profile.

The no form of the command removes the specified PIM policy from this subscriber profile.

Default 

No PIM policy is added to a subscriber profile by default.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the PIM policy. The string is case sensitive and limited to 32 ASCII 7-bit printable characters with no spaces

radius-accounting-policy

Syntax 
radius-accounting-policy name
no radius-accounting-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>rad-acct-policy
Description 

This command specifies a subscriber RADIUS based accounting policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no

Parameters 
name—
The name of the policy. The string is case sensitive and limited to 32 ASCII 7-bit printable characters with no spaces

accept-authorization-change

Syntax 
[no] accept-authorization-change
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy
Description 

This command specifies whether or not the system should handle the CoA messages initiated by the RADIUS server, and provide for mid-session interval changes of policies applicable to subscriber hosts.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no accept-authorization-change

accept-script-policy

Syntax 
accept-script-policy policy-name
no accept-script-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy
Description 

This command configures a RADIUS script policy used to change the RADIUS attributes of the incoming Access-Accept messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no accept-script-policy

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies a Python script policy to modify Access-Accept messages up to 32 characters in length

access-loop-options

Syntax 
[no] access-loop-options
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables inclusion of access loop information: Broadband Forum (BBF) access loop characteristics, DSL line state and DSL type. The BBF access loop characteristics are returned as BBF specific RADIUS attributes where DSL line state and DSL type are returned as Nokia-specific RADIUS VSA’s.

Information obtained via the ANCP protocol has precedence over information received in PPPoE Vendor Specific BBF tags or DHCP Vendor Specific BBF Options.

If ANCP is utilized and interim accounting update is enabled, any Port Up event from GSMP will initiate in an interim update. Port Up messages can include information such as an update on the current subscriber actual-upstream-speed. The next interim accounting message will be from port up triggering point.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no access-loop-options

host-accounting

Syntax 
[no] host-accounting [interim-update]
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

This command enables per-host accounting. In host accounting mode, the acct-session-id is generated per host. This acct-session-id is uniformly included in all accounting messages (START/INTERIM-UPDTATE/STOP) and it can be included in RADIUS Access-Request message.

Accounting counters are based on the queue counters and as such are aggregated for all host sharing the queues within an sla-profile instance (non HSMDA) or a subscriber (HSMDA). CoA and LI is supported based on the acct-session-id of the host.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no host-accounting

Parameters 
interim-update —
Specifies that no interim-update messages are sent for the related subscriber-hosts when the session is deleted. Without this keyword only START and STOP accounting messages are generated when the host is established/terminated. This is equivalent to a time-based accounting where only the duration of the session is required.

include-radius-attribute

Syntax 
[no] include-radius-attribute
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

This command enters the context to specify the RADIUS parameters that the system should include into RADIUS authentication-request messages.

acct-authentic

Syntax 
[no] acct-authentic
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the acct-authentic RADIUS attribute and only applies to the 7750 SR.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no acct-authentic

acct-delay-time

Syntax 
[no] acct-delay-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the acct-delay-time RADIUS attribute and only applies to the 7750 SR.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no acct-delay-time

alc-error-code

Syntax 
[no] alc-error-code
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables RADIUS accounting messages to include an error number and error code when the subscriber host session terminates. To obtain a complete list of error numbers and their corresponding codes, use the tools>dump>aaa>radius-acct-terminate-cause command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no alc-error-code

all-authorized-session-addresses

Syntax 
[no] all-authorized-session-addresses
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command specifies to include all included and authorized address/prefix attributes in session accounting and is applicable only for session-accounting mode.

With this flag enabled, all IP address attributes explicitly enabled to be included are the following:

  1. delegated-ipv6-prefix
  2. framed-ip-address
  3. framed-ip-netmask
  4. framed-ipv6-prefix
  5. ipv6-address

These are included if the corresponding addresses or prefixes are authorized (via access-accept or ludb) and independent if they are used or not.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no all-authorized-session-addresses

called-station-id

Syntax 
[no] called-station-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command includes called station id attributes and only applies to the 7750 SR.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no called-station-id

calling-station-id

Syntax 
calling-station-id
calling-station-id {mac | remote-id | sap-id | sap-string}
no calling-station-id
Context 
config>service>ies>if>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the inclusion of the calling-station-id attribute in RADIUS authentication requests and RADIUS accounting messages. The value inserted is set at the SAP level. If no calling-station-id value is set at the SAP level, the calling-station-id attribute will not be sent.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no calling-station-id

Parameters 
mac—
Specifies that the mac-address will be sent
remote-id—
Specifies that the remote-id will be sent
sap-id—
Specifies that the sap-id will be sent
sap-string—
Specifies that the value is the inserted value set at the SAP level. If no calling-station-id value is set at the SAP level, the calling-station-id attribute will not be sent.

access-loop-options

Syntax 
[no] access-loop-options
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables inclusion of access loop information: Broadband Forum (BBF) access loop characteristics, DSL line state and DSL type. The BBF access loop characteristics are returned as BBF specific RADIUS attributes where DSL line state and DSL type are returned as Nokia-specific RADIUS VSA’s.

Information obtained via the ANCP protocol has precedence over information received in PPPoE Vendor Specific BBF tags or DHCP Vendor Specific BBF Options.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no access-loop-options

acct-session-id

Syntax 
[no] acct-session-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

The acct-session-id attribute for each subscriber host will be generated at the very beginning of the session initiation. This command will enable or disable sending this attribute to the RADIUS server in the Access-Request messages regardless of whether the accounting is enabled or not. The acct-session-id attribute can be used to address the subscriber hosts from the RADIUS server in the CoA Request.

The acct-session-id attribute will be unique per subscriber host network wide. It is a 22bytes long field comprised of the system MAC address along with the creation time and a sequence number in a hex format.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no acct-session-id

circuit-id

Syntax 
[no] circuit-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the agent-circuit-id for RADIUS.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no circuit-id

delegated-ipv6-prefix

Syntax 
[no] delegated-ipv6
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the delegated-ipv6-prefix RADIUS attribute and only applies to the 7750 SR.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no delegated-ipv6

detailed-acct-attributes

Syntax 
[no] detailed-acct-attributes
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables detailed reporting of per queue and per policer octet and packet counters using RADIUS VSAs. Enabled by default. It can be enabled simultaneously with aggregate counters (std-acct-attributes).

The no form of the command excludes the detailed counter VSAs from the RADIUS accounting messages.

Default 

detailed-acct-attributes

dhcp-options

Syntax 
[no] dhcp-options
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables insertion of RADIUS VSA containing all dhcp-options from dhcp-discover (or dhcp-request) message. The VSA contains all dhcp-options in a form of the string. If required (the total length of all dhcp-options exceeds 255B), multiple VSAs are included.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no dhcp-options

dhcp6-options

Syntax 
[no] dhcp6-options
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include
Description 

This command copies DHCPv6 options from received DHCPv6 messages on ingress access and pass them to the RADIUS server in Accept-Request. The messages will be carried in the ALU VSA Alc-ToServer-Dhcp6-Options.

Default 

no dhcp6-options

dhcp-vendor-class-id

Syntax 
[no] dhcp-vendor-class-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command includes the [26-6527-36] Alc-DHCP-Vendor-Class-Id attribute in RADIUS accounting messages. The content of the DHCP Vendor-Class-Identifier option (60) is mapped in this attribute.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no dhcp-vendor-class-id

framed-interface-id

Syntax 
[no] framed-interface-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the framed-interface-id RADIUS attribute and only applies to the 7750 SR.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no framed-interface-id

framed-ip-addr

Syntax 
[no] framed-ip-addr
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the inclusion of the framed-ip-addr attribute.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no framed-ip-addr

framed-ip-netmask

Syntax 
[no] framed-ip-netmask
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the inclusion of the framed-ip-netmask attribute.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no framed-ip-netmask

framed-ipv6-prefix

Syntax 
[no] framed-ipv6-prefix
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the framed-ipv6-prefix RADIUS attribute and only applies to the 7750 SR.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no framed-ipv6-prefix

framed-ipv6-route

Syntax 
[no] framed-ipv6-route
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

When enabled, all valid [99] Framed-IPv6-Route attributes as received in the RADIUS authentication phase and associated with an instantiated IPv6 wan host will be included in the RADIUS accounting request messages. The state of the Framed-IPv6-Route (installed, shadowed, hostInactive, and so on) is not taken into account for reporting in the accounting request messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no framed-ipv6-route

framed-route

Syntax 
[no] framed-route
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

When enabled, all valid [22] Framed-Route attributes as received in the RADIUS authentication phase and associated with an instantiated IPv4 host will be included in the RADIUS accounting request messages. The state of the Framed-Route (installed, shadowed, hostInactive, and so on) is not taken into account for reporting in the accounting request messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no framed-route

ipv6-address

Syntax 
[no] framed-ipv6-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the ipv6-address RADIUS attribute.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no framed-ipv6-address

mac-address

Syntax 
[no] mac-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the client MAC address RADIUS attribute.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no mac-address

nas-identifier

Syntax 
[no] nas-identifier
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the nas-identifier RADIUS attribute.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no nas-identifier

nas-port

Syntax 
[no] nas-port bit-specification binary-spec
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the nas-port RADIUS attribute. You enter decimal representation of a 32-bit string that indicates your port information. This 32-bit string can be compiled based on different information from the port (data types). By using syntax number-of-bits data-type you indicate how many bits from the 32 bits are used for the specific data type. These data types can be combined up to 32 bits in total. In between the different data types 0's and/or 1's as bits can be added.

The no form of this command disables your nas-port configuration.

Parameters 
bit-specification binary-spec—
Specifies the NAS-Port attribute
Values—

binary-spec

<bit-specification> <binary-spec>

bit-specification

0 | 1 | <bit-origin>

bit-origin

*<number-of-bits><origin>

number-of-bits

1 to 32

origin

o | i | s | m | p

outer VLAN ID

i

inner VLAN ID

s

slot number

m

MDA number

p

port number or lag-id

 

Output 

Sample
*12o*12i00*2s*2m*2p => oooo oooo oooo iiii iiii iiii 00ss mmpp
If outer vlan = 0 & inner vlan = 1 & slot = 3 & mda = 1 & port = 1
=>  0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 0011 0101 => nas-port = 309 

nas-port-id

Syntax 
[no] nas-port-id [prefix-string string] [suffix suffix-option]
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the nas-port-id RADIUS attribute. Optionally, the value of this attribute (the SAP-id) can be prefixed by a fixed string and suffixed by the circuit-id or the remote-id of the client connection. If a suffix is configured, but no corresponding data is available, the suffix used will be 0/0/0/0/0/0.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
string
Specifies that a user configurable string will be added to the RADIUS NAS port attribute, up to 8 characters in length
suffix-option
Specifies the suffix type to be added to the RADIUS NAS port attribute
Values—
circuit-id, remote-id

 

nas-port-type

Syntax 
nas-port-type
nas-port-type [value]
no nas-port-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the nas-port-type RADIUS attribute. If set to nas-port-type, the following will be sent: values: 32 (null-encap), 33 (dot1q), 34 (qinq), 15 (DHCP hosts). The nas-port-type can also be set as a specified value, with an integer from 0 to 255.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no nas-port-type

Parameters 
value
Specifies an enumerated integer that specifies the value that will be put in the RADIUS nas-port-type attribute
Values—
0 to 255

 

nat-port-range

Syntax 
[no] nat-port-range
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the of nat-port-range attribute and only applies to the 7750 SR.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no nat-port-range

pppoe-service-name

Syntax 
[no] pppoe-service-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the pppoe-service-name RADIUS attribute.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no pppoe-service-name

remote-id

Syntax 
[no] remote-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the agent-remote-id for RADIUS.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no remote-id

sap-session-index

Syntax 
[no] sap-session-index
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the per-SAP unique session index.

The no form of the command excludes sap-session-index attributes.

Default 

no sap-session-index

tunnel-server-attrs

Syntax 
[no] tunnel-server-attrs
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command includes tunnel-server attribute.

The no form of the command disables the generation of the tunnel-server-attrs RADIUS attribute.

Default 

no tunnel-server-attrs

wifi-num-attached-ues

Syntax 
[no] wifi-num-attached-ues
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>includeconfig>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>includeconfig>aaa>isa-radius-plcy>auth-include-attributesconfig>aaa>isa-radius-plcy>acct-include-attributes
Description 

When enabled, this command indicates the number of UEs connected to the tunnel to which the radius message applies to. For session/host accounting this is the tunnel of the associated UE. For queue-instance accounting this attribute will not be included.

The no form of the command disables including the Alc-Num-Attached-UEs RADIUS attribute.

Default 

no wifi-num-attached-ues

wifi-ssid-vlan

Syntax 
[no] wifi-ssid-vlan
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>includeconfig>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>includeconfig>aaa>isa-radius-plcy>auth-include-attributesconfig>aaa>isa-radius-plcy>acct-include-attributes
Description 

This command enables including the per-SSID VLAN ID in a Alc-Wlan-SSID-VLAN.

The no form of the command disables including the per-SSID VLAN ID in Alc-Wlan-SSID-VLAN

Default 

no wifi-ssid-vlan

sla-profile

Syntax 
[no] sla-profile
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command specifies that SLA profile attributes should be included into RADIUS accounting messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no sla-profile

std-acct-attributes

Syntax 
[no] std-acct-attributes
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables reporting of aggregated forwarded IPv4 and IPv6 octet, packet and gigaword counters using standard Radius attributes. Disabled by default. It can be enabled simultaneously with detailed per queue/policer counters (detailed-acct-attributes).

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no std-acct-attributes

sub-profile

Syntax 
[no] sub-profile
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command specifies that subscriber profile attributes should be included into RADIUS accounting messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no sub-profile

subscriber-id

Syntax 
[no] subscriber-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command specifies that subscriber ID attributes should be included into RADIUS accounting messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no subscriber-id

tunnel-server-attrs

Syntax 
[no] tunnel-server-attrs
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>include-radius-attribute
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the generation of the tunnel-server RADIUS attribute and only applies to the 7750 SR.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no tunnel-server-attrs

user-name

Syntax 
[no] user-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the inclusion of the user-name attribute.

The no form of the command disables the inclusion of the user-name attribute.

Default 

no user-name

v6-aggregate-stats

Syntax 
[no] v6-aggregate-stats
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables reporting of IPv6 aggregated forwarded octet and packet counters using RADIUS VSAs. Disabled by default. It requires stat-mode v4-v6 for policers and queues for which the IPv6 aggregate forwarded packets should be counted.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no v6-aggregate-stats

wifi-rssi

Syntax 
[no] wifi-rssi
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>include-radius-attribute
Description 

This command enables the inclusion of the 802.11 Received Signal Strength Indication attribute.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no wifi-rssi

password

Syntax 
password password [hash | hash2]
no password
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy
Description 

This command sets a password that is sent with user-name in every RADIUS authentication request sent to the RADIUS server upon receipt of DHCP discover or request messages. If no password is configured, no password AVP will be sent.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Parameters 
password—
Specifies a text string containing the password. Allowed values are any string up to 64 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
hash—
Specifies that the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies that the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.

password

Syntax 
password password [hash | hash2]
no password
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq
Description 

This command sets a password that is sent with user-name in every RADIUS authentication request sent to the RADIUS server upon receipt of DHCP discover or request messages. If no password is provided, an empty password will be sent.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no password

Parameters 
password—
Specifies a text string containing the password. Allowed values are any string up to 64 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
hash—
Specifies that the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies that the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.

ppp-user-name

Syntax 
ppp-user-name append domain-name
ppp-user-name default-domain domain-name
ppp-user-name replace domain-name
ppp-user-name strip
no ppp-user-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy
Description 

This command configures the password that is sent with the User-Name in Diameter NASREQ AA-Requests for IPoE hosts.

When no password is configured, an empty password will be sent.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ppp-user-name

Parameters 
domain-name
A string specified by tmnxSubAuthPlcyPppDomain, preceded with a '@', is appended to the PAP/CHAP user name
domain-name
The same action is performed as with appendDomain, but only if the PAP/CHAP user name does not already contain a domain name
domain-name
All characters after a '@' delimiter are replaced with the string specified by tmnxSubAuthPlcyPppDomain
strip—
Any “@” character and all subsequent characters are removed from the PAP/CHAP user name

pppoe-access-method

Syntax 
pppoe-access-method {none | padi | pap-chap}
no pppoe-access-method
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy
Description 

This command indicates the authentication method used towards the RADIUS server in case the policy is used for PPPoE.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ppoe-access-method

Parameters 
none—
Indicates that the client will be authenticated by the local user database defined under the group interface and not through RADIUS
padi —
Indicates that the client will be authenticated by RADIUS as soon as the PADI packet comes in (there is no PPP authentication done in the session in this case)
pap-chap —
Indicates that the RADIUS authentication of the client will be delayed until the authentication protocol phase in the PPP session (PAP or CHAP) and authentication will be performed with the user name and PAP password / CHAP response supplied by the client

queue-instance-accounting

Syntax 
queue-instance-accounting [interim-update]
no queue-instance-accounting
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

This command enables per queue-instance-accounting. A stream of accounting messages (START/INTERIM-UPDATE/STOP) is generated per queuing instance. A queuing instance is equivalent to an sla-profile instance on non HSMDA based hardware and to subscriber on HSMDA based hardware. Accounting session id is generated per queuing instance and this accounting session id CANNOT be included in RADIUS Access-Request message. Queue instance counters represent volume based aggregation for all hosts sharing the queuing instance.

CoA and LI is supported based on the acct-session-id of the queuing instance.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

interim-update

Parameters 
interim-update—
Specifies whether accounting messages are sent for the queue-instance. The queue-instance is the subscriber on High Scale MDA (HSMDA), or the SLA profile instance.

radius-authentication-server

Syntax 
radius-authentication-server
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

This command enters the context to define RADIUS authentication server attributes under a given session authentication policy.

access-algorithm

Syntax 
access-algorithm {direct | round-robin}
no access-algorithm
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy-srvr
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>server
Description 

This command configures the algorithm used to access the list of configured RADIUS servers.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
direct—
Specifies that the first server will be used as primary server for all requests, the second as secondary and so on
round-robin—
Specifies that the first server will be used as primary server for the first request, the second server as primary for the second request, and so on. If the router gets to the end of the list, it starts again with the first server

fallback-action

Syntax 
fallback-action accept [force-probing]
fallback-action user-db local-user-db-name [force-probing]
no fallback-action
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy
Description 

This command configures the action when no RADIUS server is available; servers are either out of service or are in a probing state.

The no form of the command removes the action from the configuration.

Default 

no fallback-action

Parameters 
accept—
specifies that all authentication requests are automatically accepted
local-user-db-name—
specifies that the LUDB is used to authenticate to the server
force-probing—
specifies that a subscriber or a test user auth-request, depending which arrives first, is used to probe a RADIUS server before continuing with accept or user-db. This forces an out-of-service server to transition to a probing state.

hold-down-time

Syntax 
hold-down-time seconds
no hold-down-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy>radius-auth-server
Description 

This command determines the interval during which no new communication attempts will be made to a RADIUS server that is marked down to prevent immediately overloading the server when it is starting up. The only exception is when all servers in the authentication policy are marked down; in that case they will all be used again to prevent failures on new client connections.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

30

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the hold time before re-using a RADIUS server that was down
Values—
30 to 900

 

router

Syntax 
router router-instance
router service-name
no router
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy-srvr
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>server
Description 

This command specifies the virtual router instance applicable for the set of configured RADIUS servers. This value cannot be changed once a RADIUS server is configured for this policy. When the value is zero, both base and management router instances are matched.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no router

Parameters 
router-instance—
Specifies the virtual router instance
Values—

router-name:

Base, management

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

service-name:

Specifies the service name up to 64 characters in length

 

retry

Syntax 
retry count
no retry
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy-srvr
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>server
Description 

This command configures the number of times the router attempts to contact the RADIUS server for authentication, if not successful the first time.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

3

Parameters 
count—
Specifies the retry count
Values—
1 to 10

 

radius-server-policy

Syntax 
radius-server-policy radius-server-policy-name
no radius-server-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

This command references an existing radius-server-policy (available under the config>aaa context) for use in subscriber management authentication and accounting.

When configured in an authentication-policy, following CLI commands are ignored in the policy to avoid conflicts:

  1. all commands in the radius-authentication-server context
  2. accept-authorization-change
  3. coa-script-policy
  4. accept-script-policy
  5. request-script-policy

When configured in a radius-accounting-policy, following CLI commands are ignored in the policy to avoid conflicts:

  1. all commands in the radius-accounting-server context
  2. acct-request-script-policy

The no form of the command removes the radius-server-policy reference from the configuration

Default 

no radius-server-policy

Parameters 
radius-server-policy-name—
Specifies the RADIUS server policy

server

Syntax 
server server-index address ip-address secret key [hash | hash2] [port port-num] [coa-only] [pending-requests-limit limit]
no server index
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy>radius-auth-server
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>server
Description 

This command adds a RADIUS server and configures the RADIUS server IP address, index, and key values.

Up to sixteen RADIUS servers can be configured at any one time in a RADIUS authentication policy. Only five can be used for authentication, all other servers should be configured as coa-only servers. In a RADIUS accounting policy, up to five RADIUS servers can be configured. RADIUS servers are accessed in order from lowest to highest index for authentication or accounting requests until a response from a server is received. A higher indexed server is only queried if no response is received from a lower indexed server (which implies that the server is not available). If a response from a server is received, no other RADIUS servers are queried.

The no form of the command removes the server index from the configuration.

Parameters 
server-index—
Specifies the index for the RADIUS server. The index determines the sequence in which the servers are queried for authentication requests. Servers are queried in order from lowest to highest index.
Values—
1 to 16 (a maximum of 5 authentication servers)

 

ip-address
Specifies the IP address of the RADIUS server. Two RADIUS servers cannot have the same IP address. An error message is generated if the server address is a duplicate.
key
Specifies the secret key to access the RADIUS server. This secret key must match the password on the RADIUS server.
Values—
secret-key: Up to 20 characters in length.
hash-key: Up to 33 characters in length.
hash2-ke: Up to 55 characters in length.

 

hash—
Specifies the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.
port-num
Specifies the UDP port number on which to contact the RADIUS server for authentication
Values—
1 to 65535

 

coa-only—
Specifies Change-of-Authorization Messages only. Servers that are marked with the coa-only flag will not be used for authentication, but they will be able to accept RADIUS CoA messages, independent of the accept-authorization-change setting in the authentication policy.

For authentication purposes, the maximum number of servers is 5. All other servers may only be used as coa-only servers.

limit
Specifies the maximum number of outstanding RADIUS authentication requests for this authentication server.
Values—
1 to 4096

 

Default—
The default value when not configured is 4096

hold-down-time

Syntax 
[no] hold-down-time [sec seconds] [min minutes] [hrs hours] [days days]
Context 
config>aaa>radius-srv-plcy>servers
Description 

This command determines the interval during which no new communication attempts are made to a RADIUS server that is marked down to prevent immediately overloading the server when it is starting up. The only exception is when all servers in the authentication policy are marked down; in that case, they will all be used again to prevent failures on new client connections.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

30s

Parameters 
days —
Specifies the hold time in days before re-using a RADIUS server that was down
Values—
1 to 1

 

hours—
Specifies the hold time in hours before re-using a RADIUS server that was down
Values—
1 to 23

 

minutes —
Specifies the hold time in minutes before re-using a RADIUS server that was down
Values—
1 to 59

 

seconds —
Specifies the hold time in seconds before re-using a RADIUS server that was down
Values—
1 to 59

 

down-timeout

Syntax 
[no] down-timeout
Context 
config>aaa>radius-srv-plcy>servers>health-check
Description 

This command determines the interval to wait for a RADIUS reply message from the RADIUS server before a RADIUS server is declared out-of-service. By default, the value of the down-timeout is the number of retries multiplied by the timeout interval. Each host will use the configured timeout and retry value under the AAA RADIUS server policy.

timeout refers to the waiting period before the next retry attempt

retry refers the number of times the host will attempt to contact the RADIUS server.

If a RADIUS server is declared out-of-service, the host pending retry attempts will move on to the next RADIUS server.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no down-timeout

Parameters 
minutes —
Specifies the timer to wait, in minutes, before declaring the RADIUS server that is down
Values—
0 to 59

 

seconds—
Specifies the timer to wait, in seconds, before declaring the RADIUS server that is down
Values—
1 to 5

 

source-address

Syntax 
source-address ip-address
no source-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy-srvr
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>server
Description 

This command configures the source address of the RADIUS packet.

The system IP address must be configured in order for the RADIUS client to work. See Configuring a System Interface in the Router Configuration Guide.

Note:

The system IP address must only be configured if the source-address is not specified. When the no source-address command is executed, the source address is determined at the moment the request is sent. This address is also used in the nas-ip-address attribute: over there it is set to the system IP address if no source-address was given.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

System IP address

Parameters 
ip-address —
Specifies the IP prefix for the IP match criterion in dotted decimal notation
Values—
0.0.0.0 - 255.255.255.255

 

timeout

Syntax 
timeout seconds
no timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-plcy-srvr
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy>server
Description 

This command configures the number of seconds the router waits for a response from a RADIUS server.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

3 seconds

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the time, in seconds, that the router waits for a response from a RADIUS server, expressed as a decimal integer
Values—
1 to 90

 

session-accounting

Syntax 
session-accounting [interim-update] [host-update]
no session-accounting
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

This command enables per session accounting mode. In per session accounting mode, the acct-session-id is generated per session. This acct-session-id is uniformly included in all accounting messages (START/INTERIM-UPDTATE/STOP) and it can be included in RADIUS Access-Request message.

This accounting mode of operation can be used only in PPPoE environment with dual-stack host in which case both hosts (IPv4 and IPv6) are considered part of the same session. In addition to regular interim-updates, triggered interim-updates are sent by a host joining or leaving the session.

When an IPv4/v6 address is allocated, or released from a dual-stack host, a triggered interim-update message is immediately sent. This triggered interim-update message reflects the change in the IP address. The triggered interim-update has no effect on the interval at which the regular interim updates are scheduled.

Accounting counters are based on the queue counters and as such are aggregated for all host sharing the queues within an sla-profile instance (non HSMDA) or a subscriber (HSMDA).

CoA and LI is supported based on the acct-session-id of the session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no session-accounting

Parameters 
interim-update—
Specifies to enable interim updates. Without this keyword only START and STOP accounting messages are generated when the session is established/terminated. This is equivalent to a time-based accounting where only the duration of the session is required.
host-update—
Indicates that host updates messages are sent. INTERIM-UPDATE messages can be generated (volume based accounting) by selecting this keyword.

session-id-format

Syntax 
session-id-format {description | number}
no session-id-format
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the format for the acct-session-id attribute used in RADIUS accounting requests.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

description

Parameters 
description—
Specifies to use a string containing following information <subscriber>@<sap-id>@<SLA-profile>_<creation-time>
number—
Specifies to use a unique number generated by the OS to identify a given session

update-interval

Syntax 
update-interval minutes
no update-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the interval at which accounting data of subscriber hosts will be updated in a RADIUS Accounting Interim-Update message. Requires interim-update to be enabled when specifying the accounting mode in the radius accounting policy.

A RADIUS specified interim interval (attribute [85] Acct-Interim-Interval) overrides the CLI configured value.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
minutes—
Specifies the interval, in minutes, at which accounting data of subscriber hosts will be updated
Values—
5 to 259200

 

update-interval-jitter

Syntax 
update-interval-jitter absolute seconds
no update-interval-jitter
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the absolute maximum random delay introduced on the update interval between two accounting interim update messages. The effective maximum random delay value is the minimum of the configured absolute jitter value and 10% of the configured update-interval.

A value of zero will send the accounting interim update message without introducing an additional random delay.

The no form of the command sets the default to 10% of the configured update-interval.

Default 

no update-interval-jitter

This corresponds with 10% of the configured update-interval

Parameters 
seconds
Specifies the absolute maximum jitter value in seconds.\
Values—
0 to 36000

 

re-authentication

Syntax 
[no] re-authentication
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy
Description 

This command enables authentication process at every DHCP address lease renewal s only if RADIUS did not reply any special attributes (for example, authentication only, no authorization).

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no re-authentication

request-script-policy

Syntax 
request-script-policy policy-name
no request-script-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy
Description 

This command specifies the RADIUS script policy used to change the RADIUS attributes of the outgoing Access-Request messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no request-script-policy

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies a Python script policy to modify Access-Request messages

send-acct-stop-on-fail

Syntax 
send-acct-stop-on-fail {[on-request-failure] [on-reject] [on-accept-failure]}
no send-acct-stop-on-fail
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy
Description 

This command activates the reporting of RADIUS authentication failures of a PPPoE session to a RADIUS accounting server with an Accounting Stop message.

Three failure categories can be enabled separately:

  1. on-request-failure: All failure conditions between the sending of an Access-Request and the reception of an Access-Accept or Access-Reject.
  2. on-reject:
  3. on-accept-failure: All failure conditions that appear after receiving an Access-Accept and before successful instantiation of the host or session.

The RADIUS accounting policy to be used for sending the Accounting Stop messages must be obtained prior to RADIUS authentication via local user database pre-authentication.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no send-acct-stop-on-fail

Parameters 
on-request-failure—
Specifies that an accounting stop message will be sent when a RADIUS Access-Request message could not be sent (for example, there is no server configured, or timeout)
on-reject—
Specifies that an accounting stop message will be sent when an Access-Reject is received
on-accept-failure—
Specifies that an accounting stop message will be sent a failure occurred after the reception of a RADIUS Access-Accept message (such as a duplicate IP address)

user-name-format

Syntax 
user-name-format format [mac-format mac-format]
user-name-format format append [domain-name] [mac-format mac-format]
user-name-format format append domain-name
user-name-format format default-domain domain-name [mac-format mac-format]
user-name-format format replace domain-name [mac-format mac-format]
user-name-format format strip [mac-format mac-format]
no user-name-format
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auth-policy
Description 

This command defines the format of the “user-name” field in the session authentication request sent to the RADIUS server.

The no form of the command switches to the default format, mac.

Default 

By default, the MAC source address of the DHCP DISCOVER message is used in the user-name field.

Parameters 
format—
Specifies the user name format in RADIUS message.
Values—
ascii-converted-circuit-id, ascii-converted-tuple, circuit-id, dhcp-client-vendor-opts, mac, mac-giaddr, tuple

 

ascii-converted-circuit-id — Identical to circuit-id, but the user name will be sent to the RADIUS server as a string of hex digits, for use if there is binary data in the circuit-id

ascii-converted-tuple — Identical to tuple, but the circuit-id part of the user name will be sent to the RADIUS server as a string of hex digits, for use if there is binary data in the circuit-id

circuit-id — If the system serves as a DHCP relay server which inserts option 82 info, the user name will be formatted as defined under DHCP information option. If the system is not a DHCP relay server, the circuit-id will be taken from option 82 in the received DHCP message. If no circuit-id can be found, the DHCP-msg is rejected.

dhcp-client-vendor-opts — Creates a concatenation of the DHCP client-identifier option (option 61), a “@” delimiter and the DHCP vendor-class identifier option {option 60}. The two option strings are parsed for any characters which are non-printing are considered invalid and must be converted to underscore “_” characters. In addition, any space character (hex 20) and @ character (hex 40) are also converted to underscore. The character set considered valid is ASCII hex 21 through hex 3F, and hex 41 through hex 7E. Any character outside this set will be converted into an underscore (hex 5F) character.

mac — The MAC source address of the DHCP DISCOVER message is used in the user-name field. The format of the MAC address string used as the user name in the RADIUS authentication requests uses lowercase hex digits, and “:” as the inter-digit separator, for example, 00:11:22:aa:bb:cc is valid but 00-11-22-AA-BB-CC will return an error. The RADIUS server must be configured accordingly, otherwise the authentication request will fail.

mac-giaddr — Specifies that MAC giaddr indicates the format used to identify the user towards the RADIUS server

tuple — Specifies that the concatenation of MAC source address and circuit-ID are used in the user-name field

mac-format—
Specifies how a MAC address is represented when contacting a RADIUS server. This is only used while the value of is equal to the DHCP client vendor options and if the MAC address is used by default of the DHCP client vendor options.

Examples:

ab:

00:0c:f1:99:85:b8 7xxx style

XY-

00-0C-F1-99-85-B8 IEEE canonical style

mmmm.

0002.03aa.abff Cisco style

append—
Specifies the data type which is an enumerated integer that indicates what needs to be appended to the user-name sent to the RADIUS server
Values—
1 — nothing 2 — domain name

 

domain—
Specifies to user the domain name. In some instances it is desired to add a domain only to usernames which have omitted the domain (@domain). In these instances a default-domain can be appended to usernames which lack a @domain
append—
Adds a “@” delimiter and the specified string after the PAP/CHAP username. No allowance is made for the presence of an existing domain or @ delimited.
replace—
Replaces the character-string after the “@” delimiter with the string specified
strip—
Removes all characters after and including the “@” delimiter

For example:

Command: append
String:     domainA-1.com
PAP/CHAP User:    someuser
Resulting User:    someuser@domainA-1.com
 
Command: append
String:     domainA-1.com
PAP/CHAP User:    someuser@existing-domain.net
Resulting User:    someuser@existing-domain.net@domainA-1.com
 
Command: strip
String:            
PAP/CHAP User:    someuser@existing-domain.net
Resulting User:    someuser
 
Command: replace
String:     domainA-1.com
PAP/CHAP User:    someuser@existing-domain.net
Resulting User:    someuser@domainA-1.com
 
Command: default-domain
String:    domainA-1.com
PAP/CHAP User:    someuser@existing-domain.net
Resulting User:    someuser@existing-domain.net
 
Command: default-domain
String: domainA-1.com
PAP/CHAP User:    someuser
Resulting User:    someuser@domainA-1.com

user-name-format

Syntax 
user-name-format format
no user-name-format
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq
Description 

This command defines the format of the User-Name AVP value in Diameter NASREQ AA-Requests for IPoE hosts.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
format—
Specifies the format of the User-Name AVP value.
Values—
mac — Specifies to use the MAC source address of the DHCP DISCOVER message is used in the user-name field. The format of the MAC address string is defined with the mac-format CLI command.
circuit-id — Specifies to use the circuit ID to identify the user toward the server. If the system serves as a DHCP relay server which inserts option 82 info, the user name will be formatted as defined under DHCP information option. If the system is not a DHCP relay server, the circuit-id will be taken from option 82 in the received DHCP message. If no circuit-id can be found, the DHCP-msg is rejected.
tuple — Specifies to use a concatenation of MAC source address and circuit-ID.
ascii-converted-circuit-id — Identical to circuit-id, but the user name is a string of hex digits, for use if there is binary data in the circuit-id.
ascii-converted-tuple — Specifies a string of hex digits, for use if there is binary data in the circuit-id.
dhcp-client-vendor-opts — Specifies to use a concatenation of the DHCP client-identifier option (option 61), “@” as delimiter and the DHCP vendor-class identifier option (option 60). Spaces (hex 20), @ character (hex 40) and non printable characters (all character outside range hex 21 through hex 7E) are converted to underscore “_” (hex 5F).
mac-giaddr — Specifies to use a concatenation of MAC source address and DHCP gi address.
nas-port-id — Specifies to use a value of the nas-port-id with format defined in the include-avp section.

 

user-name-operation

Syntax 
user-name-operation operation [domain domain-name]
no user-name-operation
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq
Description 

This command enables domain name manipulation of the user name, such as append, strip, replace or add as default.

For IPoE, this command only applies when user-name-format is configured to dhcp-client-vendor-opts.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no user-name-operation

Parameters 
operation—
Specifies the user name manipulations with respect to domain name values.
Values—
append-domain – appends an “@” delimiter with the specified domain-name at the end of the user-name, independent if a domain name was already present.
strip-domain – removes all characters after and including the “@” delimiter.
default-domain – adds an “@” delimiter and the specified domain name to user-names that have no domain name present.
replace-domain – replaces the characters after the “@” delimiter with the specified domain-name.

 

domain domain-name—
Specifies the domain name string to be used in the specified operation up to 128 characters in length

9.25.2.1.4.1. RADIUS Accounting Policy Custom Record Commands

custom-record

Syntax 
[no] custom-record
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure the layout and setting for a custom accounting record associated with this accounting policy.

The no form of the command reverts the configured values to the defaults.

Default 

no custom-record

delay-start-time

Syntax 
[no] delay-start-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>acct-plcy
Description 

It is recommended to only use this command when session-accounting is used. By default, a dual stack subscriber generates a RADIUS accounting interim message for each new host update (IPv4, IPv6 WAN, and IPv6 PD). This command delays the trigger of a RADIUS accounting start message and allows all hosts to connect first. When the delay timer expires, a single RADIUS accounting start message containing all the host currently connected to the BNG is sent to the server. Subsequent host connections will trigger interim-updates if host-update is enabled on session-accounting. For all other accounting modes, this command will delay the trigger of an accounting start when a host connects.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no delay-start-time

override-counter

Syntax 
[no] override-counter override-counter-id
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Application Assurance override counter parameters.

The no form of the command removes the ID from the configuration.

Parameters 
override-counter-id—
Specifies the override counter ID.
Values—
1 to 8

 

e-counters

Syntax 
e-counters [all]
no e-counters
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>override-cntr
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-override-cntr
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue
Description 

This command enables the conftext to configure egress counter parameters for this custom record.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no e-counters

Parameters 
all—
Includes all counters.

i-counters

Syntax 
i-counters [all]
no i-counters
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>override-cntr
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-override-cntr
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue
Description 

This command configures ingress counter parameters for this custom record.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no i-counters

Parameters 
all—
Includes all counters.

queue

Syntax 
[no] queue queue-id
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr
Description 

This command specifies the queue-id for which counters will be collected in this custom record. The counters that will be collected are defined in egress and ingress counters.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value

Default 

no queue

Parameters 
queue-id—
Specifies the queue-id for which counters will be collected in this custom record.

in-profile-octets-discarded-count

Syntax 
[no] in-profile-octets-discarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>e-count
Description 

This command includes the in-profile octets discarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv4 octets discarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the in-profile octets discarded count.

Default 

no in-profile-octets-discarded-count

in-profile-octets-forwarded-count

Syntax 
[no] in-profile-octets-forwarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>e-count
Description 

This command includes the in-profile octets forwarded count. For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv4 octets forwarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the in-profile octets forwarded count.

Default 

no in-profile-octets-forwarded-count

in-profile-packets-discarded-count

Syntax 
[no] in-profile-packets-discarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>e-count
Description 

This command includes the in-profile packets discarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv4 packets discarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the in-profile packets discarded count.

Default 

no in-profile-packets-discarded-count

in-profile-packets-forwarded-count

Syntax 
[no] in-profile-packets-forwarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>e-count
Description 

This command includes the in-profile packets forwarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv4 packets forwarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the in-profile packets forwarded count.

Default 

no in-profile-packets-forwarded-count

out-profile-octets-discarded-count

Syntax 
[no] out-profile-octets-discarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>e-count
Description 

This command includes the out of profile packets discarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv6 octets discarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the out of profile packets discarded count.

Default 

no out-profile-octets-discarded-count

out-profile-octets-forwarded-count

Syntax 
[no] out-profile-octets-forwarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>e-count
Description 

This command includes the out of profile octets forwarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv6 octets forwarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the out of profile octets forwarded count.

Default 

no out-profile-octets-forwarded-count

out-profile-packets-discarded-count

Syntax 
[no] out-profile-packets-discarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>e-count
Description 

This command includes the out of profile packets discarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv6 packets discarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the out of profile packets discarded count.

Default 

no out-profile-packets-discarded-count

out-profile-packets-forwarded-count

Syntax 
[no] out-profile-packets-forwarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>e-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>e-count
Description 

This command includes the out of profile packets forwarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv6 packets forwarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the out of profile packets forwarded count.

Default 

no out-profile-packets-forwarded-count

all-octets-offered-count

Syntax 
[no] all-octets-offered-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes all octets offered in the count.

The no form of the command excludes the octets offered in the count.

Default 

no all-octets-offered-count

all-packets-offered-count

Syntax 
[no] all-packets-offered-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes all packets offered in the count.

The no form of the command excludes the packets offered in the count.

Default 

no all-packets-offered-count

high-octets-discarded-count

Syntax 
[no] high-octets-discarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the high octets discarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv4 octets discarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the high octets discarded count.

Default 

no high-octets-discarded-count

high-octets-offered-count

Syntax 
[no] high-octets-offered-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the high octets offered count.

The no form of the command excludes the high octets offered count.

Default 

no high-octets-offered-count

high-packets-discarded-count

Syntax 
[no] high-packets-discarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the high packets discarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv4 packets discarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the high packets discarded count.

Default 

no high-packets-discarded-count

high-packets-offered-count

Syntax 
[no] high-packets-offered-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the high packets offered count.

The no form of the command excludes the high packets offered count.

Default 

no high-packets-offered -count

in-profile-octets-forwarded-count

Syntax 
[no] in-profile-octets-forwarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the in profile octets forwarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv4 octets forwarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the in profile octets forwarded count.

Default 

no in-profile-octets-forwarded-count

in-profile-packets-forwarded-count

Syntax 
[no] in-profile-packets-forwarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the in profile packets forwarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes IPv4 packets forwarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the in profile packets forwarded count.

Default 

no in-profile-packets-forwarded-count

low-octets-discarded-count

Syntax 
[no] low-octets-discarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the low octets discarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv6 octets discarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the low octets discarded count.

Default 

no low-octets-discarded-count

low-packets-discarded-count

Syntax 
[no] low-packets-discarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the low packets discarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv6 packets discarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the low packets discarded count.

Default 

no low-packets-discarded-count

low-octets-offered-count

Syntax 
[no] low-octets-offered-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the low octets discarded count.

The no form of the command excludes the low octets discarded count.

low-packets-offered-count

Syntax 
[no] low-packets-offered-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the low packets discarded count.

The no form of the command excludes the low packets discarded count.

out-profile-octets-forwarded-count

Syntax 
[no] out-profile-octets-forwarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the out of profile octets forwarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv6 octets forwarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the out of profile octets forwarded count.

Default 

no out-profile-octets-forwarded-count

out-profile-packets-forwarded-count

Syntax 
[no] out-profile-packets-forwarded-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>oc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>roc>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the out of profile packets forwarded count.

For queues with stat-mode v4-v6, this command includes the IPv6 packets forwarded count instead.

The no form of the command excludes the out of profile packets forwarded count.

Default 

no out-profile-packets-forwarded-count

uncoloured-octets-offered-count

Syntax 
[no] uncoloured-packets-offered-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the uncoloured octets offered in the count.

The no form of the command excludes the uncoloured octets offered in the count.

Default 

no uncoloured-octets-offered-count

uncoloured-packets-offered-count

Syntax 
[no] uncoloured-packets-offered-count
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr>queue>i-count
config>log>acct-policy>cr>ref-queue>i-count
Description 

This command includes the uncoloured packets offered count.

The no form of the command excludes the uncoloured packets offered count.

Default 

no uncoloured-packets-offered-count

ref-aa-specific-counter

Syntax 
[no] ref-aa-specific-counter any
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr
Description 

This command includes a reference aa counter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no ref-aa-specific-counter

Parameters 
any—
Specifies to include any aa-specific counter

ref-override-counter

Syntax 
ref-override-counter ref-override-counter-id
ref-override-counter all
no ref-override-counter
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr
Description 

This command configures a reference override counter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no ref-override-counter

Parameters 
ref-override-counter-id—
Specifies an override counter ID.
Values—
1 to 8

 

all—
Specifies to include all override counters.

ref-queue

Syntax 
ref-queue queue-id
ref-queue all
no ref-queue
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr
Description 

This command configures a reference queue.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no ref-queue

significant-change

Syntax 
significant-change delta
no significant-change
Context 
config>log>acct-policy>cr
Description 

This command configures the significant change required to generate the record.

Parameters 
delta—
Specifies the delta change (significant change) that is required for the custom record to be written to the XML file
Values—
0 to 4294967295

 

9.25.2.1.5. RADIUS Route Download Commands

route-downloader

Syntax 
route-downloader name [create]
no route-downloader name
Context 
config>aaa
Description 

This command enters the context to configure a route-downloader instance. The route-downloader is a process that uses radius access-request messages to a particular server. The server returns either an access-accept or access-deny message. Access-accept messages also contain the prefixes (in the form of static blackhole routes in various formats). Only a single route-downloader object can be created.

The no form of the command removes the name from the configuration. The object must be shutdown prior to deletion. No prefix is needed to delete an existing route-download object.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of this RADIUS route downloader
create —
This keyword is mandatory while creating an instance of the route-download object

base-user-name

Syntax 
base-user-name user-name
no base-user-name
Context 
config>aaa>route-downloader
Description 

This command sets the prefix for the user name that shall be used as access requests. The actual name used will be a concatenation of this string, the “-” (dash) character and a monotonically increasing integer.

The no form of the command removes the user-name from the configuration.

Default 

The system’s configured name (system name).

Parameters 
user-name—
Specifies the prefix of the username that is used in the RADIUS access requests. The username used in the RADIUS access requests is a concatenation of this string, the dash character and an increasing integer.

default-metric

Syntax 
default-metric metric
no default-metric
Context 
config>aaa>route-downloader
Description 

This command sets the default metric that routes imported by the RTM will acquire.

The no form of the command removes the metric

Default 

2

Parameters 
metric—
Specifies the default metric of the routes imported
Values—
0 to 254

 

default-tag

Syntax 
default-tag tag
no default-tag
Context 
config>aaa>route-downloader
Description 

This command sets the default tag that routes processed by the AAA route downloader will take.

Note:

Any route received with a specific tag retains the specific tag. The tag value is passed to the Route Table Manager and is available as match condition on the export statement of other routing protocols.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

0

Parameters 
tag—
Specifies the default tag of the routes imported
Values—
0 to 4294967295

 

download-interval

Syntax 
download-interval minutes
no download-interval
Context 
config>aaa>route-downloader
Description 

This command sets the time interval, in minutes, that the system waits for between two consecutive runs of the route-download process. The time is counted from the start-time of the run, thus, if an route-download process is still ongoing by the time the timer expires, the process will restart from count=1.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

720

Parameters 
minutes—
Specifies the time interval, in minutes, between the start of the last route downloader run and the start of the next route downloader run
Values—
1 to 1440

 

max-routes

Syntax 
max-routes routes
no max-routes
Context 
config>aaa>route-downloader
Description 

This command determines the upper limits for total number of routes to be received and accepted by the system. The total number is inclusive of both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses and no differentiation is needed across protocols. It includes the sum of both. Once this limit is reached, the download process stops sending new access-requests until the next download-interval expires.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

200000

Parameters 
routes—
Specifies the maximum number of the routes imported
Values—
1 to 200000

 

password

Syntax 
password password [hash | hash2]
no password
Context 
config>aaa>route-downloader
Description 

This command specifies the password that is used in the RADIUS access requests.It shall be specified as a string of up to 32 characters in length.

The no form of the command resets the password to its default of ALU and will be stored using hash/hash2 encryption.

Default 

ALU

Parameters 
password—
Specifies a password string up to 32 characters in length
hash—
Specifies the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.

radius-server-policy

Syntax 
radius-server-policy policy-name
no radius-server-policy
Context 
config>aaa>route-downloader
Description 

This command references an existing radius-server-policy (available under the config>aaa context). The server (or servers) referenced by the policy will be used as the targets for the access-request message.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the route-downloader configuration.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the RADIUS server policy

retry-interval

Syntax 
retry-interval min minimum max maximum
no retry-interval
Context 
config>aaa>route-downloader
Description 

This command sets the duration, in minutes, of the retry interval. The retry interval is the interval meant for the system to retry sending an Access Request message after the previous one was un-answered (not with an access reject but rather just a RADIUS failure or ICMP port unreachable). This timer is actually an exponential backoff timer that starts at min and is capped at max minutes.

The no form of the command reverts to the default values.

Default 

retry-interval min 10 max 20

Parameters 
min minimum
Specifies the duration, in minutes, of the retry interval. This duration grows exponentially after each sequential failure.
Values—
1 to 1440

 

Default—
10
max maximum
Specifies the maximum duration, in minutes, of the retry interval
Values—
1 to 1440

 

Default—
20

9.25.2.1.5.1. Category Map Commands

category-map

Syntax 
category-map category-map-name [create]
no category-map category-map-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof
Description 

This command specifies the category map name.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no category-map

Parameters 
category-map-name—
Specifies the category map name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Creates the category map name. This keyword is mandatory when creating a new category map

credit-control-policy

Syntax 
credit-control-policy policy-name [create]
credit-control-policy diameter policy-name
no credit-control-policy policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates, configures or deletes a credit control policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no credit-control-policy

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the policy name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword used to create the credit control policy. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

credit-control-server

Syntax 
credit-control-server radius
credit-control-server diameter policy-name
no credit-control-server
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>credit-control-policy
Description 

This command configures the credit control server to use. In case of RADIUS, the servers defined in the authentication policy are used. For Diameter, the peers defined in the specified Diameter policy are used.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

radius

Parameters 
radius
Specifies to use the RADIUS authentication servers defined in the RADIUS authentication policy in the group interface to report credit usage and obtain new credit
diameter policy-name
Specifies to use the diameter peers specified in the diameter policy to report credit usage and obtain new credit

default-category-map

Syntax 
default-category-map category-map-name
no default-category-map
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>credit-control-policy
Description 

This command configures the default category map.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no default-category-map

Parameters 
category-map-name—
Specifies the category map name up to 32 characters in length

error-handling-action

Syntax 
error-handling-action {continue | block}
no error-handling-action
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>credit-control-policy
Description 

This command configures the error handling action for the policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

continue

Parameters 
continue—
Specifies to continue when an error occurs in the CC determination
block—
Specifies to block when an error occurs in the CC determination

out-of-credit-action

Syntax 
out-of-credit-action {continue | disconnect-host | block-category |
change-service-level}
no out-of-credit-action
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>credit-control-policy
Description 

This command configures the action to be performed when out of credit is reached.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
action—
Specifies the action to be taken when out of credit is out reached.
Values—
continue | disconnect-host | block-category |change-service-level

 

activity-threshold

Syntax 
activity-threshold kilobits-per-second
no activity-threshold
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map
Description 

This command configures the threshold that is applied to determine whether or not there is activity. This is only valid for credit-type = time (not volume).

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no activity-threshold

Parameters 
kilobits-per-second—
Specifies the activity threshold value in kilobits per second
Values—
1 to 100000000

 

category

Syntax 
category category-name [create]
no category category-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map
Description 

This command enters the context for use in RADIUS credit control, Diameter credit control (Gy), Diameter Gx Usage Monitoring, or Idle-Timeout.

Up to sixteen categories can be configured per category map. The internal category for Gx session level Usage Monitoring is included in this limit. The instantiation of the internal category is controlled with the gx-session-level-usage command.

Default 

n/a

Parameters 
category-name—
Specifies the category name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Specifies to create the category map name. This keyword is when creating a new category

category-map

Syntax 
category-map category-map-name
no category-map
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>idle-timeout
Description 

This command references the category-map to be used for the idle-timeout monitoring of subscriber hosts associated with this sla-profile. The category-map must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no category-map

Parameters 
category-map-name —
Specifies the name of the category map, up to 32 characters in length, where the activity-threshold and the category is defined for idle-timeout monitoring of subscriber hosts

category

Syntax 
category category-name [create]
no category category-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>cat-map
Description 

This command defines the category in the category-map to be used for the idle-timeout monitoring of subscriber hosts.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
category-name—
Specifies the name, up to 32 characters in length, of the category where the queues and policers are defined for idle-timeout monitoring of subscriber hosts
create—
Specifies to create the category name. This keyword is mandatory when creating a new category.

idle-timeout

Syntax 
idle-timeout timeout
no idle-timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>cat-map>category
Description 

This command defines the idle-timeout value.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no idle-timeout

Parameters 
timeout—
Specifies the idle-timeout, in seconds
Values—
60 to 15552000

 

idle-timeout-action

Syntax 
idle-timeout-action {shcv-check | terminate}
no idle-timeout-action
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>cat-map>category
Description 

This command defines the action to be executed when the idle-timeout is reached. The action is performed for all hosts associated with the sla-profile instance.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

terminate

Parameters 
shcv-check —
Performs a subscriber host connectivity verification check (IPoE hosts only).
Note:

Host connectivity verification must be enabled on the group-interface where the host is connected.

If the check is successful, the hosts are not disconnected and the idle-timeout timer is reset

If the check fails, the hosts are deleted, similar as for idle-timeout-action terminate

terminate—
Deletes the subscriber host from the system: for PPP hosts, a terminate request is send; for IPoE hosts a DHCP release is send to the DHCP server

credit-type-override

Syntax 
credit-type-override {volume | time}
no credit-type-override
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category
Description 

This command overrides the credit-type configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map context for the given category.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no credit-type-override

Parameters 
volume—
If different than the value specified in the credit-type command, the value overrides the credit-type.
time—
If different than the value specified in the credit-type command, the value overrides the credit-type

default-credit

Syntax 
default-credit volume credits bytes | kilobytes | megabytes | gigabytes
default-credit time seconds
no default-credit
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category
Description 

This command configures the default credit values for RADIUS credit control and Diameter Gy application credit control.

For RADIUS credit control, this command configures the default time or volume credit for this category. The default credit is used during initial setup when no quota is received from the RADIUS server. Refer to Minimum Credit Control Quota Values for more information.

For Diameter Gy credit control, this command specifies the interim credit assigned to this category (rating group) when Extended Failure Handling (EFH) is enabled. This command is ignored when EFH is disabled.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no default-credit

Parameters 
volume credits bytes | kilobytes | megabytes | gigabytes—
Specifies the default value for the volume credit and the unit in which the default value is expressed
Values—
1 to 4294967295 (minimum 1 byte)

 

time seconds
Specifies the default value for the time credit, in seconds
Values—
1 to 4294967295 (minimum 1 second)

 

exhausted-credit-service-level

Syntax 
[no] exhausted-credit-service-level
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category
Description 

This command enters the context to configure the exhausted credit service level

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

exhausted-credit-service-level

egress-ip-filter-entries

Syntax 
[no] egress-ip-filter-entries
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl
Description 

This command enters the context to configure the egress IP filter parameters.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

egress-ip-filter-entries

egress-ipv6-filter-entries

Syntax 
[no] egress-ipv6-filter-entries
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl
Description 

This command enters the context to configure the egress IPv6 filter parameters.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

egress-ipv6-filter-entries

ingress-ip-filter-entries

Syntax 
[no] ingress-ip-filter-entries
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl
Description 

This command enters the context to configure the ingress IP filter parameters.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

ingress-ip-filter-entries

ingress-ipv6-filter-entries

Syntax 
[no] ingress-ipv6-filter-entries
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl
Description 

This command enters the context to configure the ingress IPv6 filter parameters.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

ingress-ipv6-filter-entries

pir

Syntax 
pir pir-rate
pir max
no pir
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl
Description 

This command configures the PIR which will be enforced for all queues pertaining to this category.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no pir

Parameters 
pir-rate—
Specifies the amount of bandwidth in kilobits per second (thousand bits per second)
Values—
1 to 40000000

 

max—
Specifies to use the maximum amount of bandwidth

entry

Syntax 
entry entry-id [create]
no entry entry-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6
Description 

This command configures the IP filter entry.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
entry-id—
Specifies the entry ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

create—
Keyword used to create the entry. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

action

Syntax 
action drop
action forward
action http-redirect url
no action
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6>entry
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6>entry
Description 

This command configures the action for the filter entry.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

drop

Parameters 
drop—
Specifies to drop the IP filter entry
forward—
Specifies to forward the IP filter entry
http-redirect url
Specifies the HTTP web address, up to 255 characters in length, that will be sent to the user’s browser.
Note:

Http-redirect is not supported on 7450 ESS-1 models.

The following displays information that can optionally be added as variables in the portal URL (http-redirect url):

  1. $IP – Customer’s IP address
  2. $MAC – Customer’s MAC address
  3. $URL – Original requested URL
  4. $SAP – Customer’s SAP
  5. $SUB – Customer’s subscriber identification string
  6. $CID – string that represents the circuit-id or interface-id of the subscriber host (hexadecimal format)
  7. $RID – string that represents the remote-id of the subscriber host (hexadecimal format)

match

Syntax 
match [protocol protocol-id]
no match
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6>entry
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6>entry
Description 

This command configures the match criteria for this IP filter entry.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
protocol-id—
Specifies the protocol number or protocol number accepted in DHB
Values—
0 to 255, none, icmp, igmp, ip, tcp, egp, igp, udp, rdp, ipv6, ipv6-route, ipv6-frag, idrp, rsvp, gre, ipv6-icmp, ipv6-no-nxt, ipv6-opts, iso-ip, eigrp, ospf-igp, ether-ip, encap, pnni, pim, vrrp, l2tp, stp, ptp, isis, crtp, crudp, sctp, * - udp/tcp wildcard

 

dscp

Syntax 
dscp dscp-name
no dscp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6>entry>match
Description 

This command configures DSCP match conditions.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no dscp

Parameters 
dscp-name—
Specifies the DSCP name up to 32 characters in length

dst-ip

Syntax 
dst-ip {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask}
no dst-ip
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the destination IP match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no dst-ip

Parameters 
ip-address/mask—
Specifies the IPv4 address and mask
Values—

ip-address

a.b.c.d

mask

0 to 32

 

ipv6-address/prefix-length—
Specifies the IPv6 address and length (applies only to the 7750 SR)
Values—

ipv6-address

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (where x is [0 to FFFFH])

:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d (where d is [0 to 255]D)

 

prefix-length—
Specifies the prefix length (applies only to the 7750 SR)
Values—
1 to 128

 

netmask—
Specifies a string of 0s and 1s that mask or screen out the network part of an IP address so that only the host computer part of the address remains
Values—
a.b.c.d

 

dst-port

Syntax 
dst-port {lt | gt | eq} dst-port-number
dst-port range start end
no dst-port
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the destination port match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no dst-port

Parameters 
lt | gt | eq
Specifies the operator
dst-port-number—
Specifies the destination port number as a decimal hex or binary
Values—
0 to 65535

 

fragment

Syntax 
fragment {true | false}
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the fragmentation match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no fragment

Parameters 
true —
Enables fragmentation matching
false—
Disables fragmentation matching

icmp-code

Syntax 
icmp-code icmp-code
no icmp-code
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the ICMP code match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no icmp-code

Parameters 
icmp-code—
Specifies the ICMP code numbers accepted in DHB
Values—
0 to 255

 

icmp-type

Syntax 
icmp-type icmp-type
no icmp-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the ICMP type match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no icmp-type

Parameters 
icmp-type—
Specifies the ICMP type numbers accepted in DHB
Values—
0 to 255

 

ip-option

Syntax 
ip-option ip-option-value [ip-option-mask]
no ip-option
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the IP option match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ip-option

Parameters 
ip-option-value—
Specifies the IP option value as a decimal hex or binary
Values—
0 to 255

 

ip-option-mask—
Specifies the IP option mask as a decimal hex or binary
Values—
0 to 255

 

multiple-option

Syntax 
multiple-option {true | false}
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the multiple-option match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no multiple-option

Parameters 
true —
Enables checking the number of IP options in the IP header
false—
Disables checking the number of IP options in the IP header

option-present

Syntax 
option-present {true | false}
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the option-present match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no option-present

Parameters 
true —
Enables checking for the presence of IP options in the IP header
false—
Disables checking for the presence of IP options in the IP header

src-ip

Syntax 
src-ip {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask}
no src-ip
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the source IP match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no src-ip

Parameters 
ip-address/mask—
Specifies the IPv4 address and mask
Values—
ip-address a.b.c.d mask 0 to 32

 

netmask—
Specifies the mask, expressed as a dotted quad
Values—
a.b.c.d

 

ipv6-address/prefix-length—
Specifies the IPv6 address and length (applies only to the 7750 SR)
Values—

ipv6-address

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (where x is [0 to FFFFH])

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d (where d is [0 to 255]D)

 

prefix-length—
Specifies the prefix length (applies only to the 7750 SR)
Values—
1 to 128

 

src-port

Syntax 
src-port {lt | gt | eq} src-port-number
src-port range start end
no src-port
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the source port match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no src-port

Parameters 
lt | gt | eq—
Specifies the operators.
src-port-number—
Specifies the source port number as a decimal hex or binary.
Values—
0 to 65535

 

dst-port-number—
Specifies the destination port number as a decimal hex or binary.
Values—
0 to 65535

 

tcp-ack

Syntax 
tcp-ack {true | false}
no tcp-ack
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the TCP ACK match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no tcp-ack

Parameters 
true—
Enables checking for the ACK bit
false—
Disables checking for the ACK bit

tcp-syn

Syntax 
tcp-syn {true | false}
no tcp-syn
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>ingr-ipv6>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ip>entry>match
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>exh-lvl>egr-ipv6>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the TCP SYN match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
true—
Enables checking for the SYN bit
false—
Disables checking for the SYN bit

pir

Syntax 
pir pir-rate
pir max
no pir
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category>svc-lvl
Description 

This command configures the PIR which will be enforced for all queues pertaining to this category.

Default 

no pir

Parameters 
pir-rate—
Specifies the amount of bandwidth in kilobits per second (thousand bits per second).
Values—
1 to 40000000

 

max—
Specifies to use the maximum amount of bandwidth.

out-of-credit-action-override

Syntax 
out-of-credit-action-override {continue | block-category | change-service-level}
no out-of-credit-action-override
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category
Description 

This command specifies the action to be taken if the credit is exhausted.

Default 

no out-of-credit-action-override

Parameters 
continue—
Specifies to continue when running out of credit.
block-category—
Specifies to block the category when running out of credit.
change-service-level—
Specifies to change the service level when running out of credit.

policer

Syntax 
policer policer-id {ingress-only | egress-only | ingress-egress}
no policer policer-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category
Description 

This command configures a policer in this category.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policer-id—
Specifies an existing policer identifier.
Values—
1 to 63

 

ingress-only—
Specifies that ingress policers are defined in this category
egress-only—
Specifies that egress policers are defined in this category
ingress-egress—
Specifies that ingress and egress policers are defined in this category

queue

Syntax 
queue queue-id {ingress-only | egress-only | ingress-egress}
no queue queue-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category
Description 

This command configures a queue in this category.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
queue-id—
Specifies the queue ID for this instances. Each queue nominated in the category map is monitored for activity (over a period of approximately 60 seconds), should the activity fall below the threshold value then a time is started. Whenever this timer exceeds the configured timeout under the idle-timeout the action (currently disconnect) is executed for that subscriber and all hosts under that given SLA-profile-instance.
Values—
1 to 32

 

ingress-only—
Specifies that ingress queues are defined in this category
egress-only—
Specifies that egress queues are defined in this category
ingress-egress—
Specifies that ingress and egress queues are defined in this category

rating-group

Syntax 
rating-group rating-group-id
no rating-group
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map>category
Description 

This command configures the rating group applicable for this category.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no rating group

Parameters 
rating-group-id—
Specifies the rating group applicable for this category.

credit-exhaust-threshold

Syntax 
credit-exhaust-threshold threshold-percentage
no credit-exhaust-threshold
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map
Description 

This command specifies the credit exhaust threshold taken into account to take action.

The no form of the command reverts the configured value to the default.

Default 

100

Parameters 
threshold-percentage—
Specifies the percentage to use for the credit exhaust threshold
Values—
50 to 100

 

credit-type

Syntax 
credit-type {volume | time}
no credit-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map
Description 

This command specifies whether volume or time based accounting is performed.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

volume

Parameters 
volume—
Specifies volume-based accounting
time—
Specifies time-based accounting

gx-session-level-usage

Syntax 
[no] gx-session-level-usage
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>cat-map
Description 

This command controls the instantiation of an internal category required for Diameter Gx session level Usage Monitoring (per IP-CAN session).

When configured, Gx session level Usage Monitoring can be enabled for sessions associated with this category map.

The internal category for Gx session level Usage Monitoring is counted against the maximum of sixteen categories that can be configured.

When not configured (default), then no internal category is instantiated and Gx session level Usage Monitoring cannot be enabled for sessions associated with this category map.

Default 

no gx-session-level-usage

9.25.2.1.5.2. Diameter Commands

diameter-peer-policy

Syntax 
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name [role {client | proxy}] [create]
no diameter-peer-policy
Context 
config>aaa
Description 

This command creates a base diameter policy with up to 5 peers. There is a (TCP) connection created to each peer while only two peers can be active (used by applications) simultaneously. Various diameter applications can reference this policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
peer-policy-name—
Specifies the name of the policy that is created.
client—
Specifies that diameter is configured as client. The client initiate peering connections towards the server or Diameter proxy. Various applications such as Gx, Gy or NASREQ are layered directly on top of the Diameter client.
proxy—
Specifies that diameter is configured as proxy. Diameter proxy is used to provide multi-chassis redundancy and it can assumes active or standby state. The proxy relays messages between the Diameter client on one side and the server on the other side.
create—
Specifies the keyword used to create the diameter-peer-policy. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

diameter-application-policy

Syntax 
diameter-application-policy application-policy-name [create]
no diameter-application-policy application-policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context do create and configure diameter application policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
application-policy-name—
Specifies the name of the diameter policy up to 32 characters in length
create—
Specifies the keyword used to create the diameter-application-policy. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

diameter-peer-policy

Syntax 
diameter-peer-policy referenced-policy-name
no diameter-peer-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-app-plcy
Description 

This command is used by an application (DCCA, Gx, policy-management application, and so on) to reference a base diameter peer policy that the application will use.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no diameter-peer-policy

Parameters 
referenced-policy-name—
Specifies the name of the referenced policy

applications

Syntax 
applications {[gx] [gy] [nasreq]}
no application
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command specifies which applications are advertised in the Capability Exchange Request (CER) messages sent on the peers.

Applications that can be configured on a Diameter peer policy:

  1. client and proxy role:
    1. gx
    2. nasreq
    3. gx nasreq
  2. client role only:
    1. gy
Note:

Gx and nasreq applications can be enabled simultaneously on a single diameter peer.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
gx —
Specifies that Gx application support is advertised in CER.
gy —
Specifies that Gy (DCCA) application support is advertised in CER.
nasreq—
Specifies that NASREQ application support is advertised in CER.

application

Syntax 
application {gx | gy | nasreq}
no application
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the Diameter application for which this policy contains the configuration details, such as AVPs to include and their format.

Applications are mutually exclusive.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no application

Parameters 
gx—
Specifies that Gx is the supported application of this DIAMETER policy
gy —
Specifies that Gy is the supported application of this DIAMETER policy
nasreq—
.Specifies that NASREQ is the supported application of this DIAMETER policy

connection-timer

Syntax 
[no] connection-timer connection-time
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
Description 

This command defines the frequency of attempts to open a TCP connection to each peer that is configured in the diameter-peer-policy. Once a TCP connection fails to be established (transaction-timer expires at sending TCP SYN) or an existing TCP connection fails, the next attempt to open the connection will be tried upon the expiry of the connection-timer. There is no limit on the number of attempts.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

30

Parameters 
connection-time—
Specifies the amount of time, in seconds, for the diameter peer policy connection
Values—
1 to 1000

 

ipv6-source-address

Syntax 
ipv6-source-address ipv6-address
no ipv6-source-address
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command configures the IPv6 source address for all diameter messages sent to IPv6-reachable peers.

When no IPv6 source address is specified, then the source address is determined by:

  1. router = “management”; use the active management port IP address as configured in the Boot Options File (BOF): bof address ipv6-prefix/ipv6-prefix-length
  2. router = “Base” or VPRN service ID; use the system interface IP address: configure router interface “system” ipv6 address ipv6-address/prefix-length

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ipv6-source-address

Parameters 
ipv6-address—
Specifies the source IPv6 address to use for outgoing diameter messages to an IPv6-reachable peer
Values—

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

 

origin-host

Syntax 
origin-host origin-host-string
no origin-host
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command configures the origin-realm AVP that will be sent in CER messages and all application based messages. Together with the Origin-Host AVP, these two AVPs form a Diameter Identity.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no origin-host

Parameters 
origin-host-string—
Specifies the Origin-Host AVP (Attribute Value Pair) used by this policy up to 80 characters in length

origin-realm

Syntax 
origin-realm origin-realm-string
no origin-realm
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
Description 

This command configures the origin-realm AVP that will be sent in CER messages and all application based messages. Together with the Origin-Host AVP, these two AVPs form a Diameter Identity.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no origin-realm

Parameters 
origin-realm-string—
Specifies the origin-realm AVP (Attribute Value Pair) used by this policy. up to 80 characters in length

peer

Syntax 
peer name [create]
no peer name
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure diameter peer parameters. Up to five diameter peers can be defined inside of a diameter peer policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the peer name, up to of 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword used to create the peer. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

address

Syntax 
address ip-address
no address
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
Description 

This command configures the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the diameter peer.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no address

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the diameter peer
Values—

ipv4-address:

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

 

destination-host

Syntax 
destination-host destination-host-string
no destination-host
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
Description 

This command configures the destination-host AVP that will be sent in CCR-i/u and RAA messages. If the destination-host is not explicitly set via configuration, it will be learned from CCA or RAR messages. In other words, the origin-host received in the CCA or RAR message will be used to populate or replace the destination-host for the DCAA or GX session in the router.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no destination-host

Parameters 
destination-host-string—
Specifies the destination host name up 80 characters in length

preference

Syntax 
preference preference
no preference
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
Description 

This command configured preference per peer. Only the two peers with the highest preference in the peer table are considered for use (primary and secondary). Other peers can be the Open state and they just run keepalives (watchdog-request/answer messages). Once the primary peer fails, the secondary peer will be used as long as the last transaction on it has succeeded (stickiness). Another peer in the Open state will become secondary.Load balancing between peers is not supported.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

50

Parameters 
preference—
Specifies the preference of this diameter policy peer
Values—
1 to 100

 

transaction-timer

Syntax 
transaction-timer seconds
no transaction-timer
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
Description 

This command defines the time-out value for the Base Diameter messages (DWR, CER, DPR). Once the transaction-timer expires, an appropriate action will be taken for each message type.

This timer is used in the following cases:

  1. Opening the TCP connection (and completing the 3-way handshake) - if the TCP ACK is not received within the time specified by the transaction-timer, the TCP connection is closed and the connection-timer is started waiting for the new connection to be initiated.
  2. Capability Exchange – If the response to the CER message (CEA) is not received within the time specified by the transaction-timer, the peer connection is closed and the connection-timer is started waiting for the new connection to be initiated.
  3. Peer disconnect Request- If the response to the DPR message is not received (DPA) within the time specified by the transaction-timer, the peer connection is closed.
  4. DWR Timeout - If the response to the DWR message is not received (DWA) within the time specified by the transaction-timer, the peer connection is NOT closed. Instead the peer will transition into a peer suspended mode and at the same time the watchdog timer is restarted.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no transaction-timer

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the policy peer transaction timer, in seconds
Values—
1 to 1000

 

transport

Syntax 
transport tcp port port
no transport
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
Description 

This command defines source tcp port of the connection channel. Only TCP transport is currently supported

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

3868

Parameters 
port—
Specifies the transport protocol port number used toward this policy peer
Values—
1 to 65535

 

destination-realm

Syntax 
destination-realm destination-realm-string
no destination-realm
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
Description 

This command configures the destination-realm AVP that will be sent in CCR-i/u and RAA messages. The Destination-Realm cannot be learned dynamically from the CCA or RAR messages and therefore it should be explicitly configured in the router. Once configured, it cannot be changed while peers are open.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no destination-realm

Parameters 
destination-realm-string—
Specifies the destination realm name, up to 80 displayable characters

watchdog-timer

Syntax 
watchdog-timer seconds
no watchdog-timer
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
Description 

This command configures the interval between consecutive watchdog messages. On the first timeout of the DWR, the node will resend the DWR message. The peer is still operation during this time.

On the second timeout, the peer will transition into a suspended mode and the peer-failover procedure will be initiated (if the peer-failover is enabled via configuration). In this state the peer is not used for new transactions. At the same time, the cool down procedure is started which means that it would take 3 successful DWR/DWA message exchanges to re-instate the peer in a fully operation state.

On the third timeout, the peer is removed and its connection is closed.

This behavior is described in RFC 3539, §3.4.1)

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no watchdog-timer

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the device watchdog timer in seconds used by this policy peer
Values—
1 to 1000

 

proxy

Syntax 
proxy
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure the diameter peer policy proxy.

mcs-peer

Syntax 
mcs-peer ip-address sync-tag name
no mcs-peer
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>proxy
Description 

This command configures multi-chassis synchronization (MCS) peer (redundant node). The sync-tag identifies Diameter proxies that will participate in synchronization.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no mcs-peer

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the MCS peer
name—
Specifies the sync tag name up to 32 characters in length. The name must match on both nodes for the pair of redundant diameter proxies.

router

Syntax 
router router-instance address ip-address
no router
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>proxy
Description 

This command configures the IPv4 or IPv6 address and routing context on which the diameter proxy is listening for the client connections.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no router

Parameters 
router-instance—
Specifies the routing context in which diameter proxy is configured
ip-address—
Specifies the IPv4 or IPv6 address to which the diameter proxy is listening.
Values—

ipv4-address:

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

 

python-policy

Syntax 
python-policy [policy-name]
no python-policy
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command specified the python-policy for Diameter messages received or transmitted on the diameter peers defined in the diameter-peer-policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the Python policy, up to 32 characters in length.

router

Syntax 
router router-instance
router service service-name
no router
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command references the routing instance from which diameter peering is instantiated.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
router-instance—
Specify one of the following parameters for the router instance

router-name — Specifies a router name up to 32 characters to be used in the match criteria

Values—
Base, management

 

Default—
Base
service-id — Specifies an existing service ID to be used in the match criteria
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

service-name service-name—
Specifies an existing service name up to 64 characters in length

source-address

Syntax 
source-address ip-address
no source-address
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command configures the IPv4 source-address that the node will use for peering connections.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no source-address

Parameters 
ip-address —
Specifies IP prefix for the IP match criterion in dotted decimal notation
Values—
0.0.0.0 to 255.255.255.255

 

vendor-support

Syntax 
vendor-support [three-gpp | vodafone]
no vendor-support
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

In a diameter peer policy, this command specifies the vendor support announced in the capability exchange. In a Gy diameter application policy, this command specifies the vendor specific attributes for the user sessions.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

three-gpp

Parameters 
three-gpp—
Specifies the 3GPP diameter policy vendor type
vodafone—
Specifies the vodafone diameter policy vendor type

extended-failure-handling

Syntax 
extended-failure-handling
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Extended Failure Handling (EFH), a mechanism to establish a new Diameter Gy session with the Online Charging Server (OCS) after Credit Control Failure Handling (CCFH) CONTINUE is triggered.

interim-credit

Syntax 
interim-credit
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>efh
Description 

This command enters the context to configure interim credit parameters for Extended Failure Handling (EFH).

max-attempts

Syntax 
max-attempts count
max-attempts infinite
no max-attempts
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>efh>interim-c
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of attempts made to establish a new Diameter Gy session with the Online Charging Server (OCS) when Extended Failure Handling (EFH) is active.

A new attempt is made when the volume or time interim credit of a rating group is consumed or when the validity time expires for a rating group.

When the maximum number of attempts is reached, the user session associated with the Diameter session is terminated (the corresponding subscriber hosts are deleted from the system).

The no form of this command resets the value to the default value.

Default 

10

Parameters 
count —
Specifies the maximum number attempts that will be made to establish a Diameter Gy session with the OCS when EFH is active
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

infinite —
Specifies that an unlimited number of attempts will be made to establish a Diameter Gy session with the OCS when EFH is active

reporting

Syntax 
[no] reporting
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>efh>interim-c
Description 

This command enables reporting of the used interim credit for each rating group when a new Diameter Gy session is successfully established with the Online Charging Server (OCS). When enabled, the used interim credit report includes:

  1. the unreported used credit assigned via the initial Diameter Gy session when Extended Failure Handling (EFH) became active
  2. the used interim credits during EFH
  3. the used credits assigned via the new established Diameter Gy session

The no form of this command disables interim credit reporting. Only credit assigned via the new established Diameter Gy session is reported.

Default 

no reporting

validity-time

Syntax 
validity-time seconds
no validity-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>efh>interim-c
Description 

This command configures the validity time for the interim credit allocated to rating groups of a Diameter Gy session when Extended Failure Handling (EFH) is active. When either the allocated interim credit is consumed or the validity time expires, a new attempt is made to establish a Diameter Gy session with the Online Charging Server (OCS).The validity time applies to all interim credit allocated via the config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy application-policy-name>gy>extended-failure-handling>interim-credit>volume and config>subscr -mgmt>category-map category-map-name>category category-name>default-credit CLI commands.

A validity time value of 0 (zero) disables the validity time for the assigned interim credit.

The no form of this command resets the value to the default value.

Default 

1800

Parameters 
seconds —
Specifies the validity time, in seconds, applicable to the interim credit
Values—
0 to 4294967295

 

volume

Syntax 
volume credits {bytes | kilobytes | megabytes | gigabytes}
no volume
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>efh>interim-c
Description 

This command configures the default volume interim credit that is allocated to all rating groups of a Diameter Gy session when Extended Failure Handling (EFH) is active and for which no default credit is configured at the category map category level.

The no version of this command resets the value to the default value.

Default 

500 megabytes

Parameters 
credits—
Specifies the amount of volume credit that is allocated by default to all rating groups of a Diameter Gy session when EFH is active
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

bytes | kilobytes | megabytes | gigabytes—
Specifies whether credits are in bytes, kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes

new-session-id

Syntax 
[no] new-session-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>efh
Description 

This command determines the Diameter session ID when Extended Failure Handling (EFH) is active and an attempt is made to establish a new Diameter Gy session with the Online Charging Server (OCS). An attempt to establish a new Diameter Gy session is made when the allocated interim credit is used or the validity time expires for a rating group of a Diameter Gy session. The first attempt always uses a new Diameter session ID. This command controls the behavior for each subsequent attempt. The behavior is as follows:

  1. no new-session-id (default) — The same Diameter session ID is used for each subsequent attempt.
  2. new-session-id — A new Diameter session ID is used for each attempt.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no new-session-id

shutdown

Syntax 
[no] shutdown
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>efh
Description 

This command enables or disables Extended Failure Handling (EFH) for Diameter Gy sessions established using this Diameter application policy.

no shutdown — enables EFH for Diameter Gy sessions established using this Diameter application policy

shutdown — disables EFH for Diameter Gy sessions established using this Diameter application policy

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

shutdown

include-avp

Syntax 
[no] include-avp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq
Description 

This command enters the context to configure AVPs and their format to be included in Diameter Gx, Gy or NASREQ application messages.

an-gw-address

Syntax 
[no] an-gw-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
Description 

This command configures the IPv4 address of the node.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no an-gw-address

called-station-id

Syntax 
[no] called-station-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq>include-avp
Description 

This command configures the MAC address of AP in WiFi.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no called-station-id

calling-station-id

Syntax 
calling-station-id [type {llid | mac | remote-id | sap-id | sap-string}]
no calling-station-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the calling-station-id AVP in the specified format.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no calling-station-id

Parameters 
type—
Specifies the format of the Calling-Station-ID AVP.
Values—
llid — The LLID (logical link identifier) is the mapping from a physical to logical identification of a subscriber line and supplied by a RADIUS llid-server
mac — Specifies that the mac-address will be sent
remote-id — Specifies that the remote-id will be sent
sap-id — Specifies that the sap-id will be sent
sap-string — Specifies that the value is the inserted value set at the SAP level. If no calling-station-id value is set at the SAP level, the calling-station-id attribute will not be sent.

 

circuit-id

Syntax 
[no] circuit-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the Agent-Circuit-Id AVP.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no circuit-id

ip-can-type

Syntax 
[no] ip-can-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the ip-can-type.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ip-can-type

logical-access-id

Syntax 
[no] logical-access-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the logical-access-id.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no logical-access-id

nas-port

Syntax 
nas-port binary-spec
no nas-port
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq>include-avp
Description 

This command specifies the format of the 32 bit string used as value for the Nas-Port AVP.

Default 

no nas-port

Parameters 
binary-spec—
Specifies the NAS-Port AVP format
Values—

binary-spec

<bit-specification> <binary-spec>

bit-specification

0 | 1 | <bit-origin>

bit-origin

*<number-of-bits><origin>

number-of-bits

1 to 32

origin

s | m | p | o | i | v | c

s

- slot number

m

- MDA number

p

- port number or lag-id

o

- outer VLAN ID

i

- inner VLAN ID

v

- ATM VPI

c

- ATM VCI

 

nas-port-id

Syntax 
nas-port-id [prefix-type {none | user-string}] [prefix-string prefix-string] [suffix-type {circuit-id | none | remote-id | user-string}] [suffix-string suffix-string]
no nas-port-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the Nas-Port-Id AVP.

Default 

no nas-port-id

Parameters 
pr efix-type—
Specifies what type of prefix will be added to the NAS-Port-Id attribute if included in Nas-Port-Id AVP messages
Values—
none — No prefix is added
user-string — Specifies the user configurable string to be added as prefix to the NAS-Port-Id attribute if included in DIAMETER Gx messages

 

prefix-string
Specifies the user configurable string up to 8 characters in length, to be added as a prefix
suffix-type}
Specifies the suffix to be added to the NAS-Port attribute NAS-Port AVP
Values—
one — No suffix is added
circuit-id — the circuit-id is added as suffix-string
remote-id — the remote-id is added as suffix-string
user-string — a user configurable suffix-string is added

 

suffix-string—
Specifies the string up to 64 characters in length to be added as suffix

nas-port-type

Syntax 
nas-port-type
nas-port-type [type]
no nas-port-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the Nas-Port-Type AVP.

Default 

no nas-port-type

Parameters 
none—
Specifies values as defined in RFC 2865, Remote Authentication Dial In User Service (RADIUS), and RFC 4603, Additional Values for the NAS-Port-Type Attribute
type—
Specifies the integer value for the Nas-Port-Type AVP
Values—
0 to 255

 

remote-id

Syntax 
[no] remote-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq>include-avp
Description 

This command enables the generation of the agent-remote-id for RADIUS.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no remote-id

physical-access-id

Syntax 
[no] physical-access-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the physical access ID.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no physical-access-id

rat-type

Syntax 
[no] rat-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the RAT type.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no rat-type

supported-features

Syntax 
[no] supported-features
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the supported-features in CCR messages.

The no form of the command resets the command to the default setting.

Default 

no supported-features

user-equipment-info

Syntax 
user-equipment-info [type ue-info-type]
no user-equipment-info
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the user-equipment-info in CCR messages.

The no form of the command resets the command to the default setting.

Default 

mac

Parameters 
ue-into-type—
Specifies what is included in the Diameter User-Equipment-Info attribute if included in Diameter Gx messages.
Values—
eui64, imeisv, mac, modified-eui64

 

mac-format

Syntax 
mac-format mac-format
no mac-format
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>nasreq
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy
Description 

This command configures the format of the MAC address when reported in Gx, Gy, or NASREQ application message AVPs such as Calling-Station-Id or User-Name.

The no form of the command resets the command to the default setting.

Default 

ab

Parameters 
mac-format—
Specifies the MAC address format.
Values—
like ab: for 00:0c:f1:99:85:b8
or XY- for 00-0C-F1-99-85-B8
or mmmm. for 0002.03aa.abff
or xx for 000cf19985b8

 

report-ip-address-event

Syntax 
[no] report-ip-address-event
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx
Description 

This command enables triggered CCR-u messages based on IP address allocation/de-allocation for the subscriber host.

If the requests for both IP address families (IPv4 and IPv6) arrive at approximately the same time, a single CCR-i is sent containing the IP addresses from both address families, IPv4 and IPv6 (NA, PD, or SLAAC). When the requests for IP addresses are not nearly simultaneous, the CCR-i contains only the IP address that was allocated first (the one that triggered the session creation). The request for the second IP address family, depending on configuration, triggers an additional CCR-u that will carry the IP address allocation update to the PCRF along with the UE_IP_ADDRESS_ALLOCATE (18) event. The CCR-u content mirrors the content of the CCR-i with the exception of already allocated IP address(es).

When this command is disabled, IP address-triggered CCR-u messages are not sent.

The no form of the command disables the command.

Default 

report-ip-address-event

3gpp-ggsn-address

Syntax 
[no] 3gpp-ggsn-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the 3GPP GGSN Address AVP in the Diameter Gy messages. The value is set to the source IPv4 address that is used for outgoing diameter messages.

The no form of the command disables the command.

Default 

3gpp-ggsn-address

3gpp-ggsn-ipv6-address

Syntax 
3gpp-ggsn-ipv6-address
no 3gpp-ggsn-ipv6-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the 3GPP GGSN IPv6 Address AVP in the Diameter Gy messages. It's value is set to the source IPv6 address that is used for outgoing diameter messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no 3gpp-ggsn-ipv6-address

3gpp-charging-characteristics

Syntax 
[no] 3gpp-charging-characteristics
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the 3GPP-Charging-Characteristics AVP in all Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

The no version of this command removes the 3GPP-Charging-Characteristics AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

Default 

3gpp-charging-characteristics

3gpp-charging-id

Syntax 
3gpp-charging-id {auto | esm-info | id}
no 3gpp-charging-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the 3GPP-Charging-Id AVP in all Diameter DCCA CCR messages. The value can be configured to contain a unique 32-bit identifier or ESM information.

The no version of this command removes the 3GPP-Charging-Id AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

Default 

3gpp-charging-id auto

Parameters 
auto—
When the vendor support is 3GPP, this parameter specifies the AVP value for the subscriber-id, sap-id, and sla-profile. The default parameter value selected is auto.
esm-info—
Specifies the AVP value to subscriber-id, sap-id, and sla-profile.
id—
Specifies the AVP value asa unique 32-bit identifier per Diameter Gy session.

3gpp-gprs-negotiated-qos-profile

Syntax 
[no] 3gpp-gprs-negotiated-qos-profile
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the 3GPP-GPRS-QoS-Negotiated-Profile AVP in all Diameter DCCA CCR messages. The value is the active SLA profile.

The no version of this command removes the 3GPP-GPRS-QoS-Negotiated-Profile AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

Default 

3gpp-gprs-negotiated-qos-profile

3gpp-imsi

Syntax 
3gpp-imsi {circuit-id | imsi | subscriber-id}
no 3gpp-imsi
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the 3GPP-IMSI AVP in all Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

The no form of the command removes the 3GPP-IMSI AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

Default 

3gpp-imsi subscriber-id

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit-id as DCCA IMSI AVP value.
subscriber-id —
Specifies the subscriber-id as DCCA IMSI AVP value.
imsi —
Specifies the IMSI as DCCA IMSI AVP value.

3gpp-nsapi

Syntax 
[no] 3gpp-nsapi
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the 3GPP-NSAPI AVP in all Diameter DCCA CCR messages. The 3gpp-nsapi avp value is created from a semi-colon separated concatenation of the system name, service ID, and SAP ID of the subscriber host or session.

The no version of this command removes the 3GPP-NSAPI AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

Default 

3gpp-nsapi

3gpp-rat-type

Syntax 
3gpp-rat-type value
no 3gpp-rat-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the 3GPP-RAT-Type AVP with the specified value in all Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

The no version of this command removes the 3GPP-RAT-Type AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

Default 

no 3gpp-rat-type

Parameters 
value—
Specifies the 3GPP-RAT-Type AVP value to be included in Diameter DCCA CCR messages.
Values—
1 to 255

 

3gpp-selection-mode

Syntax 
[no] 3gpp-selection-mode
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the 3GPP-Selection-Mode AVP in all Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

The no version of this command removes the 3GPP-Selection-Mode AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

Default 

3gpp-selection-mode

3gpp-session-stop-indicator

Syntax 
[no] 3gpp-session-stop-indicator
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the 3GPP-Session-Stop-Indicator AVP in all Diameter DCCA CCR-Terminate messages.

The no version of this command removes the 3GPP-Session-Stop-Indicator AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR-Terminate messages.

Default 

3gpp-session-stop-indicator

address-avp

Syntax 
[no] address-avp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the following subscriber host/session address/prefix AVPs in all Diameter DCCA CCR messages:

  1. [8] Framed-IP-Address
  2. [97] Framed-IPv6-Prefix
  3. [123] Delegated-IPv6-Prefix
  4. [6527-99] Alc-IPv6-Address

Note: Only the address/prefix of the subscriber host that triggered the creation of the Diameter Gy session is included.

The no version of this command removes the address AVP's from the Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

Default 

address-avp

charging-rule-base-name

Syntax 
charging-rule-base-name category-map-name
charging-rule-base-name string
no charging-rule-base-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the Charging-Rule-Base-Name AVP with the specified value in all Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

The no version of this command removes the Charging-Rule-Base-Name AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

Default 

charging-rule-base-name

Parameters 
category-map-name—
This keyword specifies the name of the category-map in use.
string—
Specifies a string of up to 64 characters.

ggsn-address

Syntax 
ggsn-address {ipv4 | ipv6}
no ggsn-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

The command includes the GGSN-Address AVP value in all Diameter DCCA CCR messages. The value is either the local IPv4 address or local IPv6 address used to set up the diameter peer.

The no version of this command removes the GGSN-Address AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR messages.

Default 

no ggsn-address

Parameters 
ipv4 | ipv6
Specifies to include either the Pv4 or IPv6 address.

pdp-context-type

Syntax 
[no] pdp-context-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the [3GPP-1247] PDP-Context-Type AVP in Diameter DCCA CCR-Initial messages.

The no version of this command removes the PDP-Context-Type AVP from the Diameter DCCA CCR-Initial messages.

Default 

pdp-context-type

ps-information

Syntax 
[no] ps-information
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>avp
Description 

This command includes the following AVPs in Diameter DCCA CCR messages encapsulated in [3GPP-873] Service-Information or [3GPP-874] PS-Information grouped AVPs:

  1. [8] Framed-IP-Address
  2. [30] Called-Station-Id
  3. [97] Framed-IPv6-Prefix
  4. [123] Delegated-IPv6-Prefix
  5. [6527-99] Alc-IPv6-Address
  6. [10415-1] 3GPP-IMSI
  7. [10415-2] 3GPP-Charging-Id
  8. [10415-5] 3GPP-GPRS-Negotiated-QoS-Profile
  9. [10415-7] 3GPP-GGSN-Address
  10. [10415-10] GGSN-NSAPI
  11. [10415-11] 3GPP-Session-Stop-Indicator
  12. [10415-12] 3GPP-Selection-Mode
  13. [10415-13] 3GPP-Charging-Characteristics
  14. [10415-16] 3GPP-GGSN-IPv6-Address
  15. [10415-21] 3GPP-RAT-Type
  16. [10415-847] GGSN-Address
  17. [10415-1004] Charging-Rule-Base-Name
  18. [10415-1247] PDP-Context-Type

The AVPs are included when configured in the include-avp context.

By default, these AVPs are included at the command level.

The no version of this command resets to the default setting.

Default 

no ps-information

called-station-id

Syntax 
called-station-id [64 chars max]
no called-station-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>include-avp
Description 

This command configures the value of the called station ID AVP.

The no form of the command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no called-station-id

Parameters 
64 chars max—
Specifies the called station ID up to 64 characters in length.

radius-user-name

Syntax 
[no] radius-user-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>include-avp
Description 

This command includes the RADIUS user name AVP in the Diameter Gy messages.

The no form of the command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no radius-user-name

service-context-id

Syntax 
service-context-id name
no service-context-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy>include-avp
Description 

This command configures the value of the service context ID AVP.

The no form of the command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no service-context-id

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the service context ID AVP value up to 32 characters in length.

transaction-timer

Syntax 
[no] transaction-timer transaction-timer
Context 
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy
config>aaa>diam-peer-plcy>peer
Description 

This command defines the timeout value for the Base Diameter messages (DWR, CER, DPR). Once the transaction-timer expires, an appropriate action will be taken for each message type.

This timer is used in the following cases.

  1. Opening the TCP connection (and completing the three-way handshake). If the TCP ACK is not received within the time specified by the transaction-timer, the TCP connection is closed and the connection timer is started waiting for the new connection to be initiated.
  2. Capability Exchange — If the response to the CER message (CEA) is not received within the time specified by the transaction-timer, the peer connection is closed and the connection timer is started waiting for the new connection to be initiated.
  3. Peer disconnect Request — If the response to the DPR message is not received (DPA) within the time specified by the transaction-timer, the peer connection is closed.
  4. DWR Timeout — If the response to the DWR message is not received (DWA) within the time specified by the transaction-timer, the peer connection is not closed. Instead the peer will transition into a peer suspended mode and at the same time the watchdog timer is restarted.

The no form of the command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

30 seconds at diameter-base level

The default value at peer is taken from diameter-base.

Parameters 
transaction-timer—
Specifies the Diameter peer policy transaction timer, in seconds
Values—
1 to 1000

 

Default—
30 seconds at diameter-base level of the CLI
The default value in the peer context is taken from diameter-base

gx

Syntax 
gx
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Gx parameters.

gy

Syntax 
gy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Diameter Credit Control Application or Gy-specific options.

nasreq

Syntax 
nasreq
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure NASREQ application-specific attributes.

avp-subscription-id

Syntax 
avp-subscription-id origin [type type]
no avp-subscription-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy
Description 

This command is used to provide identification information to the PCRF/OCS for the end user.

Subscription-Id is a grouped AVP. If no data is available for the specified origin, then the Subscription-Id AVP will not be sent (Gx) or the subscriber-Id is used as origin instead (Gy).

The no form of the command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

avp-subscription-id subscriber-id type private

Parameters 
origin—
Specifies the origin of the information to send in the Subscription-Id data AVP
Values—
circuit-id — he circuit ID. For Gy, the circuit id is an ASCII- converted value.
dual-stack-remote-id — Specifies the remote ID for IPv4 and IPv6. The enterprise-id field is stripped off from IPv6 remote ID. For Gy, the remote id is an ascii-converted value.
imei — Specifies the physical ID of the end device.
imsi — Specifies the SIM ID.
mac — Specifies the MAC address of the end device.
msisdn — Specifies the phone number of the end device.
nas-port-id — Specifies the NAS port ID which can be a prefix or suffix with a custom string to make it unique network wide.
subscriber-id — Specifies the subscriber ID.
username — Specifies that the username identifier can be of type private or nai which specifies the username is a PPP username (PAP/CHAP). When the PPP username is not available, the string in the Username attribute returned by RADIUS or NASREQ is used.

 

type—
Specifies the type of the identifier stored in the Subscription-Id data AVP
Values—
e164 — Specifies the identifier is in international E.164 format (such as MSISDN)
imsi — Specifies the identifier is in international IMSI format according to the ITU-T E.212 numbering plan
nai — Specifies the identifier is in the form of a Network Access Identifier as defined in RFC 2486
private — Specifies the identifier is a private type identifier

 

ccrt-replay-interval

Syntax 
ccrt-replay-interval interval
no ccrt-replay-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gx
Description 

This command enables sending CCR-t messages for a given Gx session until a valid response (CCA-t) is received or until a 24h period expires, whichever comes first. The purpose of replaying CCR-t message is to ensure that the Gx session is cleared on the PCRF side in case that the peering session to the PCRF was not available at the time when the initial and the first retransmitted CCR-t was sent.

In case that a valid CCA-t response is not received, the system will continue to replay CCR-t messages at configurable interval for the duration of 24 hours.

The subscriber-host behind the Gx session that is in CCR-t replay mode is terminated at the time when the initial CCR-t is sent. This means that all resources associated with the subscriber (queues, DHCP lease states, PPPoE states, and so on) are freed. What is left behind in the node is an orphaned Gx session in a replay mode trying to clear itself on the PCRF side.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no ccrt-replay-interval

Parameters 
interval
Specifies the interval at which the CCR-t messages are replayed for a givenGx session. The messages will be replayed until a valid CCA-t response is received or until a 24h period expires, whichever comes first.
Values—
60 to 86400

 

out-of-credit-reporting

Syntax 
out-of-credit-reporting {final | quota-exhausted}
no out-of-credit-reporting
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy>gy
Description 

This command changes the reporting reason in an intermediate interrogation when the final granted units have been consumed and a corresponding out-of-credit-action different from disconnect-host is started.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

out-of-credit-reporting final

Parameters 
final—
Specifies the reporting reason in an intermediate interrogation when the final granted units have been consumed and a corresponding out-of-credit-action different from disconnect-host is started
quota-exhausted—
Specifies the reporting reason in an intermediate interrogation when the final granted units have been consumed and a corresponding out-of-credit-action different from disconnect-host is started

on-failure

Syntax 
on-failure [failover {enabled | disabled}] [handling {continue | retry-and-terminate | terminate}]
no on-failure
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-appl-plcy
Description 

This command configures session failure handling. Behavior of the application’s session in case of a peer failure can be controlled by the Diameter server through two AVPs carried in CCA messages that are defined in RFC4006:

  1. CC-Session-Failover AVP
    1. FAILOVER_NOT_SUPPORTED
    2. FAILOVER_SUPPORTED
  2. Credit-Control-Failure-Handling AVP
    1. TERMINATE
    2. CONTINUE
    3. RETRY_AND_TERMINATE

In case that those AVPs are not provided by the Diameter server, the local configuration provided by this command will take effect. This command defines the following:

  1. Peer-failover behavior to a secondary peer if that the primary peer is unresponsive. The primary peer is considered unresponsive in case that the application message sent to it, times out. The failover mechanism defined by this command is only applicable to CCR messages (and not to RAA messages since there is no response expected).The time out of the message is determined by the tx-timer command.
    The peer-failover action based on the message timeout is defined per session. For example, a message timeout for one session cannot cause the failover for another other session.
    The maximum number of transmissions per session is hardcoded to 2 and the same message is never re-transmitted to the same TCP socket (a TCP socket is defined as a current peering connection defined by the TCP source/destination IP addresses/ports; closing and then reopening a connection to the same peer will result in creation of a new TCP socket). Once the original message for the session times out on the primary peer, the message will be re-transmitted to the secondary peer, provided that the secondary peer is available and the failover is enabled with the corresponding handling mechanism. In case that the secondary peer is unavailable, the original message will not be re-transmitted to the same primary peer again.
    Once the reply from a peer is received, the session will be tied to that peer until the next timeout. In other words, the session always sticks to the peer from which it received the last response.
  2. Handling behavior in case that the response from the peer is not received or the peers are not available at all (all peering connections are closed). This behavior is applicable to CCR-i messages in Gx and CCR-i/u messages in Gy. In case of Gx, if the response to a session initiation message (CCR-i) is not received, the fate of the session will depend on the configuration (the session can be terminated or continue to exist with default parameters).
    The no form of the command reverts to the default value.
Default 

on-failure failover enabled handling terminate

Parameters 
failover enabled—
Specifies that the session is allowed to switch to the secondary peer
failover disabled—
Specifies that the session is not allowed to switch to the secondary peer
handling continue—
Specifies that the sessions will continue to exist if the response to a transmitted CCR message is not received. Whether the transmitted message will be re-transmitted depends on the failover configuration. In case of session initiation procedure in the Gx case (CCR-i timeout), the subscriber host will be instantiated with the default parameters, assuming that they are provided. In the default parameter are not provided, the subscriber host initiation will fail.
handling retry-and-terminate—
Specifies that the message will be re-transmitted in case that the peer-failover is enabled and the secondary peer is available. Once the retransmitted message (CCR-i in Gx; CCR-i/u in Gy) is timed-out, the application session will be terminated.
handling terminate—
Specifies that the session will be terminated if the response to the original message (CCR-I in Gx; CCR-i/u in Gy) is not received. No re-transmissions will be attempted, regardless of whether the failover is enabled or not.

tx-timer

Syntax 
tx-timer seconds
no tx-timer
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>diam-app-plcy
Description 

This command defines the time-out period for the application’s CCR-i/u messages that are waiting for a reply from a peer (message is in a pending state). Peer-failover behavior determines the action that will be taken once the message times out. Peer-failover behavior can be dictated by the PCRF or can be locally configured in the router.

Per RFC 4006, sec 13, Diameter Credit-Control Application, Credit-Control Application Related Parameters, When real-time credit-control is required, the credit-control client contacts the credit-control server before and while the service is provided to an end user. Due to the real-time nature of the application, the communication delays SHOULD be minimized; e.g., to avoid an overly long service setup time experienced by the end user. The Tx timer is introduced to control the waiting time in the client in the Pending state. When the Tx timer elapses, the credit-control client takes an action to the end user according to the value of the Credit-Control-Failure-Handling AVP or Direct-Debiting-Failure-Handling AVP. The recommended value is 10 seconds.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

10

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the Tx Timer value (in seconds) for this policy
Values—
10 to 1000

 

diameter-application-policy

Syntax 
diameter-application-policy policy-name
no diameter-application-policy
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe>host
config>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ppp>host
Description 

This command associates the specified diameter-application-policy with the processing of the host attachment requests.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

none

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the diameter policy up to 32 characters in length

9.25.2.1.5.3. Filter Commands

filter

Syntax 
filter
Context 
configure
Description 

This command enters the context to configure filters.

copy

Syntax 
copy {ip-filter | mac-filter | ipv6-filter} src-filter-id [src-entry src-entry-id] to dst-filter-id [dst-entry dst-entry-id] [overwrite]
Context 
config>filter
Description 

This command copies filters and its entries.

Parameters 
src-filter-id—
Specifies the source filter ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

src-entry-id—
Specifies the source entry ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

dst-filter-id—
Specifies the destination filter ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

dst-entry-id—
Specifies the destination entry ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

overwrite—
Specifies to overwrite the existing filter

dhcp6-filter

Syntax 
dhcp6-filter filter-id [create]
no dhcp6-filter filter-id
Context 
config>filter
Description 

This command configures the DHCPv6 filter to either bypass ESM host creation or drop DHCPv6 relay-reply messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no dhcpv6-filter

Parameters 
filter-id—
Specifies the filter ID.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

create—
Keyword used to create the DHCPv6 filter. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context. This parameter only applies to the 7750 SR.

default-action

Syntax 
default-action bypass-host-creation [na] [pd]
default-action drop
no default-action
Context 
config>filter>dhcp6-filter
Description 

This command specifies the default action when no entries match.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no default-action

Parameters 
bypass-host-creation—
Specifies to bypass ESM host creation options
Values—
na — Bypasses the DHCP NA hosts creation
pd — Bypasses the DHCP PD hosts creation

 

drop—
Specifies to drop and not process the DHCP6 message

entry

Syntax 
entry entry-id [create]
no entry entry-id
Context 
config>filter>dhcp6-filter
Description 

This command configures a DHCPv6 filter entry.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

none

Parameters 
entry-id—
Specifies the entry ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

create—
Specifies the keyword used to create the DHCPv6 filter. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context. This parameter only applies to the 7750 SR.

action

Syntax 
action bypass-host-creation [na] [pd]
action drop
no action
Context 
config>filter>dhcp6-filter>entry
Description 

This command configures an action for the DHCP6 filter entry.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no action

Parameters 
bypass-host-creation—
Bypasses ESM host creation options
Values—
na — Bypasses the DHCP NA hosts creation
pd — Bypasses the DHCP PD hosts creation

 

drop—
Specifies to drop and not process the DHCP6 message

option

Syntax 
option dhcp6-option-number {present | absent}
option dhcp6-option-number match hex hex-string [exact] [invert-match]
option dhcp6-option-number match string ascii-string [exact] [invert-match]
no option
Context 
config>filter>dhcp6-filter>entry
Description 

This command configures the DHCPv6 option to match.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no option

Parameters 
present—
Specifies the number of the DHCP6 option to filter on. The present keyword specifies that the DHCP6 option must be present.
absent—
Specifies the number of the DHCP6 option to filter on. The absent keyword specifies that the DHCP6 option must be absent.
match hex hex-string
Specifies to match the Hex string
match string ascii-string
Specifies to match the ASCII string
exact—
Specifies that an exact match is required
invert-match—
Requires the option not to (partially) match

ip-filter

Syntax 
ip-filter filter-id [create]
no ip-filter filter-id
Context 
config>filter
Description 

This command enters the context to configure an IP filter.

The no form of the command removes the filter ID from the configuration.

Default 

none

Parameters 
filter-id—
Specifies the filter ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

create—
Keyword used to create the IP filter. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

ipv6-filter

Syntax 
ipv6-filter ipv6-filter-id [create]
no ipv6-filter ipv6-filter-id
Context 
config>filter
Description 

This command enters the context to configure an IPv6 filter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

none

Parameters 
filter-id—
Specifies the filter ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

create—
Keyword used to create the IPv6 filter. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

default-action

Syntax 
default-action {drop | forward}
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
Description 

This command configures default-action for the IP or IPv6 filter.

Parameters 
drop—
Specifies to drop packets matching the filter entry
forward—
Specifies to forward packets matching the filter entry

entry

Syntax 
entry entry-id [create]
no entry entry-id
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
Description 

This command configures an IP or IPv6 filter entry.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

none

Parameters 
entry-id—
Specifies the entry ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

create—
Keyword used to create the entry. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

action

Syntax 
action {drop | forward}
no action
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry
Description 

This command configures actions for the IP or IPv6 filter entry.

Parameters 
drop
Specifies to drop packets matching the filter entries
forward—
Specifies to forward packets matching the filter entry

tcp-mss-adjust

Syntax 
tcp-mss-adjust
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry>action
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry>action
Description 

This command configures the Maximum Segment Size (MSS) adjustment for TCP packets.

log

Syntax 
log log-id
no log
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry
Description 

This command configures the log for the IP or IPv6 filter entry.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no log

Parameters 
log-id—
Specifies the log ID
Values—
101 to 199

 

match

Syntax 
match [protocol protocol-id]
no match
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry
Description 

This command configures the match criteria mat the IP or IPv6 filter entry.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

none

Parameters 
protocol-id—
Specifies the protocol numbers accepted in DHB.
Values—
1 to 42, | 45 to 49, 52 to 29, 61 to 255

 

Values—
none, crtp, crudp, egp, eigrp, encap, ether-i p, gre, icmp, idrp, igmp, igp, ip, ipv6, ipv6-icmp, ipv6-no-nxt, isis, iso-ip, l2tp, ospf-igp, pim, pnni, ptp, rdp, rsvp, stp, tcp, udp, vrrp * udp/tcp wildcard

 

dscp

Syntax 
[no] dscp
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry>match
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry>match
Description 

This command configures DSCP match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no dscp

dst-ip

Syntax 
[no] dst-ip
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry>match
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the destination IP or IPv6 address match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no dst-ip

dst-port

Syntax 
[no] dst-port
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry>match
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the destination port match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no dst-port

icmp-code

Syntax 
[no] icmp-code
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry>match
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the ICMP code match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no icmp-code

icmp-type

Syntax 
[no] icmp-type
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry>match
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the ICMP type match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no icmp-type

src-ip

Syntax 
[no] src-ip
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry>match
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the source IP or IPv6 address match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no src-ip

src-port

Syntax 
[no] src-port
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry>match
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the source port match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no src-port

tcp-ack

Syntax 
[no] tcp-ack
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry>match
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the TCP ACK match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no tcp-ack

tcp-syn

Syntax 
[no] tcp-syn
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter>entry>match
config>filter>ipv6-filter>entry>match
Description 

This command configures the TCP SYN match condition.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no tcp-syn

group-inserted-entries

Syntax 
group-inserted-entries application application location location
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
Description 

This command groups auto-inserted entries.

Default 

none

Parameters 
application—
Specifies for which application the inserted entries must be grouped
Values—
radius, credit-control

 

location—
Specifies at what location the inserted entries must be grouped
Values—
top, bottom

 

renum

Syntax 
renum old-entry-id new-entry-id
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
Description 

This command renumbers an IP or IPv6 filter entry.

Default 

none

Parameters 
old-entry-id—
Specifies the old entry ID to be renumbered
Values—
1 to 65535

 

new-entry-id—
Specifies the new entry ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

scope

Syntax 
scope {exclusive | template | embedded | system}
no scope
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
Description 

This command determines some aspects of an item's behavior regarding creation and use, unused entry garbage collection, and automated promulgation by Element Management System to other systems in the service domain.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

template

Parameters 
exclusive
Specifies that the item can only be applied once, for example to a single SAP. Attempting to assign the policy to a second SAP is not allowed and will result in an error. If the item is removed from the exclusive SAP, it will become available for assignment to another exclusive SAP.

A non-applied exclusive scope policy is a candidate to be removed from the system by a TBD garbage collection command.

The system default policies cannot be put into the exclusive scope. An error will be generated if scope exclusive is executed in any policies with a policy-id equal to 1.

template —
Specifies that the item can be applied any number of times. Policies with template scope will not be considered for deletion by a TBD garbage collection command; all items of scope template must be deleted explicitly.

The system default policies will always be scope template. An error will occur if a policy-id 1 is attempted to be set to scope exclusive.

embedded—
Specifies that the filter may be embedded in other non-embedded filters. An embedded filter may not be applied anywhere in the system. Attempting to set scope to embedded for a filter which is already applied will be rejected by the system.
system —
Specifies that the filter policy can be used as a common system filter policy only. The policy cannot be applied directly anywhere in the system. In order to activate the policy it must be configured as the active system filter policy in tFilterSystemFilterTable.

All other exclusive and template IP / IPv6 filter policies can be chained to the active system policy by setting the tIPFilterChainToSystemFilter or tIPv6FilterChainToSystemFilter object to 'true(1)'.

When an IP or IPv6 filter policy is chained to the system filter policy, the system filter policy's rules are executed first before any rules of the activating filter policy are executed.

The scope of a filter policy can be set to or from this value only when the policy does not contain any entry.

shared-radius-filter-wmark

Syntax 
shared-radius-filter-wmark low low-watermark high high-watermark
no shared-radius-filter-wmark
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
Description 

This command defines the thresholds that will be used to raise a respective alarm when the number of shared filter copies increases.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no shared-radius-filter-wmark

Parameters 
low-watermark—
Specifies the number of RADIUS Filters that are still dynamically created in the system before an high watermark notification is cleared by the system
Values—
0 — 8000

 

high-watermark—
Specifies the number of RADIUS Shared Filters that can be dynamically created in the system before an high watermark notification is generated by the system
Values—
1 — 8000

 

sub-insert-credit-control

Syntax 
sub-insert-credit-control start-entry entry-id count count
no sub-insert-credit-control
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
Description 

This command defines the range of filter entries that will be reserved for entries created based on information (match criteria and action) configured under the category-map configuration tree to enforce reduced-service level in case of credit exhaustion.

The no form of the command disables the insertion, which means that entries will not be installed even though the credit for the given category and subscriber-host has been exhausted.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

per default insertion is disabled

Parameters 
entry-id—
Specifies an integer defining the lowest entry of the range
Values—
1 to 65535

 

count—
Specifies an integer defining the number of entries in the range
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-insert-radius

Syntax 
sub-insert-radius start-entry entry-id count count
no sub-insert-radius
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
Description 

This command defines the range of filter entries which will be reserved for entries created based on information (match criteria and action) from RADIUS auth-response messages.

The no form of the command disables the insertion. This means that information from auth-response messages cannot be stored in the filter, and the corresponding host will not be created in the system.

Default 

per default insertion is disabled

Parameters 
entry-id—
Specifies an integer defining the lowest entry of the range
Values—
1 to 65535

 

count—
Specifies integer defining the number of entries in the range
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-insert-shared-radius

Syntax 
sub-insert-shared-radius start-entry entry-id count count
no sub-insert-shared-radius
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
Description 

This command defines the range of filter entries that will be reserved for shared filter entries received in RADIUS messages.

The no form of this command disables the insertion resulting in a host setup failure when shared filter attributes are received in a RADIUS authentication response.

Default 

no sub-insert-shared-radius

Parameters 
entry-id—
Specifies the lowest entry of the range
Values—
1 to 65535

 

count—
Specifies the number of entries in the range
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-insert-wmark

Syntax 
sub-insert-wmark [low percentage] [high percentage]
no sub-insert-wmark
Context 
config>filter>ip-filter
config>filter>ipv6-filter
Description 

This command defines the thresholds that will be used to raise a respective alarm to provide monitoring of the resources for subscriber-specific filter insertion.

The no form of this command sets the default values for the respective thresholds.

Default 

low - 90%

high - 95%

Parameters 
percentage—
Defines in percentage the threshold used to raise an alarm.
Values—
1 to 100, integer

 

9.25.2.1.6. IGMP Policy Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

igmp-policy

Syntax 
igmp-policy policy-name [create]
no igmp-policy
Context 
config>sub-mgmt
Description 

This command configures an IGMP policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

none

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the policy name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword used to create the IGMP policy. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

disable-router-alert-check

Syntax 
[no] disable-router-alert-check
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command disables router alert checking for IGMP messages received on this interface.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no disable-router-alert-check

egress-rate-modify

Syntax 
egress-rate-modify [egress-rate-limit | scheduler scheduler-name]
no egress-rate-modify
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command is used to apply HQoS Adjustment to a subscriber. HQoS Adjustment is needed when multicast traffic flow for the subscriber is dissociated from subscriber host queues. Multicast redirection is typical such case although it can be applied in direct IPoE subscriber per-sap replication mode.

The channel bandwidth definition policy is defined in the mcac policy under the config>router>mcac>policy hierarchy. The policy is applied under the redirected interface or under the group-interface.

In order for HQoS Adjustment to take effect, sub-mcac-policy must be in a no shutdown mode and applied under the sub-profile even if mcac is not deployed.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no egress-rate-modify

Parameters 
egress-rate-limit—
Specifies the egress rate modification to be applied. The subscriber’s bandwidth is capped via the aggregate-rate-limit command in the sub-profile or via a Change of Authorization (CoA) request. This bandwidth cap will be dynamically adjusted according to the multicast channel definition and channel association with the host via IGMP.
scheduler-name
Specifies the schedule name. The subscriber’s bandwidth is capped via the scheduling-policy in the sub-profile or via a Change of Authorization (CoA) request . HQoS Adjustment will modify the rate of the scheduler defined in the scheduling policy or configured via CoA.

import

Syntax 
import policy-name
no import
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command specifies the import policy to filter IGMP packets.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no import

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the policy name up to 32 characters in length

max-num-groups

Syntax 
max-num-groups max-num-groups
no max-num-groups
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of multicast groups.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no max-num-groups

Parameters 
max-num-groups—
Specifies the maximum number of multicast groups
Values—
0 to 16000

 

max-num-sources

Syntax 
max-num-sources max-num-sources
no max-num-sources
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of multicast sources.

The no form of the command disables the command.

Default 

no max-num-sources

Parameters 
max-num-sources—
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources
Values—
1 to 1000

 

max-num-grp-sources

Syntax 
max-num-grp-sources [max-num-grp-sources]
no max-num-grp-sources
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy
config>sub-mgmt>msap-policy>igmp-host-tracking
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of group sources for which IGMP can have local receiver information based on received IGMP reports on this interface. When this configuration is changed dynamically to a value lower than currently accepted number of group sources, the group sources that are already accepted are not deleted. Only new group sources will not be allowed. When this object has a value of 0, there is no limit to the number of group sources.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no max-num-grp-sources

Parameters 
max-num-grp-sources
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowed to be tracked per group
Values—
1 to 32000

 

mcast-reporting

Syntax 
[no] mcast-reporting
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure mcast reporting.

mcast-reporting-dest

Syntax 
mcast-reporting-dest dest-name
no mcast-reporting-dest
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>igmp-policy>mcast-reporting
config>subscr-mgmt>host-tracking-policy>mcast-reporting
Description 

This command references the multicast reporting destination to which IGMP related events are exported.

The multicast reporting destination is referenced with the subscriber itself or within the Host-Tracking-Policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no mcast-reporting-dest

Parameters 
dest-name—
Specifies the name of the multicast reporting destination up to 32 characters in length

opt-reporting-fields

Syntax 
opt-reporting-fields [host-mac] [pppoe-session-id] [svc-id] [sap-id]
no opt-reporting-fields
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>igmp-policy>mcast-reporting
config>subscr-mgmt>host-tracking-policy>mcast-reporting
Description 

This command specifies optional data relevant to the IGMP event that can be exported. This optional data includes:

  1. Host MAC address
  2. PPPoE session-ID
  3. Service ID
  4. SAP

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no opt-reporting-fields

Parameters 
host-mac—
Specifies that the host-mac optional field should be included into the multicast reporting messages
pppoe-session-id—
Specifies that the pppoe-session-id optional field should be included into the multicast reporting messages
svc-id—
Specifies that the svc-id optional field should be included into the multicast reporting messages
sap-id—
Specifies that the sap-id optional field should be included into the multicast reporting messages

query-interval

Syntax 
query-interval seconds
no query-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command specifies the frequency at which the querier router transmits general host-query messages. Host-query messages solicit group membership information and are sent to the all-systems multicast group address, 224.0.0.1. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>igmp context or in the config>service>vprn>igmp context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each IGMP policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no query-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the frequency, in seconds, at which the router transmits general host-query messages
Values—
2 to 1024

 

query-last-member-interval

Syntax 
query-last-member-interval seconds
no query-last-member-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command configures the frequency at which the querier router sends group-specific query messages, including the messages sent in response to leave-group messages. The shorter the interval, the faster a loss of the last member of a group can be detected. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-last-member-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>igmp context or the config>service>vprn>igmp context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each IGMP policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no query-last-member-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the frequency, in seconds, at which query messages are sent
Values—
1 to 1024

 

query-response-interval

Syntax 
query-response-interval seconds
no query-response-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command configures the query response interval. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-response-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>igmp context or in the config>service>vprn>igmp context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each IGMP policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no query-response-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the length of time, in seconds, that the querier router waits to receive a response to from the host
Values—
1 to 1023

 

sub-mcac-policy

Syntax 
sub-mcac-policy policy-name
no sub-mcac-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates a policy template with mcac bandwidth limits that will be applied to the subscriber.

Per interface mcac bandwidth limits will be set directly under the interface (regular interface or group-interface) and no such policy templates are needed.

The need for a separate policy template for subscribers is due to the fact that sub-groups of subscribers under the group-interface can share certain settings that can be configured via templates.

To summarize, the mcac bandwidth constraints for subscribers are defined in the sub-mcac-policy while the mcac bandwidth constraints for the interface are configured directly under the igmp>interface>mcac or igmp>grp-if>mcac context without the need for policy templates.

Note:

The sub-mcac-policy only deals with the mcac bandwidth limits and not the channel bandwidth definitions. Channels bandwidth is defined in a different policy (under the config>router>mcac hierarchy) and that policy is applied on the interface level as follows:

In case of HQoS Adjustment, it is mandatory that the sub-mcac-policy be created and applied to the subscriber. The sub-mac-policy does not have to contain any bandwidth constrains, but it has to be in a no shutdown state in order for HQoS Adjustment to work.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no sub-mcac-policy

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the policy up to 32 characters in length

sub-mcac-policy

Syntax 
sub-mcac-policy policy-name
no sub-mcac-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile
Description 

This command enters the context to configure sub MCAC policy parameters. The policy template in which the MCAC bandwidth limits are defined. MCAC for the subscriber is effectively enabled with this command when the sub-profile is applied to the subscriber. The bandwidth of the channels is defined in a different policy (under the config>router>mcac context) and this policy is applied on the interface level as follows:

  1. for regular interfaces in the config>service/router>igmp>interface>mcac context
  1. for HQoS adjustment, it is mandatory that the sub-mcac-policy be created and applied to the subscriber. The sub-mac-policy does not have to contain any bandwidth constrains, but it has to be in a no shutdown state in order for HQoS Adjustment to work.
Default 

none

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the policy name up to 32 characters in length

version

Syntax 
version version
no version
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command configures the version of IGMP.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

3

Parameters 
version—
Specifies the IGMP version
Values—
1, 2 or 3

 

fast-leave

Syntax 
[no] fast-leave
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command enables IGMP fast-leave processing.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

fast-leave

static

Syntax 
static
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IGMP static group membership parameters.

per-host-replication

Syntax 
per-host-replication [uni-mac | mcast-mac]
no per-host-replication
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command enables per-host-replication in IPoE model. For PPPoX, per-host-replication is the only mode of operation. In the per-host-replication mode, multicast traffic is replicated per each host within the subscriber irrespective of the fact that some hosts may be subscribed to the same multicast stream. As a result, in case that multiple hosts within the subscriber are registered for the same multicast group, the multicast streams of that group will be generated. The destination MAC address of multicast streams will be changed to unicast so that each host receives its own copy of the stream. Multicast traffic in the per-host-replication mode can be classified via the existing QoS CLI structure. As such the multicast traffic will flow through the subscriber queues. HQoS Adjustment is not needed in this case.

The alternative behavior for multicast replication in IPoE environment is per-SAP- replication. In this model, only a single copy of the multicast stream is sent per SAP, irrespective of the number of hosts that are subscribed to the same multicast group. This behavior applies to 1:1 connectivity model as well as on 1:N connectivity model (SAP centric behavior as opposed to subscriber centric behavior).

In the per-SAP-replication model the destination MAC address is multicast (as opposed to unicast in the per-host-replication model). Multicast traffic is flowing via the SAP queue which is outside of the subscriber context. The consequence is that multicast traffic is not accounted in the subscriber HQoS. In addition, HQoS Adaptation is not supported in the per SAP replication model.

Default 

no per-host-replication — By default there is no per host replication and replication is done per SAP. This mode utilizes the SAP queues. With per-host-replication it will allow the use of the subscriber queues. Per-host-replication uses unicast MAC and multicast IP to deliver multicast content to end hosts. This is useful for multi host per SAP cases. To interoperate with end devices that do not support unicast MAC, there is an option to use per-host-replication with a multicast MAC. The traffic will be the same as replication per SAP but the difference of using the subscriber queues.

Parameters 
uni-mac—
Specifies that multicast traffic is sent with a unicast MAC and multicast IP
mcast-mac—
Specifies that multicast traffic is sent with a multicast MAC and IP

redirection-policy

Syntax 
redirection-policy policy-name
no redirection-policy
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy
Description 

This command will apply multicast redirection action to the subscriber. The redirection action along with the redirected interface (and possibly service id) is defined in the referenced policy-name. IGMP messages will be redirected to an alternate interface if that alternate interface has IGMP enabled. The alternate interface does not have to have any multicast groups registered via IGMP. Currently all IGMP messages are redirected and there is no ability to selectively redirect IGMP messages based on match conditions (multicast-group address, source IP address, and so on). Multicast redirection is supported between VPRN services and also between interfaces within the Global Routing Context. Multicast Redirection is not supported between the VRPN services and the Global Routing Table (GRT).

IGMP state is maintained per subscriber host and per redirected interface. Traffic is however forwarded only on the redirected interface.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no redirection-policy

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the redirection policy to be applied to this host IGMP policy up to 32 characters in length. This is a policy defined in the config>router>policy-option>policy-statement context.

group

Syntax 
[no] group ip-address
Context 
config>sub-mgmt>igmp-policy>static
Description 

This command adds or removes a static multicast group.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

none

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the multicast group IP address
Values—
a.b.c.d

 

9.25.2.1.6.1. Host Lockout Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

host-key

Syntax 
host-key {mac}
no host-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>host-lockout-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the parameters used in host identification for lockout on a given SAP or capture SAP.

no host-key – include (MAC address, Circuit-Id, Remote-Id)

host-key mac – include MAC address only

“host-key mac” should be used in DHCPv4 scenarios where Circuit-Id and Remote-Id are changed with “dhcp option action replace” configuration: a host lockout context is created with the replaced Circuit-Id/Remote-Id; with the default host-key (including Circuit-Id and Remote-Id), lockout does not kick in on the original trigger packet when it is retransmitted by the client.

Changing the host-key to mac should be used with care: all hosts with the same MAC address on a given SAP or capture SAP are identified as a single host with respect to host-lockout.

This command cannot be changed when the host-lockout-policy is referenced (configured under a SAP context).

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no host-key

Parameters 
mac—
Specifies to use the MAC address only for host identification for lockout.

host-lockout-policy

Syntax 
host-lockout-policy policy-name [create]
no host-lockout-policy policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates a host lockout policy. The policy contains set of host lockout configuration parameters. It is applied to SAP or MSAPs (by a MSAP-policy). Any change does not impact existing locked-out hosts, but only new incoming hosts that enter lockout.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration. The policy must not be associated with any entity.

Default 

none

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies an existing host lockout policy to associate with the SAP
create—
Specifies the keyword required to create the host lockout policy. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

ies

Syntax 
ies service-id customer customer-id [vpn vpn-id] [create]
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command enters the context to configure or edit an Internet Enhanced Service (IES) service instance. The ies command is used to create or maintain an IES service. If the service ID does not exist, a context for the service is created. If the service ID exists, the context for editing the service is entered.

For further information about the vpls command usage, syntax and description, refer to the SR OS Layer 3 Services Guide.

vpls

Syntax 
vpls service-id customer customer-id [vpn vpn-id] [create]
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command enters the context to configure or edit a Virtual Private LAN Services (VPLS) instance. The vpls command is used to create or maintain a VPLS service. If the service ID does not exist, a context for the service is created. If the service-id exists, the context for editing the service is entered.

For further information about the vpls command usage, syntax and description, refer to the SR OS Layer 2 Services Guide.

The no form of the command removes the service ID from the configuration.

vprn

Syntax 
vprn service-id [customer customer-id] [create]
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command creates or edits a Virtual Private Routed Network (VPRN) service instance. The vprn command is used to create or maintain a VPRN service. If the service ID does not exist, a context for the service is created. If the service-id exists, the context for editing the service is entered.

The no form of the command removes the service ID from the configuration.

For further information about the vprn command usage, syntax and description, refer to the SR OS Layer 3 Services Guide.

interface

Syntax 
[no] interface ip-int-name
Context 
config>service>ies
config>service>vprn
Description 

This command creates a logical IP routing interface for an Layer 3 service. Once created, attributes like an IP address and service access point (SAP) can be associated with the IP interface.

The no form of the command removes the interface ID from the configuration.

For further information about the interface command usage, syntax and description, refer to the SR OS Layer 3 Services Guide.

Default 

none

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface. Interface names must be unique within the group of defined IP interfaces for config router interface and config service vprn interface commands. An interface name cannot be in the form of an IP address. Interface names can be from 1 to 32 alphanumeric characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

sap

Syntax 
[no] sap sap-id
Context 
config>service>ies
config>service>vprn
config>service>ies>if
config>service>vprn>if
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
Description 

This command creates a Service Access Point (SAP) within a service. A SAP is a combination of port and encapsulation parameters which identifies the service access point on the interface and within the router. Each SAP must be unique.

The no form of the command removes the SAP ID from the configuration.

For further information about the sap command usage, syntax and description, refer to the SR OS Layer 2 Services Guide and the SR OS Layer 3 Services Guide.

cflowd

Syntax 
cflowd {acl | interface}
Context 
config>service>ies>if
Description 

This command enables cflowd to collect traffic flow samples through a router for analysis. Cflowd is used for network planning and traffic engineering, capacity planning, security, application and user profiling, performance monitoring, usage-based billing, and SLA measurement. When cflowd is enabled at the interface level, all packets forwarded by the interface are subjected to analysis according to the cflowd configuration.

Default 

no cflowd

Parameters 
act—
Specifies to include the cflowd configuration associated with a filter.
interface—
Specifies to include the cflowd configuration associated with an interface.

host-lockout-policy

Syntax 
host-lockout-policy policy-name
no host-lockout-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>if>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>sap
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>sap
Description 

This command selects an existing host lockout policy. The host-lockout-policy policy-name is created in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the SAP configuration.

Default 

none

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies an existing host lockout policy, up to 32 characters in length, to associate with the SAP

lockout-time

Syntax 
lockout-time [min seconds] [max seconds]
no lockout-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>host-lockout-plcy
Description 

This command configures the time for which a client stays in the lockout state during which authentication and ESM host creation is suppressed.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

lockout-time min 10 max 3600

Parameters 
min seconds
Specifies the minimum lockout-time for this host lockout policy
Values—
1 to 86400

 

Default—
10 seconds
max seconds
Specifies the maximum lockout-time for this host lockout policy
Values—
1 to 86400

 

Default—
3600 seconds

lockout-reset-time

Syntax 
lockout-reset-time seconds
no lockout-reset-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>host-lockout-plcy
Description 

This command configures the time that needs to elapse from the point a client enters lockout to when the client’s lockout time can be reset to the configured minimum value. The range is 1 sec

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

60

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the lockout reset time, in seconds
Values—
1 to 86400

 

max-lockout-hosts

Syntax 
max-lockout-hosts hosts
no max-lockout-hosts
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>host-lockout-plcy
Description 

When a client enters lockout, authentication and ESM host creation is suppressed. A lightweight context maintains the lockout state and the timeouts for the client in lockout. This command allows the number of lockout contexts to be configured per SAP. If the number of existing contexts reaches the configured count, incoming hosts that fail authentication or creation are not subject to lockout, and are retired as normal.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

100

Parameters 
hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of lockout host
Values—
1 to 32000

 

host-tracking-policy

Syntax 
host-tracking-policy policy-name [create]
no host-tracking-policy policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command configures a host tracking policy. IGMP host tracking is an option in the subscriber profile that allows the factoring in of a subscriber’s (multicast) video traffic by reducing the unicast operational egress aggregate rate or the rate of the scheduler specified in the ANCP policy to account for a subscriber’s multicast traffic. If no ANCP policy is defined, the egress aggregate rate configured in the subscriber profile is reduced. If an ANCP policy is defined, the rate-modify command in the policy specifies whether the egress aggregate rate or the rate of the egress policer specified in the policy is to be reduced to account for the subscriber’s multicast traffic.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Parameters 
policy-name
Specifies a host tracking policy name up to 32 characters in length

egress-rate-modify

Syntax 
egress-rate-modify agg-rate-limit
egress-rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
no egress-rate-modify
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>trk-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the egress-rate modification that is to be applied.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no egress-rate-modify

Parameters 
agg-rate-limit—
Specifies to use the egress rate limit
scheduler-name
Specifies the scheduler name up to 32 characters in length

9.25.2.1.7. PIM Policy Commands

pim-policy

Syntax 
pim-policy pim-policy-name [create]
no pim-policy pim-policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates a PIM policy or enters the context to configure a PIM policy.

The no form of this command deletes the specified PIM policy.

Default 

none

Parameters 
pim-policy-name—
Specifies the PIM policy name up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes
create—
Specifies the keyword used to create the PIM policy. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

9.25.2.1.8. Router Advertisement Policy Commands

router-advertisement-policy

Syntax 
router-advertisement-policy name [create]
no router-advertisement-policy name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates a router advertisement policy or enters the context to configure a router advertisement policy. The keyword create is mandatory when creating a router advertisement policy the first time.

The no form of this command deletes the specified router advertisement policy.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the router advertisement policy name up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
create—
Specifies the keyword used to create the router advertisement policy. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

current-hop-limit

Syntax 
current-hop-limit limit
no current-hop-limit
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command configures the hop limit to be advertised.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

64

Parameters 
limit—
Specifies the default value to be placed in the current hop limit field in router advertisement policies sent.
Values—
0 to 255

 

dns-options

Syntax 
[no] dns-options
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IPv6 DNS options for SLAAC hosts.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no dns-options

include-dns

Syntax 
[no] include-dns
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>dns-opt
Description 

This command specifies to include the Recursive DNS Server (RDNSS) Option as defined in RFC 6106 in IPv6 router advertisements for DNS name resolution of IPv6 SLAAC hosts.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no include-dns

rdnss-lifetime

Syntax 
rdnss-lifetime seconds
rdnss-lifetime infinite
no rdnss-lifetime
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>dns-opt
Description 

This command configures the maximum time that the RDNSS address may be used for name resolution.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

3600

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the time, in seconds, that the RDNSS address is valid for this route.
Values—
900 to 3600

 

infinite—
Specifies that the RDNSS address can be used permanently.

force-mcast

Syntax 
force-mcast {ip | mac}
no force-mcast
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command configures the protocols with forced multicast, either IP or MAC.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no force-mcast

managed-configuration

Syntax 
[no] managed-configuration
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command sets or resets the managed address configuration flag.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no managed-configuration

max-advertisement

Syntax 
max-advertisement seconds
no max-advertisement
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the maximum time allowed between sending unsolicited router advertisements.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

1800

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the maximum advertisement interval, in seconds.
Values—
900 to 1800

 

min-advertisement

Syntax 
max-advertisement seconds
no max-advertisement
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the minimum time allowed between sending unsolicited router advertisements.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

900

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the minimum advertisement interval, in seconds.
Values—
900 to 1350

 

mtu

Syntax 
mtu bytes
no mtu
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command specifies the value to be placed in link MTU options sent by the router.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no mtu

Parameters 
bytes—
Sets the advertised MTU value, in bytes, for this interface.
Values—
1280 to 9212

 

other-stateful-configuration

Syntax 
[no] other-stateful-configuration
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command sets and resets the other-stateful-configuration flag.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no other-stateful-configuration

prefix-options

Syntax 
[no] prefix-options
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command enters the configuration of prefix options.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no prefix-options

stateful

Syntax 
[no] stateful
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>pfx-opt
Description 

This command enables the configuration of RA options for stateful DHCP prefix used by the subscriber host.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no stateful

stateless

Syntax 
[no] stateless
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>pfx-opt
Description 

This command enables the configuration of RA options for stateless SLAAC prefix used by the subscriber host.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

no stateless

on-link

Syntax 
[no] on-link
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>pfx-opt>stateful
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>pfx-opt>stateless
Description 

This command specifies whether the prefix is to be assigned to an interface on the specified link.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

on-link

preferred-lifetime

Syntax 
preferred-lifetime seconds
preferred-lifetime infinite
no preferred-lifetime
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>pfx-opt>stateful
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>pfx-opt>stateless
Description 

This command specifies the remaining time for this prefix to be preferred.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

3600

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the time, in seconds, for the prefix to remain preferred.
Values—
3600 to 86400

 

infinite—
Specifies that the remaining time never expires.

valid-lifetime

Syntax 
preferred-lifetime seconds
preferred-lifetime infinite
no preferred-lifetime
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>pfx-opt>stateful
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>pfx-opt>stateless
Description 

This command specifies the time for this prefix to remain valid.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

86400

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the time, in seconds, for the prefix to remain preferred.
Values—
3600 to 86400

 

infinite—
Specifies that the time never expires.

reachable-time

Syntax 
reachable-time milli-seconds
no reachable-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command configures the reachable time for advertisements.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

0

Parameters 
milli-seconds—
Specifies the time, in milliseconds, for the reachable time.
Values—
0 to 3600000

 

retransmit-time

Syntax 
retransmit-time milli-seconds
no retransmit-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy
Description 

This command configures the retransmit time for advertisements.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

0

Parameters 
milli-seconds—
Specifies the time, in milliseconds, for the retransmit time.
Values—
0 to 1800000

 

router-lifetime

Syntax 
router-lifetime seconds
router-lifetime no-default-router
no router-lifetime
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rtr-adv-plcy>
Description 

This command specifies the router lifetime.

The no form of this command returns the command to the default setting.

Default 

4500

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the time, in seconds, for the prefix to remain preferred.
Values—
2700 to 9000

 

no-default-router—
Specifies that the router is not to be used as a default router.

9.25.2.1.9. Managed SAP Policy Commands

msap-policy

Syntax 
msap-policy msap-policy-name [create]
no msap-policy msap-policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures a managed SAP policy. Managed SAPs allow the use of policies and a SAP template for the creation of a SAP.

The no form of the command removes the MSAP policy from the configuration.

Default 

none

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Specifies the managed SAP policy name up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
 
Values—

 

create—
Keyword used to create the managed SAP policy. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context.

cpu-protection

Syntax 
cpu-protection
Context 
config>sys>security
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command enters the context to configure CPU protection policies.

cpu-protection

Syntax 
cpu-protection policy-id [mac-monitoring]
no cpu-protection
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command assigns an existing CPU protection policy to the SAP or interface.

CPU protection policies are configured in the config>sys>security>cpu-protection context.

The no form of the command removes the policy ID from the SAP or interface configuration.

Default 

254

Parameters 
policy-id—
Specifies an existing CPU protection policy to assign to the SAP or interface
Values—
1 to 255

 

mac-monitoring—
Specifies that the per-source rate limit be applied

cpu-protection

Syntax 
cpu-protection policy-id
no cpu-protection
Context 
config>router>if
config>service>ies>if
config>service>vprn>if
Description 

This command assigns an existing CPU protection policy to the SAP or interface.

CPU protection policies are configured in the config>sys>security>cpu-protection context.

The no form of the command removes the policy ID from the SAP or interface configuration.

Default 

254

Parameters 
policy-id—
Specifies an existing CPU protection policy to assign to the SAP
Values—
1 to 255

 

default-host

Syntax 
default-host ip-address/mask next-hop next-hop-ip
no default-host
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command configures the default-host to be used. More than one default-host can be configured per SAP.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

none

Parameters 
ip-address/mask—
Assigns an IP address/IP subnet format to the interface
next-hop-ip
Assigns the next hop IP address

dist-cpu-protection

Syntax 
dist-cpu-protection policy-name
no dist-cpu-protection
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy
Description 

This command assigns a Distributed CPU Protection (DCP) policy to an MSAP policy. The DCP policy is automatically assigned to MSAPs created with this policy. A non-existent DCP policy can be assigned to an msap-policy because an MSAP policy is similar to a template that is applied in the MSAP creation. The DCP policy is validated at the time that the MSAP is created, and the MSAP creation is blocked (and an appropriate log event created) if the DCP policy does not exist.

Note:

For other types of objects (for example, normal non-MSAP SAPs and network interfaces) the DCP policy must exist before it can be assigned to the SAP.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

If no dist-cpu-protection policy is assigned to an MSAP policy, then the default access DCP policy (_default-access-policy) is used.

If no DCP functionality is required on the MSAP policy, then an empty DCP policy can be created and explicitly assigned to the MSAP policy.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the DCP policy up to 32 characters in length

ies-vprn-only-sap-parameters

Syntax 
ies-vprn-only-sap-parameters
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure managed SAP IES and VPRN properties. VPRN services are supported on the 7750 SR only.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>ies-vprn
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress policies for Managed SAPs (MSAPs).

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>ies-vprn
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress policies for Managed SAPs (MSAPs).

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id
qos policy-id [multipoint-shared | service-queuing]
qos policy-id [shared-queuing | service-queuing]
no qos
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>ies-vprn>egress
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>ies-vprn>ingress
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>egress
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>ingress
Description 

This command specifies the ingress or egress Quality of Service (QoS) policy that will be associated with a Managed SAP (MSAP). Only QoS policies with scope template can be associated with MSAPs.

The no version of this command resets the default value. The system default QoS policy is used in that case.

Default 

qos 1 — For egress parameters.

qos 1 multipoint-shared — For ingress vpls-only-sap-parameters.

qos 1 shared-queuing — For ingress ies-vprn-only-sap-parameters.

Parameters 
policy-id—
The QoS policy ID or name to associate with the MSAPs. The policy ID or name must already exist.
Values—
1 to 65535
Up to 64 characters maximum for policy name

 

multipoint-shared —
Ingress unicast MSAP queues are mapped one-for-one with hardware queues. Multipoint MSAP queues are not instantiated. Unicast and BUM packets traverse the ingress forwarding plane twice: in the first pass, both unicast and BUM traffic use the unicast MSAP queues, while in the second pass shared unicast and multipoint queues are used towards the egress line card. Multipoint-shared queuing greatly reduces ingress queue consumption. This keyword can only be specified for ingress vpls-only-sap-parameters.
shared-queuing—
Ingress unicast MSAP queues are mapped one-for-one with hardware queues. Unicast packets traverse the ingress forwarding plane twice: in the first pass the MSAP queues are used, while in the second pass shared queues are used towards the egress line card. Shared-queuing greatly reduces ingress queue consumption. This keyword can only be specified for ingress ies-vprn-only-sap-parameters.
service-queuing—
Ingress MSAP queues are mapped to multiple hardware queues, per egress line card destination. For scaled environments such as in subscriber management, this could lead to a high number of queue resources being used. Therefore, service-queuing for MSAP's should only be enabled for specific use cases. This keyword can only be specified for ingress parameters.

igmp-host-tracking

Syntax 
igmp-host-tracking
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IGMP host tracking parameters.

disable-router-alert-check

Syntax 
[no] disable-router-alert-check
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>igmp-host-tracking
Description 

This command enables the IGMP router alert check option.

The no form of the command disables the router alert check.

Default 

no disable-router-alert-check

expiry-time

Syntax 
expiry-time expiry-time
no expiry-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>igmp-host-tracking
Description 

This command configures the time that the system continues to track inactive hosts.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

no expiry-time

Parameters 
expiry-time—
Specifies the time, in seconds, that this system continues to track an inactive host
Values—
1 to 65535

 

import

Syntax 
import policy-name
no import
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>igmp-host-tracking
Description 

This command specifies the import routing policy to be used for IGMP packets to be used on this SAP or SDP. Only a single policy can be imported on a single SAP at any time.

The no form of the command removes the policy association from the SAP or SDP.

Default 

no import

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the routing policy name up to 32 characters in length

max-num-group

Syntax 
max-num-groups max-num-groups
no max-num-groups
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>igmp-host-tracking
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of multicast groups allowed to be tracked.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

no max-num-groups

Parameters 
max-num-groups—
Specifies the maximum number of multicast groups allowed to be tracked
Values—
1 to 196607

 

max-num-sources

Syntax 
max-num-sources max-num-sources
no max-num-sources
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>igmp-host-tracking
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of multicast sources allowed to be tracked per group.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
max-num-sources—
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowedto be tracked per group
Values—
1 to 1000

 

max-num-grp-sources

Syntax 
max-num-grp-sources [max-num-grp-sources]
no max-num-grp-sources
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>igmp-host-tracking
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of group sources for which IGMP can have local receiver information based on received IGMP reports on this interface. When this configuration is changed dynamically to a value lower than currently accepted number of group sources, the group sources that are already accepted are not deleted. Only new group sources will not be allowed. When this object has a value of 0, there is no limit to the number of group sources.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no max-num-grp-sources

Parameters 
max-num-grp-sources
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowed to be tracked per group
Values—
1 to 32000

 

lag-link-map-profile

Syntax 
lag-link-map-profile link-map-profile-id
no lag-link-map-profile
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy
Description 

This command assigns a pre-configured lag link map profile to a SAP/network interface configured on a LAG or a PW port that exists on a LAG. Once assigned/de-assigned, the SAP/network interface egress traffic will be re-hashed over LAG as required by the new configuration.

The no form of this command reverts the SAP/network interface to use per-flow, service or link hash as configured for the service/LAG.

Default 

no lag-link-map-profile

Parameters 
link-map-profile-id—
Defines a unique LAG link map profile on which the LAG the SAP/network interface exist
Default—
1 to 64

sticky

Syntax 
[no] sticky
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy
Description 

This command prevents MSAPs associated with the specified MSAP policy from being deleted unless a manual clear command is issued. If this command is not enabled, an MSAP is deleted when a host creation fails or when a subscriber is no longer associated with the MSAP, for example, when a subscriber ends the session. This feature is useful for an operator who wants to keep historical statistics records on MSAPs. It can also speed up host creation on an MSAP since the MSAP is already created.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no sticky

sub-sla-mgmt

Syntax 
[no] sub-sla-mgmt
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to configure subscriber management parameters for an MSAP.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no sub-sla-mgmt

def-app-profile

Syntax 
def-app-profile app-profile-name
no def-app-profile
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap-param>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap-param>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command specifies the application profile to be used by a subscriber host.

The no form of the command removes the application profile name from the configuration.

Default 

no def-app-profile

Parameters 
app-profile-name—
Specifies an existing application profile to be mapped to the subscriber profile by default up to 32 characters in length

def-inter-dest-id

Syntax 
def-inter-dest-id {string string | use-top-q}
no def-inter-dest-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command specifies a default destination string for all subscribers associated with the SAP. The command also accepts the use-top-q flag that automatically derives the string based on the top most delineating Dot1Q tag from the SAP’s encapsulation.

The no form of the command removes the default subscriber identification string from the configuration.

Default 

no def-inter-dest-id

Parameters 
use-top-q—
Derives the string based on the top most delineating Dot1Q tag from the SAP’s encapsulation
string
Specifies the subscriber identification applicable for a subscriber host up to 32 characters in length

def-sub-id

Syntax 
def-sub-id use-auto-id
def-sub-id use-sap-id
def-sub-id string sub-id
no def-sub-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap-param>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap-param>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command specifies the explicit default sub-id for dynamic subscriber hosts (including ARP hosts) in case that the sub-id string is not supplied through RADIUS or LUDB.

The sub-id is assigned to a new subscriber host in the following order of priority:

  1. RADIUS
  2. LUDB
  3. Explicit default – The def-sub-id command is used to explicitly set the sub-id name of the host as one of the following:
    1. The SAP ID to which the new host is associated
    2. An explicit string
    3. An auto-generated string consisting of the concatenated subscriber identification fields defined under the subscr-mgmt>auto-sub-id-key node. The fields are taken in the order in which they are configured and are separated by a ‘|‘character. The subscriber host identification fields are separately defined for IPoE and PPPoE host types.
  4. Implicit default – If the sub-id string is not returned via RADIUS or LUDB and there is no def-sub-id configured, the sub-id name will be generated as a random 10 character encoded string based on the auto-sub-id-keys. This 10 characters encoded string will be unique per chassis as well as in dual-homed environment. It is generated based on auto-sub-id-keys. If auto-sub-id-keys are not explicitly configured, the default ones are:
    1. mac, sap-id, or session-id for PPP type hosts
    2. mac or sap-id for IPoE type hosts.

This command does not apply to static subscribers.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
use-sap-id —
Specifies the sub-id name-id on which the original request for host creation arrived (DHCP Discover, or PADI or ARP Request)
sub-id
Explicitly configured sub-id name up to 32 characters in length
use-auto-id —
Specifies the concatenated string of auto-sub-id-keys separated by a “|” character.
Default—
no def-sub-id
Implicit default   If the sub-id string is not supplied through RADIUS, LUDB, or def-sub-id configuration, then a random 10 character encoded sub-id name will be generated. This random sub-id name will be based on the subscriber identification keys defined under the subscr-mgmt>auto-sub-id-key node. In case that the auto-sub-id-keys are not defined explicitly, the default ones are:
  1. mac, sap-id, or session-id for PPPoE type hosts
  2. mac or sap-id for IPoE type hosts

def-sla-profile

Syntax 
def-sla-profile default-sla-profile-name
no def-sla-profile
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command specifies a default SLA profile for an MSAP.

An SLA profile is a named group of QoS parameters used to define per service QoS for all subscriber hosts common to the same subscriber within a provider service offering. A single SLA profile may define the QoS parameters for multiple subscriber hosts.

The no form of the command removes the default SLA profile from the MSAP configuration.

Default 

no def-sla-profile

Parameters 
default-sla-profile-name—
Specifies a default SLA profile for an MSAP up to 32 characters in length

def-sub-profile

Syntax 
def-sub-profile default-subscriber-profile-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command specifies a default subscriber profile for an MSAP.

A subscriber profile defines the aggregate QoS for all hosts within a subscriber context. This is done through the definition of the egress and ingress scheduler policies that govern the aggregate SLA for subscriber using the subscriber profile.

The no form of the command removes the default SLA profile from the SAP configuration.

Parameters 
default-sub-profile—
Specifies a default subscriber profile for this SAP up to 32 characters in length

multi-sub-sap

Syntax 
multi-sub-sap [subscriber limit]
no multi-sub-sap
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command defines the maximum number of subscribers (dynamic + static) that can be simultaneously active on an MSAP.

If the limit is reached, a new host will be denied access and the corresponding DHCP ACK will be dropped.

The no form of the command reverts back to the default setting.

Default 

1

Parameters 
limit—
Specifies the maximum number of subscribers allowed
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071

 

single-sub-parameters

Syntax 
single-sub-parameters
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to configure single subscriber MSAP parameters.

non-sub-traffic

Syntax 
non-sub-traffic sub-profile sub-profile-name sla-profile sla-profile-name [subscriber sub-ident-string] [app-profile app-profile-name]
no non-sub-traffic
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt>single-sub
Description 

This command configures traffic profiles for non-IP traffic such as PPPoE.It is used in conjunction with the profiled-traffic-only on single subscriber SAPs and creates a subscriber host which is used to forward non-IP traffic through the single subscriber SAP without the need for SAP queues.

The no form of the command removes any configured profile.

Default 

no non-sub-traffic

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Identifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
sla-profile-name—
Identifies the SLA profile name up to 32 characters in length

profiled-traffic-only

Syntax 
[no] profiled-traffic-only
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt>single-sub
Description 

This command specifies whether only profiled traffic is applicable for an MSAP. When enabled, all queues will be deleted.

The no form of the command reverts to the default setting.

Default 

no profiled-traffic-only

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
[no] sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command specifies an existing subscriber identification policy. Each subscriber identification policy can have a default subscriber profile defined. The subscriber identification policy default subscriber profile overrides the system default and the subscriber SAP default subscriber profiles. Defining a subscriber identification policy default subscriber profile is optional.

Defining a subscriber profile as a subscriber identification policy default subscriber profile will cause all active subscribers currently associated with a subscriber SAP using the policy and associated with a subscriber policy through the system default or subscriber SAP default subscriber profiles to be reassigned to the subscriber policy defined as default on the subscriber identification policy.

Attempting to delete a subscriber profile that is currently defined as a default for a subscriber identification policy will fail.

When attempting to remove a subscriber identification policy default subscriber profile definition, the system will evaluate each active subscriber on all subscriber SAPs the subscriber identification policy is currently associated with that are using the default definition to determine whether the active subscriber can be either reassigned to a subscriber SAP default or the system default subscriber profile. If all active subscribers cannot be reassigned, the removal attempt will fail.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
sub-ident-policy-name—
Specifies the name of the subscriber identification policy up to 32 characters in length

vpls-only-sap-parameters

Syntax 
vpls-only-sap-parameters
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure MSAP VPLS properties.

arp-host

Syntax 
arp-host
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only
config>service>vpls>sap>arp-host
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ARP host parameters.

host-limit

Syntax 
host-limit max-num-hosts
no host-limit
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>arp-host
config>service>vpls>sap>arp-host
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>arp-host
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>arp-host
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of ARP hosts.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
max-num-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of ARP hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071

 

min-auth-interval

Syntax 
min-auth-interval min-auth-interval
no min-auth-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only
config>service>vpls>sap>arp-host
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>arp-host
Description 

This command configures the minimum authentication interval.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

15

Parameters 
min-auth-interval—
Specifies the minimum authentication interval
Values—
1 to 6000

 

sap-host-limit

Syntax 
sap-host-limit max-num-hosts-sap
no sap-host-limit
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>arp-host
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>arp-host
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of ARP hosts per SAP.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
max-num-hosts-sap—
Specifies the maximum number of ARP hosts per SAP allowed on this interface
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071

 

arp-reply-agent

Syntax 
arp-reply-agent [sub-ident]
no arp-reply-agent
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only
Description 

This command enables a special ARP response mechanism in the system for ARP requests destined to static or dynamic hosts associated with the SAP. The system responds to each ARP request using the hosts MAC address as the both the source MAC address in the Ethernet header and the target hardware address in the ARP header.

ARP replies and requests received on an MSAP with arp-reply-agent enabled will be evaluated by the system against the anti-spoof filter entries associated with the ingress SAP (if the SAP has anti-spoof filtering enabled). ARPs from unknown hosts on the SAP will be discarded when anti-spoof filtering is enabled.

The ARP reply agent only responds if the ARP request enters an interface (SAP, spoke-SDP or mesh-SDP) associated with the VPLS instance of the MSAP.

A received ARP request that is not in the ARP reply agent table is flooded to all forwarding interfaces of the VPLS capable of broadcast except the ingress interface while honoring split-horizon constraints.

Static hosts can be defined using the host command. Dynamic hosts are enabled on the system by enabling the lease-populate command in the dhcp context. In the event that both a static host and a dynamic host share the same IP and MAC address, the VPLS ARP reply agent will retain the host information until both the static and dynamic information are removed. In the event that both a static and dynamic host share the same IP address, but different MAC addresses, the VPLS ARP reply agent is populated with the static host information.

The arp-reply-agent command will fail if an existing static host does not have both MAC and IP addresses specified. Once the ARP reply agent is enabled, creating a static host on the MSAP without both an IP address and MAC address will fail.

The ARP-reply-agent may only be enabled on SAPs supporting Ethernet encapsulation.

The no form of the command disables ARP-reply-agent functions for static and dynamic hosts on the MSAP.

Default 

no arp-reply-agent

Parameters 
sub-ident —
Configures the arp-reply-agent to discard ARP requests received on the MSAP that are targeted for a known host on the same MSAP with the same subscriber identification.

Hosts are identified by their subscriber information. For DHCP subscriber hosts, the subscriber hosts, the subscriber information is configured using the optional subscriber parameter string.

When arp-reply-agent is enabled with sub-ident:

  1. If the subscriber information for the destination host exactly matches the subscriber information for the originating host and the destination host is known on the same MSAP as the source, the ARP request is silently discarded.
  2. If the subscriber information for the destination host or originating host is unknown or undefined, the source and destination hosts are not considered to be the same subscriber. The ARP request is forwarded outside the MSAP’s Split Horizon Group.
  3. When sub-ident is not configured, the arp-reply-agent does not attempt to identify the subscriber information for the destination or originating host and will not discard an ARP request based on subscriber information.

dhcp

Syntax 
dhcp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only
Description 

This command enters the context to configure DHCP parameters.

option

Syntax 
[no] option
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp
config>service>ies>sub-if>dhcp
Description 

This command enables DHCP Option 82 (Relay Agent Information Option) parameters processing and enters the context for configuring Option 82 sub-options.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no option

action

Syntax 
action {replace | drop | keep}
no action
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp>option
Description 

This command configures the Relay Agent Information Option (Option 82) processing.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

keep

Parameters 
replace—
In the upstream direction (from the user), the Option 82 field from the router is inserted in the packet (overwriting any existing Option 82 field). In the downstream direction (towards the user) the Option 82 field is stripped (in accordance with RFC 3046).
drop—
The DHCP packet is dropped if an Option 82 field is present, and a counter is incremented.
keep—
The existing information is kept in the packet and the router does not add any additional information. In the downstream direction the Option 82 field is not stripped and is forwarded towards the client.

circuit-id

Syntax 
circuit-id [ascii-tuple | vlan-ascii-tuple]
no circuit-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp>option
Description 

When enabled, the router sends an ASCII-encoded tuple in the circuit-id sub-option of the DHCP packet. This ASCII-tuple consists of the access-node-identifier, service-id, and SAP-ID, separated by “|”.

If disabled, the circuit-id sub-option of the DHCP packet will be left empty.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

ascii-tuple

Parameters 
ascii-tuple—
Specifies that the ASCII-encoded concatenated tuple consisting of the access-node-identifier, service-id, and interface-name is used
vlan-ascii-tuple—
Specifies that the format will include VLAN-id and dot1p bits in addition to what is included in ascii-tuple already. The format is supported on dot1q and qinq ports only. Thus, when the option 82 bits are stripped, dot1p bits will be copied to the Ethernet header of an outgoing packet.

vendor-specific-option

Syntax 
[no] vendor-specific-option
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp>option
config>service>ies>sub-if>dhcp
Description 

This command configures the vendor-specific sub-option parameters of the DHCP relay packet.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no vendor-specific-option

client-mac-address

Syntax 
[no] client-mac-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp>option>vendor
config>service>ies>sub-if>dhcp>option
Description 

This command enables the sending of the MAC address in the Nokia vendor-specific sub-option of the DHCP relay packet.

The no form of the command disables the sending of the MAC address in the Nokia vendor-specific sub-option of the DHCP relay packet.

Default 

no client-mac-address

sap-id

Syntax 
[no] sap-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp>option>vendor
config>service>ies>sub-if>dhcp>option
Description 

This command enables the sending of the SAP ID in the A Nokia vendor-specific sub-option of the DHCP relay packet.

The no form of the command disables the sending of the SAP ID in the Nokia vendor-specific sub-option of the DHCP relay packet.

Default 

no sap-id

service-id

Syntax 
[no] service-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp>option>vendor
config>service>ies>sub-if>dhcp>option
Description 

This command enables the sending of the service ID in the Nokia vendor-specific sub-option of the DHCP relay packet.

The no form of the command disables the sending of the service ID in the Nokia vendor-specific sub-option of the DHCP relay packet.

Default 

no service-id

string

Syntax 
[no] string text
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp>option>vendor
config>service>ies>sub-if>dhcp>option
Description 

This command specifies the string in the Nokia vendor-specific sub-option of the DHCP relay packet.

The no form of the command returns the default value.

Default 

no string

Parameters 
text—
The string can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 32 characters in length. If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).

system-id

Syntax 
[no] system-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp>option>vendor
config>service>ies>sub-if>dhcp>option
Description 

This command specifies whether the system-id is encoded in the A Nokia vendor-specific sub-option of Option 82.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no system-id

emulated-server

Syntax 
emulated-server ip-address
no emulated-server
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp>proxy
config>service>ies>sub-if>dhcp
Description 

This command configures the IP address which will be used as the DHCP server address in the context of the MSAP. Typically, the configured address should be in the context of the subnet represented by the service.

The no form of this command reverts to the default setting. The local proxy server will not become operational without the emulated-server address being specified.

Default 

no emulated server

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the emulated server’s IP address. This address must be unique within the subnet and specified in dotted decimal notation. Allowed values are IP addresses in the range 1.0.0.0 – 223.255.255.255 (with support of /31 subnets).

lease-time

Syntax 
lease-time [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds] [override]
no lease-time
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>dhcp>proxy
config>service>ies>sub-if>dhcp
Description 

This command defines the length of lease-time that will be provided to DHCP clients. By default the local-proxy-server will always make use of the lease-time information provide by either a RADIUS or DHCP server.

The no form of this command disables the use of the lease-time command. The local-proxy-server will use the lease-time offered by either a RADIUS or DHCP server.

Default 

no lease-time

Parameters 
override—
Specifies that the local-proxy-server will use the configured lease-time information to provide DHCP clients
days—
Specifies the number of days that the given IP address is valid
Values—
0 to 3650

 

hours—
Specifies the number of hours that the given IP address is valid
Values—
0 to 23

 

minutes—
Specifies the number of minutes that the given IP address is valid
Values—
0 to 59

 

seconds—
Specifies the number of seconds that the given IP address is valid
Values—
0 to 59

 

igmp-snooping

Syntax 
igmp-snooping
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) snooping parameters.

Default 

none

fast-leave

Syntax 
[no] fast-leave
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command enables fast leave.

When IGMP fast leave processing is enabled, the 7450 ESS or 7750 SR will immediately remove a SAP or SDP from the IP multicast group when it detects an IGMP leave on that SAP or SDP. Fast leave processing allows the switch to remove a SAP or SDP that sends a leave from the forwarding table without first sending out group-specific queries to the SAP or SDP, and thus speeds up the process of changing channels (zapping).

Fast leave should only be enabled when there is a single receiver present on the SAP or SDP.

When fast leave is enabled, the configured last-member-query-interval value is ignored.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no fast-leave

import

Syntax 
import policy-name
no import
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command specifies the import routing policy to be used for IGMP packets to be used on this SAP or SDP. Only a single policy can be imported on a single SAP at any time.

The no form of the command removes the policy association from the SAP or SDP.

Default 

no import (No import policy is specified)

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the routing policy name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes. Routing policies are configured in the config>router>policy-options context The router policy must be defined before it can be imported.

last-member-query-interval

Syntax 
last-member-query-interval tenths-of-seconds
no last-member-query-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command configures the maximum response time used in group-specific queries sent in response to leave messages, and is also the amount of time between two consecutive group-specific queries. This value may be tuned to modify the leave latency of the network. A reduced value results in reduced time to detect the loss of the last member of a group.

The configured interval is ignored when fast-leave is enabled on the SAP or SDP.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

10

Parameters 
seconds —
Specifies the frequency, in tenths of seconds, at which query messages are sent
Values—
1 to 50

 

max-num-groups

Syntax 
max-num-groups max-num-groups
no max-num-groups
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of multicast groups that can be joined on an MSAP or SDP. If the router receives an IGMP join message that would exceed the configured number of groups, the request is ignored.

Default 

no max-num-groups

Parameters 
max-num-groups —
Specifies the maximum number of groups that can be joined on an MSAP or SDP
Values—
1 to 1000

 

mcac

Syntax 
mcac
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp>
Description 

This command enters the context to configure multicast CAC parameters.

Default 

none

if-policy

Syntax 
if-policy mcac-if-policy-name
no if-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp>mcac
Description 

This command assigns an existing MCAC interface policy to this MSAP policy.

The no form of the command removes the MCAC interface policy association.

Default 

no if-policy

Parameters 
mcac-if-policy-name—
Specifies an existing MCAC interface policy up to 32 characters in length

mc-constraints

Syntax 
mc-constraints
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp>mcac
Description 

This command enters the context to configure the level and its associated bandwidth for a bundle or a logical interface.

level

Syntax 
level level-id bw bandwidth
no level level-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp>mcac
Description 

This command configures levels and their associated bandwidth for multicast CAC policy on an interface.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
level-id—
Specifies has an entry for each multicast CAC policy constraint level configured on a system
Values—
1 to 8

 

bandwidth —
Specifies the bandwidth in kilobits per second (kb/s) for the level.
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

number-down

Syntax 
number-down number-lag-port-down level level-id
no number-down number-lag-port-down
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp>mcac
Description 

This command configures the number of ports down along with level for multicast CAC policy on an MSAP

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
number-lag-port-down—
Specifies the number of port in a LAG group that are down. If the number of ports available in the LAG is reduced by the number of ports configured in this command here then bandwidth allowed for bundle and/or interface will be as per the levels configured in this context.
Values—
1 to 64 (for 64-link LAG)
1 to 32 (for other LAGs)

 

level-id
Specifies the amount of bandwidth available within a given bundle for MC traffic for a specified level.

policy

Syntax 
policy policy-name
no policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp>mcac
Description 

This command configures the multicast CAC policy name.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no policy

Parameters 
policy-name—
The multicast CAC policy name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

unconstrained-bw

Syntax 
unconstrained-bw bandwidth mandatory-bw mandatory-bw
no unconstrained-bw
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp>mcac
Description 

This command configures the bandwidth for the interface's multicast CAC policy traffic. When disabled (no unconstrained-bw) there will be no checking of bandwidth constraints on the interface level. When enabled and a policy is defined, enforcement is performed. The allocated bandwidth for optional channels should not exceed the unconstrained-bw minus the mandatory-bw and the mandatory channels have to stay below the specified value for the mandatory-bw. After this interface check, the bundle checks are performed.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no unconstrained-bw

Parameters 
bandwidth—
Specifies bandwidth assigned for interface's MCAC policy traffic, in kilobits per second (kb/s)
Values—
0 to 2147483647

 

mandatory-bw
Specifies the bandwidth pre-reserved for all the mandatory channels on a given interface in kilobits per second (kb/s).

If the bandwidth value is 0, no mandatory channels are allowed. If the value of bandwidth is '-1', then all mandatory and optional channels are allowed.

If the value of mandatory-bw is equal to the value of bandwidth, then all the unconstrained bandwidth on a given interface is allocated to mandatory channels configured through multicast CAC policy on that interface and no optional groups (channels) are allowed.

The value of mandatory-bw should always be less than or equal to that of bandwidth, An attempt to set the value of mandatory-bw greater than that of bandwidth, will result in inconsistent value error.

Values—
0 to 2147483647

 

use-lag-port-weight

Syntax 
[no] use-lag-port-weight
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp>mcac>mc-constraints
Description 

This command enables port weight to be used when determining available bandwidth per level when LAG ports go down/come up. The command is required for proper operation on mixed port-speed LAGs and can be used for non-mixed port-speed LAGs as well.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no use-lag-port-weight

sub-mcac-policy

Syntax 
sub-mcac-policy sub-mcac-policy-name [create]
no sub-mcac-policy b
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates a policy template with MCAC bandwidth limits that are applied to the subscriber.

Per interface mcac bandwidth limits are set directly under the interface (regular interface or group-interface) and no such policy templates are needed.

The need for a separate policy template for subscribers is due to the fact that groups of subscribers under the same group-interface can share certain settings that can be configured via this template.

To summarize, the MCAC bandwidth constraints for subscribers are defined in the sub-mcac-policy while the mcac bandwidth constraints for the interface are configured directly under the igmp>interface>mcac or igmp>grp-if>mcac context without the need for policy templates.

Note:

The sub-mcac-policy only deals with the mcac bandwidth limits and not the channel bandwidth definitions. Channels bandwidth is defined in a different policy (in the config>router>mcac context) and that policy is applied on the interface level as follows:

  1. For group-interface: under the config>service>vprn>igmp>grp-if>mcac context
  2. For regular interface: under the config>service/router>igmp>interface>mcac context.

In case of HQoS Adjustment, it is mandatory that the sub-mcac-policy be created and applied to the subscriber. The sub-mac-policy does not have to contain any bandwidth constrains, but it has to be in a no shutdown state in order for HQoS Adjustment to work.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the name of the policy up to 32 characters in length

mvr

Syntax 
mvr
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Multicast VPLS Registration (MVR) parameters.

from-vpls

Syntax 
from-vpls service-id
no from-vpls
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp>mvr
Description 

This command configures the VPLS from which multicast traffic is copied upon receipt of an IGMP join request.

IGMP snooping must be enabled on the MVR VPLS.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no from-vpls

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies the MVR VPLS from which multicast channels be copied into an MSAP
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

up to 64 characters in length (applies only to the 7750 SR)

 

query-interval

Syntax 
query-interval seconds
no query-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command configures the IGMP query interval. If the send-queries command is enabled, this parameter specifies the interval between two consecutive general queries sent by the system on an MSAP or SDP.

The configured query interval must be greater than the configured query-response interval.

If send-queries is not enabled on an MSAP or SDP, the configured query interval value is ignored.

Default 

125

Parameters 
seconds —
Specifies the time interval, in seconds, that the router transmits general host-query messages
Values—
2 to 1024

 

query-response-interval

Syntax 
query-response-interval seconds
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command configures the IGMP query response interval. If the send-queries command is enabled, this parameter specifies the maximum response time advertised in IGMPv2/v3 queries.

The configured query-response-interval must be smaller than the configured query-interval.

If send-queries is not enabled on an MSAP or SDP, the configured query-response-interval value is ignored.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

10

Parameters 
seconds —
Specifies the length of time, in seconds, to wait to receive a response to the host-query message from the host.
Values—
1 to 1023

 

robust-count

Syntax 
robust-count robust-count
no robust-count
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command configures the IGMP robustness variable. If the send-queries command is enabled, this parameter allows tuning for the expected packet loss on a SAP or SDP. The robust-count variable allows tuning for the expected packet loss on a subnet and is comparable to a retry count. If an MSAP or SDP is expected to be “lossy”, this parameter may be increased. IGMP snooping on an MSAP or SDP is robust to (robust-count-1) packet losses.

If send-queries is not enabled, this parameter is ignored.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

2

Parameters 
robust-count —
Specifies the robust count for the SAP or SDP
Values—
2 to 7

 

send-queries

Syntax 
[no] send-queries
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command specifies whether to send IGMP general query messages on the managed SAP. When send-queries is configured, all type of queries generate ourselves are of the configured version. If a report of a version higher than the configured version is received, the report will get dropped and a new wrong version counter will get incremented.

If send-queries is not configured, the version command has no effect. The version used on that SAP/SDP will be the version of the querier. This implies that, for example, when there is a v2 querier, a v3 group or group-source specific query is never sent when a host wants to leave a certain group.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no send-queries

version

Syntax 
version version
no version
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command specifies the version of IGMP which is running on an MSAP. This object can be used to configure a router capable of running either value. For IGMP to function correctly, all routers on a LAN must be configured to run the same version of IGMP on that LAN.

When the send-query command is configured, all type of queries generate ourselves are of the configured version. If a report of a version higher than the configured version is received, the report gets dropped and a new “wrong version” counter is incremented.

If the send-query command is not configured, the version command has no effect. The version used on that SAP or SDP will be the version of the querier. This implies that, for example, when there is a v2 querier, a v3 group or group-source specific query when a host wants to leave a certain group will never be sent.

Default 

3

Parameters 
version—
Specifies the IGMP version
Values—
1, 2, 3

 

mac-da-hashing

Syntax 
[no] mac-da-hashing
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only
Description 

This command specifies whether subscriber traffic egressing a LAG SAP has its egress LAG link selected by a function of the MAC destination address instead of the subscriber ID.

This command is only meaningful if subscriber management is enabled and can be configured for a VPLS service.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no mac-da-hashing

split-horizon-group

Syntax 
split-horizon-group group-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>vpls-only>igmp-snp
Description 

This command specifies the name of the split horizon group to which the MSAP belongs.

default-msap-policy

Syntax 
default-msap-policy policy-name
no default-msap-policy
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
Description 

This command specifies the default managed SAP policy to use to create MSAPs when the response from the RADIUS server does not specify a managed SAP policy.

The policy-name parameter is only valid for a SAP with the keywords capture-sap specified in the SAP’s configuration. The capture-sap keyword in the SAP configuration captures the SAP where triggering packets will be sent to the CPM. Non-triggering packets captured by the capture SAP will be dropped.

The managed SAP policy must already be defined in the config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy context

The no form of the command removes the policy-name from the configuration.

Default 

no default-msap-policy

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies an existing default managed SAP policy

trigger-packet

Syntax 
trigger-packet [dhcp] [pppoe] [arp] [dhcp6] [ppp] [rtr-solicit] [data]
no trigger-packet
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
Description 

This command enables triggering packet to initiate RADIUS authentication that provides a service context. The authentication, together with the service context for this request, creates a managed SAP. The VLAN is the same as the triggering packet. This SAP behaves as a regular SAP but the configuration is not user-editable and not maintained in the configuration file. The managed SAP remains active as long as the session is active.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
dhcp—
Specifies whether the receipt of DHCP trigger packets on this VPLS SAP when the keyword capture-sap is specified in the sap command creation string, will result in a RADIUS authentication that will provide a service context and the creation of a SAP with a value of managed.
pppoe—
Specifies whether the receipt of PPPoE trigger packets on this VPLS SAP when the keyword capture-sap is specified in the sap command creation string, will result in a RADIUS authentication that will provide a service context and the creation of a SAP with a value of managed.
arp—
Indicates that ARP is the type of trigger packets for this entry
dhcp6—
Indicates that DHCP6 is the type of trigger packets for this entry
ppp—
Indicates that PPP is the type of trigger packets for this entry
rtr-solicit —
Indicates that router solicit is the type of trigger packets for this entry
data —
Indicates that data is the type of trigger packets for this entry

allow-dot1q-msaps

Syntax 
[no] allow-dot1q-msaps
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
Description 

This command enables support for single tagged traffic triggering managed SAP creation on a qinq encapsulated capture SAP.

With this command enabled, a single tagged trigger packet received on a qinq encapsulated capture SAP (x/y/z:*.* or x/y/z:tag.*) can trigger the creation of an x/y/z:tag.0 managed SAP (MSAP).

The config>system>ethernet>new-qinq-untagged-sap command should be configured:

  1. as a prerequisite for an x/y/z:tag.* capture-sap
  1. where x/y/z:tag1.0 and x/y/z:tag1.tag2 MSAPs for an x/y/z:*.* capture-sap should co-exist

Note that enabling new-qinq-untagged-sap affects the behavior of existing <port-id>:tag.0 SAPs.

With the allow-dot1q-msaps command disabled (default), a single tagged trigger packet received on a qinq encapsulated capture SAP (x/y/z:*.* or x/y/z:tag.*) is dropped as “Invalid QTag”.

This command cannot be enabled on:

  1. a dot1q encapsulated capture-sap
  2. an inverse capture sap (x/y/z:*.tag)

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no allow-dot1q-msaps

authentication-policy

Syntax 
authentication-policy name
no authentication-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command defines which subscriber authentication policy must be applied when a DHCP message is received on the interface. The authentication policies must already be defined. The policy will only be applied when DHCP snooping is enabled on the SAP on Layer 2 interfaces.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
name—
Specifies a unique authentication policy name

9.25.2.1.10. Multi-Chassis Redundancy Commands

redundancy

Syntax 
redundancy
Context 
config
Description 

This command allows the user to perform redundancy operations.

Parameters 
force-switchover —
Forces a switchover to the standby CPM card
Values—

now

Specifies a keyword to switch to the standby CPM)

 

Note:

Switching to the standby displays the following message.

WARNING: Configuration and/or Boot options may have changed since the last save.

Are you sure you want to switchover (y/n)?

synchronize

Syntax 
synchronize {boot-env | config}
Context 
config>redundancy
Description 

This command performs a synchronization of the standby CPM images and/or config files to the active CPM. Either the boot-env or config parameter must be specified.

In the config>redundancy context, this command performs an automatically triggered standby CPM synchronization.

When the standby CPM takes over operation following a failure or reset of the active CPM, it is important to ensure that the active and standby CPM have identical operational parameters. This includes the saved configuration, CPM and IOM images.

The active CPM ensures that the active configuration is maintained on the standby CPM. However, to ensure smooth operation under all circumstances, runtime images and system initialization configurations must also be automatically synchronized between the active and standby CPM.

If synchronization fails, alarms and log messages that indicate the type of error that caused the failure of the synchronization operation are generated. When the error condition ceases to exist, the alarm is cleared.

Only files stored on the router are synchronized. If a configuration file or image is stored in a location other than on a local compact flash, the file is not synchronized (for example, storing a configuration file on an FTP server).

Default 

no synchronize

Parameters 
boot-env—
Synchronizes all files required for the boot process (loader, BOF, images, and configuration files
config —
Synchronizes only the primary, secondary, and tertiary configuration files

multi-chassis

Syntax 
multi-chassis
Context 
config>redundancy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure multi-chassis parameters.

peer

Syntax 
peer ip-address [create]
no peer ip-address
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command creates a new multi-chassis redundancy peer or enters the context to configure an existing peer.

The peer address can be either an IPv4 address or an IPv6 address. If an IPv6 address is used, the following MCS clients are not supported:

  1. mc-endpoint
  2. l2tp

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies an IPv4 or IPv6 unicast address

authentication-key

Syntax 
authentication-key [authentication-key | hash-key] [hash | hash2]
no authentication-key
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer
Description 

This command configures the authentication key used between this node and the multi-chassis peer. The authentication key can be any combination of letters or numbers.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
authentication-key—
Specifies the authentication key. Allowed values are any string up to 20 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
hash-key
Specifies the hash key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 33 (hash1-key) or 55 (hash2-key) characters in length (encrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).
hash—
Specifies that the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies that the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.

mc-ipsec

Syntax 
mc-ipsec
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer
Description 

This command enable the context to configure multi-chassis IPSec parameters.

discovery-interval

Syntax 
discovery-interval interval-1 [boot interval-2]
no discovery-interval
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-ipsec
Description 

This command specifies the time interval the tunnel group stays in the Discovery state. Interval-1 is used as discovery-interval when a new tunnel group is added to multi-chassis redundancy (mp-ipsec); interval-2 is used as the discovery interval at system boot-up. It is optional and when it is not specified, interval-1 will be used.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

discovery-interval 300 boot 300

Parameters 
interval-1/2—
Specifies the interval in seconds
Values—
1 to 1800 seconds

 

keep-alive-interval

Syntax 
keep-alive-interval time-interval
no keep-alive-interval
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-ipsec
Description 

This command specifies the time interval of the mastership election protocol sending the keep-alive packet.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

10

Parameters 
time-interval—
Specifies the time interval in tenths of a second
Values—
5 to 500

 

hold-on-neighbor-failure

Syntax 
hold-on-neighbor-failure multiplier
no hold-on-neighbor-failure
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-ipsec
Description 

This command specifies the number of keep-alive failures before the peer is considered down.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

3

Parameters 
multiplier—
Specifies the number of intervals the standby node will wait for packets from the active node before assuming a redundant-neighbor node failure.
Values—
2 to 25

 

bfd-enable

Syntax 
bfd-enable service service-id interface interface-name dst-ip ip-address
no bfd-enable
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-ipsec
Description 

This command enables tracking a central BFD session. If the BFD session goes down, then the system considers the peer down and changes the mc-ipsec status of the configured tunnel-group accordingly.

The BFD session uses the specified loopback interface (in the specified service) address as the source address and uses the specified dst-ip as the destination address. Other BFD parameters are configured with the bfd command on the specified interface.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no bfd-enable

Parameters 
interface-name—
Specifies the name of the loopback interface
service-id—
Specifies the ID of the service
dst-id—
Specifies the destination address of the BFD packet

tunnel-group

Syntax 
tunnel-group group-id [create]
no tunnel-group group-id
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-ipsec
Description 

This command enables multi-chassis redundancy for the specified tunnel-group or enters an already configured tunnel-group context. The configured tunnel-group could failover independently.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
group-id—
Specifies the tunnel-group ID
Values—
1 to 16

 

create—
Enables multi-chassis redundancy for the specified tunnel-group

peer-group

Syntax 
peer-group group-id
no peer-group
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-ipsec>tunnel-group
Description 

This command specifies the corresponding tunnel-group ID on the peer node. The peer tunnel-group ID does not necessarily equal the local tunnel-group ID.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no peer-group

Parameters 
group-id—
Specifies the tunnel-group ID
Values—
1 to 16

 

priority

Syntax 
priority priority
no priority
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-ipsec>tunnel-group
Description 

This command specifies the local priority of the tunnel group. This is used to elect the master (higher number is the master). If priorities are the same, then the peer with the more active ISA becomes the master. If the priority and the number of active ISAs are the same, then the peer with the higher IP address is the master.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
priority—
Specifies the priority of the tunnel-group
Values—
0 to 255

 

preempt

Syntax 
[no] preempt
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-ipsec>tunnel-group
Description 

This command enables the preempt behavior of local node.

The no form of the command disables mastership preemption by this tunnel group.

Default 

no preempt

mc-lag

Syntax 
[no] mc-lag
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-lag
Description 

This command enters the context to configure multi-chassis LAG operations and related parameters.

The no form of this command administratively disables multi-chassis LAG. MC-LAG can only be issued only when mc-lag is shutdown.

hold-on-neighbor-failure

Syntax 
hold-on-neighbor-failure multiplier
no hold-on-neighbor-failure
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-lag
Description 

This command specifies the interval that the standby node will wait for packets from the active node before assuming a redundant-neighbor node failure. This delay in switch-over operation is required to accommodate different factors influencing node failure detection rate, such as IGP convergence, or HA switch-over times and to prevent the standby node to take action prematurely.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

3

Parameters 
multiplier—
Specifies the time interval that the standby node waits for packets from the active node before assuming a redundant-neighbor node failure
Values—
2 to 25

 

keep-alive-interval

Syntax 
keep-alive-interval interval
no keep-alive-interval
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-lag
Description 

This command sets the interval at which keep-alive messages are exchanged between two systems participating in MC-LAG. These keep-alive messages are used to determine remote-node failure and the interval is set in deci-seconds.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

10

Parameters 
interval—
Specifies the time interval expressed in deci-seconds
Values—
5 to 500

 

lag

Syntax 
lag lag-id lacp-key admin-key system-id system-id [remote-lag lag-id] system-priority system-priority
no lag lag-id
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc-lag
Description 

This command defines a LAG which is forming a redundant-pair for MC-LAG with a LAG configured on the given peer. The same LAG group can be defined only in the scope of 1 peer.

The same lacp-key, system-id, and system-priority must be configured on both nodes of the redundant pair in order to MC-LAG to become operational. In order MC-LAG to become operational, all parameters (lacp-key, system-id, system-priority) must be configured the same on both nodes of the same redundant pair.

The partner system (the system connected to all links forming MC-LAG) will consider all ports using the same lacp-key, system-id, system-priority as the part of the same LAG. In order to achieve this in MC operation, both redundant-pair nodes have to be configured with the same values. In case of the mismatch, MC-LAG is kept in oper-down status.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
lag-id—
The LAG identifier, expressed as a decimal integer. Specifying the lag-id allows the mismatch between lag-id on redundant-pair. If no lag-id is specified it is assumed that neighbor system uses the same lag-id as a part of the given MC-LAG. If no matching MC-LAG group can be found between neighbor systems, the individual LAGs will operate normally (no MC-LAG operation is established).
Values—
1 to 800

 

admin-key
Specifies a 16 bit key that needs to be configured in the same manner on both sides of the MC-LAG in order for the MC-LAG to come up
Values—
1 to 65535

 

system-id
Specifies a 6 byte value expressed in the same notation as MAC address
Values—
xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx - xx [00 to FF]

 

lag-id
Specifies the LAG ID on the remote system
Values—
1 to 200 (applies to the 7450 ESS)
1 to 800 (applies to the 7750 SR)

 

system-priority
Specifies the system priority to be used in the context of the MC-LAG. The partner system will consider all ports using the same lacp-key, system-id, and system-priority as part of the same LAG.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

source-address

Syntax 
source-address ip-address
no source-address
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer
Description 

This command specifies the source address used to communicate with the multi-chassis peer.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no source-address

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the source address used to communicate with the multi-chassis peer

sync

Syntax 
[no] sync
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer
Description 

This command enters the context to configure synchronization parameters.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no sync

igmp

Syntax 
[no] igmp
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command specifies whether IGMP protocol information should be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no igmp

igmp-snooping

Syntax 
[no] igmp-snooping
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command specifies whether IGMP snooping information should be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no igmp-snooping

local-dhcp-server

Syntax 
[no] local-dhcp-server
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command synchronizes DHCP server information.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no local-dhcp-server

mc-ring

Syntax 
[no] mc-ring
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command synchronizes mc-ring information.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no mc-ring

mld-snooping

Syntax 
[no] mld-snooping
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command is not supported. It is not blocked for backwards-compatibility reasons but has no effect on the system if configured.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no mld-snooping

pim-snooping

Syntax 
pim-snooping [saps] [spoke-sdp]
no pim-snooping
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command specifies whether PIM snooping for IPv4 information should be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer. Entering only pim-snooping (without any parameter) results in the synchronization being applicable only to SAPs.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no pim-snooping

Parameters 
saps
Specifies that SAPs are to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer relating to sync-tags configured on ports. This is the default when no parameters are included.
spoke-sdp—
Specifies that PIM snooping data is synchronized with the multi-chassis peer on SAP endpoints

port

Syntax 
port [port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [create]
no port [port-id | lag-id]
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command specifies the port to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer and a synchronization tag to be used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
port-id—
Specifies the port to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
lag-id—
Specifies the LAG ID to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
sync-tag
Specifies a synchronization tag to be used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer, up to 32 characters in length

range

Syntax 
range encap-range sync-tag sync-tag
no range encap-range
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync>port
Description 

This command configures a range of encapsulation values.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
encap-range—
Specifies a range of encapsulation values on a port to be synchronized with a multi-chassis peer
Values—

Dot1Q

start-vlan-end-vlan

QinQ

Q1.start-vlan-Q1.end-vlan

 

sync-tag sync-tag
Specifies a synchronization tag, up to 32 characters in length, to be used while synchronizing this encapsulation value range with the multi-chassis peer.

srrp

Syntax 
[no] srrp
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command specifies whether subscriber routed redundancy protocol (SRRP) information should be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no srrp

sub-host-trk

Syntax 
[no] sub-host-trk
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command synchronizes subscriber host tracking information.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no sub-host-trk

sub-mgmt

Syntax 
sub-mgmt [ipoe | pppoe]
no sub-mgmt
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command synchronizations of subscriber states between chassis. Synchronization is enabled per protocol type (IPoE or PPPoE).

The keywords (ipoe, pppoe) must match on both nodes. If not, subscriber synchronization will fail. For example if one node is configured with:

config>multi-chassis>peer>sync>sub-mgmt ipoe

but the other node is configured with:

config>multi-chassis>peer>sync>sub-mgmt ipoe pppoe, synchronization will fail even for ipoe application.

Default 

no sub-mgmt

Parameters 
ipoe—
Specifies that IPoE subscribers will be synchronized
pppoe—
Specifies that PPPoE subscribers will be synchronized

tunnel-group

Syntax 
tunnel-group tunnel-group-id sync-tag tag-name [create]
no tunnel-group
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command enables multi-chassis synchronization of IPSec states of a specified tunnel-group with its peer. Sync-tag is used to match corresponding tunnel-groups on both peers. IPSec states will be synchronized between tunnel-groups with the same sync-tag.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
tunnel-group-id—
Specifies the ID of the tunnel-group
tag-name—
Specifies the name of sync-tag.

ipsec

Syntax 
[no] ipsec
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>sync
Description 

This command enables multi-chassis synchronization of IPSec states on system level.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ipsec

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer
Description 

This command enters the context to configure the multi-chassis ring parameters.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

mc-ring

ring

Syntax 
ring sync-tag [create]
no ring sync-tag
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr
Description 

This command configures a multi-chassis ring.

The no form of the command removes the sync-tag from the configuration.

Default 

none

l3-ring

Syntax 
l3-ring name [create]
no l3-ring name
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr
Description 

This command configures a Layer 3 multi-chassis ring.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

in-band-control-path

Syntax 
in-band-control-path
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring
Description 

This command enters the context to configure control path parameters.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

debounce

Syntax 
[no] debounce
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring>in-band-control-path
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring>in-band-control-path
Description 

This command enables the inband control path debouncing. The no form of the command disables inband control path debouncing.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

debounce

dst-ip

Syntax 
dst-ip ip-address
no dst-ip
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring>in-band-control-path
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring>in-band-control-path
Description 

This command specifies the destination IP address used in the inband control connection.

If the destination IP address is not configured, the ring cannot become operational.

Default 

none

Parameters 
ip-address —
The destination IP address.

interface

Syntax 
interface ip-int-name
no interface
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring>in-band-control-path
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring>in-band-control-path
Description 

This command specifies the name of the IP interface used for the inband control connection.

If an interface name is not configured, the ring cannot become operational.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no interface

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
Specifies an interface name up to 32 characters in length

max-debounce-time

Syntax 
max-debounce-time max-debounce-time
no max-debounce-time
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring>in-band-control-path
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring>in-band-control-path
Description 

This command configures the inband control path maximum debounce time.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

10

Parameters 
max-debounce-time—
Specifies the maximum debounce time on the transition of the operational state of the inband control connection
Values—
5 to 200 seconds

 

service-id

Syntax 
service-id service-id
no service-id
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring>in-band-control-path
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring>in-band-control-path
Description 

This command configures the service ID of the SAP used for the Ring-Node Connectivity Verification of this ring node.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no service-id

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing service ID or service name
Values—
service-id: 1 to 214748364
svc-name: A string up to 64 characters in length

 

path-b

Syntax 
[no] path-b
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring
Description 

This command specifies the set of upper-VLAN IDs associated with the SAPs that belong to path B with respect to load-sharing. All other SAPs belong to path A.

Default 

If not specified, the default is an empty set.

range

Syntax 
[no] range vlan-range
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring>path-b
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring>path-excl
Description 

This command specifies the set of VLAN IDs associated with the SAPs that are controlled by the remote peer. It is a bitmap that associates bit i with VLAN ID i, with i in [0 to 4094]. Setting the value to the empty string is equivalent to setting it to 512 zeroes.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no range

ring-node

Syntax 
ring-node ring-node-name [create]
no ring-node ring-node-name
Context 
config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring
Description 

This command specifies the unique name of a multi-chassis ring access node.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
ring-node-name—
Specifies the ring-node name up to 32 characters in length

path-excl

Syntax 
[no] path-excl
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring
Description 

This command specifies the set of upper-VLAN IDs associated with the SAPs that are to be excluded from control by the multi-chassis ring.

Default 

If not specified, the default is an empty set.

connectivity-verify

Syntax 
connectivity-verify
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring
Description 

This command enters the context to configure a node connectivity check.

interval

Syntax 
interval interval
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mcr>ring>cv
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring>cv
Description 

This command specifies the polling interval of the ring-node connectivity verification of this ring node.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

5

Parameters 
interval—
Specifies the polling interval of the ring-node connectivity verification of this ring node
Values—
1 to 6000

 

service-id

Syntax 
service-id service-id
no service-id
Context 
config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring-node>connect-verify
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring>connectivity-verify
Description 

This command specifies the service ID of the SAP used for ring-node connectivity verification of this ring node.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no service-id

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies the service ID or service name
Values—
service-id: 1 to 214748364
svc-name: A string up to 64 characters in length

 

src-ip

Syntax 
src-ip ip-address
no src-ip
Context 
config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring-node>connect-verify
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring>connectivity-verify
Description 

This command specifies the source IP address used in ring-node connectivity verification of this ring node.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no src-ip

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the source IP address used in ring-node connectivity verification of this ring node

src-mac

Syntax 
src-mac ieee-address
no src-mac
Context 
config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring-node>connect-verify
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring>connectivity-verify
Description 

This command specifies the source MAC address used for the Ring-Node Connectivity Verification of this ring node.

If all zeros are specified, then the MAC address of the system management processor (CPM) is used.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no src-mac

Parameters 
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.

vlan

Syntax 
vlan [vlan-encap]
Context 
config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring-node>connect-verify
config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>l3ring>node>cv
Description 

This command specifies the VLAN tag of the SAP used for ring-node connectivity verification of this ring node. It is only meaningful if the value of is not zero.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no vlan

Parameters 
vlan-encap—
Specifies the node cc VLAN IP

srrp-instance

Syntax 
[no] srrp-instance srrp-id
Context 
config>redundancy>multi-chassis>peer>mc>l3-ring
Description 

This command configures an SRRP instance for Layer 3 ring.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
srrp-id—
Specifies the SRRP ID of this SRRP instance
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

9.25.2.1.11. SLA Profile Commands

sla-profile

Syntax 
sla-profile sla-profile-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures an SLA profile mapping. Hosts associated with a subscriber are subdivided into Service Level Agreement (SLA) profiles. For each subscriber host an SLA profile can be specified. For a subscriber host, the SLA profile determines:

  1. The QoS-policies to use
    1. The classification
    2. The queues
    3. The queue mapping
  2. The IP filters to use

The SLA profile also has the attribute host-limit which limits the total number of hosts (belonging to the same subscriber) on a certain SAP that can be using this SLA profile.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
sla-profile-name—
Specifies the name of the SLA profile

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress parameters for the SLA profile.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress parameters for the SLA profile.

host-limits

Syntax 
[no] no host-limits
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile
Description 

This command enters the context to configure host limit parameter for this for this SLA profile.

The no form of this command removes the parameters from the configuration.

ipv4-arp

Syntax 
ipv4-arp max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv4-arp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of IPv4 ARP hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv4 ARP hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv4-arp

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv4 ARP hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies

Values—
0 to 131071

 

ipv4-dhcp

Syntax 
ipv4-dhcp max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv4-dhcp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command limits the number of IPv4 DHCP hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv4 DHCP hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv4-dhcp

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv4 DHCP hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
0 to 131071

 

ipv4-overall

Syntax 
ipv4-overall max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv4-overall
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command limits the total number of IPv4 hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv4 hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv4-overall

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv4 hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
0 to 32767

 

ipv4-ppp

Syntax 
ipv4-ppp max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv4-ppp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command limits the total number of IPv4 PPP hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv4 PPP hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv4-ppp

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv4 PPP hosts
Values—
0 to 32767

 

ipv6-overall

Syntax 
ipv6-overall max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv6-overall
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command limits the total number of IPv6 hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv6 hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv6-overall

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv6 hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies

Values—
0 to 32767

 

ipv6-pd-ipoe-dhcp

Syntax 
ipv6-pd-ipoe-dhcp max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv6-pd-ipoe-dhcp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command configures the total number of IPv6 DHCP PD hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv6 DHCP hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv6-dhcp

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the total number of IPv6 DHCP PD hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies

Values—
0 to 32767

 

ipv6-pd-overall

Syntax 
ipv6-pd-overall max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv6-pd-overall
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command limits the total number of IPv6-PD hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv6-PD hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv6-pd-overall

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv6-PD hosts overall
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies

Values—
0 to 32767

 

ipv6-pd-ppp-dhcp

Syntax 
ipv6-pd-ppp-dhcp max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv6-pd-ppp-dhcp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of IPv6-WAN PPP DHCP hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv6-WAN PPP DHCP hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv6-pd-ppp-dhcp

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv6-WAN PPP DHCP hosts.
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
0 to 32767

 

ipv6-wan-ipoe-dhcp

Syntax 
ipv6-wan-ipoe-dhcp max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv6-wan-ipoe-dhcp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of IPv6-WAN PPP DHCP hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv6-WAN PPP DHCP hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv6-wan-ipoe-dhcp

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv6-WAN PPP DHCP hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies

Values—
0 to 32767

 

ipv6-wan-ipoe-slaac

Syntax 
ipv6-wan-ipoe-slaac max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv6-wan-ipoe-slaac
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of IPv6-WAN IPoE SLAAC hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv6-WAN IPoE SLAAC hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv6-wan-ipoe-slaac

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv6-WAN IPoE SLAAC hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies

Values—
0 to 32767

 

ipv6-wan-overall

Syntax 
ipv6-wan-overall max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv6-wan-overall
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command configures the total number of IPv6 WAN hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPV6 WAN hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv6-wan-overall

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv6 WAN hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies

Values—
0 to 32767

 

ipv6-wan-ppp-dhcp

Syntax 
ipv6-wan-ppp-dhcp max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv6-wan-ppp-dhcp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command configures the total number of IPv6 PPP DHCP WAN hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of IPv6 PPP DHCP WAN hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv6-wan-ppp-dhcp

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of IPv6 PPP DHCP WAN hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies

Values—
0 to 32767

 

ipv6-wan-ppp-slaac

Syntax 
ipv6-wan-ppp-slaac max-nr-of-hosts
no ipv6-wan-ppp-slaac
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command configures the total number of SLAAC hosts.

The no form of the command removes the number of SLAAC hosts from the SLA profile.

Default 

no ipv6-wan-ppp-slaac

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of SLAAC hosts
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies

Values—
0 to 32767

 

lac-overall

Syntax 
lac-overall max-nr-of-hosts
no lac-overall
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command configures the total number of L2TP LAC hosts

The no form of the command removes the number of L2TP LAC from the SLA profile.

Default 

no lac-overall

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of L2TP LAC hosts.
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies

Values—
0 to 32767

 

overall

Syntax 
overall max-nr-of-hosts
no overall
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command configures the total number of hosts.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no overall

Parameters 
max-nr-of-hosts—
Specifies the maximum number of hosts
Values—
0 to 32767

 

remove-oldest

Syntax 
[no] remove-oldest
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>host-limits
Description 

This command removes the oldest subscriber host when the host limit is reached.

The no form of the command maintains the oldest subscriber host when the host limit is reached.

Default 

no remove-oldest

ip-filter

Syntax 
[no] ip-filter filter-id
no ip-filter [force]
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>egress
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>ingress
Description 

This command configures an egress or ingress IP filter.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
filter-id—
Specifies an existing IP filter policy ID
Values—
1 to 65535

 

9.25.2.1.11.1. SLA Profile QoS Commands

qos

Syntax 
qos sap-egress-policy-id [vport-scheduler | port-scheduler] [force]
no qos
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress
Description 

This command specifies the egress QoS policy applicable to this SLA profile. The policy must already be defined in the config>qos>sap-egress context.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
sap-egress-policy-id—
Specifies the egress policy to be applied to the egress SLA profile
Values—
1 to 65535

 

vport-scheduler | port-scheduler—
Specifies if a host queue with the port-parent option enabled should be scheduled within the context of a Vport port scheduler policy or a the port’s port scheduler policy
force—
Forces a policy change

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id [shared-queuing | multipoint-shared | service-queuing] [force]
no qos
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress
Description 

This command specifies the ingress QoS policy applicable to this SLA profile. The policy must already be defined in the config>qos>sap-ingress context.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

qos 1

Parameters 
sap-ingress-policy-id—
Specifies the policy to be applied to the ingress SLA profile
Values—
1 to 65535

 

shared-queuing—
Specifies the policy used by this SAP. When the value of this object is null it means that the SAP will use individual ingress QoS queues, instead of the shared ones
multipoint-shared—
This keyword is mutually exclusive with the shared-queuing and service-queuing keywords. When multipoint-shared is specified, the ingress forwarding plane will conserve hardware queues by performing two tier queuing on ingress unicast and multipoint packets through the SAP. Unicast service queues defined in the SAP ingress QoS policy are created for the SAP on the ingress forwarding plane without regard for the switch fabric destinations to which the SAP may need to forward (other destinations in the VPLS context). The multipoint queues defined in the SAP ingress QoS policy are not created for the SAP. Instead, all multipoint traffic is mapped to the unicast queues based on forwarding class in the first pass. In the second pass the unicast packets will be mapped to the unicast shared queues while the multipoint traffic will be mapped to the multipoint shared queues.
service-queuing—
This keyword is mutually exclusive with the multipoint-shared and shared-queuing keywords to state that service queueing is needed
force—
Forces a policy change.

queue

Syntax 
[no] queue queue-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos
Description 

This command configures the context to configure egress or ingress queue parameters. Parameters defined in the config>qos>sap-egress policy-id or the config>qos>sap-ingress policy-id context are overridden by parameters specified in the subscriber management SLA profile context.

The classification and the queue mapping are shared by all the hosts on the same complex that use the same QoS policy (specified in the sla-profile SAP egress and SAP ingress policy IDs).

The queues are shared by all the hosts (of the same subscriber) on the same SAP that are using the same SLA profile. Queues are instantiated when, on a given SAP, a host of a subscriber is the first to use a certain SLA profile. This instantiation is referred to as an SLA profile instance.

The no form of the command removes the queue-id from the SLA profile.

Default 

none

Parameters 
queue-id —
Specifies the queue ID for the SAP egress or ingress queue, expressed as a decimal integer. The ID uniquely identifies the queue within the profile.
Values—
1 to 0

 

avg-frame-overhead

Syntax 
avg-frame-overhead percent
no avg-frame-overhead
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>queue
Description 

This command configures the average frame overhead to define the average percentage that the offered load to a queue will expand during the frame encapsulation process before sending traffic on-the-wire. While the avg-frame-overhead value may be defined on any queue, it is only used by the system for queues that egress a SONET or SDH port or channel. Queues operating on egress Ethernet ports automatically calculate the frame encapsulation overhead based on a 20 byte per packet rule (8 bytes for preamble and 12 bytes for Inter-Frame Gap).

When calculating the frame encapsulation overhead for port scheduling purposes, the system determines the following values:

  1. Offered-load — The offered-load of a queue is calculated by starting with the queue depth in octets, adding the received octets at the queue and subtracting queue discard octets. The result is the number of octets the queue has available to transmit. This is the packet based offered-load.
  2. Frame encapsulation overhead — Using the avg-frame-overhead parameter, the frame encapsulation overhead is simply the queues current offered-load (how much has been received by the queue) multiplied by the avg-frame-overhead. If a queue had an offered load of 10000 octets and the avg-frame-overhead equals 10%, the frame encapsulation overhead would be 10000 x 0.1 or 1000 octets.

For egress Ethernet queues, the frame encapsulation overhead is calculated by multiplying the number of offered-packets for the queue by 20 bytes. If a queue was offered 50 packets then the frame encapsulation overhead would be 50 x 20 or 1000 octets.

  1. Frame based offered-load — The frame based offered-load is calculated by adding the offered-load to the frame encapsulation overhead. If the offered-load is 10000 octets and the encapsulation overhead was 1000 octets, the frame based offered-load would equal 11000 octets.
  2. Packet to frame factor — The packet to frame factor is calculated by dividing the frame encapsulation overhead by the queues offered-load (packet based). If the frame encapsulation overhead is 1000 octets and the offered-load is 10000 octets then the packet to frame factor would be 1000 / 10000 or 0.1. When in use, the avg-frame-overhead will be the same as the packet to frame factor making this calculation unnecessary.
  3. Frame based CIR — The frame based CIR is calculated by multiplying the packet to frame factor with the queues configured CIR and then adding that result to that CIR. If the queue CIR is set at 500 octets and the packet to frame factor equals 0.1, the frame based CIR would be 500 x 1.1 or 550 octets.
  4. Frame based within-cir offered-load — The frame based within-cir offered-load is the portion of the frame based offered-load considered to be within the frame-based CIR. The frame based within-cir offered-load is the lesser of the frame based offered-load and the frame based CIR. If the frame based offered-load equaled 11000 octets and the frame based CIR equaled 550 octets, the frame based within-cir offered-load would be limited to 550 octets. If the frame based offered-load equaled 450 octets and the frame based CIR equaled 550 octets, the frame based within-cir offered-load would equal 450 octets (or the entire frame based offered-load).

As a special case, when a policer, queue or associated intermediate scheduler is configured with a CIR-weight equal to 0, the system automatically sets the queue’s frame based within-cir offered-load to 0, preventing it from receiving bandwidth during the port scheduler’s within-cir pass.

  1. Frame based PIR — The frame based PIR is calculated by multiplying the packet to frame factor with the queue’s configured PIR and then adding the result to that PIR. If the queue PIR is set to 7500 octets and the packet to frame factor equals 0.1, the frame based PIR would be 7500 x 1.1 or 8250 octets.
  2. Frame based within-pir offered-load — The frame based within-pir offered-load is the portion of the frame based offered-load considered to be within the frame based PIR. The frame based within-pir offered-load is the lesser of the frame based offered-load and the frame based PIR. If the frame based offered-load equaled 11000 octets and the frame based PIR equaled 8250 octets, the frame based within-pir offered-load would be limited to 8250 octets. If the frame based offered-load equaled 7000 octets and the frame based PIR equaled 8250 octets, the frame based within-pir offered load would equal 7000 octets.

Port scheduler operation using frame transformed rates — The port scheduler uses the frame based rates to determine the maximum rates that each queue may receive during the within-cir and above-cir bandwidth allocation passes. During the within-cir pass, a queue may receive up to its frame based within-cir offered-load. The maximum it may receive during the above-cir pass is the difference between the frame based within-pir offered load and the amount of actual bandwidth allocated during the within-cir pass.

SAP and subscriber SLA-profile average frame overhead override — The average frame overhead parameter on a sap-egress may be overridden at an individual egress queue basis. On each SAP and within the sla-profile policy used by subscribers an avg-frame-overhead command may be defined under the queue-override context for each queue. When overridden, the queue instance will use its local value for the average frame overhead instead of the sap-egress defined overhead.

The no form of this command reverts to the default. When set to 0, the system uses the packet based queue statistics for calculating port scheduler priority bandwidth allocation. If the no avg-frame-overhead command is executed in a queue-override queue id context, the avg-frame-overhead setting for the queue within the sap-egress QoS policy takes effect.

Default 

0

Parameters 
percent—
Specifies the average amount of packet-to-frame encapsulation overhead expected for the queue. This value is not used by the system for egress Ethernet queues.
Values—
0 to 100, default

 

cbs

Syntax 
cbs size-in-kbytes
no cbs
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>queue
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos>queue
Description 

This command can be used to override specific attributes of the specified queue's CBS parameters. It is permissible, and possibly desirable, to oversubscribe the total CBS reserved buffers for a given access port egress buffer pool. Oversubscription may be desirable due to the potential large number of service queues and the economy of statistical multiplexing the individual queues’ CBS settings into the defined reserved total.

When oversubscribing the reserved total, it is possible for a queue depth to be lower than its CBS setting and still not receive a buffer from the buffer pool for an ingress frame. As more queues are using their CBS buffers and the total in use exceeds the defined reserved total, essentially the buffers are being removed from the shared portion of the pool without the shared in use average and total counts being decremented. This can affect the operation of the high and low priority RED slopes on the pool, causing them to miscalculate when to start randomly drop packets.

The no form of this command returns the CBS size to the size as configured in the QoS policy.

Default 

no cbs

Parameters 
size-in-kbytes—
The size parameter is an integer expression of the number of kilobytes reserved for the queue. If a value of 10KBytes is desired, enter the value 10. A value of 0 specifies that no reserved buffers are required by the queue (a minimal reserved size can still be applied for scheduling purposes).
Values—
0 to 131072, default

 

high-prio-only

Syntax 
high-prio-only percent
no high-prio-only
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>queue
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos>queue
Description 

This command configures the value of the percentage of buffer space for the queue, used exclusively by high priority packets. The specified value overrides the default value for the context.

The priority of a packet can only be set in the SAP ingress QoS policy and is only applicable on the ingress queues for a SAP. The high-prio-only parameter is used to override the default value derived from the network-queue command.

The defined high-prio-only value cannot be greater than the MBS size of the queue. Attempting to change the MBS to a value smaller than the high priority reserve will generate an error and fail execution. Attempting to set the high-prio-only value larger than the current MBS size will also result in an error and fail execution.

The no form of this command returns high-prio-only to the size as configured in the QoS policy.

Default 

no high-prio-only

Parameters 
percent—
The percent parameter is the percentage reserved for high priority traffic on the queue. If a value of 10KBytes is desired, enter the value 10. A value of 0 specifies that none of the MBS of the queue will be reserved for high priority traffic. This does not affect RED slope operation for packets attempting to be queued.
Values—
0 to 100 | default

 

mbs

Syntax 
mbs size [bytes | kilobytes]
no mbs
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>queue
Description 

This command configures the maximum size for the queue.

The sum of the MBS for all queues on an egress access port can oversubscribe the total amount of buffering available. When congestion occurs and buffers become scarce, access to buffers is controlled by the RED slope a packet is associated with. A queue that has not exceeded its MBS size is not guaranteed that a buffer will be available when needed or that the packet’s RED slope will not force the discard of the packet. Setting proper CBS parameters and controlling CBS oversubscription is one major safeguard to queue starvation (when a queue does not receive its fair share of buffers). Another is properly setting the RED slope parameters for the needs of services on this port or channel.

The no form of this command returns the MBS size to the size as configured in the QoS policy.

Default 

no mbs

Parameters 
size—
This required parameter specifies that the MBS is expressed as an integer representing the required size in either bytes or kilobytes. The default is kilobytes. The optional byte and kilobyte keywords are mutually exclusive and are used to explicitly to define the size. By specifying the keyword default sets the MBS to its default value.
Values—
0 to 1073741824, default

 

bytes—
Specifies that the value given for size is interpreted as the queue'sMBS value in bytes.
kilobytes—
Specifies that the value given for size is interpreted as the queue's MBS value in kilobytes.

mbs

Syntax 
mbs size [bytes | kilobytes]
no mbs
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos>queue
Description 

The Maximum Burst Size (MBS) command configures the explicit definition of the maximum amount of buffers allowed for a specific queue.

The MBS value is used by a queue to determine whether it has exhausted all of its buffers while enqueuing packets. Once the queue has exceeded the amount of buffers allowed by MBS, all packets are discarded until packets have been drained from the queue.

The sap-ingress context for mbs provides a mechanism for overriding the default maximum size for the queue.

The sum of the MBS for all queues on an ingress access port can oversubscribe the total amount of buffering available. When congestion occurs and buffers become scarce, access to buffers is controlled by the RED slope a packet is associated with. A queue that has not exceeded its MBS size is not guaranteed that a buffer will be available when needed or that the packet’s RED slope will not force the discard of the packet. Setting proper CBS parameters and controlling CBS oversubscription is one major safeguard to queue starvation (when a queue does not receive its fair share of buffers). Another is properly setting the RED slope parameters for the needs of services on this port or channel.

The no form of this command returns the MBS size to the size as configured in the QoS policy.

Default 

no mbs

Parameters 
size—
This required parameter specifies that the MBS is expressed as an integer representing the required size in either bytes or kilobytes. The default is kilobytes. The optional byte and kilobyte keywords are mutually exclusive and are used to explicitly to define the size. By specifying the keyword default sets the MBS to its default value.
Values—
0 to 1073741824, default

 

bytes—
Specifies that the value given for size is interpreted as the queue'sMBS value in bytes.
kilobytes—
Specifies that the value given for size is interpreted as the queue's MBS value in kilobytes.

rate

Syntax 
rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
no rate
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>queue
Description 

This command defines the administrative Peak Information Rate (PIR) and the administrative Committed Information Rate (CIR) parameters for the queue. The PIR defines the maximum rate that the queue can transmit packets out an egress interface (for SAP egress queues). Defining a PIR does not necessarily guarantee that the queue can transmit at the intended rate. The actual rate sustained by the queue can be limited by oversubscription factors or available egress bandwidth.

The CIR defines the rate at which the system prioritizes the queue over other queues competing for the same bandwidth. In-profile then out-of-profile packets are preferentially queued by the system at egress and at subsequent next hop nodes where the packet can traverse. To be properly handled throughout the network, the packets must be marked accordingly for profiling at each hop.

The CIR can be used by the queue’s parent command’s cir-level and cir-weight parameters to define the amount of bandwidth considered to be committed for the child queue during bandwidth allocation by the parent scheduler.

The rate command can be executed at anytime, altering the PIR and CIR rates for all queues created through the association of the SAP egress QoS policy with the queue-id.

The no form of the command returns all queues created with the queue-id by association with the QoS policy to the default PIR and CIR parameters (max, 0).

Default 

no rate

Parameters 
pir-rate—
Defines the administrative PIR rate, in Kbps, for the queue. When the rate command is executed, a valid PIR setting must be explicitly defined. When the rate command has not been executed, the default PIR of max is assumed. Fractional values are not allowed and must be given as a positive integer.

The actual PIR rate is dependent on the queues adaptation-rule parameters and the actual hardware where the queue is provisioned.

Values—
1 to 2000000000, max

 

Default—
max
cir-rate—
Defines the administrative CIR rate, Kbps, for the queue. The cir parameter overrides the default administrative CIR used by the queue. When the rate command is executed, a CIR setting is optional. When the rate command has not been executed or the cir parameter is not explicitly specified, the default CIR (0) is assumed. Fractional values are not allowed and must be given as a positive integer.
Values—
0 to 2000000000, max

 

Default—
0

qos-marking-from-sap

Syntax 
[no] qos-marking-from-sap
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile>egress
Description 

This command sets the QoS policy from which the egress QoS marking rules are applied.

Note:

If applied to a managed SAP, the default s-egress qos-policy (sap-egress 1) cannot be changed.

The no form of the command reverts to the egress QoS marking defined in SAP-egress policy defined at sla-profile level.

Default 

qos-marking-from-sap

report-rate

Syntax 
report-rate agg-rate-limit
report-rate scheduler scheduler-name
report-rate pppoe-actual-rate
report-rate rfc5515-actual-rate
no report-rate
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress
Description 

This command configures the source for Tx and Rx connect speeds in AVP 38 (Rx Connect Speed) and AVP 24 (Tx Connect Speed) of an L2TP session established on a LAC.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no report-rate – Rates are taken from the physical port speed.

Parameters 
agg-rate-limit —
Specifies that the rate (egress only) is taken from:
  1. the agg-rate RADIUS override (RADIUS VSA “Alc-Subscriber-QoS-Override” in a RADIUS Access-Accept message) if present
  2. the configured agg-rate-limit in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>egr context
  3. fall back to the default (no report-rate)
scheduler-name
Specifies the rate taken from the scheduler scheduler-name up to 32 characters in length. If the scheduler scheduler-name is not present in the scheduler-policy configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>egr context, fall back to the default (no report-rate)
pppoe-actual-rate—
Specifies rates taken from the DSL Line characteristics PPPoE tags (Actual Data Rate Upstream/Downstream) if present; otherwise fall back to the default (no report-rate)
rfc5515-actual-rate—
Puts the same value as the transmitted Actual-Data-Rate-Upstream AVP in the Rx-Connect-Speed AVP, and the same value as the transmitted Actual-Data-Rate-Downstream AVP in the Tx-Connect-Speed AVP

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
no scheduler-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress
Description 

This command specifies a scheduler policy to associate to the sla profile. Scheduler policies are configured in the configure>qos>scheduler>policy context. Each scheduler policy is divided up into groups of schedulers based on the tier each scheduler is created under. A tier is used to give structure to the schedulers within a policy and define rules for parent scheduler associations. The policy defines the hierarchy and operating parameters for virtual schedulers.

The no form of the command removes the scheduler-policy-name from the configuration.

Default 

no scheduler-policy

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name —
Specifies an existing scheduler policy name up to 32 characters in length

scheduler

Syntax 
scheduler scheduler-name rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
no scheduler scheduler-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>sched
Description 

This command provides a way to override parameters of the existing scheduler associated with the egress scheduler policy. A scheduler defines bandwidth controls that limit each child (other schedulers and queues) associated with the scheduler. Scheduler objects are created within the hierarchical tiers of the policy. It is assumed that each scheduler created will have queues or other schedulers defined as child associations. The scheduler can be a child (take bandwidth from a scheduler in a higher tier).

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
scheduler-name
Specify an existing scheduler policy name up to 32 characters in length
pir-rate —
Specifies the PIR rate in Kbps. This parameter overrides the administrative PIR used by the scheduler. When the rate command is executed, a valid PIR setting must be explicitly defined. Fractional values are not allowed and must be given as a positive integer.
Values—
1 to 3200000000, max

 

Default—
none
cir-rate —
Specifies the CIR rate in Kbps. This parameter overrides the administrative CIR used by the scheduler. When the rate command is executed, a CIR setting is optional. The sum keyword specifies that the CIR be used as the summed CIR values of the children schedulers or queues. Fractional values are not allowed and must be given as a positive integer.
Values—
0 to 3200000000, sum, max

 

Default—
sum

use-ingress-l2tp-dscp

Syntax 
[no] use-ingress-l2tp-dscp
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress
Description 

This command enables the use of the DSCP marking taken from the L2TP header received on an L2TP Access Concentrator (LAC) for egress classification for the subscriber host using the associated sla-profile.

This command is ignored if the ingress packet is not identified as an L2TP packet.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no use-ingress-l2tp-dscp

one-time-http-redirection

Syntax 
one-time-http-redirection filter-id
one-time-http-redirection
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof
Description 

This command specify the one-time http redirection filter id. This filter will apply to the host when host is created, and will be replaced by the sla-profile ingress filter (configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress context) after first HTTP request from host has been redirected.

Note:

The system does not check if the configured filter include http-redirection entry. If the filter does not include the http-redirection then it will not be replaced in future.

If 7750 SR receives filter insertion via CoA or access-accept when one-time redirection filter is still active then the received filter entries will only be applied to the sla-profile ingress filter. And after 1st http redirection, the original sla-profile ingress filter + received filter will replace the redirection filter.

The no form of this command reverts to the default.

Default 

no one-time-http-redirection

Parameters 
filter-id—
Specifies the ID of filter that is used for HTTP redirection
Values—
1 to 65535

 

rate

Syntax 
rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
no rate
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos>queue
Description 

This command defines the administrative Peak Information Rate (PIR) and the administrative Committed Information Rate (CIR) parameters for the queue. The PIR defines the maximum rate that the queue can transmit packets through the switch fabric (for SAP ingress queues). Defining a PIR does not necessarily guarantee that the queue can transmit at the intended rate. The actual rate sustained by the queue can be limited by oversubscription factors or available egress bandwidth.

The CIR defines the rate at which the system prioritizes the queue over other queues competing for the same bandwidth. For SAP ingress, the CIR also defines the rate that packets are considered in-profile by the system. In-profile then out-of-profile packets are preferentially queued by the system at egress and at subsequent next hop nodes where the packet can traverse. To be properly handled throughout the network, the packets must be marked accordingly for profiling at each hop.

The CIR can be used by the queue’s parent command’s cir-level and cir-weight parameters to define the amount of bandwidth considered to be committed for the child queue during bandwidth allocation by the parent scheduler.

The rate command can be executed at anytime, altering the PIR and CIR rates for all queues created through the association of the SAP ingress or SAP egress QoS policy with the queue-id.

The no form of the command returns all queues created with the queue-id by association with the QoS policy to the default PIR and CIR parameters (max, 0).

Default 

no rate

Parameters 
pir-rate—
Defines the administrative PIR rate, in kilobits, for the queue. When the rate command is executed, a valid PIR setting must be explicitly defined. When the rate command has not been executed, the default PIR of max is assumed.

Fractional values are not allowed and must be given as a positive integer.

The actual PIR rate is dependent on the queues adaptation-rule parameters and the actual hardware where the queue is provisioned.

Values—
1 to 2000000000, max

 

Default—
max
cir-rate—
Specifies the cir parameter used by the queue. When the rate command is executed, a CIR setting is optional. When the rate command has not been executed or the cir parameter is not explicitly specified, the default CIR (0) is assumed.

Fractional values are not allowed and must be given as a positive integer.

Values—
0 to 2000000000, max

 

Default—
0

policer

Syntax 
policer policer-id [create]
no policer policer-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile>hsmda>ingress-qos>qos>policer
Description 

This command is used in the sap-ingress and sap-egress QoS policies to create, modify or delete a policer. Policers are created and used in a similar manner to queues. The policer ID space is separate from the queue ID space, allowing both a queue and a policer to share the same ID. The sap-ingress policy may have up to 32 policers (numbered 1 through 32) may be defined while the sap-egress QoS policy supports a maximum of 8 (numbered 1 through 8). While a policer may be defined within a QoS policy, it is not actually created on SAPs or subscribers associated with the policy until a forwarding class is mapped to the policer’s ID.

All policers must be created within the QoS policies. A default policer is not created when a sap-ingress or sap-egress QoS policy is created.

Once a policer is created, the policer's metering rate and profiling rates may be defined as well as the policer's maximum and committed burst sizes (MBS and CBS respectively). Unlike queues which have dedicated counters, policers allow various stat-mode settings that define the counters that will be associated with the policer. Another supported feature—packet-byte-offset—provides a policer with the ability to modify the size of each packet based on a defined number of bytes.

Once a policer is created, it cannot be deleted from the QoS policy unless any forwarding classes that are mapped to the policer are first moved to other policers or queues.

The system will allow a policer to be created on a SAP QoS policy regardless of the ability to support policers on objects where the policy is currently applied. The system only scans the current objects for policer support and sufficient resources to create the policer when a forwarding class is first mapped to the policer ID. If the policer cannot be created due to one or more instances of the policy not supporting policing or having insufficient resources to create the policer, the forwarding class mapping will fail.

The no form of this command is used to delete a policer from a sap-ingress or sap-egress QoS policy. The specified policer cannot currently have any forwarding class mappings for the removal of the policer to succeed. It is not necessary to actually delete the policer ID for the policer instances to be removed from SAPs or subscribers associated with the QoS policy once all forwarding classes have been moved away from the policer. It is automatically deleted from each policing instance although it still appears in the QoS policy.

Parameters 
policer-id
Specifies the policer ID. The policer-id must be specified when executing the policer command. If the specified ID already exists, the system enters that policer's context to allow the policer’s parameters to be modified. If the ID does not exist and is within the allowed range for the QoS policy type, a context for the policer ID will be created (depending on the system's current create keyword requirements which may require the create keyword to actually add the new policer ID to the QoS policy) and the system will enter that new policer’s context for possible parameter modification.
Values—
1 to 63

 

cbs

Syntax 
cbs size [bytes | kilobytes]
no cbs
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos>policer
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>policer
Description 

This command is used to configure the policer’s CIR leaky bucket’s exceed threshold. The CIR bucket’s exceed threshold represents the committed burst tolerance allowed by the policer. If the policer’s forwarding rate is equal to or less than the policer's defined CIR, the CIR bucket depth hovers around the 0 depth with spikes up to the maximum packet size in the offered load. If the forwarding rate increases beyond the profiling rate, the amount of data allowed to be in-profile above the rate is capped by the threshold.

The policer’s cbs size defined in the QoS policy may be overridden on an sla-profile or SAP where the policy is applied.

The no form of this command returns the policer to its default CBS size.

Default 

no cbs

Parameters 
size
Specifies the size parameter and is expressed as an integer representing the required size in either bytes or kilobytes. The default is kilobytes. The optional byte and kilobyte keywords are mutually exclusive and are used to explicitly define whether size represents bytes or kilobytes.
bytes—
Specifies the size parameter the size parameter in bytes. When bytes is defined, the value given for size is interpreted as the queue’s MBS value given in bytes
kilobytes—
Specifies the size parameter in kilobytes. When kilobytes is defined, the value is interpreted as the queue’s MBS value given in kilobytes
Values—
0 to 16777216

 

Default—
kilobyte

mbs

Syntax 
mbs size [bytes | kilobytes]
no mbs
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos>policer
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>policer
Description 

This command configures the MBS for the QoS policer.

Default 

no mbs

Parameters 
size—
This required parameter specifies that the MBS is expressed as an integer representing the required size in either bytes or kilobytes. The default is kilobytes. The optional byte and kilobyte keywords are mutually exclusive and are used to explicitly to define the size. By specifying the keyword default sets the MBS to its default value.
Values—
0 to 1073741824, default

 

bytes—
Specifies that the value given for size is interpreted as the queue'sMBS value in bytes.
kilobytes—
Specifies that the value given for size is interpreted as the queue's MBS value in kilobytes.

mbs

Syntax 
mbs size [bytes | kilobytes]
no mbs
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile>hsmda>egress-qos>qos>queue
Description 

This command overrides definition of the maximum amount of buffers allowed for a specific queue. The value is given in bytes or kilobytes and overrides the default value for the context.

The no form of the command returns the queue to its default MBS size.

Default 

none

Parameters 
size [bytes | kilobytes]
Specifies the and is expressed as an integer representing the required size in either bytes or kilobytes. The default is kilobytes. The optional byte and kilobyte keywords are mutually exclusive and are used to explicitly define whether size represents bytes or kilobytes.
byte—
When byte is defined, the value given for size is interpreted as the queue’s MBS value given in bytes
Values—
0 to 2688000

 

kilobyte—
When kilobytes is defined, the value is interpreted as the queue’s MBS value given in kilobytes
Values—
0 to 2625

 

Default—
kilobyte

packet-byte-offset

Syntax 
packet-byte-offset {add bytes | subtract bytes}
no packet-byte-offset
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos>policer
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>policer
Description 

This command is used to modify the size of each packet handled by the policer by adding or subtracting a number of bytes. The actual packet size is not modified; only the size used to determine the bucket depth impact is changed. The packet-byte-offset command is meant to be an arbitrary mechanism the can be used to either add downstream frame encapsulation or remove portions of packet headers. Both the policing metering and profiling throughput is affected by the offset as well as the stats associated with the policer.

When child policers are adding to or subtracting from the size of each packet, the parent policer’s min-thresh-separation value should also need to be modified by the same amount.

The policer’s packet-byte-offset defined in the QoS policy may be overridden on an sla-profile or SAP where the policy is applied. Packet byte offset settings are not included in the applied rate when (queue) frame based accounting is configured and the policer is managed by HQoS, however the offsets are applied to the statistics.

The no form of the command removes the per packet size modifications from the policer.

Default 

none

Parameters 
add bytes
Specifies the packet byte offset. The add keyword is mutually exclusive to the subtract keyword. Either add or subtract must be specified. When add is defined the corresponding bytes parameter specifies the number of bytes that is added to the size each packet associated with the policer for rate metering, profiling and accounting purposes. From the policer’s perspective, the maximum packet size is increased by the amount being added to the size of each packet.
Values—
0 to 31

 

Default—
None
subtract bytes
Specifies the packet byte offset. The subtract keyword is mutually exclusive to the add keyword. Either add or subtract must be specified. When b is defined the corresponding bytes parameter specifies the number of bytes that is subtracted from the size of each packet associated with the policer for rate metering, profiling and accounting purposes. From the policer’s perspective, the maximum packet size is reduced by the amount being subtracted from the size of each packet.
Note:

The minimum resulting packet size used by the system is 1 byte.

Values—
ingress 1 to 32
egress: 1 to 64

 

Default—
none

rate

Syntax 
rate {max | kilobits-per-second} [cir {max | kilobits-per-second}]
no rate
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos>policer
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>policer
Description 

This command is used to configure the policer’s metering and optional profiling rates. The metering rate is used by the system to configure the policer’s PIR leaky bucket’s decrement rate while the profiling rate configures the policer’s CIR leaky bucket’s decrement rate. The decrement function empties the bucket while packets applied to the bucket attempt to fill it based on the each packets size. If the bucket fills faster than how much is decremented per packet, the bucket’s depth eventually reaches it's exceed (CIR) or violate (PIR) threshold. The cbs, mbs, and high-prio-only commands are used to configure the policer’s PIR and CIR thresholds.

If a packet arrives at the policer while the bucket’s depth is less than the threshold associated with the packet, the packet is considered to be conforming to the bucket’s rate. If the bucket depth is equal to or greater than the threshold, the packet is considered to be in the exception state. For the CIR bucket, the exception state is exceeding the CIR rate while the PIR bucket's exception state is violating the PIR bucket rate. If the packet is violating the PIR, the packet is marked red and will be discarded. If the packet is not red, it may be green or yellow based on the conforming or exceeding state from the CIR bucket.

When a packet is red neither the PIR or CIR bucket depths are incremented by the packets size. When the packet is yellow the PIR bucket is incremented by the packet size, but the CIR bucket is not. When the packet is green, both the PIR and CIR buckets are incremented by the packet size. This ensures that conforming packets impact the bucket depth while exceeding or violating packets do not.

The policer’s adaptation-rule command settings are used by the system to convert the specified rates into hardware timers and decrement values for the policer’s buckets.

By default, the policer’s metering rate is max and the profiling rate is 0 Kbps (all packets out-of-profile).

The rate settings defined for the policer in the QoS policy may be overridden on an sla-profile or SAP where the policy is applied.

The no form of the command restores the default metering and profiling rate to a policer.

Parameters 
{max | kilobits-per-second}
Specifies the packet byte offset. Specifying the keyword max or an explicit kilobits-per-second parameter directly following the rate command is required and identifies the policer’s metering rate for the PIR leaky bucket. When the policer is first created, the metering rate defaults to max. The kilobits-per-second value must be expressed as an integer and defines the rate in kilobits-per-second. The integer value is multiplied by 1,000 to derive the actual rate in bits-per-second. When max is specified, the maximum policer rate used will be equal to the maximum capacity of the card on which the policer is configured. If the policer rate is set to a value larger than the maximum rate possible for the card, then the PIR used is equivalent to max.
Values—
max or 1 to 2000000000

 

cir {max | kilobits-per-second}
Specifies the packet byte offset. The optional cir keyword is used to override the default CIR rate of the policer. Specifying the keyword max or an explicit kilobits-per-second parameter directly following the cir keyword is required and identifies the policer’s profiling rate for the CIR leaky bucket. When the policer is first created, the profiling rate defaults to 0 Kbps. The kilobits-per-second value must be expressed as an integer and defines the rate in kilobits-per-second. The integer value is multiplied by 1,000 to derive the actual rate in bits-per-second. When max is specified, the maximum policer rate used will be equal to the maximum capacity of the card on which the policer is configured. If the policer rate is set to a value larger than the maximum rate possible for the card, then the CIR used is equivalent to max.
Values—
max or 0 to 2000000000

 

stat-mode

Syntax 
stat-mode stat-mode
no stat mode
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos>policer
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>ingress>qos>queue
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>policer
config>subscr-mgmt>sla-prof>egress>qos>queue
Description 

This command is used to configure the forwarding plane octet and packet counters of a policer or queue to count packets of a specific type or state. For example separate counters for IPv4/IPv6 or separate counters for offered high and low priority policed traffic.

For policers, this command overrides the policer stat-mode configuration as defined in the sap-ingress or sap-egress qos policy. For details on sap-ingress and sap-egress policer stat-mode, refer to the Quality of Service Guide. For use in Enhanced Subscriber Management (ESM) context only, an additional stat-mode enables separate counters for IPv4 and IPv6 packets.

When a policer’s stat-mode is changed while the sla profile is in use, any previous counter values are lost and any new counters are set to zero.

For queues, this command sets the stat-mode. Queue stat-mode is only available for use in Enhanced Subscriber Management (ESM) context to enable separate IPv4/IPv6 counters.

A queue’s stat-mode cannot be changed while the SLA profile is in use.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

For policers, the default is no stat-mode override. The sap-ingress or sap-egress stat-mode is used instead.

For queues, the default is to count in-/out-of-profile octets and packets.

Parameters 
stat-mode —
Specifies the stat mode for the policer

For ingress and egress qos queue stat-mode overrides

For ingress and egress qos policer stat-mode overrides, refer to the Quality of Service Guide for details on the sap-ingress and sap-egress policer stat-mode parameters.

For use in Enhanced Subscriber Management (ESM) context only:

Values—
no-stats, minimal, offered-profile-no-cir, offered-priority-no-cir, offered-profile-cir, offered-priority-cir, offered-total-cir, offered-limited-profile-cir, offered-profile-capped-cir, offered-limited-capped-cir, v4-v6 (count IPv4 and IPv6 forwarded/dropped octets and packets separately)

 

9.25.2.1.12. Subscriber Identification Policy Commands

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
[no] sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures a subscriber identification policy. Each subscriber identification policy can have a default subscriber profile defined. The subscriber identification policy default subscriber profile overrides the system default and the subscriber SAP default subscriber profiles. Defining a subscriber identification policy default subscriber profile is optional.

The subscriber identification policy default subscriber profile cannot be defined with the subscriber profile name default.

Defining a subscriber profile as a subscriber identification policy default subscriber profile will cause all active subscribers currently associated with a subscriber SAP using the policy and associated with a subscriber policy through the system default or subscriber SAP default subscriber profiles to be reassigned to the subscriber policy defined as default on the subscriber identification policy.

Attempting to delete a subscriber profile that is currently defined as a default for a subscriber identification policy will fail.

When attempting to remove a subscriber identification policy default subscriber profile definition, the system will evaluate each active subscriber on all subscriber SAPs the subscriber identification policy is currently associated with that are using the default definition to determine whether the active subscriber can be either reassigned to a subscriber SAP default or the system default subscriber profile. If all active subscribers cannot be reassigned, the removal attempt will fail.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
sub-ident-policy-name—
Specifies the name of the subscriber identification policy up to 32 characters in length

app-profile-map

Syntax 
app-profile-map
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol
Description 

This command enters the context to configure an application profile mapping.

entry

Syntax 
entry key app-profile-string app-profile app-profile-name
no entry key app-profile-string
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>app-profile-map
Description 

This command configures an application profile string.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

none

Parameters 
app-profile-string—
Specifies the application profile string up to 16 characters in length
app-profile-name—
Specifies the application profile name up to 32 characters in length

use-direct-map-as-default

Syntax 
[no] use-direct-map-as-default
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>app-profile-map
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>sla-profile-map
Description 

This command enables direct mapping of application profile as default. With this flag, a script returned string will be used as the named profile. If the named profiled cannot be found, the default profile will be used.

The no form of the command disables the direct mapping.

Default 

no use-direct-map-as-default

primary

Syntax 
primary
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol
Description 

This command enters the context to configure primary identification script parameters.

script-url

Syntax 
script-url dhcp-script-url
no script-url
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>primary
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>secondary
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>tertiary
Description 

This command specifies the URL of the identification scripts.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
dhcp-primary-script-url—
Specifies the URL of the primary identification script up to 180 characters in length
dhcp-secondary-script-url—
Specifies the URL of the secondary identification script up to 180 characters in length
dhcp-tertiary-script-url—
Specifies the URL of the tertiary identification script up to 180 characters in length

secondary

Syntax 
secondary
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol
Description 

This command enters the context to configure secondary identification script parameters.

sla-profile-map

Syntax 
sla-profile-map
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SLA profile mapping parameters.

sub-profile-map

Syntax 
sla-profile-map
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol
Description 

This command enters the context to configure subscriber profile mapping parameters.

entry

Syntax 
entry key sla-profile-string sla-profile sla-profile-name
no entry key sla-profile-string
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>sla-profile-map
Description 

This command configures an SLA profile string. Each subscriber identification string can be provisioned into a subscriber mapping table providing an explicit mapping of the string to a specific subscriber profile. This allows certain subscribers to be directly mapped to the appropriate subscriber profile in the event that the default mappings are not desired for the subscriber.

An explicit mapping of a subscriber identification string to a subscriber profile cannot be defined with the subscriber profile name default. It is possible for the subscriber identification string to be entered in the mapping table without a defined subscriber profile which can result in the explicitly defined subscriber to be associated with the subscriber profile named default.

Explicitly mapping a subscriber identification string to a subscriber profile will cause an existing active subscriber associated with the string to be reassigned to the newly mapped subscriber profile. An explicit mapping overrides all default subscriber profile definitions.

Attempting to delete a subscriber profile that is currently defined as in an explicit subscriber identification string mapping will fail.

The system will fail the removal attempt of an explicit subscriber identification string mapping to a subscriber profile definition when an active subscriber is using the mapping and cannot be reassigned to a defined default non-provisioned subscriber profile.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
sla-profile-string—
Identifies the SLA profile string up to 16 characters in length
sla-profile-name—
Identifies the SLA profile name up to 32 characters in length

entry

Syntax 
entry key sub-profile-string sub-profile sub-profile-name
no entry key sub-profile-string
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol>sub-profile-map
Description 

This command configures a subscriber profile string.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
sub-profile-string—
Specifies the subscriber profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length

tertiary

Syntax 
tertiary
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol
Description 

This command enters the context to configure tertiary identification script parameters.

9.25.2.1.12.1. Auto-Generated Subscriber Identification Key Commands

auto-sub-id-key

Syntax 
auto-sub-id-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to configure auto-generated subscriber identification key parameters.

ipoe-sub-id-key

Syntax 
ipoe-sub-id-key sub-id-key [sub-id-key...(up to 4 max)]
no ipoe-sub-id-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auto-sub-id-key
Description 

This command enables certain fields to become the base for auto-generation of the default sub-id name. The sub-id name will be auto generated if there is not a more specific method available. Such more specific methods would be a default sub-id name as a sap-id, a preconfigured static string or explicit mappings based on RADIUS/LUDB returned strings.

In case that a more specific sub-id name generation method is not available AND the auto-id keyword is defined under the def-sub-id hierarchy, the sub-id name will be generated by concatenating fields defined in this command separated by a “|” character.

The maximum sub-id name length is 32 characters while the concatenation of subscriber identification fields can easily exceed 32 characters. Subscriber host instantiation will fail in case that the sub-id name is based on subscriber identification fields whose concatenated length exceeds 32 characters. Failing the host creation rather than truncating sub-id name on a 32 character boundary will prevent collision of sub-ids (subscriber name duplication).

In case that a more specific sub-id name generation method is not available AND the auto-id keyword is not defined under the def-sub-id hierarchy, the sub-id name will be a random 10 character encoded string based on the fields defined under this command.

There is only one set of identification fields allowed per host type (IPoE or PPP) per chassis.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

ipoe-sub-id-key mac sap-id

Parameters 
sub-id-key—
Specifies the auto-generated sub-id keys for IPoE hosts
Values—
mac — Specifies that the MAC address can be combined with other subscriber host identification fields (circuit-id, remote-id, session-id or sap-id) to form a sub-id name in a user readable format or as a random 10 character encoded value.
In case that the mac address is used as a concatenation field in the sub-id name, then its format becomes a string xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx with the length 17B.
The MAC address as the subscriber host identification field is not applicable to PPPoA hosts or static hosts.
circuit-id — Specifies that the circuit-id can be combined with other subscriber host identification fields (mac, remote-id, session-id or sap-id) to form a sub-id name in a user readable format or as a random 10 character encoded value.
In case that the circuit-id is used as a concatenation field in the sub-id name, then its format becomes access-node-id eth slot/port:[vlan-id] or access-node-id atm slot/port:vpi.vci with a variable length.
Note:

If circuit-id contains any non printable ASCI characters, the entire circuit-id string will be formatted in hex in the sub-id name output. Otherwise all characters in circuit-id will be converted to ASCII. ASCII printable characters contain bytes in range 0x20 to 0x7E.

The circuit-id as the subscriber identification field is not applicable to PPPoA hosts, ARP hosts or static hosts.
remote-id — Specifies that the remote-id can be combined with other subscriber host identification fields (mac, circuit-id, session-id or sap-id) to form a sub-id name in a user readable format or as a random 10 character encoded value.
In case that the remote-id is used as a concatenation field in the sub-id name, then its format becomes a remote-id string with a variable length.
Note:

If remote-id contains any non printable ASCI characters, the entire remote-id string will be formatted in hex in the sub-id name output. Otherwise all characters in remote-id will be converted to ASCII. ASCII printable characters contain bytes in range 0x20 to 0x7E.

The remote-id as the subscriber identification field is not applicable to PPPoA hosts, ARP hosts or static hosts.
sap-id — Specifies that the sap-id can be combined with other subscriber host identification fields (mac, circuit-id, remote-id, or session-id) to form a sub-id name in a user readable format or as a random 10 character encoded value.
If a circuit-id is used as a concatenation field in the sub-id name, then its format becomes: slot/mda:[outer-vlan].[inner-vlan] with a variable length.
The sap-id as the subscriber identification field is applicable to all hosts types with exception of static hosts.
dual-stack-remote-id — Specifies that the dual stack remote ID is used as the base for the auto-generated subscriber identification

 

ppp-sub-id-key

Syntax 
ppp-sub-id-key sub-id-key [sub-id-key...(up to 5 max)]
no ppp-sub-id-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>auto-sub-id-key
Description 

This command enables certain fields to become the base for auto-generation of default sub-id name. The sub-id name will be auto-generated if there is not a more specific method available. Examples of these specific methods would be a default sub-id name as a sap-id, a preconfigured static string or explicit mappings based on RADIUS/LUDB returned strings.

In case that a more specific sub-id name generation method is not available and the auto-id keyword is defined under the def-sub-id hierarchy, the sub-id name will be generated by concatenating fields defined in this command separated by a “|” character.

The maximum sub-id name length is 32 characters while the concatenation of subscriber identification fields can easily exceed 32 characters. The subscriber host instantiation will fail if the sub-id name is based on subscriber identification fields whose concatenated length exceeds 32 characters. Failing the host creation rather than truncating sub-id name on a 32 character boundary will prevent collision of sub-ids (subscriber name duplication).

In case that a more specific sub-id name generation method is not available and the auto-id keyword is not defined under the def-sub-id hierarchy, the sub-id name will be a random 10 character encoded string based on the fields defined under this command.

There is only one set of identification fields allowed per host type (IPoE or PPP) per chassis.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

ppp-sub-id-key mac sap-id session-id

Parameters 
sub-id-key—
Specifies the auto-generated sub-id keys for PPP hosts.
Values—
mac — Specifies that the MAC address can be combined with other subscriber host identification fields (circuit-id, remote-id, session-id or sap-id) to form a sub-id name in a user readable format or as a random 10 character encoded value.
In case that the mac address is used as a concatenation field in the sub-id name, then its format becomes a string xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx with the length 17B.
The MAC address as the subscriber host identification field is not applicable to PPPoA hosts or static hosts.
circuit-id — Specifies that the circuit-id can be combined with other subscriber host identification fields (mac, remote-id, session-id or sap-id) to form a sub-id name in a user readable format or as a random 10 character encoded value.
If the circuit-id is used as a concatenation field in the sub-id name, then its format becomes access-node-id eth slot/port:[vlan-id] or access-node-id atm slot/port:vpi.vci with a variable length.
Note:

If circuit-id contains any non printable ASCI characters, the entire circuit-id string will be formatted in hex in the sub-id name output. Otherwise all characters in circuit-id will be converted to ASCII. ASCII printable characters contain bytes in range 0x20 to 0x7E.

If the circuit-id is used as the subscriber identification field is not applicable to PPPoA hosts, ARP hosts or static hosts.
remote-id — Specifies that the remote-id can be combined with other subscriber host identification fields (mac, circuit-id, session-id or sap-id) to form a sub-id name in a user readable format or as a random 10 character encoded value.
If the remote-id is used as a concatenation field in the sub-id name, then its format becomes a remote-id string with a variable length.
Note:

If remote-id contains any non printable ASCI characters, the entire remote-id string will be formatted in hex in the sub-id name output. Otherwise all characters in remote-id will be converted to ASCII. ASCII printable characters contain bytes in range 0x20 to 0x7E.

The remote-id as the subscriber identification field is not applicable to PPPoA hosts, ARP hosts or static hosts.
sap-id — The sap-id can be combined with other subscriber host identification fields (mac, circuit-id, remote-id, or session-id) to form a sub-id name in a user readable format or as a random 10 character encoded value.
In case that the circuit-id is used as a concatenation field in the sub-id name, then its format becomes : slot/mda:[outer-vlan].[inner-vlan] with a variable length.
The sap-id as the subscriber identification field is applicable to all hosts types with exception of static hosts.
session-id — The session-id can be combined with other subscriber host identification fields (mac, circuit-id, remote-id, or sap-id) to form a sub-id name in a user readable format or as a random 10 character encoded value.
In case that the circuit-id is used as a concatenation field in the sub-id name, then its format becomes a decimal number with variable length.
The session-id as the subscriber identification field is applicable only to PPPoE/PPPoEoA type hosts.

 

9.25.2.1.13. Subscriber Profile Commands

accu-stats-policy

Syntax 
accu-stats-policy policy-name [create]
no accu-stats-policy policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates a storage policy for cumulative statistics for subscribers. The policy defines the specific direction for the policer or the queue to be stored and performs the following functions.

  1. The policy stores subscriber statistics even if the subscriber session has ended. The subscriber statistics can be viewed even if the subscriber is offline.
  2. When the subscriber session ends, the statistics are added to the past statistics stored in memory so that all previous session statistics are accumulated. The accumulated statistics are reset to zero when the chassis reboots.

The no form of this command deletes the policy only when it is no longer referenced by a subscriber profile.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the name for the policy, to a maximum of 32 characters.
create—
Configures an entry for the policy.

entry

Syntax 
[no] entry direction direction type type id id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>accu-stats-policy
Description 

This command defines the direction of the policer or queue to the stored and accumulated policy.

The no form of this command removes the entry.

Parameters 
direction—
Specifies the direction of the queue or policer.
Values—
egress, ingress

 

type—
Specifies whether the entry is for a queue or policer.
Values—
queue, policer

 

id—
Specifies the queue or policer ID.
Values—
1 to 63

 

sub-profile

Syntax 
[no] sub-profile subscriber-profile-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to configure a subscriber profile. A subscriber profile is a template used to define the aggregate QoS for all hosts within a subscriber context. This is done through the definition of the egress and ingress scheduler policies that govern the aggregate SLA for subscribers using the subscriber profile. Subscriber profiles also allow for specific SLA profile definitions when the default definitions from the subscriber identification policy must be overridden.

Subscribers are either explicitly mapped to a subscriber profile template or are dynamically associated by one of various non-provisioned subscriber profile definitions.

A subscriber host can be associated with a subscriber profile in the following ways, listed from lowest to highest precedence:

  1. The subscriber profile named default.
  2. The subscriber profile defined as the subscriber SAP default.
  3. The subscriber profile found by the subscriber identification policy sub-profile-map.
  4. The subscriber profile found by the subscriber identification policy explicit map.

In the event that no defaults are defined and the subscriber identification string is not explicitly provisioned to map to a subscriber profile, either the static subscriber host creation will fail or the dynamic subscriber host DHCP ACK will be discarded.

Default Subscriber profile:

When a subscriber profile is created with the subscriber-profile-name default, it will be used when no other subscriber profile is associated with the subscriber host by the system. Creating a subscriber profile with the subscriber-profile-name default is optional. If a default subscriber profile is not created, all subscriber hosts subscriber identification strings must match either a non-provisioned default or be provisioned as an explicit match to a subscriber profile.

The default profile has no effect on existing active subscriber on the system as they exist due to higher precedence mappings.

Attempting to delete any subscriber profile (including the profile named default) while in use by existing active subscribers will fail.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
subscriber-profile-name—
Specifies the name of the subscriber profile up to 32 characters in length.

accounting-policy

Syntax 
accounting-policy acct-policy-id
no accounting-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command specifies the policy to use to collect accounting statistics on this subscriber profile.

A maximum of one accounting policy can be associated with a profile at one time. Accounting policies are configured in the config>log context.

The no form of this command removes the accounting policy association.

Default 

no accounting policy

Parameters 
acct-policy-id—
Specifies the accounting policy-id as configured in the config>log>accounting-policy context.
Values—
1 to 99

 

accu-stats-policy

Syntax 
accu-stats-policy policy-name
no accu-stats-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile
Description 

This command associates an accumulated statistics policy with a subscriber profile.

The no form of this command removes the association of the accu-stats-policy from the subscriber profile. It is possible to remove the policy from the subscriber profile while the subscriber is still online, however, the statistics remain in memory and must be cleared manually, using the clear subscriber-mgmt accu-stats active-subs no-accu-stats-policy command.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the accumulated statistics policy to be used, to a maximum of 32 characters.

collect-stats

Syntax 
[no] collect-stats
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

When enabled, the agent collects non-RADIUS accounting statistics.

When the no collect-stats command is issued the statistics are still accumulated by the IOM cards. However, the CPU will not obtain the results and write them to the billing file. If a subsequent collect-stats command is issued then the counters written to the billing file include all the traffic while the no collect-stats command was in effect.

Default 

collect-stats

agg-rate-limit

Syntax 
agg-rate-limit {max | kilobits-per-second} [queue-frame-based-accounting]
no agg-rate-limit
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>egress
Description 

This command define a subscriber aggregate limit when the subscriber profile is directly associated with an egress port based scheduler instead of a scheduler policy. The optional queue-frame-based-accounting keyword allows the subscriber queues to operate in the frame based accounting mode.

Once egress frame based accounting is enabled on the subscriber profile, all queues associated with the subscriber (created through the sla-profile associated with each subscriber host) will have their rate and CIR values interpreted as frame based values. When shaping, the queues will include the 12-byte Inter-Frame Gap (IFG) and 8-byte preamble for each packet scheduled out the queue. The profiling CIR threshold will also include the 20-byte frame encapsulation overhead. Statistics associated with the queue do not include the frame encapsulation overhead. Packet byte offset settings are not included in the applied rate when queue frame based accounting is configured, however the offsets are applied to the statistics.

The queue-frame-based-accounting keyword does not change the behavior of the egress-agg-rate-limit rate value. Since the egress-agg-rate-limit is always associated with egress port based scheduling and egress port based scheduling is dependent on frame based operation, the egress-agg-rate-limit rate is always interpreted as a frame based value.

Enabling queue-frame-based-accounting will not cause statistics for queues associated with the subscriber to be cleared.

The no form of the command removes both an egress aggregate rate limit and egress frame based accounting for all subscribers associated with the sub-profile. If a subscriber’s accounting mode is changed, the subscriber’s queue statistics are cleared.

Parameters 
{max | kilobits-per-second}
Specifies the egress aggregate rate limit. The max keyword and kilobits-per-second parameter are mutually exclusive. Either max or a value for kilobits-per-second must follow the egress-agg-rate-limit command.
max—
Specifies that the egress aggregate rate limit for the subscriber is unlimited. Scheduling for the subscriber queues will only be governed by the individual queue parameters and any congestion on the port relative to each queues scheduling priority.
kilobits-per-second—
Specifies an actual egress aggregate rate to which all queues associated with the sub-profile will be limited. The limit will be managed per subscriber associated with the sub-profile. The value must be defined as an integer and is representative of increments of 1000 bits per second.
Values—
1 to 800000000

 

Default—
max
queue-frame-based-accounting—
Enables frame based accounting on all queues associated with the subscriber profile. If frame based accounting is required when a subscriber aggregate limit is not necessary, the max keyword should precede the queue-frame-based-accounting keyword. If frame based accounting must be disabled, execute the egress-agg-rate-limit command without the queue-frame-based-accounting keyword present.
Default—
Frame based accounting is disabled by default
queue-frame-based-accounting—
Specifies whether to use frame-based accounting when evaluating the aggregation rate limit for the egress queues for this SAP

avg-frame-size

Syntax 
avg-frame-size bytes
no avg-frame-size
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile>egress
Description 

This command specifies the average frame size used in the calculation of the fixed and variable encapsulation offset when the encap-offset command is enabled in the egress context of a subscriber profile.

If the user does not explicitly configure a value for the avg-frame-size parameter, then it will also be assumed the offset is zero.

The no form of the command removes the avg-frame-size parameter from the subscriber profile.

Default 

0

Parameters 
bytes—
Specifies the average frame size value to be used in the adjustment of the subscriber aggregate rate to account for the per packet variable expansion of the last mile for the specific session used by the subscriber host.
Values—
64 to 4096

 

encap-offset

Syntax 
encap-offset [type type]
no encap-offset
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile>egress
Description 

This command enables the adjustment of the queue and subscriber aggregate rate based on the last mile Ethernet or ATM encapsulation.

The data path computes the adjusted frame size real-time for each serviced packet from a queue by adding the actual packet size to the fixed offset provided by CPM for this queue and variable AAL5 padding.

When this command is enabled, the fixed packet offset is derived from the encapsulation type value signaled in the Access-loop-encapsulation sub-TLV in the Vendor-Specific PPPoE Tags or DHCP Relay Options as per RFC 4679. If the user specifies an encapsulation type with the command, this value is used as the default value for all hosts of this subscriber until a host session signaled a valid value. The signaled value is applied to this host only and the remaining hosts of this subscriber continue to use the user entered default type value if configured, or no offset is applied. However, hosts of the same subscriber using the same SLA profile and which are on the same SAP will share the same instance of FC queues. In this case, the last valid encapsulation value signaled by a host of that same instance of the SAP egress QoS policy will override any previous signaled or configured value.

If the user manually applied a constant byte offset to each packet serviced by the queue by configuring the packet-byte-offset, it will have no effect on the net offset computed for the packet. This net offset is stored in the subscriber host table.

The procedures for handling signaling changes or configuration changes affecting the subscriber profile are as follows:

The avg-frame-size parameter in the subscriber profile is ignored.

If the user specifies an encapsulation type with the command, this value is used as the default value for all hosts of this subscriber until a host session signaled a valid value. The signaled value is applied to this host and other hosts of the same subscriber sharing the same SLA profile and which are on the same SAP. The remaining hosts of this subscriber continue to use the user entered default type value if configured, or no offset is applied.

If the user enables/disables the encap-offset option, or changes the parameter value of the encap-offset option, CPM immediately triggers a re-evaluation of subscribers hosts using the corresponding subscriber profile and an update the IOM with the new fixed offset value.

If a subscriber has a static host or an ARP host, the subscriber host continues to use the user-configured default encapsulation type value or the last valid encapsulation value signaled in the PPPoE tags or DHCP relay options by other hosts of the same subscriber which use the same SLA profile instance. If none was signaled or configured, then no rate adjustment is applied.

When the encap-offset option is configured in the subscriber profile, the subscriber host queue rates, that is, CLI and operational PIR and CIR as well as queue bucket updates, the queue statistics, that is, forwarded, dropped, and HQoS offered counters use the last-mile frame-over-the-wire format. The scheduler policy CLI and operational rates also use LM-FoW format. The port scheduler max-rate and the priority level rates and weights, if a Weighted Scheduler Group is used, are always entered in CLI and interpreted as local port frame-over-the-wire rates. The same is true for an agg-rate-limit applied to a Vport. Finally the subscriber agg-rate-limit is entered in CLI as last-mile frame-over-the-wire rate. The system maintains a running average frame expansion ratio for each queue to convert queue rates between these two formats.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
type type
The name of the default encapsulation used for all host queues of a subscriber in the absence of a valid value signaled in the PPPoE tags
Values—
pppoa-llc, pppoa-null, pppoeoa-llc, pppoeoa-llc-fcs, pppoeoa-llc-tagged, pppoeoa-llc-tagged-fcs, pppoeoa-null, pppoeoa-null-fcs, pppoeoa-null-tagged, pppoeoa-null-tagged-fcs, ipoa-llc, ipoa-null, ipoeoa-llc, ipoeoa-llc-fcs, ipoeoa-llc-tagged, ipoeoa-llc-tagged-fcs, ipoeoa-null, ipoeoa-null-fcs, ipoeoa-null-tagged, ipoeoa-null-tagged-fcs, pppoe, pppoe-tagged, ipoe, ipoe-tagged

 

scheduler

Syntax 
scheduler scheduler-name rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
no scheduler scheduler-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>egress>sched
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>ingress>sched
Description 

This command provides a way to override parameters of the existing scheduler associated with the egress or ingress scheduler policy. A scheduler defines bandwidth controls that limit each child (other schedulers and queues) associated with the scheduler. Scheduler objects are created within the hierarchical tiers of the policy. It is assumed that each scheduler created will have queues or other schedulers defined as child associations. The scheduler can be a child (take bandwidth from a scheduler in a higher tier).

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
scheduler scheduler-policy-name—
Specify an existing scheduler policy name.
pir-rate—
Specify the pir-rate, in kilobits, to override the administrative PIR used by the scheduler. When the rate command is executed, a valid PIR setting must be explicitly defined Fractional values are not allowed and must be given as a positive integer.
Values—
1 to 3200000000, max

 

Default—
none
cir-rate—
The cir parameter overrides the administrative CIR used by the scheduler. When the rate command is executed, a CIR setting is optional. The sum keyword specifies that the CIR be used as the summed CIR values of the children schedulers or queues. Fractional values are not allowed and must be given as a positive integer.
Values—
0 to 3200000000, sum, max

 

Default—
sum

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
no scheduler-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile>egress
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile>ingress
Description 

This command specifies a scheduler policy to associate to the subscriber profile. Scheduler policies are configured in the configure>qos>scheduler>policy context. Each scheduler policy is divided up into groups of schedulers based on the tier each scheduler is created under. A tier is used to give structure to the schedulers within a policy and define rules for parent scheduler associations. The policy defines the hierarchy and operating parameters for virtual schedulers.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name—
Specify an existing scheduler policy name up to 32 characters in length

lag-per-link-hash

Syntax 
lag-per-link-hash class {class} weight weight
no lag-per-link-hash
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile>egress
Description 

This command configures weight and class to be used on LAG egress when the LAG uses weighted per-link-hash by subscribers with the profile assigned. Subscribers using profile with lag-per-link-hash default configuration, inherit weight and class from the SAP configuration (1 and 1 respectively if none configured under SAP).

The no form of this command restores default configuration.

Default 

no lag-per-link-hash

Parameters 
class—
Specifies the class to be used to select a LAG link
Values—
1, 2, 3

 

Default—
1
weight—
Specifies the weight to be associated with this SAP when selecting a LAG link
Values—
1 to 1024

 

Default—
1

policer-control-policy

Syntax 
policer-control-policy policy-name [create]
no policer-control-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>ingress
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>egress
Description 

This command is used to create, delete, or modify policer control policies. The policer-control-policy controls the aggregate bandwidth available to a set of child policers. Once created, the policy can be applied to ingress or egress SAPs. The policy can also be applied to the ingress or egress context of a sub-profile.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no policer-control-policy

Parameters 
policy-name
Specifies the policer control policy name. Each policer-control-policy must be created with a unique policy name. The name must given as policy-name must adhere to the system policy ASCII naming requirements. If the defined policy-name already exists, the system will enter that policy’s context for editing purposes. If policy-name does not exist, the system will attempt to create a policy with the specified name. Creating a policy may require use of the create parameter when the system is configured for explicit object creation mode.
Default—
None
create
The create keyword is required when a new policy is being created and the system is configured for explicit object creation mode

max-rate

Syntax 
max-rate {kilobits-per-second | max}
no max-rate
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>ingress>policer-control-policy
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>egress>policer-control-policy
Description 

The max-rate command defines the parent policer’s PIR leaky bucket’s decrement rate. A parent policer is created for each time the policer-control-policy is applied to either a SAP or subscriber instance. Packets that are not discarded by the child policers associated with the SAP or subscriber instance are evaluated against the parent policer’s PIR leaky bucket.

For each packet, the bucket is first decremented by the correct amount based on the decrement rate to derive the current bucket depth. The current depth is then compared to one of two discard thresholds associated with the packet. The first discard threshold (discard-unfair) is applied if the FIR (Fair Information Rate) leaky bucket in the packet’s child policer is in the confirming state. The second discard threshold (discard-all) is applied if the child policer's FIR leaky bucket is in the exceed state. Only one of the two thresholds is applied per packet. If the current depth of the parent policer PIR bucket is less than the threshold value, the parent PIR bucket is in the conform state for that particular packet. If the depth is equal to or greater than the applied threshold, the bucket is in the violate state for the packet.

If the result is “conform,” the bucket depth is increased by the size of the packet (plus or minus the per-packet-offset setting in the child policer) and the packet is not discarded by the parent policer. If the result is “violate,” the bucket depth is not increased and the packet is discarded by the parent policer. When the parent policer discards a packet, any bucket depth increases (PIR, CIR and FIR) in the parent policer caused by the packet are canceled. This prevents packets that are discarded by the parent policer from consuming the child policers PIR, CIR and FIR bandwidth.

The policer-control-policy root max-rate setting may be overridden on each SAP or sub-profile where the policy is applied.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

max

Parameters 
kilobits-per-second
Specifies the max rate in Kbps. Defining the kilobits-per-second value is mutually exclusive with the max parameter. The kilobits-per-second value must be defined as an integer that represents the number of kilobytes that the parent policer will be decremented per second. The actual decrement is performed per packet based on the time that has elapsed since the last packet associated with the parent policer.
Values—
Integer 0 – 2000000000

 

max—
Specifies the maximum frame-based bandwidth limit of this policer. The max parameter is mutually exclusive with defining a kilobits-per-second value. When max is specified, the parent policer does not enforce a maximum rate on the aggregate throughput of the child policers. This is the default setting when the policer-control-policy is first created and is the value that the parent policer returns to when no max-rate is executed. In order for the parent policer to be effective, a kilobits-per-second value should be specified.

priority-mbs-thresholds

Syntax 
priority-mbs-thresholds
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>ingress>policer-control-policy
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>egress>policer-control-policy
Description 

The priority-mbs-thresholds command contains the root arbiter parent policer’s min-thresh-separation command and each priority level’s mbs-contribution command that is used to internally derive each priority level’s shared-portion and fair-portion values. The system uses each priority level’s shared-portion and fair-portion value to calculate each priority level’s discard-unfair and discard-all MBS thresholds that enforce priority sensitive rate-based discards within the root arbiter’s parent policer.

The priority-mbs-thresholds CLI node always exists and does not need to be created.

min-thresh-separation

Syntax 
min-thresh-separation size [bytes | kilobytes]
no min-thresh-separation
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>ingress>policer-control-policy>priority-mbs-thresholds
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>egress>policer-control-policy>priority-mbs-thresholds
Description 

The min-thresh-separation command defines the minimum required separation between each in-use discard threshold maintained for each parent policer context associated with the policer-control-policy. The min-thresh-separation value may be overridden on each SAP or sub-profile to which the policy is applied.

The system uses the default or specified min-thresh-separation value in order to determine the minimum separation required between each of the of the parent policer discard thresholds. The system enforces the minimum separation based on the following behavior in two ways. The first is determining the size of the shared-portion for each priority level (when the mbs-contribution command’s optional fixed keyword is not specified):

  1. When a parent policer instance’s priority level has less than two child policers associated, the shared-portion for the level will be zero.
  2. When a parent policer instance’s priority level has two or more child policers associated, the shared-portion for the level will be equal to the current value of min-thresh-separation.

The second function the system uses the min-thresh-separation value for is determining the value per priority level for the fair-portion:

  1. When a parent policer instance’s priority level has no child policers associated, the fair-portion for the level will be zero.
  2. When a parent policer instance’s priority level has one child policer associated, the fair-portion will be equal to the maximum of the min-thresh-separation value and the priority level’s mbs-contribution value.
  3. When a parent policer instance's priority level has two or more child policers associated, the fair-portion will be equal to the maximum of the following:
    1. min-thresh-separation value
    2. The priority level’s mbs-contribution value less min-thresh-separation value

When the mbs-contribution command’s optional fixed keyword is defined for a priority level within the policy, the system will treat the defined mbs-contribution value as an explicit definition of the priority level’s MBS. While the system will continue to track child policer associations with the parent policer priority levels, the association counters will have no effect. Instead the following rules will be used to determine a fixed priority level’s shared-portion and fair-portion:

  1. If a fixed priority level’s mbs-contribution value is set to zero, both the shared-portion and fair-portion will be set to zero
  2. If the mbs-contribution value is not set to zero:
    1. The shared-portion will be set to the current min-thresh-separation value
    2. The fair-portion will be set to the maximum of the following:

min-thresh-separation value

mbs-contribution value less min-thresh-separation value

Each time the min-thresh-separation value is modified, the thresholds for all instances of the parent policer created through association with this policer-control-policy are reevaluated.

Determining the Correct Value for the Minimum Threshold Separation Value

The minimum value for min-thresh-separation should be set equal to the maximum size packet that will be handled by the parent policer. This ensures that when a lower priority packet is incrementing the bucket, the size of the increment will not cause the bucket's depth to equal or exceed a higher priority threshold. It also ensures that an unfair packet within a priority level cannot cause the PIR bucket to increment to the discard-all threshold within the priority.

When evaluating maximum packet size, each child policer’s per-packet-offset setting should be taken into consideration. If the maximum size packet is 1518 bytes and a per-packet-offset parameter is configured to add 20 bytes per packet, min-thresh-separation should be set to 1538 due to the fact that the parent policer will increment its PIR bucket using the extra 20 bytes.

In most circumstances, a value larger than the maximum packet size is not necessary. Management of priority level aggregate burst tolerance is intended to be implemented using the priority level mbs-contribution command. Setting a value larger than the maximum packet size will not adversely affect the policer performance, but it may increase the aggregate burst tolerance for each priority level.

Note:

A priority level’s shared-portion of the parent policer’s PIR bucket depth is only necessary to provide some separation between a lower priority’s discard-all threshold and this priority’s discard-unfair threshold. It is expected that the burst tolerance for the unfair packets is relatively minimal since the child policers feeding the parent policer priority level all have some amount of fair burst before entering into an FIR exceed or unfair state. The fair burst amount for a priority level is defined using the mbs-contribution command.

The no form of this command returns the policy’s min-thresh-separation value to the default value.

Default 

no min-thresh-separation

Parameters 
size [bytes | kilobytes]
The size parameter is required when executing the min-thresh-separation command. It is expressed as an integer and specifies the shared portion in bytes or kilobytes that is selected by the trailing bytes or kilobytes keywords. If both bytes and kilobytes are missing, kilobytes is the assumed value. Setting this value has no effect on parent policer instances where the min-thresh-separation value has been overridden.
Values—
0 – 16777216

 

Default—
none
[bytes | kilobytes]
The bytes keyword is optional and is mutually exclusive with the kilobytes keyword. When specified, size is interpreted as specifying the size of min-thresh-separation in bytes.

The kilobytes keyword is optional and is mutually exclusive with the bytes keyword. When specified, size is interpreted as specifying the size of min-thresh-separation in kilobytes.

Values—
bytes or kilobytes

 

Default—
kilobytes

priority

Syntax 
priority level
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>ingress>policer-control-policy>priority-mbs-thresholds
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>egress>policer-control-policy>priority-mbs-thresholds
Description 

The priority level command contains the mbs-contribution configuration command for a given strict priority level. Eight levels are supported numbered 1 through 8 with 8 being the highest strict priority.

Each of the eight priority CLI nodes always exists and do not need to be created. While parameters exist for each priority level, the parameters are only applied when the priority level within a parent policer instance is currently supporting child policers.

mbs-contribution

Syntax 
mbs-contribution size [bytes | kilobytes] [fixed]
no mbs-contribution
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>ingress>policer-control-policy>priority-mbs-thresholds>priority
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>egress>policer-control-policy>priority-mbs-thresholds>priority
Description 

The mbs-contribution command is used to configure the policy-based burst tolerance for a parent policer instance created when the policy is applied to a SAP or subscriber context. The system uses the parent policer’s min-thresh-separation value, the priority level’s mbs-contribution value and the number of child policers currently attached to the priority level to derive the priority level’s shared-portion and fair-portion of burst tolerance within the local priority level. The shared-portion and fair-portions for each priority level are then used by the system to calculate each priority level’s discard-unfair threshold and discard-all threshold.

The value for a priority level’s mbs-contribution within the policer-control-policy may be overridden on the SAP or subscriber sub-profile where the policy is applied in order to allow fine tuning of the discard-unfair and discard-all thresholds relevant to the needs of the local child policers on the object.

Accumulative Nature of Burst Tolerance for a Parent Policer Priority Level

When defining mbs-contribution, the specified size may only be a portion of the burst tolerance associated with the priority level. The packets associated with the priority level share the burst tolerance of lower within the parent policer. As the parent policer PIR bucket depth increases during congestion, the lower priority packets eventually experience discard based on each priority’s discard-unfair and discard-all thresholds. Assuming congestion continues once all the lower priority packets have been prevented from consuming bucket depth, the burst tolerance for the priority level will be consumed by its own packets and any packets associated with higher priorities.

The Effect of Fair and Unfair Child Policer Traffic at a Parent Policer Priority Level

The system continually monitors the offered rate of each child policer on each parent policer priority level and detects when the policer is in a congested state (the aggregate offered load is greater than the decrement rate defined on the parent policer). As previously stated, the result of congestion is that the parent policer's bucket depth will increase until it eventually hovers around either a discard-unfair or discard-all threshold belonging to one of the priority levels. This threshold is the point where enough packets are being discarded that the increment rate and decrement rate begin to even out. If only a single child policer is associated to the priority level, the discard-unfair threshold is not used since fairness is only applicable when multiple child policers are competing at the same priority level.

When multiple child policers are sharing the congested priority level, the system uses the offered rates and the parenting parameters of each child to determine the fair rate per child when the parent policer is unable to meet the bandwidth needs of each child. The fair rate represents the amount of bandwidth that each child at the priority level should receive relative to the other children at the same level according to the policer control policy instance managing the child policers. This fair rate is applied as the decrement rate for each child's FIR bucket. Changing a child’s FIR rate does not modify the amount of packets forwarded by the parent policer for the child’s priority level. It simply modifies the forwarded ratio between the children on that priority level. Since each child FIR bucket has some level of burst tolerance before marking its packets as unfair, the current parent policer bucket depth may at times rise above the discard-unfair threshold. The mbs-contribution value provides a means to define how much separation is provided between the priority level’s discard-unfair and discard-all threshold to allow the parent policer to absorb some amount of FIR burst before reaching the priority’s discard-all threshold.

This level of fair aggregate burst tolerance is based on the decrement rate of the parent policer’s PIR bucket while the individual fair bursts making up the aggregate are based on each child’s FIR decrement rate. The aggregate fair rate of the priority level is managed by the system with consideration of the current rate of traffic in higher priority levels. In essence, the system ensures that for each iteration of the child FIR rate calculation, the sum of the child FIR decrement rates plus the sum of the higher priority traffic increment rates equals the parent policers decrement rate. This means that dynamic amounts of higher priority traffic can be ignored when sizing a lower priority’s fair aggregate burst tolerance. Consider the following:

  1. The parent policer decrement rate is set to 20 Mbps (max-rate 20,000).
  2. A priority level’s fair burst size is set to 30 kbytes (mbs-contribution 30 kbytes).
  3. Higher priority traffic is currently taking 12 Mb/s.
  4. The priority level has three child policers attached.
  5. Each child’s PIR MBS is set to 10 kbytes, which makes each child’s FIR MBS 10 kbytes.
  6. The children want 10 Mbps, but only 8 Mb/s is available,
  7. Based on weights, the children's FIR rates are set as follows:

    FIR Rate

    FIR MBS

    Child 1

    4 Mb/s

    10 kbytes

    Child 2

    3 Mb/s

    10 kbytes

    Child 3

    1 Mb/s

    10 kbytes

The 12 Mbps of the higher priority traffic and the 8 Mbps of fair traffic equal the 20 Mbps decrement rate of the parent policer.

It is clear that the higher priority traffic is consuming 12 Mbps of the parent policer’s decrement rate, leaving 8 Mbps of decrement rate for the lower priority’s fair traffic.

  1. The burst tolerance of child 1 is based on 10 kbytes above 4 Mb/s,
  2. The burst tolerance of child 2 is based on 10 kbytes above 3 Mb/s,
  3. The burst tolerance of child 3 is based on 10 kbytes above 1 Mb/s.

If all three children burst simultaneously (unlikely), they will consume 30 kbytes above 8 Mb/s. This is the same as the remaining decrement rate after the higher priority traffic.

Parent Policer Total Burst Tolerance and Downstream Buffering

The highest in-use priority level’s discard-all threshold is the total burst tolerance of the parent policer. In some cases the parent policer represents downstream bandwidth capacity and the max-rate of the parent policer is set to prevent overrunning the downstream bandwidth. The burst tolerance of the parent policer defines how much more traffic may be sent beyond the downstream scheduling capacity. In the worst case scenario, when the downstream buffering is insufficient to handle the total possible burst from the parent policer, downstream discards based on lack of buffering may occur. However, in all likelihood, this is not the case.

In most cases, lower priority traffic in the policer will be responsible for the greater part of congestion above the parent policer rate. Since this traffic is discarded with a lower threshold, this lowers the effective burst tolerance even while the highest priority traffic is present.

Configuring a Priority Level's MBS Contribution Value

In the most conservative case, a priority level’s mbs-contribution value may be set to be greater than the sum of child policer’s mbs and one max-size-frame per child policer. This ensures that even in the absolute worst case where all the lower priority levels are simultaneously bursting to the maximum capacity of each child, enough burst tolerance for the priority’s children will exist if they also burst to their maximum capacity.

Since simply adding up all the child policer’s PIR MBS values may result in large overall burst tolerances that are not ever likely to be needed, you should consider some level of burst oversubscription when configuring the mbs-contribution value for each priority level. The amount of oversubscription should be determined based on the needs of each priority level.

Using the Fixed Keyword to Create Deterministic Parent Policer Discard Thresholds

In the default behavior, the system ignores the mbs-contribution values for a priority level on a subscriber or SAP parent policer when a child policer is not currently associated with the level. This prevents additional burst tolerance from being added to higher priority traffic within the parent policer.

This does cause fluctuations in the defined threshold values when child policers are added or removed from a parent policer instance. If this behavior is undesirable, the fixed keyword may be used which causes the mbs-contribution value to always be included in the calculation of parent policer’s discard thresholds. The defined mbs-contribution value may be overridden on a subscriber sla-profile or on a SAP instance, but the fixed nature of the contribution cannot be overridden.

If the defined mbs-contribution value for the priority level is zero, the priority level will have no effect on the parent policer’s defined discard thresholds. A packet associated with the priority level will use the next lower priority level’s discard-unfair and discard-all thresholds.

The no mbs-contribution command returns the policy’s priority level’s MBS contribution to the default value. When changed, the thresholds for the priority level and all higher priority levels for all instances of the parent policer will be recalculated.

Default 

no mbs-contribution

Parameters 
size [bytes | kilobytes]
The size parameter is required when executing the mbs-contribution command. It is expressed as an integer and specifies the priority’s specific portion amount of accumulative MBS for the priority level in bytes or kilobytes which is selected by the trailing bytes or kilobytes keywords. If both bytes and kilobytes are missing, kilobytes is assumed. Setting this value has no effect on parent policer instances where the priority level’s mbs-contribution value has been overridden.
Values—
0 to 16777216

 

Default—
none
bytes | kilobytes:
The bytes keyword is optional and is mutually exclusive with the kilobytes keyword. When specified, size is interpreted as specifying the size of min-thresh-separation in bytes.

The kilobytes keyword is optional and is mutually exclusive with the bytes keyword. Size is interpreted as specifying the size of min-thresh-separation in kilobytes.

Default—
kilobytes
fixed—
This optional fixed keyword is used to force the inclusion of the defined mbs-contribution value in the parent policer’s discard threshold calculations. If the mbs-contribution command is executed without the fixed keyword, the fixed calculation behavior for the priority level is removed.

radius-accounting

Syntax 
radius-accounting
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command enters the RADIUS accounting context for configuring RADIUS accounting subscriber profile parameters.

policy

Syntax 
policy name1 [name2] [name3] [name4] [name5]
no policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>rad-acct
Description 

This command specifies the RADIUS accounting policy for the subscriber that is using this subscriber profile. This command allows the configuration of up to five RADIUS accounting policies. The RADIUS accounting policies function according to their respective configuration, including the individual accounting mode, their own included attributes, and the update interval.

Default 

no policy

Parameters 
name1—
Specifies the name of the RADIUS accounting policy to be used for the subscriber profile (32 characters maximum)
name2
Specifies the name of the second RADIUS accounting policy to be used for the subscriber profile (32 characters maximum)
name3
Specifies the name of the third RADIUS accounting policy to be used for the subscriber profile (32 characters maximum)
name4
Specifies the name of the fourth RADIUS accounting policy to be used for the subscriber profile (32 characters maximum)
name5
Specifies the name of the fifth RADIUS accounting policy to be used for the subscriber profile (32 characters maximum)

session-optimized-stop

Syntax 
[no] session-optimized-stop
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>rad-acct
Description 

This command optimizes a RADIUS Accounting Stop message for a PPPoE session termination (specifically for session accounting mode when the host update is enabled). By default when a PPPoE session terminates, the system removes a dual stack host in sequence, one host at a time. Therefore, the system will generate a RADIUS accounting interim for each host termination until only the final host is left. The final host will generate a final accounting stop message. Enabling this command will trigger a single Stop RADIUS accounting message and include information of all hosts without the host updates.

Default 

no session-optimized-stop

sla-profile-map

Syntax 
sla-profile-map
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SLA profile mapping.

entry

Syntax 
entry key sub-profile-string sub-profile sub-profile-name
no entry key sub-profile-string
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>sla-prof-map
Description 

This command configures SLA profile string mappings.

Parameters 
sub-profile-string—
Specifies the subscriber profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length

use-direct-map-as-default

Syntax 
[no] use-direct-map-as-default
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>sla-prof-map
Description 

This command enables direct mapping of the SLA profile as default.

The no form of the command disables direct mapping.

sub-mcac-policy

Syntax 
sub-mcac-policy policy-name
no sub-mcac-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command references the policy template in which the mcac bandwidth limits are defined. Mcac for the subscriber is effectively enabled with this command when the sub-profile is applied to the subscriber. The bandwidth of the channels is defined in a different policy (under the config>router>mcac context) and this policy is applied on the interface level as follows:

  1. For group-interfaces under the config>service>vprn>igmp>grp-if>mcac context
  2. For regular interfaces under the config>service/router>igmp>interface>mcac context

In case of HQoS Adjustment, it is mandatory that the sub-mcac-policy be created and applied to the subscriber. The sub-mac-policy does not have to contain any bandwidth constrains, but it has to be in a no shutdown state in order for HQoS Adjustment to work.

The no form of the command removes the policy from the configuration.

Default 

none

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the policy name configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-mcac-policy context.

secondary-shaper-hashing

Syntax 
[no] secondary-shaper-hashing
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command enables LAG secondary shaper ID hashing (the equivalent of Vport hashing) for the HSMDA. With this feature enabled, secondary shaper ID hashing can span multiple forwarding complexes on egress LAG. The default is to perform secondary shaper ID hashing on egress and requires all active LAG members to be on the same forwarding complex.

The no form of the command enables the default behavior.

Default 

no secondary-shaper-hashing

vport-hashing

Syntax 
[no] vport-hashing
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command enables LAG vPort ID hashing. When enabled, vPort ID hashing can span multiple forwarding complexes on egress LAG. The default is to perform vPort ID hashing on egress and requires all active LAG members to be on the same forwarding complex. This command is not applicable to the HSMDA.

The no form of the command enables the default behavior.

Default 

no vport-hashing

volume-stats-type

Syntax 
volume-stats-type {ip | default}
no volume-stats-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command enables the reporting of Layer 3 (IP) based subscriber host volume accounting data.

By default, subscriber host volume accounting data includes Layer 2 header octets and can be configured to include a fixed packet byte offset or last-mile encapsulation overhead.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

volume-stats-type default

Parameters 
default —
Specifies that the subscriber host volume accounting data is reported including the Layer 2 header octets and optional delta’s introduced by configuration (for example: packet byte offset, last mile aware shaping, and so on)
ip —
Specifies that the subscriber host volume accounting data reporting is based on Layer 3 (IP) packet sizes. This includes subscriber host ingress/egress queue and policer stats in snmp, CLI show commands, RADIUS and XML accounting, and Diameter Gx usage monitoring. RADIUS and Diameter (DCCA) based credit control volume quota are interpreted as Layer 3 (IP).

igmp-policy

Syntax 
igmp-policy policy-name
no igmp-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command will enable IGMP processing per subscriber host. Without this command IGMP states will not be maintained per subscriber hosts. The referenced policy is defined under the configure>subscr-mgmt context and can be only applied via the sub-profile.

The referenced policy contains entries such as:

  1. description statement
  2. import statement — IGMP filters
  3. egress-rate-modify statement—HQoS Adjustment
  4. mcast-redirection statement—redirection to alternate interface
  5. static statement—definition of static IGMP groups
  6. version statement —IGMP version
  7. fast-leave statement
  8. max-num-groups statement—the maximum number of multicast groups allowed

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the name of the IGMP policy for the subscriber. The policy itself is defined under the configure>sub-mgmt context.

hsmda

Syntax 
hsmda
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress and ingress HSMDA queue parameters.

egress-qos

Syntax 
egress-queues
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SAP egress QOS policy for the HSMDA egress queue.

ingress-qos

Syntax 
ingress-queues
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>egress-queues
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SAP egress QOS policy for the HSMDA ingress queue

agg-rate

Syntax 
agg-rate rate
no agg-rate
Context 
config>port>sonet-sdh>path>access>egress>vport
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command configures an aggregate rate for the Vport.The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command. Applying a scheduler-policy to a Vport is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
rate—
Specifies the rate limit for the Vport
Values—
1 to 800000000, max

 

limit-unused-bandwidth

Syntax 
[no] limit-unused-bandwidth
Context 
config>port>sonet-sdh>path>access>egress>vport
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command specifies to limit the unused bandwidth and allow a tighter control in allocation of bandwidth by HQos. When enabled, HQos algorithm distributes any unused aggregate bandwidth between queues operating below their fair share rates. This allows a simplified aggregate rate protection while allocating bandwidth by HQos

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no limit-unused-bandwidth

agg-rate-limit

Syntax 
agg-rate-limit agg-rate
no agg-rate-limit
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>egress-qos
Description 

This command defines a maximum total rate for all subscriber egress queues for each subscriber associated with the sub-profile. The egress-agg-rate-limit command is mutually exclusive with the egress-scheduler-policy. When an egress-scheduler-policy is defined on the sub-profile, the egress-agg-rate-limit command will fail. If the egress-agg-rate-limit command is specified, at attempt to bind an egress-scheduler-policy to the sub-profile will fail.

A port scheduler policy must be applied on the egress port or channel the subscriber instance is bound to in order for the defined egress-agg-rate-limit command to take effect. The egress port scheduler enforces the aggregate queue rate as it distributes its bandwidth at the various port priority levels. The port scheduler stops offering bandwidth to member queues once it has detected that the aggregate rate limit has been reached.

If a port scheduler is not defined on the egress port, the queues are allowed to operate based on their own bandwidth parameters.

The no form of the command removes the aggregate rate limit from the sub-profile.

Default 

no agg-rate-limit

Parameters 
agg-rate—
Defines the maximum aggregate rate the egress queues associated with the subscriber profile may operate. The value is specified in kilobits per second in a base 10 context. A value of 1 indicates a rate of 1000 bits per second.
Values—
1 to 40000000, max Kbps

 

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id
no qos
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>egress-qos
Description 

This command assigns a SAP egress QoS policy to the HSMDA egress queue.

The no form of the command removes the policy from the configuration.

Default 

1

Parameters 
policy-id—
Specifies the policy ID of an existing QoS SAP egress policy
Values—
1 to 65535

 

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id
no qos
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>ingress-qos
Description 

This command assigns a SAP ingress QOS policy to the HSMDA ingress queue.

The no form of the command removes the policy from the configuration.

Default 

1

Parameters 
policy-id—
Specifies the policy ID of an existing QoS SAP egress policy.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

packet-byte-offset

Syntax 
packet-byte-offset {add add-bytes | subtract sub-bytes}
no packet-byte-offset
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>egress-qos
Description 

This command adds or subtracts the specified number of bytes to the accounting function for each packet handled by the HSMDA queue. Normally, the accounting and leaky bucket functions are based on the Ethernet DLC header, payload and the 4-byte CRC (everything except the preamble and inter-frame gap). As an example, the packet-byte-offset command can be used to add the frame encapsulation overhead (20 bytes) to the queues accounting functions.

The accounting functions affected include:

  1. Offered High Priority / In-Profile Octet Counter
  2. Offered Low Priority / Out-of-Profile Octet Counter
  3. Discarded High Priority / In-Profile Octet Counter
  4. Discarded Low Priority / Out-of-Profile Octet Counter
  5. Forwarded In-Profile Octet Counter
  6. Forwarded Out-of-Profile Octet Counter
  7. Peak Information Rate (PIR) Leaky Bucket Updates
  8. Committed Information Rate (CIR) Leaky Bucket Updates
  9. Queue Group Aggregate Rate Limit Leaky Bucket Updates

The secondary shaper leaky bucket, scheduler priority level leaky bucket and the port maximum rate updates are not affected by the configured packet-byte-offset. Each of these accounting functions are frame based and always include the preamble, DLC header, payload and the CRC regardless of the configured byte offset.

The packet-byte-offset command accepts either add or subtract as valid keywords which define whether bytes are being added or removed from each packet traversing the queue. An example use case for subtracting bytes from each packet is an IP based accounting function. Given a Dot1Q encapsulation, the command packet-byte-offset subtract 14 would remove the DLC header and the Dot1Q header from the size of each packet for accounting functions only. The 14 bytes are not actually removed from the packet, only the accounting size of the packet is affected.

As inferred above, the variable accounting size offered by the packet-byte-offset command is targeted at the queue and queue group level. The packet-byte-offset, when set, applies to all queues in the queue group. The accounting size of the packet is ignored by the secondary shapers, the scheduling priority level shapers and the scheduler maximum rate. The actual on-the-wire frame size is used for these functions to allow an accurate representation of the behavior of the subscriber’s packets on an Ethernet aggregation network.

The packet-byte-offset value may be overridden at the queue-group level.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no packet-byte-offset

Parameters 
add add-bytes
Indicates that the byte value should be added to the packet for queue and queue group level accounting functions. Either the add or subtract keyword must be specified. The corresponding byte value must be specified when executing the packet-byte-offset command. The add keyword is mutually exclusive with the subtract keyword.
Values—
0 to 31

 

subtract sub-bytes
Indicates that the byte value should be subtracted from the packet for queue and queue group level accounting functions. The subtract keyword is mutually exclusive with the add keyword. Either the add or subtract keyword must be specified. The corresponding byte value must be specified when executing the packet-byte-offset command.
Note:

The minimum resulting packet size used by the system is 1 byte.

Values—
1 to 64

 

queue

Syntax 
queue queue-id [create]
no queue queue-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>ingress-qos>qos
Description 

This command specifies the HSMDA queue mapping for all packets in point-to-point services and unicast destined packets in multipoint services. Point-to-point services include epipe and other VLL type services. Multipoint services include IES, VPLS and VPRN services. The queue command does not apply to multicast, broadcast or unknown unicast packets within multipoint services (the multicast, broadcast and unknown commands must be used to define the queue mapping for non-unicast packets within a forwarding class). For Epipe services, the queue queue-id mapping applies to all packets, regardless of the packets destination MAC address.

Each forwarding class has a default queue ID based on the intrinsic hierarchy between the forwarding classes. Executing the queue command within the HSMDA context of a forwarding class with a different queue ID than the default overrides the default mapping. Multiple forwarding classes may be mapped to the same HSMDA queue ID.

The no form of the command returns the HSMDA queue mapping for queue to the default mapping for the forwarding class.

Default 

none

Parameters 
queue-id—
Specifies the queue ID to override.
Values—
1 to 8

 

create—
This keyword is mandatory while creating a new queue override.

rate

Syntax 
rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
no rate
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>egress-qos>qos>queue
Description 

This command can be used to override specific attributes of the specified queue’s Peak Information Rate (PIR) and the Committed Information Rate (CIR) parameters. The PIR defines the maximum rate that the queue can transmit packets out an egress interface (for SAP egress queues). Defining a PIR does not necessarily guarantee that the queue can transmit at the intended rate. The actual rate sustained by the queue can be limited by oversubscription factors or available egress bandwidth.

The CIR defines the rate at which the system prioritizes the queue over other queues competing for the same bandwidth. In-profile, then out-of-profile packets are preferentially queued by the system at egress and at subsequent next hop nodes where the packet can traverse. To be properly handled throughout the network, the packets must be marked accordingly for profiling at each hop.

The CIR can be used by the queue’s parent commands cir-level and cir-weight parameters to define the amount of bandwidth considered to be committed for the child queue during bandwidth allocation by the parent scheduler.

The rate command can be executed at any time, altering the PIR and CIR rates for all queues created through the association of the SAP egress QoS policy with the queue-id.

The no form of the command returns all queues created with the queue-id by association with the QoS policy to the default PIR and CIR parameters (max, 0).

Default 

rate max cir 0

Parameters 
pir-rate—
Defines the administrative PIR rate, in kilobits, for the queue. When the rate command is executed, a valid PIR setting must be explicitly defined. When the rate command has not been executed, the default PIR of max is assumed.

Fractional values are not allowed and must be given as a positive integer.

The actual PIR rate is dependent on the queue’s adaptation-rule parameters and the actual hardware where the queue is provisioned.

Values—
1 to 100000000

 

Default—
max
cir-rate—
The cir parameter overrides the default administrative CIR used by the queue. When the rate command is executed, a CIR setting is optional. When the rate command has not been executed or the cir parameter is not explicitly specified, the default CIR (0) is assumed. Fractional values are not allowed and must be given as a positive integer. The sum keyword specifies that the CIR be used as the summed CIR values of the children schedulers or queues.
Values—
0 to 100000000, max, sum

 

Default—
0

slope-policy

Syntax 
slope-policy hsmda-slope-policy-name
no slope-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>egress-qos>qos>queue
Description 

This command specifies an existing slope policy name. The policy contains the Maximum Buffer Size (MBS) that will be applied to the queue and the high and low priority RED slope definitions. The function of the MBS and RED slopes is to provide congestion control for an HSMDA queue. The MBS parameter defines the maximum depth a queue may reach when accepting packets. The low and high priority RED slopes provides for random early detection of congestion and slope based discards based on queue depth.

An hsmda-slope-policy can be applied to queues defined in the sap-ingress and sap-egress QoS policy hsmda-queues context. Once an HSMDA slope policy is applied to a SAP QoS policy queue, it cannot be deleted. Any edits to the policy are updated to all HSMDA queues indirectly associated with the policy.

Default HSMDA Slope Policy

An hsmda-slope-policy named default always exists on the system and does not need to be created. The default policy is automatically applied to all HSMDA queues unless another HSMDA slope policy is specified for the queue. The default policy cannot be modified or deleted. Attempting to execute no hsmda-slope-policy default will result in an error.

The no form of the command removes the slope policy from the subscriber profile HSMDA configuration.

stat-mode

Syntax 
stat-mode {v4-v6}
no stat-mode
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>ingress-qos>qos>policer
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>ingress-qos>qos>queue
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>egress-qos>qos>queue
Description 

This command configures the forwarding plane octet and packet counters of a policer or queue to count packets of a specific type or state. For example separate counters for IPv4/IPv6.

For HSMDA ingress policers, this command overrides the policer stat-mode configuration as defined in the sap-ingress qos policy. For details on sap-ingress and sap-egress policer stat-mode, refer to the Quality of Service Guide. For use in Enhanced Subscriber Management (ESM) context only, an additional stat-mode enables separate counters for IPv4 and IPv6 packets. stat-mode v4-v6 is the only mode that can be configured as an HSMDA ingress policer override.

An HSMDA policer’s stat-mode cannot be changed while the sub profile is in use.

For queues, this command sets the stat-mode. Queue stat-mode is only available for use in ESM context to enable separate IPv4/IPv6 counters.

An HSMDA queue’s stat-mode cannot be changed while the sub profile is in use.

Default 

no stat-mode

For policers, the default is no stat-mode override. The sap-ingress stat-mode is used instead.

For queues, the default is to count in-/out-of-profile octets and packets.

Parameters 
v4-v6 —
Count IPv4 and IPv6 forwarded/dropped octets and packets separately

wrr-weight

Syntax 
wrr-weight value
no wrr-weight
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>egress-qos>qos>queue
Description 

This command assigns the weight value to the HSMDA queue.

The no form of the command returns the weight value for the queue to the default value.

Parameters 
percentage
Specifies the weight for the HSMDA queue
Values—
1 to 32

 

wrr-policy

Syntax 
wrr-policy hsmda-wrr-policy-name
no wrr-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>sub-prof>hsmda>egress-qos>qos
Description 

This command associates an existing HSMDA weighted-round-robin (WRR) scheduling loop policy to the HSMDA queue.

Parameters 
hsmda-wrr-policy-name
Specifies the existing HSMDA WRR policy name to associate to the queue

9.25.2.1.14. Explicit Subscriber Mapping Commands

explicit-sub-map

Syntax 
explicit-sub-map
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures an explicit subscriber mapping

entry

Syntax 
entry key sub-ident-string [sub-profile sub-profile-name] [alias sub-alias-string] [sla-profile sla-profile-name]
no entry key sub-profile-string
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>explicit-sub-map
Description 

This command configures a subscriber identification string.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string—
Specifies the profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies an existing subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
sub-alias-string
Specifies an alias for the subscriber identification string
sla-profile-name
Specifies an existing SLA profile

9.25.2.1.15. Subscriber Management Service Commands

9.25.2.1.15.1. SAP Subscriber Management Commands

sub-sla-mgmt

Syntax 
[no] sub-sla-mgmt
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>ies>if>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap-parameters
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap-parameters
Description 

This command enters the context to configure subscriber management parameters for this SAP.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no sub-sla-mgmt

def-sla-profile

Syntax 
def-sla-profile default-sla-profile-name
no def-sla-profile
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap-param>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap-param>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command specifies a default SLA profile for this SAP.

An SLA profile is a named group of QoS parameters used to define per service QoS for all subscriber hosts common to the same subscriber within a provider service offering. A single SLA profile may define the QoS parameters for multiple subscriber hosts.

The no form of the command removes the default SLA profile from the SAP configuration.

Default 

no def-sla-profile

Parameters 
default-sla-profile-name—
Specifies a default SLA profile for this SAP

def-sub-profile

Syntax 
def-sub-profile default-subscriber-profile-name
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap-param>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap-param>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command specifies a default subscriber profile for this SAP.

A subscriber profile defines the aggregate QoS for all hosts within a subscriber context. This is done through the definition of the egress and ingress scheduler policies that govern the aggregate SLA for subscriber using the subscriber profile.

The no form of the command removes the default SLA profile from the SAP configuration.

Parameters 
default-sub-profile—
Specifies a default subscriber profile for this SAP

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap-param>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap-param>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command associates a subscriber identification policy to this SAP.

Subscribers are managed by the system through the use of subscriber identification strings. A subscriber identification string uniquely identifies a subscriber. For static hosts, the subscriber identification string is explicitly defined with each static subscriber host.

For dynamic hosts, the subscriber identification string must be derived from the DHCP ACK message sent to the subscriber host. The default value for the string is the content of Option 82 CIRCUIT-ID and REMOTE-ID fields interpreted as an octet sting. As an option, the DHCP ACK message may be processed by a subscriber identification policy which has the capability to parse the message into an alternative ASCII or octet string value.

When multiple hosts on the same port are associated with the same subscriber identification string they are considered to be host members of the same subscriber.

The no form of the command removes the default subscriber identification policy from the SAP configuration.

Default 

no sub-ident-policy

Parameters 
sub-ident-policy-name—
Specifies a subscriber identification policy for this SAP

multi-sub-sap

Syntax 
multi-sub-sap number-of-sub
no multi-sub-sap
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command defines the maximum number of subscribers (dynamic + static) that can be simultaneously active on this SAP.

If the limit is reached, a new host will be denied access and the corresponding DHCP ACK will be dropped.

The no form of the command reverts back to the default setting.

Default 

no multi-sub-sap

Parameters 
multi-sub-sap—
Specifies the maximum number of subscribers allowed for this SAP. The operational maximum value may be smaller than the configured value due to equipped hardware dependencies.
Values—
2 to 131071

 

single-sub-parameters

Syntax 
single-sub-parameters
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>ies>if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to configure single subscriber SAP parameters.

non-sub-traffic

Syntax 
non-sub-traffic sub-profile sub-profile-name sla-profile sla-profile-name [subscriber sub-ident-string]
no non-sub-traffic
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt>single-sub
config>service>ies>if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt>single-sub
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt>single-sub
Description 

This command configures traffic profiles for non-IP traffic such as PPPoE.It is used in conjunction with the profiled-traffic-only on single subscriber SAPs and creates a subscriber host which is used to forward non-IP traffic through the single subscriber SAP without the need for SAP queues.

The no form of the command removes any configured profile.

Default 

no non-sub-traffic

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Identifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
sla-profile-name—
Identifies the SLA profile name up to 32 characters in length

profiled-traffic-only

Syntax 
[no] profiled-traffic-only
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt>single-sub-parameters
config>service>ies>if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt>single-sub
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt>single-sub
Description 

This command specifies whether only profiled traffic is applicable for this SAP. The profiled traffic refers to single subscriber traffic on a dedicated SAP (in the VLAN-per-subscriber model). When enabled, subscriber queues are instantiated through the QOS policy defined in the sla-profile and the associated SAP queues are deleted. This can increase subscriber scaling by reducing the number of queues instantiated per subscriber (in the VLAN-per-subscriber model). In order for this to be achieved, any configured multi-sub-sap limit must be removed (leaving the default of 1).

The no form of the command reverts to the default setting.

Default 

no profiled-traffic-only

srrp

Syntax 
srrp srrp-id [create]
no srrp srrp-id
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command creates an SRRP instance on a group IP interface. An SRRP instance manages all subscriber subnets within the group interfaces subscriber IP interface or other subscriber IP interfaces that are associated through a wholesale/retail relationship. Only one unique SRRP instance can be configured per group interface.

The no form of the command removes an SRRP instance from a group IP interface. Once removed, the group interface ignores ARP requests for the SRRP gateway IP addresses that may exist on subscriber subnets associated with the group IP interface. Then the group interface stops routing using the redundant IP interface associated with the group IP interface and will stop routing with the SRRP gateway MAC address. Ingress packets destined to the SRRP gateway MAC will also be silently discarded. This is the same behavior as a group IP interface that is disabled (shutdown).

This command applies only to the 7750 SR.

The no form of the command removes the SRRP ID from the configuration.

Default 

no srrp

Parameters 
srrp-id—
Specifies a 32 bit instance ID that must be unique to the system. The instance ID must also match the instance ID used by the remote router that is participating in the same SRRP context. SRRP is intended to perform a function similar to VRRP where adjacent IP hosts within local subnets use a default gateway to access IP hosts on other subnets.
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

bfd-enable

Syntax 
[no] bfd-enable [service-id] interface interface-name dst-ip ip-address
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

This commands assigns a bi-directional forwarding (BFD) session providing heart-beat mechanism for the given VRRP/SRRP instance. There can be only one BFD session assigned to any given VRRP/SRRP instance, but there can be multiple SRRP/VRRP sessions using the same BFD session.

BFD control the state of the associated interface. By enabling BFD on a given protocol interface, the state of the protocol interface is tied to the state of the BFD session between the local node and the remote node. The parameters used for the BFD are set via the BFD command under the IP interface.

The no form of this command disables BFD.

Default 

none

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies the service ID of the interface running BFD
Values—
service-id: 1 to 214748364
svc-name: A string up to 64 characters in length

 

interface-name
Specifies the name of the interface running BFD
ip-address
Specifies the destination address of the interface running BFD

gw-mac

Syntax 
gw-mac mac-address
no gw-mac
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

This command overrides the default SRRP gateway MAC address used by the SRRP instance. Unless specified, the system uses the same base MAC address for all SRRP instances with the last octet overridden by the lower 8 bits of the SRRP instance ID. The same SRRP gateway MAC address should be in-use by both the local and remote routers participating in the same SRRP context.

One reason to change the default SRRP gateway MAC address is if two SRRP instances sharing the same broadcast domain are using the same SRRP gateway MAC. The system will use the SRRP instance ID to separate the SRRP messages (by ignoring the messages that does not match the local instance ID), but a unique SRRP gateway MAC is essential to separate the routed packets for each gateway IP address.

The no form of the command removes the explicit SRRP gateway MAC address from the SRRP instance. The SRRP gateway MAC address can only be changed or removed when the SRRP instance is shutdown.

Parameters 
mac-address—
Specifies a MAC address that is used to override the default SRRP base MAC address
Values—
Any MAC address except all zeros, broadcast or multicast addresses. The offset is expressed in normal Ethernet MAC address notation. The defined gw-mac cannot be 00:00:00:00:00:00, ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff or any multicast address.
If not specified, the system uses the default SRRP gateway MAC address with the last octet set to the 8 least significant bits of the SRRP instance ID.

 

keep-alive-interval

Syntax 
keep-alive-interval interval
no keep-alive-interval
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

This command defines the interval between SRRP advertisement messages sent when operating in the master state. The interval is also the basis for setting the master-down timer used to determine when the master is no longer sending. The system uses three times the keep-alive interval to set the timer. Every time an SRRP advertisement is seen that is better then the local priority, the timer is reset. If the timer expires, the SRRP instance assumes that a master does not exist and initiates the attempt to become master.

When in backup state, the SRRP instance takes the keep-alive interval of the master as represented in the masters SRRP advertisement message. Once in master state, the SRRP instance uses its own configured keep-alive interval.

The keep-alive-interval may be changed at anytime, but will have no effect until the SRRP instance is in the master state.

The no form of the command restores the default interval.

Default 

10

Parameters 
interval—
Specifies the interval, in milliseconds, between SRRP advertisement messages sent when operating in the master state
Values—
1 to 100

 

message-path

Syntax 
message-path sap-id
no message-path
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

This command defines a specific SAP for SRRP in-band messaging. A message-path SAP must be defined prior to activating the SRRP instance. The defined SAP must exist on the SRRP instances group IP interface for the command to succeed and cannot currently be associated with any dynamic or static subscriber hosts. Once a group IP interface SAP has been defined as the transmission path for SRRP Advertisement messages, it cannot be administratively shutdown, will not support static or dynamic subscriber hosts and cannot be removed from the group IP interface.

The SRRP instance message-path command may be executed at anytime on the SRRP instance. Changing the message SAP will fail if a dynamic or static subscriber host is associated with the new SAP. Once successfully changed, the SRRP instance will immediately disable anti-spoof on the SAP and start sending SRRP Advertisement messages if the SRRP instance is activated.

Changing the current SRRP message SAP on an active pair of routers should be done in the following manner:

  1. Shutdown the backup SRRP instance.
  2. Change the message SAP on the shutdown node.
  3. Change the message SAP on the active master node.
  4. Re-activate the shutdown SRRP instance.

Shutting down the backup SRRP instance prevents the SRRP instances from becoming master due to temporarily using differing message path SAPs.

If an MCS peering is operational between the redundant nodes and the SRRP instance has been associated with the peering, the designated message path SAP will be sent from each member.

The no form of the command can only be executed when the SRRP instance is shutdown. Executing no message-path allows the existing SAP to be used for subscriber management functions. A new message-path SAP must be defined prior to activating the SRRP instance.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition

monitor-oper-group

Syntax 
monitor-oper-group name priority-step step
no monitor-oper-group
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

This command will configure the association between the SRRP instance in a Fate Sharing Group and the operational-group that contains messaging SAPs. A state transition of a messaging SAP within an operational-group will trigger calculation of the priority for all SRRP instances that are associated with that operational-group.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no monitor-oper-group

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the operational-group, up to 32 characters in length, that is tracking operational state of SRRP messaging SAPs
priority-step—
Specifies the priority step for which the priority of an SRRP instance will be changed. If a messaging SAP within an operational-group transition to a non-UP state, the priority will be decreased by the step value. If the messaging SAP within the operational-group transition into the UP state, the priority of the SRRP instance will be increased by the step value.
Values—
1 to 10

 

one-garp-per-sap

Syntax 
[no] one-garp-per-sap
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

This command enables the sending of one gratuitous ARP to each SAP and is applicable to PPPoE only deployments in which there are multiple subnets under the subscriber interface. In such case, if the switchover occurs, it will be sufficient to send a single Gratuitous ARP on every VLAN to update the Layer 2 forwarding path in the access aggregation network. This single gratuitous ARP will contain the IP address of the first GW address found under the subscriber interface address.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no one-garp-per-sap

policy

Syntax 
[no] policy vrrp-policy-id
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

This command associates one or more VRRP policies with the SRRP instance. A VRRP policy is a collection of connectivity and verification tests used to manipulate the in-use priorities of VRRP and SRRP instances. A VRRP policy can test the link state of ports, ping IP hosts, discover the existence of routes in the routing table or the ability to reach Layer 2 hosts. When one or more of these tests fail, the VRRP policy has the option of decrementing or setting an explicit value for the in-use priority of an SRRP instance.

More than one VRRP policy may be associated with an SRRP instance. When more than one VRRP policy is associated with an SRRP instance the delta decrement of the in-use priority is cumulative unless one or more test fail that have explicit priority values. When one or more explicit tests fail, the lowest priority value event takes effect for the SRRP instance. When the highest delta-in-use-limit is used to manage the lowest delta derived in-use priority for the SRRP instance.

VRRP policy associations may be added and removed at anytime. A maximum of two VRRP policies can be associated with a single SRRP instance.

The no form of the command removes the association with vrrp-policy-id from the SRRP instance.

Default 

no policy

Parameters 
vrrp-policy-id—
Specifies one or more VRRP policies with the SRRP instance
Values—
1 to 9999

 

preempt

Syntax 
[no] preempt
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

When preempt is enabled, a newly initiated SRRP instance can overrides an existing Master SRRP instance if its priority value is higher than the priority of the current Master.

If preempt is disabled, an SRRP instance only becomes Master if the master down timer expires before an SRRP advertisement message is received from the adjacent SRRP enabled node.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

preempt

priority

Syntax 
priority priority
no priority
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

This command overrides the default base priority for the SRRP instance. The SRRP instance priority is advertised by the SRRP instance to its neighbor router and is compared to the priority received from the neighbor router. The router with the best (highest) priority enters the master state while the other router enters the backup state. If the priority of each router is the same, the router with the lowest source IP address in the SRRP advertisement message assumes the master state.

The base priority of an SRRP instance can be managed by VRRP policies. A VRRP policy defines a set of connectivity or verification tests which, when they fail, may lower an SRRP instances base priority (creating an in-use priority for the instance). Every time an SRRP instances in-use priority changes when in master state, it sends an SRRP advertisement message with the new priority. If the dynamic priority drops to zero or receives an SRRP Advertisement message with a better priority, the SRRP instance transitions to the becoming backup state.

When the priority command is not specified, or the no priority command is executed, the system uses a default base priority of 100. The priority command may be executed at anytime.

The no form of the command restores the default base priority to the SRRP instance. If a VRRP policy is associated with the SRRP instance, it will use the default base priority as the basis for any modifications to the SRRP instances in-use priority.

Default 

100

Parameters 
priority—
Specifies a base priority for the SRRP instance to override the default
Values—
1 to 254

 

send-fib-population-packets

Syntax 
send-fib-population-packets mode
no send-fib-population-packets
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>srrp
Description 

This command sends FDB population packets.

The no form of the command disables sending FDB population packets.

Default 

all

Parameters 
mode—
Specifies the mode used to send FDB population packets
Values—
all: Sends FDB population packets to all VLANs
out-tag-only: Sends FDB population packets to only outer VLAN tags.

 

srrp-enabled-routing

Syntax 
srrp-enabled-routing [hold-time hold-time]
no srrp-enabled-routing
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command configures SRRP-enabled routing.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no srrp-enabled-routing

Parameters 
hold-time hold-time
Specifies the hold time, in deci-seconds
Values—
1 to 50

 

tos-marking-state

Syntax 
tos-marking-state {trusted | untrusted}
no tos-marking-state
Context 
config>service>vprn>interface
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command is used to alter the default trusted state to a non-trusted state. When unset or reverted to the trusted default, the ToS field will not be remarked by egress network IP interfaces unless the egress network IP interface has the remark-trusted state set, in which case the egress network interface treats all VPRN and network IP interface as untrusted.

When the ingress interface is set to untrusted, all egress network IP interfaces will remark IP packets received on the network interface according to the egress marking definitions on each network interface. The egress network remarking rules also apply to the ToS field of IP packets routed using IGP shortcuts (tunneled to a remote next-hop). However, the tunnel QoS markings are always derived from the egress network QoS definitions. Egress marking and remarking is based on the internal forwarding class and profile state of the packet once it reaches the egress interface. The forwarding class is derived from ingress classification functions. The profile of a packet is either derived from ingress classification or ingress policing.

The default marking state for network IP interfaces is trusted. This is equivalent to declaring no tos-marking-state on the network IP interface. When undefined or set to tos-marking-state trusted, the trusted state of the interface will not be displayed when using show config or show info unless the detail parameter is given. The save config command will not store the default tos-marking-state trusted state for network IP interfaces unless the detail parameter is also specified.

The no form of the command restores the trusted state to a network IP interface. This is equivalent to executing the tos-marking-state trusted command.

Default 

trusted

Parameters 
trusted—
The default prevents the ToS field to not be remarked by egress network IP interfaces unless the egress network IP interface has the remark-trusted state set
untrusted—
Specifies that all egress network IP interfaces will remark IP packets received on the network interface according to the egress marking definitions on each network interface

mac-da-hashing

Syntax 
mac-da-hashing
no mac-da-hashing
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command specifies whether subscriber traffic egressing a LAG SAP has its egress LAG link selected by a function of the MAC destination address instead of the subscriber ID.

The no form of the command reverts to the default setting.

Default 

no mac-da-hashing

diameter-auth-policy

Syntax 
diameter-auth-policy name
no diameter-auth-policy
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
Description 

This command is used to configure the Diameter NASREQ application policy to use for authentication.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

none

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the Diameter NASREQ application policy to use for authentication

host

Syntax 
host {[ip ip-address [mac mac-address]} [subscriber-sap-id | subscriber sub-ident-string [sub-profile sub-profile-name [sla-profile sla-profile-name [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile app-profile-name] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id]
no host {[ip ip-address] [mac ieee-address]}
no host all
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>ies>if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command creates a static subscriber host for the SAP. Static subscriber hosts may be used by the system for various purposes. Applications within the system that make use of static host entries include anti-spoof, ARP reply agent and source MAC population into the VPLS forwarding database.

Multiple static hosts may be defined on the SAP. Each host is identified by either a source IP address, a source MAC address or both a source IP and source MAC address. Every static host definition must have at least one address defined, IP or MAC.

Static hosts can exist on the SAP even with anti-spoof and ARP reply agent features disabled. When enabled, each feature has different requirements for static hosts.

The no form of the command removes a static entry from the system. The specified ip-address and mac-address must match the host’s exact IP and MAC addresses as defined when it was created. When a static host is removed from the SAP, the corresponding anti-spoof filter entry and/or FDB entry is also removed.

Default 

none

Parameters 
ip-address —
Specifies an association with a subscriber with the static subscriber host. Only one static host can be configured on the SAP with a given IP address.
mac-address —
Specifies the MAC address to define a static host. The MAC address must be specified for anti-spoof mac, anti-spoof ip-mac and arp-reply-agent (the arp-reply-agent is supported by the 7450 ESS only). Multiple static hosts may be configured with the same MAC address given that each definition is distinguished by a unique IP address.

Every static host definition must have at least one address defined, IP or MAC.

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile to be associated with the static subscriber host. The subscriber identification profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol context. The subscriber information is used by the VPLS SAP arp-reply-agent to determine the proper handling of received ARP requests from subscribers.

For VPLS SAPs with arp-reply-agent enabled with the optional sub-ident parameter, the static subscriber hosts sub-ident-string is used to determine whether an ARP request received on the SAP is sourced from a host belonging to the same subscriber as the destination host. When both the destination and source hosts from the ARP request are known on the SAP and the subscriber identifications do not match, the ARP request may be forwarded to the rest of the VPLS destinations.

If the static subscriber hosts sub-ident string is not defined, the host is not considered to belong to the same subscriber as another host on the SAP.

If source or destination host is unknown, the hosts are not considered to belong to the same subscriber. (ARP messages from unknown hosts are subject to anti-spoof filtering rules applied at the SAP.)

If sub-ident is not enabled on the SAP arp-reply-agent, subscriber identification matching is not performed on ARP requests received on the SAP.

ARP requests are never forwarded back to the same SAP or within the receiving SAP’s Split Horizon Group.

sub-profile sub-profile-name
Specifies an existing subscriber profile name to be associated with the static subscriber host. The subscriber profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile context.
sla-profile sla-profile-name
Specifies an existing SLA profile name to be associated with the static subscriber host. The SLA profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile context.
Note:

If Enhanced Subscriber Management is enabled on a SAP using the sub-sla-mgmt command, the sub-ident, sub-profile, and sla-profile must be configured for all static hosts defined on this SAP.

9.25.2.1.15.2. Wireless Portal Protocol (WPP) Commands

wpp

Syntax 
wpp
Context 
config>aaa
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Wireless Portal Protocol (WPP) parameters.

portal-group

Syntax 
portal-group portal-group-name [create]
no portal-group portal-group-name
Context 
config>aaa>wpp>portal-groups
Description 

This command creates a new portal group or enters the configuration context of an existing port group.

Parameters 
portal-group-name—
Specifies the portal group name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

portal-group

Syntax 
portal-group portal-group-name
no portal-group
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
Description 

This command specifies the WPP portal group for the subscriber interface. This command is mutually exclusive with the portal command.

The no form of the command removes the name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
portal-group-name—
Specifies the portal group name up to 32 characters in length

portal-group

Syntax 
portal-group portal-group-name
no portal-group
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe>host>wpp
Description 

This command specifies the WPP portal group for the LUBD host. This command is mutually exclusive with the portal command.

The no form of the command removes the name from the LUBD configuration.

Parameters 
portal-group-name—
Specifies the portal group name up to 32 characters in length

portal-groups

Syntax 
portal-groups
Context 
config>aaa>wpp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure portal group parameters for WPP.

portal

Syntax 
[no] portal router router-instance name wpp-portal-name
Context 
config>aaa>wpp>portal-groups>portal-group
Description 

This command configures the portal for this portal group.

Parameters 
router-instance
Specifies the virtual router instance
Values—

router-name:

Base, management

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

service-name:

Specifies the service name up to 64 characters in length

 

Default—
Base
wpp-portal-name
Specifies the name of the web portal server up to 32 characters in length

portal

Syntax 
portal router router-instance name wpp-portal-name
no portal
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe>host>wpp
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
Description 

This command specifies the web portal server that system talks to for the hosts on the group-interface. This command is mutually exclusive with the portal-group command.

The no form of the command removes the router instance or portal name from the configuration.

Default 

no portal

Parameters 
router-instance
Specifies the virtual router instance
Values—

router-name:

Base, management

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

service-name:

Specifies the service name up to 64 characters in length

 

Default—
Base
wpp-portal-name
Specifies the name of the web portal server up to 32 characters in length

portals

Syntax 
portals
Context 
config>router>wpp
config>service>vprn>wpp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure WPP portal server parameters.

ack-auth-retry-count

Syntax 
ack-auth-retry-count [0..5]
no ack-auth-retry-count
Context 
config>router>wpp>portals>portal
config>service>vprn>wpp>portals>portal
Description 

This command configures the number of retransmissions of an ACK_OUT message.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

5

Parameters 
0 .. 5
Specifies the number of retransmissions of an ACK_OUT message

ntf-logout-retry-count

Syntax 
ntf-logout-retry-count [value]
no ntf-logout-retry-count
Context 
config>router>wpp>portals>portal
config>service>vprn>wpp>portals>portal
Description 

This command configures the number of retransmissions of an NTF_LOGOUT message.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

5

Parameters 
value
Specifies the number of retransmissions of an NTF_LOGOUT message
Values—
0 to 5

 

retry-interval

Syntax 
retry-interval milliseconds
no retry-interval
Context 
config>router>wpp>portals>portal
config>service>vprn>wpp>portals>portal
Description 

This command configures the time interval between two consecutive retransmissions

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

2000

Parameters 
milliseconds—
Specifies the time interval between two consecutive retransmissions
Values—
10 to 2000

 

secret

Syntax 
secret secret [hash | hash2]
no secret
Context 
config>router>wpp>portals>portal
config>service>vprn>wpp>portals>portal
Description 

This command configures the secret that is used by WPPv2 to authenticate the messages between portal and BRAS.

The no form of the command removes the secret and hash from the configuration.

Parameters 
secret
Specifies the secret key to access the server, up to 64 characters in length
hash—
Specifies the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.

version

Syntax 
version version
no version
Context 
config>router>wpp>portals>portal
config>service>vprn>wpp>portals>portal
Description 

This command configure the protocol version that is expected by the WPP portal.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
version—
Specifies the protocol version
Values—
1, 2

 

enable-triggered-hosts

Syntax 
[no] enable-triggered-hosts
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
Description 

This command enables system to auto creates ESM hosts upon successful WPP authentication. Default host need to be configured under SAP on the subscriber SAP in order to redirection un-authentication client traffic to web portal.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no enabled-triggered-hosts

initial-app-profile

Syntax 
initial-app-profile app-profile-name
no initial-app-profile
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe>host>wpp
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
Description 

This command specifies the initial app-profile for the hosts created on the group-interface. This initial app-profile will be replaced after hosts pass web portal authentication.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no initial-app-profile

Parameters 
app-profile-name—
Specifies the initial application profile, up to 32 characters in length, to be used during the WPP authentication phase of the IPoE hosts

initial-sla-profile

Syntax 
initial-sla-profile sla-profile-name
no initial-sla-profile
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe>host>wpp
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
Description 

This command specifies the initial sla-profile for the hosts created on the group-interface. This initial sla-profile will be replaced after hosts pass web portal authentication.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no initial-sla-profile

Parameters 
sla-profile-name—
Specifies the initial SLA profile, up to 32 characters in length, to be used during the WPP authentication phase of the IPOE host

initial-sub-profile

Syntax 
initial-sub-profile sub-profile-name
no initial-sub-profile
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe>host>wpp
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
Description 

This command specifies the initial sub-profile for the hosts created on the group-interface. This initial sub-profile will be replaced after hosts pass web portal authentication.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no initial-sub-profile

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the initial subscriber profile, up to 32 characters in length, to be used during the WPP authentication phase of the IPoE host

restore-disconnected

Syntax 
[no] restore-disconnected
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe>host>wpp
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
Description 

This command specifies the behavior that system will restore the initial-sla-profile or initial-sub-profile or initial-aa-profile when hosts disconnects instead of removing them.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

restore-connected

Parameters 
restore—
Specifies that the initial profiles must be restored after a DHCP host has disconnected
no-restore—
Specifies that the initial profiles will not be restored after a DHCP host has disconnected

user-db

Syntax 
user-db local-user-db-name
no user-db
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe>host>wpp
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>wpp
Description 

This command configures the user database.

Note:

If configured, the values configured under grp-if will only be used if there is no corresponding value returned from LUDB lookup.

This command specifies the LUDB system use to lookup while creating initial host before WPP authentication. LUDB could return WPP attributes such as portal name, initial-sla-profile, initial-sub-profile, and so on LUDB is configured in config>subscr-mgmt>local-user-db context.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no user-db

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the Local User Database name up to 32 characters in length

9.25.2.1.16. Subscriber Management Service Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

subscriber-interface

Syntax 
subscriber-interface ip-int-name [create]
subscriber-interface ip-int-name [create] fwd-service service-id fwd-subscriber-interface ip-int-name]
no subscriber-interface ip-int-name
Context 
config>service>ies
config>service>vprn
Description 

This command allows the operator to create special subscriber-based interfaces. It is used to contain multiple group interfaces. Multiple subnets associated with the subscriber interface can be applied to any of the contained group interfaces in any combination. The subscriber interface allows subnet sharing between group interfaces.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
Specifies the interface name of a subscriber interface. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
service-id
Specifies the wholesale service ID or service name
Values—
service-id: 1 to 214748364
svc-name: A string up to 64 characters in length

 

ip-int-name
Specifies the wholesale subscriber interface

address

Syntax 
[no] address {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask} [gw-ip-address ip-address] [populate-host-routes]
Context 
config>service>ies>subscriber-interface
config>service>vprn>subscriber-interface
Description 

This command creates or removes an IP address, IP subnet or broadcast address format for the interface. Multiple IP addresses can be associated with a subscriber-interface

The IP address for the interface can be entered in either CIDR (Classless Inter-Domain Routing) or traditional dotted decimal notation. The show commands display CIDR notation and is stored in configuration files.

In the IES subscriber interface context, this command is used to assign one or more host IP addresses and subnets. This differs from a normal IES interfaces where secondary command creates and additional subnet after the primary address is assigned. A user can then add or remove addresses without having to keep a primary address.

Use the no form of this command to remove the IP address assignment from the IP interface.

Default 

no IP address or subnet associations configured

Parameters 
ip-address—
The IP address of the IP interface. The ip-address portion of the address command specifies the IP host address that will be used by the IP interface within the subnet. This address must be unique within the subnet and specified in dotted decimal notation. Allowed values are IP addresses in the range 1.0.0.0 – 223.255.255.255 (with support of /31 subnets).
/—
The forward slash is a parameter delimiter and separates the ip-address portion of the IP address from the mask that defines the scope of the local subnet. No spaces are allowed between the ip-address, the “/” and the mask-length parameter. If a forward slash is not immediately following the ip-address, a dotted decimal mask must follow the prefix.
mask—
The subnet mask in dotted decimal notation. When the IP prefix is not specified in CIDR notation, a space separates the ip-address from a traditional dotted decimal mask. The mask parameter indicates the complete mask that will be used in a logical AND function to derive the local subnet of the IP address. Allowed values are dotted decimal addresses in the range 128.0.0.0 – 255.255.255.252.
Note:

A mask of 255.255.255.255 is reserved for system IP addresses.

netmask—
The subnet mask in dotted decimal notation.
Values—
0.0.0.0 - 255.255.255.255

 

ip-address
Specifies a separate IP address within the subnet for SRRP routing purposes. This parameter must be followed by a valid IP interface that exists within the subscriber subnet created by the address command. The defined gateway IP address cannot currently exist as a subscriber host (static or dynamic). If the defined ip-address already exists as a subscriber host address, the address command will fail. The specified ip-address must be unique within the system.

The gw-address parameter may be specified at anytime. If the subscriber subnet was created previously, executing the address command with a gw-address parameter will simply add the SRRP gateway IP address to the existing subnet.

If the address command is executed without the gw-address parameter when the subscriber subnet is associated with an active SRRP instance, the address will fail. If the SRRP instance is inactive or removed, executing the address command without the gw-address parameter will remove the SRRP gateway IP address from the specified subscriber subnet.

If the address command is executed with a new gw-address, all SRRP instances currently associated with the specified subscriber subnet will be updated with the new SRRP gateway IP address.

populate-host-routes—
Specifies to populate subscriber-host routes in local FDB. Storing them in FDB benefits topologies only where the external router advertises more specific routes than the one corresponding to locally configured subscriber-interface subnets.

ipv6

Syntax 
ipv6
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
Description 

This command enters the context to enable IPv6 IPoE bridged mode.

allow-unmatching-subnets

Syntax 
[no] allow-unmatching-subnets
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
Description 

This command allows address assignment for IPoEv4 and PPPoEv4 subscriber hosts in cases where the subscriber assigned IPv4 address falls outside of the subscriber-interface subnet configured under the same CLI hierarchy. Such subscriber host will be installed in the FDB as /32 hosts because the aggregated subscriber-interface route is not available for them (not configured under the subscriber-interface). Without the allow-unmatching-subnets command, such host are instantiated in the system but forwarding for them is disabled.

This command can be only configured in case where the subscriber-interface has an IP address (and therefore subnet) configured. In case where the subscriber interface does not have explicitly configured and IP address, execution of this command will fail.

IPv6 hosts are not affected by this command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no allow-unmatching-subnets

allow-unmatching-subnets

Syntax 
[no] allow-unmatching-subnets
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>ipv6
config>service>vprn>sub-if>ipv6
Description 

This command will allow address assignment for IPoEv6 and PPPoEv6 hosts in cases where the subscriber host assigned IPv6 address or prefix falls outside of the subscriber-prefix range explicitly configured for the subscriber-interface (configure>service>vprn/ies>sub-if>ipv6) or the subscriber-prefix is not configured at all.

SLAAC hosts will be installed in the FDB as /64 entries, the length of the installed DHCP-PD prefix will be dictated by the prefix-length and the DHCP-NA host will be installed as /128 entries.

IPv4 subscriber hosts are unaffected by this command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no allow-unmatching-subnets

allow-unmatching-prefixes

Syntax 
[no] allow-unmatching-prefixes
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>ipv6
config>service>vprn>sub-if>ipv6
Description 

This command will allow address assignment for IPoEv6 and PPPoEv6 hosts in cases where the subscriber host assigned IPv6 address or prefix falls outside of the subscriber-prefix range explicitly configured for the subscriber-interface (configure>service>vprn/ies>sub-if>ipv6) or the subscriber-prefix is not configured at all.

SLAAC hosts will be installed in the FDB as /64 entries, the length of the installed DHCP-PD prefix will be dictated by the prefix-length and the DHCP-NA host will be installed as /128 entries.

IPv4 subscriber hosts are unaffected by this command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no allow-unmatching-subnets

authentication-policy

Syntax 
authentication-policy name
no authentication-policy
Context 
config>service>vprn>if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command assigns an authentication policy to the interface.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the group interface configuration.

Default 

no authentication-policy

Parameters 
name —
Specifies the authentication policy name. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

arp-populate

Syntax 
[no] arp-populate
Context 
config>service>vprn>if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>subscriber-interface
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enables populating static and dynamic hosts into the system ARP cache. When enabled, the host’s IP address and MAC address are placed in the system ARP cache as a managed entry. Static hosts must be defined on the interface using the host command. Dynamic hosts are enabled on the system through enabling lease-populate in the IP interface DHCP context. In the event that both a static host and a dynamic host share the same IP and MAC address, the system’s ARP cache retains the host information until both the static and dynamic information are removed. Both static and dynamic hosts override static ARP entries. Static ARP entries are marked as inactive when they conflict with static or dynamic hosts and will be repopulated once all static and dynamic host information for the IP address are removed. Since static ARP entries are not possible when static subscriber hosts are defined or when DHCP lease state table population is enabled, conflict between static ARP entries and the arp-populate function is not an issue.

The arp-populate command will fail if an existing static subscriber host on the SAP does not have both MAC and IP addresses specified.

Once arp-populate is enabled, creating a static subscriber host on the SAP without both an IP address and MAC address will fail.

arp-populate can only be enabled on VPRN interfaces supporting Ethernet encapsulation.

The no form of the command disables ARP cache population functions for static and dynamic hosts on the interface. All static and dynamic host information in the systems ARP cache will be removed. Any existing static ARP entries previously inactive due to static or dynamic hosts will be populated in the system ARP cache.

When arp-populate is enabled, the system will not send out ARP Requests for hosts that are not in the ARP cache. Only statically configured and DHCP learned hosts are reachable through an IP interface with arp-populate enabled.

Default 

not enabled

arp-timeout

Syntax 
arp-timeout seconds
no arp-timeout
Context 
config>service>vprn>interface
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command configures the minimum time in seconds an ARP entry learned on the IP interface will be stored in the ARP table. ARP entries are automatically refreshed when an ARP request or gratuitous ARP is seen from an IP host, otherwise, the ARP entry is aged from the ARP table. If arp-timeout is set to a value of zero seconds, ARP aging is disabled.

Default 

14400 seconds

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the minimum number of seconds a learned ARP entry will be stored in the ARP table, expressed as a decimal integer. A value of zero specifies that the timer is inoperative and learned ARP entries will not be aged.
Values—
0 to 65535

 

lease-populate

Syntax 
lease-populate [nbt-of-entries]
no lease-populate
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>dhcp
Description 

This command enables dynamic host lease state management for SAPs.

For VPLS, DHCP snooping must be explicitly enabled (using the snoop command) at all points where DHCP messages requiring snooping enter the VPLS instance (both from the DHCP server and from the subscribers). Lease state information is extracted from snooped DHCP ACK messages to populate lease state table entries for the MSAP.

The optional number-of-entries parameter is used to define the number lease state table entries allowed for an MSAP or IP interface. If number-of-entries is omitted, only a single entry is allowed. Once the maximum number of entries has been reached, subsequent lease state entries are not allowed and subsequent DHCP ACK messages are discarded.

The retained lease state information representing dynamic hosts may be used to:

  1. Populate an MSAP based anti-spoof filter table to provide dynamic anti-spoof filtering. If the system is unable to populate the dynamic host information in the anti-spoof filter table on the SAP, the DHCP ACK message must be discarded without adding new lease state entry or updating an existing lease state entry.
  2. Generate dynamic ARP replies if arp-reply-agent is enabled.

The no form of the command disables dynamic host lease state management for the MSAP.

Default 

no lease-populate

Parameters 
nbt-of-entries—
Specifies the maximum number of DHCP leases
Values—
1 to 131071

 

export-host-routes

Syntax 
[no] export-host-routes
Context 
config>service>ies>subscriber-interface
config>service>vprn>subscriber-interface
Description 

This command controls the export of subscriber management host routes from a retail service to the corresponding forwarding wholesale VPRN service.

By default, subscriber management host routes are not exported.

The presence of retail subscriber management host routes in the wholesale VPRN service is required for downstream traffic forwarding in multi-chassis redundancy scenario’s with a redundant interface and when the retail subscriber subnets are not leaked in the wholesale VPRN service (allow-unmatching-subnets or unnumbered retail subscriber interface).

This command will fail if the subscriber interface is not associated with a forwarding wholesale service subscriber interface or if the subscriber interface is not configured to support address allocation outside the provisioned subnets (allow-unmatching-subnets or unnumbered subscriber interface)

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no export-host-routes

group-interface

Syntax 
group-interface ip-int-name [create] [type]
group-interface ip-int-name
Context 
config>service>ies>subscriber-interface
config>service>vprn>subscriber-interface
Description 

This command creates a group interface. This interface is designed for triple-play services where multiple SAPs are part of the same subnet. A group interface may contain one or more SAPs.

The no form of the command removes the group interface from the subscriber interface.

Default 

no group interfaces configured

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
Specifies the interface name of a group interface. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on.), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
lns —
Specifies to use LNS
wlangw—
Specifies to use dynamic GRE encapsulation

data-trigger

Syntax 
data-trigger
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure data-triggered subscriber management entities.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress network filter parameters for the interface.

policy-accounting

Syntax 
policy-accounting template-name
no policy-accounting
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ingress
Description 

This command configures the specified policy accounting template.

The no form of the command disables the policy accounting template.

Parameters 
template-name—
Specifies the template name up to 32 characters in length

ip-mtu

Syntax 
ip-mtu octets
no ip-mtu
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command specifies the maximum size of IP packets on this group interface. Packets larger than this are fragmented.

The ip-mtu applies to all IPoE host types (dhcp, arp, static). For PPP/L2TP sessions, the ip-mtu is not taken into account for the MTU negotiation. The ppp-mtu in the ppp-policy should be used instead.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ip-mtu

Parameters 
octets—
Specifies the largest frame size (in octets) that this interface can handle
Values—
512 to 9000

 

enable-ingress-stats

Syntax 
[no] enable-ingress-stats
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enables the collection of ingress interface IP stats. This command is only applicable to IP statistics, and not to uRPF statistics.

If enabled, then the following statistics are collected:

  1. IPv4 offered packets
  2. IPv4 offered octets
  3. IPv6 offered packets
  4. IPv6 offered octets
Note:

Octet statistics for IPv4 and IPv6 bytes at IP interfaces include the layer 2 frame overhead.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no enable-ingress-stats

host-connectivity-verify

Syntax 
host-connectivity-verify [interval interval] [action {remove | alarm}] [timeout retry-timeout] [retry-count count] [family family]
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enables subscriber host connectivity verification on a given SAP within a service. This tool will periodically scan all known hosts (from dhcp-state) and perform UC ARP requests. The subscriber host connectivity verification will maintain state (connected vs. not-connected) for all hosts.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no host-connectivity-verify

Parameters 
interval
Specifies the interval, in minutes, which specifies the time interval which all known sources should be verified. The actual rate is then dependent on the number of known hosts and interval.
Values—
1 to 6000
A zero value can be used by the SNMP agent to disable host-connectivity-verify.

 

action {remove | alarm}—
Defines the action taken on a subscriber host connectivity verification failure for a given host. The remove keyword raises an alarm and removes dhcp-state and releases all allocated resources (queues, table entries and and so on). DHCP-RELEASE will be signaled to corresponding DHCP server. Static hosts will be never removed. The alarm keyword raises an alarm indicating that the host is disconnected.
retry-timeout
Specifies the retry timeout
Values—
10 to 60 seconds

 

count
Specifies the number of retry requests
Values—
2 to 29

 

family
Allows the host connectivity checks to be performed for IPv4 endpoint, IPv6 endpoint or both. With family IPv6 configured, host connectivity checks will be performed on the global unicast address (assigned via SLAAC or DHCPv6 IA_NA) and link-local address of a Layer 3 RG or bridged hosts. In case of SLAAC assignment, host connectivity can only be performed if the /128 is known (via downstream ND). DHCPv6 PD assigned prefixes will be removed if link-local address is determined to be unreachable via host connectivity check” Reachability checks for GUA and link-local address will be done simultaneously.
Values—
ipv4, ipv6, both

 

ipoe-linking

Syntax 
ipoe-linking
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IPoE host linking.

gratuitous-rtr-adv

Syntax 
[no] gratuitous-rtr-adv
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>ipoe-linking
config>service>vprn>sub-if>ipoe-linking
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-linking
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-linking
Description 

This command enables the generation of unsolicited Router-advertisement on creation of v4 host.

The no form of the command disables gratuitous-rtr-adv.

Default 

gratuitous-rtr-adv

ipoe-session

Syntax 
[no] ipoe-session
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IPoE session parameters.

shared-circuit-id

Syntax 
[no] shared-circuit-id
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

If configured, circuit-id in DHCPv4 option-82 is used to authenticate DHCPv6. If DHCPv6 is received before DHCPv4, it is dropped. Also, a SLAAC host is created based on DHCPv4 authentication if RADIUS returns IPv6 framed-prefix. IPv6oE host is deleted if the linked IPv4oE host is deleted due to DHCP release or lease time-out. The linkage between IPv4 and IPv6 is based on SAP and MAC address. The sharing of circuit-id from DHCPv4 for authentication of DHCPv6 (or SLAAC) allows 7750 SR to work around lack of support for LDRA on Access-nodes.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no shared-circuit-id

ipv6

Syntax 
[no] ipv6
Context 
config>service>ies>if
config>service>vprn>if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IPv6 for an IES interface.

qos-route-lookup

Syntax 
[no] qos-route-lookup
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipv6
Description 

This command enables QoS route lookup for the interface.

The no form of the command reverts to the default (strict) mode.

urpf-check

Syntax 
[no] urpf-check
Context 
config>service>ies>if
config>service>ies>if>ipv6
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipv6
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enables unicast RPF (uRPF) check on this interface.

The no form of the command disables unicast RPF (uRPF) check on this interface.

Default 

no urpf-check

mode

Syntax 
mode {strict | loose | strict-no-ecmp}
no mode
Context 
config>service>ies>if>urfp-check
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipv6>urfp-check
Description 

This command specifies the mode of unicast RPF check.

The no form of the command reverts to the default (strict) mode.

Default 

strict

Parameters 
strict—
When specified, uRPF checks whether incoming packet has a source address that matches a prefix in the routing table, and whether the interface expects to receive a packet with this source address prefix.
loose—
In loose mode, uRPF checks whether incoming packet has source address with a corresponding prefix in the routing table. However, the loose mode does not check whether the interface expects to receive a packet with a specific source address prefix. This object is valid only when urpf-check is enabled.
strict-no-ecmp—
When a packet is received on an interface in this mode and the SA matches an ECMP route the packet is dropped by uRPF

match-circuit-id

Syntax 
[no] match-circuit-id
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>dhcp
Description 

This command enables Option 82 circuit ID on relayed DHCP packet matching. For routed CO, the group interface DHCP relay process is stateful. When packets are relayed to the server the virtual router ID, transaction ID, SAP ID, and client hardware MAC address of the relayed packet are tracked.

When a response is received from the server the virtual router ID, transaction ID, and client hardware MAC address must be matched to determine the SAP on which to send the packet out. In some cases, the virtual router ID, transaction ID, and client hardware MAC address are not guaranteed to be unique.

When the match-circuit-id command is enabled this as part of the key is used to guarantee correctness in our lookup. This is really only needed when dealing with an IP aware DSLAM that proxies the client hardware MAC address.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no match-circuit-id

mac

Syntax 
mac ieee-address
no mac
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command assigns a specific MAC address to a subscriber group interface.

The no form of the command returns the MAC address of the group interface to the default value.

Default 

The physical MAC address associated with the Ethernet interface that the SAP is configured on (the default MAC address assigned to the interface, assigned by the system).

Parameters 
ieee-address—
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.

oper-up-while-empty

Syntax 
[no] oper-up-while-empty
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command allows the subscriber interface to treat this group interface to be operationally enabled without any active SAPs.

This command is typically used with MSAPs where advertising the subnet prior to having a MSAP dynamically created is needed.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no oper-up-while-empty

policy-control

Syntax 
policy-control diameter-policy-name
no policy-control
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command configures a policy-control policy for the interface.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
diameter-policy-name
Specifies the name of an existing diameter policy up to 32 characters in length

proxy-arp-policy

Syntax 
[no] proxy-arp-policy policy-name [policy-name...(up to 5 max)]
Context 
config>service>ies>if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>if
Description 

This command configures a proxy ARP policy for the interface.

The no form of this command disables the proxy ARP capability.

Default 

no proxy-arp-policy

Parameters 
policy-name—
The export route policy name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

The specified name(s) must already be defined.

router-advertisements

Syntax 
[no] router-advertisements
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>ipv6
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipv6
config>service>vprn>sub-if>ipv6
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipv6
Description 

This command enables IPv6 router advertisements for this interface.

The no form of the command disables the router advertisements.

mode

Syntax 
mode mode
Context 
config>card>mda>atm
Description 

This command configures the ATM MDA into a mode with the increased VC scale (16k VCs, as opposed to 8K VCs). ESM is supported only in 16K VCs mode. In 16K VCs mode, there is only one queue allocated to each VC in the ATM MDA. In 8K VCs mode, there are two queues allocated per VC.

The 16K VC mode is supported only on the 4-port oc-3/12c/STM-1/4c and the 16-port ATM oc-3/STM-1 ATM MDA.

Changing the ATM MDA mode requires a reset of the MDA. A warning is issued asking for the confirmation before the command is executed.

Default 

max8k-vc

Parameters 
mode—
Specifies the VC scale
Values—
max8k-vc, max16k-vc

 

agg-rate

Syntax 
[no] agg-rate
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
Description 

This command enters the context to configure aggregation rate parameters. This command is used to control an HQoS aggregate rate limit. It is used in conjunction with the following parameter commands: rate, limit-unused-bandwidth, and queue-frame-based-accounting.

When specified under a Vport, the agg-rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate or port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command.

The no form of the command disables the aggregation rate.

rate

Syntax 
rate {max | rate}
no rate
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport>agg-rate
Description 

This command defines the enforced aggregate rate for all queues associated with the agg-rate context. A rate must be specified for the agg-rate context to be considered to be active on the context’s object (SAP, subscriber, Vport, and so on.).

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no rate

Parameters 
rate —
Specifies the rate limit for the Vport
Values—
max, 1 to 3200000000, max

 

limit-unused-bandwidth

Syntax 
[no] limit-unused-bandwidth
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
Description 

This command enables aggregate rate overrun protection.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no limit-unused-bandwidth

queue-frame-based-accounting

Syntax 
[no] queue-frame-based-accounting
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
Description 

This command enables frame-based accounting on all queues associated with the agg-rate context. Only supported on Ethernet ports. Not supported on HSMDA Ethernet ports. Packet byte offset settings are not included in the applied rate when queue frame based accounting is configured, however the offsets are applied to the statistics.

The no form of the command disables frame-based accounting.

Default 

no queue-frame-based-accounting

vpi

Syntax 
vpi vpi egress-traffic-desc atm-td-profile-id
no vpi vpi
Context 
config>port>sonet-sdh>path>atm
Description 

This command enables the ATM VP shaper under the ATM port. The type of ATM shaper are CBR or rt/nrt-VBR as defined by the traffic descriptor. It cannot be a UBR service-type.

All VCs within the shaper will degrade into a UBR type service class. For example, when a CBR type VC is associated with the shaper, it will degrade into a UBR type VC. Scheduling traffic amongst VCs within the shaper is based on WRR using the weight parameter.

If the VP shaper is deleted, the VCs that were under it is restored to their original service category.

The VP shaper is statically configured and instantiated upon configuration.

A VP shaper can be seamlessly added to or removed from the active VCs in the system.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
vpi—
Specifies the VP identifier
Values—
0 to 4095

 

atm-td-profile-id—
Specifies the ATM traffic description ID
Values—
1 to 1000

 

traffic-desc

Syntax 
traffic-desc atm-td-profile-id
no traffic-desc
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>atm>egress
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>atm>ingress
Description 

This command references traffic-descriptor id for VPs and VCs. The VP shaper cannot be of service-type UBR.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

Default traffic descriptor (id=1) of UBR type.

Parameters 
atm-td-profile-id—
Specifies the traffic-descriptor ID
Values—
1 to 1000

 

weight

Syntax 
weight weight
no weight
Context 
config>qos>atm-td-profile
Description 

VCs within the VP tunnel are serviced by a single scheduler assigned to each VP tunnel. VCs within the shaped VP tunnel are degraded from the originally assigned service category to a common UBR service category (default traffic descriptor). Scheduling between VCs are based on WRR with a weight parameter that can be explicitly configured in the ATM traffic descriptor profile. If weight is not specifically configured, the defaults are taken.

The explicitly configured weight parameter is honored only on the ATM MDA in the max16k-vc mode. On all other ATM capable MDAs (ASAP or ATM MDA in max8k-vc mode), the weight parameter is ignored.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

VC degraded from CBR = weight 10

VC degraded from rt-VBR = weight 7

VC degraded from nrt-VBR = weight 5

VC degraded from UBR+ = weight 2

VC degraded from UBR = weight 1

Parameters 
weight—
Specifies the weight parameter value
Values—
1 to 255

 

encapsulation

Syntax 
encapsulation [aal5auto | aal5nlpid-ppp | aal5mux-ppp | aal5snap-bridged | aal5mux-bridged-eth-nofcs]
no encapsulation
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vpls>sap>atm
Description 

This command is a SAP level command that either statically sets or enable dynamic detection of the encapsulation.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no encapsulation

Parameters 
aal5auto —
This option is available only in max16k-vc mode on dynamic or static SAPs. Enables automatic detection of one of the four supported encapsulation types.
aal5mux-bridged-eth-nofcs—
This option already exist outside of the ESM context on regular interfaces. Within the ESM context (group-interfaces and capture SAPs), this option is available only in max16K-vc mode. The encapsulation is statically set to VC-MUX bridged Ethernet with no FCS. This is a valid encapsulation only for PPPoEoA.
aal5mux-ppp—
This option is available only in max16k-vc mode on dynamic or static SAPs. The encapsulation is statically set VC-MUX PPP encapsulation. This is a valid encapsulation only for PPPoA.
aal5nlpid-ppp—
dynamic or static SAPs. The encapsulation is statically set to NLPID (LLC) PPP encapsulation. This is a valid encapsulation only for PPPoA.
aal5snap-bridged—
This option already exist outside of the ESM context on regular interfaces. Within the ESM context (group-interfaces and capture SAPs), this option is available only in max16k-vc mode. The encapsulation is statically set to bridged Ethernet with or without FCS. Both PIDs (0x 00-01 and 0x 00-07) are accepted on ingress and use this to determine whether to strip four bytes from the end of the encapsulated Ethernet frame. The inner FCS is not checked. This is a valid encapsulation only for PPPoEoA.
Note:

On ATM, frames with Ethernet FCS or without FCS, are accepted but only frames with no Ethernet FCS are sent.

def-inter-dest-id

Syntax 
def-inter-dest-id string interest-string
def-inter-dest-id {use-top-q | use-vpi}
no def-inter-dest-id
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command associates the Vport with the subscriber. The association method depends on the configured option.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no def-inter-dest-id

Parameters 
string—
A RADIUS VSA (Alc-Int-Dest-Id-Str, type 28) obtained during the subscriber authentication phase will contain the destination string name that will be matched against the string defined under the Vport. In this fashion the subscriber host will be associated with the corresponding Vport.

Alternatively, the destination string can be defined in LUDB.

use-top-q—
This is applicable only to Ethernet ports.
use-vpi—
VP Identifier (VPI) will be used to make the association between the subscriber and the Vport automatically.

Control Plane will be aware of the VPI during the session initiation phase. This VPI will be used to make the association between the host and the Vport with the same name (VPI number).

Note:

In this case the Vport name under the configure>port>sonet-sdh>path>access>egress context must be the VPI number.

pppoe-user-db

Syntax 
pppoe-user-db ludb-name
no pppoe-user-db
Context 
config>services>vpls>sap
Description 

This command enables LUDB authentication on capture SAPs for PPPoE(oA) clients. If this command is configured along with the authentication-policy command (RADIUS authentication), then the authentication-policy command will take precedence.

Optionally, with a separate command (ppp-user-db) PPPoA clients can be authenticated under a separate LUDB.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no pppoe-user-db

Parameters 
ludb-name—
Specifies the name of the local user database up to 32 characters in length

ppp-user-db

Syntax 
ppp-user-db ludb-name
no ppp-user-db
Context 
config>services>vpls>sap
Description 

This command enables LUDB authentication on capture SAPs for PPPoA clients. If this command is configured along with the authentication-policy command (RADIUS authentication), then the authentication-policy command will take precedence.

Optionally, with a separate command (pppoe-user-db) PPPoE(oA) clients can be authenticated under a separate LUDB.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ppp-user-db

Parameters 
ludb-name—
Specifies the name of local user database up to 256 characters in length

ppp-policy

Syntax 
ppp-policy ppp-pol-name
no ppp-policy
Context 
config>services>vpls>sap
Description 

This command references a ppp-policy that will define session parameters (ppp-mtu, authentication options, and so on) during the session initiation phase. Normally, the PPP policy is referenced under the group-interface hierarchy. But with capture SAP is it not known at the session initiation phase to which group-interface the session belongs. This is why, with the capture SAP, the ppp-policy must be referenced directly under the capture SAP. The ppp-policy referenced under the group-interface must be the same as the ppp-policy referenced under the capture SAP. Otherwise the session will not come up.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ppp-policy

Parameters 
ppp-pol-name—
Specifies the PPP policy name up to 32 characters in length

pppoe-policy

Syntax 
pppoe-policy pppoe-policy-name
no pppoe-policy
Context 
config>services>vpls>sap
Description 

This command references a pppoe-policy that will define session parameters (ppp-mtu, authentication options, and so on) during the session initiation phase. Normally, the PPPoE policy is referenced under the group-interface hierarchy. But with capture SAP is it not known at the session initiation phase to which group-interface the session belongs. This is why, with the capture SAP, the ppp-policy must be referenced directly under the capture SAP. The pppoe-policy referenced under the group-interface must be the same as the pppoe-policy referenced under the capture SAP. Otherwise the session will not come up.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no pppoe-policy

Parameters 
pppoe-policy-name—
Specifies the pppoe-policy name up to 32 characters in length

rtr-solicit-user-db

Syntax 
rtr-solicit-user-db local-user-db
no rtr-solicit-user-db
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
Description 

This command enabled access to LUDB for SLAAC hosts under the capture SAP. The name of this ludb must match the name of ludb configured under the configure>service>vprn/ies>subscrintf>group-intf>ipv6>router-solicit> hierarchy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no rtr-solicit-user-db

Parameters 
local-user-db —
Specifies the name of the local-user-database up to 32 characters in length

vc-range

Syntax 
vc-range num vpi-range vpi-range vci-range vci-range
no vc-range num
Context 
config>services>vpls>sap>atm
Description 

This command configures ATM Virtual Circuit ranges and is supported only in max16k-vc ATM MDA mode. An ATM MDA supports a number of passive (or listening) VCs, of which a subset can be simultaneously active.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no vc-range-num

Parameters 
num—
Specifies the VC range.
Values—
1 to 5 (Five ranges are supported to accommodate non-contiguous ranges of VPI/VCI pairs.

 

vci-range vci-range
Specifies the VCI range
Values—
1, 2, 5 to 65535 (Contiguous VCI ranges in the form of x-y.)

 

vpi-range vpi-range . —
Specifies the VPI range
Values—
0 to 255 for UNI
0 to 4095 for NNI
(Contiguous VPI range in the form of x-y)

 

local-address-assignment

Syntax 
local-address-assignment
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enters the context t configure the local address assignment.

ipv6

Syntax 
[no] ipv6
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IPv6 local address assignment parameters.

client-application

Syntax 
client-application [ppp-v4]
no client-application
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
Description 

This command enables local router DHCP server pool management for PPPoXv4 clients. A pool of IP addresses can be shared between IPoE clients that rely on DHCP protocol (lease renewal process) and PPPoX clients where address allocation is not dependent on DHCP messaging but instead an IP address allocation within the pool is tied to the PPPoX session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no client-application

client-application

Syntax 
client-application [ppp-slaac] [ipoe-wan] [ipoe-slaac]
no client-application
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign>ipv6
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign>ipv6
Description 

This command defines the client application that will use the local address server to perform address assignment. This feature is relies on RADIUS or local-user-database to return a pool name. The pool name is matched again the pools defined in the local-dhcp6-server configuration. The name of the local-dhcp6-server must also be provisioned.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no client-application

Parameters 
ppp-slaac—
This parameter indicates using the local DHCPv6 prefix pool to assign SLAAC prefixes for hosts. The pool name where the prefixes are used for SLAAC prefix assignment are obtained from RADIUS or local-user-database during the authentication process. The RADIUS attribute Alc-slaac-ipv6-pool is used to indicate the SLAAC pool name for PPPoE hosts.
ipoe-wan—
This parameter indicates using the local DHCPv6 pool for IA_NA address assignment and a static pre-defined prefixes for IA_PD. Both the IA_NA pool name and the IA_PD static framed-prefix are either obtained from RADIUS or LUDB during authentication. In the case of RADIUS, it must return both IA_NA Framed-IPv6-Pool and IA_PD Delegated-IPv6-Prefix after a successful authentication. In the case of LUDB, it must have ipv6-wan-address-pool and ipv6-delegated-prefix populated. This feature is specific to this use case and is not required for other combinations of DHCPv6 assignments such as IA_NA and IA_PD address assignment through RADIUS or LUDB.
ipoe-slaac—
This parameter indicates using the local DHCPv6 prefix pool to assign SLAAC prefixes for hosts. The pool name where the prefixes are used for SLAAC prefix assignment are obtained from RADIUS or local-user-database during the authentication process. The RADIUS attribute Alc-slaac-ipv6-pool is used to indicate the SLAAC pool name for PPPoE hosts.

default-pool

Syntax 
default-pool pool-name [secondary pool-name]
no default-pool
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
Description 

This command references a default DHCP address pool for local PPPoX pool management in case that the pool-name is not returned via RADIUS or LUDB.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
pool-name—
Specifies the name of the local router DHCP server pool

server

Syntax 
server server-name
no server
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
Description 

This command designates a local router DHCPv4 server for local pools management where IPv4 addresses for PPPoXv4 clients will be allocated without the need for the internal router DHCP relay-agent. Those addresses will be tied to PPPoX sessions and they will be de-allocated when the PPPoX session is terminated.

Parameters 
server-name—
The name of the local 7450 ESS or 7750 SR DHCP server

server

Syntax 
server server-name
no server
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign>ipv6
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign>ipv6
Description 

This command designates a local router DHCPv6 server for local pools management where IPv6 prefixes or address for PPPoXv6 clients or IPoEv6 clients will be allocated without the need for the internal router DHCP relay-agent. Those addresses will be tied to PPPoX or IPoE sessions and they will be de-allocated when the PPPoX or IPoE session is terminated.

Parameters 
server-name—
The name of the local router DHCPv6 server.

9.25.2.1.16.1. Layer 3 Subscriber Interfaces SAP Commands

accounting-policy

Syntax 
accounting-policy acct-policy-id
no accounting-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>if>spoke-sdp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command specifies the policy to use to collect accounting statistics on a subscriber profile.

A maximum of one accounting policy can be associated with a profile at one time.

The no form of this command removes the accounting policy association.

Default 

no accounting policy

Parameters 
acct-policy-id—
Specifies an existing accounting policy ID as configured in the config>log>accounting-policy context
Values—
1 to 99

 

anti-spoof

Syntax 
anti-spoof {ip | ip-mac | nh-mac}
no anti-spoof
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy
Description 

This command configures the anti-spoof type of the MSAP.

The type of anti-spoof filtering defines what information in the incoming packet is used to generate the criteria to lookup an entry in the anti-spoof filter table. The type parameter (ip, ip-mac) defines the anti-spoof filter type enforced by the SAP when anti-spoof filtering is enabled.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Note:

For IES and VPRN subscriber group interfaces, setting no anti-spoof will set the default anti-spoofing type which is ip-mac.

Default 

no anti-spoof

Parameters 
ip—
Configures SAP anti-spoof filtering to use only the source IP address in its lookup. If a static host exists on the SAP without an IP address specified, the anti-spoof type ip command will fail.
Note:

This parameter is not applicable in the config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy context.

ip-mac—
Configures SAP anti-spoof filtering to use both the source IP address and the source MAC address in its lookup. The anti-spoof type ip-mac command will fail if the default anti-spoof filter type of the SAP is ip-mac and the default is not overridden, or if the SAP does not support Ethernet encapsulation.
nh-mac—
Indicates that the ingress anti-spoof is based on the source MAC and egress anti-spoof is based on the nh-ip-address

app-profile

Syntax 
app-profile app-profile-name
no app-profile
Context 
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command configures the application profile name.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
app-profile-name—
Specifies an existing application profile name configured in the config>app-assure>group>policy context

collect-stats

Syntax 
[no] collect-stats
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

When enabled, the agent collects non-RADIUS accounting statistics on a subscriber profile.

When the no collect-stats command is issued the statistics are still accumulated by the IOM cards. However, the CPU will not obtain the results and write them to the billing file. If a subsequent collect-stats command is issued then the counters written to the billing file include all the traffic while the

collect-stats

default-host

Syntax 
default-host ipv4-prefix/mask | ipv6-prefix/prefix-length next-hop ipv4-address | ipv6-address
no default-host ipv4-prefix/mask | ipv6-prefix/prefix-length
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command configures the default-host. More than one default host can be configured per SAP.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

no lease-populate

Parameters 
ipv64prefix/prefix-length—
Specifies an IPv4 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv4-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

prefix-length - [0 to 128]

 

ipv6-prefix/prefix-length—
Specifies an IPv6 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

prefix-length - [0 to 128]

 

next-hop—
Assigns the next hop IP address

cpu-protection

Syntax 
cpu-protection policy-id [mac-monitoring] | [eth-cfm-monitoring [aggregate] [car]]
no cpu-protection
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command assigns an existing CPU protection policy to the associated group interface. The CPU protection policies are configured in the config>sys>security>cpu-protection>policy cpu-protection-policy-id context.

If no CPU-Protection policy is assigned to a group interface SAP, then the default policy is used to limit the overall-rate. The default policy is policy number 254 for access interfaces and 255 for network interfaces.

The no form of the command removes the association of the CPU protection policy from the associated interface and reverts to the default policy values.

Default 

cpu-protection 254 (for access interfaces)

cpu-protection 255 (for network interfaces)

The configuration of no cpu-protection returns the interface/SAP to the default policies as shown above.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Specifies an existing CPU protection policy
Values—
1 to 255

 

mac-monitoring—
Specifies to enable MAC monitoring
eth-cfm-monitoring
Specifies to enable Ethernet Connectivity Fault Management monitoring
aggregate—
Applies the rate limit to the sum of the per peer packet rates
car—
Applies the Committed Access Rate (CAR). This keyword causes Eth-CFM packets to be ignored when enforcing the overall-rate.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress SAP Quality of Service (QoS) policies and filter policies.

If no sap-egress QoS policy is defined, the system default sap-egress QoS policy is used for egress processing. If no egress filter is defined, no filtering is performed.

filter

Syntax 
filter ip ip-filter-id
filter
no filter [ip ip-filter-id]
no filter
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command associates an IP filter policy with an ingress or egress Service Access Point (SAP). Filter policies control the forwarding and dropping of packets based on the matching criteria.

MAC filters are only allowed on Epipe and Virtual Private LAN Service (VPLS) SAPs.

The filter command is used to associate a filter policy with a specified ip-filter-id with an ingress or egress SAP. The filter policy must already be defined before the filter command is executed. If the filter policy does not exist, the operation will fail and an error message returned.

In general, filters applied to SAPs (ingress or egress) apply to all packets on the SAP. One exception is non-IP packets are not applied to the match criteria, so the default action in the filter policy applies to these packets.

The no form of this command removes any configured filter ID association with the SAP. The filter ID itself is not removed from the system unless the scope of the created filter is set to local. To avoid deletion of the filter ID and only break the association with the service object, use the scope command within the filter definition to change the scope to local or global. The default scope of a filter is local.

Special Cases 
IES—
Only IP filters are supported on an IES IP interface, and the filters only apply to routed traffic
Parameters 
ip—
Keyword indicating the filter policy is an IP filter.
ip-filter-id—
Specifies the ID for the IP filter policy. Allowed values are an integer in the range of 1 and 65535 that corresponds to a previously created IP filter policy in the configure>filter context.

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id
no qos
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

Associates a Quality of Service (QoS) policy with an egress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface.

QoS egress policies are important for the enforcement of SLA agreements. The policy ID must be defined prior to associating the policy with a SAP or IP interface. If the policy-id does not exist, an error will be returned.

The qos command is used to associate egress QoS policies. The qos command only allows egress policies on SAP or IP interface egress. Attempts to associate a QoS policy of the wrong type returns an error.

Only one ingress QoS policy can be associated with a SAP or IP interface at one time. Attempts to associate a second QoS policy of a given type will return an error.

By default, no specific QoS policy is associated with the SAP or IP interface for egress, so the default QoS policy is used.

The normal behavior is for queues to be created per destination.

The no form of this command removes the QoS policy association from the SAP or IP interface, and the QoS policy reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policy-id—
The egress policy ID to associate with SAP or IP interface on egress. The policy ID must already exist.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id [shared-queuing]
no qos
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

Associates a Quality of Service (QoS) policy with an ingress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface.

QoS ingress policies are important for the enforcement of SLA agreements. The policy ID must be defined prior to associating the policy with a SAP or IP interface. If the policy-id does not exist, an error will be returned.

This qos command is used to associate ingress QoS policies. The qos command only allows ingress policies to be associated on SAP or IP interface ingress.

Only one ingress and one egress QoS policy can be associated with a SAP or IP interface at one time. Attempts to associate a second QoS policy of a given type will return an error.

By default, no specific QoS policy is associated with the SAP or IP interface for ingress so the default QoS policy is used.

The normal behavior is for queues to be created per destination. Shared and multipoint shared change this behavior creating either unicast or unicast and mcast shared queues.

The no form of this command removes the QoS policy association from the SAP or IP interface, and the QoS policy reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policy-id—
The ingress policy ID to associate with SAP or IP interface on ingress. The policy ID must already exist.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

shared-queuing—
This keyword can only be specified on SAP ingress. Specify the ingress shared queue policy used by a SAP. When the value of this object is null it means that the SAP will use individual ingress QoS queues, instead of the shared ones.

policer-control-policy

Syntax 
policer-control-policy policy-name
no policer-control-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command is used to create, delete, or modify policer control policies. The policer-control-policy controls the aggregate bandwidth available to a set of child policers. Once created, the policy can be applied to ingress or egress SAPs. The policy can also be applied to the ingress or egress context of a sub-profile.

The no form of the command resets the command to the default setting.

Default 

no policer-control-policy

Parameters 
policy-name
Specifies the policer control policy name. Each policer control policy name must be unique and adhere to the system policy ASCII naming requirements. If the defined policy name already exists, the system enters that policy’s context for editing purposes. If policy-name does not exist, the system will attempt to create a policy with the specified name.

qinq-mark-top-only

Syntax 
[no] qinq-mark-top-only
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
Description 

When the encapsulation type is qinq for the access port for the specified SAP, enabling this command specifies which P-bits or DEI bit to mark during packet egress. Only the P-bits or DEI bit in the top Q tag are marked. When this command is disabled, both sets of P-bits and the DEI bit are marked.

Default 

no qinq-mark-top-only

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
no scheduler-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command applies an existing scheduler policy to an ingress or egress scheduler used by ingress SAP queues or egress SAP policers and queues associated with this multi-service customer site. The schedulers defined in the scheduler policy can only be created once the customer site has been appropriately assigned to a chassis port, channel or slot. Scheduler policies are defined in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context.

The no form of this command removes the configured ingress or egress scheduler policy from the multi-service customer site. When the policy is removed, the schedulers created due to the policy are removed also making them unavailable for the SAP policers or queues associated with the customer site. Policers and queues that lose their parent scheduler association are deemed to be orphaned and are no longer subject to a virtual scheduler. The SAPs that have policers or queues reliant on the removed schedulers enter into an operational state depicting the orphaned status of one or more policers or queues. When the no form of the command executed, the customer site ingress or egress node will not contain an applied scheduler policy.

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name:—
Specifies the scheduler policy name to apply to an existing scheduler policy that was created in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context to create the hierarchy of ingress or egress virtual schedulers. The scheduler names defined within the policy are created and made available to any ingress queues or egress policers and queues created on associated SAPs.
Values—
Any existing valid scheduler policy name.

 

host

Syntax 
host ip ip-address [mac ieee-address]] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile sub-profile-name] [sla-profile sla-profile-name]
no host {[ip ip-address] [mac ieee-address]}
no host all
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>ies>if>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command creates a static subscriber host for the SAP. Static subscriber hosts may be used by the system for various purposes. Applications within the system that make use of static host entries include anti-spoof filters and ARP cache population.

Multiple static hosts may be defined on the SAP. Each host is identified by either a source IP address, a source MAC address or both a source IP and source MAC address. Every static host definition must have at least one address defined, IP or MAC.

Static hosts can exist on the SAP even with anti-spoof and ARP populate features disabled. When enabled, each feature has different requirements for static hosts.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Parameters 
anti-spoof—
When enabled, this feature uses static and dynamic host information to populate entries into an anti-spoof filter table. The anti-spoof filter entries generated will be of the same type as specified in the anti-spoof type parameter. If the SAP anti-spoof filter is defined as ip, each static host definition must specify an IP address. If the SAP anti-spoof filter is defined as ip-mac, each static host definition must specify both an IP address and MAC address. If definition of a static host is attempted without the appropriate addresses specified for the enabled anti-spoof filter, the static host definition will fail.
arp-populate—
When enabled, this feature uses static and dynamic host information to populate entries in the system ARP cache.

Attempting to define a static subscriber host that conflicts with an existing DHCP lease state table entry will fail.

Use the no form of the command to remove a static entry from the system. The specified ip-address and mac-address must match the host’s exact IP and MAC addresses as defined when it was created. When a static host is removed from the SAP, the corresponding anti-spoof entry and/or ARP cache entry is also removed.

ip-address —
Specifies this optional parameter when defining a static host. The IP address must be specified for anti-spoof ip, anti-spoof ip-mac and arp-populate. Only one static host may be configured on the SAP with a given IP address.
mac-address —
Specifies this optional parameter when defining a static host. The MAC address must be specified for anti-spoof ip-mac and arp-populate. Multiple static hosts may be configured with the same MAC address given that each definition is distinguished by a unique IP address.
sub-ident-string —
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing subscriber identification profile to be associated with the static subscriber host. The subscriber identification profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol context. The subscriber information is used by the VPRN SAP arp-reply-agent to determine the proper handling of received ARP requests from subscribers.

For VPRN SAPs with arp-reply-agent enabled with the optional sub-ident parameter, the static subscriber hosts sub-ident-string is used to determine whether an ARP request received on the SAP is sourced from a host belonging to the same subscriber as the destination host. When both the destination and source hosts from the ARP request are known on the SAP and the subscriber identifications do not match, the ARP request may be forwarded to the rest of the VPRN destinations.

If the static subscriber hosts sub-ident string is not defined, the host is not considered to belong to the same subscriber as another host on the SAP.

If source or destination host is unknown, the hosts are not considered to belong to the same subscriber. (ARP messages from unknown hosts are subject to anti-spoof filtering rules applied at the SAP.)

If sub-ident is not enabled on the SAP arp-reply-agent, subscriber identification matching is not performed on ARP requests received on the SAP.

ARP requests are never forwarded back to the same SAP or within the receiving SAP’s Split Horizon Group.

sub-profile-name
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing subscriber profile name to be associated with the static subscriber host. The subscriber profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile context.
sla-profile-name
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing SLA profile name to be associated with the static subscriber host. The SLA profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile context.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress SAP Quality of Service (QoS) policies and filter policies.

If no SAP ingress QoS policy is defined, the system default sap-ingress QoS policy is used for ingress processing. If no ingress filter is defined, no filtering is performed.

multi-service-site

Syntax 
[no] multi-service-site customer-site-name
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command creates a new customer site or edits an existing customer site with the customer-site-name parameter. A customer site is an anchor point to create an ingress and egress virtual scheduler hierarchy. When a site is created, it must be assigned to a chassis slot or port. When scheduler policies are defined for ingress and egress, the scheduler names contained in each policy are created according to the parameters defined in the policy. Multi-service customer sites exist for the sole purpose of creating a virtual scheduler hierarchy and making it available to queues on multiple Service Access Points (SAPs).

The scheduler policy association with the customer site normally prevents the scheduler policy from being deleted until after the scheduler policy is removed from the customer site. The multi-service-site object will generate a log message indicating that the association was deleted due to scheduler policy removal.

When the multi-service customer site is created, an ingress and egress scheduler policy association does not exist. This does not prevent the site from being assigned to a chassis slot or prevent service SAP assignment. After the site has been created, the ingress and egress scheduler policy associations can be assigned or removed at anytime.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
customer-site-name—
Each customer site must have a unique name within the context of the customer. If customer-site-name already exists for the customer ID, the CLI context changes to that site name for the purpose of editing the site scheduler policies or assignment. Any modifications made to an existing site will affect all SAPs associated with the site. Changing a scheduler policy association may cause new schedulers to be created and existing policers and queues on the SAPs to no longer be orphaned. Existing schedulers on the site may cease to exist, causing policers and queues relying on that scheduler to be orphaned.

If the customer-site-name does not exist, it is assumed that an attempt is being made to create a site of that name in the customer ID context. The success of the command execution depends on the following:

The maximum number of customer sites defined for the chassis slot has not been met.

The customer-site-name is valid.

The create keyword is included in the command line syntax (if the system requires it).

When the maximum number of customer sites has been exceeded a configuration error occurs, the command will not execute and the CLI context will not change.

If the customer-site-name is invalid, a syntax error occurs, the command will not execute and the CLI context will not change.

Values—
Valid names consist of any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

 

9.25.2.1.16.1. ATM Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

atm

Syntax 
atm
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command the context to configure ATM-related parameters. This command can only be used when a given context (for example, a channel or SAP) supports ATM functionality such as:

  1. Configuring ATM port or ATM port-related functionality on MDAs supporting ATM functionality
  2. Configuring ATM-related configuration for ATM-based SAPs that exist on MDAs supporting ATM functionality.

If ATM functionality is not supported for a given context, the command returns an error.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress ATM attributes for the SAP.

encapsulation

Syntax 
encapsulation atm-encap-type
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command configures RFC 2684, Multiprotocol Encapsulation over ATM Adaptation Layer 5, encapsulation for an ATM PVCC delimited SAP.

This command specifies the data encapsulation for an ATM PVCC delimited SAP. The definition references RFC 2684 and to the ATM Forum LAN Emulation specification.

Ingress traffic that does not match the configured encapsulation will be dropped.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

The encapsulation is driven by the services for which the SAP is configured. For IES service SAPs, the default is aal5snap-routed.

Parameters 
atm-encap-type—
Specify the encapsulation type
Values—
aal5snap-routed — Routed encapsulation for LLC encapsulated circuit (LLC/SNAP precedes protocol datagram) as defined in RFC 2684.
aal5mux-ip — Routed IP encapsulation for VC multiplexed circuit as defined in RFC 2684

 

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command configures ingress ATM attributes for the SAP.

traffic-desc

Syntax 
traffic-desc traffic-desc-profile-id
no traffic-desc
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
Description 

This command assigns an ATM traffic descriptor profile to a given context (for example, a SAP). When configured under the ingress context, the specified traffic descriptor profile defines the traffic contract in the forward direction. When configured under the egress context, the specified traffic descriptor profile defines the traffic contract in the backward direction.

The no form of the command reverts the traffic descriptor to the default traffic descriptor profile.

Default 

The default traffic descriptor (trafficDescProfileId. = 1) is associated with newly created PVCC-delimited SAPs.

Parameters 
traffic-desc-profile-id—
Specify a defined traffic descriptor profile (see the QoS atm-td-profile command).

oam

Syntax 
oam
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>interface >sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enters the context to configure OAM functionality for a PVCC delimiting a SAP.

The ATM-capable MDAs support F5 end-to-end OAM functionality (AIS, RDI, Loopback):

  1. ITU-T Recommendation I.610 - B-ISDN Operation and Maintenance Principles and Functions version 11/95
  2. GR-1248-CORE - Generic Requirements for Operations of ATM Network Elements (NEs). Issue 3 June 1996
  3. GR-1113-CORE - Bellcore, Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) and ATM Adaptation Layer (AAL) Protocols Generic Requirements, Issue 1, July 1994

alarm-cells

Syntax 
[no] alarm-cells
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
Description 

This command configures AIS/RDI fault management on a PVCC. Fault management allows PVCC termination to monitor and report the status of their connection by propagating fault information through the network and by driving PVCCs operational status.

When alarm-cells functionality is enabled, PVCCs operational status is affected when a PVCC goes into AIS or RDI state because of an AIS/RDI processing (i.e. assuming nothing else affects PVCCs operational status, PVCC goes DOWN, when it enters a fault state and comes back UP, when it exits that fault state) and RDI cell are generated when PVCC is operationally DOWN. No OAM-specific SNMP trap is raised whenever an endpoint enters/exits an AIS or RDI states, however, if as result of an OAM state change, the PVCC changes operational status, then a trap is expected from an entity the PVCC is associated with (for example a SAP).

The no form of the command disables alarm-cells functionality for a PVCC. When alarm-cells functionality is disabled, PVCCs operational status is no longer affected by PVCCs OAM state changes due to AIS/RDI processing (when alarm-cells is disabled, a PVCC will change operational status to UP, if it was DOWN because of the alarm-cell processing) and RDI cells are not generated as result of PVCC going into AIS or RDI state, however, PVCCs OAM status will record OAM faults as described above.

Default 

Enabled for PVCCs delimiting IES SAPs

periodic-loopback

Syntax 
[no] periodic-loopback
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>if >sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enables periodic OAM loopbacks on this SAP. This command is only configurable on IES and VPRN SAPs. When enabled, an ATM OAM loopback cell is transmitted every period as configured in the config>system>atm>oam>loopback-period period context.

If a response is not received and consecutive retry-down retries also result in failure, the endpoint will transition to an alarm indication signal/loss of clock state. Then, an ATM OAM loopback cell will be transmitted every period as configured in the loopback-period period. If a response is received for the periodic loopback and consecutive retry-up retries also each receive a response, the endpoint will transition back to the up state.

The no form of the command sets the value back to the default.

Default 

no periodic-loopback

9.25.2.1.16.2. Redundant Interface Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

redundant-interface

Syntax 
[no] redundant-interface ip-int-name
Context 
config>service>ies
config>service>vprn
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command configures a redundant interface.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface. Interface names can be from 1 to 32 alphanumeric characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

remote-proxy-arp

Syntax 
[no] remote-proxy-arp
Context 
config>service>ies>interface
Description 

This command enables remote proxy ARP on the interface.

The no form of the command disables remote proxy ARP on the interface.

Default 

no remote-proxy-arp

address

Syntax 
address {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask} [remote-ip ip-address]
no address
Context 
config>service>vprn>redundant-interface
Description 

This command assigns an IP address mask or netmask and a remote IP address to the interface.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Parameters 
ip-address/mask—
Assigns an IP address/IP subnet format to the interface
ip-address netmask—
Assigns an IP address netmask to the interface. Specifies a string of 0s and 1s that mask or screen out the network part of an IP address so that only the host computer part of the address remains.
remote-ip ip-address
Assigns a remote IP to the interface

spoke-sdp

Syntax 
[no] spoke-sdp sdp-id
Context 
config>service>vprn
Description 

This command binds a service to an existing Service Distribution Point (SDP).

A spoke SDP is treated like the equivalent of a traditional bridge “port” where flooded traffic received on the spoke SDP is replicated on all other “ports” (other spoke and mesh SDPs or SAPs) and not transmitted on the port it was received.

The SDP has an operational state which determines the operational state of the SDP within the service. For example, if the SDP is administratively or operationally down, the SDP for the service will be down.

The SDP must already be defined in the config>service>sdp context in order to associate an SDP with a VPRN service. If the sdp sdp-id is not already configured, an error message is generated. If the sdp-id does exist, a binding between that sdp-id and the service is created.

SDPs must be explicitly associated and bound to a service. If an SDP is not bound to a service, no far-end 7750 SR devices can participate in the service.

The no form of this command removes the SDP binding from the service. The SDP configuration is not affected; only the binding of the SDP to a service. Once removed, no packets are forwarded to the far-end router.

Special Cases 
VPRN—
Several SDPs can be bound to a VPRN service. Each SDP must be destined to a different 7750 SR OS. If two sdp-id bindings terminate on the same 7750 SR, an error occurs and the second SDP binding is rejected.
Parameters 
sdp-id—
The SDP identifier. Allowed values are integers in the range of 1 and 17407 for existing SDPs
vc-id—
The virtual circuit identifier
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress SDP parameters.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress SDP parameters.

vc-label

Syntax 
vc-label egress-vc-label
no vc-label [egress-vc-label]
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>egress
Description 

This command configures the egress VC label.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no vc-label

Parameters 
vc-label—
A VC egress value that indicates a specific connection
Values—
16 to 1048575

 

vc-label

Syntax 
vc-label ingress-vc-label
no vc-label [ingress-vc-label]
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>ingress
Description 

This command configures the ingress VC label.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no vc-label

Parameters 
vc-label—
A VC ingress value that indicates a specific connection
Values—
2048 to 18431

 

filter

Syntax 
filter {ip ip-filter-id}
no filter
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>ingress
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>egress
Description 

This command associates an IP filter policy with an ingress or egress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface. An IP filter policy can be associated with spoke SDPs.

Filter policies control the forwarding and dropping of packets based on IP or MAC matching criteria.

The filter command is used to associate a filter policy with a specified ip-filter-id with an ingress or egress SAP. The ip-filter-id must already be defined before the filter command is executed. If the filter policy does not exist, the operation will fail and an error message returned.

In general, filters applied to SAPs (ingress or egress) apply to all packets on the SAP. One exception is non-IP packets are not applied to IP match criteria, so the default action in the filter policy applies to these packets.

The no form of this command removes any configured filter ID association with the SAP or IP interface. The filter ID itself is not removed from the system unless the scope of the created filter is set to local. To avoid deletion of the filter ID and only break the association with the service object, use scope command within the filter definition to change the scope to local or global. The default scope of a filter is local.

Default 

no filter

Parameters 
ip-filter-id
Specifies IP filter policy. The filter ID must already exist within the created IP filters
Values—
1 to 65535

 

9.25.2.1.16.3. SDP Binding Commands

binding

Syntax 
binding
Context 
config>service>sdp
Description 

The command enters the context to configure SDP bindings.

port

Syntax 
port [port-id | lag-id]
no ort
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding
Description 

This command specifies the port or lag identifier, to which the PW ports associated with the underlying SDP are bound. If the underlying SDP is re-routed to a port or lag other than the specified one, the PW ports on the SDP are operationally brought down.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
port-id—
The identifier of the port in the slot/mda/port format
lag-id—
Specifies the LAG identifier

pw-port

Syntax 
pw-port pw-port-id [vc-id vc-id] [create]
no pw-port
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding
Description 

This command creates a pseudowire port.

The no form of the command removes the pseudowire port ID from the configuration.

Parameters 
pw-port-id—
Specifies a unique identifier of the pseudowire port
Values—
1 to 10239

 

vc-id vc-id
Specifies a virtual circuit identifier signaled to the peer
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

description

Syntax 
description description-string
no description
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command creates a text description stored in the configuration file for a configuration context.

The description command associates a text string with a configuration context to help identify the content in the configuration file.

The no form of the command removes the string from the configuration.

Default 

no description

Parameters 
description-string—
Specifies the description character string of the configuration context
Values—
Any string up to 80 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

 

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command enters the context to configure PW-port egress side parameters.

encap-type

Syntax 
encap-type {dot1q | qinq}
no encap-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets the encapsulation type for the PW-port as dot1q or qinq.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

dot1q

Parameters 
dot1q—
Specifies dot1q encapsulation type
qinq—
Specifies qinq encapsulation type

shaper

Syntax 
[no] shaper
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress
Description 

This command configures an egress shaping option for use by a PW port.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no shaper

int-dest-id

Syntax 
[no] int-dest-id int-dest-id
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress>shaper
Description 

This command specifies the intermediate destination string configured for dynamic Vport selection.

This command is only valid for PW ports used for enhanced subscriber management (ESM on PW).

The no form of the command removes the configured intermediate destination string.

Default 

no.int-dest-id

Parameters 
int-dest-id—
Specifies a text string that describes the intermediate destination ID

vport

Syntax 
vport vport-name
no vport
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress>shaper
Description 

This command configures the name of the Vport to be used for the PW port.

This command is valid for PW ports used for enhanced subscriber management (ESM on pseudowire) and pseudowire SAPs on Ethernet ports. It is not valid for pseudowire ports on the HSMDA.

The no form of the command removes the configured Vport name.

Default 

no vport

Parameters 
vport-name—
Specifies a text string up to 32 characters in length representing the name of the Vport

vc-type

Syntax 
vc-type {ether | vlan}
no vc-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets the forwarding mode for PW-port. The vc-type is signaled to the peer, and must be configured consistently on both ends of the PW. vc-type VLAN is only configurable with dot1q encapsulation on the PW-port. The tag with vc-type vlan only has significance for transport, and is not used for service delineation or ESM. The top (provider tag) is stripped while forwarding out of the PW, and a configured vlan-tag (for vc-type vlan) is inserted when forwarding into the PW. With vc-type ether, the tags if present (max 2), are transparently preserved when forwarding in our out of the PW.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

ether

Parameters 
ether—
Specifies ether as the virtual circuit (VC) associated with the SDP binding
vlan—
Specifies vlan as the virtual circuit (VC) associated with the SDP binding

vlan-vc-tag

Syntax 
vlan-vc-tag vlan-id
no vc-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets tag relevant for vc-type vlan mode. This tag is inserted in traffic forwarded into the PW.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

0

Parameters 
vlan-id—
Specifies the VLAN ID value
Values—
0 to 4094

 

9.25.2.1.1.1. RIP Commands

rip-policy

Syntax 
rip-policy policy-name [create]
no rip- policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates a RIP policy. This policy is applied to a subscriber IPv4 host to enable the BNG to learn RIP routes from the host. RIP routes are never sent to the hosts.

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the RIP policy name up to 32 characters in length.
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

neighbor

Syntax 
[no] neighbor ip-int-name
Context 
config>router>rip>group
config>service>vprn>rip>group
Description 

This command creates a context for configuring a RIP neighbor interface. By default, group interfaces are not activated with RIP, unless explicitly configured. The BNG will only learn RIP routes from IPv4 host on the group interface. The RIP neighbor group interface will default send to “none”. The send operation is unchangeable for group-interface.

The no form of the command deletes the RIP interface configuration for this group interface. The shutdown command in the config>router>rip>group group-name>neighbor context can be used to disable an interface without removing the configuration for the interface.

Default 

no neighbor

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
The group interface name. Interface names must be unique within the group of defined group interfaces within config service vprn/ies sub-interface grp-interface commands. An interface name cannot be in the form of an IP address. Interface names can be any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes. If the group interface name does not exist, an error message will be returned.

authentication-key

Syntax 
authentication-key [authentication-key | hash-key] [hash | hash2]
no authentication-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rip-policy
Description 

This command configures the BGP authentication key.

Authentication is performed between neighboring routers before setting up the BGP session by verifying the password. Authentication is performed using the MD-5 message-based digest. The authentication key can be any combination of letters or numbers from 1 to 16.

The no form of the command removes the authentication password from the configuration and effectively disables authentication.

Default 

Authentication is disabled and the authentication password is empty.

Parameters 
authentication-key—
The authentication key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 255 characters in length (unencrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).
hash-key—
The hash key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 342 characters in length (encrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).

This is useful when a user must configure the parameter, but, for security purposes, the actual unencrypted key value is not provided.

hash—
Specifies the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.

authentication-type

Syntax 
authentication-type {none | password | message-digest | message-digest-20}
no authentication-type
Context 
config>sub-mgmg>rip-policy>
Description 

This command sets the type of authentication to be used between RIP neighbors. The type and password must match exactly for the RIP message to be considered authentic and processed.

The no form of the command removes the authentication type from the configuration and effectively disables authentication.

Default 

no authentication-type

Parameters 
none—
Disables authentication at a given level (global, group, neighbor). If the command does not exist in the configuration, the parameter is inherited.
password —
Specifies enable simple password (plain text) authentication. If authentication is enabled and no authentication type is specified in the command, simple password authentication is enabled.
message-digest—
Configures 16 byte message digest for MD5 authentication. If this option is configured, then at least one message-digest-key must be configured.
message-digest-20—
Configures 20 byte message digest for MD5 authentication in accordance with RFC 2082, RIP-2 MD5 Authentication. If this option is configured, then at least one message-digest-key must be configured.

retail-svc-id

Syntax 
retail-svc-id service-id
retail-svc-id
Context 
config>service>ies|vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>static-host
Description 

This command specifies the service id of the retailer IES/VPRN service to which the static IPv6 host belongs. A corresponding retailer subscriber interface must exist in the specified service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no retail-svc-id

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies the retailer service ID or retailer service name
Values—
service-id: 1 to 2148007978
svc-name: A string up to 64 characters in length

 

rip

Syntax 
[no] rip
Context 
config>service>vprn
config>service>ies
Description 

This command enables the RIP protocol on the given VPRN IP interface.

The no form of the command disables the RIP protocol from the given VPRN IP interface.

Default 

no rip

group

Syntax 
[no] group group-name
Context 
config>service>vprn>rip
config>service>ies>rip
Description 

This command creates a context for configuring a RIP group of neighbors. RIP groups are a way of logically associating RIP neighbor interfaces to facilitate a common configuration for RIP interfaces.

The no form of the command deletes the RIP neighbor interface group. Deleting the group will also remove the RIP configuration of all the neighbor interfaces currently assigned to this group.

Default 

no group

Parameters 
group-name—
The RIP group name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

9.25.2.1.2.1. Vport Commands

ethernet

Syntax 
ethernet
Context 
config>port
Description 

This command the context to configure Ethernet port attributes.

This context can only be used when configuring Fast Ethernet, gigabit or 10-G Fast Ethernet or Ethernet LAN ports on an appropriate MDA.

egress-scheduler-override

Syntax 
[no] egress-scheduler-override
Context 
config>port>ethernet
Description 

This command applies egress scheduler overrides. When a port scheduler is associated with an egress port, it is possible to override the following parameters:

  1. The max-rate allowed for the scheduler.
  2. The maximum rate for each priority level 8 through 1.
  3. The CIR associated with each priority level 8 through 1.

See the SR OS Quality of Service Guide for command syntax and usage for the port-scheduler-policy command.

The no form of this command removes all override parameters from the egress port or channel scheduler context. Once removed, the port scheduler reverts all rate parameters back to the parameters defined on the port-scheduler-policy associated with the port.

Default 

no egress-scheduler-override

level

Syntax 
level priority-level rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
no level priority-level
Context 
config>port>ethernet>egress-scheduler-override
Description 

This command overrides the maximum and CIR rate parameters for a specific priority level on the port or channel’s port scheduler instance. When the level command is executed for a priority level, the corresponding priority level command in the port-scheduler-policy associated with the port is ignored. The override level command supports the keyword max for the rate and cir parameter. When executing the level override command, at least the rate or cir keywords and associated parameters must be specified for the command to succeed.

The no form of this command removes the local port priority level rate overrides. Once removed, the port priority level will use the port scheduler policies level command for that priority level.

Default 

no level

Parameters 
priority-level—
Identifies which of the eight port priority levels are being overridden
Values—
1 to 8

 

pir-rate
Overrides the port scheduler policy’s maximum level rate and requires either the max keyword or a rate defined in kilobits-per-second to follow
Values—
1 to 40000000, max

 

cir-rate
Overrides the port scheduler policy’s within-cir level rate and requires either the max keyword or a rate defined in kilobits-per-second to follow
Values—
0 to 40000000, max

 

max—
Removes any existing rate limit imposed by the port scheduler policy for the priority level allowing it to use as much total bandwidth as possible

access

Syntax 
access
Context 
config>port>ethernet
Description 

This command configures Ethernet access port parameters.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Ethernet access egress port parameters.

vport

Syntax 
vport name [create]
no vport name
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress
Description 

This command configures a scheduling node, referred to as virtual port, within the context of an egress Ethernet port. The Vport scheduler operates either like a port scheduler with the difference that multiple Vport objects can be configured on the egress context of an Ethernet port, or it can be an aggregate rate when an egress port-scheduler policy is applied to the port.

The Vport is always configured at the port level even when a port is a member of a LAG.

When a port scheduler policy is applied to a Vport the following command is used:

configure>port>ethernet>acess>egress>vport>port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name

The CLI will not allow the user to apply a port scheduler policy to a Vport if one has been applied to the port. Conversely, the CLI will not allow the user to apply a port scheduler policy to the egress of an Ethernet port if one has been applied to any Vport defined on the access egress context of this port. The agg-rate-limit, along with an egress port-scheduler, can be used to ensure that a given Vport does not oversubscribe the port’s rate.

SAP and subscriber host queues can be port-parented to a Vport scheduler in a similar way they port-parent to a port scheduler or can be port-parented directly to the egress port-scheduler if the agg-rate-limit is used.

When the Vport uses an aggregate rate, the following command is used:

configure>port>ethernet>acess>egress>vport>agg-rate-limit

The no form of the command removes the Vport name from the configuration.

Default 

no vport

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the Vport scheduling node and can be up to 32 ASCII characters in length. This does not need to be unique within the system but is unique within the port or a LAG.
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

agg-rate-limit

Syntax 
agg-rate-limit agg-rate
no agg-rate-limit
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command configures an aggregate rate for the Vport. This command is mutually exclusive with the port-scheduler-policy command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no agg-rate-limit

Parameters 
agg-rate
Specifies the rate limit for the Vport
Values—
max, 1 to 10000000

 

egress-rate-modify

Syntax 
[no] egress-rate-modify
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command is used to apply HQoS Adjustment to a Vport. HQoS Adjustment refers to the dynamic adjustment of the rate limit at an QoS enforcement point within router when the multicast traffic stream is disjointed from the unicast traffic stream. This QoS enforcement point within router represents the physical point further down in the access part of the network where the two streams join each other and potentially can cause congestion.

An example would be a PON port which is shared amongst subscriber’s multicast traffic (single copy of each channel) and subscriber’s unicast traffic. The bandwidth control point for this PON port resides in the upstream router BNG node in the form of a Vport. In case that the multicast delivery method in the router BNG utilizes redirection, the multicast traffic in the router BNG will flow outside of the subscriber or the Vport context and thus will bypass any bandwidth enforcement in the router. To correct this, a Vport bandwidth adjustment is necessary in the router that will account for the multicast bandwidth consumption that is bypassing Vport in the router but is present in the PON port whose bandwidth is controlled by Vport.

An estimate of the multicast bandwidth consumption on the PON port can be made at the Vport level based on the IGMP messages sourced from the subscribers behind the PON port. This process is called HQoS Adjustment.

A multicast channel bandwidth is subtracted from or added to the Vport rate limit according to the received IGMP Join/Leave messages and the channel bandwidth definition policy associated with the Vport (indirectly through a group-interface). Since the multicast traffic on the PON port is shared amongst subscribers behind this PON port, only the first IGMP Join or the last IGMP Leave per multicast channel is tracked for the purpose of the Vport bandwidth modification.

The Vport rate that will be affected by this functionality depends on the configuration:

  1. In case the agg-rate-limit within the Vport is configured, its value will be modified based on the IGMP activity associated with the subscriber under this Vport.
  2. In case the port-scheduler-policy within the Vport is referenced, the max-rate defined in the corresponding port-scheduler-policy will be modified based on the IGMP activity associated with the subscriber under this Vport.

The channel bandwidth definition policy is defined in the mcac policy in the configure>router>mcac>policy context. The policy is applied under the group-interface or in case of redirection under the redirected-interface.

The rates in effect can be displayed with the following two commands:

show port 1/1/5 vport name

qos scheduler-hierarchy port port-id vport vport-name

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport, which is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces, is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport, which is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces, is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no egress-rate-modify

host-match

Syntax 
host-match dest destination-string [create]
no host-match dest destination-string
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egr>qgrp
Description 

This command configures host matching for the Ethernet port egress queue-group.

The no form of the command removes the destination string from the configuration.

Parameters 
destination-string
Specify a host match destination string up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword used to create the host match. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context

port-scheduler-policy

Syntax 
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name
no port-scheduler-policy
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command specifies the destination and organization strings to be used for matching subscriber hosts with this Vport.

The parent Vport of a subscriber host queue, which has the port-parent option enabled, is determined by matching the destination string dest string associated with the subscriber and the organization string org string associated with the subscriber host with the strings defined under a Vport on the port associated with the subscriber.

If a given subscriber host policers or queue does not have the port-parent option enabled, it will be foster-parented to the Vport used by this subscriber and which is based on matching the dest string and org string. If the subscriber could not be matched with a Vport on the egress port, the host policer or queue will not be bandwidth controlled and will compete for bandwidth directly based on its own PIR and CIR parameters.

By default, a subscriber host policer or queue with the port-parent option enabled is scheduled within the context of the port’s port scheduler policy.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command. Applying a scheduler policy to a Vport is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces.

The no form of the command removes the port-scheduler-policy-name from the configuration.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no port-scheduler-policy

Parameters 
port-scheduler-policy-name—
Specifies an existing port-scheduler-policy configured in the config>qos context

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
no scheduler-policy
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command specifies a scheduler policy to associate to the Vport. Scheduler policies are configured in the configure>qos>scheduler>policy context. Each scheduler policy is divided up into groups of schedulers based on the tier each scheduler is created under. A tier is used to give structure to the schedulers within a policy and define rules for parent scheduler associations. The policy defines the hierarchy and operating parameters for virtual schedulers.

The no form of this command removes the configured egress scheduler policy from the Vport.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command.

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no scheduler-policy

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name—
The scheduler-policy-name parameter applies an existing scheduler policy that was created in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context to create the hierarchy of egress virtual schedulers.

parent-location

Syntax 
parent-location {default | sla}
no parent-location
Context 
config>qos>sap-egress
Description 

This command determines the expected location of the parent schedulers for queues configured with a parent command within the SAP egress policy. All parent schedulers must be configured within a scheduler policy applied at the location corresponding to the parent-location parameter.

If a parent scheduler name does not exist at the specified location, the queue will not be parented and will be orphaned.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

parent-location default

Parameters 
default—
Specifies that the queues should look for their in the SAP's egress scheduler-policy or the multi-service-site's egress scheduler policy depending on which is configured and Subscriber queues will look for their parents in the subscriber-profile's egress scheduler-policy.When the SAP egress policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the queues must be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the subscriber’s SUB profile. When the SAP egress policy is applied to a SAP, the parent schedulers of the queues need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the SAP or the multi-service site.
sla—
Specifies that the queues should look for their parent in the SLA-profile's egress scheduler-policy; all queues that are not port-parented and to which SLA-profile is not applicable will behave as orphans in this case.When the SAP egress policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the queues must be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the same SLA profile. If this parameter is configured within a SAP egress policy that is applied to any object except of the egress of an SLA profile, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the queues will not be parented and will be orphaned.

parent-location

Syntax 
parent-location {none | sub | vport}
no parent-location
Context 
config>qos>scheduler-policy
Description 

This command determines the expected location of the parent schedulers for the tier 1 schedulers configured with a parent command within the scheduler policy. The parent schedulers must be configured within a scheduler policy applied at the location corresponding to the parent location parameter.

If a parent scheduler name does not exist at the specified location, the schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned.

The configuration of parent-location and frame-based-accounting commands in a scheduler policy is mutually exclusive in to ensure consistency between the different scheduling levels.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

parent-location none

Parameters 
none—
This parameter indicates that the tier 1 schedulers do not have a parent scheduler and the configuration of the parent under a tier 1 scheduler is blocked. Conversely, this parameter is blocked when any tier 1 scheduler has a parent configured.
sub—
When the scheduler policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the tier 1 schedulers need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the subscriber’s SUB profile.

If this parameter is configured within a scheduler policy that is applied to any object except for the egress of an SLA profile, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the tier 1 schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned.

vport—
When the scheduler policy is applied to an SLA profile, a SUB profile for a subscriber or to the egress of a PW SAP, the parent schedulers of the tier 1 schedulers need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the VPORT to which the subscriber will be assigned.

If this parameter is configured within a scheduler policy that is applied to to any object except for the egress of an SLA profile or SUB profile, or to the egress of a PW SAP, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the tier 1 schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned. This parameter is not supported when policers-hqos-manageable is configured in the SAP egress QoS policy.

9.25.2.1.2.1. MLD Policy Commands

mld-policy

Syntax 
mld-policy mld-policy-name [create]
no mld-policy mld-policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to create an MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no mld-policy

Parameters 
mld-policy-name—
Specifies the MLD policy name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

disable-router-alert-check

Syntax 
[no] disable-router-alert-check
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command disables router alert checking for MLD messages received on this interface. The no form of the command enables router alert checking.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no disable-router-alert-check

egress-rate-modify

Syntax 
egress-rate-modify agg-rate-limit
egress-rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
no egress-rate-modify
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the egress rate modification.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

no egress-rate-modify

Parameters 
agg-rate-limit—
Specifies that the maximum total rate for all subscriber egress queues for each subscriber associated with the policy
scheduler-name
Specifies the scheduler to be applied for egress rate modification

fast-leave

Syntax 
[no] fast-leave
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enables fast leave. When fast leave processing is enabled, the router will immediately remove a SAP or SDP from the IP multicast group when it detects an MLD leave on that SAP or SDP. Fast leave processing allows the switch to remove a SAP or SDP that sends a leave from the forwarding table without first sending out group-specific queries to the SAP or SDP, and thus speeds up the process of changing channels (zapping).

Fast leave should only be enabled when there is a single receiver present on the SAP or SDP.

When fast leave is enabled, the configured last-member-query-interval value is ignored.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no fast-leave

import

Syntax 
import policy-name
no import
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command specifies the import routing policy to be used. Only a single policy can be imported at a time.

The no form of the command removes the policy association.

Default 

no import

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the import policy name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes. Routing policies are configured in the config>router>policy-options context The router policy must be defined before it can be imported.

max-num-groups

Syntax 
max-num-groups count
no max-num-groups
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command defines the maximum number of multicast groups that can be joined. If the router receives a join message that would exceed the configured number of groups, the request is ignored.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no max-num-groups

Parameters 
count —
Specifies the maximum number of groups that can be joined
Values—
1 to 1000

 

max-num-grp-sources

Syntax 
max-num-grp-sources [max-num-grp-sources]
no max-num-grp-sources
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of group sources for which MLD can have local receiver information based on received MLD reports on this interface. When this configuration is changed dynamically to a value lower than currently accepted number of group sources, the group sources that are already accepted are not deleted. Only new group sources will not be allowed. When this object has a value of 0, there is no limit to the number of group sources.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no max-num-grp-sources

Parameters 
max-num-grp-sources
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowed to be tracked per group
Values—
1 to 32000

 

max-num-sources

Syntax 
max-num-sources max-num-sources
no max-num-sources
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of multicast sources allowed per group.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
max-num-sources—
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowed per group
Values—
1 to 1000

 

per-host-replication

Syntax 
[no] per-host-replication
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enables per-host-replication. In the per-host-replication mode, multicast traffic is replicated per each host within the subscriber irrespective of the fact that some hosts may be subscribed to the same multicast stream. As a result, in case that multiple hosts within the subscriber are registered for the same multicast group, the multicast streams of that group will be generated. The destination MAC address of multicast streams will be changed to unicast so that each host receives its own copy of the stream. Multicast traffic in the per-host-replication mode can be classified via the existing QoS CLI structure. As such the multicast traffic will flow through the subscriber queues. HQoS Adjustment is not needed in this case.

The alternative behavior for multicast replication in IPoE environment is per-SAP- replication. In this model, only a single copy of the multicast stream is sent per SAP, irrespective of the number of hosts that are subscribed to the same multicast group. This behavior applies to 1:1 connectivity model as well as on 1:N connectivity model (SAP centric behavior as opposed to subscriber centric behavior).

In the per-SAP-replication model the destination MAC address is multicast (as opposed to unicast in the per-host-replication model). Multicast traffic is flowing via the SAP queue which is outside of the subscriber context. The consequence is that multicast traffic is not accounted in the subscriber HQoS. In addition, HQoS Adaptation is not supported in the per SAP replication model.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no per-host-replication

query-interval

Syntax 
query-interval seconds
no query-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command specifies the frequency at which the querier router transmits general host-query messages. Host-query messages solicit group membership information and are sent to the link-scope all-node address, FF02::1. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config> service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no query-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the frequency, in seconds, at which the router transmits general host-query messages
Values—
2 to 1024

 

query-last-listener-interval

Syntax 
query-last-listener-interval seconds
no query-last-listener-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the frequency at which the querier router sends a group-specific query messages, including the messages sent in response to leave-group messages. The shorter the interval, the faster the loss of the last member of a group can be detected. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-last-listener-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config>service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the frequency, in seconds, at which query messages are sent
Values—
1 to 1023

 

query-response-interval

Syntax 
query-response-interval seconds
no query-response-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the query response interval. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-response-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config>service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no query-response-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the length of time that the querier router waits to receive a response to from the host
Values—
1 to 1023

 

redirection-policy

Syntax 
redirection-policy policy-name
no redirection-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command will apply multicast redirection action to the subscriber. The redirection action along with the redirected interface (and possibly service id) is defined in the referenced policy-name. MLD messages will be redirected to an alternate interface if that alternate interface has MLD enabled. The alternate interface does not have to have any multicast groups registered via MLD. Currently all MLD messages are redirected and there is no ability to selectively redirect MLD messages based on match conditions (multicast-group address, source IP address, and so on). Multicast redirection is supported between VPRN services and also between interfaces within the Global Routing Context. Multicast Redirection is not supported between the VRPN services and the Global Routing Table (GRT).

MLD state is maintained per subscriber host and per redirected interface. Traffic is however forwarded only on the redirected interface.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies a redirection policy name up to 32 characters in length. This is a regular policy defined under the configure>router>policy-option>policy-statement context

static

Syntax 
static
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure MLD static group membership parameters.

group

Syntax 
[no] group grp-ipv6-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static
Description 

This command configures a static multicast group.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no group

Parameters 
grp-ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address
Values—
<grp-ipv6-address> : ipv6-address - x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces) x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d
x - [0 to FFFF]H
d - [0 to 255]D
- multicast group IPv6 address

 

source

Syntax 
[no] source ipv6-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static>group
Description 

This command adds or removes a static multicast source.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
grp-ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address
Values—
<grp-ipv6-address> : ipv6-address - x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces) x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d
x - [0 to FFFF]H
d - [0 to 255]D
- multicast group IPv6 address

 

starg

Syntax 
[no] starg
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static>group
Description 

This command adds a static (*,G) entry. This command can only be enabled if no existing source addresses for this group are specified.

The no form of the command removes the starg entry from the configuration.

Default 

no starg

version

Syntax 
version version
no version
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy#
Description 

This command configures the MLD version.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

version 2

Parameters 
version—
Specifies the MLD version
Values—
1, 2

 

9.25.2.1.2.2. IPoE Session Commands

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy policy-name [create]
no ipoe-session-policy policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures an IPoE session policy. The policies are referenced from subscriber interfaces, group interfaces and capture SAPs. Multiple IPoE session policies can be configured.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the IPoE policy name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

circuit-id-from-auth

Syntax 
[no] circuit-id-from-auth
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command takes the circuit ID value from the authentication server to identify the session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no circuit-id-from-auth

description

Syntax 
description description-string
no description
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command takes the circuit-id value from the authentication server when it creates a text description stored in the configuration file for a configuration context.

The description command associates a text string with a configuration context to help identify the context in the configuration file.

The no form of this command removes any description string from the context.

Default 

no description

Parameters 
description-string—
Specifies a text string describing the entity. Allowed values are any string up to 80 characters in length, composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes..

session-key

Syntax 
session-key sap mac [cid] [rid]
no session-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command configures the key to logically group subscriber hosts that belong to the same dual stack end device in an IPoE session.

The SAP and MAC address are always part of the IPoE session key. Optionally the Circuit-Id/Interface-Id or Remote-Id can be added to the session key.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

sap mac

Parameters 
sap —
Includes the SAP as part of the IPoE session key. The sap parameter is mandatory and cannot be removed from the key
mac—
Includes the MAC address as part of the IPoE session key. The mac parameter is mandatory and cannot be removed from the key
cid—
Optionally adds the DHCPv4 Relay Agent Circuit-Id (Option 82, sub Option 1) and DHCPv6 Interface-Id (Option 18) field to the IPoE session key
rid—
Optionally adds the DHCPv4 Relay Agent Remote-Id (Option 82, sub Option 2) and DHCPv6 Remote-Id (Option 37) field to the IPoE session key. For DHCPv6, the enterprise number is excluded from the key.

sap and mac are mandatory parameters while cid and rid are optional and mutually exclusive. Valid IPoE session key parameters are: sap mac, sap mac cid and sap mac rid.

session-timeout

Syntax 
session-timeout timeout
no session-timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command defines the time in seconds between 1 second and 360 days before the IPoE session will be disconnected. The default value is unlimited session timeout.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no session-timeout

Parameters 
timeout—
Specifies the session timeout in seconds
Values—
1 to 31104000

 

sap

Syntax 
sap sap-id [create] [capture-sap]
Context 
config>service>vpls
Description 

This command declares a given SAP as a primary (or secondary) VPLS port.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
capture-sap—
Specifies a capturing SAP in which triggering packets will be sent to the CPM. Non-triggering packets captured by the capture SAP will be dropped. This parameter applies to the 7450 ESS or 7750 SR only.
create—
Specifies to create a SAP instance. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context

ipoe-session

Syntax 
[no] ipoe-session
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
Description 

This command configures IPoE session parameters.

force-auth

Syntax 
force-auth [cid-change] [rid-change]
force-auth disabled
no force-auth
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

By default, if the circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id in the IPoE session re-authentication trigger packet (such as a DHCP renewal) is not empty and different from the circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id stored in the IPoE session data, a forced re-authentication is performed, ignoring the configured min-auth-interval. This default behavior can be changed with this command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default behavior.

Default 

force-auth cid-change rid-change force-auth disabled on wlan-gw group interfaces

Parameters 
cid-change —
Perform a forced re-authentication upon a circuit-id/interface-id change. An empty circuit-id/interface-id is not considered a change
rid-change —
Perform a forced re-authentication upon a remote-id change. an empty remote-id is not considered a change. For DHCPv6, the enterprise number is excluded from the comparison.
disabled —
Specifies that the min-auth-interval never is ignored. The system does not perform a forced re-authentication upon a circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id change.

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy policy-name
no ipoe-session-policy
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the IPoE session policy applicable for this group interface or capture SAP.

On WLAN GW group interfaces, it is not possible to change this value.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ipoe-session-policy ipoe-session-policy default on WLAN GW group interfaces

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the IPoE session policy name up to 32 characters in length

min-auth-interval

Syntax 
min-auth-interval [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
min-auth-interval infinite
no min-auth-interval
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

Re-authentication for IPoE sessions enable dynamic policy changes.

This command configures the maximum frequency of re-authentications by specifying a minimum interval between two non-forced authentications for the same IPoE session.

A forced authentication is by default triggered by a circuit-id, interface-id or remote-id change (see the force-auth command).

Re-authentications are, by default, disabled and can be enabled by configuring a min-auth-interval.

Setting the min-auth-interval to zero seconds will always re-authenticate on each trigger packet.

The no form of the command reverts to the default behavior.

Default 

infinite

Parameters 
days
Specifies the min number of days between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 365

 

hours
Specifies the min number of hours between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 23

 

minutes
Specifies the min number of minutes between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 59

 

seconds
Specifies the min number of seconds between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 59

 

infinite —
Does not perform non-forced re-authentications for IPoE sessions (default)

radius-session-timeout

Syntax 
radius-session-timeout {backwards-compatible | ignore | absolute}
no radius-session-timeout
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies how to interpret the session-timeout coming from a RADIUS VSA in an Access-Accept or CoA message.

The value of this command can only be changed on wlan-gw group interfaces.

The no form of this command to resets the default behavior.

Default 

absolute (backward compatible on wlan-gw group interfaces)

Parameters 
backwards-compatible —
Specifies that the VSA will be interpreted as an IPv4 lease time if the Alc-Lease-Time attribute is not present and an absolute timeout otherwise. The VSA will be treated the same as for non-ipoe session DHCP hosts
ignore —
Specifies that the VSA meaning is irrelevant for IPoE session and should be ignored
absolute —
Specifies that the VSA would be treated as a timeout starting from the moment the IPoE session is set up

sap-session-limit

Syntax 
sap-session-limit sap-session-limit
no sap-session-limit
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the number of IPoE sessions per SAP allowed for this group-interface

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
sap-session-limit —
Specifies the number of allowed IPoE sessions
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071 131071 on wlan-gw group interfaces

 

session-limit

Syntax 
session-limit session-limit
no session-limit
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the number of IPoE sessions allowed for this group interface or retail subscriber interface.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
session-limit—
Specifies the number of allowed IPoE sessions
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071
1 – 500000 (retail subscriber interface)

 

user-db

Syntax 
user-db local-user-db-name
no user-db
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command configures the local user database to use for IPoE session authentication.

When configured on a capture SAP, the group interface must have the same local user database configured.

On a wlan-gw group interface, the no form of this command indicates that the user database will be picked from the following sources in the order shown:

  1. dhcp
  2. ipv6>dhcp6
  3. ipv6>router-solicit

If no user database can be found in any of these locations, processing continues as if no user database was configured. This behavior is for backwards compatibility reasons only; when using a LUDB, it should be explicitly added to the IPoE session configuration.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no user-db

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the local user database name up to 32 characters in length

shutdown

Syntax 
[no] shutdown
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

The shutdown command enables or disables IPoE session management on a group interface or capture SAP.

A shutdown of the IPoE session CLI hierarchy on a group-interface will clear all active IPoE sessions on that interface, resulting in a deletion of all corresponding subscriber hosts.

On wlan-gw group interfaces it is not possible to disable an IPoE session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

shutdown no shutdown on wlan-gw group interfaces

9.25.2.1.3.1. SHCV Policy Commands

shcv-policy

Syntax 
shcv-policy name [create]
no shcv-policy name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures a Subscriber Host Connectivity Verification (SHCV) policy. An SHCV policy can be applied to both the subscriber management group interface and VPLS instances. All SHCV-related features inside a group interface and a VPLS service will follow the configuration specified in the SHCV policy. The SHCV policy and the SHCV configuration on a group interface are mutually exclusive. Only one can be applied to the group interface.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the SHCV policy, up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

layer-3

Syntax 
layer-3
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior parameters for IES and VPRN services.

source-ip-origin

Syntax 
source-ip-origin {interface | vrrp}
no source-ip-origin
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>layer-3
Description 

This command selects the source IP address to be used for SHCV messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
interface—
Specifies to use the interface IP as the source address of SHCV
vrrp—
Specifies to use the VRRP configured IP as the source address of SHCV

periodic

Syntax 
periodic
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure periodic SHCV properties for the subscriber management group-interface. This tool will periodically scan all known DHCP hosts only and perform unicast ARP/NS requests. The subscriber host connectivity verification will maintain state (connected vs. not-connected) for all hosts.

action

Syntax 
action {alarm | remove}
no action
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the action to take when the periodic connectivity verification failed.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

alarm

Parameters 
alarm—
Raises an alarm indicating that the host is disconnected
remove—
Raises an alarm and releases all allocated resources (addresses, prefixes, queues, table entries, and so on). Static hosts are removed.

interval

Syntax 
interval minutes
no interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command specifies the time interval which all known sources should be verified. The actual rate is dependent on the number of known hosts and intervals.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

30 minutes

Parameters 
minutes—
Specifies the interval, in minutes, between periodic connectivity checks
Values—
1 to 6000

 

retry-count

Syntax 
retry-count [count]
no retry-count
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the number of retransmissions.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1 — For trigger-type ip-conflict, host-limit-exceeded and mobility

10 — For trigger-type inactivity and MAC learning

Parameters 
count
Specifies the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification
Values—
2 to 29

 

timeout

Syntax 
timeout seconds
no timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the timeout before a retransmission in triggered connectivity verification.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

10

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the timeout, in seconds, before a retransmission in triggered connectivity verification
Values—
10 to 60

 

trigger

Syntax 
trigger trigger-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enables to context to configure SHCV triggers.

Parameters 
trigger-type—
Specifies the trigger SHCV properties for the subscriber management group-interface.
Values—
ip-conflict — Upon detecting an IP conflict for the new host, a trigger SHCV is sent using a unicast ARP/NS. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
host-limit-exceeded — Upon exceeding the host-limit for (sla-profile, ipoe-session sap-session-limit, ipoe-session session-limit, and arp-host), a trigger SHCV is sent. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
inactivity — A trigger SHCV is sent to the idle host to verify the host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system.
mobility — Detects detects an IP or MAC conflict between different SAPs. Upon detecting a MAC or an IP conflict, a trigger SHCV is sent. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
mac-learning — Specifies the trigger SHCV properties to learn the MAC address of static hosts. Upon a no shutdown, a trigger SHCV is sent to the host to learn the host’s MAC address.

 

retry-count

Syntax 
retry-count [count]
no retry-count
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>trigger
Description 

This command configures the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
count
Specifies the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification
Values—
1 to 29

 

timeout

Syntax 
timeout seconds
no timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>trigger
Description 

This command configures the timeout before a retransmission.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1 for trigger-type ip-conflict, host-limit-exceeded and mobility

2 for trigger-type inactivity and mac-learning

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the retry timeout in seconds
Values—
1 to 60

 

vpls

Syntax 
vpls service-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in VPLS services. Refer to the Layer 2 Service Guide for VPLS service command syntax and descriptions.

vprn

Syntax 
vprn service-id
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in VPRN services. Refer to the Layer 3 Services Guide for VPRN service command syntax and descriptions.

ies

Syntax 
ies service-id
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in IES services. Refer to the Layer 3 Services Guide for IES service command syntax and descriptions.

shcv-policy-ipv4

Syntax 
shcv-policy-ipv4 name
no shcv-policy-ipv4
Context 
config>service>vpls
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>ies>if
config>service>vprn>if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the shcv-policy to be used exclusive for IPv4 subscriber hosts. The shcv-policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

shcv-policy-ipv6

Syntax 
shcv-policy-ipv6 name
no shcv-policy-ipv6
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the SHCV policy to be used exclusive for IPv6 subscriber hosts. The policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

shcv-policy

Syntax 
shcv-policy name
no shcv-policy
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the SHCV policy to be used for both IPv4 and IPv6 subscriber hosts. The policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

source-ip

Syntax 
source-ip ip-address
no source-ip
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>vpls
Description 

This command configures the IPv4 address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no source-ip

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IPv4 address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service

source-mac

Syntax 
source-mac ieee-address
no source-mac
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>vpls
Description 

Specifies the MAC address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no source-mac

Parameters 
ieee-address—
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address in the xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx or xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx format

9.25.2.1.16.1. Show Commands

Note:

The command outputs in the following section are examples only; actual displays may differ depending on supported functionality and user configuration.

diameter-peer-policy

Syntax 
diameter-peer-policy [peer-policy-name]
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name peer peer-name [statistics]
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name client-side-peer-ip ip-address port tcp-port [statistics]
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays diameter peer policy information and diameter peer information and statistics. For the diameter proxy, the incoming peer can be specified with an IP address and port number.

Parameters 
peer-policy-name—
Specifies the diameter peer policy name, up to 32 characters in length
peer-name —
Specifies the diameter peer name, up to 32 characters in length
ip address —
Specifies the IP address of the incoming peer (client side) of a diameter proxy
tcp-port —
Specifies the TCP port number of the incoming peer (client side) of a diameter proxy
statistics —
Displays the diameter peer statistics with details per diameter application, per message type, and per direction (rx/ tx)
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA Diameter peer policy information.

Sample Output
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1
===============================================================================
Last Mgmt Change      : 01/07/2016 20:05:12
Applications          : gy
Role                  : client
Description           : Diamater peer policy - gy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Diameter Config Values
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Origin Host           : bng.domain.com
Origin Realm          : domain.com
Source IPv4 Address   : 192.0.2.51
Source IPv6 Address   : N/A
Router                : Base               Transaction Timer  : 30 (default)
Watchdog Timer        : 30 (default)       Connection Timer   : 30 (default)
Vendor Support        : 3GPP (default)
Python Policy         : py-policy-diam-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Peer Name            Oper  PSM State     Susp  Cooldown  Pref  Order  Pri/Sec
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
peer-1               Yes   I-Open        No    -         30    1      Primary
peer-2               No    Closed        No    -         50    -      -
===============================================================================
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1" peer "peer-1"
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1
===============================================================================
Peer IP address        : 172.16.1.1
Last Mgmt Change       : 01/07/2016 20:05:12
Peer Operational       : Yes              Watchdog Algorithm Active   : Yes
Peer State Machine     : I-Open           Watchdog Answer Pending     : No
Connection Timer  (Tc) : -                Connection Suspended        : No
Transaction Timer (Tt) : -                Cooldown Sequence Pending   : No
Watchdog Timer    (Tw) : 17               Cooldown Sequence Active    : No
Primary/Secondary Peer : Primary          Cooldown Sequence Progress  : -
Preference Order       : 1                Peer Removal Pending        : No
Pending Messages       : 0
===============================================================================
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1" peer "peer-1" statistics
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1 (statistics)
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer             : peer-1
Time statistics cleared   : 01/07/2016 20:05:10
===============================================================================
                                      Request     Answer    Request     Answer
                                           Tx         Rx         Rx         Tx
===============================================================================
Aggregates
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                       1          1          0          0
Failed                                      0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 0 (Base)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Capabilities-Exchange                       1          1          0          0
Disconnect-Peer                             0          0          0          0
Device-Watchdog                             0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 1 (NASREQ)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Authorization-Authentication                0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 4 (Gy)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Credit-Control (Initial)                    0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Update)                     0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Termination)                0          0          0          0
Re-Auth                                     0          0          0          0
Abort-Session                               0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 16777238 (Gx)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Credit-Control (Initial)                    0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Update)                     0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Termination)                0          0          0          0
Re-Auth                                     0          0          0          0
Abort-Session                               0          0          0          0
===============================================================================

Table 87 provides a description of the counters in the output of the show aaa diameter-peer-policy command. and Table 88 provides the failure reasons for the aggregate Failed counter (Request Rx and Answer Rx).

Table 87:  show aaa diameter-peer-policy Field Descriptions 

Counter

Counts  

Aggregates Total

Request Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully transmitted diameter request messages (all applications, all message types)

Answer Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully received diameter answer messages (all applications, all message types)

Request Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully received diameter request messages (all applications, all message types)

Answers Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully transmitted diameter answer messages (all applications, all message types)

Aggregates Failed

Request Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all request messages that could not be sent for internal reasons, such as TCP socket error (for example, congestion), failure reported to application (for example, no retries left)

Dropped by Python — Timeouts (requests for which no answer was received within the configured timeout interval)

Answer Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all Answer messages that failed to be successfully decoded, such as such as invalid header length or a violation against the Command Code Format (CCF) specification.

See Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters for more information.

Request Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all Request messages that failed to be successfully decoded, such as invalid header length or a violation against the Command Code Format (CCF) specification.

See Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters for more information.

Answers Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all answer messages that could not be sent for internal reasons such as TCP socket error (for example, congestion).

Dropped by Python

Application ID id message type

Request Tx

Successfully transmitted diameter request messages for the corresponding application and message type

Answer Rx

Successfully received diameter answer messages for the corresponding application and message type

Request Rx

Successfully received diameter request messages for the corresponding application and message type

Answers Tx

Successfully transmitted diameter answer messages for the corresponding application and message type

Table 88:  Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters 

Role

Failed reasons 

Proxy

Proxy (message length too short / too long / version unsupported)

Consistency check failed: header size, message length, illegal flag combination, AVP header too small, AVP present but not allowed (base RFC messages), and so on

Not a base message

Not a request

Tx overload (message received to be send to client)

Dropped by python

Failed to create answer

No transaction (answer to server, but request is not found - 5 min.)

Diameter base / Diameter application

Message dropped due to result code

Message too big / too small

Dropped by python

Consistency check failed

end-2-end mismatch hop-to-hop command code (answer/request mismatch)

Cool down sequence drop

cc error request

Application id in header error

T bit in header

isa-radius-policy

Syntax 
isa-radius-policy policy-name
isa-radius-policy policy-name associations
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays ISA RADIUS policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information about the specified ISA RADIUS policy
associations—
Displays the information associated with the ISA RADIUS server policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA ISA RADIUS policy information.

Sample Output
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show aaa isa-radius-policy "ZiggoAAA_DRP_ISAPlcy" 
===============================================================================
Status for ISA RADIUS server policy "ZiggoAAA_DRP_ISAPlcy"
===============================================================================
Server 1, group 1, member 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Purposes Up                                     : accounting authentication
Source IP address                               : 172.18.128.33
Acct Tx Requests                                : 2469931
Acct Tx Retries                                 : 320
Acct Tx Timeouts                                : 160
Acct Rx Replies                                 : 2469471
Auth Tx Requests                                : 16417061
Auth Tx Retries                                 : 7169
Auth Tx Timeouts                                : 2922
Auth Rx Replies                                 : 16406973
CoA Rx Requests                                 : 0
 
Table 89:  Subscriber ISA RADIUS Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Purposes Up

Indicates the RADIUS services that are up and running, and fully operational for this server.

Source IP address

Indicates the IP address of the RADIUS server.

Acct Tx Requests

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests transmitted.

Acct TX Retries

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction request retries.

Acct TX Timeouts

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that have timed out.

Acct RX Replies

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction responses received.

Auth Tx Requests

Indicates the number of authentication requests transmitted.

Auth Tx Retries

Indicates the number of authentication request retries.

Auth Tx Timeouts

Indicates the number of RADIUS authentication requests that have timed out for the policy.

CoA RX Requests

Indicates the number of Change-of-Authorization message responses received.

radius-configuration

Syntax 
radius-configuration
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays RADIUS configuration information.

Output 

The following output is an example of AAA RADIUS configuration information.

Sample Output
# show aaa radius-configuration 
===============================================================================
RADIUS configuration
===============================================================================
CoA Port                    : 3799
===============================================================================

Table 89 provides a description of the counters in the output of the show aaa isa-radius-policy command.

Table 90:  AAA ISA RADIUS Policy Field Descriptions  

Label

Description

CoA Port

Displays the RADIUS Change of Authorization (CoA) port.

 

radius-server-policy

Syntax 
radius-server-policy policy-name [acct-on-off]
radius-server-policy policy-name associations
radius-server-policy policy-name msg-buffer-stats
radius-server-policy policy-name statistics
radius-server-policy [acct-on-off]
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays RADIUS server policy configuration information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information for the specified RADIUS server policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the RADIUS server policy.
msg-buffer-stats—
Displays statistics related to the RADIUS messages that are buffered for each specified RADIUS server policy
statistics—
Displays statistics for the specified RADIUS server policy
act-on-off—
Displays the admin state of the acct-on-off feature
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA RADIUS server policy information.

Sample Output
Table 91:  Subscriber RADIUS Server Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Tx transaction requests

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests transmitted.

Rx transaction responses

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction responses received.

Transaction requests timed out

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that have timed out.

Transaction requests send failed

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that could not be transmitted.

Packet retries

Indicates the number of times a RADIUS request packet was retransmitted to a server.

Transaction requests send rejected

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that were not transmitted due to unacceptable configuration.

Authentication requests failed

Indicates the number of authentication failures for this policy.

Accounting requests failed

Indicates the number of accounting failures for this policy.

Ratio of access-reject over auth responses

Indicates the ratio of access-rejects in the auth responses for this policy.

Transaction success ratio

Indicates the transaction success ratio for this policy.

Transaction failure ratio

Indicates the transaction failure ratio for this policy.

Statistics last reset at

Indicated the date and time at which the statistics for this policy were last reset.

*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show aaa radius-server-policy "ZiggoAAA_anycast" statistics 
===============================================================================
RADIUS server policy "ZiggoAAA_anycast" statistics
===============================================================================
Tx transaction requests                         : 24818681
Rx transaction responses                        : 24817329
Transaction requests timed out                  : 1351
Transaction requests send failed                : 0
Packet retries                                  : 12410
Transaction requests send rejected              : 0
Authentication requests failed                  : 303530
Accounting requests failed                      : 0
Ratio of access-reject over auth responses      : 13%
Transaction success ratio                       : 99%
Transaction failure ratio                       : 1%
Statistics last reset at                        : 05/21/2015 01:11:39

wpp

Syntax 
wpp portal-group name
wpp [portal-group name] [host ip-address] hosts
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays information about the specified WPP portal group or the WPP hosts controlled by the WPP portal group.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the WPP portal group up to 32 characters in length
ip-address—
Specifies the IP address of the WPP host
hosts—
Output 

The following output is an example of WPP portal group or WPP host information.

Sample Output
show aaa wpp portal-group "test" 
===============================================================================
wpp portal group "test"
===============================================================================
administrative state                  : in-service
controlled router                     : 500
number of enabled interfaces          : 1
triggered hosts                       : disabled
last management change                : 01/02/2017 19:02:11
===============================================================================

ancp-policy

Syntax 
ancp-policy [policy-name]
ancp-policy policy-name association
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information for the specified ANCP policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the ANCP policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP policy information.

Sample Output
A:cses-E11>config>subscr-mgmt>ancp# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy "test"
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "test"
===============================================================================
I. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
I. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
I. Rate Monitor        : 63360 kbps
I. Rate Monitor Alarm  : Yes
I. Rate Modify         : N/A
 
E. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
E. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
E. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
E. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
E. Rate Modify         : N/A
 
Port Down : N/A
 
Last Mgmt Change: 02/13/2013 19:15:28
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11>config>subscr-mgmt>ancp# 

ancp-string

Syntax 
ancp-string
ancp-string ancp-string
ancp-string customer customer-id site customer-site-name
ancp-string sap sap-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) string information.

Parameters 
ancp-string—
Specifies an Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) string up to 63 characters in length
customer-id
Specifies an existing customer ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

customer-site-name
Specifies an existing customer site name up to 32 characters in length
sap-id
Displays ANCP string information for the specified SAP ID
Values—

<sap-id>

null

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | aps-id>

dot1q

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | aps-id | pw-id>:qtag1

qinq

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | pw-id>:qtag1.qtag2

atm

<port-id | aps-id>[:vpi/vci | vpi | vpi1.vpi2 | cp.conn-prof-id]

cp

keyword

conn-prof-id

[1 to 8000]

frame

<port-id | aps-id>:dlci

cisco-hdlc

slot/mda/port.channel

cem

slot/mda/port.channel

ima-grp

<bundle-id>[:vpi/vci | vpi | vpi1.vpi2 | cp.conn-prof-id]

cp

keyword

conn-prof-id

[1 to 8000]

port-id

slot/mda/port[.channel]

bundle-id

bundle-<type>-slot/mda.<bundle-num>

bundle

keyword

type

ima | fr | ppp

bundle-num

[1 to 336]

bpgrp-id

bpgrp-<type>-<bpgrp-num>

bpgrp

keyword

type

ima | ppp

bpgrp-num

[1 to 2000]

aps-id

aps-<group-id>[.channel]

aps

keyword

group-id

[1 to 64]

ccag-id

ccag-<id>.<path-id>[cc-type]:<cc-id>

ccag

keyword

id

[1 to 8]

path-id

[a | b]

cc-type

[.sap-net |.net-sap]

cc-id

[0 to 4094]

eth-tunnel

eth-tunnel-<id>[:<eth-tun-sap-id>]

id

[1 to 1024]

eth-tun-sap-id

[0 to 4094]

lag-id

lag-<id>

lag

keyword

id

[1 to 800]

pw-id

pw-<id>

pw

keyword

id

[1 to 10239]

qtag1

[0 to 4094]

qtag2

[* | 0 to 4094]

vpi

[0 to 4095] (NNI)

[0 to 255] (UNI)

vci

[1 | 2 | 5 to 65535]

dlci

[16 to 1022]

tunnel-id

tunnel-<id>.<private | public>:<tag>

tunnel

keyword

id

[1 to 16]

tag

[0 to 4094]

 

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP string information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string "ANCP-0000003-0000001"
========================================================================
ANCP-String "ANCP-0000003-0000001"
========================================================================
Type       : SUB - "4AACAHCU74"
State      : Up                 Ancp Policy: N/A
I. Rate    : 129 kbps           E. Rate    : 130 kbps
Adj I. Rate: N/A                Adj E. Rate: N/A
Act I. Rate: N/A                Act E. Rate: N/A
Service Id : 50 (VPRN)
Group      : linux
Neighbor   : 10.0.0.2:34885
Persist Key: N/A
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Actual-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream              : 129 kbits/s
Actual-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream            : 130 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream             : 131 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream           : 132 kbits/s
Attainable-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream          : 133 kbits/s
Attainable-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream        : 134 kbits/s
Maximum-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream             : 135 kbits/s
Maximum-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream           : 136 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Low-Power-Data-Rate-Upstream   : 137 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Low-Power-Data-Rate-Downstream : 138 kbits/s
Maximum-Interleaving-Delay-Upstream        : 139 ms
Actual-Interleaving-Delay-Upstream         : 140 ms
Maximum-Interleaving-Delay-Downstream      : 141 ms
Actual-Interleaving-Delay-Downstream       : 142 ms
DSL-Line-State                             : 2 (IDLE)
Access-Loop-Encapsulation                  : 16909056 (0x01020300)
========================================================================
 

authentication

Syntax 
authentication policy-name association
authentication [policy-name]
authentication [policy-name] statistics
authentication coa-statistics
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber management RADIUS authentication policy information and statistics.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the subscriber management RADIUS authentication policy name, up to 32 characters in length, for which information is requested
association—
Displays SAP, interface, local user database host, AA and L2TP associations of this policy
coa-statistics—
Displays the overall statistics for incoming RADIUS Change of Authorization (CoA) messages and Disconnect Messages. For dropped requests, a counter for different drop reasons is available.
statistics—
Displays a list of policies with basic statistics (without specifying a policy name) or detailed statistics, including per-server statistics for the specified policy-name. These statistics apply only to the legacy RADIUS server configuration method where the servers are directly configured in the authentication policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management authentication information.

Sample Output
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
auth-policy-1                    Radius auth policy - servers
auth-policy-2                    Radius auth policy - radius-server-policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Authentication Policies : 2
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-2" 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy auth-policy-2
===============================================================================
Description          : Radius auth policy - radius-server-policy
Re-authentication    : Yes                 Username Format      : MAC Address
PPPoE Access Method  : PAP/CHAP            Username Mac-Format  : "aa:"
PPP-Username Oper    : None                
PPP-Domain-Name      : N/A
Username Oper        : None                
Domain-Name          : N/A
Acct-Stop-On-Fail    : 
RADIUS Server Policy : "aaa-server-policy-1"
Fallback Action      : deny                
Last Mgmt Change     : 06/24/2013 21:16:50 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include Radius Attributes
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Remote Id            : Yes                 Circuit Id           : Yes
NAS Port Id          : Yes                 NAS Identifier       : Yes
PPPoE Service Name   : Yes                 DHCP Vendor Class Id : Yes
Access Loop Options  : Yes                 MAC Address          : Yes
NAS Port Prefix      : None                NAS Port Suffix      : None
NAS-Port-Type        : Yes (standard)      Acct Session Id      : Host
Calling Station Id   : Yes (sap-string)    Called Station Id    : Yes
Tunnel Server Attr   : Yes                 DHCP Options         : Yes
NAS Port             : Yes                 
NAS Port Bits Spec   : *3s*1m*4p*12o*12i
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Servers
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Router               : management + Base   Source Address       : N/A
Access Algorithm     : Direct              Retry                : 3
Timeout (s)          : 5                   Hold down time (s)   : 30
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Index IP Address      Port  Pend-Req-Limit Out/Overload time (s) Oper State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Radius Servers configured.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Accept Radius Attributes
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Matching Entries
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Script Policies
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Access-Request          : "N/A"
Access-Accept           : "N/A"       
Change-of-Authorization : "N/A"
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-2" association 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy auth-policy-2
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Interface Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 3000 (VPRN)
 - If Name : group-int-ws-1-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db PPPoE Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db : ludb-1
 - Host : host-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db DHCP Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db : ludb-1
 - Host : default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application Assurance Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
No associated L2TP groups found.
No associated L2TP tunnels found.
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication statistics 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy Statistics
===============================================================================
Policy Name                       Subscr. Pkts   Subscr. Pkts   Subscr. Pkts
                                  Authenticated  Rejected       Rejected
                                                                Send Failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
auth-policy-1                     0              0              0
auth-policy-2                     0              0              0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Authentication Policies : 2
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-1" statistics 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy Statistics
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy name                               : auth-policy-1
subscriber packets authenticated          : 0
subscriber packets rejected               : 0
subscriber packets rejected send failed   : 0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
radius server     requests  requests  requests  requests   requests requests
idx IP-address    accepted  rejected  no reply  md5 failed pending  send failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 172.16.1.1      0         0         0         0          0        0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication coa-statistics 
===============================================================================
Radius Notify Statistics    Change-Of-Authorization   Disconnect-Messages
===============================================================================
Requests Received             7                        10
Requests Accepted             5                        6
Requests Rejected             2                        4
Requests Dropped              0                        0
    No Auth Policy found      0                        0
    Invalid message           0                        0
    Out of resources          0                        0
    Authentication failure    0                        0
===============================================================================
 
Table 92:  Subscriber Authentication Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Requests Received

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests received.

Requests Accepted

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests accepted.

Requests Rejected

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected.

Requests Dropped

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests dropped.

No Auth Policy found

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests found.

Invalid message

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected because of decode errors.

Out of resources

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected due to lack of resources.

Authentication Failure

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests which do not have NAS-Port-ID or Framed-IP-Address set or have mismatched subscriber-id.

category-map

Syntax 
category-map [category-map]
category-map category-map subscribers
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays category map information.

With no parameters specified, a summary view of all configured category maps is displayed.

With the optional category-map name parameter specified, the detailed configuration of the specified category map name is displayed.

With the category-map subscribers parameters specified, all subscribers that have the specified category-map associated are displayed.

Parameters 
category-map
Specifies the category map name for which information is displayed
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management category map information.

Sample Output
Node# show subscriber-mgmt category-map "cat-map-1"
===============================================================================
Category Map: cat-map-1
===============================================================================
Description        : gy - time and volume
Credit Type        : volume             Credit Exh. Thresh.: 80%
Activity Thresh.   : 0 kb/s
Gx session level
usage monitoring   : false
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Category: cat-1-time
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Description        : Rating group for Time quota
Credit Type Over.  : none               Rating Group       : 11
OutOfCredit Action : none
Default Credit     : none
Ingress Queues     : 1
Egress Queues      : 1
Ingress Policers   : none
Egress Policers    : none
ExhCrdSvcLvl Pir   : none
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Category: cat-1-volume
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Description        : Rating group for Volume quota
Credit Type Over.  : none               Rating Group       : 12
OutOfCredit Action : none
Default Credit     : none
Ingress Queues     : 1
Egress Queues      : 1
Ingress Policers   : none
Egress Policers    : none
ExhCrdSvcLvl Pir   : 100
===============================================================================

diameter-application-policy

Syntax 
diameter-application-policy [name]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays Diameter application policy information.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be displayed
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management Diameter application policy information

Sample Output
# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
diameter-gx-policy-1             Diameter Gx policy
diameter-gy-policy-1             Diameter Gy policy
diameter-nasreq-policy-1         Diameter NASREQ policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of policies: 3
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Description                 : Diameter NASREQ policy
Session failover            : enabled
Failover handling           : continue
Peer policy                 : diameter-peer-policy-1
Application                 : nasreq
Tx timer (s)                : 10
Last management change      : 02/28/2015 14:53:49
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
NASREQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include AVP                 : nas-port-id
                              nas-port-type
NAS-Port-Id prefix type     : none
NAS-Port-Id suffix type     : user-string
NAS-Port-Id suffix          : @bng1
NAS-Port-Type type          : standard
 
User name format            : mac
User name operation         : no-operation
MAC address format          : aa:
Last management change      : 02/28/2015 14:53:49
===============================================================================
Interfaces using diameter-auth-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Interface-name                   Service-id Type
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
group-int-1-1                    1000       IES
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of interfaces: 1 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
VPLS SAP's with diameter-auth-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service    SAP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10         1/1/4:*.*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of SAP's: 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy "diamapppol_gx"
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policy "diamapppol_gx"
===============================================================================
Description                 : (Not Specified)
Session failover            : enabled
Failover handling           : retry-and-terminate
Peer policy                 : diampeerpol_gx
Application                 : gx
Tx timer (s)                : 10
Last management change      : 05/08/2015 05:55:59
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Gx
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include AVP                 : an-gw-address
Calling-Station-Id type     : mac
NAS-Port bits spec          : 0
NAS-Port-Id prefix type     : user-string
NAS-Port-Id prefix          : Testing
NAS-Port-Id suffix type     : circuit-id
NAS-Port-Type value         : 0
User-Equipment-Info         : mac
 
Subscription-Id-Data origin : subscriber-id
Subscription-Id-Data type   : e164
MAC address format          : aa:
Report IP address event     : enabled
CCR-t replay interval       : 60
Last management change      : 05/08/2015 06:54:27
 

diameter-session

Syntax 
diameter-session
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to display diameter session information.

ccrt-replay

Syntax 
ccrt-replay [session-id session-id] [diameter-application-policy name]
ccrt-replay summary
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>diam-session
Description 

This command displays information about diameter Gx sessions that are in Credit-Control-Request Session-Terminate-Request (CCR-T) replay mode.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be deleted
session-id
Identifies a diameter session ID
summary—
Displays summarized information about CCRT replay
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management CCR-T replay information.

Sample Output
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:21:46 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay session-id ro 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:21:27
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay summary 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Total Count   : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay diameter-application-
policy "diamapppol_gx" 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:18:49
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 

mac

Syntax 
mac all | ieee-address | unknown
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by MAC address.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors starting with the lowest MAC address
ieee-address—
Shows only the error of a specific MAC address
unknown—
Shows errors with unknown MAC addresses, such as for PPPoA subscribers
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management listed by MAC addresses.

Sample Output
*A:eng-BNG-2# show  subscriber-mgmt errors mac all
===============================================================================
Subscriber management errors
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:46.0
Service   : 1000
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:16.0
Service   : 1000
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
===============================================================================

sap

Syntax 
sap all | sap-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by SAP.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors starting with the lowest SAP index
sap-id—
Shows only the error of a specific SAP index
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management errors listed by SAP.

Sample Output
A:BNG-2# show  subscriber-mgmt errors sap all
===============================================================================
Subscriber management errors
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:46.0
Service   : 1000
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:16.0
Service   : 1000
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
===============================================================================

sdp

Syntax 
sdp all | sdp-id:vc-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by SDP.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors beginning with the lowest SDP index
sdp-id:vc-id—
Shows only the error of a specific SDP index

unknown-origin

Syntax 
unknown-origin
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command lists errors of an unknown origin. Errors shown do have a corresponding SAP ID or a SDP ID.

explicit-subscriber-map

Syntax 
explicit-subscriber-map
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays explicit subscriber mappings.

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management explicit subscriber map information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# explicit-subscriber-map
===============================================================================
Explicit Subscriber Map
===============================================================================
Key                              Sub profile
                                 SLA profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_ident_A_1                    sub_prof80
                                 sla_prof80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Explicit Subscriber Mappings : 1
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt#

host-lockout-policy

Syntax 
host-lockout-policy
host-lockout-policy policy-name association
host-lockout-policy policy-name
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state sap sap-id [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [circuit-id circuit-id] [sap sap-id] [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [mac ieee-address] [sap sap-id] [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [remote-id remote-id] [sap sap-id] [summary]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays host lockout policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies a specific subscriber host lockout policy name up to 32 characters
association—
Specifies to display the association of the host lockout policy
lockout-state—
Specifies to display information for hosts in a specific lockout state
Values—
all, active, graceful

 

sap sap-id
Specifies to display SAP ID information
circuit-id circuit-id—
Specifies to display circuit ID information. The circuit-id is 256 characters maximum.
mac ieee-address
Specifies to display MAC address information up to 30 characters in length
remote-id remote-id—
Specifies to display remote ID information up to 256 characters in length
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management host lockout policy information.

Sample Output
*A:cses-E11# show subscriber-mgmt host-lockout-policy
===============================================================================
Host Lockout Policies
===============================================================================
Lockout Policy                   Last Mgmt Change
  Lockout Time Min                 Lockout Time Max
Description
  Lockout Reset Time               Max Lockout Hosts
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
test                             04/20/2012 19:51:02
  10                               3600
test
  60                               100
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11# 
 
 
*A:cses-E11# show subscriber-mgmt host-lockout-policy "test"
===============================================================================
Host Lockout Policy "test"
===============================================================================
Description                        test
Last Mgmt Change                   04/20/2012 19:51:02
Lockout time min                   10
Lockout time max                   3600
Lockout reset time                 60
Max lockout hosts                  100
Host key                           all
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11#

igmp-policy

Syntax 
igmp-policy
igmp-policy policy-name association
igmp-policy policy-name
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays IGMP policy information and only applies to the 7750 SR.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies an existing IGMP policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the IGMP policy
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management IGMP policy information.

Sample Output
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policies
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy                                                                    
  Import Policy                    Admin Version                    
Description                                                                    
  Num Subscribers                  Host Max Groups                  
  Fast Leave                                
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
pol1                                                                           
                                   3
  2                                0
  fast-leave                       
pol2                                                                           
                                   3
  0                                0
  fast-leave                       
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C# 
 
 
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy "pol1" 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy pol1
===============================================================================
Import Policy                         : 
Admin Version                         : 3
Num Subscribers                       : 2
Host Max Group                        : 0
Fast Leave                            : yes
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C#
 
 
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy "pol1" association 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy pol1 Associations
===============================================================================
sub_1                                                                          
sub_2                                                                          
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of subscriber(s): 2
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C#

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy ipoe-session-policy-name [association]
ipoe-session-policy
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays IPoE session policy information.

Parameters 
ipoe-session-policy-name—
Specifies the IPoE session policy name up to 32 characters in length
association—
Displays the interface and captures SAPs that reference the IPoE session policy
Output 

The following output is an example of IPoE session policy information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt ipoe-session-policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
IPoE Session Policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Description           : IPoE policy
Last Mgmt Change      : 02/28/2015 11:51:25
Session Key           : sap-mac
Session Timeout       : unlimited
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt ipoe-session-policy "ipoe-policy-1" association
===============================================================================
IPoE Session Policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPoE Interface Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 1000 (IES)
 - group-int-1-1
Service-Id : 2000 (VPRN)
 - group-int-1-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Capture SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 10 (VPLS)
- 1/1/4:*.*
===============================================================================
 

local-user-db

Syntax 
local-user-db local-user-db-name association [dhcp] [ppp] [12tp] [radius] [pppoe] [dhcp6] [capture-sap] [rtr-solicit] [wpp] [ipoe]
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-all-hosts
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-host ipoe-host-name
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-unmatched-hosts
local-user-db [local-user-db-name]
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-all-hosts
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-host pppoe-host-name
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-unmatched-hosts
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays local user database information.

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the name of a local user database up to 32 characters in length
association—
Displays entities associated with the specified local user database
dhcp—
Displays DHCP information
ppp—
Displays PPP information
l2tp—
Displays L2TP information
radius—
Displays RADIUS information
pppoe—
Displays PPPoE information
dhcp6—
Displays DHCP6 information
capture-sap—
Displays capture SAP information
rt-solicit—
Displays RT solicit information
wpp—
Displays WPP information
ipoe—
Displays IPoE information
ipoe-all-hosts—
Displays IPoE all hosts information
ipoe-host-name
Displays IPoE host name information
ipoe-unmatched-hosts—
Displays IPoE unmatched hosts information
ppp-all-hosts—
Displays information about PPP all hosts
pppoe-hosts—
Displays information about PPPoE hosts
pppoe-unmatched-hosts—
Displays information about PPPoE unmatched hosts
Output 

The following output is an example of local user database information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db
===============================================================================
Local User Databases
===============================================================================
Name                             Admin Host  Description
                                 State Count
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
database01                       Down  1
database02 Provider001/Class0002 Down  0     This is a long testdescription wi*
test                             Down  2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Local User Databases : 3     Number of Hosts : 3
===============================================================================
* indicates that the corresponding row element may have been truncated.
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db database01
===============================================================================
Local User Database "database01"
===============================================================================
Admin State          : Down
Last Mgmt Change     : 11/08/2007 12:27:36
Host Count           : 1
DHCP Match Types     : circ-id
DHCP CircId Mask Pfx : test
DHCP CircId Mask Sfx : N/A
PPPoE Match Types    : N/A
PPPoE CircId Mask Pfx: N/A
PPPoE CircId Mask Sfx: N/A
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db database01 dhcp-all-hosts
===============================================================================
Local User Database "database01" DHCP hosts
===============================================================================
Name                             Admin     Matched objects
                                 State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
host001                          Down      -
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of DHCP Hosts : 1
===============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" dhcp-host host001
===============================================================================
DHCP Host "host001"
===============================================================================
Admin State          : Down
Last Mgmt Change     : 11/08/2007 12:13:42
 
Host Identification
 Circuit Id          : N/A
 Mac Address         : N/A
 Remote Id           : N/A
 Sap Id              : N/A
 Service Id          : N/A
 String              : N/A
 Option 60           : N/A
 System Id           : N/A
 
Matched Objects      : N/A
 
Address              : N/A
 
Identification Strings
 Subscriber Id       : N/A
 SLA Profile String  : N/A
 Sub Profile String  : N/A
 App Profile String  : N/A
 ANCP String         : N/A
 Inter Destination Id: N/A
===============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" dhcp-unmatched-hosts
==============================================================================
Local User Database "database01" DHCP unmatched hosts
==============================================================================
Name                              Reason      Duplicate Host
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
host002                           No match    N/A                             
host003                           Duplicate   host001                         
host004                           No match    N/A                             
host005                           Duplicate   host001                         
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of DHCP Unmatched Hosts : 4
==============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" association
===============================================================================
DHCP Servers where database01 is used
===============================================================================
Server-Name                      Router-Name                                   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
dhcpS1                           vprn1000                                      
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Server(s): 1
===============================================================================
Interfaces where database01 is used for authentication
===============================================================================
Interface-Name                   Service-Id Type                               
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Interface(s): 0
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" association dhcp
===============================================================================
DHCP Servers where database01 is used
===============================================================================
Server-Name                      Router-Name                                   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
dhcpS1                           vprn1000                                      
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Server(s): 1
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
===============================================================================
 
# show subscriber-mgmt local-user-db "ludb-1" association ipoe
===============================================================================
IPoE client interface associations for ludb-1
===============================================================================
Interface-Name                           Svc-Id     Type
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
group-int-1-1                            1000       IES
group-int-1-1                            2000       VPRN
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Interface(s): 2
===============================================================================
===============================================================================
Capture SAP associations for ludb-1
===============================================================================
SAP                              Svc-Id     Type   PPPoE PPP IPoE DHCP DHCP6 RS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4:1202.*                     10         VPLS   y         y    y    y     y
1/1/4:*.*                        10         VPLS   y         y    y    y     y
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of SAP(s): 2
===============================================================================
 

msap-policy

Syntax 
msap-policy [msap-policy-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays Managed SAP policy information.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Displays information about the specifies MSAP policy
association—
Displays information related to the specifies MSAP policy
Output 

The following output is an example of managed SAP policy information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# msap-policy
===============================================================================
Managed SAP Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Num    Description
                                 MSAPs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
test                             0      (Not Specified)
test 1                           0      (Not Specified)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of MSAP Policies : 2
Number of MSAPs         : 0
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 

pcc-rule

Syntax 
pcc-rule
pcc-rule monitoring-key key detail
pcc-rule rule-id id detail
pcc-rule rule-name rule-name
pcc-rule rule-name rule-name detail
pcc-rule summary
pcc-rule monitoring-key key
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays a list of pcc-rules and associated monitoring keys in the system.

Parameters 
key
Displays details about a specific monitoring-key
id
Displays details about a specific pcc-rule
rule-name
Displays information about a specific pcc-rule
summary—
Displays summarized information for a active rules in the system
key
Displays information about a specific monitoring-key
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management PCC rule information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule summary 
===============================================================================
PCC Rules Summary
===============================================================================
Nbr Active PCC Rules    : 26 / 1023
Nbr Active Combinations
  IPv4 Filter           : 2 / 4095
  IPv6 Filter           : 0 / 4095
  Egress Qos            : 1 / 4095
  Ingress Qos           : 1 / 4095
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule 
===============================================================================
                       Id      Dir  ForwardAction         QosAction
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
name      : RULE_egress_FC
monitorKey: -
                       29      egr  -                      fc
name      : RULE_egress_UM
monitorKey: um_RULE_egress_UM
                       34      egr  -                      monitor
name      : RULE_ingress_FC
monitorKey: -
                       37      ingr -                      fc
name      : RULE_ingress_UM
monitorKey: um_RULE_ingress_UM
                       50      ingr -                      monitor
name      : RULE_egress_DROP
monitorKey: -
                       28      egr  drop                  -
name      : RULE_ingress_RDR
monitorKey: -
                       49      ingr fwd nh4               -
name      : RULE_egress_UM_FC
monitorKey: um_RULE_egress_UM_FC
                       35      egr  -                      fc monitor
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule rule-name "RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR" detail 
===============================================================================
PCC Rules
===============================================================================
PCC rule name         : RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
PCC rule id           : 47
Monitoring key        : um_RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
Flow status           : Enabled
Nbr of Flows          : 1 (ingress)
HTTP-Redirect         : -
Next-Hop Redir. IPv4  : 10.10.10.10
Next-Hop Redir. IPv6  : -
QoS Ingr. CIR/PIR     : 1000 kbps / 2000 kbps
QoS Egr. CIR/PIR      : - / -
FC change             : h2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Flows
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Src. IP  : any                                    Src. Port: -
Dst. IP  : 75.24.24.17/32                         Dst. Port: -
Protocol : 6                                      DSCP     : cp60
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
 
 
show service active-subscribers pcc-rule subscriber "1/1/3:1.1|00:00:00:00:00:01" 
===============================================================================
Active Subscribers
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber 1/1/3:1.1|00:00:00:00:00:01 (subprof1)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(1) SLA Profile Instance sap:1/1/3:1.1 - sla:sla1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingr Qos Policy Override : 3:P2
Egr  Qos Policy Override : 2:P2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IP Address
                MAC Address       PPPoE-SID Origin
--------------------------------------------------------
22.1.0.1
                00:00:00:00:00:01 N/A       DHCP
--------------------------------------------------------
Ingr Filter Override : 5:P4
Egr  Filter Override : 6:P5
========================================================
Preference Rule Id   Rule Name
--------------------------------------------------------
0          28        RULE_egress_DROP
0          29        RULE_egress_FC
0          30        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT
0          31        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_FC
0          32        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_UM
0          33        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC
0          34        RULE_egress_UM
0          35        RULE_egress_UM_FC
0          36        RULE_ingress_DROP
0          37        RULE_ingress_FC
0          38        RULE_ingress_FC_HTTP
0          39        RULE_ingress_FC_RDR
0          40        RULE_ingress_HTTP
0          41        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT
0          42        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_FC
0          43        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_FC_RDR
0          44        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_RDR
0          45        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM
0          46        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC
0          47        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
0          48        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_RDR
0          49        RULE_ingress_RDR
0          50        RULE_ingress_UM
0          51        RULE_ingress_UM_FC
0          52        RULE_ingress_UM_FC_RDR
0          53        RULE_ingress_UM_RDR
========================================================
 
 

radius-accounting-policy

Syntax 
radius-accounting-policy name association
radius-accounting-policy [name]
radius-accounting-policy name statistics
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays RADIUS accounting policy information.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the RADIUS accounting policy name
association—
Displays parameters associated with this RADIUS accounting policy
statistics—
Displays statistics associated with this RADIUS accounting policy
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management RADIUS accounting policy information.

Sample Output
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show subscriber-mgmt radius-accounting-policy "ZiggoAcct1813" 
statistics 
===============================================================================
Radius Accounting Policy ZiggoAcct1813 Statistics
===============================================================================
Tx Requests      : 36035966           Rx Responses  : 36035966
Request Timeouts : 0                  Send Retries  : 2713
Send Failed      : 0                  
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Servers
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Index IP Address      Tx Reqs     Rx Resps    Req Timeouts Req Send Failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     172.18.129.36   9012635     9011762     873          0
2     172.18.129.37   9004736     9003814     922          0
3     172.18.129.68   9010236     9009925     311          0
4     172.18.129.69   9011115     9010465     650          0
===============================================================================
Table 93:  Subscriber RADIUS Accounting Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Tx Requests/TX Reqs

Displays the number of accounting requests transmitted for this policy.

Rx Responses/Rx Resps

Displays the number of accounting responses received for this policy.

Request Timeouts/Req Timeouts

Displays the number of accounting requests which have timed out for this policy.

Send Retries

Displays the number of retries to a different server for a single accounting request for this policy.

Send Failed

Req Send Failed

Displays how many accounting requests failed because the packet could not be sent out for this policy.

Radius Servers

Displays a table in which the statistics associated with this RADIUS accounting policy are broken down by individual RADIUS server.

The table columns are:

Index—displays the index number assigned to the RADIUS server. The index determines the sequence in which the servers are queried for authentication requests. Servers are queried in order from lowest to highest index.

IP Address—the address of the RADIUS server.

TX Reqs—see TX Requests in this table.

Rx Resps—see RX Responses in this table.

Req Timeouts—see Request Timeouts in this table.

Req Send Failed—see Send Failed in this table.

sla-profile

Syntax 
sla-profile [sla-profile-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays SLA profile information.

Parameters 
sla-profile-name—
Specifies an existing SLA profile name
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sla-profile-name.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management SLA profile information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile
===============================================================================
SLA Profiles
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sla_default
sla_prof100_VOIP
sla_prof110_VOIP
sla_prof120_VOIP
sla_prof130_VOIP
sla_prof140_VOIP
sla_prof230_VOIP
sla_prof80
sla_prof80_VOIP
sla_prof81_VOIP
sla_prof90_VOIP
sla_profPC1
sla_profPC2
sla_profPC3
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of SLA Profiles : 14
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A# 
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile sla_prof100_VOIP
===============================================================================
SLA Profile sla_prof100_VOIP
===============================================================================
Host Limit           : 3 (Remove Oldest)
Ingress Qos-Policy   : 100                    Egress Qos-Policy : 100
Ingress Queuing Type : Service-queuing
Ingress Filter-Id    : N/A                    Egress Filter-Id  : N/A
Last Mgmt Change     : 07/10/2006 12:55:33
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Queue Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Rate      CIR       HiPrio  CBS     MBS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2     4000      -         -       -       -
3     2500      -         -       -       -
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Queue Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Rate      CIR       HiPrio  CBS     MBS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2     4000      -         -       -       -
3     2500      -         -       -       -
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile sla_prof100_VOIP association
===============================================================================
SLA Profile sla_prof100_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Default-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Static Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Non-Sub-Traffic-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Ident-Policy Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-name : sub_ident_all
 - Key : sla_prof100_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Explicit Subscriber Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

sla-profile

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Displays information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Displays information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Displays information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler stats information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber "sub1" sla-profile "sla-profile.1" sap 1/1/1:1 scheduler 
 
"session-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
Egress Schedulers
 
session-sched                      0                      0
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

port

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
Description 

This command displays the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port port-id
Displays information for the specified port
vport name
Displays information for the specified Vport
scheduler scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
detail —
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler hierarchy information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-hierarchy port 1/1/1 vport "dslam1" scheduler "dslam-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Port 1/1/1
===============================================================================
Scheduler-policy dslam-sched-pol
| slot(1)
|--(S) : subscriber-sched (VPort dslam1 1/1/1)
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->1
|   |   |
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->1
|   |   |
|
|--(S) : subscriber-sched (VPort dslam1 1/1/1)
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->1
|   |   |
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->1
|   |   |
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

vport

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the Vport scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port-id
Displays information for the specified port
name
Displays information for the specified Vport
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-stats port 1/1/1 vport "dslam1" scheduler "dslam-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Schedulers
 
dslam-sched                        0                      0
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

statistics

Syntax 
statistics iom (slot | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics mda (mda | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics port (port-id | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics pw-port (pw-port | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics sla-profiles
statistics sub-profiles
statistics system [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays enhanced subscriber management statistics per port, PW port, MDA, IOM, or system.

For each statistic, there is current value and peak value. Peak value is the highest value since the last reset as a result of a system boot or the clear subscriber-mgmt peakvalue-stats command.

Note:

The peak values can be reset using the clear subscriber-mgmt peakvalue-stats command.

Parameters 
iom slot
Displays specified IOM slot information.
mda mda
Displays specified slot/mda information.
port port-id
Specifies to display information for both the physical port ID and LAG.
pw-port pw-port
Specifies to display information for a pseudowire port ID.
Values—
1 to 10239

 

all—
displays statistics of all IOM or MDA or port or pseudowire port in the system
host—
Displays v4/v6 host statistics only.
session—
Displays PPPoX/LAC/LNS session statistics only.
sla-profiles—
Displays the current and historical statistics for SLA profiles.
sub-profiles—
Displays the current and historical statistics for subscriber profiles.
subscriber—
Displays subscriber statistics only.
summary—
Displays summary statistics only.
non-zero-value-only—
Displays only non-zero value counters.

The following tables describe the counters available in the show subscriber management statistics command output.

The following terminology is used to indicate applicability of the stats:

  1. ESM — Enhanced Subscriber Management. Subscriber traffic forwarded via subscriber queues. Enabled with SAP sub-sla-mgmt in no shutdown state
  2. BSM — Basic Subscriber Management. Subscriber traffic forwarded via SAP queues. SAP sub-sla-mgmt must be in shutdown state. For DHCP, dhcp lease-populate or dhcp6-relay lease-populate must be enabled to count the leases. For IPv4, if anti-spoof is enabled on the SAP, a subscriber host is instantiated.
  3. Routed CO — IES or VPRN service with subscriber interface and group interface constructs
  4. Bridged CO — VPLS service with DHCPv4 lease management enabled (lease-populate)
  5. regular interface — IES or VPRN interface (none subscriber-interface or group-interface)
  6. Host (also subscriber host) — A resource in the system that is used for traffic forwarding and security related actions. The creation of a subscriber host entry is linked to anti-spoof being enabled on a SAP. For ESM, anti-spoof is mandatory and hence every connected {IP/MAC} consumes by default a subscriber host entry. A DHCP6 IA-PD can also be modeled as a managed route. In this case, no subscriber host is instantiated. For BSM, anti-spoof is optional on regular interfaces. An IPv4 static-host and DHCPv4 lease do not result in a subscriber host instantiation when anti-spoof is disabled on the SAP.
    Table 94:  Host And Protocol Statistics  

    Section

    Counter

    Counts

    Applies to

    IPv4

    1. PPP Hosts - IPCP

    IPv4 local terminated PPP hosts (PTA, LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    2. IPOE Hosts - DHCP

    DHCPv4 hosts (lease states)

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    3. IPOE Hosts - ARP

    ARP hosts

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    4. IPOE Hosts – Static

    IPv4 static hosts

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    5. IPOE Hosts BSM - DHCP

    DHCPv4 hosts (lease states: anti-spoof and lease-populate enabled)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    6. IPOE Hosts BSM – Static

    IPv4 static hosts (with anti-spoof enabled)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    7. IPOE BSM - DHCP

    DHCPv4 lease states (with lease-populate enabled, no anti-spoof)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    8. IPOE BSM – Static

    IPv4 static hosts (no anti-spoof)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    IPv6

    PPP Hosts – SLAAC

    Local terminated IPv6 wan-host – SLAAC (PTA, LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Hosts - DHCP6 (PD)

    Local terminated IPv6 pd-host (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-PD leases over PPP (excluding PD as managed route)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Hosts - DHCP6 (NA)

    Local terminated IPv6 wan-host (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-NA leases over PPP

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Mngd Rt - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-PD leases over PPP (PD as managed route only)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – SLAAC

    IPv6 wan-host – SLAAC

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 pd-host – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (excluding PD as managed route)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts - DHCP6 (NA)

    IPv6 wan-host – DHCP6 IA-NA leases

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Mngd Rt - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (PD as managed route only)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – Static (PD)

    IPv6 static hosts with prefix-length shorter than /128

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – Static (WAN)

    IPv6 static hosts with prefix-length equal to /128

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE BSM - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (lease-populate)

    BSM, regular interface

    IPOE BSM - DHCP6 (NA)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-NA leases (lease-populate)

    BSM, regular interface

    Total

    PPP Hosts

    Local terminated PPP hosts (PTA, LNS)

    Sum of counters 1, 9, 10 and 11

    ESM

    IPOE Hosts

    Total IPv4 and IPv6 IPOE hosts.

    Sum of counters 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 13, 14, 15, 17 and 18

    ESM

    IPv4 Hosts

    Total IPv4 hosts. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6

    ESM

    IPv6 Hosts

    Total IPv6 hosts. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17 and 18

    ESM

    IPv6 PD Mngd Routes

    Total DHCP6 IA-PD leases modeled as a managed route. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 12 and 16

    ESM

    L2TP LAC Hosts

    L2TP LAC hosts – single host per single or dual stack PPP session.

    Counter also increases for outgoing LTS sessions.

    ESM, Routed CO

    Internal Hosts

    Subscriber hosts for internal use. For example: LNS redirect hosts (for LTS, an LNS redirect host is also instantiated).

    ESM

    Total (Cont)

    Non-Sub-Traffic L2-Hosts

    Host on a single subscriber SAP in a VPLS service that enables non-IP traffic to be forwarded using the specified SLA profile instance queues.

    Host on a single subscriber SAP attached to an IES/VPRN group-interface that enables traffic normally forwarded via the SAP queues to flow via the specified SLA profile instance queues.

    configure service vpls <service-id> sap <sap-id> sub-sla-mgmt single-sub-parameters non-sub-traffic sub-profile <sub-profile-name> sla-profile <sla-profile-name> [subscriber <sub-ident-string>] [app-profile <app-profile-name>]

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    DHCP leases

    Total number of DHCPv4 lease states.

    Sum of counters 2, 5 and 7

    ESM, BSM

    DHCPv6 leases

    Total number of DHCPv6 lease states.

    Sum of counters 10, 11, 12, 14, 15, 16, 19 and 20

    ESM, BSM

    Subscriber Hosts

    Counter displayed in the output of “show subscriber-mgmt statistics iom | mda | port | pw-port”

    This counter matches the number of hosts accounted for in the per line card limit

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18 and 26

    ESM

    Total (Cont)

    System Hosts Scale

    Counter displayed in the output of “show subscriber-mgmt statistics system”

    This counter matches the number of hosts accounted for in the system wide limit

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, 26 and 27

    ESM

    Table 95:  PPP Session Statistics 

    Section

    Counter

    Counts

    Applies to

    Local

    PPP Sessions - PPPoE

    Local terminated PPPoE sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoEoA

    Local terminated PPPoEoA sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    .PPP Sessions - PPPoA

    Local terminated PPPoA sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - L2TP (LNS)

    Local terminated PPP sessions (L2TP LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    LAC

    PPP Sessions - PPPoE

    Tunneled PPPoE session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoEoA

    Tunneled PPPoEoA session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoA

    Tunneled PPPoA session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - L2TP (LTS)

    Tunneled PPP session (L2TP LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    Total

    PPP Sessions - established

    PPP sessions that are established (at least one active host attached) – PTA/LAC/LTS/LNS

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - in setup

    PPP sessions in setup (session created, host setup in progress) – PTA/LAC/LTS/LNS

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - local

    Local terminated PPPoX sessions (PTA, L2TP LNS)

    Sum of counters 33, 34, 35 and 36

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - LAC

    Tunneled PPPoX session (L2TP LAC, L2TP LTS)

    Sum of counters 37, 38, 39 and 40

    ESM, Routed CO

    L2TP

    L2TP Tunnels - originator

    Number of L2TP Tunnels originated on this node. (LAC/ LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    .L2TP Tunnels - receiver

    Number of L2TP Tunnels terminated on this node. (LNS/LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    Total L2TP Tunnels

    Number of L2TP Tunnels originated or terminated on this node

    Sum of counters 45 and 46

    ESM, Routed CO

Table 96:  IPoE Session Statistics 

Section

Counter

Counts

Applies to

Total

IPOE Sessions - established

IPoE sessions that are established (at least one active host attached).

ESM, Routed CO

IPOE Sessions- in setup

IPoE sessions in setup (session created, host setup in progress).

ESM, Routed CO

Table 97:  Subscriber Statistics 

Section

Counter

Counts

Applies to

Total

Subscribers

Total number of active subscribers.

ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

Table 98:  SubMgmt Statistics Summary 

Section

Counter

Counts

Hosts

IPv4

IPv6

Total IPv4 hosts (counter 23 in tables above)

Total IPv6 hosts (counter 24 in tables above)

Sessions

PPP

IPOE

Total PPP sessions - established (counter 41 in tables above)

Total IPOE sessions – established (counter 48 in tables above)

Subscribers

Total number of active subscribers (counter 50 in tables above)

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management system statistics.

Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics system
===============================================================================
Subscriber Management Statistics for System
===============================================================================
       Type                               Current      Peak      Peak Timestamp
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Host & Protocol Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPv4   PPP Hosts      - IPCP                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP                    0         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       IPOE Hosts     - ARP                     1         1 02/28/2015 13:46:10
       IPOE Hosts     - Static                  0         0
       IPOE Hosts BSM - DHCP                    0         0
       IPOE Hosts BSM - Static                  0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP                    0         0
       IPOE BSM       - Static                  0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPv6   PPP Hosts      - SLAAC                   0         0
       PPP Hosts      - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       PPP Hosts      - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
       PPP Mngd Rt    - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - SLAAC                   0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
       IPOE Mngd Rt   - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - Static (PD)             0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - Static (WAN)            0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  PPP Hosts                                1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPOE Hosts                               1         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       IPv4 Hosts                               2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPv6 Hosts                               0         0
       IPv6 PD Mngd Routes                      0         0
       L2TP LAC Hosts                           0         0
       Internal Hosts                           0         0
       Non-Sub-Traffic L2-Hosts                 0         0
       DHCP Leases                              0         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       DHCPv6 Leases                            0         0
       System Hosts Scale                       2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PPP Session Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local  PPP Sessions  - PPPoE                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoEoA                  0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoA                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - L2TP (LNS)               0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
LAC    PPP Sessions  - PPPoE                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoEoA                  0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoA                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - L2TP (LTS)               0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  PPP Sessions  - established              1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - in setup                 0         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - local                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - LAC                      0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
L2TP   L2TP Tunnels  - originator               0         0
       L2TP Tunnels  - receiver                 0         0
       Total L2TP Tunnels                       0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPOE Session Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  IPOE Sessions - established              0         0
       IPOE Sessions - in setup                 0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  Subscribers                              2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
Peak values last reset at : n/a
 
Sample Output (summary view)
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics port 1/1/4 summary
===============================================================================
SubMgmt Statistics
===============================================================================
                 |       Hosts        |      Sessions      |    Subscribers
Port Id          |   IPv4      IPv6   |    PPP      IPOE   |
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4            |        2         2 |        1         1 |        2   (Curr)
                 |        3         3 |        1         2 |        3   (Peak)
===============================================================================
 
Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics sla-profiles
===============================================================================
SLA Profile Statistics
===============================================================================
SLA-Profile Name                        Current       Peak       Peak Timestamp 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
tv-prof                                       0          0 
hsi-prof                                      1          1  12/29/2016 15:50:50
hsi-iptv--prof                                0          0 
no-prof-1                                     1          1  01/03/2017 20:00:37
hsi-voip-prof                                 0          2  12/29/2016 18:42:44
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                         2
===============================================================================
 
Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics sub-profiles
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile Statistics
===============================================================================
Subscriber-Profile Name                  Current       Peak       Peak Timestamp
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
no-prof                                        2          3  12/29/2016 18:42:44
sub-10M                                        0          0
sub-10M-UPNP                                   0          0
sub-20M                                        0          0
sub-20M-UPNP                                   0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                          2
===============================================================================
 

steering-profile

Syntax 
steering-profile steering-profile-name
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays steering profile information.

Parameters 
steering-profile-name—
Specifies an existing steering profile name.

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
sub-ident-policy [sub-ident-policy-name [association]]
sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name script {primary | secondary | tertiary}
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber identification policy information.

Parameters 
sub-ident-policy-name—
Specifies an existing subscriber identification policy name
association—
Displays information configured with the specified sub-ident-policy-name
script {primary | secondary | tertiary}—
Displays information for the specified identification script
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management subscriber identification policy information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_ident_all
sub_ident_pc
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Subscriber Identification Policies : 2
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Sub Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              Sub profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_prof100                      sub_prof100
sub_prof110                      sub_prof110
sub_prof120                      sub_prof120
sub_prof130                      sub_prof130
sub_prof140                      sub_prof140
sub_prof230                      sub_prof230
sub_prof80                       sub_prof80
sub_prof81                       sub_prof81
sub_prof90                       sub_prof90
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              SLA profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sla_prof100_VOIP                 sla_prof100_VOIP
sla_prof110_VOIP                 sla_prof110_VOIP
sla_prof120_VOIP                 sla_prof120_VOIP
sla_prof130_VOIP                 sla_prof130_VOIP
sla_prof140_VOIP                 sla_prof140_VOIP
sla_prof230_VOIP                 sla_prof230_VOIP
sla_prof80_VOIP                  sla_prof80_VOIP
sla_prof81_VOIP                  sla_prof81_VOIP
sla_prof90_VOIP                  sla_prof90_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Python Scripts
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
#         Admin Oper  Script
          State State Name
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Primary   Down  Down  pyTom.py
Secondary Up    Up    pyTomDebug.py
Tertiary  Up    Up    hardcoded.py
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all association
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 80 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80
Service-Id : 90 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:90
Service-Id : 100 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:100
 - SAP : 1/2/1:101
 - SAP : 1/2/1:102
Service-Id : 110 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:110
 - SAP : 1/2/1:111
 - SAP : 1/2/1:112
Service-Id : 120 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:120
 - SAP : 1/2/1:121
 - SAP : 1/2/1:122
Service-Id : 130 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:130
Service-Id : 140 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:140
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script primary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Primary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/pyTom.py
Admin State : Down                      Oper State : Down
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Script is not active.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script secondary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Secondary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/pyTomDebug.py
Admin State : Up                        Oper State : Up
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      1 import alc
      2 yiaddr = alc.dhcp.yiaddr
      3 # Subscriber ID equals full client IP address.
      4 # Note: IP address 10.10.10.10 yields 'sub-168430090'
      5 # and not 'sub-10.10.10.10'
      6 alc.dhcp.sub_ident = 'sub-' + str(yiaddr)
      7 # DHCP server is configured such that the third byte (field) of the IP
      8 # address indicates the session Profile ID.
      9 alc.dhcp.sla_profile = 'sp-' + str((yiaddr & 0x0000FF00) >> 8)
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script tertiary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Tertiary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/hardcoded.py
Admin State : Up                        Oper State : Up
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      1 from alc import dhcp
      2
      3 dhcp.sub_ident = 'sub_ident_A_1'
      4 dhcp.sub_profile_string = 'sub_prof_B_2'
      5 dhcp.sla_profile_string = 'sla_prof_C_3'
      6
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt#

sub-profile

Syntax 
sub-profile [sub-profile-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber profile information.

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Specifies an existing subscriber profile name
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sub-profile-name
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber profile information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profiles
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_default
sub_prof100
sub_prof110
sub_prof120
sub_prof130
sub_prof140
sub_prof230
sub_prof80
sub_prof81
sub_prof90
sub_profPC1
sub_profPC2
sub_profPC3
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Subscriber Profiles : 13
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile sub_prof100
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile sub_prof100
===============================================================================
I. Sched. Policy : service100
E. Sched. Policy : service100
Acct. Policy     : 1                                Collect Stats : Enabled
Last Mgmt Change : 07/10/2006 12:55:33
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Scheduler Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Scheduler                        Rate      CIR
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv100                          8000      sum
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Scheduler Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Scheduler                        Rate      CIR
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv100                          8000      sum
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              SLA Profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No mappings configured.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile sub_prof100 association
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile sub_prof100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Default-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Static Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Non-Sub-Traffic-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Ident-Policy Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-name : sub_ident_all
 - Key : sub_prof100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Explicit Subscriber Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

pw-port

Syntax 
pw-port [pw-port-id] [detail]
pw-port sdp sdp-id
pw-port sdp none
Context 
show>pw-port
Description 

Displays pseudo-wire port information.

If no optional parameters are specified, the command displays a summary of all defined PW ports. The optional parameters restrict output to only ports matching the specified properties.

Parameters 
pw-port-id
Specifies the pseudo-wire port identifier
Values—
1 to 10239

 

detail—
Displays detailed port information that includes all the pw-port output fields
sdp-id
The SDP ID for which to display matching PW port information
Values—
1 to 17407

 

Output 

The following output is an example of PW port information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1         dot1q          1          1526726657          1
2         qinq           1          1526726658          2
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
4         qinq           1          1526726660          4
============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port 3
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port 3 detail
===============================================================================
PW Port Information
===============================================================================
PW Port            : 3
Encap              : dot1q
SDP                : 1
IfIndex            : 1526726659
VC-Id              : 3
Description        : 1-Gig Ethernet dual fiber
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>config>pw-port$ show pw-port sdp none
 
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
5         dot1q                     1526726661
============================================================================
 
 
*A:ALA-48>config>pw-port$ show pw-port sdp 1
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1         dot1q          1          1526726657          1
2         qinq           1          1526726658          2
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
4         qinq           1          1526726660          4
============================================================================
 

The following table describes show pw-port output fields:

Table 99:  Subscriber Show PW-Port Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

PW Port

The PW port identifier.

Encap

The encapsulation type of the PW port.

SDP

The SDP identifier.

IfIndex

The interface index used for the PW port.

VC-Id

The Virtual Circuit identifier.

Description

The description string for the PW port.

port-scheduler-policy

Syntax 
port-scheduler-policy [port-scheduler-policy-name] [association]
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name network-policy network-queue-policy-name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name sap-egress policy-id
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name sap-egress policy-id
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays scheduler policy information.

Parameters 
port-scheduler-policy-name—
Specifies an existing port scheduler policy name
network-queue-policy-name—
Specifies an existing network queue policy name
policy-id—
Specifies an existing SAP egress policy ID
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS port scheduler policy information.

Sample Output
A:NS072860910>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# info
----------------------------------------------
            max-rate 10000
            group "group1" create
                rate 3000 cir 1000
            exit
            group "group2" create
                rate 2000 cir 500
            exit
            level 7 rate 7000 cir 700 group "group1" weight 3
            level 6 rate 6000 cir 600 group "group1" weight 2
            level 5 rate 5000 cir 500 group "group1" weight 1
            level 2 rate 2000 cir 200 group "group2" weight 2
            level 1 rate 1000 cir 100 group "group2" weight 1
----------------------------------------------
 
A:NS072860910# show qos scheduler-hierarchy port 5/1/2 vport "fred"
========================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Port 5/1/2, Vport "fred"
========================================================================
Port-scheduler-policy psp1
    Port Bandwidth : 1000000    Max Rate : 10000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Within CIR Level 8]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->1
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->1
 
[Within CIR Group "group1"]
    Rate     : 1000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Within CIR Level 7]
        Weight   : 3
        Rate     : 700
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->2
 
    [Within CIR Level 6]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 600
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->3
 
    [Within CIR Level 5]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 500
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->4
 
[Within CIR Level 4]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Within CIR Level 3]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->5
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->5
 
[Within CIR Group "group2"]
    Rate : 500
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Within CIR Level 2]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 200
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->6
 
    [Within CIR Level 1]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 200
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->7
 
[Within CIR Level 0]
    Rate     : 0
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->8
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->8
 
[Above CIR Level 8]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Group "group1"]
    Rate     : 3000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 7]
        Weight   : 3
        Rate     : 7000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 6]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 6000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 5]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 5000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Level 4]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Level 3]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Group "group2"]
    Rate     : 2000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 2]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 2000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 1]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 1000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->1
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->5
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->8
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->1
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->5
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->8
========================================================================
A:NS072860910# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp"
========================================================================
QoS Port Scheduler Policy
========================================================================
Policy-Name       : psp                 
Description       : (Not Specified)
Max Rate          : max                 Last changed      : 04/15/2010 00:37:02
Group             : 1                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 2                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 3                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 4                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Lvl1 PIR          : max                 Lvl1 CIR          : max
Lvl1 Group        : 1                   Lvl1 Grp Weight   : 10
 
Lvl2 PIR          : max                 Lvl2 CIR          : max
Lvl2 Group        : 1                   Lvl2 Grp Weight   : 20
 
Lvl3 PIR          : max                 Lvl3 CIR          : max
Lvl3 Group        : 2                   Lvl3 Grp Weight   : 30
 
Lvl4 PIR          : max                 Lvl4 CIR          : max
Lvl4 Group        : 2                   Lvl4 Grp Weight   : 40
 
Lvl5 PIR          : max                 Lvl5 CIR          : max
Lvl5 Group        : 3                   Lvl5 Grp Weight   : 50
 
Lvl6 PIR          : max                 Lvl6 CIR          : max
Lvl6 Group        : 3                   Lvl6 Grp Weight   : 60
 
Lvl7 PIR          : max                 Lvl7 CIR          : max
Lvl7 Group        : 4                   Lvl7 Grp Weight   : 70
 
Lvl8 PIR          : max                 Lvl8 CIR          : max
Lvl8 Group        : 4                   Lvl8 Grp Weight   : 80
 
Orphan Lvl        : default             Orphan Weight     : default
Orphan CIR-Lvl    : default             Orphan CIR-Weight : default
========================================================================
*A:Bennet-Dut-A>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp" association 
========================================================================
QoS Port Scheduler Policy
========================================================================
Policy-Name       : psp                 
Description       : (Not Specified)
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
------------------------------------------------------------------------
 - Port : 1/1/2 VPort : vp1
========================================================================
*A:B-Dut-A# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp" sap-egress 1000
========================================================================
Compatibility : Port-scheduler Policy psp & Sap Egress Queue 1000
========================================================================
Orphan Queues :
 
None Found
 
Hierarchy     :
 
Root
|
|---(Q) : 1    
|
|---(Q) : 2    
|
|---(Q) : 3    
|
|---(Q) : 4    
|
|---(Q) : 5    
|
|---(Q) : 6                           
|
|---(Q) : 7    
|
|---(Q) : 8    
========================================================================
*A:B-Dut-A# 
 

sap-egress

Syntax 
sap-egress [policy-id] [association | detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays SAP egress policy information.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Displays information for the specified SAP egress policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sap-egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of Qos SAP egress information.

Sample Output
*A:Dut-A# show qos sap-egress
===============================================================================
Sap Egress Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id  Scope     Name                     Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1          Template  default                  Default SAP egress QoS policy.
30         Template                           1 video channel, 1 BE
31         Template                           1 video EF, 2xvideo AF, 1 BE
80         Template                           Limit outgoing 80
100        Template                           User100
110        Template                           User110
120        Template                           User120
130        Template                           User130
140        Template                           User140
901        Template                           User90_1
902        Template                           User90_2
903        Template                           User90_3
904        Template                           User90_4
905        Template                           User90_5
1000       Template                           Service all
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Policies : 15
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-egress 31 detail
===============================================================================
QoS Sap Egress
===============================================================================
Sap Scheduler Policy (31)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-id      : 31                           Scope        : Template
Description    : 1 video EF, 2xvideo AF, 1 BE
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue         CIR Admin PIR Admin CBS     HiPrio  PIR Lvl/Wt    Parent
              CIR Rule  PIR Rule  MBS             CIR Lvl/Wt
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1             0         max       def     def     1/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
2             0         max       def     def     2/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
3             0         max       def     def     3/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC Name               Queue-id    Explicit/Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be                    1           Explicit (0)
af                    2           Explicit (0)
ef                    3           Explicit (0)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 23 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 1
 - SAP : 1/2/2:4000
Service-Id     : 30 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : lag-1
 - SAP : lag-2:5
Service-Id     : 31 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : 1/2/1:31
SLA Profiles :
 - sla_profPC1                      override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Mirror SAPs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Mirror SAPs Found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

sap-ingress

Syntax 
sap-ingress [policy-id] [association | match-criteria | detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays SAP ingress policy information.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Displays information for the specified SAP ingress policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sap-ingress policy
match-criteria—
Displays information about the matching criteria
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS SAP ingress information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-ingress
===============================================================================
Sap Ingress Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id  Scope     Name                     Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1          Template  default                  Default SAP ingress QoS policy.
80         Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
90         Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
100        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
110        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
120        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
130        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
140        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
901        Template                           User90_1
902        Template                           User90_2
903        Template                           User90_3
904        Template                           User90_4
905        Template                           User90_5
1000       Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for all s*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Policies : 14
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
* indicates that the corresponding row element may have been truncated.
*A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-ingress 80 detail
===============================================================================
QoS Sap Ingress
===============================================================================
Sap Ingress Policy (80)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-id      : 80                           Scope        : Template
Default FC     : be                           Priority     : Low
Criteria-type  : IP
Description    :  Dot1p mappings/service for service 80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Mode    CIR Admin PIR Admin CBS     HiPrio  PIR Lvl/Wt    Parent
              CIR Rule  PIR Rule  MBS             CIR Lvl/Wt
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     Prio    0         7000      def     def     1/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
2     Prio    0         3500      def     def     2/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
3     Prio    0         2000      def     def     3/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
11    Prio    0         max       def     def     1/1           None
              closest   closest   def             0/1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC                  UCastQ         MCastQ         BCastQ         UnknownQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be                  1              def            def            def
af                  2              def            def            def
ef                  3              def            def            def
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SubFC                              Profile        In-Remark      Out-Remark
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
af                                 None           None           None
be                                 None           None           None
ef                                 None           None           None
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Dot1p           FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
0               be                               Default
2               af                               Default
5               ef                               Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
DSCP            FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No DSCP-Map Entries Found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Prec Value      FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Prec-Map Entries Found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Match Criteria
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IP Match Criteria
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Entry          : 1
Source IP      : Undefined                    Source Port  : None
Dest. IP       : Undefined                    Dest. Port   : None
Protocol       : None                         DSCP         : None
Fragment       : Off
FC             : Default                      Priority     : Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 80 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 80
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80
 
SLA Profiles :
 - sla_prof80                       override
 - sla_prof80_VOIP                  override
 - sla_prof81_VOIP                  override
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

scheduler-hierarchy

Syntax 
scheduler-hierarchy
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command enters the context to display information about policies that use this scheduler.

customer

Syntax 
customer customer-id site customer-site-name [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the scheduler hierarchy per customer multi-service-site.

Parameters 
customer-id
Displays information for the specified customer ID
customer-site-name
Displays information for the specified multi-service customer
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
ingress—
Displays information for the ingress policy
egress—
Displays information for the egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information

sap

Syntax 
sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the scheduler stats per SAP.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
ingress—
Displays information for the ingress policy
egress—
Displays information for the egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
Description 

This command displays the scheduler hierarchy rooted at the SLA profile scheduler.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Displays information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Displays information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Displays information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
detail —
Displays detailed information
Note:

If the SLA profile scheduler is orphaned (that is when the scheduler has a parent which does not exist) then the hierarchy is only shown when the show command includes the sla-profile and sap parameters.

Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber "sub1" sla-profile "sla-profile.1" sap 1/1/1:1 scheduler "session-sched" 
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber sub1 SLA-Profile sla-profile.1 SAP 1/1/1:1
===============================================================================
Egress Scheduler Policy : session-sched-pol
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
session-sched (Egr)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->3
|
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->2
|
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->1
|
 
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber nokia_100 scheduler serv_all
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
serv_all (Ing)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:101->11 MCast
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->11 MCast
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->11 MCast
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->3
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 1/2
|   |
...
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber nokia_100 scheduler serv_all detail
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
Legend :
(U) - Unrestricted     (P) - Provisioned
(A) - Administrative   (O) - Operational
MIR - Measured Info Rate
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv_all (Ing)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:101->11 MCast
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:4            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):7000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):1000000      PIR (O):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :1280
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:256
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->11 MCast
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:4            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):7000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):1000000      PIR (O):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :1280
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:256
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->1
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:1            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :1687
|   |    PIR (P):1690         PIR (U):3510
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/1
|   |   |
|   |   |    PIR Lvl:1            PIR Wt :1
|   |   |    CIR Lvl:1            CIR Wt :1
|   |   |
|   |   |    MIR    :0
|   |   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):1830
|   |   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |   |
|   |   |    PIR (A):7000         PIR (O):1850
|   |   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :64
|   |   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:8
|   |
...
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->3
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:3            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):2000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):2000         PIR (O):2000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :64
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:8
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#

scheduler-name

Syntax 
scheduler-name scheduler-name
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays information about the specified scheduler name.

Parameters 
scheduler-name—
Displays information about the specified scheduler

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy [scheduler-policy-name] [association | sap-ingress policy-id | sap-egress policy-id]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays information about the specified scheduler policy.

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name—
Displays information for the specified scheduler policy
policy-id
Displays information for the ingress policy
policy-id
Displays information for the egress policy
association—
Displays the information currently configured with the specified scheduler-policy-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler policy information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy
===============================================================================
Sap Scheduler Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id                        Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
maximum_4000_1xEF_1xBE
maximum_8000_1xEF_2xAF_1xBE
multiservice-site
root
scheduler-7Mbps
service100
service110
service120
service130
service140
service80
service90
service_all
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy root association
===============================================================================
QoS Scheduler Policy
===============================================================================
Policy-Name    : root
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy association
===============================================================================
QoS Scheduler Policy
===============================================================================
Policy-Name    : maximum_4000_1xEF_1xBE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : maximum_8000_1xEF_2xAF_1xBE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 23 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 1
 - SAP : 1/3/2:4000 (Egr)
Service-Id     : 30 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : lag-1 (Egr)
 - SAP : lag-2:5 (Egr)
Policy-Name    : multiservice-site
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 90 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 90
 - SAP : 1/1/12:95 (Ing) (Egr) MSS : site1
 - SAP : 1/1/20:94 (Ing) (Egr) MSS : site1
 
 - Customer : 2         MSS : site1  (Ing) (Egr)
 - Customer : 90        MSS : site1  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : root
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : scheduler-7Mbps
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : service100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 100 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 100
 - SAP : 1/2/1:100 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:101 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:102 (Ing) (Egr)
 
 - Customer : 100       MSS : site100  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof100 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service110
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 110 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 110
 - SAP : 1/2/1:110 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:111 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:112 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof110 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service120
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 120 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 120
 - SAP : 1/2/1:120 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:121 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:122 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof120 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service130
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 130 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 130
 - SAP : 1/2/1:130 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof130 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service140
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 140 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 140
 - SAP : 1/2/1:140 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof140 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 80 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 80
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80 (Ing) (Egr)
 
 - Customer : 80        MSS : site80  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof80 (Ing) (Egr)
 - sub_prof81 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service90
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 90 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 90
 - SAP : 1/2/1:90 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof90 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service_all
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_default (Ing) (Egr)
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#

scheduler-stats

Syntax 
scheduler-stats
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command enters the context to display scheduler statistics information.

Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler stats information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Schedulers
root                               112777                 25218126
serv_all                           112777                 25218126
Egress Schedulers
root                               113781                 26008462
serv_all                           113781                 26008462
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber nokia_100 scheduler root
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Schedulers
root                               0                      0
Egress Schedulers
root                               0                      0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A# 

shared-queue

Syntax 
shared-queue [shared-queue-policy-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays shared policy information.

Parameters 
shared-queue-policy-name—
Specifies the name of a shared-queue
detail—
Displays detailed information about the shared queue policy
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS shared queue information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos shared-queue
===============================================================================
Shared Queue Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id                        Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
default                          Default Shared Queue Policy
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos shared-queue detail
===============================================================================
QoS Network Queue Policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Shared Queue Policy (default)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy         : default
Description    : Default Shared Queue Policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue CIR       PIR       CBS     MBS     HiPrio  Multipoint
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     0         100       1       50      10      FALSE
2     25        100       3       50      10      FALSE
3     25        100       10      50      10      FALSE
4     25        100       3       25      10      FALSE
5     100       100       10      50      10      FALSE
6     100       100       10      50      10      FALSE
7     10        100       3       25      10      FALSE
8     10        100       3       25      10      FALSE
9     0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
10    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
11    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
12    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
13    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
14    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
15    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
16    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
17    0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
18    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
19    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
20    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
21    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
22    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
23    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
24    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
25    0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
26    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
27    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
28    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
29    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
30    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
31    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
32    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC    UCastQ    MCastQ    BCastQ  UnknownQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be    1         9         17      25
l2    2         10        18      26
af    3         11        19      27
l1    4         12        20      28
h2    5         13        21      29
ef    6         14        22      30
h1    7         15        23      31
nc    8         16        24      32
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:101 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:102 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:103 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:104 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:105 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:106 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:107 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:108 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:109 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:110 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:111 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:112 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:113 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:114 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:115 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:116 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:117 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:118 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:119 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:120 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:121 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:122 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:123 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/5:279 (shared Q)
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

accu-stats

Syntax 
accu-stats subscriber subscriber-id
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command displays the accumulated statistics for both online and offline statistics.

Parameters 
subscriber-id—
Specifies the subscriber ID, to a maximum of 32 characters.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber statistics.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats subscriber home-1
===============================================================================
Subscriber accumulated statistics for “home-1”
===============================================================================
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber accumulated statistics ingress queue 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     packets                octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Offered high priority                0                      0        
Offered low priority                 0                      0        
Dropped high priority                0                      0    
Dropped low priority                 0                      0        
Forwarded in-profile                 0                      0   
Forwarded out-of-profile             0                      0   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber accumulated statistics egress queue 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     packets                octets
Forwarded in-profile                 0                      0   
Forwarded out-of-profile             0                      0   
Dropped in-profile                   0                      0   
Dropped out-of--profile              0                      0   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================

accu-stats-policy

Syntax 
accu-stats-policy
accu-stats-policy policy-name [associations]
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command displays the configuration of the accumulated statistics policy for the subscriber profile that referenced the accumulated statistics policy.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the policy name, to a maximum of 32 characters.
associations—
Lists the sub-profile that referenced the policy.
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management accumulated statistics information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-policy “accu-stats-policy-01”
===============================================================================
Subscriber accumulated statistics policy accu-stats-policy-01
===============================================================================
Description                          : (Not Specified)         
Last management change               : 09/23/2016 16:48:46
===============================================================================
 
===============================================================================
Entries
===============================================================================
Direction Type     Id
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ingress   queue    1     
egress    queue    1     
===============================================================================
Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-policy “accu-stats-policy-01” associations
===============================================================================
Subscriber profile associations
===============================================================================
no-prof                         
sub-prof
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
No. of subscriber profiles: 2
===============================================================================

accu-stats-subscribers

Syntax 
accu-stats-subscribers [subscriber sub-ident] [sub-profile name]
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command lists all subscribers on the system that had referenced an accumulated statistics policy. The list contains subscribers that are currently referencing an accu-stats-policy as well as subscribers that no longer reference an accu-stats-policy (due to removal of the policy from the subscriber profile).

Parameters 
sub-ident—
Specifies a specific subscriber ID, to a maximum of 32 characters.
sub-profile name
Lists all subscribers that are referencing the specified subscriber profile, to a maximum of 32 characters.
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management accumulated statistics information.

Sample Output
*DUT# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-subscribers    
===============================================================================
Subscribers with accumulated statistics
===============================================================================
Subscriber                            : home-1
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : accu-stats-policy-01
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber                            : home-2
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : accu-stats-policy-02
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber                            : twamp-host
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : (Unknown)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Subscribers with accumulated statistics: 3
===============================================================================
Sample Output

The show subscriber-mgmt status system command shows the number of subscribers using accumulated statistics and whether the statistics usage has reached the peak value.

*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt status system 
===============================================================================
Subscriber Management System Status
===============================================================================
Chassis 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Memory usage high                                       : No
DHCP message processing overload                        : No
Statistics usage high                                   : Yes
Number of subscribers using statistics                  : 131072
Data-trigger statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Packets received                                        : 0
Packets dropped                                         : 0
Packets in queue (actual)                               : 0
Packets in queue (peak)                                 : 0
Bridged Residential Gateway statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
BRG initialized                                         : 0
BRG operational                                         : 0
BRG in connectivity verification                        : 0
BRG on hold                                             : 0
BRG authenticated by proxy                              : 0
===============================================================================

ancp-policy

Syntax 
ancp-policy [policy-name]
Context 
show>subscriber-management
Description 

This command displays subscriber ANCP policy information.

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP policy information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy
===============================================================================
ANCP Policies
===============================================================================
adsl-operator1
vdsl-operator1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of ANCP policies : 2
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy adsl-operator1
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "adsl-operator1"
===============================================================================
I. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
I. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
I. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
I. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
I. Rate Modify         : scheduler "root"
 
E. Rate Reduction      : 10 kbps
E. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
E. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
E. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
E. Rate Modify         : scheduler "root"
Port Down : N/A
Last Mgmt Change: 01/26/2007 17:10:51
================================================================================
A:active#
 
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy adsl-operator1 association
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "adsl-operator1" associations 
===============================================================================
SAP Static Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- SAP     : 1/1/3                             Svc-id  : 333 (VPLS)
     String : "ANCP-String-1"
     String : "ANCP-String-2"
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MSS Static Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Cust-id : 1                                 MSS-name: mss1
     String : "ANCP-String-3"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
Number of associations : 3
===============================================================================
A:active#

ancp-string

Syntax 
ancp-string
ancp-string ancp-string
ancp-string customer customer-id site customer-site-name
ancp-string sap sap-id
Context 
show>subscriber-management
Description 

This command displays subscriber ANCP string information.

Parameters 
ancp-string—
Specify the ASCII representation of the DSLAM circuit-id name
customer-id
Specify the associated existing customer name
customer-site-name
Specify the associated customer’s configured MSS name
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management ANCP string information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string
===============================================================================
ANCP-Strings
===============================================================================
ANCP-String                                                Assoc State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
"ANCP-String-1"                                            SAP   Up
"ANCP-String-2"                                            SAP   Down
"ANCP-String-3"                                            MSS   Up
"ANCP-String-4"                                            MSS   Unknown
"ANCP-String-5"                                            ANCP  Up
"ANCP-String-6"                                            MSS   Unknown
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of ANCP-Strings : 6
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string hpolSub43
===============================================================================
ANCP-String "hpolSub43"
===============================================================================
Type       : SUB - "hpolSub43"
State      : Up                 Ancp Policy: ancpPol
I. Rate    : 100 kbps           E. Rate    : 200 kbps
Adj I. Rate: N/A                Adj E. Rate: 200 kbps
Act I. Rate: N/A                Act E. Rate: 182 kbps
Service Id : 1 (VPRN)
Group      : Alu
Neighbor   : 100.100.100.1:49063
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-C# 

Other applicable show command output:

A:active# show service id 333 sap 1/1/3 detail 
===============================================================================
Service Access Points(SAP)
===============================================================================
Service Id         : 333
SAP                : 1/1/3                    Encap             : null
...
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ANCP Override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ing Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 100 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-1"
Egr Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 100 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
...
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
 
A:active# show service customer 1 site mss1
===============================================================================
Customer  1
===============================================================================
Customer-ID        : 1
Description        : Default customer
...
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ANCP Override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egr Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 90 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-3"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service Association
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Service Association Found.
===============================================================================
A:active#

radius-proxy-server

Syntax 
radius-proxy-server server-name
radius-proxy-server server-name cache
radius-proxy-server server-name cache hex-key hex-string
radius-proxy-server server-name cache string-key string
radius-proxy-serverserver-name cache summary
radius-proxy-server server-name statistics
radius-proxy-server
Context 
show>router
Description 

This command displays RADIUS proxy server information.

Parameters 
server-name—
Specifies the default RADIUS proxy server name created in the config>router>radius-proxy context
cache—
Displays cached information
hex-string
Displays the hex key string
Values—
[0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (max 64 hex nibbles)]

 

string
Displays the packet type of the RADIUS messages to use to generate the key for the cache of this RADIUS proxy server
summary—
Displays summarized information
statistics—
Displays statistics for the specified RADIUS proxy server
Output 
Table 100:  Subscriber RADIUS Proxy Server Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Invalid response Authenticator Rx packet

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx Access-Request

Displays the number of Access-Request packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx Accounting-Request

Displays the number of Accounting-Request packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx dropped

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server but dropped.

Retransmit

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they are retransmitted.

Wrong purpose

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the value of tmnxRadProxSrvPurpose is set to a value not matching the type of packet.

No UE MAC to cache

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the UE MAC address was not present in the packet.

Client context limit reached

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the limit of client contexts was reached. For each RADIUS transaction a client context is created, and will be deleted once the transaction is finished.

No ISA RADIUS policy configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it has no ISA RADIUS server policy configured for that type of packet.

Server admin down

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it is administratively shut down.

No RADIUS policy configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it has no RADIUS server policy configured for that type of packet.

No load-balance-key configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the selected RADIUS server policy's algorithm is set to hashBased and no load balance key is configured.

Invalid length

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because their length was invalid.

Invalid Code field

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they had an invalid Code field.

Invalid attribute encoding

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because one of the attributes was incorrectly encoded.

Invalid User-Name

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid User-Name attribute.

Invalid password

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the User-Password attribute could not be decoded.

Invalid accounting Authenticator

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Authenticator field.

Invalid Message-Authenticator

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Message-Authenticator attribute.

Management core overload

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because the ISA management core is not able to process any new RADIUS requests because of overload.

No memory

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because there was not enough memory to store them.

Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Acct-Status-Type attribute.

Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained no Acct-Status-Type attribute.

Registered user overload

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because the registered user indicated to be in overload.

Dropped by Python

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server but dropped by Python.

Tx Access-Accept

Displays the number of Access-Accept packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Access-Reject

Displays the number of Access-Reject packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Access-Challenge

Displays the number of Access-Challenge packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Accounting-Response

Displays the number of Accounting-Response packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx dropped

Displays the number of packets dropped by this RADIUS proxy server before transmission.

No key to cache

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the key information was not present in the packet.

Cache key too long

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the key information present in the packet was too long.

Cache attributes too long

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the total length of the attributes is too long.

Reached maximum number of cache entries

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the limit has been reached.

No memory

Displays the number of packets that could not be transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server because there was not enough memory.

Server timeout

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS servers have timed out.

Server authentication failure

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet which failed authentication (invalid response Authenticator or Message Authenticator attribute).

Server invalid Code

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet with an invalid Code field.

Invalid attribute encoding

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet with an invalid attribute.

Registered user overload

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the registered user indicated to be in overload.

No RADIUS server configured

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the RADIUS server policy has no servers configured.

RADIUS server send failure

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the packet could not get transmitted to one of the servers in the RADIUS server policy.

Dropped by Python

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the packet was dropped by the Python script.

Invalid response Authenticator

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet which failed authentication

Sample Output
 
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show router radius-proxy-server "ZiggoRadiusProxyAnyCast" statistics
===============================================================================
RADIUS Proxy server statistics for "ZiggoRadiusProxyAnyCast"
===============================================================================
Rx packet                                                : 28454097
Rx Access-Request                                        : 24846521
Rx Accounting-Request                                    : 3607576
Rx dropped                                               : 22986
  Retransmit                                             : 22986
  Server admin down                                      : 0
  No RADIUS policy configured                            : 0
  No load-balance-key configured                         : 0
  Invalid length                                         : 0
  Invalid Code field                                     : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Invalid User-Name                                      : 0
  Invalid password                                       : 0
  Invalid accounting Authenticator                       : 0
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 0
  No memory                                              : 0
  Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type       : 0
  Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type            : 0
  Registered user overload                               : 0
  Dropped by Python                                      : 0
 
Tx Access-Accept                                         : 1929725
Tx Access-Reject                                         : 302354
Tx Access-Challenge                                      : 22598950
Tx Accounting-Response                                   : 3598730
Tx dropped                                               : 1351
  No key to cache                                        : 0
  Cache key too long                                     : 0
  Cache attributes too long                              : 0
  Reached maximum number of cache entries                : 0
  No memory                                              : 0
  Server timeout                                         : 1351
  Server authentication failure                          : 0
  Server invalid Code                                    : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Registered user overload                               : 0
  No RADIUS server configured                            : 0
  RADIUS server send failure                             : 0
  Dropped by Python                                      : 0
===============================================================================
 
 
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show router radius-proxy-server "ZiggoRadiusDRPProxyanyCast-LEG" statistics 
===============================================================================
ISA RADIUS Proxy server statistics for "ZiggoRadiusDRPProxyanyCast-LEG"
===============================================================================
Group 1 member 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Rx packet                                                : 72250262
Rx Access-Request                                        : 61457394
Rx Accounting-Request                                    : 10792868
Rx dropped                                               : 1525690
  Retransmit                                             : 28470
  Wrong purpose                                          : 0
  No UE MAC to cache                                     : 1497212
  Client context limit reached                           : 0
  No ISA RADIUS policy configured                        : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Invalid password                                       : 0
  Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type       : 0
  Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type            : 0
  Invalid accounting Authenticator                       : 0
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 8
  Management core overload                               : 0
 
Tx Access-Accept                                         : 5830313
Tx Access-Reject                                         : 743060
Tx Access-Challenge                                      : 54844862
Tx Accounting-Response                                   : 9294168
Tx dropped                                               : 12226
  Server timeout                                         : 12169
  Invalid response Authenticator                         : 57
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  RADIUS server send failure                             : 0
 

wpp

Syntax 
wpp
wpp [portal wpp-portal-name] [host ip-address] hosts
wpp portal wpp-portal-name
wpp statistics
Context 
show>router
Description 

This command displays WPP port-related information in the specified routing instance.

Parameters 
wpp-portal-name
Specifies the name of this WPP portal
ip-address
Specifies the host IP address
hosts—
Displays the hosts enabled on the portal
Output 

The following output is an example of router WPP information.

Sample Output
show router wpp
===============================================================================
WPP portals
===============================================================================
Portal                           Address         Controlled-Rtr      Num-Itf
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
svr1                             1.1.1.1         0                   0
svr2                             2.2.2.2         0                   0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of portals: 2
===============================================================================
 
 
show router wpp portal "svr1" 
===============================================================================
WPP Portal "svr1"
===============================================================================
Address                               : 1.1.1.1
Controlled router                     : 0
Number of enabled interfaces          : 0
Triggered hosts                       : disabled
Last management change                : 01/27/2014 00:48:45
===============================================================================
 
 

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays IPoE information.

session

Syntax 
session [sap sap-id] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [interface ip-int-name | ip-address] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [no-inter-dest-id] [ip-address ip-prefix[/prefix-length]] [port port-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sap-session-id sap-session-index] [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
Context 
show>service>id>ipoe
Description 

This command displays the identified IPoE session details active on the specified service instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length.
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length.
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface up to 32 characters in length.
ip-address[/prefix-length]—
Specifies information for the specified IP address and mask.
no-inter-dest-id—
Displays the information about no intermediate destination ID.
port-id
Displays information about the specified port ID.
sap-session-index—
Displays sap-session-index information.
service-id
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

 

intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length.
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile.
detail—
Displays all IPoE session details.
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the router advertisement policy, up to 32 characters in length.
Output 

The following output is an example of service IPoE session information.

Sample Output
# show service id 4000 ipoe session
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for svc-id 4000
===============================================================================
Sap Id                           Mac Address         Up Time         MC-Stdby
    Subscriber-Id
        [CircuitID] | [RemoteID]
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4:1201.27                    00:51:00:00:00:0c   0d 00:00:18
    ipoe-session-001
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
CID | RID displayed when included in session-key
Number of sessions : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
# show service id 4000 ipoe session detail
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for service 4000
===============================================================================
SAP                     : 1/1/4:1201.27
Mac Address             : 00:51:00:00:00:0c
Circuit-Id              : circuit-id-1
Remote-Id               : remote-id-1
Session Key             : sap-mac
 
MC-Standby              : No
 
Subscriber-interface    : sub-int-1
Group-interface         : group-int-1
 
Up Time                 : 0d 00:01:01
Session Time Left       : N/A
Last Auth Time          : 02/28/2015 01:01:09
Min Auth Intvl (left)   : 0d 00:05:00 (0d 00:03:59)
Persistence Key         : N/A
 
Subscriber              : "ipoe-session-001"
Sub-Profile-String      : "sub-profile-1"
SLA-Profile-String      : "sla-profile-1"
ANCP-String             : ""
Int-Dest-Id             : ""
App-Profile-String      : ""
Category-Map-Name       : ""
Acct-Session-Id         : "144DFF0000001354D806D5"
Sap-Session-Index       : 1
 
IP Address              : 10.10.1.201/24
IP Origin               : Radius
Primary DNS             : N/A
Secondary DNS           : N/A
Primary NBNS            : N/A
Secondary NBNS          : N/A
Address-Pool            : N/A
 
IPv6 Prefix             : 2001:db8:a:111::/64
IPv6 Prefix Origin      : Radius
IPv6 Prefix Pool        : ""
IPv6 Del.Pfx.           : 2001:db8:a001:a100::/56
IPv6 Del.Pfx. Origin    : Radius
IPv6 Del.Pfx. Pool      : ""
IPv6 Address            : 2001:db8:a:101::aaa:1
IPv6 Address Origin     : Radius
IPv6 Address Pool       : ""
Primary IPv6 DNS        : N/A
Secondary IPv6 DNS      : N/A
 
Radius Session-TO       : N/A
Radius Class            :
Radius User-Name        : 00:51:00:00:00:0c
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of sessions : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-A# show service id 13 ipoe session router-advertisement-policy ra-policy-01
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for svc-id 13
===============================================================================
Sap Id                           Mac Address         Up Time         MC-Stdby
    Subscriber-Id                                                    
        [CircuitID] | [RemoteID]                                     
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:13   0d 00:13:06     
    Belgacom
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:14   0d 00:08:03     
    Belgacom
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:15   0d 00:06:23     
    Belgacom
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
CID | RID displayed when included in session-key
Number of sessions : 3
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# 

summary

Syntax 
summary
Context 
show>service>id>ipoe
Description 

This command displays a summary of IPoE information.

managed-hosts

Syntax 
managed-hosts type {aaa | data-triggered} [ip ip-address] [mac ieee-address]
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays information about hosts that are not yet linked to an in-band control plane protocol, such as DHCP or DHCPv6. Examples include hosts installed by data-triggers and hosts installed by RADIUS.

Parameters 
aaa—
Displays information about managed hosts installed and removed only by RADIUS
data-triggered—
Displays information about managed hosts installed by data-triggers
ip-address—
Displays information about a managed host with the specified IPv4 or IPv6 address
ieee-address—
Displays information about a managed host with the specified MAC address
Output 

The following output is an example of managed host information.

Sample Output
# show service id 100 managed-hosts type data-triggered
===============================================================================
Managed data-triggered hosts
===============================================================================
IP address                                MAC address
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10.0.0.9/32                               fa:ac:a6:02:11:01
2001:a:b:5::1/128                         fa:ac:a6:02:11:01
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Managed hosts: 2
===============================================================================

slaac

Syntax 
slaac
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays SLAAC information.

host

Syntax 
host [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host interface interface-name [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host mac ieee-address [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host ipv6-address ipv6-prefix [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host sap sap-id [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
Context 
show>service>id>slaac
Description 

This command displays SLAAC host related information.

Parameters 
detail—
Specifies to display detailed SLAAC host related information.
service-id—
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler.
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

session—
Specifies to display information about SLAAC hosts that are associated with an IPoE session or a PPP session.
Values—
none, ipoe, ppp

 

interface-name—
Specifies the interface name, up to a maximum of 32 characters.
ieee-address—
Specifies the MAC address for which to display SLAAC host information.
ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address for which to display SLACC host information.
sap-id—
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the router advertisement policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of detailed SLAAC host information.

Sample Output
*A:eng-BNG-2# show service id 1000 slaac host detail
===============================================================================
SLAAC hosts for service 1000
===============================================================================
Service ID           : 1000
Prefix               : 2001:1000:bad:beef::/64
Interface Id         : N/A
Mac Address          : 00:00:10:10:12:12
Subscriber-interface : sub-int-01
Group-interface      : grp-int-01
SAP                  : 1/1/20:841
Termination Type     : local
Creation Time        : 2017/02/13 22:05:03
Persistence Key      : N/A
Router adv. policy   : ra-policy-01
IPoE|PPP session     : No
Radius sub-if prefix : N/A
IPoE Trigger         : rtr-solicit
Last Auth Time       : 2017/02/13 22:05:03
Inactivity Timer     : N/A
Sub-Ident            : "host-1"
Sub-Profile-String   : "no-prof"
SLA-Profile-String   : "no-prof"
App-Profile-String   : ""
ANCP-String          : ""
Int Dest Id          : ""
Category-Map-Name    : ""
Info origin          : radius
Pool                 : ""
Primary-Dns          : N/A
Secondary-Dns        : N/A
Circuit Id           : N/A
Remote Id            : N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of hosts : 1
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# show service id 13 slaac host router-advertisement-policy ra-policy-01
===============================================================================
SLAAC hosts for service 13
===============================================================================
Prefix                      Mac Address          Sap Id                MC-Stdby
  IntId                                                                
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2013:bad:beef:1::/64        00:00:00:00:00:13    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
2013:bad:beef:2::/64        00:00:00:00:00:14    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
2013:bad:beef:3::/64        00:00:00:00:00:15    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of hosts : 3
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# 

summary

Syntax 
summary
Context 
show>service>id>slaac
Description 

This command displays a summary of all SLAAC hosts.

call-trace

Syntax 
call-trace
Context 
show
Description 

This command enters the context to display information related to the call-trace module.

files

Syntax 
files [running | finished] [detail]
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command gives an overview of all the files in use by the call-trace module, either for running or finished jobs.

Parameters 
running—
Displays the active jobs that are tracing events triggered by the host being monitored
finished—
Displays the jobs that have already finished and not tracing events generated by the host anymore
detail—
Displays detailed information about the files
Output 

The following output displays call trace local log files information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace files
===============================================================================
Call trace files of running jobs
===============================================================================
File path                                                             File size
                                                                        (bytes)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
cf1-A:/calltrace/running/mac_00-02-00-00-00-19_160119_1557.pcap            1575
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace files of running jobs: 1
===============================================================================
===============================================================================
Call trace files of finished jobs
===============================================================================
File path                                                             File size
                                                                        (bytes)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace files of finished jobs: 0
===============================================================================

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command enters the context to display IP over Ethernet (IPoE) call trace information.

session

Syntax 
session [name trace-name] [detail]
session sap sap mac mac [{circuit-id circuit-id | remote-id remote-id}] [detail]
Context 
show>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command displays call trace information for the active IPoE session.

Configuring this command with a specific IPoE session key will display information for the specified trace job only.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that identifies an IPoE session.
detail—
Displays detailed information.
mac—
Specifies a MAC address that identifies an IPoE session.
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that identifies an IPoE session
trace-name—
Specifies the name of the trace that triggered the job.
sap—
Specifies a SAP that identifies an IPoE session.
Output 

The following output displays call trace information for the active IPoE session.

Sample Output
Node # show call-trace ipoe session
=========================================================
Call trace IPoE session
=========================================================
IEEE address Status No. of messages
Trace name
---------------------------------------------------------
00:02:00:00:00:19 running 10
default
---------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace IPoE debug jobs: 1
=========================================================
 
 
Node# show call-trace ipoe session detail
===============================================================================
Call trace IPoE session
===============================================================================
SAP ID : 4/1/ 2
IEEE address: 00:02:00:00:00:19
Trace name : default Status : running
Size limit : 10 MB Time limit : 86400 sec
Live output
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Destination : none
Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Started : 2017/01/11 15:34:08UTC
No. of captured msgs : 10
Size of captured msgs : 2575 B
===============================================================================

trace

Syntax 
trace [name trace-name]
Context 
show>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command displays information about all traces and associated parameters that are currently enabled on the system. Including the trace-name parameter will limit the output to the specified trace only.

Parameters 
trace-name—
Specifies the name of the trace to be displayed.
Output 

The following output displays call trace information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace ipoe trace
===============================================================================
Call trace trace
===============================================================================
Trace name : default Type : ipoe
SAP ID :
IEEE address: 00:02:00:00:00:19
Maximum jobs: 1
===============================================================================

status

Syntax 
status
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command gives a router-wide overview of call-trace operational data, such as number of configured profile, number of jobs and status of the compact flash.

Output 

The following output displays call trace status information.

Sample Output
===============================================================================
Call trace status
===============================================================================
No. of trace profiles: 1
No. of trace jobs    : 0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Primary CF           : CF1              Max files number     : 200
CF1 state            : enabled          CF1 volume limit     : 1000 MB
CF2 state            : enabled          CF2 volume limit     : 1000 MB

trace-profile

Syntax 
trace-profile [detail]
trace-profile profile-name
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command provides an overview of all configured profiles or details of a specific profile. If the detail option is specified the full information for all configured profiles will be displayed.

Parameters 
detail—
Displays detailed trace profile information.
Output 

The following output displays call-trace trace-profile information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace trace-profile "default" 
===============================================================================
Call-trace  trace profile
===============================================================================
Profile name              : default
Description                : none
Live output                : none
Format                       : pcap
Size limit                   : 10 MB
Time limit                  : 86400 secs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of profiles : 1
===============================================================================
 

9.25.2.2.16.1. Clear Commands

session

Syntax 
session sap sap mac mac [{circuit-id circuit-id | remote-id remote-id}]
Context 
clear>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command clears the trace job identified by this session.

The sap, mac, circuit-id, and remote-id parameters cannot use wildcard characters, and must match the IPoE session key. This command does not affect any of the debug trace commands, and new jobs can still be executed for other IPoE sessions.

After a session is cleared, tracing for the session will not be restarted by any configured trace. Only explicitly starting a new trace with the trace-existing-sessions parameter can restart tracing for the session.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that identifies an IPoE session.
mac—
Specifies a MAC address that identifies an IPoE session.
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that identifies an IPoE session
sap—
Specifies a SAP that identifies an IPoE session.

trace

Syntax 
trace trace-name
Context 
clear>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command clears all trace jobs started by the specified trace. This command does not affect the trace command itself, and new jobs can still be executed for other IPoE sessions.

After a session is cleared, tracing for the session will not be restarted by any configured trace. Only explicitly starting a new trace with the trace-existing-sessions parameter can restart tracing for the session.

Parameters 
trace-name—
Specifies the configured name of the trace.

accu-stats

Syntax 
accu-stats active-subs no-accu-stats-policy
accu-stats active-subs sub-profile profile-name
accu-stats inactive-subs
accu-stats subscriber subscriber-id
Context 
clear>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command removes the accumulated statistics for a subscriber.

Parameters 
active-subs no accu-stats-policy—
Removes the accumulated statistics that are no longer associated with an accu-stats-policy. These are active subscribers that are referencing a subscriber profile that removed an accu-stats-policy.
active-subs sub-profile profile-name
Removes the accumulated statistics for the specified subscriber profile.
inactive-subs—
Removes the accumulated statistics from all inactive subscribers.
profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile, to a maximum of 32 characters.
subscriber-id—
Specifies the subscriber, to a maximum of 32 characters.

ancp-sub-string

Syntax 
ancp-sub-string string
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp
Description 

This command clears subscriber ANCP data.

Parameters 
string—
Clears the ANCP string corresponding to this subscriber ID

arp

Syntax 
arp {all | ip-address}
arp interface [ip-int-name | ip-address]
Context 
clear>router
Description 

This command clears all or specific ARP entries.

The scope of ARP cache entries cleared depends on the command line option(s) specified.

Parameters 
all—
Clears all ARP cache entries
ip-addr—
Clears the ARP cache entry for the specified IP address
ip-int-name
Clears all ARP cache entries for the interface with the specified name
ip-addr
Clears all ARP cache entries for the specified interface with the specified address

authentication

Syntax 
authentication [policy-name]
authentication coa-statistics
Context 
clear
Description 

This command clears subscriber authentication data.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Clears the specifies existing authentication policy name
coa-statistics—
Clears statistics for incoming RADIUS Change of Authorization requests

diameter-session

Syntax 
diameter-session
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command clears diameter session data.

ccrt-replay

Syntax 
ccrt-replay diameter-application-policy name
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt>diam-session
Description 

This command clears diameter Gx sessions that are in CCR Terminate replay mode.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be deleted

errors

Syntax 
errors
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command clears all errors in the circular buffer.

idle-only-msap

Syntax 
idle-only-msap msap-policy-name
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command removes all idle MSAPs associated with the MSAP policy.This command only removes idle MSAPs without active subscribers. This command is considered safer than the clear>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy msap-policy-name idle-only command because in that command, the parameter idle-only is optional. Not specifying idle-only will delete MSAPs with active subscribers.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Specifies the MSAP policy for which all associated idle MSAPs will be cleared

msap-policy

Syntax 
msap-policy msap-policy-name [idle-only]
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command deletes Managed SAPs (MSAPs) created by the MSAP policy.

This command can remove an MSAP with active subscribers still associated with the MSAP. Use the idle-only parameter to remove only MSAPs in an idle state.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Specifies an existing managed SAP policy name. A string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
idle-only—
Specifies to remove only the MSAPs in an idle state

peakvalue-stats

Syntax 
peakvalue-stats iom (slot | all) [recursive]
peakvalue-stats mda (mda | all) [recursive]
peakvalue-stats port (port-id | all)
peakvalue-stats pw-port (pw-port | all)
peakvalue-stats system [recursive]
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the most recent peak counter.

Note:

Clearing one counter will not impact other counters. For example, clearing one IOM’s most recent peak value will not impact chassis peak value.

Parameters 
slot
Clears IOM host peak value statistics for the specified IOM
mda
Clears MDA host peak value statistics for the specified MDA
port-id
Clears port host peak value statistics for the specified port ID
pw-port
Clears pseudowire port host peak value statistics for the specified port
Values—
1 to 10239

 

system —
Clears system host peak value statistics
all—
Clears all host peak value statistics
recursive—
Resets the sub-level counters. For example, clearing IOM counters with the recursive keyword will also clear counters of all ports counters on that IOM

radius-accounting

Syntax 
radius-accounting [policy-name]
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command clears RADIUS accounting data for the specified policy.

Parameters 
policy-name—
The name of the policy. The string is case sensitive and limited to 32 ASCII 7-bit printable characters with no spaces.

statistics

Syntax 
statistics sub-profile {sub-profile-name | all}
statistics sla-profile {sla-profile-name | all}
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command clears the current and historical statistics.

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Clears the statistics for a specific subscriber profile, limited to 32 characters.
sub-profile all—
Clears all subscriber profile statistics.
sla-profile-name—
Clears the statistics for a specific SLA profile, limited to 32 characters.
sla-profile all—
Clears all SLA profile statistics.

scheduler-stats

Syntax 
scheduler-stats
Context 
clear>qos
Description 

This command clears scheduler statistics.

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears scheduler stats per subscriber.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string—
Clears information for the subscriber profile name
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler-name
egress—
Clears egress information for the subscriber
ingress
Clears ingress information for the subscriber

sla-profile

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Clears information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Clears information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Clears information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler-name

srrp

Syntax 
srrp
Context 
clear>router
Description 

This command enters the context to clear and reset SRRP virtual router instances.

interface

Syntax 
interface subscriber-interface [id srrp-id]
Context 
clear>router>srrp
Description 

This command clears and resets SRRP interface instances.

Parameters 
subscriber-interface—
Specifies an existing subscriber interface name up to 32 characters in length
srrp-id
Specifies an existing SRRP ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

statistics

Syntax 
statistics interface subscriber-interface [id srrp-id]
Context 
clear>router>srrp
Description 

This command clears statistics for SRRP instances.

Parameters 
subscriber-interface—
Specifies an existing subscriber interface name up to 32 characters in length
srrp-id
Specifies an existing SRRP ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

route-downloader

Syntax 
route-downloader name [vprn vprn] [family family]
Context 
clear>aaa
Description 

This command clears all the radius-downloaded routes from the internal downloader cache (or protocol RIB/db) (and thus eventually from the RTM itself). The parameters vprn and/or family allow to restrict the deletion of those routes learned in a particular address family (IPv4 or IPv6) and/or a particular VPRN.

By default, all VPRNs and both IPv4 and IPv6 families are affected.

Note:

A clear of the internal protocol DB means the corresponding prefix that were deleted should be removed from the RTM (and from any other exports) as well.

Parameters 
vprn
Specifies to limit the removal of prefixes to only the specific VPRN. The parameter can be either the service-id or service-name that identifies a VPRN
family
Specifies to limit he removal or prefixes only belonging to the address family IPv4 or IPv6. Only these two values will be accepted.
Values—
ipv4, ipv6

 

vport

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears the Vport scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port-id
Clears information for the specified port
name
Clears information for the specified Vport
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler name

ipoe session

Syntax 
ipoe session [sap sap-id] [interface ip-int-name | ip-address] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [no-inter-dest-id] [ip-address ip-prefix[/prefix-length]] [port port-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sap-session-id sap-session-index]
ipoe session all
Context 
clear>service>id
Description 

This commands clears all identified IPoE sessions for the specified service instance. All associated subscriber hosts will be deleted from the system.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface up to 32 characters in length
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
ip-address[/prefix-length]—
Specifies information for the specified IP address and mask
no-inter-dest-id—
Displays the information about no intermediate destination ID
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
port-id
Displays information about the specified port ID
sap-session-index—
Displays sap-session-index information
service-id
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
service-id
Specifies information for the specified service ID
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

detail—
Displays all IPoE session details
all—
clears all active IPoE sessions for the specified service instance.

9.25.2.3.16.1. Tools Commands

tools

Syntax 
tools
Context 
root
Description 

The context to enable useful tools for debugging purposes.

Default 

none

Parameters 
dump—
Enables dump tools for the various protocols
perform—
Enables tools to perform specific tasks

avp-match-learned-session-id

Syntax 
avp-match-learned-session-id
Context 
tools>dump>debug>diameter
Description 

This command displays the diameter session IDs that are learned by the AVP value matching in a diameter debug.

Per avp-match id in a diameter peer policy, a single diameter session ID can be learned. "N/A" means no session ID is learned.

Output 

The following is a sample output for the avp-match-learned-session-id command.

Sample output
# tools dump debug diameter avp-match-learned-session-id
===============================================================================
Learned Session-Id
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy             ID Session-Id
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
diameter-peer-policy-1           1  bng.domain.com;1452197100;13
diameter-peer-policy-1           2  N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of AVP matches: 2
===============================================================================

perform

Syntax 
perform
Context 
tools
Description 

This command enters the context to enable tools to perform specific tasks.

Default 

none

credit-reset

Syntax 
credit-reset sap sap-id subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset sap sap-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset svc service-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the credit for an SLA-profile instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-address
Resets the credit for the specified IP address
sub-ident-string
Resets the credit for the specified subscriber identification.
sub-profile-string
Resets the credit for the specified subscriber profile
sla-profile-string
Resets the credit for the specified SLA profile
service-id
Resets the credit for the specified service ID
Values—
service-id: 1 2147483647 svc-name: up to 64 characters maximum.

 

persistence

Syntax 
persistence
Context 
tools>perform
Description 

This command enters the context to configure downgrade parameters.

downgrade

Syntax 
downgrade target-version target [reboot]
Context 
tools>perform>persistence
Description 

This command downgrades persistence files to a previous version.

Parameters 
target
Specifies the downgrade version
reboot—
Specifies to reboot the system after a successful conversion

eval-msap

Syntax 
eval-msap {policy msap-policy-name | msap sap-id}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command re-applies the managed SAP policy to the managed SAP identified by the specified sap-id or to all managed SAPs associated with the specified msap-policy name.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name
Specifies an existing MSAP policy. The MSAP policy will be re-applied to all associated managed SAPs
sap-id
Specifies an MSAP sap-id. The MSAP policy will be re-applied to the specified MSAP
Values—
[port-id | lag-id]:qtag1
[port-id | lag-id]:qtag1.qtag2

 

eval-lease-state

Syntax 
eval-lease-state [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [ip ip-address] [mac mac-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates lease state.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ip-address—
Specifies the a server’s IP address. This address must be unique within the subnet and specified in dotted decimal notation. Allowed values are IP addresses in the range 1.0.0.0 – 223.255.255.255 (with support of /31 subnets).
sub-ident-string—
Specifies the subscriber ID string, up to 32 characters in length
service-id—
Specifies an existing service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

subscriber-mgmt

Syntax 
subscriber-mgmt
Context 
tools>perform
Description 

This command enters the context to configure tools to control subscriber management.

edit-lease-state

Syntax 
edit-lease-state sap sap-id ip ip-address [mac ieee-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string [app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
edit-lease-state svc-id service-id ip ip-address [mac ieee-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string [app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command provides the parameters to edit lease state information.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ip-address
Modifies lease state information for the specified IP address.
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
sub-ident-string
Modifies the lease state information for the specified subscriber identification.
sub-profile-string
Modifies lease state information for the specified subscriber profile.
sla-profile-string
Modifies lease state information for the specified SLA profile.
service-id
Modifies lease state information for the specified service ID.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

coa

Syntax 
coa [nas-port-id attr-string] [framed-ip-addr ip-address] [alc-ipv6-addr ipv6-address] [delegated-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]] [framed-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix [/ipv6-prefix-length]] [alc-serv-id serv-id] [acct-session-id attr-string] [alc-subscr-id attr-string] [alc-brg-id attr-string] [alc-client-hw-addr mac-address] [attr attribute [attribute...(up to 5 max)]] [attr-from-file file-url] [from-server attr-string] [router-or-service attr-string] [debug]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command triggers a Change of Authorization (CoA) on the 7750 SR, 7450 ESS, and 7950 XRS without a RADIUS authentication policy.

This command can be used to spoof a CoA from a configured server for purposes such as testing CoA python scripts. However, spoofing a CoA from a RADIUS server requires the configuration of a RADIUS authentication policy.

Parameters 
nas-port-id attr-string
Specifies the physical access circuit of the NAS with a maximum of 253 characters.
framed-ip-addr ip-address
Specifies the IPv4 host address.
Values—

ipv4-address:

a,b,c,d

 

alc-ipv6-addr ipv6-address
Specifies the IPv6 host address.
Values—

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

 

delegated-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]
Specifies the IPv6 PD host prefix.
Values—

ipv6-prefix:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix-length

[0..128]

 

framed-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]
Specifies the IPv6 SLAAC host prefix.
Values—

ipv6-prefix:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix-length

[0..128]

 

serv-id
Specifies the service ID of the LNS subscriber.
Values—
0 to 4294967295

 

acct-session-id attr-string
Specifies the subscriber accounting session ID to a maximum of 22 characters in length.
alc-subscr-id attr-string
Specifies the subscriber ID to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
alc-brg-id attr-string
Specifies the BRG ID to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
mac-address
Specifies the subscriber host MAC address. in the form xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx.
attribute
Specifies the attributes (RADIUS VSAs) for override. The VSA must be specified in number format. For example, VSA Alc-Subsc-Prof-Str=”1M-prof” is expressed as 6527.12 =“1M-prof”. Up to five attributes can be specified within this command.

For more information on VSAs, refer to the RADIUS Attributes Reference Guide.

Values—

<type>=<value>

<type>:<tag>=<value>

<vendor>,<type>=<value>

e, <type>,<exttyp>=<value> (type=[241|242|243|244])

le,<type>,<exttyp>=<value> (type=[245|246])

evs,<type>,<vendor>,<vendor-type>=<value>

levs,<type>,<vendor>,<vendor-type>=<value>

 

file-url
Specifies the file URL where the VSAs are located.
Values—

local-url

[cflash-id/] [file-path] (200 characters maximum including cflash-id directory length of 99 characters maximum each)

remote-url

[{ftp://|tftp://}login:pswd@remote-locn/][file-path] (255 characters maximum with directory length 99 characters maximum each)

remote-locn

[hostname | ipv4-address | ipv6-address]

ipv4-address:

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x [-interface]

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d[-interface]

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

interface - Specifies the link local addresses, up to 32 characters maximum.

cflash-id

cf1: | cf1-A: | cf1-B: | cf2 :| cf2-A: | cf2-B: | cf3: | cf3-A: | cf3-B:

 

from-server attr-string
Specifies the RADIUS server name that is configured under the router or VPRN service context, to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
router-or-service attr-string
Specifies the router or VPRN service instance where the RADIUS server is configured, to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
debug —
Displays the debug message associated with the CoA command.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management CoA tools information.

Sample Output
Node# tools perform subscriber-mgmt coa alc-subscr-id subscriber-01 attr 6527,13=new-sla-prof debug
===============================================================================
Inject Change-of-Authorization
===============================================================================
SUCCESS: got ACK
  Change of Authorization(43) id 0 len 50 from 0.0.0.0:3799 vrid 1
    VSA [26] 8 Alcatel(6527)
      SUBSC ID STR [11] 6 subscriber-01
    VSA [26] 10 Alcatel(6527)
      SLA PROF STR [13] 8 new-sla-prof
  Hex Packet Dump:
  1a 0e 00 00 19 7f 0b 08 77 69 66 69 2d 31 1a 10 00 00 19 7f 0d 0a 73 6c 61
  2d 70 72 6f 66
  Change of Authorization Ack(44) 0.0.0.0:3799 id 0 len 20 vrid 1
  Hex Packet Dump:

credit-reset

Syntax 
credit-reset sap sap-id subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset sap sap-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset svc service-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the credit for an SLA-profile instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-address
Specifies lease state information for the specified IP address
sub-ident-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified subscriber identification
sub-profile-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified subscriber profile
sla-profile-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified SLA profile
service-id
Specifies lease state information for the specified service ID
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

edit-ppp-session

Syntax 
edit-ppp-session sap sap-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
edit-ppp-session svc-id service-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the PPP session identified with the given MAC address and SAP identifier. Optionally the remote-id and circuit-id can be specified to identify the IPoE session to update.

Note:

The changes take immediate effect.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
sla-profile-string—
Identifies the SLA profile string up to 16 characters in length
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sub-profile-string—
Specifies the subscriber profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
ancp-string—
Specifies the ASCII representation of the up to 63 characters in length
app-profile-string—
Specifies the application profile string up to 16 characters in length

edit-slaac-host

Syntax 
edit-slaac-host sap sap-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
edit-slaac-host svc-id service-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the SLAAC host information.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
sla-profile-string—
Identifies the SLA profile string up to 16 characters in length
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sub-profile-string—
Specifies the subscriber profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
ancp-string—
Specifies the ASCII representation of the up to 63 characters in length
app-profile-string—
Specifies the application profile string up to 16 characters in length

edit-ipoe-session

Syntax 
edit-ipoe-session sap sap-id mac mac-address [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the IPoE session identified with the given MAC address and SAP identifier. Optionally the remote ID and circuit ID can be specified to identify the IPoE session to update.

Note:

The changes take immediate effect.

eval-ipoe-session

Syntax 
eval-ipoe-session [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [mac mac-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command re-evaluates the mapping between authentication strings such as the SLA profile string and the actual profiles for the identified IPoE sessions.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile

eval-ppp-session

Syntax 
eval-ppp-session [svc-id service-id] [user-name user-name] [sap sap-id] [ip ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
eval-ppp-session [svc-id service-id] [user-name user-name] [sap sap-id] mac mac-address [session-id session-id] [ip ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates PPP sessions.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
mac-address—
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

eval-slaac-host

Syntax 
eval-slaac-host [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [ipv6-address ipv6-prefix] [mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates the SLAAC host.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
ipv6-prefix—
Specifies an IPv6 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

 

remap-lease-state

Syntax 
remap-lease-state old-mac ieee-address mac ieee-address
remap-lease-state sap sap-id [mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command allows the remapping of all existing hosts if network card on CMTS/WAC side is changed is required.

When this command is executed, the following restrictions apply:

  1. When sap is taken, all leases associated with the SAP are re-written.
    1. For a SAP with a configured MAC in lease-populate command, this MAC will be taken.
    2. For a SAP without a configured MAC the MAC from tools command will be taken.
    3. For a SAP without a configured MAC and no MAC in tools command no action will be perform.
  2. When using the old-mac option, providing a new MAC ieee-address is mandatory.

This command is applicable only when dealing with DHCP lease states which were instantiated using l2header mode of DHCP operation.

Parameters 
old-mac ieee-address
Specifies the old MAC address to remap
mac ieee-address
Specifies that the provisioned MAC address will be used in the anti-spoofing entries for this SAP when l2-header is enabled. The parameter may be changed mid-session. Existing sessions will not be re-programmed unless a tools perform command is issued for the lease.
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.

When configured, the SAP parameter will remap all MAC addresses of DHCP lease states on the specified SAP. When no optional MAC parameter is specified, the sap sap-id command remaps all MAC addresses of lease states towards the MAC address specified in the l2-header configuration.

re-ident-sub

Syntax 
re-ident-sub old-sub-ident-string to new-sub-ident-string
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command renames a subscriber identification string.

Parameters 
old-sub-ident-string—
Specifies the existing subscriber identification string to be renamed
new-sub-ident-string—
Specifies the new subscriber identification string name

redundancy

Syntax 
redundancy
Context 
tools>dump
Description 

This command enters the context to dump redundancy parameters.

multi-chassis

Syntax 
multi-chassis
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy
Description 

This command enters the context to dump multi-chassis parameters.

mc-endpoint

Syntax 
mc-endpoint peer ip-address
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis endpoint information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address

force-switchover

Syntax 
force-switchover tunnel-group local-group-id
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command manually switches over mc-ipsec mastership of the specified tunnel-group.

Parameters 
local-group-id—
Specifies the local tunnel-group ID configured under the config>redundancy.multichassis>peer>mc-ipsec context

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
mc-ring peer ip-address [ring sync-tag]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
sync-tag
Specifies the ring’s sync-tag created in the config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring context

srrp-sync-database

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps SRRP database information and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
instance instance-id
Dumps information for the specified Subscriber Router Redundancy Protocol instance configured on this system.
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps MCS database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
port-id | lag-id
Indicates the port or LAG ID to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
slot/mda/port or lag-lag-id

 

sync-tag
Specifies a synchronization tag to be used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application
Specifies a particular multi-chassis peer synchronization protocol application
Values—

dhcp-server:

local dhcp server (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

igmp:

Internet group management protocol

igmp-snooping:

igmp-snooping

mc-ring:

multi-chassis ring

mld-snooping:

multicast listener discovery-snooping

srrp:

simple router redundancy protocol (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-host-trk:

subscriber host tracking (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-mgmt:

subscriber management (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

 

type
Indicates the locally deleted or alarmed deleted entries in the MCS database per multi-chassis peer
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

detail—
Displays detailed information

mc-ipsec

Syntax 
mc-ipsec
Context 
tools>perform>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command enters the context to configure mc-ipsec parameters.

mc-endpoint

Syntax 
mc-endpoint peer ip-address
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis endpoint information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
mc-ring peer ip-address [ring sync-tag]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address.
sync-tag
Specifies the ring’s sync-tag created in the config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring context.

srrp-sync-database

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps SRRP database information and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
instance-id
Dumps information for the specified Subscriber Router Redundancy Protocol instance configured on this system.
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps MCS database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
port-id | lag-id
Indicates the port or LAG ID to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
slot/mda/port or lag-lag-id

 

sync-tag
Specifies a synchronization tag to be used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application
Specifies a particular multi-chassis peer synchronization protocol application
Values—

dhcp-server:

local dhcp server (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

igmp:

Internet group management protocol

igmp-snooping:

igmp-snooping

mc-ring:

multi-chassis ring

mld-snooping:

multicast listener discovery-snooping

srrp:

simple router redundancy protocol (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-host-trk:

subscriber host tracking (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-mgmt:

subscriber management (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

 

type
Indicates the locally deleted or alarmed deleted entries in the MCS database per multi-chassis peer
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

detail—
Displays detailed information

forcerenew

Syntax 
forcerenew svc-id service-id {ip ip-address[/mask] | mac ieee-address}
forcerenew {interface interface-name | sap sap-id | sdp sdp-id:vc-id} [ip ip-address[/mask] |mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command forces the renewal of lease state and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR

Parameters 
service-id
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified SAP.
ip-address
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified IP address
ieee-address
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified MAC address
interface-name
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified interface name

local-user-db

Syntax 
local-user-db local-user-db-name
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command provides tools to control the local user database.

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the name of a local user database up to 32 characters in length

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db
Description 

This command provides the tools to control IPoE entries in the local user database.

host-lookup

Syntax 
host-lookup [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id-ascii] [sap-id sap-id] [service-id service-id] [string vso-string] [system-id system-id] [option60 option-60-ascii] [circuit-id circuit-id-ascii] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [option60-hex option60-hex] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [ip-prefix ip-prefix/ip-prefix-length]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe
Description 

This command performs a lookup in the local user database.

Parameters 
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
remote-id
Specifies the information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-ascii—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length in ASCII
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

vso-string—
Specifies a Vendor Specific Option (VSO) string
system-id—
Specifies the system ID
Values—
up to 255 characters maximum

 

option-60-ascii
Specifies the Vendor-Identifying Vendor Option to match against. Option 60 is encoded as Type - Length - Value and must be formatted in ASCII.
option-60-hex
Specifies the Vendor-Identifying Vendor Option to match against. Option 60 is encoded as Type - Length - Value and must be formatted in HEX

ppp

Syntax 
ppp
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db
Description 

This command provides the tools to control PPPoE entries in the local user database.

authentication

Syntax 
authentication user-name user-name password password [circuit-id circuit-id] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [sap-id sap-id] [service-name service-name]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ppp
Description 

This command authenticates the PPPoE user name.

Parameters 
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
password
Specifies the password of this host up to 64 characters in length
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
circuit-id-hex
Specifies the circuit ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 254 hex nibbles)

 

derived-id
Specifies an ASCII string that uniquely identifies a host, and is derived by a Python script from packet content available during a DHCP transaction up to 255 characters in length
ieee-address
Specifies information about the MAC address of the PPP session
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-hex—
Specifies the remote ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 510hex nibbles)

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters in length
service-name
Specifies the service name

host-lookup

Syntax 
host-lookup [circuit-id circuit-id] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [sap-id sap-id] [service-name service-name] [user-name user-name]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ppp
Description 

This command performs a lookup in the local user database.

Parameters 
circuit-id circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID from the Option 82
circuit-id-hex
Specifies the circuit ID in hexadecimal format from the Option 82
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 254 hex nibbles)

 

derived-id
Specifies an ASCII string that uniquely identifies a host, and is derived by a Python script from packet content available during a DHCP transaction
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-hex—
Specifies the remote ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 510hex nibbles)

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters in length
service-name
Specifies a PPP service name up to 253 characters in length
user-name
Specifies a user name up to 128 characters in length

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring data.

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis sync database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Dumps the specified address of the multi-chassis peer
port-id
Dumps the specified port ID of the multi-chassis peer
lag-id
Dumps the specified Link Aggregation Group (LAG) on this system
sync-tag
Dumps the synchronization tag used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application—
Dumps the specified application information that was synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
dhcps, igmp, igmp-snooping, mc-ring, srrp, sub-mgmt, mld-snooping, all

 

detail—
Displays detailed information
type
Filters by the specified entry type
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

sync-database-reconcile

Syntax 
sync-database-reconcile [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id [sync-tag sync-tag]] [application application]
sync-database-reconcile [peer ip-address] [sdp sdp-id [sync-tag sync-tag]] [application application]
Context 
tools>perform>redundancy>multi-chassis>mc-ipsec
Description 

This command provides the parameters to reconcile MCS database entries.

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IP address (in the form of a.b.c.d)
port-id—
Specifies the port ID in the slot/MDA/port format
lag-id—
Specifies the LAG ID
Values—
lag-id: lag-id
lag: keyword
id: 1 to 200

 

syn-tag—
Specifies the syn tag up to 32 characters in length
application—
Specifies the application
Values—
dhcp-server — Specifies the local DHCP server
igmp — Specifies the Internet group management protocol
igmp-snooping — Specifies igmp-snooping
mc-ring — Specifies multi-chassis ring
l2tp — Specifies L2TP
mld — Specifies multicast listener discovery
mld-snooping — Specifies multicast listener discovery-snooping
srrp — Specifies simple router redundancy protocol
sub-host-trk — Specifies subscriber host tracking
sub-mgmt-ipoe — Specifies subscriber management for IPoE
sub-mgmt-pppoe — Specifies subscriber management for PPPoE
mc-ipsec — Specifies multi-chassis IPsec
python — Specifies Python cache
diameter-proxy — Specifies diameter proxy
pim-snpg-sap — Specifies protocol independent multicast snooping for SAPs
pim-snpg-sdp — Specifies protocol independent multicast snooping for SDPs

 

sdp-id—
Specifies the SDP ID
Values—
1 to 17407

 

srrp-sync-data

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis SRRP sync database information.

Parameters 
instance-id—
Specifies the instance ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

ip-address—
Dumps the specified address (in the form of a.b.c.d)

route-downloader

Syntax 
route-downloader start [force]
Context 
tools>perform>aaa
Description 

This command causes the download process to start immediately. If an ongoing download is already in progress then no further action is needed, except if the force keyword is added. In case the force keyword is added, then the current download is aborted and a new one is immediately restarted. If aborting the current download, the internal route table should not be emptied or cleared.

Parameters 
start—
Starts the download process immediately
force—
Causes the current download to be aborted and a new one is immediately restarted

router

Syntax 
router [router-instance]
router service-name service-name
Context 
tools>dump
Description 

This command enters the context for tools dump commands in the specified routing instance.

Parameters 
router-instance—
Specifies the router instance name (Base or management) or service ID
service-name—
Specifies the configured service name for the routing instance

ipoe-session

Syntax 
ipoe-session
Context 
tools>dump>router
Description 

This command enters the context for IPoE session-related tools dump commands in the specified routing instance.

migration

Syntax 
migration [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
tools>dump>router>ipoe-session
Description 

This command displays details on the IPoE session migration progress. It shows per group interface the number of hosts per type (DHCPv4, DHCPv6 and SLAAC) that are associated with an IPoE session or that are not associated with an IPoE session.

Output 

The following is an example of IPoE session migration information.

Sample Output
# tools dump router ipoe-session migration interface group-int-1-1
================================================================================
 Type                Total     IPoE session     Non IPoE session
================================================================================
 Group-interface: group-int-1-1 (IPoE session enabled)
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 DHCPv4              2         1                1
 DHCPv6              3         2                1
 SLAAC               0         0                0
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 IPoE sessions       1
================================================================================

9.25.2.4.16.1. Debug Commands

diameter

Syntax 
[no] diameter
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command enables debugging for diameter.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

dest-realm

Syntax 
dest-realm realm
no dest-realm
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts the output to a specific destination-realm.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
realm—
Specifies the realm up to 80 characters in length

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level level
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command configures the detail level of debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
level—
Specifies the detail level
Values—
low, medium, high

 

diameter-peer

Syntax 
diameter-peer peer [psm-events]
no diameter-peer
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts output to a specific peer.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
psm-events—
Specifies to restrict output to the peer’s state machine (PSM)

diameter-peer-policy

Syntax 
diameter-peer-policy policy
no diameter-peer-policy policy
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages on peers of a specific diameter peer policy. Up to eight diameter peer policies can be specified.

The no form of the command removes the specified diameter peer policy and all debug statement under this policy from the debug configuration.

Parameters 
policy—
Specifies the diameter peer policy name, up to 32 characters in length

avp-match

Syntax 
avp-match id
no avp-match id
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages within the diameter peer policy that belong to a diameter session identified based on the AVP value matching in a diameter application message.At least the message type and one AVP match criteria must be specified in an avp-match id command.

If a diameter application message matches all criteria within one AVP match ID, then the session ID is learned and all subsequent messages of that diameter session are shown until a relearning occurs. (OR function between avp-match id commands.)

When the session ID is learned in an Answer message, an attempt is made to include the corresponding Request message in the debug output: The Request message should still be available in the system and must pass all debug filters (such as message-type).

By default an avp-match id is disabled and must be configured with the debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match no shutdown to activate.

Parameters 
id—
Specifies the AVP match ID, up to five per diameter peer policy
Values—
1 to 5

 

avp

Syntax 
avp avp-id type type [ascii | hex] value value
no avp avp-id
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command specifies an AVP match criteria for AVP value matching. At least one and up to five AVP match criteria can be specified in an avp-match id command. When multiple AVP match criteria are specified, they must all match to be successful and result in a diameter session ID learning. (AND function between avp avp-id commands.)

The AVP in an AVP match criteria is identified by its AVP ID. The AVP ID is specified as [vendor-id-]avp-code[.avp-id] with nesting up to five levels deep.

The format type of the AVP should match the standard documents in which the AVP is specified. Any AVP can be specified as an octet string in hex format.

Parameters 
avp-id—
Specifies that an AVP is a [vendor-id-]avp-code[.avp-id], up to five levels deep. For example to specify the Multiple-Services-Credit-Control.Quota-Holding-Time AVP, use avp-id = 456.10415-871.
Values—
vendor-id: [1 to 4294967295]
avp-code: [1 to 4294967295]

 

type—
Specifies the format type of the AVP as octets string, integer32, integer64, unsigned32, unsigned64 or address. The type should match the format as specified in the corresponding standard documents. Any AVP can be specified as octet string in hex.
ascii | hex—
Specifies the value format. The ASCII format is default. The hexadecimal format value should start with "0x". For example: 0x0000000a to specify a 4 byte integer value in hexadecimal format.
value—
Specifies the actual value of the AVP that should be matched against (256 characters maximum; 127 characters maximum when specified in hex)

message-type

Syntax 
message-type [ccr] [cca] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
no message-type
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command specifies the message type match criteria for AVP value matching. Only specified diameter application messages are used for AVP value matching. This is a mandatory criteria in an avp-match id command.This command does not restrict the debug output to the specified messages.

Parameters 
ccr—
credit control request
cca—
credit control answer
rar —
re-authentication request
raa —
re-authentication answer
asr —
abort session request
asa —
abort session answer
aar —
aa request
aaa —
aa answer
all —
all message types

shutdown

Syntax 
[no] shutdown
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command enables or disables the avp-match id criteria for filtering debug output based on AVP value matching.A shutdown of the avp-match id clears the learned diameter session ID.

diameter-peer

Syntax 
diameter-peer peer [psm-events]
no diameter-peer
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages on a specific peer within the diameter peer policy. Overrides the debug>diam>diam-peer debug command for the specified diameter peer policy. A single peer can be specified per diameter peer policy.

When no peer is specified at the diameter peer policy level, the debug output is restricted to the peer configured at the debug>diam level.

The no form of the command removes the peer from the debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy debug output.

Parameters 
peer—
Specifies a peer name, up to 32 characters in length
psm-events—
Specifies to include Peer State Machine (PSM) events in the debug output

message-type

Syntax 
message-type [ccr] [cca] [cer] [cea] [dwr] [dwa] [dpr] [dpa] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
no message-type
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
debug>diam
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to the specified message types.

When specified within a diameter peer policy, it overrides the message type configuration at the debug>diam level for messages received and sent on that diameter peer policy.

The no form of the command removes the message type from the debug configuration.

Parameters 
ccr—
credit control request
cca—
credit control answer
cer —
capabilities exchange request
cea —
capabilities exchange answer
dwr —
device watchdog request
dwa —
device watchdog answer
dpr —
disconnect peer request
dpa —
disconnect peer answer
rar —
re-authentication request
raa —
re-authentication answer
asr —
abort session request
asa —
abort session answer
aar —
aa request
aaa —
aa answer
all —
all message types

origin-realm

Syntax 
origin-realm realm
no origin-realm
Context 
debug>diam
Description 

This command restricts output to a specific origin-realm.

arp-host

Syntax 
[no] arp-host
Context 
debug>service>id
Description 

This command enables and configures ARP host debugging.

The no form of the command disables ARP host debugging.

one-time-http-redirection

Syntax 
one-time-http-redirection
Context 
debug>service>id
Description 

This command produces one-time HTTP redirection debug output.

ppp

Syntax 
[no] ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>
Description 

This command enables the PPP debug context.

The no form of the command disables PPP debugging.

event

Syntax 
[no] event
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables the PPP event debug context.

The no form of the command disables PPP event debugging.

dhcp-client

Syntax 
dhcp-client [terminate-only]
no dhcp-client
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enable PPP event debug for DHCP client.

The no form of the command disables PPP event debugging for the DHCP client.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debug for local terminated PPP session

l2tp

Syntax 
l2tp [terminate-only]
no l2tp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables PPP L2TP event debug.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debug for local terminated PPP session

local-address-assignment

Syntax 
local-address-assignment [terminate-only]
no local-address-assignment
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables debugging for local-address-assignment events.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debugging for local address assignment

ppp

Syntax 
ppp [terminate-only]
no ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables PPP event debug.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debugging for local terminated PPP session

mac

Syntax 
[no] mac ieee-address
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command displays PPP packets for a particular MAC address.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

msap

Syntax 
[no] msap msap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables debugging for specific PPP MSAPs.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

packet

Syntax 
[no] packet
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables the PPP packet debug context.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level {low | medium | high}
no detail-level
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command specify the detail level of PPP packet debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
low | medium | high—
Specifies the detail level of PPP packet debug output

dhcp-client

Syntax 
[no] dhcp-client
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables packet debug output for DHCP client of the PPP session

The no form of the command disables debugging.

discovery

Syntax 
discovery [padi] [pado] [padr] [pads] [padt]
no discovery
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables PPP discovery packet debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
[padi] [pado] [padr] [pads] [padt]
Enables the corresponding type of PPP discovery packet

mode

Syntax 
mode {dropped-only | ingr-and-dropped | egr-ingr-and-dropped}
no mode
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command specifies PPP packet debug mode.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
dropped-only—
Displays only dropped packets
ingr-and-dropped—
Displays only ingress packet and dropped packets
egr-ingr-and-dropped—
Displays ingress, egress and dropped packets

ppp

Syntax 
ppp [lcp] [pap] [chap] [ipcp] [ipv6cp]
no ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables PPP discovery packet debug output for the specified PPP protocol.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
[lcp] [pap] [chap] [ipcp] [ipv6cp]
Enables debug for the specified protocol

remote-id

Syntax 
[no] remote-id remote-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables debugging for specific PPP remote-ids.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

sap

Syntax 
[no] sap sap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables PPP debug output for the specified SAP, this command allow multiple instances.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies the SAP ID

username

Syntax 
[no] username username
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified username. since not all PPP packets contain username, so a mac debug filter will be created automatically when system sees a PPP packet contain the specified username.

Multiple username filters can be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
user-name—
Specifies the PPP username

circuit-id

Syntax 
[no] circuit-id circuit-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified circuit-id.

Multiple circuit-id filters can be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
circuit-id —
Specifies the circuit-id in PADI

remote-id

Syntax 
[no] remote-id remote-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified remote-id.

Multiple remote-id filters could be specified in the same debug command.

Parameters 
remote-id—
Specifies the remote-id in PADI

msap

Syntax 
[no] msap msap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified managed SAP.

Multiple msap filters could be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
msap-id—
Specifies the managed SAP ID

authentication

Syntax 
authentication [policy policy-name] [mac-addr ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id]
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command debugs subscriber authentication.

Parameters 
policy-name
Specifies an existing subscriber management authentication policy name
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx or xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx
circuit-id
Specify the circuit-id, up to 256 characters in length

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
[no] sub-ident-policy policy-name
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command debugs subscriber identification policies.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the subscriber identification policy to debug

script-compile-error

Syntax 
[no] script-compile-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command send the traceback of the compile error to the logger. The traceback contains detailed information about where and why the compilation fails. The compilation takes place when the CLI user changes the admin state of the Python URL from shutdown to no-shutdown.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-export-variables

Syntax 
[no] script-export-variables
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the result (the three output variables) of the Python script to the logger when the script ran successfully.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-output

Syntax 
[no] script-output
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the output (such as from 'print' statements) of the Python script to the logger.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-output-on-error

Syntax 
[no] script-output-on-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the output (such as from print statements) of the Python script to the logger, but only when the script fails.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-runtime-error

Syntax 
[no] script-runtime-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the traceback of the Python script failure to the logger.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-all-info

Syntax 
script-all-info
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command enables the script-compile-error, script-export-variables, script-output, script-output-on-error, and script-runtime-error functionalities.

srrp

Syntax 
[no] srrp
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

events

Syntax 
[no] events [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
debug>router>srrp
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

packets

Syntax 
[no] packets [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
debug>router>srrp
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

radius

Syntax 
[no] radius
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enables the debug router RADIUS context.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level {low | medium | high}
no detail-level
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the output detail level of command debug router radius.

Default 

medium

Parameters 
low—
Specifies that the output includes packet type, server address, length, radius-server-policy name
medium—
Specifies all output in low level including the RADIUS attributes in the packet
high—
Specifies all output in medium level including the hex packet dump

packet-type

Syntax 
packet-type [authentication] [accounting] [coa]
no packet-type
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the RADIUS packet type filter of command debug router radius

Default 

authentication accounting coa

Parameters 
authentication—
Specifies the RADIUS authentication packet
accounting—
Specifies the RADIUS accounting packet
coa—
Specifies the RADIUS change of authorization packet

radius-attr

Syntax 
radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction]
radius-attr type attribute-type [transaction] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction] [encoding encoding-type]
radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction] [encoding encoding-type] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
no radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type]
no radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
no radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type]
no radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] {address | hex | integer | string} [0..16777215] attribute-value
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the RADIUS attribute filter of command debug router radius.

Parameters 
attribute-type
Specifies the RADIUS attribute type
Values—
1 to 255

 

attribute-ext-type
Specifies the RADIUS attribute extended type (RFC 6929)
Values—
1 to 255

 

address—
Specifies the value is a IPv4 or IPv6 address/prefix/subnet
string—
Specifies the value is a ASCII string
integer—
Specifies the value is a integer
hex—
Specifies the value is a binary string in hex format, such as “\0xAB01FE”
attribute-value
Specifies the value of the RADIUS attribute
Values—

address

<ipv4-address> | <ipv6-address> | <ipv6-prefix/prefix-length>

ipv4-address

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

ipv6-prefix-length [0 to 128]

hex

[0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (max 506 hex nibbles)]

integer

[0 to 4294967295]

string

ascii-string (max 253 chars)

 

transaction—
Specifies that the system will output both request and response packets in the same session even if the response packet does not include the filter attribute
vendor-id
Specifies the vendor id for the vendor specific attribute
Values—
0 to 16777215

 

encoding-type
Specifies the size of the vendor-type and vendor-length in bytes. It is a two digitals string: “xy”, x is the size of vendor-type, range from 1 to 4; y is the size of vendor-length, range from 0 to 2; it is “11” by default.
Values—
type-size:1 to 4, length-size: 0 to 2

 

wpp

Syntax 
[no] wpp
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enters the context to configure WPP debugging parameters.

packet

Syntax 
[no] packet
Context 
debug>router>wpp
debug>router>wpp>portal
Description 

This command enables WPP packet debugging.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level detail-level
Context 
debug>router>wpp
debug>router>wpp>packet
debug>router>wpp>portal>packet
Description 

This command specifies the detail level of WPP packet debugging.

Parameters 
detail-level—
specifies the detail level of WPP packet debugging
Values—
high — Specifies a high detail level for WPP packet debugging
low — Specifies a low detail for WPP packet debugging

 

portal

Syntax 
[no] portal wpp-portal-name
Context 
debug>router>wpp
Description 

This command enables WPP debugging for the specified WPP portal.

Parameters 
wpp-portal-name—
Specifies the WPP portal name

call-trace

Syntax 
call-trace
Context 
debug
Description 

This command enters the context to set up various call trace debug sessions.

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
debug>call-trace
Description 

This command enters the context to set up call trace debugging for IP over Ethernet (IPoE) sessions.

trace

Syntax 
trace sap sap-id [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace mac ieee-address [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace circuit-id circuit-id [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace remote-id remote-id [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
no trace [sap sap-id] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id]
no trace name trace-name
Context 
debug>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command enables tracing for IPoE sessions specified by the configured parameters. This command can trace a single session or multiple sessions, and can use wildcard characters.

This command can be executed multiple times to start multiple traces. When rules overlap, such as for a wildcard SAP and a specific SAP, the rule that a specific trace will be associated with cannot be guaranteed.

The no form of the command will prevent new traces from being configured and will terminate all trace jobs that were previously started using the trace command.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that is used to filter sessions to trace. The circuit-id and remote-id parameters are mutually exclusive.
ieee-address—
Specifies a MAC address that is used to identify a session to trace, in the format “ab:cd:ef:01:23:45”. A wildcard character can be used to match all remaining octets; for example, the format “ab:cd:ef:*” can be used to filter by OUI.
num—
Specifies the maximum number of jobs that may be started with this rule.
Values—
1 to 50

 

Default—
1
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that is used to filter sessions to trace. The remote-id and circuit-id parameters are mutually exclusive.
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP to trace. The following formats are accepted:
  1. port/lag/pw-port:svlan.cvlan
  2. port/lag/pw-port:vlan
  3. port/lag/pw-port
  4. port/lag/pw-port:vlan.*
  5. port/lag/pw-port:* (also matches *.*)
trace-existing-sessions—
Specifies that existing IPoE sessions will be traced. If this parameter is not included, only new IPoE sessions will be traced.
trace-name—
Specifies the name by which the trace will be referenced, up to 16 characters maximum.
trace-profile-name—
Specifies the name of the trace profile to be applied. The default parameters will be used if a trace profile is not specified.

9.25.2.5.16.1. Monitor Commands

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sap sap-id sla-profile sla-profile-name [base | ingress-queue-id ingress-queue-id | egress-queue-id egress-queue-id] [interval seconds] [repeat repeat] [absolute | rate]
Context 
monitor>service
Description 

This command monitors statistics for a subscriber.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile to monitor
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
sla-profile-name
Specifies an existing SLA profile
seconds
Configures the interval for each display in seconds
Default—
11
Values—
11 to 60

 

repeat
Configures how many times the command is repeated
Default—
10
Values—
1 to 999

 

absolute—
Specifies that raw statistics are displayed, without processing. No calculations are performed on the delta or rate statistics.
Default—
mode delta
rate —
Specifies that the rate-per-second for each statistic is displayed instead of the delta
base —
Monitors base statistics
ingress-queue-id ingress-queue-id
Monitors statistics for this queue
Values—
1 to 32

 

egress-queue-id egress-queue-id
Monitors statistics for this queue
Values—
1 to 8

 

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber monitor statistics

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 94531                  30704535
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 7332                    2510859
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 87067                   28152288
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 90862                   12995616
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance per Queue statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Ingress Queue 1 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Ingress Queue 2 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 94531                   30704535
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 7332                    2510859
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 87067                   28152288
 
Ingress Queue 3 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Ingress Queue 11 (Multipoint) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 1
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 90862                   12995616
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 2
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 3
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default base rate
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 109099                  35427060
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 8449                    2894798
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 100523                  32489663
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 105578                  15104553
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
At time t = 11 sec (Mode: Rate)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets                  % Port
                                                                        Util.
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0                       0.00
Off. LowPrio          : 1469                    477795                  0.38
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0                       0.00
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0                       0.00
Dro. LowPrio          : 119                     40691                   0.03
For. InProf           : 0                       0                       0.00
For. OutProf          : 1349                    437350                  0.34
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0                       0.00
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0                       0.00
For. InProf           : 1469                    209129                  0.16
For. OutProf          : 0                       0                       0.00
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default ingress-queue-id 1
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Ingress Queue 1 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default egress-queue-id 1
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Egress Queue 1
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 164366                  23506178
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
==============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

host

Syntax 
host [sap sap-id] [wholesaler service-id] [port port-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [detail]
host [sap sap-id] [wholesaler service-id] [port port-id] no-inter-dest-id [detail]
host summary
host [detail] wholesaler service-id (VPRN only)
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays static host information configured on this service.

Parameters 
sap-id
Displays SAP information for the specified SAP ID
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
summary—
Displays summary host information
wholesaler service-id
Specifies the VPRN service ID of the wholesaler. When specified in this context, SAP, SDP, interface, IP address and MAC parameters are ignored. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

Default 

collect-stats

default-host

Syntax 
default-host ipv4-prefix/mask | ipv6-prefix/prefix-length next-hop ipv4-address | ipv6-address
no default-host ipv4-prefix/mask | ipv6-prefix/prefix-length
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command configures the default-host. More than one default host can be configured per SAP.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

no lease-populate

Parameters 
ipv64prefix/prefix-length—
Specifies an IPv4 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv4-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

prefix-length - [0 to 128]

 

ipv6-prefix/prefix-length—
Specifies an IPv6 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

prefix-length - [0 to 128]

 

next-hop—
Assigns the next hop IP address

cpu-protection

Syntax 
cpu-protection policy-id [mac-monitoring] | [eth-cfm-monitoring [aggregate] [car]]
no cpu-protection
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command assigns an existing CPU protection policy to the associated group interface. The CPU protection policies are configured in the config>sys>security>cpu-protection>policy cpu-protection-policy-id context.

If no CPU-Protection policy is assigned to a group interface SAP, then the default policy is used to limit the overall-rate. The default policy is policy number 254 for access interfaces and 255 for network interfaces.

The no form of the command removes the association of the CPU protection policy from the associated interface and reverts to the default policy values.

Default 

cpu-protection 254 (for access interfaces)

cpu-protection 255 (for network interfaces)

The configuration of no cpu-protection returns the interface/SAP to the default policies as shown above.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Specifies an existing CPU protection policy
Values—
1 to 255

 

mac-monitoring—
Specifies to enable MAC monitoring
eth-cfm-monitoring
Specifies to enable Ethernet Connectivity Fault Management monitoring
aggregate—
Applies the rate limit to the sum of the per peer packet rates
car—
Applies the Committed Access Rate (CAR). This keyword causes Eth-CFM packets to be ignored when enforcing the overall-rate.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress SAP Quality of Service (QoS) policies and filter policies.

If no sap-egress QoS policy is defined, the system default sap-egress QoS policy is used for egress processing. If no egress filter is defined, no filtering is performed.

filter

Syntax 
filter ip ip-filter-id
filter
no filter [ip ip-filter-id]
no filter
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command associates an IP filter policy with an ingress or egress Service Access Point (SAP). Filter policies control the forwarding and dropping of packets based on the matching criteria.

MAC filters are only allowed on Epipe and Virtual Private LAN Service (VPLS) SAPs.

The filter command is used to associate a filter policy with a specified ip-filter-id with an ingress or egress SAP. The filter policy must already be defined before the filter command is executed. If the filter policy does not exist, the operation will fail and an error message returned.

In general, filters applied to SAPs (ingress or egress) apply to all packets on the SAP. One exception is non-IP packets are not applied to the match criteria, so the default action in the filter policy applies to these packets.

The no form of this command removes any configured filter ID association with the SAP. The filter ID itself is not removed from the system unless the scope of the created filter is set to local. To avoid deletion of the filter ID and only break the association with the service object, use the scope command within the filter definition to change the scope to local or global. The default scope of a filter is local.

Special Cases 
IES—
Only IP filters are supported on an IES IP interface, and the filters only apply to routed traffic
Parameters 
ip—
Keyword indicating the filter policy is an IP filter.
ip-filter-id—
Specifies the ID for the IP filter policy. Allowed values are an integer in the range of 1 and 65535 that corresponds to a previously created IP filter policy in the configure>filter context.

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id
no qos
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

Associates a Quality of Service (QoS) policy with an egress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface.

QoS egress policies are important for the enforcement of SLA agreements. The policy ID must be defined prior to associating the policy with a SAP or IP interface. If the policy-id does not exist, an error will be returned.

The qos command is used to associate egress QoS policies. The qos command only allows egress policies on SAP or IP interface egress. Attempts to associate a QoS policy of the wrong type returns an error.

Only one ingress QoS policy can be associated with a SAP or IP interface at one time. Attempts to associate a second QoS policy of a given type will return an error.

By default, no specific QoS policy is associated with the SAP or IP interface for egress, so the default QoS policy is used.

The normal behavior is for queues to be created per destination.

The no form of this command removes the QoS policy association from the SAP or IP interface, and the QoS policy reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policy-id—
The egress policy ID to associate with SAP or IP interface on egress. The policy ID must already exist.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id [shared-queuing]
no qos
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

Associates a Quality of Service (QoS) policy with an ingress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface.

QoS ingress policies are important for the enforcement of SLA agreements. The policy ID must be defined prior to associating the policy with a SAP or IP interface. If the policy-id does not exist, an error will be returned.

This qos command is used to associate ingress QoS policies. The qos command only allows ingress policies to be associated on SAP or IP interface ingress.

Only one ingress and one egress QoS policy can be associated with a SAP or IP interface at one time. Attempts to associate a second QoS policy of a given type will return an error.

By default, no specific QoS policy is associated with the SAP or IP interface for ingress so the default QoS policy is used.

The normal behavior is for queues to be created per destination. Shared and multipoint shared change this behavior creating either unicast or unicast and mcast shared queues.

The no form of this command removes the QoS policy association from the SAP or IP interface, and the QoS policy reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policy-id—
The ingress policy ID to associate with SAP or IP interface on ingress. The policy ID must already exist.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

shared-queuing—
This keyword can only be specified on SAP ingress. Specify the ingress shared queue policy used by a SAP. When the value of this object is null it means that the SAP will use individual ingress QoS queues, instead of the shared ones.

policer-control-policy

Syntax 
policer-control-policy policy-name
no policer-control-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command is used to create, delete, or modify policer control policies. The policer-control-policy controls the aggregate bandwidth available to a set of child policers. Once created, the policy can be applied to ingress or egress SAPs. The policy can also be applied to the ingress or egress context of a sub-profile.

The no form of the command resets the command to the default setting.

Default 

no policer-control-policy

Parameters 
policy-name
Specifies the policer control policy name. Each policer control policy name must be unique and adhere to the system policy ASCII naming requirements. If the defined policy name already exists, the system enters that policy’s context for editing purposes. If policy-name does not exist, the system will attempt to create a policy with the specified name.

qinq-mark-top-only

Syntax 
[no] qinq-mark-top-only
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
Description 

When the encapsulation type is qinq for the access port for the specified SAP, enabling this command specifies which P-bits or DEI bit to mark during packet egress. Only the P-bits or DEI bit in the top Q tag are marked. When this command is disabled, both sets of P-bits and the DEI bit are marked.

Default 

no qinq-mark-top-only

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
no scheduler-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command applies an existing scheduler policy to an ingress or egress scheduler used by ingress SAP queues or egress SAP policers and queues associated with this multi-service customer site. The schedulers defined in the scheduler policy can only be created once the customer site has been appropriately assigned to a chassis port, channel or slot. Scheduler policies are defined in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context.

The no form of this command removes the configured ingress or egress scheduler policy from the multi-service customer site. When the policy is removed, the schedulers created due to the policy are removed also making them unavailable for the SAP policers or queues associated with the customer site. Policers and queues that lose their parent scheduler association are deemed to be orphaned and are no longer subject to a virtual scheduler. The SAPs that have policers or queues reliant on the removed schedulers enter into an operational state depicting the orphaned status of one or more policers or queues. When the no form of the command executed, the customer site ingress or egress node will not contain an applied scheduler policy.

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name:—
Specifies the scheduler policy name to apply to an existing scheduler policy that was created in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context to create the hierarchy of ingress or egress virtual schedulers. The scheduler names defined within the policy are created and made available to any ingress queues or egress policers and queues created on associated SAPs.
Values—
Any existing valid scheduler policy name.

 

host

Syntax 
host ip ip-address [mac ieee-address]] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile sub-profile-name] [sla-profile sla-profile-name]
no host {[ip ip-address] [mac ieee-address]}
no host all
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>ies>if>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command creates a static subscriber host for the SAP. Static subscriber hosts may be used by the system for various purposes. Applications within the system that make use of static host entries include anti-spoof filters and ARP cache population.

Multiple static hosts may be defined on the SAP. Each host is identified by either a source IP address, a source MAC address or both a source IP and source MAC address. Every static host definition must have at least one address defined, IP or MAC.

Static hosts can exist on the SAP even with anti-spoof and ARP populate features disabled. When enabled, each feature has different requirements for static hosts.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Parameters 
anti-spoof—
When enabled, this feature uses static and dynamic host information to populate entries into an anti-spoof filter table. The anti-spoof filter entries generated will be of the same type as specified in the anti-spoof type parameter. If the SAP anti-spoof filter is defined as ip, each static host definition must specify an IP address. If the SAP anti-spoof filter is defined as ip-mac, each static host definition must specify both an IP address and MAC address. If definition of a static host is attempted without the appropriate addresses specified for the enabled anti-spoof filter, the static host definition will fail.
arp-populate—
When enabled, this feature uses static and dynamic host information to populate entries in the system ARP cache.

Attempting to define a static subscriber host that conflicts with an existing DHCP lease state table entry will fail.

Use the no form of the command to remove a static entry from the system. The specified ip-address and mac-address must match the host’s exact IP and MAC addresses as defined when it was created. When a static host is removed from the SAP, the corresponding anti-spoof entry and/or ARP cache entry is also removed.

ip-address —
Specifies this optional parameter when defining a static host. The IP address must be specified for anti-spoof ip, anti-spoof ip-mac and arp-populate. Only one static host may be configured on the SAP with a given IP address.
mac-address —
Specifies this optional parameter when defining a static host. The MAC address must be specified for anti-spoof ip-mac and arp-populate. Multiple static hosts may be configured with the same MAC address given that each definition is distinguished by a unique IP address.
sub-ident-string —
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing subscriber identification profile to be associated with the static subscriber host. The subscriber identification profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol context. The subscriber information is used by the VPRN SAP arp-reply-agent to determine the proper handling of received ARP requests from subscribers.

For VPRN SAPs with arp-reply-agent enabled with the optional sub-ident parameter, the static subscriber hosts sub-ident-string is used to determine whether an ARP request received on the SAP is sourced from a host belonging to the same subscriber as the destination host. When both the destination and source hosts from the ARP request are known on the SAP and the subscriber identifications do not match, the ARP request may be forwarded to the rest of the VPRN destinations.

If the static subscriber hosts sub-ident string is not defined, the host is not considered to belong to the same subscriber as another host on the SAP.

If source or destination host is unknown, the hosts are not considered to belong to the same subscriber. (ARP messages from unknown hosts are subject to anti-spoof filtering rules applied at the SAP.)

If sub-ident is not enabled on the SAP arp-reply-agent, subscriber identification matching is not performed on ARP requests received on the SAP.

ARP requests are never forwarded back to the same SAP or within the receiving SAP’s Split Horizon Group.

sub-profile-name
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing subscriber profile name to be associated with the static subscriber host. The subscriber profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile context.
sla-profile-name
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing SLA profile name to be associated with the static subscriber host. The SLA profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile context.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress SAP Quality of Service (QoS) policies and filter policies.

If no SAP ingress QoS policy is defined, the system default sap-ingress QoS policy is used for ingress processing. If no ingress filter is defined, no filtering is performed.

multi-service-site

Syntax 
[no] multi-service-site customer-site-name
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command creates a new customer site or edits an existing customer site with the customer-site-name parameter. A customer site is an anchor point to create an ingress and egress virtual scheduler hierarchy. When a site is created, it must be assigned to a chassis slot or port. When scheduler policies are defined for ingress and egress, the scheduler names contained in each policy are created according to the parameters defined in the policy. Multi-service customer sites exist for the sole purpose of creating a virtual scheduler hierarchy and making it available to queues on multiple Service Access Points (SAPs).

The scheduler policy association with the customer site normally prevents the scheduler policy from being deleted until after the scheduler policy is removed from the customer site. The multi-service-site object will generate a log message indicating that the association was deleted due to scheduler policy removal.

When the multi-service customer site is created, an ingress and egress scheduler policy association does not exist. This does not prevent the site from being assigned to a chassis slot or prevent service SAP assignment. After the site has been created, the ingress and egress scheduler policy associations can be assigned or removed at anytime.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
customer-site-name—
Each customer site must have a unique name within the context of the customer. If customer-site-name already exists for the customer ID, the CLI context changes to that site name for the purpose of editing the site scheduler policies or assignment. Any modifications made to an existing site will affect all SAPs associated with the site. Changing a scheduler policy association may cause new schedulers to be created and existing policers and queues on the SAPs to no longer be orphaned. Existing schedulers on the site may cease to exist, causing policers and queues relying on that scheduler to be orphaned.

If the customer-site-name does not exist, it is assumed that an attempt is being made to create a site of that name in the customer ID context. The success of the command execution depends on the following:

The maximum number of customer sites defined for the chassis slot has not been met.

The customer-site-name is valid.

The create keyword is included in the command line syntax (if the system requires it).

When the maximum number of customer sites has been exceeded a configuration error occurs, the command will not execute and the CLI context will not change.

If the customer-site-name is invalid, a syntax error occurs, the command will not execute and the CLI context will not change.

Values—
Valid names consist of any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

 

9.25.2.1.16.2. ATM Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

atm

Syntax 
atm
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command the context to configure ATM-related parameters. This command can only be used when a given context (for example, a channel or SAP) supports ATM functionality such as:

  1. Configuring ATM port or ATM port-related functionality on MDAs supporting ATM functionality
  2. Configuring ATM-related configuration for ATM-based SAPs that exist on MDAs supporting ATM functionality.

If ATM functionality is not supported for a given context, the command returns an error.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress ATM attributes for the SAP.

encapsulation

Syntax 
encapsulation atm-encap-type
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command configures RFC 2684, Multiprotocol Encapsulation over ATM Adaptation Layer 5, encapsulation for an ATM PVCC delimited SAP.

This command specifies the data encapsulation for an ATM PVCC delimited SAP. The definition references RFC 2684 and to the ATM Forum LAN Emulation specification.

Ingress traffic that does not match the configured encapsulation will be dropped.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

The encapsulation is driven by the services for which the SAP is configured. For IES service SAPs, the default is aal5snap-routed.

Parameters 
atm-encap-type—
Specify the encapsulation type
Values—
aal5snap-routed — Routed encapsulation for LLC encapsulated circuit (LLC/SNAP precedes protocol datagram) as defined in RFC 2684.
aal5mux-ip — Routed IP encapsulation for VC multiplexed circuit as defined in RFC 2684

 

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command configures ingress ATM attributes for the SAP.

traffic-desc

Syntax 
traffic-desc traffic-desc-profile-id
no traffic-desc
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
Description 

This command assigns an ATM traffic descriptor profile to a given context (for example, a SAP). When configured under the ingress context, the specified traffic descriptor profile defines the traffic contract in the forward direction. When configured under the egress context, the specified traffic descriptor profile defines the traffic contract in the backward direction.

The no form of the command reverts the traffic descriptor to the default traffic descriptor profile.

Default 

The default traffic descriptor (trafficDescProfileId. = 1) is associated with newly created PVCC-delimited SAPs.

Parameters 
traffic-desc-profile-id—
Specify a defined traffic descriptor profile (see the QoS atm-td-profile command).

oam

Syntax 
oam
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>interface >sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enters the context to configure OAM functionality for a PVCC delimiting a SAP.

The ATM-capable MDAs support F5 end-to-end OAM functionality (AIS, RDI, Loopback):

  1. ITU-T Recommendation I.610 - B-ISDN Operation and Maintenance Principles and Functions version 11/95
  2. GR-1248-CORE - Generic Requirements for Operations of ATM Network Elements (NEs). Issue 3 June 1996
  3. GR-1113-CORE - Bellcore, Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) and ATM Adaptation Layer (AAL) Protocols Generic Requirements, Issue 1, July 1994

alarm-cells

Syntax 
[no] alarm-cells
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
Description 

This command configures AIS/RDI fault management on a PVCC. Fault management allows PVCC termination to monitor and report the status of their connection by propagating fault information through the network and by driving PVCCs operational status.

When alarm-cells functionality is enabled, PVCCs operational status is affected when a PVCC goes into AIS or RDI state because of an AIS/RDI processing (i.e. assuming nothing else affects PVCCs operational status, PVCC goes DOWN, when it enters a fault state and comes back UP, when it exits that fault state) and RDI cell are generated when PVCC is operationally DOWN. No OAM-specific SNMP trap is raised whenever an endpoint enters/exits an AIS or RDI states, however, if as result of an OAM state change, the PVCC changes operational status, then a trap is expected from an entity the PVCC is associated with (for example a SAP).

The no form of the command disables alarm-cells functionality for a PVCC. When alarm-cells functionality is disabled, PVCCs operational status is no longer affected by PVCCs OAM state changes due to AIS/RDI processing (when alarm-cells is disabled, a PVCC will change operational status to UP, if it was DOWN because of the alarm-cell processing) and RDI cells are not generated as result of PVCC going into AIS or RDI state, however, PVCCs OAM status will record OAM faults as described above.

Default 

Enabled for PVCCs delimiting IES SAPs

periodic-loopback

Syntax 
[no] periodic-loopback
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>if >sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enables periodic OAM loopbacks on this SAP. This command is only configurable on IES and VPRN SAPs. When enabled, an ATM OAM loopback cell is transmitted every period as configured in the config>system>atm>oam>loopback-period period context.

If a response is not received and consecutive retry-down retries also result in failure, the endpoint will transition to an alarm indication signal/loss of clock state. Then, an ATM OAM loopback cell will be transmitted every period as configured in the loopback-period period. If a response is received for the periodic loopback and consecutive retry-up retries also each receive a response, the endpoint will transition back to the up state.

The no form of the command sets the value back to the default.

Default 

no periodic-loopback

9.25.2.1.16.3. Redundant Interface Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

redundant-interface

Syntax 
[no] redundant-interface ip-int-name
Context 
config>service>ies
config>service>vprn
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command configures a redundant interface.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface. Interface names can be from 1 to 32 alphanumeric characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

remote-proxy-arp

Syntax 
[no] remote-proxy-arp
Context 
config>service>ies>interface
Description 

This command enables remote proxy ARP on the interface.

The no form of the command disables remote proxy ARP on the interface.

Default 

no remote-proxy-arp

address

Syntax 
address {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask} [remote-ip ip-address]
no address
Context 
config>service>vprn>redundant-interface
Description 

This command assigns an IP address mask or netmask and a remote IP address to the interface.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Parameters 
ip-address/mask—
Assigns an IP address/IP subnet format to the interface
ip-address netmask—
Assigns an IP address netmask to the interface. Specifies a string of 0s and 1s that mask or screen out the network part of an IP address so that only the host computer part of the address remains.
remote-ip ip-address
Assigns a remote IP to the interface

spoke-sdp

Syntax 
[no] spoke-sdp sdp-id
Context 
config>service>vprn
Description 

This command binds a service to an existing Service Distribution Point (SDP).

A spoke SDP is treated like the equivalent of a traditional bridge “port” where flooded traffic received on the spoke SDP is replicated on all other “ports” (other spoke and mesh SDPs or SAPs) and not transmitted on the port it was received.

The SDP has an operational state which determines the operational state of the SDP within the service. For example, if the SDP is administratively or operationally down, the SDP for the service will be down.

The SDP must already be defined in the config>service>sdp context in order to associate an SDP with a VPRN service. If the sdp sdp-id is not already configured, an error message is generated. If the sdp-id does exist, a binding between that sdp-id and the service is created.

SDPs must be explicitly associated and bound to a service. If an SDP is not bound to a service, no far-end 7750 SR devices can participate in the service.

The no form of this command removes the SDP binding from the service. The SDP configuration is not affected; only the binding of the SDP to a service. Once removed, no packets are forwarded to the far-end router.

Special Cases 
VPRN—
Several SDPs can be bound to a VPRN service. Each SDP must be destined to a different 7750 SR OS. If two sdp-id bindings terminate on the same 7750 SR, an error occurs and the second SDP binding is rejected.
Parameters 
sdp-id—
The SDP identifier. Allowed values are integers in the range of 1 and 17407 for existing SDPs
vc-id—
The virtual circuit identifier
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress SDP parameters.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress SDP parameters.

vc-label

Syntax 
vc-label egress-vc-label
no vc-label [egress-vc-label]
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>egress
Description 

This command configures the egress VC label.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no vc-label

Parameters 
vc-label—
A VC egress value that indicates a specific connection
Values—
16 to 1048575

 

vc-label

Syntax 
vc-label ingress-vc-label
no vc-label [ingress-vc-label]
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>ingress
Description 

This command configures the ingress VC label.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no vc-label

Parameters 
vc-label—
A VC ingress value that indicates a specific connection
Values—
2048 to 18431

 

filter

Syntax 
filter {ip ip-filter-id}
no filter
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>ingress
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>egress
Description 

This command associates an IP filter policy with an ingress or egress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface. An IP filter policy can be associated with spoke SDPs.

Filter policies control the forwarding and dropping of packets based on IP or MAC matching criteria.

The filter command is used to associate a filter policy with a specified ip-filter-id with an ingress or egress SAP. The ip-filter-id must already be defined before the filter command is executed. If the filter policy does not exist, the operation will fail and an error message returned.

In general, filters applied to SAPs (ingress or egress) apply to all packets on the SAP. One exception is non-IP packets are not applied to IP match criteria, so the default action in the filter policy applies to these packets.

The no form of this command removes any configured filter ID association with the SAP or IP interface. The filter ID itself is not removed from the system unless the scope of the created filter is set to local. To avoid deletion of the filter ID and only break the association with the service object, use scope command within the filter definition to change the scope to local or global. The default scope of a filter is local.

Default 

no filter

Parameters 
ip-filter-id
Specifies IP filter policy. The filter ID must already exist within the created IP filters
Values—
1 to 65535

 

9.25.2.1.16.4. SDP Binding Commands

binding

Syntax 
binding
Context 
config>service>sdp
Description 

The command enters the context to configure SDP bindings.

port

Syntax 
port [port-id | lag-id]
no ort
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding
Description 

This command specifies the port or lag identifier, to which the PW ports associated with the underlying SDP are bound. If the underlying SDP is re-routed to a port or lag other than the specified one, the PW ports on the SDP are operationally brought down.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
port-id—
The identifier of the port in the slot/mda/port format
lag-id—
Specifies the LAG identifier

pw-port

Syntax 
pw-port pw-port-id [vc-id vc-id] [create]
no pw-port
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding
Description 

This command creates a pseudowire port.

The no form of the command removes the pseudowire port ID from the configuration.

Parameters 
pw-port-id—
Specifies a unique identifier of the pseudowire port
Values—
1 to 10239

 

vc-id vc-id
Specifies a virtual circuit identifier signaled to the peer
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

description

Syntax 
description description-string
no description
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command creates a text description stored in the configuration file for a configuration context.

The description command associates a text string with a configuration context to help identify the content in the configuration file.

The no form of the command removes the string from the configuration.

Default 

no description

Parameters 
description-string—
Specifies the description character string of the configuration context
Values—
Any string up to 80 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

 

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command enters the context to configure PW-port egress side parameters.

encap-type

Syntax 
encap-type {dot1q | qinq}
no encap-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets the encapsulation type for the PW-port as dot1q or qinq.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

dot1q

Parameters 
dot1q—
Specifies dot1q encapsulation type
qinq—
Specifies qinq encapsulation type

shaper

Syntax 
[no] shaper
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress
Description 

This command configures an egress shaping option for use by a PW port.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no shaper

int-dest-id

Syntax 
[no] int-dest-id int-dest-id
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress>shaper
Description 

This command specifies the intermediate destination string configured for dynamic Vport selection.

This command is only valid for PW ports used for enhanced subscriber management (ESM on PW).

The no form of the command removes the configured intermediate destination string.

Default 

no.int-dest-id

Parameters 
int-dest-id—
Specifies a text string that describes the intermediate destination ID

vport

Syntax 
vport vport-name
no vport
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress>shaper
Description 

This command configures the name of the Vport to be used for the PW port.

This command is valid for PW ports used for enhanced subscriber management (ESM on pseudowire) and pseudowire SAPs on Ethernet ports. It is not valid for pseudowire ports on the HSMDA.

The no form of the command removes the configured Vport name.

Default 

no vport

Parameters 
vport-name—
Specifies a text string up to 32 characters in length representing the name of the Vport

vc-type

Syntax 
vc-type {ether | vlan}
no vc-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets the forwarding mode for PW-port. The vc-type is signaled to the peer, and must be configured consistently on both ends of the PW. vc-type VLAN is only configurable with dot1q encapsulation on the PW-port. The tag with vc-type vlan only has significance for transport, and is not used for service delineation or ESM. The top (provider tag) is stripped while forwarding out of the PW, and a configured vlan-tag (for vc-type vlan) is inserted when forwarding into the PW. With vc-type ether, the tags if present (max 2), are transparently preserved when forwarding in our out of the PW.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

ether

Parameters 
ether—
Specifies ether as the virtual circuit (VC) associated with the SDP binding
vlan—
Specifies vlan as the virtual circuit (VC) associated with the SDP binding

vlan-vc-tag

Syntax 
vlan-vc-tag vlan-id
no vc-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets tag relevant for vc-type vlan mode. This tag is inserted in traffic forwarded into the PW.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

0

Parameters 
vlan-id—
Specifies the VLAN ID value
Values—
0 to 4094

 

9.25.2.1.1. RIP Commands

rip-policy

Syntax 
rip-policy policy-name [create]
no rip- policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates a RIP policy. This policy is applied to a subscriber IPv4 host to enable the BNG to learn RIP routes from the host. RIP routes are never sent to the hosts.

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the RIP policy name up to 32 characters in length.
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

neighbor

Syntax 
[no] neighbor ip-int-name
Context 
config>router>rip>group
config>service>vprn>rip>group
Description 

This command creates a context for configuring a RIP neighbor interface. By default, group interfaces are not activated with RIP, unless explicitly configured. The BNG will only learn RIP routes from IPv4 host on the group interface. The RIP neighbor group interface will default send to “none”. The send operation is unchangeable for group-interface.

The no form of the command deletes the RIP interface configuration for this group interface. The shutdown command in the config>router>rip>group group-name>neighbor context can be used to disable an interface without removing the configuration for the interface.

Default 

no neighbor

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
The group interface name. Interface names must be unique within the group of defined group interfaces within config service vprn/ies sub-interface grp-interface commands. An interface name cannot be in the form of an IP address. Interface names can be any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes. If the group interface name does not exist, an error message will be returned.

authentication-key

Syntax 
authentication-key [authentication-key | hash-key] [hash | hash2]
no authentication-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rip-policy
Description 

This command configures the BGP authentication key.

Authentication is performed between neighboring routers before setting up the BGP session by verifying the password. Authentication is performed using the MD-5 message-based digest. The authentication key can be any combination of letters or numbers from 1 to 16.

The no form of the command removes the authentication password from the configuration and effectively disables authentication.

Default 

Authentication is disabled and the authentication password is empty.

Parameters 
authentication-key—
The authentication key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 255 characters in length (unencrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).
hash-key—
The hash key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 342 characters in length (encrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).

This is useful when a user must configure the parameter, but, for security purposes, the actual unencrypted key value is not provided.

hash—
Specifies the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.

authentication-type

Syntax 
authentication-type {none | password | message-digest | message-digest-20}
no authentication-type
Context 
config>sub-mgmg>rip-policy>
Description 

This command sets the type of authentication to be used between RIP neighbors. The type and password must match exactly for the RIP message to be considered authentic and processed.

The no form of the command removes the authentication type from the configuration and effectively disables authentication.

Default 

no authentication-type

Parameters 
none—
Disables authentication at a given level (global, group, neighbor). If the command does not exist in the configuration, the parameter is inherited.
password —
Specifies enable simple password (plain text) authentication. If authentication is enabled and no authentication type is specified in the command, simple password authentication is enabled.
message-digest—
Configures 16 byte message digest for MD5 authentication. If this option is configured, then at least one message-digest-key must be configured.
message-digest-20—
Configures 20 byte message digest for MD5 authentication in accordance with RFC 2082, RIP-2 MD5 Authentication. If this option is configured, then at least one message-digest-key must be configured.

retail-svc-id

Syntax 
retail-svc-id service-id
retail-svc-id
Context 
config>service>ies|vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>static-host
Description 

This command specifies the service id of the retailer IES/VPRN service to which the static IPv6 host belongs. A corresponding retailer subscriber interface must exist in the specified service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no retail-svc-id

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies the retailer service ID or retailer service name
Values—
service-id: 1 to 2148007978
svc-name: A string up to 64 characters in length

 

rip

Syntax 
[no] rip
Context 
config>service>vprn
config>service>ies
Description 

This command enables the RIP protocol on the given VPRN IP interface.

The no form of the command disables the RIP protocol from the given VPRN IP interface.

Default 

no rip

group

Syntax 
[no] group group-name
Context 
config>service>vprn>rip
config>service>ies>rip
Description 

This command creates a context for configuring a RIP group of neighbors. RIP groups are a way of logically associating RIP neighbor interfaces to facilitate a common configuration for RIP interfaces.

The no form of the command deletes the RIP neighbor interface group. Deleting the group will also remove the RIP configuration of all the neighbor interfaces currently assigned to this group.

Default 

no group

Parameters 
group-name—
The RIP group name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

9.25.2.1.2. Vport Commands

ethernet

Syntax 
ethernet
Context 
config>port
Description 

This command the context to configure Ethernet port attributes.

This context can only be used when configuring Fast Ethernet, gigabit or 10-G Fast Ethernet or Ethernet LAN ports on an appropriate MDA.

egress-scheduler-override

Syntax 
[no] egress-scheduler-override
Context 
config>port>ethernet
Description 

This command applies egress scheduler overrides. When a port scheduler is associated with an egress port, it is possible to override the following parameters:

  1. The max-rate allowed for the scheduler.
  2. The maximum rate for each priority level 8 through 1.
  3. The CIR associated with each priority level 8 through 1.

See the SR OS Quality of Service Guide for command syntax and usage for the port-scheduler-policy command.

The no form of this command removes all override parameters from the egress port or channel scheduler context. Once removed, the port scheduler reverts all rate parameters back to the parameters defined on the port-scheduler-policy associated with the port.

Default 

no egress-scheduler-override

level

Syntax 
level priority-level rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
no level priority-level
Context 
config>port>ethernet>egress-scheduler-override
Description 

This command overrides the maximum and CIR rate parameters for a specific priority level on the port or channel’s port scheduler instance. When the level command is executed for a priority level, the corresponding priority level command in the port-scheduler-policy associated with the port is ignored. The override level command supports the keyword max for the rate and cir parameter. When executing the level override command, at least the rate or cir keywords and associated parameters must be specified for the command to succeed.

The no form of this command removes the local port priority level rate overrides. Once removed, the port priority level will use the port scheduler policies level command for that priority level.

Default 

no level

Parameters 
priority-level—
Identifies which of the eight port priority levels are being overridden
Values—
1 to 8

 

pir-rate
Overrides the port scheduler policy’s maximum level rate and requires either the max keyword or a rate defined in kilobits-per-second to follow
Values—
1 to 40000000, max

 

cir-rate
Overrides the port scheduler policy’s within-cir level rate and requires either the max keyword or a rate defined in kilobits-per-second to follow
Values—
0 to 40000000, max

 

max—
Removes any existing rate limit imposed by the port scheduler policy for the priority level allowing it to use as much total bandwidth as possible

access

Syntax 
access
Context 
config>port>ethernet
Description 

This command configures Ethernet access port parameters.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Ethernet access egress port parameters.

vport

Syntax 
vport name [create]
no vport name
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress
Description 

This command configures a scheduling node, referred to as virtual port, within the context of an egress Ethernet port. The Vport scheduler operates either like a port scheduler with the difference that multiple Vport objects can be configured on the egress context of an Ethernet port, or it can be an aggregate rate when an egress port-scheduler policy is applied to the port.

The Vport is always configured at the port level even when a port is a member of a LAG.

When a port scheduler policy is applied to a Vport the following command is used:

configure>port>ethernet>acess>egress>vport>port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name

The CLI will not allow the user to apply a port scheduler policy to a Vport if one has been applied to the port. Conversely, the CLI will not allow the user to apply a port scheduler policy to the egress of an Ethernet port if one has been applied to any Vport defined on the access egress context of this port. The agg-rate-limit, along with an egress port-scheduler, can be used to ensure that a given Vport does not oversubscribe the port’s rate.

SAP and subscriber host queues can be port-parented to a Vport scheduler in a similar way they port-parent to a port scheduler or can be port-parented directly to the egress port-scheduler if the agg-rate-limit is used.

When the Vport uses an aggregate rate, the following command is used:

configure>port>ethernet>acess>egress>vport>agg-rate-limit

The no form of the command removes the Vport name from the configuration.

Default 

no vport

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the Vport scheduling node and can be up to 32 ASCII characters in length. This does not need to be unique within the system but is unique within the port or a LAG.
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

agg-rate-limit

Syntax 
agg-rate-limit agg-rate
no agg-rate-limit
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command configures an aggregate rate for the Vport. This command is mutually exclusive with the port-scheduler-policy command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no agg-rate-limit

Parameters 
agg-rate
Specifies the rate limit for the Vport
Values—
max, 1 to 10000000

 

egress-rate-modify

Syntax 
[no] egress-rate-modify
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command is used to apply HQoS Adjustment to a Vport. HQoS Adjustment refers to the dynamic adjustment of the rate limit at an QoS enforcement point within router when the multicast traffic stream is disjointed from the unicast traffic stream. This QoS enforcement point within router represents the physical point further down in the access part of the network where the two streams join each other and potentially can cause congestion.

An example would be a PON port which is shared amongst subscriber’s multicast traffic (single copy of each channel) and subscriber’s unicast traffic. The bandwidth control point for this PON port resides in the upstream router BNG node in the form of a Vport. In case that the multicast delivery method in the router BNG utilizes redirection, the multicast traffic in the router BNG will flow outside of the subscriber or the Vport context and thus will bypass any bandwidth enforcement in the router. To correct this, a Vport bandwidth adjustment is necessary in the router that will account for the multicast bandwidth consumption that is bypassing Vport in the router but is present in the PON port whose bandwidth is controlled by Vport.

An estimate of the multicast bandwidth consumption on the PON port can be made at the Vport level based on the IGMP messages sourced from the subscribers behind the PON port. This process is called HQoS Adjustment.

A multicast channel bandwidth is subtracted from or added to the Vport rate limit according to the received IGMP Join/Leave messages and the channel bandwidth definition policy associated with the Vport (indirectly through a group-interface). Since the multicast traffic on the PON port is shared amongst subscribers behind this PON port, only the first IGMP Join or the last IGMP Leave per multicast channel is tracked for the purpose of the Vport bandwidth modification.

The Vport rate that will be affected by this functionality depends on the configuration:

  1. In case the agg-rate-limit within the Vport is configured, its value will be modified based on the IGMP activity associated with the subscriber under this Vport.
  2. In case the port-scheduler-policy within the Vport is referenced, the max-rate defined in the corresponding port-scheduler-policy will be modified based on the IGMP activity associated with the subscriber under this Vport.

The channel bandwidth definition policy is defined in the mcac policy in the configure>router>mcac>policy context. The policy is applied under the group-interface or in case of redirection under the redirected-interface.

The rates in effect can be displayed with the following two commands:

show port 1/1/5 vport name

qos scheduler-hierarchy port port-id vport vport-name

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport, which is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces, is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport, which is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces, is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no egress-rate-modify

host-match

Syntax 
host-match dest destination-string [create]
no host-match dest destination-string
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egr>qgrp
Description 

This command configures host matching for the Ethernet port egress queue-group.

The no form of the command removes the destination string from the configuration.

Parameters 
destination-string
Specify a host match destination string up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword used to create the host match. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context

port-scheduler-policy

Syntax 
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name
no port-scheduler-policy
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command specifies the destination and organization strings to be used for matching subscriber hosts with this Vport.

The parent Vport of a subscriber host queue, which has the port-parent option enabled, is determined by matching the destination string dest string associated with the subscriber and the organization string org string associated with the subscriber host with the strings defined under a Vport on the port associated with the subscriber.

If a given subscriber host policers or queue does not have the port-parent option enabled, it will be foster-parented to the Vport used by this subscriber and which is based on matching the dest string and org string. If the subscriber could not be matched with a Vport on the egress port, the host policer or queue will not be bandwidth controlled and will compete for bandwidth directly based on its own PIR and CIR parameters.

By default, a subscriber host policer or queue with the port-parent option enabled is scheduled within the context of the port’s port scheduler policy.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command. Applying a scheduler policy to a Vport is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces.

The no form of the command removes the port-scheduler-policy-name from the configuration.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no port-scheduler-policy

Parameters 
port-scheduler-policy-name—
Specifies an existing port-scheduler-policy configured in the config>qos context

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
no scheduler-policy
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command specifies a scheduler policy to associate to the Vport. Scheduler policies are configured in the configure>qos>scheduler>policy context. Each scheduler policy is divided up into groups of schedulers based on the tier each scheduler is created under. A tier is used to give structure to the schedulers within a policy and define rules for parent scheduler associations. The policy defines the hierarchy and operating parameters for virtual schedulers.

The no form of this command removes the configured egress scheduler policy from the Vport.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command.

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no scheduler-policy

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name—
The scheduler-policy-name parameter applies an existing scheduler policy that was created in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context to create the hierarchy of egress virtual schedulers.

parent-location

Syntax 
parent-location {default | sla}
no parent-location
Context 
config>qos>sap-egress
Description 

This command determines the expected location of the parent schedulers for queues configured with a parent command within the SAP egress policy. All parent schedulers must be configured within a scheduler policy applied at the location corresponding to the parent-location parameter.

If a parent scheduler name does not exist at the specified location, the queue will not be parented and will be orphaned.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

parent-location default

Parameters 
default—
Specifies that the queues should look for their in the SAP's egress scheduler-policy or the multi-service-site's egress scheduler policy depending on which is configured and Subscriber queues will look for their parents in the subscriber-profile's egress scheduler-policy.When the SAP egress policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the queues must be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the subscriber’s SUB profile. When the SAP egress policy is applied to a SAP, the parent schedulers of the queues need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the SAP or the multi-service site.
sla—
Specifies that the queues should look for their parent in the SLA-profile's egress scheduler-policy; all queues that are not port-parented and to which SLA-profile is not applicable will behave as orphans in this case.When the SAP egress policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the queues must be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the same SLA profile. If this parameter is configured within a SAP egress policy that is applied to any object except of the egress of an SLA profile, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the queues will not be parented and will be orphaned.

parent-location

Syntax 
parent-location {none | sub | vport}
no parent-location
Context 
config>qos>scheduler-policy
Description 

This command determines the expected location of the parent schedulers for the tier 1 schedulers configured with a parent command within the scheduler policy. The parent schedulers must be configured within a scheduler policy applied at the location corresponding to the parent location parameter.

If a parent scheduler name does not exist at the specified location, the schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned.

The configuration of parent-location and frame-based-accounting commands in a scheduler policy is mutually exclusive in to ensure consistency between the different scheduling levels.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

parent-location none

Parameters 
none—
This parameter indicates that the tier 1 schedulers do not have a parent scheduler and the configuration of the parent under a tier 1 scheduler is blocked. Conversely, this parameter is blocked when any tier 1 scheduler has a parent configured.
sub—
When the scheduler policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the tier 1 schedulers need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the subscriber’s SUB profile.

If this parameter is configured within a scheduler policy that is applied to any object except for the egress of an SLA profile, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the tier 1 schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned.

vport—
When the scheduler policy is applied to an SLA profile, a SUB profile for a subscriber or to the egress of a PW SAP, the parent schedulers of the tier 1 schedulers need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the VPORT to which the subscriber will be assigned.

If this parameter is configured within a scheduler policy that is applied to to any object except for the egress of an SLA profile or SUB profile, or to the egress of a PW SAP, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the tier 1 schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned. This parameter is not supported when policers-hqos-manageable is configured in the SAP egress QoS policy.

9.25.2.1.2.1. MLD Policy Commands

mld-policy

Syntax 
mld-policy mld-policy-name [create]
no mld-policy mld-policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to create an MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no mld-policy

Parameters 
mld-policy-name—
Specifies the MLD policy name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

disable-router-alert-check

Syntax 
[no] disable-router-alert-check
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command disables router alert checking for MLD messages received on this interface. The no form of the command enables router alert checking.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no disable-router-alert-check

egress-rate-modify

Syntax 
egress-rate-modify agg-rate-limit
egress-rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
no egress-rate-modify
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the egress rate modification.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

no egress-rate-modify

Parameters 
agg-rate-limit—
Specifies that the maximum total rate for all subscriber egress queues for each subscriber associated with the policy
scheduler-name
Specifies the scheduler to be applied for egress rate modification

fast-leave

Syntax 
[no] fast-leave
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enables fast leave. When fast leave processing is enabled, the router will immediately remove a SAP or SDP from the IP multicast group when it detects an MLD leave on that SAP or SDP. Fast leave processing allows the switch to remove a SAP or SDP that sends a leave from the forwarding table without first sending out group-specific queries to the SAP or SDP, and thus speeds up the process of changing channels (zapping).

Fast leave should only be enabled when there is a single receiver present on the SAP or SDP.

When fast leave is enabled, the configured last-member-query-interval value is ignored.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no fast-leave

import

Syntax 
import policy-name
no import
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command specifies the import routing policy to be used. Only a single policy can be imported at a time.

The no form of the command removes the policy association.

Default 

no import

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the import policy name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes. Routing policies are configured in the config>router>policy-options context The router policy must be defined before it can be imported.

max-num-groups

Syntax 
max-num-groups count
no max-num-groups
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command defines the maximum number of multicast groups that can be joined. If the router receives a join message that would exceed the configured number of groups, the request is ignored.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no max-num-groups

Parameters 
count —
Specifies the maximum number of groups that can be joined
Values—
1 to 1000

 

max-num-grp-sources

Syntax 
max-num-grp-sources [max-num-grp-sources]
no max-num-grp-sources
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of group sources for which MLD can have local receiver information based on received MLD reports on this interface. When this configuration is changed dynamically to a value lower than currently accepted number of group sources, the group sources that are already accepted are not deleted. Only new group sources will not be allowed. When this object has a value of 0, there is no limit to the number of group sources.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no max-num-grp-sources

Parameters 
max-num-grp-sources
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowed to be tracked per group
Values—
1 to 32000

 

max-num-sources

Syntax 
max-num-sources max-num-sources
no max-num-sources
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of multicast sources allowed per group.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
max-num-sources—
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowed per group
Values—
1 to 1000

 

per-host-replication

Syntax 
[no] per-host-replication
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enables per-host-replication. In the per-host-replication mode, multicast traffic is replicated per each host within the subscriber irrespective of the fact that some hosts may be subscribed to the same multicast stream. As a result, in case that multiple hosts within the subscriber are registered for the same multicast group, the multicast streams of that group will be generated. The destination MAC address of multicast streams will be changed to unicast so that each host receives its own copy of the stream. Multicast traffic in the per-host-replication mode can be classified via the existing QoS CLI structure. As such the multicast traffic will flow through the subscriber queues. HQoS Adjustment is not needed in this case.

The alternative behavior for multicast replication in IPoE environment is per-SAP- replication. In this model, only a single copy of the multicast stream is sent per SAP, irrespective of the number of hosts that are subscribed to the same multicast group. This behavior applies to 1:1 connectivity model as well as on 1:N connectivity model (SAP centric behavior as opposed to subscriber centric behavior).

In the per-SAP-replication model the destination MAC address is multicast (as opposed to unicast in the per-host-replication model). Multicast traffic is flowing via the SAP queue which is outside of the subscriber context. The consequence is that multicast traffic is not accounted in the subscriber HQoS. In addition, HQoS Adaptation is not supported in the per SAP replication model.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no per-host-replication

query-interval

Syntax 
query-interval seconds
no query-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command specifies the frequency at which the querier router transmits general host-query messages. Host-query messages solicit group membership information and are sent to the link-scope all-node address, FF02::1. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config> service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no query-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the frequency, in seconds, at which the router transmits general host-query messages
Values—
2 to 1024

 

query-last-listener-interval

Syntax 
query-last-listener-interval seconds
no query-last-listener-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the frequency at which the querier router sends a group-specific query messages, including the messages sent in response to leave-group messages. The shorter the interval, the faster the loss of the last member of a group can be detected. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-last-listener-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config>service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the frequency, in seconds, at which query messages are sent
Values—
1 to 1023

 

query-response-interval

Syntax 
query-response-interval seconds
no query-response-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the query response interval. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-response-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config>service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no query-response-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the length of time that the querier router waits to receive a response to from the host
Values—
1 to 1023

 

redirection-policy

Syntax 
redirection-policy policy-name
no redirection-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command will apply multicast redirection action to the subscriber. The redirection action along with the redirected interface (and possibly service id) is defined in the referenced policy-name. MLD messages will be redirected to an alternate interface if that alternate interface has MLD enabled. The alternate interface does not have to have any multicast groups registered via MLD. Currently all MLD messages are redirected and there is no ability to selectively redirect MLD messages based on match conditions (multicast-group address, source IP address, and so on). Multicast redirection is supported between VPRN services and also between interfaces within the Global Routing Context. Multicast Redirection is not supported between the VRPN services and the Global Routing Table (GRT).

MLD state is maintained per subscriber host and per redirected interface. Traffic is however forwarded only on the redirected interface.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies a redirection policy name up to 32 characters in length. This is a regular policy defined under the configure>router>policy-option>policy-statement context

static

Syntax 
static
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure MLD static group membership parameters.

group

Syntax 
[no] group grp-ipv6-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static
Description 

This command configures a static multicast group.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no group

Parameters 
grp-ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address
Values—
<grp-ipv6-address> : ipv6-address - x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces) x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d
x - [0 to FFFF]H
d - [0 to 255]D
- multicast group IPv6 address

 

source

Syntax 
[no] source ipv6-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static>group
Description 

This command adds or removes a static multicast source.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
grp-ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address
Values—
<grp-ipv6-address> : ipv6-address - x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces) x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d
x - [0 to FFFF]H
d - [0 to 255]D
- multicast group IPv6 address

 

starg

Syntax 
[no] starg
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static>group
Description 

This command adds a static (*,G) entry. This command can only be enabled if no existing source addresses for this group are specified.

The no form of the command removes the starg entry from the configuration.

Default 

no starg

version

Syntax 
version version
no version
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy#
Description 

This command configures the MLD version.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

version 2

Parameters 
version—
Specifies the MLD version
Values—
1, 2

 

9.25.2.1.2.2. IPoE Session Commands

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy policy-name [create]
no ipoe-session-policy policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures an IPoE session policy. The policies are referenced from subscriber interfaces, group interfaces and capture SAPs. Multiple IPoE session policies can be configured.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the IPoE policy name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

circuit-id-from-auth

Syntax 
[no] circuit-id-from-auth
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command takes the circuit ID value from the authentication server to identify the session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no circuit-id-from-auth

description

Syntax 
description description-string
no description
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command takes the circuit-id value from the authentication server when it creates a text description stored in the configuration file for a configuration context.

The description command associates a text string with a configuration context to help identify the context in the configuration file.

The no form of this command removes any description string from the context.

Default 

no description

Parameters 
description-string—
Specifies a text string describing the entity. Allowed values are any string up to 80 characters in length, composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes..

session-key

Syntax 
session-key sap mac [cid] [rid]
no session-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command configures the key to logically group subscriber hosts that belong to the same dual stack end device in an IPoE session.

The SAP and MAC address are always part of the IPoE session key. Optionally the Circuit-Id/Interface-Id or Remote-Id can be added to the session key.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

sap mac

Parameters 
sap —
Includes the SAP as part of the IPoE session key. The sap parameter is mandatory and cannot be removed from the key
mac—
Includes the MAC address as part of the IPoE session key. The mac parameter is mandatory and cannot be removed from the key
cid—
Optionally adds the DHCPv4 Relay Agent Circuit-Id (Option 82, sub Option 1) and DHCPv6 Interface-Id (Option 18) field to the IPoE session key
rid—
Optionally adds the DHCPv4 Relay Agent Remote-Id (Option 82, sub Option 2) and DHCPv6 Remote-Id (Option 37) field to the IPoE session key. For DHCPv6, the enterprise number is excluded from the key.

sap and mac are mandatory parameters while cid and rid are optional and mutually exclusive. Valid IPoE session key parameters are: sap mac, sap mac cid and sap mac rid.

session-timeout

Syntax 
session-timeout timeout
no session-timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command defines the time in seconds between 1 second and 360 days before the IPoE session will be disconnected. The default value is unlimited session timeout.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no session-timeout

Parameters 
timeout—
Specifies the session timeout in seconds
Values—
1 to 31104000

 

sap

Syntax 
sap sap-id [create] [capture-sap]
Context 
config>service>vpls
Description 

This command declares a given SAP as a primary (or secondary) VPLS port.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
capture-sap—
Specifies a capturing SAP in which triggering packets will be sent to the CPM. Non-triggering packets captured by the capture SAP will be dropped. This parameter applies to the 7450 ESS or 7750 SR only.
create—
Specifies to create a SAP instance. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context

ipoe-session

Syntax 
[no] ipoe-session
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
Description 

This command configures IPoE session parameters.

force-auth

Syntax 
force-auth [cid-change] [rid-change]
force-auth disabled
no force-auth
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

By default, if the circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id in the IPoE session re-authentication trigger packet (such as a DHCP renewal) is not empty and different from the circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id stored in the IPoE session data, a forced re-authentication is performed, ignoring the configured min-auth-interval. This default behavior can be changed with this command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default behavior.

Default 

force-auth cid-change rid-change force-auth disabled on wlan-gw group interfaces

Parameters 
cid-change —
Perform a forced re-authentication upon a circuit-id/interface-id change. An empty circuit-id/interface-id is not considered a change
rid-change —
Perform a forced re-authentication upon a remote-id change. an empty remote-id is not considered a change. For DHCPv6, the enterprise number is excluded from the comparison.
disabled —
Specifies that the min-auth-interval never is ignored. The system does not perform a forced re-authentication upon a circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id change.

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy policy-name
no ipoe-session-policy
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the IPoE session policy applicable for this group interface or capture SAP.

On WLAN GW group interfaces, it is not possible to change this value.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ipoe-session-policy ipoe-session-policy default on WLAN GW group interfaces

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the IPoE session policy name up to 32 characters in length

min-auth-interval

Syntax 
min-auth-interval [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
min-auth-interval infinite
no min-auth-interval
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

Re-authentication for IPoE sessions enable dynamic policy changes.

This command configures the maximum frequency of re-authentications by specifying a minimum interval between two non-forced authentications for the same IPoE session.

A forced authentication is by default triggered by a circuit-id, interface-id or remote-id change (see the force-auth command).

Re-authentications are, by default, disabled and can be enabled by configuring a min-auth-interval.

Setting the min-auth-interval to zero seconds will always re-authenticate on each trigger packet.

The no form of the command reverts to the default behavior.

Default 

infinite

Parameters 
days
Specifies the min number of days between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 365

 

hours
Specifies the min number of hours between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 23

 

minutes
Specifies the min number of minutes between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 59

 

seconds
Specifies the min number of seconds between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 59

 

infinite —
Does not perform non-forced re-authentications for IPoE sessions (default)

radius-session-timeout

Syntax 
radius-session-timeout {backwards-compatible | ignore | absolute}
no radius-session-timeout
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies how to interpret the session-timeout coming from a RADIUS VSA in an Access-Accept or CoA message.

The value of this command can only be changed on wlan-gw group interfaces.

The no form of this command to resets the default behavior.

Default 

absolute (backward compatible on wlan-gw group interfaces)

Parameters 
backwards-compatible —
Specifies that the VSA will be interpreted as an IPv4 lease time if the Alc-Lease-Time attribute is not present and an absolute timeout otherwise. The VSA will be treated the same as for non-ipoe session DHCP hosts
ignore —
Specifies that the VSA meaning is irrelevant for IPoE session and should be ignored
absolute —
Specifies that the VSA would be treated as a timeout starting from the moment the IPoE session is set up

sap-session-limit

Syntax 
sap-session-limit sap-session-limit
no sap-session-limit
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the number of IPoE sessions per SAP allowed for this group-interface

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
sap-session-limit —
Specifies the number of allowed IPoE sessions
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071 131071 on wlan-gw group interfaces

 

session-limit

Syntax 
session-limit session-limit
no session-limit
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the number of IPoE sessions allowed for this group interface or retail subscriber interface.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
session-limit—
Specifies the number of allowed IPoE sessions
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071
1 – 500000 (retail subscriber interface)

 

user-db

Syntax 
user-db local-user-db-name
no user-db
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command configures the local user database to use for IPoE session authentication.

When configured on a capture SAP, the group interface must have the same local user database configured.

On a wlan-gw group interface, the no form of this command indicates that the user database will be picked from the following sources in the order shown:

  1. dhcp
  2. ipv6>dhcp6
  3. ipv6>router-solicit

If no user database can be found in any of these locations, processing continues as if no user database was configured. This behavior is for backwards compatibility reasons only; when using a LUDB, it should be explicitly added to the IPoE session configuration.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no user-db

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the local user database name up to 32 characters in length

shutdown

Syntax 
[no] shutdown
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

The shutdown command enables or disables IPoE session management on a group interface or capture SAP.

A shutdown of the IPoE session CLI hierarchy on a group-interface will clear all active IPoE sessions on that interface, resulting in a deletion of all corresponding subscriber hosts.

On wlan-gw group interfaces it is not possible to disable an IPoE session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

shutdown no shutdown on wlan-gw group interfaces

9.25.2.1.3. SHCV Policy Commands

shcv-policy

Syntax 
shcv-policy name [create]
no shcv-policy name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures a Subscriber Host Connectivity Verification (SHCV) policy. An SHCV policy can be applied to both the subscriber management group interface and VPLS instances. All SHCV-related features inside a group interface and a VPLS service will follow the configuration specified in the SHCV policy. The SHCV policy and the SHCV configuration on a group interface are mutually exclusive. Only one can be applied to the group interface.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the SHCV policy, up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

layer-3

Syntax 
layer-3
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior parameters for IES and VPRN services.

source-ip-origin

Syntax 
source-ip-origin {interface | vrrp}
no source-ip-origin
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>layer-3
Description 

This command selects the source IP address to be used for SHCV messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
interface—
Specifies to use the interface IP as the source address of SHCV
vrrp—
Specifies to use the VRRP configured IP as the source address of SHCV

periodic

Syntax 
periodic
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure periodic SHCV properties for the subscriber management group-interface. This tool will periodically scan all known DHCP hosts only and perform unicast ARP/NS requests. The subscriber host connectivity verification will maintain state (connected vs. not-connected) for all hosts.

action

Syntax 
action {alarm | remove}
no action
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the action to take when the periodic connectivity verification failed.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

alarm

Parameters 
alarm—
Raises an alarm indicating that the host is disconnected
remove—
Raises an alarm and releases all allocated resources (addresses, prefixes, queues, table entries, and so on). Static hosts are removed.

interval

Syntax 
interval minutes
no interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command specifies the time interval which all known sources should be verified. The actual rate is dependent on the number of known hosts and intervals.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

30 minutes

Parameters 
minutes—
Specifies the interval, in minutes, between periodic connectivity checks
Values—
1 to 6000

 

retry-count

Syntax 
retry-count [count]
no retry-count
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the number of retransmissions.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1 — For trigger-type ip-conflict, host-limit-exceeded and mobility

10 — For trigger-type inactivity and MAC learning

Parameters 
count
Specifies the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification
Values—
2 to 29

 

timeout

Syntax 
timeout seconds
no timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the timeout before a retransmission in triggered connectivity verification.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

10

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the timeout, in seconds, before a retransmission in triggered connectivity verification
Values—
10 to 60

 

trigger

Syntax 
trigger trigger-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enables to context to configure SHCV triggers.

Parameters 
trigger-type—
Specifies the trigger SHCV properties for the subscriber management group-interface.
Values—
ip-conflict — Upon detecting an IP conflict for the new host, a trigger SHCV is sent using a unicast ARP/NS. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
host-limit-exceeded — Upon exceeding the host-limit for (sla-profile, ipoe-session sap-session-limit, ipoe-session session-limit, and arp-host), a trigger SHCV is sent. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
inactivity — A trigger SHCV is sent to the idle host to verify the host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system.
mobility — Detects detects an IP or MAC conflict between different SAPs. Upon detecting a MAC or an IP conflict, a trigger SHCV is sent. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
mac-learning — Specifies the trigger SHCV properties to learn the MAC address of static hosts. Upon a no shutdown, a trigger SHCV is sent to the host to learn the host’s MAC address.

 

retry-count

Syntax 
retry-count [count]
no retry-count
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>trigger
Description 

This command configures the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
count
Specifies the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification
Values—
1 to 29

 

timeout

Syntax 
timeout seconds
no timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>trigger
Description 

This command configures the timeout before a retransmission.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1 for trigger-type ip-conflict, host-limit-exceeded and mobility

2 for trigger-type inactivity and mac-learning

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the retry timeout in seconds
Values—
1 to 60

 

vpls

Syntax 
vpls service-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in VPLS services. Refer to the Layer 2 Service Guide for VPLS service command syntax and descriptions.

vprn

Syntax 
vprn service-id
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in VPRN services. Refer to the Layer 3 Services Guide for VPRN service command syntax and descriptions.

ies

Syntax 
ies service-id
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in IES services. Refer to the Layer 3 Services Guide for IES service command syntax and descriptions.

shcv-policy-ipv4

Syntax 
shcv-policy-ipv4 name
no shcv-policy-ipv4
Context 
config>service>vpls
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>ies>if
config>service>vprn>if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the shcv-policy to be used exclusive for IPv4 subscriber hosts. The shcv-policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

shcv-policy-ipv6

Syntax 
shcv-policy-ipv6 name
no shcv-policy-ipv6
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the SHCV policy to be used exclusive for IPv6 subscriber hosts. The policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

shcv-policy

Syntax 
shcv-policy name
no shcv-policy
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the SHCV policy to be used for both IPv4 and IPv6 subscriber hosts. The policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

source-ip

Syntax 
source-ip ip-address
no source-ip
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>vpls
Description 

This command configures the IPv4 address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no source-ip

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IPv4 address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service

source-mac

Syntax 
source-mac ieee-address
no source-mac
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>vpls
Description 

Specifies the MAC address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no source-mac

Parameters 
ieee-address—
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address in the xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx or xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx format

9.25.2.1.16. Show Commands

Note:

The command outputs in the following section are examples only; actual displays may differ depending on supported functionality and user configuration.

diameter-peer-policy

Syntax 
diameter-peer-policy [peer-policy-name]
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name peer peer-name [statistics]
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name client-side-peer-ip ip-address port tcp-port [statistics]
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays diameter peer policy information and diameter peer information and statistics. For the diameter proxy, the incoming peer can be specified with an IP address and port number.

Parameters 
peer-policy-name—
Specifies the diameter peer policy name, up to 32 characters in length
peer-name —
Specifies the diameter peer name, up to 32 characters in length
ip address —
Specifies the IP address of the incoming peer (client side) of a diameter proxy
tcp-port —
Specifies the TCP port number of the incoming peer (client side) of a diameter proxy
statistics —
Displays the diameter peer statistics with details per diameter application, per message type, and per direction (rx/ tx)
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA Diameter peer policy information.

Sample Output
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1
===============================================================================
Last Mgmt Change      : 01/07/2016 20:05:12
Applications          : gy
Role                  : client
Description           : Diamater peer policy - gy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Diameter Config Values
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Origin Host           : bng.domain.com
Origin Realm          : domain.com
Source IPv4 Address   : 192.0.2.51
Source IPv6 Address   : N/A
Router                : Base               Transaction Timer  : 30 (default)
Watchdog Timer        : 30 (default)       Connection Timer   : 30 (default)
Vendor Support        : 3GPP (default)
Python Policy         : py-policy-diam-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Peer Name            Oper  PSM State     Susp  Cooldown  Pref  Order  Pri/Sec
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
peer-1               Yes   I-Open        No    -         30    1      Primary
peer-2               No    Closed        No    -         50    -      -
===============================================================================
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1" peer "peer-1"
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1
===============================================================================
Peer IP address        : 172.16.1.1
Last Mgmt Change       : 01/07/2016 20:05:12
Peer Operational       : Yes              Watchdog Algorithm Active   : Yes
Peer State Machine     : I-Open           Watchdog Answer Pending     : No
Connection Timer  (Tc) : -                Connection Suspended        : No
Transaction Timer (Tt) : -                Cooldown Sequence Pending   : No
Watchdog Timer    (Tw) : 17               Cooldown Sequence Active    : No
Primary/Secondary Peer : Primary          Cooldown Sequence Progress  : -
Preference Order       : 1                Peer Removal Pending        : No
Pending Messages       : 0
===============================================================================
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1" peer "peer-1" statistics
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1 (statistics)
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer             : peer-1
Time statistics cleared   : 01/07/2016 20:05:10
===============================================================================
                                      Request     Answer    Request     Answer
                                           Tx         Rx         Rx         Tx
===============================================================================
Aggregates
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                       1          1          0          0
Failed                                      0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 0 (Base)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Capabilities-Exchange                       1          1          0          0
Disconnect-Peer                             0          0          0          0
Device-Watchdog                             0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 1 (NASREQ)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Authorization-Authentication                0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 4 (Gy)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Credit-Control (Initial)                    0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Update)                     0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Termination)                0          0          0          0
Re-Auth                                     0          0          0          0
Abort-Session                               0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 16777238 (Gx)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Credit-Control (Initial)                    0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Update)                     0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Termination)                0          0          0          0
Re-Auth                                     0          0          0          0
Abort-Session                               0          0          0          0
===============================================================================

Table 87 provides a description of the counters in the output of the show aaa diameter-peer-policy command. and Table 88 provides the failure reasons for the aggregate Failed counter (Request Rx and Answer Rx).

Table 87:  show aaa diameter-peer-policy Field Descriptions 

Counter

Counts  

Aggregates Total

Request Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully transmitted diameter request messages (all applications, all message types)

Answer Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully received diameter answer messages (all applications, all message types)

Request Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully received diameter request messages (all applications, all message types)

Answers Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully transmitted diameter answer messages (all applications, all message types)

Aggregates Failed

Request Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all request messages that could not be sent for internal reasons, such as TCP socket error (for example, congestion), failure reported to application (for example, no retries left)

Dropped by Python — Timeouts (requests for which no answer was received within the configured timeout interval)

Answer Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all Answer messages that failed to be successfully decoded, such as such as invalid header length or a violation against the Command Code Format (CCF) specification.

See Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters for more information.

Request Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all Request messages that failed to be successfully decoded, such as invalid header length or a violation against the Command Code Format (CCF) specification.

See Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters for more information.

Answers Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all answer messages that could not be sent for internal reasons such as TCP socket error (for example, congestion).

Dropped by Python

Application ID id message type

Request Tx

Successfully transmitted diameter request messages for the corresponding application and message type

Answer Rx

Successfully received diameter answer messages for the corresponding application and message type

Request Rx

Successfully received diameter request messages for the corresponding application and message type

Answers Tx

Successfully transmitted diameter answer messages for the corresponding application and message type

Table 88:  Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters 

Role

Failed reasons 

Proxy

Proxy (message length too short / too long / version unsupported)

Consistency check failed: header size, message length, illegal flag combination, AVP header too small, AVP present but not allowed (base RFC messages), and so on

Not a base message

Not a request

Tx overload (message received to be send to client)

Dropped by python

Failed to create answer

No transaction (answer to server, but request is not found - 5 min.)

Diameter base / Diameter application

Message dropped due to result code

Message too big / too small

Dropped by python

Consistency check failed

end-2-end mismatch hop-to-hop command code (answer/request mismatch)

Cool down sequence drop

cc error request

Application id in header error

T bit in header

isa-radius-policy

Syntax 
isa-radius-policy policy-name
isa-radius-policy policy-name associations
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays ISA RADIUS policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information about the specified ISA RADIUS policy
associations—
Displays the information associated with the ISA RADIUS server policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA ISA RADIUS policy information.

Sample Output
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show aaa isa-radius-policy "ZiggoAAA_DRP_ISAPlcy" 
===============================================================================
Status for ISA RADIUS server policy "ZiggoAAA_DRP_ISAPlcy"
===============================================================================
Server 1, group 1, member 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Purposes Up                                     : accounting authentication
Source IP address                               : 172.18.128.33
Acct Tx Requests                                : 2469931
Acct Tx Retries                                 : 320
Acct Tx Timeouts                                : 160
Acct Rx Replies                                 : 2469471
Auth Tx Requests                                : 16417061
Auth Tx Retries                                 : 7169
Auth Tx Timeouts                                : 2922
Auth Rx Replies                                 : 16406973
CoA Rx Requests                                 : 0
 
Table 89:  Subscriber ISA RADIUS Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Purposes Up

Indicates the RADIUS services that are up and running, and fully operational for this server.

Source IP address

Indicates the IP address of the RADIUS server.

Acct Tx Requests

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests transmitted.

Acct TX Retries

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction request retries.

Acct TX Timeouts

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that have timed out.

Acct RX Replies

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction responses received.

Auth Tx Requests

Indicates the number of authentication requests transmitted.

Auth Tx Retries

Indicates the number of authentication request retries.

Auth Tx Timeouts

Indicates the number of RADIUS authentication requests that have timed out for the policy.

CoA RX Requests

Indicates the number of Change-of-Authorization message responses received.

radius-configuration

Syntax 
radius-configuration
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays RADIUS configuration information.

Output 

The following output is an example of AAA RADIUS configuration information.

Sample Output
# show aaa radius-configuration 
===============================================================================
RADIUS configuration
===============================================================================
CoA Port                    : 3799
===============================================================================

Table 89 provides a description of the counters in the output of the show aaa isa-radius-policy command.

Table 90:  AAA ISA RADIUS Policy Field Descriptions  

Label

Description

CoA Port

Displays the RADIUS Change of Authorization (CoA) port.

 

radius-server-policy

Syntax 
radius-server-policy policy-name [acct-on-off]
radius-server-policy policy-name associations
radius-server-policy policy-name msg-buffer-stats
radius-server-policy policy-name statistics
radius-server-policy [acct-on-off]
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays RADIUS server policy configuration information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information for the specified RADIUS server policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the RADIUS server policy.
msg-buffer-stats—
Displays statistics related to the RADIUS messages that are buffered for each specified RADIUS server policy
statistics—
Displays statistics for the specified RADIUS server policy
act-on-off—
Displays the admin state of the acct-on-off feature
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA RADIUS server policy information.

Sample Output
Table 91:  Subscriber RADIUS Server Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Tx transaction requests

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests transmitted.

Rx transaction responses

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction responses received.

Transaction requests timed out

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that have timed out.

Transaction requests send failed

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that could not be transmitted.

Packet retries

Indicates the number of times a RADIUS request packet was retransmitted to a server.

Transaction requests send rejected

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that were not transmitted due to unacceptable configuration.

Authentication requests failed

Indicates the number of authentication failures for this policy.

Accounting requests failed

Indicates the number of accounting failures for this policy.

Ratio of access-reject over auth responses

Indicates the ratio of access-rejects in the auth responses for this policy.

Transaction success ratio

Indicates the transaction success ratio for this policy.

Transaction failure ratio

Indicates the transaction failure ratio for this policy.

Statistics last reset at

Indicated the date and time at which the statistics for this policy were last reset.

*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show aaa radius-server-policy "ZiggoAAA_anycast" statistics 
===============================================================================
RADIUS server policy "ZiggoAAA_anycast" statistics
===============================================================================
Tx transaction requests                         : 24818681
Rx transaction responses                        : 24817329
Transaction requests timed out                  : 1351
Transaction requests send failed                : 0
Packet retries                                  : 12410
Transaction requests send rejected              : 0
Authentication requests failed                  : 303530
Accounting requests failed                      : 0
Ratio of access-reject over auth responses      : 13%
Transaction success ratio                       : 99%
Transaction failure ratio                       : 1%
Statistics last reset at                        : 05/21/2015 01:11:39

wpp

Syntax 
wpp portal-group name
wpp [portal-group name] [host ip-address] hosts
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays information about the specified WPP portal group or the WPP hosts controlled by the WPP portal group.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the WPP portal group up to 32 characters in length
ip-address—
Specifies the IP address of the WPP host
hosts—
Output 

The following output is an example of WPP portal group or WPP host information.

Sample Output
show aaa wpp portal-group "test" 
===============================================================================
wpp portal group "test"
===============================================================================
administrative state                  : in-service
controlled router                     : 500
number of enabled interfaces          : 1
triggered hosts                       : disabled
last management change                : 01/02/2017 19:02:11
===============================================================================

ancp-policy

Syntax 
ancp-policy [policy-name]
ancp-policy policy-name association
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information for the specified ANCP policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the ANCP policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP policy information.

Sample Output
A:cses-E11>config>subscr-mgmt>ancp# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy "test"
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "test"
===============================================================================
I. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
I. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
I. Rate Monitor        : 63360 kbps
I. Rate Monitor Alarm  : Yes
I. Rate Modify         : N/A
 
E. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
E. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
E. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
E. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
E. Rate Modify         : N/A
 
Port Down : N/A
 
Last Mgmt Change: 02/13/2013 19:15:28
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11>config>subscr-mgmt>ancp# 

ancp-string

Syntax 
ancp-string
ancp-string ancp-string
ancp-string customer customer-id site customer-site-name
ancp-string sap sap-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) string information.

Parameters 
ancp-string—
Specifies an Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) string up to 63 characters in length
customer-id
Specifies an existing customer ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

customer-site-name
Specifies an existing customer site name up to 32 characters in length
sap-id
Displays ANCP string information for the specified SAP ID
Values—

<sap-id>

null

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | aps-id>

dot1q

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | aps-id | pw-id>:qtag1

qinq

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | pw-id>:qtag1.qtag2

atm

<port-id | aps-id>[:vpi/vci | vpi | vpi1.vpi2 | cp.conn-prof-id]

cp

keyword

conn-prof-id

[1 to 8000]

frame

<port-id | aps-id>:dlci

cisco-hdlc

slot/mda/port.channel

cem

slot/mda/port.channel

ima-grp

<bundle-id>[:vpi/vci | vpi | vpi1.vpi2 | cp.conn-prof-id]

cp

keyword

conn-prof-id

[1 to 8000]

port-id

slot/mda/port[.channel]

bundle-id

bundle-<type>-slot/mda.<bundle-num>

bundle

keyword

type

ima | fr | ppp

bundle-num

[1 to 336]

bpgrp-id

bpgrp-<type>-<bpgrp-num>

bpgrp

keyword

type

ima | ppp

bpgrp-num

[1 to 2000]

aps-id

aps-<group-id>[.channel]

aps

keyword

group-id

[1 to 64]

ccag-id

ccag-<id>.<path-id>[cc-type]:<cc-id>

ccag

keyword

id

[1 to 8]

path-id

[a | b]

cc-type

[.sap-net |.net-sap]

cc-id

[0 to 4094]

eth-tunnel

eth-tunnel-<id>[:<eth-tun-sap-id>]

id

[1 to 1024]

eth-tun-sap-id

[0 to 4094]

lag-id

lag-<id>

lag

keyword

id

[1 to 800]

pw-id

pw-<id>

pw

keyword

id

[1 to 10239]

qtag1

[0 to 4094]

qtag2

[* | 0 to 4094]

vpi

[0 to 4095] (NNI)

[0 to 255] (UNI)

vci

[1 | 2 | 5 to 65535]

dlci

[16 to 1022]

tunnel-id

tunnel-<id>.<private | public>:<tag>

tunnel

keyword

id

[1 to 16]

tag

[0 to 4094]

 

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP string information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string "ANCP-0000003-0000001"
========================================================================
ANCP-String "ANCP-0000003-0000001"
========================================================================
Type       : SUB - "4AACAHCU74"
State      : Up                 Ancp Policy: N/A
I. Rate    : 129 kbps           E. Rate    : 130 kbps
Adj I. Rate: N/A                Adj E. Rate: N/A
Act I. Rate: N/A                Act E. Rate: N/A
Service Id : 50 (VPRN)
Group      : linux
Neighbor   : 10.0.0.2:34885
Persist Key: N/A
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Actual-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream              : 129 kbits/s
Actual-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream            : 130 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream             : 131 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream           : 132 kbits/s
Attainable-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream          : 133 kbits/s
Attainable-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream        : 134 kbits/s
Maximum-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream             : 135 kbits/s
Maximum-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream           : 136 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Low-Power-Data-Rate-Upstream   : 137 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Low-Power-Data-Rate-Downstream : 138 kbits/s
Maximum-Interleaving-Delay-Upstream        : 139 ms
Actual-Interleaving-Delay-Upstream         : 140 ms
Maximum-Interleaving-Delay-Downstream      : 141 ms
Actual-Interleaving-Delay-Downstream       : 142 ms
DSL-Line-State                             : 2 (IDLE)
Access-Loop-Encapsulation                  : 16909056 (0x01020300)
========================================================================
 

authentication

Syntax 
authentication policy-name association
authentication [policy-name]
authentication [policy-name] statistics
authentication coa-statistics
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber management RADIUS authentication policy information and statistics.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the subscriber management RADIUS authentication policy name, up to 32 characters in length, for which information is requested
association—
Displays SAP, interface, local user database host, AA and L2TP associations of this policy
coa-statistics—
Displays the overall statistics for incoming RADIUS Change of Authorization (CoA) messages and Disconnect Messages. For dropped requests, a counter for different drop reasons is available.
statistics—
Displays a list of policies with basic statistics (without specifying a policy name) or detailed statistics, including per-server statistics for the specified policy-name. These statistics apply only to the legacy RADIUS server configuration method where the servers are directly configured in the authentication policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management authentication information.

Sample Output
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
auth-policy-1                    Radius auth policy - servers
auth-policy-2                    Radius auth policy - radius-server-policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Authentication Policies : 2
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-2" 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy auth-policy-2
===============================================================================
Description          : Radius auth policy - radius-server-policy
Re-authentication    : Yes                 Username Format      : MAC Address
PPPoE Access Method  : PAP/CHAP            Username Mac-Format  : "aa:"
PPP-Username Oper    : None                
PPP-Domain-Name      : N/A
Username Oper        : None                
Domain-Name          : N/A
Acct-Stop-On-Fail    : 
RADIUS Server Policy : "aaa-server-policy-1"
Fallback Action      : deny                
Last Mgmt Change     : 06/24/2013 21:16:50 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include Radius Attributes
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Remote Id            : Yes                 Circuit Id           : Yes
NAS Port Id          : Yes                 NAS Identifier       : Yes
PPPoE Service Name   : Yes                 DHCP Vendor Class Id : Yes
Access Loop Options  : Yes                 MAC Address          : Yes
NAS Port Prefix      : None                NAS Port Suffix      : None
NAS-Port-Type        : Yes (standard)      Acct Session Id      : Host
Calling Station Id   : Yes (sap-string)    Called Station Id    : Yes
Tunnel Server Attr   : Yes                 DHCP Options         : Yes
NAS Port             : Yes                 
NAS Port Bits Spec   : *3s*1m*4p*12o*12i
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Servers
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Router               : management + Base   Source Address       : N/A
Access Algorithm     : Direct              Retry                : 3
Timeout (s)          : 5                   Hold down time (s)   : 30
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Index IP Address      Port  Pend-Req-Limit Out/Overload time (s) Oper State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Radius Servers configured.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Accept Radius Attributes
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Matching Entries
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Script Policies
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Access-Request          : "N/A"
Access-Accept           : "N/A"       
Change-of-Authorization : "N/A"
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-2" association 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy auth-policy-2
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Interface Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 3000 (VPRN)
 - If Name : group-int-ws-1-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db PPPoE Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db : ludb-1
 - Host : host-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db DHCP Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db : ludb-1
 - Host : default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application Assurance Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
No associated L2TP groups found.
No associated L2TP tunnels found.
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication statistics 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy Statistics
===============================================================================
Policy Name                       Subscr. Pkts   Subscr. Pkts   Subscr. Pkts
                                  Authenticated  Rejected       Rejected
                                                                Send Failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
auth-policy-1                     0              0              0
auth-policy-2                     0              0              0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Authentication Policies : 2
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-1" statistics 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy Statistics
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy name                               : auth-policy-1
subscriber packets authenticated          : 0
subscriber packets rejected               : 0
subscriber packets rejected send failed   : 0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
radius server     requests  requests  requests  requests   requests requests
idx IP-address    accepted  rejected  no reply  md5 failed pending  send failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 172.16.1.1      0         0         0         0          0        0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication coa-statistics 
===============================================================================
Radius Notify Statistics    Change-Of-Authorization   Disconnect-Messages
===============================================================================
Requests Received             7                        10
Requests Accepted             5                        6
Requests Rejected             2                        4
Requests Dropped              0                        0
    No Auth Policy found      0                        0
    Invalid message           0                        0
    Out of resources          0                        0
    Authentication failure    0                        0
===============================================================================
 
Table 92:  Subscriber Authentication Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Requests Received

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests received.

Requests Accepted

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests accepted.

Requests Rejected

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected.

Requests Dropped

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests dropped.

No Auth Policy found

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests found.

Invalid message

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected because of decode errors.

Out of resources

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected due to lack of resources.

Authentication Failure

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests which do not have NAS-Port-ID or Framed-IP-Address set or have mismatched subscriber-id.

category-map

Syntax 
category-map [category-map]
category-map category-map subscribers
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays category map information.

With no parameters specified, a summary view of all configured category maps is displayed.

With the optional category-map name parameter specified, the detailed configuration of the specified category map name is displayed.

With the category-map subscribers parameters specified, all subscribers that have the specified category-map associated are displayed.

Parameters 
category-map
Specifies the category map name for which information is displayed
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management category map information.

Sample Output
Node# show subscriber-mgmt category-map "cat-map-1"
===============================================================================
Category Map: cat-map-1
===============================================================================
Description        : gy - time and volume
Credit Type        : volume             Credit Exh. Thresh.: 80%
Activity Thresh.   : 0 kb/s
Gx session level
usage monitoring   : false
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Category: cat-1-time
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Description        : Rating group for Time quota
Credit Type Over.  : none               Rating Group       : 11
OutOfCredit Action : none
Default Credit     : none
Ingress Queues     : 1
Egress Queues      : 1
Ingress Policers   : none
Egress Policers    : none
ExhCrdSvcLvl Pir   : none
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Category: cat-1-volume
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Description        : Rating group for Volume quota
Credit Type Over.  : none               Rating Group       : 12
OutOfCredit Action : none
Default Credit     : none
Ingress Queues     : 1
Egress Queues      : 1
Ingress Policers   : none
Egress Policers    : none
ExhCrdSvcLvl Pir   : 100
===============================================================================

diameter-application-policy

Syntax 
diameter-application-policy [name]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays Diameter application policy information.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be displayed
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management Diameter application policy information

Sample Output
# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
diameter-gx-policy-1             Diameter Gx policy
diameter-gy-policy-1             Diameter Gy policy
diameter-nasreq-policy-1         Diameter NASREQ policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of policies: 3
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Description                 : Diameter NASREQ policy
Session failover            : enabled
Failover handling           : continue
Peer policy                 : diameter-peer-policy-1
Application                 : nasreq
Tx timer (s)                : 10
Last management change      : 02/28/2015 14:53:49
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
NASREQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include AVP                 : nas-port-id
                              nas-port-type
NAS-Port-Id prefix type     : none
NAS-Port-Id suffix type     : user-string
NAS-Port-Id suffix          : @bng1
NAS-Port-Type type          : standard
 
User name format            : mac
User name operation         : no-operation
MAC address format          : aa:
Last management change      : 02/28/2015 14:53:49
===============================================================================
Interfaces using diameter-auth-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Interface-name                   Service-id Type
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
group-int-1-1                    1000       IES
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of interfaces: 1 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
VPLS SAP's with diameter-auth-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service    SAP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10         1/1/4:*.*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of SAP's: 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy "diamapppol_gx"
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policy "diamapppol_gx"
===============================================================================
Description                 : (Not Specified)
Session failover            : enabled
Failover handling           : retry-and-terminate
Peer policy                 : diampeerpol_gx
Application                 : gx
Tx timer (s)                : 10
Last management change      : 05/08/2015 05:55:59
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Gx
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include AVP                 : an-gw-address
Calling-Station-Id type     : mac
NAS-Port bits spec          : 0
NAS-Port-Id prefix type     : user-string
NAS-Port-Id prefix          : Testing
NAS-Port-Id suffix type     : circuit-id
NAS-Port-Type value         : 0
User-Equipment-Info         : mac
 
Subscription-Id-Data origin : subscriber-id
Subscription-Id-Data type   : e164
MAC address format          : aa:
Report IP address event     : enabled
CCR-t replay interval       : 60
Last management change      : 05/08/2015 06:54:27
 

diameter-session

Syntax 
diameter-session
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to display diameter session information.

ccrt-replay

Syntax 
ccrt-replay [session-id session-id] [diameter-application-policy name]
ccrt-replay summary
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>diam-session
Description 

This command displays information about diameter Gx sessions that are in Credit-Control-Request Session-Terminate-Request (CCR-T) replay mode.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be deleted
session-id
Identifies a diameter session ID
summary—
Displays summarized information about CCRT replay
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management CCR-T replay information.

Sample Output
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:21:46 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay session-id ro 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:21:27
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay summary 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Total Count   : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay diameter-application-
policy "diamapppol_gx" 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:18:49
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 

mac

Syntax 
mac all | ieee-address | unknown
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by MAC address.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors starting with the lowest MAC address
ieee-address—
Shows only the error of a specific MAC address
unknown—
Shows errors with unknown MAC addresses, such as for PPPoA subscribers
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management listed by MAC addresses.

Sample Output
*A:eng-BNG-2# show  subscriber-mgmt errors mac all
===============================================================================
Subscriber management errors
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:46.0
Service   : 1000
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:16.0
Service   : 1000
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
===============================================================================

sap

Syntax 
sap all | sap-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by SAP.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors starting with the lowest SAP index
sap-id—
Shows only the error of a specific SAP index
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management errors listed by SAP.

Sample Output
A:BNG-2# show  subscriber-mgmt errors sap all
===============================================================================
Subscriber management errors
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:46.0
Service   : 1000
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:16.0
Service   : 1000
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
===============================================================================

sdp

Syntax 
sdp all | sdp-id:vc-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by SDP.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors beginning with the lowest SDP index
sdp-id:vc-id—
Shows only the error of a specific SDP index

unknown-origin

Syntax 
unknown-origin
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command lists errors of an unknown origin. Errors shown do have a corresponding SAP ID or a SDP ID.

explicit-subscriber-map

Syntax 
explicit-subscriber-map
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays explicit subscriber mappings.

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management explicit subscriber map information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# explicit-subscriber-map
===============================================================================
Explicit Subscriber Map
===============================================================================
Key                              Sub profile
                                 SLA profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_ident_A_1                    sub_prof80
                                 sla_prof80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Explicit Subscriber Mappings : 1
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt#

host-lockout-policy

Syntax 
host-lockout-policy
host-lockout-policy policy-name association
host-lockout-policy policy-name
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state sap sap-id [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [circuit-id circuit-id] [sap sap-id] [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [mac ieee-address] [sap sap-id] [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [remote-id remote-id] [sap sap-id] [summary]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays host lockout policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies a specific subscriber host lockout policy name up to 32 characters
association—
Specifies to display the association of the host lockout policy
lockout-state—
Specifies to display information for hosts in a specific lockout state
Values—
all, active, graceful

 

sap sap-id
Specifies to display SAP ID information
circuit-id circuit-id—
Specifies to display circuit ID information. The circuit-id is 256 characters maximum.
mac ieee-address
Specifies to display MAC address information up to 30 characters in length
remote-id remote-id—
Specifies to display remote ID information up to 256 characters in length
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management host lockout policy information.

Sample Output
*A:cses-E11# show subscriber-mgmt host-lockout-policy
===============================================================================
Host Lockout Policies
===============================================================================
Lockout Policy                   Last Mgmt Change
  Lockout Time Min                 Lockout Time Max
Description
  Lockout Reset Time               Max Lockout Hosts
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
test                             04/20/2012 19:51:02
  10                               3600
test
  60                               100
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11# 
 
 
*A:cses-E11# show subscriber-mgmt host-lockout-policy "test"
===============================================================================
Host Lockout Policy "test"
===============================================================================
Description                        test
Last Mgmt Change                   04/20/2012 19:51:02
Lockout time min                   10
Lockout time max                   3600
Lockout reset time                 60
Max lockout hosts                  100
Host key                           all
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11#

igmp-policy

Syntax 
igmp-policy
igmp-policy policy-name association
igmp-policy policy-name
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays IGMP policy information and only applies to the 7750 SR.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies an existing IGMP policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the IGMP policy
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management IGMP policy information.

Sample Output
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policies
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy                                                                    
  Import Policy                    Admin Version                    
Description                                                                    
  Num Subscribers                  Host Max Groups                  
  Fast Leave                                
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
pol1                                                                           
                                   3
  2                                0
  fast-leave                       
pol2                                                                           
                                   3
  0                                0
  fast-leave                       
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C# 
 
 
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy "pol1" 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy pol1
===============================================================================
Import Policy                         : 
Admin Version                         : 3
Num Subscribers                       : 2
Host Max Group                        : 0
Fast Leave                            : yes
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C#
 
 
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy "pol1" association 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy pol1 Associations
===============================================================================
sub_1                                                                          
sub_2                                                                          
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of subscriber(s): 2
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C#

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy ipoe-session-policy-name [association]
ipoe-session-policy
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays IPoE session policy information.

Parameters 
ipoe-session-policy-name—
Specifies the IPoE session policy name up to 32 characters in length
association—
Displays the interface and captures SAPs that reference the IPoE session policy
Output 

The following output is an example of IPoE session policy information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt ipoe-session-policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
IPoE Session Policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Description           : IPoE policy
Last Mgmt Change      : 02/28/2015 11:51:25
Session Key           : sap-mac
Session Timeout       : unlimited
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt ipoe-session-policy "ipoe-policy-1" association
===============================================================================
IPoE Session Policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPoE Interface Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 1000 (IES)
 - group-int-1-1
Service-Id : 2000 (VPRN)
 - group-int-1-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Capture SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 10 (VPLS)
- 1/1/4:*.*
===============================================================================
 

local-user-db

Syntax 
local-user-db local-user-db-name association [dhcp] [ppp] [12tp] [radius] [pppoe] [dhcp6] [capture-sap] [rtr-solicit] [wpp] [ipoe]
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-all-hosts
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-host ipoe-host-name
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-unmatched-hosts
local-user-db [local-user-db-name]
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-all-hosts
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-host pppoe-host-name
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-unmatched-hosts
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays local user database information.

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the name of a local user database up to 32 characters in length
association—
Displays entities associated with the specified local user database
dhcp—
Displays DHCP information
ppp—
Displays PPP information
l2tp—
Displays L2TP information
radius—
Displays RADIUS information
pppoe—
Displays PPPoE information
dhcp6—
Displays DHCP6 information
capture-sap—
Displays capture SAP information
rt-solicit—
Displays RT solicit information
wpp—
Displays WPP information
ipoe—
Displays IPoE information
ipoe-all-hosts—
Displays IPoE all hosts information
ipoe-host-name
Displays IPoE host name information
ipoe-unmatched-hosts—
Displays IPoE unmatched hosts information
ppp-all-hosts—
Displays information about PPP all hosts
pppoe-hosts—
Displays information about PPPoE hosts
pppoe-unmatched-hosts—
Displays information about PPPoE unmatched hosts
Output 

The following output is an example of local user database information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db
===============================================================================
Local User Databases
===============================================================================
Name                             Admin Host  Description
                                 State Count
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
database01                       Down  1
database02 Provider001/Class0002 Down  0     This is a long testdescription wi*
test                             Down  2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Local User Databases : 3     Number of Hosts : 3
===============================================================================
* indicates that the corresponding row element may have been truncated.
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db database01
===============================================================================
Local User Database "database01"
===============================================================================
Admin State          : Down
Last Mgmt Change     : 11/08/2007 12:27:36
Host Count           : 1
DHCP Match Types     : circ-id
DHCP CircId Mask Pfx : test
DHCP CircId Mask Sfx : N/A
PPPoE Match Types    : N/A
PPPoE CircId Mask Pfx: N/A
PPPoE CircId Mask Sfx: N/A
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db database01 dhcp-all-hosts
===============================================================================
Local User Database "database01" DHCP hosts
===============================================================================
Name                             Admin     Matched objects
                                 State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
host001                          Down      -
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of DHCP Hosts : 1
===============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" dhcp-host host001
===============================================================================
DHCP Host "host001"
===============================================================================
Admin State          : Down
Last Mgmt Change     : 11/08/2007 12:13:42
 
Host Identification
 Circuit Id          : N/A
 Mac Address         : N/A
 Remote Id           : N/A
 Sap Id              : N/A
 Service Id          : N/A
 String              : N/A
 Option 60           : N/A
 System Id           : N/A
 
Matched Objects      : N/A
 
Address              : N/A
 
Identification Strings
 Subscriber Id       : N/A
 SLA Profile String  : N/A
 Sub Profile String  : N/A
 App Profile String  : N/A
 ANCP String         : N/A
 Inter Destination Id: N/A
===============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" dhcp-unmatched-hosts
==============================================================================
Local User Database "database01" DHCP unmatched hosts
==============================================================================
Name                              Reason      Duplicate Host
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
host002                           No match    N/A                             
host003                           Duplicate   host001                         
host004                           No match    N/A                             
host005                           Duplicate   host001                         
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of DHCP Unmatched Hosts : 4
==============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" association
===============================================================================
DHCP Servers where database01 is used
===============================================================================
Server-Name                      Router-Name                                   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
dhcpS1                           vprn1000                                      
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Server(s): 1
===============================================================================
Interfaces where database01 is used for authentication
===============================================================================
Interface-Name                   Service-Id Type                               
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Interface(s): 0
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" association dhcp
===============================================================================
DHCP Servers where database01 is used
===============================================================================
Server-Name                      Router-Name                                   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
dhcpS1                           vprn1000                                      
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Server(s): 1
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
===============================================================================
 
# show subscriber-mgmt local-user-db "ludb-1" association ipoe
===============================================================================
IPoE client interface associations for ludb-1
===============================================================================
Interface-Name                           Svc-Id     Type
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
group-int-1-1                            1000       IES
group-int-1-1                            2000       VPRN
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Interface(s): 2
===============================================================================
===============================================================================
Capture SAP associations for ludb-1
===============================================================================
SAP                              Svc-Id     Type   PPPoE PPP IPoE DHCP DHCP6 RS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4:1202.*                     10         VPLS   y         y    y    y     y
1/1/4:*.*                        10         VPLS   y         y    y    y     y
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of SAP(s): 2
===============================================================================
 

msap-policy

Syntax 
msap-policy [msap-policy-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays Managed SAP policy information.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Displays information about the specifies MSAP policy
association—
Displays information related to the specifies MSAP policy
Output 

The following output is an example of managed SAP policy information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# msap-policy
===============================================================================
Managed SAP Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Num    Description
                                 MSAPs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
test                             0      (Not Specified)
test 1                           0      (Not Specified)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of MSAP Policies : 2
Number of MSAPs         : 0
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 

pcc-rule

Syntax 
pcc-rule
pcc-rule monitoring-key key detail
pcc-rule rule-id id detail
pcc-rule rule-name rule-name
pcc-rule rule-name rule-name detail
pcc-rule summary
pcc-rule monitoring-key key
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays a list of pcc-rules and associated monitoring keys in the system.

Parameters 
key
Displays details about a specific monitoring-key
id
Displays details about a specific pcc-rule
rule-name
Displays information about a specific pcc-rule
summary—
Displays summarized information for a active rules in the system
key
Displays information about a specific monitoring-key
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management PCC rule information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule summary 
===============================================================================
PCC Rules Summary
===============================================================================
Nbr Active PCC Rules    : 26 / 1023
Nbr Active Combinations
  IPv4 Filter           : 2 / 4095
  IPv6 Filter           : 0 / 4095
  Egress Qos            : 1 / 4095
  Ingress Qos           : 1 / 4095
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule 
===============================================================================
                       Id      Dir  ForwardAction         QosAction
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
name      : RULE_egress_FC
monitorKey: -
                       29      egr  -                      fc
name      : RULE_egress_UM
monitorKey: um_RULE_egress_UM
                       34      egr  -                      monitor
name      : RULE_ingress_FC
monitorKey: -
                       37      ingr -                      fc
name      : RULE_ingress_UM
monitorKey: um_RULE_ingress_UM
                       50      ingr -                      monitor
name      : RULE_egress_DROP
monitorKey: -
                       28      egr  drop                  -
name      : RULE_ingress_RDR
monitorKey: -
                       49      ingr fwd nh4               -
name      : RULE_egress_UM_FC
monitorKey: um_RULE_egress_UM_FC
                       35      egr  -                      fc monitor
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule rule-name "RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR" detail 
===============================================================================
PCC Rules
===============================================================================
PCC rule name         : RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
PCC rule id           : 47
Monitoring key        : um_RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
Flow status           : Enabled
Nbr of Flows          : 1 (ingress)
HTTP-Redirect         : -
Next-Hop Redir. IPv4  : 10.10.10.10
Next-Hop Redir. IPv6  : -
QoS Ingr. CIR/PIR     : 1000 kbps / 2000 kbps
QoS Egr. CIR/PIR      : - / -
FC change             : h2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Flows
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Src. IP  : any                                    Src. Port: -
Dst. IP  : 75.24.24.17/32                         Dst. Port: -
Protocol : 6                                      DSCP     : cp60
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
 
 
show service active-subscribers pcc-rule subscriber "1/1/3:1.1|00:00:00:00:00:01" 
===============================================================================
Active Subscribers
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber 1/1/3:1.1|00:00:00:00:00:01 (subprof1)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(1) SLA Profile Instance sap:1/1/3:1.1 - sla:sla1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingr Qos Policy Override : 3:P2
Egr  Qos Policy Override : 2:P2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IP Address
                MAC Address       PPPoE-SID Origin
--------------------------------------------------------
22.1.0.1
                00:00:00:00:00:01 N/A       DHCP
--------------------------------------------------------
Ingr Filter Override : 5:P4
Egr  Filter Override : 6:P5
========================================================
Preference Rule Id   Rule Name
--------------------------------------------------------
0          28        RULE_egress_DROP
0          29        RULE_egress_FC
0          30        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT
0          31        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_FC
0          32        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_UM
0          33        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC
0          34        RULE_egress_UM
0          35        RULE_egress_UM_FC
0          36        RULE_ingress_DROP
0          37        RULE_ingress_FC
0          38        RULE_ingress_FC_HTTP
0          39        RULE_ingress_FC_RDR
0          40        RULE_ingress_HTTP
0          41        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT
0          42        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_FC
0          43        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_FC_RDR
0          44        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_RDR
0          45        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM
0          46        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC
0          47        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
0          48        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_RDR
0          49        RULE_ingress_RDR
0          50        RULE_ingress_UM
0          51        RULE_ingress_UM_FC
0          52        RULE_ingress_UM_FC_RDR
0          53        RULE_ingress_UM_RDR
========================================================
 
 

radius-accounting-policy

Syntax 
radius-accounting-policy name association
radius-accounting-policy [name]
radius-accounting-policy name statistics
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays RADIUS accounting policy information.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the RADIUS accounting policy name
association—
Displays parameters associated with this RADIUS accounting policy
statistics—
Displays statistics associated with this RADIUS accounting policy
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management RADIUS accounting policy information.

Sample Output
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show subscriber-mgmt radius-accounting-policy "ZiggoAcct1813" 
statistics 
===============================================================================
Radius Accounting Policy ZiggoAcct1813 Statistics
===============================================================================
Tx Requests      : 36035966           Rx Responses  : 36035966
Request Timeouts : 0                  Send Retries  : 2713
Send Failed      : 0                  
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Servers
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Index IP Address      Tx Reqs     Rx Resps    Req Timeouts Req Send Failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     172.18.129.36   9012635     9011762     873          0
2     172.18.129.37   9004736     9003814     922          0
3     172.18.129.68   9010236     9009925     311          0
4     172.18.129.69   9011115     9010465     650          0
===============================================================================
Table 93:  Subscriber RADIUS Accounting Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Tx Requests/TX Reqs

Displays the number of accounting requests transmitted for this policy.

Rx Responses/Rx Resps

Displays the number of accounting responses received for this policy.

Request Timeouts/Req Timeouts

Displays the number of accounting requests which have timed out for this policy.

Send Retries

Displays the number of retries to a different server for a single accounting request for this policy.

Send Failed

Req Send Failed

Displays how many accounting requests failed because the packet could not be sent out for this policy.

Radius Servers

Displays a table in which the statistics associated with this RADIUS accounting policy are broken down by individual RADIUS server.

The table columns are:

Index—displays the index number assigned to the RADIUS server. The index determines the sequence in which the servers are queried for authentication requests. Servers are queried in order from lowest to highest index.

IP Address—the address of the RADIUS server.

TX Reqs—see TX Requests in this table.

Rx Resps—see RX Responses in this table.

Req Timeouts—see Request Timeouts in this table.

Req Send Failed—see Send Failed in this table.

sla-profile

Syntax 
sla-profile [sla-profile-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays SLA profile information.

Parameters 
sla-profile-name—
Specifies an existing SLA profile name
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sla-profile-name.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management SLA profile information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile
===============================================================================
SLA Profiles
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sla_default
sla_prof100_VOIP
sla_prof110_VOIP
sla_prof120_VOIP
sla_prof130_VOIP
sla_prof140_VOIP
sla_prof230_VOIP
sla_prof80
sla_prof80_VOIP
sla_prof81_VOIP
sla_prof90_VOIP
sla_profPC1
sla_profPC2
sla_profPC3
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of SLA Profiles : 14
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A# 
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile sla_prof100_VOIP
===============================================================================
SLA Profile sla_prof100_VOIP
===============================================================================
Host Limit           : 3 (Remove Oldest)
Ingress Qos-Policy   : 100                    Egress Qos-Policy : 100
Ingress Queuing Type : Service-queuing
Ingress Filter-Id    : N/A                    Egress Filter-Id  : N/A
Last Mgmt Change     : 07/10/2006 12:55:33
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Queue Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Rate      CIR       HiPrio  CBS     MBS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2     4000      -         -       -       -
3     2500      -         -       -       -
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Queue Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Rate      CIR       HiPrio  CBS     MBS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2     4000      -         -       -       -
3     2500      -         -       -       -
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile sla_prof100_VOIP association
===============================================================================
SLA Profile sla_prof100_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Default-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Static Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Non-Sub-Traffic-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Ident-Policy Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-name : sub_ident_all
 - Key : sla_prof100_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Explicit Subscriber Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

sla-profile

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Displays information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Displays information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Displays information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler stats information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber "sub1" sla-profile "sla-profile.1" sap 1/1/1:1 scheduler 
 
"session-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
Egress Schedulers
 
session-sched                      0                      0
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

port

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
Description 

This command displays the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port port-id
Displays information for the specified port
vport name
Displays information for the specified Vport
scheduler scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
detail —
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler hierarchy information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-hierarchy port 1/1/1 vport "dslam1" scheduler "dslam-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Port 1/1/1
===============================================================================
Scheduler-policy dslam-sched-pol
| slot(1)
|--(S) : subscriber-sched (VPort dslam1 1/1/1)
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->1
|   |   |
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->1
|   |   |
|
|--(S) : subscriber-sched (VPort dslam1 1/1/1)
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->1
|   |   |
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->1
|   |   |
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

vport

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the Vport scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port-id
Displays information for the specified port
name
Displays information for the specified Vport
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-stats port 1/1/1 vport "dslam1" scheduler "dslam-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Schedulers
 
dslam-sched                        0                      0
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

statistics

Syntax 
statistics iom (slot | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics mda (mda | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics port (port-id | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics pw-port (pw-port | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics sla-profiles
statistics sub-profiles
statistics system [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays enhanced subscriber management statistics per port, PW port, MDA, IOM, or system.

For each statistic, there is current value and peak value. Peak value is the highest value since the last reset as a result of a system boot or the clear subscriber-mgmt peakvalue-stats command.

Note:

The peak values can be reset using the clear subscriber-mgmt peakvalue-stats command.

Parameters 
iom slot
Displays specified IOM slot information.
mda mda
Displays specified slot/mda information.
port port-id
Specifies to display information for both the physical port ID and LAG.
pw-port pw-port
Specifies to display information for a pseudowire port ID.
Values—
1 to 10239

 

all—
displays statistics of all IOM or MDA or port or pseudowire port in the system
host—
Displays v4/v6 host statistics only.
session—
Displays PPPoX/LAC/LNS session statistics only.
sla-profiles—
Displays the current and historical statistics for SLA profiles.
sub-profiles—
Displays the current and historical statistics for subscriber profiles.
subscriber—
Displays subscriber statistics only.
summary—
Displays summary statistics only.
non-zero-value-only—
Displays only non-zero value counters.

The following tables describe the counters available in the show subscriber management statistics command output.

The following terminology is used to indicate applicability of the stats:

  1. ESM — Enhanced Subscriber Management. Subscriber traffic forwarded via subscriber queues. Enabled with SAP sub-sla-mgmt in no shutdown state
  2. BSM — Basic Subscriber Management. Subscriber traffic forwarded via SAP queues. SAP sub-sla-mgmt must be in shutdown state. For DHCP, dhcp lease-populate or dhcp6-relay lease-populate must be enabled to count the leases. For IPv4, if anti-spoof is enabled on the SAP, a subscriber host is instantiated.
  3. Routed CO — IES or VPRN service with subscriber interface and group interface constructs
  4. Bridged CO — VPLS service with DHCPv4 lease management enabled (lease-populate)
  5. regular interface — IES or VPRN interface (none subscriber-interface or group-interface)
  6. Host (also subscriber host) — A resource in the system that is used for traffic forwarding and security related actions. The creation of a subscriber host entry is linked to anti-spoof being enabled on a SAP. For ESM, anti-spoof is mandatory and hence every connected {IP/MAC} consumes by default a subscriber host entry. A DHCP6 IA-PD can also be modeled as a managed route. In this case, no subscriber host is instantiated. For BSM, anti-spoof is optional on regular interfaces. An IPv4 static-host and DHCPv4 lease do not result in a subscriber host instantiation when anti-spoof is disabled on the SAP.
    Table 94:  Host And Protocol Statistics  

    Section

    Counter

    Counts

    Applies to

    IPv4

    1. PPP Hosts - IPCP

    IPv4 local terminated PPP hosts (PTA, LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    2. IPOE Hosts - DHCP

    DHCPv4 hosts (lease states)

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    3. IPOE Hosts - ARP

    ARP hosts

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    4. IPOE Hosts – Static

    IPv4 static hosts

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    5. IPOE Hosts BSM - DHCP

    DHCPv4 hosts (lease states: anti-spoof and lease-populate enabled)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    6. IPOE Hosts BSM – Static

    IPv4 static hosts (with anti-spoof enabled)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    7. IPOE BSM - DHCP

    DHCPv4 lease states (with lease-populate enabled, no anti-spoof)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    8. IPOE BSM – Static

    IPv4 static hosts (no anti-spoof)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    IPv6

    PPP Hosts – SLAAC

    Local terminated IPv6 wan-host – SLAAC (PTA, LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Hosts - DHCP6 (PD)

    Local terminated IPv6 pd-host (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-PD leases over PPP (excluding PD as managed route)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Hosts - DHCP6 (NA)

    Local terminated IPv6 wan-host (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-NA leases over PPP

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Mngd Rt - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-PD leases over PPP (PD as managed route only)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – SLAAC

    IPv6 wan-host – SLAAC

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 pd-host – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (excluding PD as managed route)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts - DHCP6 (NA)

    IPv6 wan-host – DHCP6 IA-NA leases

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Mngd Rt - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (PD as managed route only)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – Static (PD)

    IPv6 static hosts with prefix-length shorter than /128

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – Static (WAN)

    IPv6 static hosts with prefix-length equal to /128

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE BSM - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (lease-populate)

    BSM, regular interface

    IPOE BSM - DHCP6 (NA)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-NA leases (lease-populate)

    BSM, regular interface

    Total

    PPP Hosts

    Local terminated PPP hosts (PTA, LNS)

    Sum of counters 1, 9, 10 and 11

    ESM

    IPOE Hosts

    Total IPv4 and IPv6 IPOE hosts.

    Sum of counters 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 13, 14, 15, 17 and 18

    ESM

    IPv4 Hosts

    Total IPv4 hosts. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6

    ESM

    IPv6 Hosts

    Total IPv6 hosts. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17 and 18

    ESM

    IPv6 PD Mngd Routes

    Total DHCP6 IA-PD leases modeled as a managed route. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 12 and 16

    ESM

    L2TP LAC Hosts

    L2TP LAC hosts – single host per single or dual stack PPP session.

    Counter also increases for outgoing LTS sessions.

    ESM, Routed CO

    Internal Hosts

    Subscriber hosts for internal use. For example: LNS redirect hosts (for LTS, an LNS redirect host is also instantiated).

    ESM

    Total (Cont)

    Non-Sub-Traffic L2-Hosts

    Host on a single subscriber SAP in a VPLS service that enables non-IP traffic to be forwarded using the specified SLA profile instance queues.

    Host on a single subscriber SAP attached to an IES/VPRN group-interface that enables traffic normally forwarded via the SAP queues to flow via the specified SLA profile instance queues.

    configure service vpls <service-id> sap <sap-id> sub-sla-mgmt single-sub-parameters non-sub-traffic sub-profile <sub-profile-name> sla-profile <sla-profile-name> [subscriber <sub-ident-string>] [app-profile <app-profile-name>]

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    DHCP leases

    Total number of DHCPv4 lease states.

    Sum of counters 2, 5 and 7

    ESM, BSM

    DHCPv6 leases

    Total number of DHCPv6 lease states.

    Sum of counters 10, 11, 12, 14, 15, 16, 19 and 20

    ESM, BSM

    Subscriber Hosts

    Counter displayed in the output of “show subscriber-mgmt statistics iom | mda | port | pw-port”

    This counter matches the number of hosts accounted for in the per line card limit

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18 and 26

    ESM

    Total (Cont)

    System Hosts Scale

    Counter displayed in the output of “show subscriber-mgmt statistics system”

    This counter matches the number of hosts accounted for in the system wide limit

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, 26 and 27

    ESM

    Table 95:  PPP Session Statistics 

    Section

    Counter

    Counts

    Applies to

    Local

    PPP Sessions - PPPoE

    Local terminated PPPoE sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoEoA

    Local terminated PPPoEoA sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    .PPP Sessions - PPPoA

    Local terminated PPPoA sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - L2TP (LNS)

    Local terminated PPP sessions (L2TP LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    LAC

    PPP Sessions - PPPoE

    Tunneled PPPoE session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoEoA

    Tunneled PPPoEoA session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoA

    Tunneled PPPoA session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - L2TP (LTS)

    Tunneled PPP session (L2TP LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    Total

    PPP Sessions - established

    PPP sessions that are established (at least one active host attached) – PTA/LAC/LTS/LNS

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - in setup

    PPP sessions in setup (session created, host setup in progress) – PTA/LAC/LTS/LNS

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - local

    Local terminated PPPoX sessions (PTA, L2TP LNS)

    Sum of counters 33, 34, 35 and 36

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - LAC

    Tunneled PPPoX session (L2TP LAC, L2TP LTS)

    Sum of counters 37, 38, 39 and 40

    ESM, Routed CO

    L2TP

    L2TP Tunnels - originator

    Number of L2TP Tunnels originated on this node. (LAC/ LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    .L2TP Tunnels - receiver

    Number of L2TP Tunnels terminated on this node. (LNS/LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    Total L2TP Tunnels

    Number of L2TP Tunnels originated or terminated on this node

    Sum of counters 45 and 46

    ESM, Routed CO

Table 96:  IPoE Session Statistics 

Section

Counter

Counts

Applies to

Total

IPOE Sessions - established

IPoE sessions that are established (at least one active host attached).

ESM, Routed CO

IPOE Sessions- in setup

IPoE sessions in setup (session created, host setup in progress).

ESM, Routed CO

Table 97:  Subscriber Statistics 

Section

Counter

Counts

Applies to

Total

Subscribers

Total number of active subscribers.

ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

Table 98:  SubMgmt Statistics Summary 

Section

Counter

Counts

Hosts

IPv4

IPv6

Total IPv4 hosts (counter 23 in tables above)

Total IPv6 hosts (counter 24 in tables above)

Sessions

PPP

IPOE

Total PPP sessions - established (counter 41 in tables above)

Total IPOE sessions – established (counter 48 in tables above)

Subscribers

Total number of active subscribers (counter 50 in tables above)

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management system statistics.

Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics system
===============================================================================
Subscriber Management Statistics for System
===============================================================================
       Type                               Current      Peak      Peak Timestamp
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Host & Protocol Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPv4   PPP Hosts      - IPCP                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP                    0         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       IPOE Hosts     - ARP                     1         1 02/28/2015 13:46:10
       IPOE Hosts     - Static                  0         0
       IPOE Hosts BSM - DHCP                    0         0
       IPOE Hosts BSM - Static                  0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP                    0         0
       IPOE BSM       - Static                  0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPv6   PPP Hosts      - SLAAC                   0         0
       PPP Hosts      - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       PPP Hosts      - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
       PPP Mngd Rt    - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - SLAAC                   0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
       IPOE Mngd Rt   - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - Static (PD)             0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - Static (WAN)            0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  PPP Hosts                                1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPOE Hosts                               1         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       IPv4 Hosts                               2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPv6 Hosts                               0         0
       IPv6 PD Mngd Routes                      0         0
       L2TP LAC Hosts                           0         0
       Internal Hosts                           0         0
       Non-Sub-Traffic L2-Hosts                 0         0
       DHCP Leases                              0         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       DHCPv6 Leases                            0         0
       System Hosts Scale                       2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PPP Session Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local  PPP Sessions  - PPPoE                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoEoA                  0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoA                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - L2TP (LNS)               0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
LAC    PPP Sessions  - PPPoE                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoEoA                  0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoA                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - L2TP (LTS)               0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  PPP Sessions  - established              1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - in setup                 0         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - local                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - LAC                      0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
L2TP   L2TP Tunnels  - originator               0         0
       L2TP Tunnels  - receiver                 0         0
       Total L2TP Tunnels                       0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPOE Session Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  IPOE Sessions - established              0         0
       IPOE Sessions - in setup                 0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  Subscribers                              2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
Peak values last reset at : n/a
 
Sample Output (summary view)
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics port 1/1/4 summary
===============================================================================
SubMgmt Statistics
===============================================================================
                 |       Hosts        |      Sessions      |    Subscribers
Port Id          |   IPv4      IPv6   |    PPP      IPOE   |
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4            |        2         2 |        1         1 |        2   (Curr)
                 |        3         3 |        1         2 |        3   (Peak)
===============================================================================
 
Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics sla-profiles
===============================================================================
SLA Profile Statistics
===============================================================================
SLA-Profile Name                        Current       Peak       Peak Timestamp 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
tv-prof                                       0          0 
hsi-prof                                      1          1  12/29/2016 15:50:50
hsi-iptv--prof                                0          0 
no-prof-1                                     1          1  01/03/2017 20:00:37
hsi-voip-prof                                 0          2  12/29/2016 18:42:44
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                         2
===============================================================================
 
Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics sub-profiles
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile Statistics
===============================================================================
Subscriber-Profile Name                  Current       Peak       Peak Timestamp
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
no-prof                                        2          3  12/29/2016 18:42:44
sub-10M                                        0          0
sub-10M-UPNP                                   0          0
sub-20M                                        0          0
sub-20M-UPNP                                   0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                          2
===============================================================================
 

steering-profile

Syntax 
steering-profile steering-profile-name
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays steering profile information.

Parameters 
steering-profile-name—
Specifies an existing steering profile name.

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
sub-ident-policy [sub-ident-policy-name [association]]
sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name script {primary | secondary | tertiary}
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber identification policy information.

Parameters 
sub-ident-policy-name—
Specifies an existing subscriber identification policy name
association—
Displays information configured with the specified sub-ident-policy-name
script {primary | secondary | tertiary}—
Displays information for the specified identification script
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management subscriber identification policy information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_ident_all
sub_ident_pc
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Subscriber Identification Policies : 2
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Sub Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              Sub profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_prof100                      sub_prof100
sub_prof110                      sub_prof110
sub_prof120                      sub_prof120
sub_prof130                      sub_prof130
sub_prof140                      sub_prof140
sub_prof230                      sub_prof230
sub_prof80                       sub_prof80
sub_prof81                       sub_prof81
sub_prof90                       sub_prof90
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              SLA profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sla_prof100_VOIP                 sla_prof100_VOIP
sla_prof110_VOIP                 sla_prof110_VOIP
sla_prof120_VOIP                 sla_prof120_VOIP
sla_prof130_VOIP                 sla_prof130_VOIP
sla_prof140_VOIP                 sla_prof140_VOIP
sla_prof230_VOIP                 sla_prof230_VOIP
sla_prof80_VOIP                  sla_prof80_VOIP
sla_prof81_VOIP                  sla_prof81_VOIP
sla_prof90_VOIP                  sla_prof90_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Python Scripts
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
#         Admin Oper  Script
          State State Name
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Primary   Down  Down  pyTom.py
Secondary Up    Up    pyTomDebug.py
Tertiary  Up    Up    hardcoded.py
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all association
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 80 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80
Service-Id : 90 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:90
Service-Id : 100 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:100
 - SAP : 1/2/1:101
 - SAP : 1/2/1:102
Service-Id : 110 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:110
 - SAP : 1/2/1:111
 - SAP : 1/2/1:112
Service-Id : 120 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:120
 - SAP : 1/2/1:121
 - SAP : 1/2/1:122
Service-Id : 130 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:130
Service-Id : 140 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:140
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script primary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Primary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/pyTom.py
Admin State : Down                      Oper State : Down
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Script is not active.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script secondary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Secondary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/pyTomDebug.py
Admin State : Up                        Oper State : Up
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      1 import alc
      2 yiaddr = alc.dhcp.yiaddr
      3 # Subscriber ID equals full client IP address.
      4 # Note: IP address 10.10.10.10 yields 'sub-168430090'
      5 # and not 'sub-10.10.10.10'
      6 alc.dhcp.sub_ident = 'sub-' + str(yiaddr)
      7 # DHCP server is configured such that the third byte (field) of the IP
      8 # address indicates the session Profile ID.
      9 alc.dhcp.sla_profile = 'sp-' + str((yiaddr & 0x0000FF00) >> 8)
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script tertiary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Tertiary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/hardcoded.py
Admin State : Up                        Oper State : Up
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      1 from alc import dhcp
      2
      3 dhcp.sub_ident = 'sub_ident_A_1'
      4 dhcp.sub_profile_string = 'sub_prof_B_2'
      5 dhcp.sla_profile_string = 'sla_prof_C_3'
      6
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt#

sub-profile

Syntax 
sub-profile [sub-profile-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber profile information.

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Specifies an existing subscriber profile name
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sub-profile-name
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber profile information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profiles
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_default
sub_prof100
sub_prof110
sub_prof120
sub_prof130
sub_prof140
sub_prof230
sub_prof80
sub_prof81
sub_prof90
sub_profPC1
sub_profPC2
sub_profPC3
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Subscriber Profiles : 13
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile sub_prof100
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile sub_prof100
===============================================================================
I. Sched. Policy : service100
E. Sched. Policy : service100
Acct. Policy     : 1                                Collect Stats : Enabled
Last Mgmt Change : 07/10/2006 12:55:33
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Scheduler Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Scheduler                        Rate      CIR
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv100                          8000      sum
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Scheduler Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Scheduler                        Rate      CIR
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv100                          8000      sum
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              SLA Profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No mappings configured.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile sub_prof100 association
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile sub_prof100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Default-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Static Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Non-Sub-Traffic-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Ident-Policy Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-name : sub_ident_all
 - Key : sub_prof100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Explicit Subscriber Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

pw-port

Syntax 
pw-port [pw-port-id] [detail]
pw-port sdp sdp-id
pw-port sdp none
Context 
show>pw-port
Description 

Displays pseudo-wire port information.

If no optional parameters are specified, the command displays a summary of all defined PW ports. The optional parameters restrict output to only ports matching the specified properties.

Parameters 
pw-port-id
Specifies the pseudo-wire port identifier
Values—
1 to 10239

 

detail—
Displays detailed port information that includes all the pw-port output fields
sdp-id
The SDP ID for which to display matching PW port information
Values—
1 to 17407

 

Output 

The following output is an example of PW port information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1         dot1q          1          1526726657          1
2         qinq           1          1526726658          2
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
4         qinq           1          1526726660          4
============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port 3
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port 3 detail
===============================================================================
PW Port Information
===============================================================================
PW Port            : 3
Encap              : dot1q
SDP                : 1
IfIndex            : 1526726659
VC-Id              : 3
Description        : 1-Gig Ethernet dual fiber
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>config>pw-port$ show pw-port sdp none
 
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
5         dot1q                     1526726661
============================================================================
 
 
*A:ALA-48>config>pw-port$ show pw-port sdp 1
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1         dot1q          1          1526726657          1
2         qinq           1          1526726658          2
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
4         qinq           1          1526726660          4
============================================================================
 

The following table describes show pw-port output fields:

Table 99:  Subscriber Show PW-Port Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

PW Port

The PW port identifier.

Encap

The encapsulation type of the PW port.

SDP

The SDP identifier.

IfIndex

The interface index used for the PW port.

VC-Id

The Virtual Circuit identifier.

Description

The description string for the PW port.

port-scheduler-policy

Syntax 
port-scheduler-policy [port-scheduler-policy-name] [association]
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name network-policy network-queue-policy-name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name sap-egress policy-id
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name sap-egress policy-id
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays scheduler policy information.

Parameters 
port-scheduler-policy-name—
Specifies an existing port scheduler policy name
network-queue-policy-name—
Specifies an existing network queue policy name
policy-id—
Specifies an existing SAP egress policy ID
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS port scheduler policy information.

Sample Output
A:NS072860910>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# info
----------------------------------------------
            max-rate 10000
            group "group1" create
                rate 3000 cir 1000
            exit
            group "group2" create
                rate 2000 cir 500
            exit
            level 7 rate 7000 cir 700 group "group1" weight 3
            level 6 rate 6000 cir 600 group "group1" weight 2
            level 5 rate 5000 cir 500 group "group1" weight 1
            level 2 rate 2000 cir 200 group "group2" weight 2
            level 1 rate 1000 cir 100 group "group2" weight 1
----------------------------------------------
 
A:NS072860910# show qos scheduler-hierarchy port 5/1/2 vport "fred"
========================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Port 5/1/2, Vport "fred"
========================================================================
Port-scheduler-policy psp1
    Port Bandwidth : 1000000    Max Rate : 10000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Within CIR Level 8]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->1
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->1
 
[Within CIR Group "group1"]
    Rate     : 1000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Within CIR Level 7]
        Weight   : 3
        Rate     : 700
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->2
 
    [Within CIR Level 6]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 600
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->3
 
    [Within CIR Level 5]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 500
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->4
 
[Within CIR Level 4]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Within CIR Level 3]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->5
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->5
 
[Within CIR Group "group2"]
    Rate : 500
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Within CIR Level 2]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 200
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->6
 
    [Within CIR Level 1]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 200
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->7
 
[Within CIR Level 0]
    Rate     : 0
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->8
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->8
 
[Above CIR Level 8]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Group "group1"]
    Rate     : 3000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 7]
        Weight   : 3
        Rate     : 7000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 6]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 6000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 5]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 5000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Level 4]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Level 3]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Group "group2"]
    Rate     : 2000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 2]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 2000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 1]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 1000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->1
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->5
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->8
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->1
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->5
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->8
========================================================================
A:NS072860910# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp"
========================================================================
QoS Port Scheduler Policy
========================================================================
Policy-Name       : psp                 
Description       : (Not Specified)
Max Rate          : max                 Last changed      : 04/15/2010 00:37:02
Group             : 1                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 2                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 3                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 4                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Lvl1 PIR          : max                 Lvl1 CIR          : max
Lvl1 Group        : 1                   Lvl1 Grp Weight   : 10
 
Lvl2 PIR          : max                 Lvl2 CIR          : max
Lvl2 Group        : 1                   Lvl2 Grp Weight   : 20
 
Lvl3 PIR          : max                 Lvl3 CIR          : max
Lvl3 Group        : 2                   Lvl3 Grp Weight   : 30
 
Lvl4 PIR          : max                 Lvl4 CIR          : max
Lvl4 Group        : 2                   Lvl4 Grp Weight   : 40
 
Lvl5 PIR          : max                 Lvl5 CIR          : max
Lvl5 Group        : 3                   Lvl5 Grp Weight   : 50
 
Lvl6 PIR          : max                 Lvl6 CIR          : max
Lvl6 Group        : 3                   Lvl6 Grp Weight   : 60
 
Lvl7 PIR          : max                 Lvl7 CIR          : max
Lvl7 Group        : 4                   Lvl7 Grp Weight   : 70
 
Lvl8 PIR          : max                 Lvl8 CIR          : max
Lvl8 Group        : 4                   Lvl8 Grp Weight   : 80
 
Orphan Lvl        : default             Orphan Weight     : default
Orphan CIR-Lvl    : default             Orphan CIR-Weight : default
========================================================================
*A:Bennet-Dut-A>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp" association 
========================================================================
QoS Port Scheduler Policy
========================================================================
Policy-Name       : psp                 
Description       : (Not Specified)
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
------------------------------------------------------------------------
 - Port : 1/1/2 VPort : vp1
========================================================================
*A:B-Dut-A# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp" sap-egress 1000
========================================================================
Compatibility : Port-scheduler Policy psp & Sap Egress Queue 1000
========================================================================
Orphan Queues :
 
None Found
 
Hierarchy     :
 
Root
|
|---(Q) : 1    
|
|---(Q) : 2    
|
|---(Q) : 3    
|
|---(Q) : 4    
|
|---(Q) : 5    
|
|---(Q) : 6                           
|
|---(Q) : 7    
|
|---(Q) : 8    
========================================================================
*A:B-Dut-A# 
 

sap-egress

Syntax 
sap-egress [policy-id] [association | detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays SAP egress policy information.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Displays information for the specified SAP egress policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sap-egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of Qos SAP egress information.

Sample Output
*A:Dut-A# show qos sap-egress
===============================================================================
Sap Egress Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id  Scope     Name                     Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1          Template  default                  Default SAP egress QoS policy.
30         Template                           1 video channel, 1 BE
31         Template                           1 video EF, 2xvideo AF, 1 BE
80         Template                           Limit outgoing 80
100        Template                           User100
110        Template                           User110
120        Template                           User120
130        Template                           User130
140        Template                           User140
901        Template                           User90_1
902        Template                           User90_2
903        Template                           User90_3
904        Template                           User90_4
905        Template                           User90_5
1000       Template                           Service all
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Policies : 15
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-egress 31 detail
===============================================================================
QoS Sap Egress
===============================================================================
Sap Scheduler Policy (31)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-id      : 31                           Scope        : Template
Description    : 1 video EF, 2xvideo AF, 1 BE
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue         CIR Admin PIR Admin CBS     HiPrio  PIR Lvl/Wt    Parent
              CIR Rule  PIR Rule  MBS             CIR Lvl/Wt
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1             0         max       def     def     1/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
2             0         max       def     def     2/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
3             0         max       def     def     3/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC Name               Queue-id    Explicit/Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be                    1           Explicit (0)
af                    2           Explicit (0)
ef                    3           Explicit (0)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 23 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 1
 - SAP : 1/2/2:4000
Service-Id     : 30 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : lag-1
 - SAP : lag-2:5
Service-Id     : 31 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : 1/2/1:31
SLA Profiles :
 - sla_profPC1                      override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Mirror SAPs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Mirror SAPs Found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

sap-ingress

Syntax 
sap-ingress [policy-id] [association | match-criteria | detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays SAP ingress policy information.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Displays information for the specified SAP ingress policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sap-ingress policy
match-criteria—
Displays information about the matching criteria
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS SAP ingress information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-ingress
===============================================================================
Sap Ingress Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id  Scope     Name                     Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1          Template  default                  Default SAP ingress QoS policy.
80         Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
90         Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
100        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
110        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
120        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
130        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
140        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
901        Template                           User90_1
902        Template                           User90_2
903        Template                           User90_3
904        Template                           User90_4
905        Template                           User90_5
1000       Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for all s*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Policies : 14
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
* indicates that the corresponding row element may have been truncated.
*A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-ingress 80 detail
===============================================================================
QoS Sap Ingress
===============================================================================
Sap Ingress Policy (80)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-id      : 80                           Scope        : Template
Default FC     : be                           Priority     : Low
Criteria-type  : IP
Description    :  Dot1p mappings/service for service 80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Mode    CIR Admin PIR Admin CBS     HiPrio  PIR Lvl/Wt    Parent
              CIR Rule  PIR Rule  MBS             CIR Lvl/Wt
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     Prio    0         7000      def     def     1/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
2     Prio    0         3500      def     def     2/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
3     Prio    0         2000      def     def     3/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
11    Prio    0         max       def     def     1/1           None
              closest   closest   def             0/1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC                  UCastQ         MCastQ         BCastQ         UnknownQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be                  1              def            def            def
af                  2              def            def            def
ef                  3              def            def            def
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SubFC                              Profile        In-Remark      Out-Remark
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
af                                 None           None           None
be                                 None           None           None
ef                                 None           None           None
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Dot1p           FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
0               be                               Default
2               af                               Default
5               ef                               Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
DSCP            FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No DSCP-Map Entries Found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Prec Value      FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Prec-Map Entries Found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Match Criteria
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IP Match Criteria
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Entry          : 1
Source IP      : Undefined                    Source Port  : None
Dest. IP       : Undefined                    Dest. Port   : None
Protocol       : None                         DSCP         : None
Fragment       : Off
FC             : Default                      Priority     : Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 80 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 80
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80
 
SLA Profiles :
 - sla_prof80                       override
 - sla_prof80_VOIP                  override
 - sla_prof81_VOIP                  override
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

scheduler-hierarchy

Syntax 
scheduler-hierarchy
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command enters the context to display information about policies that use this scheduler.

customer

Syntax 
customer customer-id site customer-site-name [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the scheduler hierarchy per customer multi-service-site.

Parameters 
customer-id
Displays information for the specified customer ID
customer-site-name
Displays information for the specified multi-service customer
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
ingress—
Displays information for the ingress policy
egress—
Displays information for the egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information

sap

Syntax 
sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the scheduler stats per SAP.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
ingress—
Displays information for the ingress policy
egress—
Displays information for the egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
Description 

This command displays the scheduler hierarchy rooted at the SLA profile scheduler.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Displays information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Displays information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Displays information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
detail —
Displays detailed information
Note:

If the SLA profile scheduler is orphaned (that is when the scheduler has a parent which does not exist) then the hierarchy is only shown when the show command includes the sla-profile and sap parameters.

Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber "sub1" sla-profile "sla-profile.1" sap 1/1/1:1 scheduler "session-sched" 
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber sub1 SLA-Profile sla-profile.1 SAP 1/1/1:1
===============================================================================
Egress Scheduler Policy : session-sched-pol
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
session-sched (Egr)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->3
|
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->2
|
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->1
|
 
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber nokia_100 scheduler serv_all
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
serv_all (Ing)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:101->11 MCast
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->11 MCast
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->11 MCast
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->3
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 1/2
|   |
...
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber nokia_100 scheduler serv_all detail
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
Legend :
(U) - Unrestricted     (P) - Provisioned
(A) - Administrative   (O) - Operational
MIR - Measured Info Rate
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv_all (Ing)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:101->11 MCast
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:4            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):7000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):1000000      PIR (O):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :1280
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:256
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->11 MCast
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:4            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):7000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):1000000      PIR (O):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :1280
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:256
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->1
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:1            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :1687
|   |    PIR (P):1690         PIR (U):3510
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/1
|   |   |
|   |   |    PIR Lvl:1            PIR Wt :1
|   |   |    CIR Lvl:1            CIR Wt :1
|   |   |
|   |   |    MIR    :0
|   |   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):1830
|   |   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |   |
|   |   |    PIR (A):7000         PIR (O):1850
|   |   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :64
|   |   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:8
|   |
...
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->3
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:3            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):2000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):2000         PIR (O):2000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :64
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:8
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#

scheduler-name

Syntax 
scheduler-name scheduler-name
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays information about the specified scheduler name.

Parameters 
scheduler-name—
Displays information about the specified scheduler

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy [scheduler-policy-name] [association | sap-ingress policy-id | sap-egress policy-id]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays information about the specified scheduler policy.

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name—
Displays information for the specified scheduler policy
policy-id
Displays information for the ingress policy
policy-id
Displays information for the egress policy
association—
Displays the information currently configured with the specified scheduler-policy-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler policy information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy
===============================================================================
Sap Scheduler Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id                        Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
maximum_4000_1xEF_1xBE
maximum_8000_1xEF_2xAF_1xBE
multiservice-site
root
scheduler-7Mbps
service100
service110
service120
service130
service140
service80
service90
service_all
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy root association
===============================================================================
QoS Scheduler Policy
===============================================================================
Policy-Name    : root
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy association
===============================================================================
QoS Scheduler Policy
===============================================================================
Policy-Name    : maximum_4000_1xEF_1xBE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : maximum_8000_1xEF_2xAF_1xBE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 23 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 1
 - SAP : 1/3/2:4000 (Egr)
Service-Id     : 30 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : lag-1 (Egr)
 - SAP : lag-2:5 (Egr)
Policy-Name    : multiservice-site
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 90 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 90
 - SAP : 1/1/12:95 (Ing) (Egr) MSS : site1
 - SAP : 1/1/20:94 (Ing) (Egr) MSS : site1
 
 - Customer : 2         MSS : site1  (Ing) (Egr)
 - Customer : 90        MSS : site1  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : root
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : scheduler-7Mbps
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : service100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 100 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 100
 - SAP : 1/2/1:100 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:101 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:102 (Ing) (Egr)
 
 - Customer : 100       MSS : site100  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof100 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service110
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 110 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 110
 - SAP : 1/2/1:110 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:111 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:112 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof110 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service120
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 120 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 120
 - SAP : 1/2/1:120 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:121 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:122 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof120 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service130
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 130 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 130
 - SAP : 1/2/1:130 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof130 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service140
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 140 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 140
 - SAP : 1/2/1:140 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof140 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 80 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 80
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80 (Ing) (Egr)
 
 - Customer : 80        MSS : site80  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof80 (Ing) (Egr)
 - sub_prof81 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service90
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 90 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 90
 - SAP : 1/2/1:90 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof90 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service_all
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_default (Ing) (Egr)
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#

scheduler-stats

Syntax 
scheduler-stats
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command enters the context to display scheduler statistics information.

Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler stats information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Schedulers
root                               112777                 25218126
serv_all                           112777                 25218126
Egress Schedulers
root                               113781                 26008462
serv_all                           113781                 26008462
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber nokia_100 scheduler root
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Schedulers
root                               0                      0
Egress Schedulers
root                               0                      0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A# 

shared-queue

Syntax 
shared-queue [shared-queue-policy-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays shared policy information.

Parameters 
shared-queue-policy-name—
Specifies the name of a shared-queue
detail—
Displays detailed information about the shared queue policy
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS shared queue information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos shared-queue
===============================================================================
Shared Queue Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id                        Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
default                          Default Shared Queue Policy
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos shared-queue detail
===============================================================================
QoS Network Queue Policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Shared Queue Policy (default)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy         : default
Description    : Default Shared Queue Policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue CIR       PIR       CBS     MBS     HiPrio  Multipoint
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     0         100       1       50      10      FALSE
2     25        100       3       50      10      FALSE
3     25        100       10      50      10      FALSE
4     25        100       3       25      10      FALSE
5     100       100       10      50      10      FALSE
6     100       100       10      50      10      FALSE
7     10        100       3       25      10      FALSE
8     10        100       3       25      10      FALSE
9     0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
10    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
11    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
12    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
13    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
14    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
15    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
16    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
17    0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
18    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
19    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
20    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
21    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
22    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
23    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
24    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
25    0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
26    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
27    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
28    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
29    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
30    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
31    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
32    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC    UCastQ    MCastQ    BCastQ  UnknownQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be    1         9         17      25
l2    2         10        18      26
af    3         11        19      27
l1    4         12        20      28
h2    5         13        21      29
ef    6         14        22      30
h1    7         15        23      31
nc    8         16        24      32
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:101 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:102 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:103 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:104 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:105 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:106 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:107 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:108 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:109 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:110 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:111 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:112 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:113 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:114 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:115 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:116 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:117 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:118 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:119 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:120 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:121 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:122 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:123 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/5:279 (shared Q)
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

accu-stats

Syntax 
accu-stats subscriber subscriber-id
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command displays the accumulated statistics for both online and offline statistics.

Parameters 
subscriber-id—
Specifies the subscriber ID, to a maximum of 32 characters.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber statistics.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats subscriber home-1
===============================================================================
Subscriber accumulated statistics for “home-1”
===============================================================================
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber accumulated statistics ingress queue 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     packets                octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Offered high priority                0                      0        
Offered low priority                 0                      0        
Dropped high priority                0                      0    
Dropped low priority                 0                      0        
Forwarded in-profile                 0                      0   
Forwarded out-of-profile             0                      0   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber accumulated statistics egress queue 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     packets                octets
Forwarded in-profile                 0                      0   
Forwarded out-of-profile             0                      0   
Dropped in-profile                   0                      0   
Dropped out-of--profile              0                      0   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================

accu-stats-policy

Syntax 
accu-stats-policy
accu-stats-policy policy-name [associations]
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command displays the configuration of the accumulated statistics policy for the subscriber profile that referenced the accumulated statistics policy.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the policy name, to a maximum of 32 characters.
associations—
Lists the sub-profile that referenced the policy.
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management accumulated statistics information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-policy “accu-stats-policy-01”
===============================================================================
Subscriber accumulated statistics policy accu-stats-policy-01
===============================================================================
Description                          : (Not Specified)         
Last management change               : 09/23/2016 16:48:46
===============================================================================
 
===============================================================================
Entries
===============================================================================
Direction Type     Id
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ingress   queue    1     
egress    queue    1     
===============================================================================
Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-policy “accu-stats-policy-01” associations
===============================================================================
Subscriber profile associations
===============================================================================
no-prof                         
sub-prof
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
No. of subscriber profiles: 2
===============================================================================

accu-stats-subscribers

Syntax 
accu-stats-subscribers [subscriber sub-ident] [sub-profile name]
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command lists all subscribers on the system that had referenced an accumulated statistics policy. The list contains subscribers that are currently referencing an accu-stats-policy as well as subscribers that no longer reference an accu-stats-policy (due to removal of the policy from the subscriber profile).

Parameters 
sub-ident—
Specifies a specific subscriber ID, to a maximum of 32 characters.
sub-profile name
Lists all subscribers that are referencing the specified subscriber profile, to a maximum of 32 characters.
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management accumulated statistics information.

Sample Output
*DUT# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-subscribers    
===============================================================================
Subscribers with accumulated statistics
===============================================================================
Subscriber                            : home-1
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : accu-stats-policy-01
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber                            : home-2
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : accu-stats-policy-02
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber                            : twamp-host
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : (Unknown)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Subscribers with accumulated statistics: 3
===============================================================================
Sample Output

The show subscriber-mgmt status system command shows the number of subscribers using accumulated statistics and whether the statistics usage has reached the peak value.

*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt status system 
===============================================================================
Subscriber Management System Status
===============================================================================
Chassis 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Memory usage high                                       : No
DHCP message processing overload                        : No
Statistics usage high                                   : Yes
Number of subscribers using statistics                  : 131072
Data-trigger statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Packets received                                        : 0
Packets dropped                                         : 0
Packets in queue (actual)                               : 0
Packets in queue (peak)                                 : 0
Bridged Residential Gateway statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
BRG initialized                                         : 0
BRG operational                                         : 0
BRG in connectivity verification                        : 0
BRG on hold                                             : 0
BRG authenticated by proxy                              : 0
===============================================================================

ancp-policy

Syntax 
ancp-policy [policy-name]
Context 
show>subscriber-management
Description 

This command displays subscriber ANCP policy information.

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP policy information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy
===============================================================================
ANCP Policies
===============================================================================
adsl-operator1
vdsl-operator1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of ANCP policies : 2
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy adsl-operator1
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "adsl-operator1"
===============================================================================
I. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
I. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
I. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
I. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
I. Rate Modify         : scheduler "root"
 
E. Rate Reduction      : 10 kbps
E. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
E. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
E. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
E. Rate Modify         : scheduler "root"
Port Down : N/A
Last Mgmt Change: 01/26/2007 17:10:51
================================================================================
A:active#
 
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy adsl-operator1 association
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "adsl-operator1" associations 
===============================================================================
SAP Static Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- SAP     : 1/1/3                             Svc-id  : 333 (VPLS)
     String : "ANCP-String-1"
     String : "ANCP-String-2"
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MSS Static Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Cust-id : 1                                 MSS-name: mss1
     String : "ANCP-String-3"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
Number of associations : 3
===============================================================================
A:active#

ancp-string

Syntax 
ancp-string
ancp-string ancp-string
ancp-string customer customer-id site customer-site-name
ancp-string sap sap-id
Context 
show>subscriber-management
Description 

This command displays subscriber ANCP string information.

Parameters 
ancp-string—
Specify the ASCII representation of the DSLAM circuit-id name
customer-id
Specify the associated existing customer name
customer-site-name
Specify the associated customer’s configured MSS name
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management ANCP string information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string
===============================================================================
ANCP-Strings
===============================================================================
ANCP-String                                                Assoc State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
"ANCP-String-1"                                            SAP   Up
"ANCP-String-2"                                            SAP   Down
"ANCP-String-3"                                            MSS   Up
"ANCP-String-4"                                            MSS   Unknown
"ANCP-String-5"                                            ANCP  Up
"ANCP-String-6"                                            MSS   Unknown
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of ANCP-Strings : 6
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string hpolSub43
===============================================================================
ANCP-String "hpolSub43"
===============================================================================
Type       : SUB - "hpolSub43"
State      : Up                 Ancp Policy: ancpPol
I. Rate    : 100 kbps           E. Rate    : 200 kbps
Adj I. Rate: N/A                Adj E. Rate: 200 kbps
Act I. Rate: N/A                Act E. Rate: 182 kbps
Service Id : 1 (VPRN)
Group      : Alu
Neighbor   : 100.100.100.1:49063
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-C# 

Other applicable show command output:

A:active# show service id 333 sap 1/1/3 detail 
===============================================================================
Service Access Points(SAP)
===============================================================================
Service Id         : 333
SAP                : 1/1/3                    Encap             : null
...
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ANCP Override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ing Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 100 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-1"
Egr Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 100 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
...
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
 
A:active# show service customer 1 site mss1
===============================================================================
Customer  1
===============================================================================
Customer-ID        : 1
Description        : Default customer
...
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ANCP Override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egr Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 90 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-3"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service Association
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Service Association Found.
===============================================================================
A:active#

radius-proxy-server

Syntax 
radius-proxy-server server-name
radius-proxy-server server-name cache
radius-proxy-server server-name cache hex-key hex-string
radius-proxy-server server-name cache string-key string
radius-proxy-serverserver-name cache summary
radius-proxy-server server-name statistics
radius-proxy-server
Context 
show>router
Description 

This command displays RADIUS proxy server information.

Parameters 
server-name—
Specifies the default RADIUS proxy server name created in the config>router>radius-proxy context
cache—
Displays cached information
hex-string
Displays the hex key string
Values—
[0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (max 64 hex nibbles)]

 

string
Displays the packet type of the RADIUS messages to use to generate the key for the cache of this RADIUS proxy server
summary—
Displays summarized information
statistics—
Displays statistics for the specified RADIUS proxy server
Output 
Table 100:  Subscriber RADIUS Proxy Server Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Invalid response Authenticator Rx packet

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx Access-Request

Displays the number of Access-Request packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx Accounting-Request

Displays the number of Accounting-Request packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx dropped

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server but dropped.

Retransmit

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they are retransmitted.

Wrong purpose

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the value of tmnxRadProxSrvPurpose is set to a value not matching the type of packet.

No UE MAC to cache

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the UE MAC address was not present in the packet.

Client context limit reached

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the limit of client contexts was reached. For each RADIUS transaction a client context is created, and will be deleted once the transaction is finished.

No ISA RADIUS policy configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it has no ISA RADIUS server policy configured for that type of packet.

Server admin down

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it is administratively shut down.

No RADIUS policy configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it has no RADIUS server policy configured for that type of packet.

No load-balance-key configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the selected RADIUS server policy's algorithm is set to hashBased and no load balance key is configured.

Invalid length

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because their length was invalid.

Invalid Code field

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they had an invalid Code field.

Invalid attribute encoding

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because one of the attributes was incorrectly encoded.

Invalid User-Name

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid User-Name attribute.

Invalid password

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the User-Password attribute could not be decoded.

Invalid accounting Authenticator

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Authenticator field.

Invalid Message-Authenticator

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Message-Authenticator attribute.

Management core overload

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because the ISA management core is not able to process any new RADIUS requests because of overload.

No memory

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because there was not enough memory to store them.

Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Acct-Status-Type attribute.

Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained no Acct-Status-Type attribute.

Registered user overload

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because the registered user indicated to be in overload.

Dropped by Python

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server but dropped by Python.

Tx Access-Accept

Displays the number of Access-Accept packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Access-Reject

Displays the number of Access-Reject packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Access-Challenge

Displays the number of Access-Challenge packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Accounting-Response

Displays the number of Accounting-Response packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx dropped

Displays the number of packets dropped by this RADIUS proxy server before transmission.

No key to cache

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the key information was not present in the packet.

Cache key too long

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the key information present in the packet was too long.

Cache attributes too long

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the total length of the attributes is too long.

Reached maximum number of cache entries

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the limit has been reached.

No memory

Displays the number of packets that could not be transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server because there was not enough memory.

Server timeout

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS servers have timed out.

Server authentication failure

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet which failed authentication (invalid response Authenticator or Message Authenticator attribute).

Server invalid Code

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet with an invalid Code field.

Invalid attribute encoding

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet with an invalid attribute.

Registered user overload

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the registered user indicated to be in overload.

No RADIUS server configured

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the RADIUS server policy has no servers configured.

RADIUS server send failure

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the packet could not get transmitted to one of the servers in the RADIUS server policy.

Dropped by Python

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the packet was dropped by the Python script.

Invalid response Authenticator

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet which failed authentication

Sample Output
 
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show router radius-proxy-server "ZiggoRadiusProxyAnyCast" statistics
===============================================================================
RADIUS Proxy server statistics for "ZiggoRadiusProxyAnyCast"
===============================================================================
Rx packet                                                : 28454097
Rx Access-Request                                        : 24846521
Rx Accounting-Request                                    : 3607576
Rx dropped                                               : 22986
  Retransmit                                             : 22986
  Server admin down                                      : 0
  No RADIUS policy configured                            : 0
  No load-balance-key configured                         : 0
  Invalid length                                         : 0
  Invalid Code field                                     : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Invalid User-Name                                      : 0
  Invalid password                                       : 0
  Invalid accounting Authenticator                       : 0
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 0
  No memory                                              : 0
  Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type       : 0
  Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type            : 0
  Registered user overload                               : 0
  Dropped by Python                                      : 0
 
Tx Access-Accept                                         : 1929725
Tx Access-Reject                                         : 302354
Tx Access-Challenge                                      : 22598950
Tx Accounting-Response                                   : 3598730
Tx dropped                                               : 1351
  No key to cache                                        : 0
  Cache key too long                                     : 0
  Cache attributes too long                              : 0
  Reached maximum number of cache entries                : 0
  No memory                                              : 0
  Server timeout                                         : 1351
  Server authentication failure                          : 0
  Server invalid Code                                    : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Registered user overload                               : 0
  No RADIUS server configured                            : 0
  RADIUS server send failure                             : 0
  Dropped by Python                                      : 0
===============================================================================
 
 
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show router radius-proxy-server "ZiggoRadiusDRPProxyanyCast-LEG" statistics 
===============================================================================
ISA RADIUS Proxy server statistics for "ZiggoRadiusDRPProxyanyCast-LEG"
===============================================================================
Group 1 member 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Rx packet                                                : 72250262
Rx Access-Request                                        : 61457394
Rx Accounting-Request                                    : 10792868
Rx dropped                                               : 1525690
  Retransmit                                             : 28470
  Wrong purpose                                          : 0
  No UE MAC to cache                                     : 1497212
  Client context limit reached                           : 0
  No ISA RADIUS policy configured                        : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Invalid password                                       : 0
  Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type       : 0
  Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type            : 0
  Invalid accounting Authenticator                       : 0
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 8
  Management core overload                               : 0
 
Tx Access-Accept                                         : 5830313
Tx Access-Reject                                         : 743060
Tx Access-Challenge                                      : 54844862
Tx Accounting-Response                                   : 9294168
Tx dropped                                               : 12226
  Server timeout                                         : 12169
  Invalid response Authenticator                         : 57
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  RADIUS server send failure                             : 0
 

wpp

Syntax 
wpp
wpp [portal wpp-portal-name] [host ip-address] hosts
wpp portal wpp-portal-name
wpp statistics
Context 
show>router
Description 

This command displays WPP port-related information in the specified routing instance.

Parameters 
wpp-portal-name
Specifies the name of this WPP portal
ip-address
Specifies the host IP address
hosts—
Displays the hosts enabled on the portal
Output 

The following output is an example of router WPP information.

Sample Output
show router wpp
===============================================================================
WPP portals
===============================================================================
Portal                           Address         Controlled-Rtr      Num-Itf
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
svr1                             1.1.1.1         0                   0
svr2                             2.2.2.2         0                   0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of portals: 2
===============================================================================
 
 
show router wpp portal "svr1" 
===============================================================================
WPP Portal "svr1"
===============================================================================
Address                               : 1.1.1.1
Controlled router                     : 0
Number of enabled interfaces          : 0
Triggered hosts                       : disabled
Last management change                : 01/27/2014 00:48:45
===============================================================================
 
 

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays IPoE information.

session

Syntax 
session [sap sap-id] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [interface ip-int-name | ip-address] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [no-inter-dest-id] [ip-address ip-prefix[/prefix-length]] [port port-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sap-session-id sap-session-index] [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
Context 
show>service>id>ipoe
Description 

This command displays the identified IPoE session details active on the specified service instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length.
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length.
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface up to 32 characters in length.
ip-address[/prefix-length]—
Specifies information for the specified IP address and mask.
no-inter-dest-id—
Displays the information about no intermediate destination ID.
port-id
Displays information about the specified port ID.
sap-session-index—
Displays sap-session-index information.
service-id
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

 

intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length.
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile.
detail—
Displays all IPoE session details.
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the router advertisement policy, up to 32 characters in length.
Output 

The following output is an example of service IPoE session information.

Sample Output
# show service id 4000 ipoe session
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for svc-id 4000
===============================================================================
Sap Id                           Mac Address         Up Time         MC-Stdby
    Subscriber-Id
        [CircuitID] | [RemoteID]
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4:1201.27                    00:51:00:00:00:0c   0d 00:00:18
    ipoe-session-001
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
CID | RID displayed when included in session-key
Number of sessions : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
# show service id 4000 ipoe session detail
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for service 4000
===============================================================================
SAP                     : 1/1/4:1201.27
Mac Address             : 00:51:00:00:00:0c
Circuit-Id              : circuit-id-1
Remote-Id               : remote-id-1
Session Key             : sap-mac
 
MC-Standby              : No
 
Subscriber-interface    : sub-int-1
Group-interface         : group-int-1
 
Up Time                 : 0d 00:01:01
Session Time Left       : N/A
Last Auth Time          : 02/28/2015 01:01:09
Min Auth Intvl (left)   : 0d 00:05:00 (0d 00:03:59)
Persistence Key         : N/A
 
Subscriber              : "ipoe-session-001"
Sub-Profile-String      : "sub-profile-1"
SLA-Profile-String      : "sla-profile-1"
ANCP-String             : ""
Int-Dest-Id             : ""
App-Profile-String      : ""
Category-Map-Name       : ""
Acct-Session-Id         : "144DFF0000001354D806D5"
Sap-Session-Index       : 1
 
IP Address              : 10.10.1.201/24
IP Origin               : Radius
Primary DNS             : N/A
Secondary DNS           : N/A
Primary NBNS            : N/A
Secondary NBNS          : N/A
Address-Pool            : N/A
 
IPv6 Prefix             : 2001:db8:a:111::/64
IPv6 Prefix Origin      : Radius
IPv6 Prefix Pool        : ""
IPv6 Del.Pfx.           : 2001:db8:a001:a100::/56
IPv6 Del.Pfx. Origin    : Radius
IPv6 Del.Pfx. Pool      : ""
IPv6 Address            : 2001:db8:a:101::aaa:1
IPv6 Address Origin     : Radius
IPv6 Address Pool       : ""
Primary IPv6 DNS        : N/A
Secondary IPv6 DNS      : N/A
 
Radius Session-TO       : N/A
Radius Class            :
Radius User-Name        : 00:51:00:00:00:0c
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of sessions : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-A# show service id 13 ipoe session router-advertisement-policy ra-policy-01
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for svc-id 13
===============================================================================
Sap Id                           Mac Address         Up Time         MC-Stdby
    Subscriber-Id                                                    
        [CircuitID] | [RemoteID]                                     
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:13   0d 00:13:06     
    Belgacom
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:14   0d 00:08:03     
    Belgacom
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:15   0d 00:06:23     
    Belgacom
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
CID | RID displayed when included in session-key
Number of sessions : 3
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# 

summary

Syntax 
summary
Context 
show>service>id>ipoe
Description 

This command displays a summary of IPoE information.

managed-hosts

Syntax 
managed-hosts type {aaa | data-triggered} [ip ip-address] [mac ieee-address]
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays information about hosts that are not yet linked to an in-band control plane protocol, such as DHCP or DHCPv6. Examples include hosts installed by data-triggers and hosts installed by RADIUS.

Parameters 
aaa—
Displays information about managed hosts installed and removed only by RADIUS
data-triggered—
Displays information about managed hosts installed by data-triggers
ip-address—
Displays information about a managed host with the specified IPv4 or IPv6 address
ieee-address—
Displays information about a managed host with the specified MAC address
Output 

The following output is an example of managed host information.

Sample Output
# show service id 100 managed-hosts type data-triggered
===============================================================================
Managed data-triggered hosts
===============================================================================
IP address                                MAC address
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10.0.0.9/32                               fa:ac:a6:02:11:01
2001:a:b:5::1/128                         fa:ac:a6:02:11:01
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Managed hosts: 2
===============================================================================

slaac

Syntax 
slaac
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays SLAAC information.

host

Syntax 
host [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host interface interface-name [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host mac ieee-address [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host ipv6-address ipv6-prefix [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host sap sap-id [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
Context 
show>service>id>slaac
Description 

This command displays SLAAC host related information.

Parameters 
detail—
Specifies to display detailed SLAAC host related information.
service-id—
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler.
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

session—
Specifies to display information about SLAAC hosts that are associated with an IPoE session or a PPP session.
Values—
none, ipoe, ppp

 

interface-name—
Specifies the interface name, up to a maximum of 32 characters.
ieee-address—
Specifies the MAC address for which to display SLAAC host information.
ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address for which to display SLACC host information.
sap-id—
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the router advertisement policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of detailed SLAAC host information.

Sample Output
*A:eng-BNG-2# show service id 1000 slaac host detail
===============================================================================
SLAAC hosts for service 1000
===============================================================================
Service ID           : 1000
Prefix               : 2001:1000:bad:beef::/64
Interface Id         : N/A
Mac Address          : 00:00:10:10:12:12
Subscriber-interface : sub-int-01
Group-interface      : grp-int-01
SAP                  : 1/1/20:841
Termination Type     : local
Creation Time        : 2017/02/13 22:05:03
Persistence Key      : N/A
Router adv. policy   : ra-policy-01
IPoE|PPP session     : No
Radius sub-if prefix : N/A
IPoE Trigger         : rtr-solicit
Last Auth Time       : 2017/02/13 22:05:03
Inactivity Timer     : N/A
Sub-Ident            : "host-1"
Sub-Profile-String   : "no-prof"
SLA-Profile-String   : "no-prof"
App-Profile-String   : ""
ANCP-String          : ""
Int Dest Id          : ""
Category-Map-Name    : ""
Info origin          : radius
Pool                 : ""
Primary-Dns          : N/A
Secondary-Dns        : N/A
Circuit Id           : N/A
Remote Id            : N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of hosts : 1
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# show service id 13 slaac host router-advertisement-policy ra-policy-01
===============================================================================
SLAAC hosts for service 13
===============================================================================
Prefix                      Mac Address          Sap Id                MC-Stdby
  IntId                                                                
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2013:bad:beef:1::/64        00:00:00:00:00:13    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
2013:bad:beef:2::/64        00:00:00:00:00:14    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
2013:bad:beef:3::/64        00:00:00:00:00:15    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of hosts : 3
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# 

summary

Syntax 
summary
Context 
show>service>id>slaac
Description 

This command displays a summary of all SLAAC hosts.

call-trace

Syntax 
call-trace
Context 
show
Description 

This command enters the context to display information related to the call-trace module.

files

Syntax 
files [running | finished] [detail]
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command gives an overview of all the files in use by the call-trace module, either for running or finished jobs.

Parameters 
running—
Displays the active jobs that are tracing events triggered by the host being monitored
finished—
Displays the jobs that have already finished and not tracing events generated by the host anymore
detail—
Displays detailed information about the files
Output 

The following output displays call trace local log files information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace files
===============================================================================
Call trace files of running jobs
===============================================================================
File path                                                             File size
                                                                        (bytes)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
cf1-A:/calltrace/running/mac_00-02-00-00-00-19_160119_1557.pcap            1575
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace files of running jobs: 1
===============================================================================
===============================================================================
Call trace files of finished jobs
===============================================================================
File path                                                             File size
                                                                        (bytes)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace files of finished jobs: 0
===============================================================================

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command enters the context to display IP over Ethernet (IPoE) call trace information.

session

Syntax 
session [name trace-name] [detail]
session sap sap mac mac [{circuit-id circuit-id | remote-id remote-id}] [detail]
Context 
show>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command displays call trace information for the active IPoE session.

Configuring this command with a specific IPoE session key will display information for the specified trace job only.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that identifies an IPoE session.
detail—
Displays detailed information.
mac—
Specifies a MAC address that identifies an IPoE session.
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that identifies an IPoE session
trace-name—
Specifies the name of the trace that triggered the job.
sap—
Specifies a SAP that identifies an IPoE session.
Output 

The following output displays call trace information for the active IPoE session.

Sample Output
Node # show call-trace ipoe session
=========================================================
Call trace IPoE session
=========================================================
IEEE address Status No. of messages
Trace name
---------------------------------------------------------
00:02:00:00:00:19 running 10
default
---------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace IPoE debug jobs: 1
=========================================================
 
 
Node# show call-trace ipoe session detail
===============================================================================
Call trace IPoE session
===============================================================================
SAP ID : 4/1/ 2
IEEE address: 00:02:00:00:00:19
Trace name : default Status : running
Size limit : 10 MB Time limit : 86400 sec
Live output
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Destination : none
Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Started : 2017/01/11 15:34:08UTC
No. of captured msgs : 10
Size of captured msgs : 2575 B
===============================================================================

trace

Syntax 
trace [name trace-name]
Context 
show>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command displays information about all traces and associated parameters that are currently enabled on the system. Including the trace-name parameter will limit the output to the specified trace only.

Parameters 
trace-name—
Specifies the name of the trace to be displayed.
Output 

The following output displays call trace information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace ipoe trace
===============================================================================
Call trace trace
===============================================================================
Trace name : default Type : ipoe
SAP ID :
IEEE address: 00:02:00:00:00:19
Maximum jobs: 1
===============================================================================

status

Syntax 
status
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command gives a router-wide overview of call-trace operational data, such as number of configured profile, number of jobs and status of the compact flash.

Output 

The following output displays call trace status information.

Sample Output
===============================================================================
Call trace status
===============================================================================
No. of trace profiles: 1
No. of trace jobs    : 0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Primary CF           : CF1              Max files number     : 200
CF1 state            : enabled          CF1 volume limit     : 1000 MB
CF2 state            : enabled          CF2 volume limit     : 1000 MB

trace-profile

Syntax 
trace-profile [detail]
trace-profile profile-name
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command provides an overview of all configured profiles or details of a specific profile. If the detail option is specified the full information for all configured profiles will be displayed.

Parameters 
detail—
Displays detailed trace profile information.
Output 

The following output displays call-trace trace-profile information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace trace-profile "default" 
===============================================================================
Call-trace  trace profile
===============================================================================
Profile name              : default
Description                : none
Live output                : none
Format                       : pcap
Size limit                   : 10 MB
Time limit                  : 86400 secs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of profiles : 1
===============================================================================
 

9.25.2.2.16. Clear Commands

session

Syntax 
session sap sap mac mac [{circuit-id circuit-id | remote-id remote-id}]
Context 
clear>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command clears the trace job identified by this session.

The sap, mac, circuit-id, and remote-id parameters cannot use wildcard characters, and must match the IPoE session key. This command does not affect any of the debug trace commands, and new jobs can still be executed for other IPoE sessions.

After a session is cleared, tracing for the session will not be restarted by any configured trace. Only explicitly starting a new trace with the trace-existing-sessions parameter can restart tracing for the session.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that identifies an IPoE session.
mac—
Specifies a MAC address that identifies an IPoE session.
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that identifies an IPoE session
sap—
Specifies a SAP that identifies an IPoE session.

trace

Syntax 
trace trace-name
Context 
clear>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command clears all trace jobs started by the specified trace. This command does not affect the trace command itself, and new jobs can still be executed for other IPoE sessions.

After a session is cleared, tracing for the session will not be restarted by any configured trace. Only explicitly starting a new trace with the trace-existing-sessions parameter can restart tracing for the session.

Parameters 
trace-name—
Specifies the configured name of the trace.

accu-stats

Syntax 
accu-stats active-subs no-accu-stats-policy
accu-stats active-subs sub-profile profile-name
accu-stats inactive-subs
accu-stats subscriber subscriber-id
Context 
clear>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command removes the accumulated statistics for a subscriber.

Parameters 
active-subs no accu-stats-policy—
Removes the accumulated statistics that are no longer associated with an accu-stats-policy. These are active subscribers that are referencing a subscriber profile that removed an accu-stats-policy.
active-subs sub-profile profile-name
Removes the accumulated statistics for the specified subscriber profile.
inactive-subs—
Removes the accumulated statistics from all inactive subscribers.
profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile, to a maximum of 32 characters.
subscriber-id—
Specifies the subscriber, to a maximum of 32 characters.

ancp-sub-string

Syntax 
ancp-sub-string string
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp
Description 

This command clears subscriber ANCP data.

Parameters 
string—
Clears the ANCP string corresponding to this subscriber ID

arp

Syntax 
arp {all | ip-address}
arp interface [ip-int-name | ip-address]
Context 
clear>router
Description 

This command clears all or specific ARP entries.

The scope of ARP cache entries cleared depends on the command line option(s) specified.

Parameters 
all—
Clears all ARP cache entries
ip-addr—
Clears the ARP cache entry for the specified IP address
ip-int-name
Clears all ARP cache entries for the interface with the specified name
ip-addr
Clears all ARP cache entries for the specified interface with the specified address

authentication

Syntax 
authentication [policy-name]
authentication coa-statistics
Context 
clear
Description 

This command clears subscriber authentication data.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Clears the specifies existing authentication policy name
coa-statistics—
Clears statistics for incoming RADIUS Change of Authorization requests

diameter-session

Syntax 
diameter-session
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command clears diameter session data.

ccrt-replay

Syntax 
ccrt-replay diameter-application-policy name
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt>diam-session
Description 

This command clears diameter Gx sessions that are in CCR Terminate replay mode.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be deleted

errors

Syntax 
errors
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command clears all errors in the circular buffer.

idle-only-msap

Syntax 
idle-only-msap msap-policy-name
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command removes all idle MSAPs associated with the MSAP policy.This command only removes idle MSAPs without active subscribers. This command is considered safer than the clear>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy msap-policy-name idle-only command because in that command, the parameter idle-only is optional. Not specifying idle-only will delete MSAPs with active subscribers.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Specifies the MSAP policy for which all associated idle MSAPs will be cleared

msap-policy

Syntax 
msap-policy msap-policy-name [idle-only]
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command deletes Managed SAPs (MSAPs) created by the MSAP policy.

This command can remove an MSAP with active subscribers still associated with the MSAP. Use the idle-only parameter to remove only MSAPs in an idle state.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Specifies an existing managed SAP policy name. A string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
idle-only—
Specifies to remove only the MSAPs in an idle state

peakvalue-stats

Syntax 
peakvalue-stats iom (slot | all) [recursive]
peakvalue-stats mda (mda | all) [recursive]
peakvalue-stats port (port-id | all)
peakvalue-stats pw-port (pw-port | all)
peakvalue-stats system [recursive]
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the most recent peak counter.

Note:

Clearing one counter will not impact other counters. For example, clearing one IOM’s most recent peak value will not impact chassis peak value.

Parameters 
slot
Clears IOM host peak value statistics for the specified IOM
mda
Clears MDA host peak value statistics for the specified MDA
port-id
Clears port host peak value statistics for the specified port ID
pw-port
Clears pseudowire port host peak value statistics for the specified port
Values—
1 to 10239

 

system —
Clears system host peak value statistics
all—
Clears all host peak value statistics
recursive—
Resets the sub-level counters. For example, clearing IOM counters with the recursive keyword will also clear counters of all ports counters on that IOM

radius-accounting

Syntax 
radius-accounting [policy-name]
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command clears RADIUS accounting data for the specified policy.

Parameters 
policy-name—
The name of the policy. The string is case sensitive and limited to 32 ASCII 7-bit printable characters with no spaces.

statistics

Syntax 
statistics sub-profile {sub-profile-name | all}
statistics sla-profile {sla-profile-name | all}
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command clears the current and historical statistics.

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Clears the statistics for a specific subscriber profile, limited to 32 characters.
sub-profile all—
Clears all subscriber profile statistics.
sla-profile-name—
Clears the statistics for a specific SLA profile, limited to 32 characters.
sla-profile all—
Clears all SLA profile statistics.

scheduler-stats

Syntax 
scheduler-stats
Context 
clear>qos
Description 

This command clears scheduler statistics.

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears scheduler stats per subscriber.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string—
Clears information for the subscriber profile name
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler-name
egress—
Clears egress information for the subscriber
ingress
Clears ingress information for the subscriber

sla-profile

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Clears information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Clears information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Clears information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler-name

srrp

Syntax 
srrp
Context 
clear>router
Description 

This command enters the context to clear and reset SRRP virtual router instances.

interface

Syntax 
interface subscriber-interface [id srrp-id]
Context 
clear>router>srrp
Description 

This command clears and resets SRRP interface instances.

Parameters 
subscriber-interface—
Specifies an existing subscriber interface name up to 32 characters in length
srrp-id
Specifies an existing SRRP ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

statistics

Syntax 
statistics interface subscriber-interface [id srrp-id]
Context 
clear>router>srrp
Description 

This command clears statistics for SRRP instances.

Parameters 
subscriber-interface—
Specifies an existing subscriber interface name up to 32 characters in length
srrp-id
Specifies an existing SRRP ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

route-downloader

Syntax 
route-downloader name [vprn vprn] [family family]
Context 
clear>aaa
Description 

This command clears all the radius-downloaded routes from the internal downloader cache (or protocol RIB/db) (and thus eventually from the RTM itself). The parameters vprn and/or family allow to restrict the deletion of those routes learned in a particular address family (IPv4 or IPv6) and/or a particular VPRN.

By default, all VPRNs and both IPv4 and IPv6 families are affected.

Note:

A clear of the internal protocol DB means the corresponding prefix that were deleted should be removed from the RTM (and from any other exports) as well.

Parameters 
vprn
Specifies to limit the removal of prefixes to only the specific VPRN. The parameter can be either the service-id or service-name that identifies a VPRN
family
Specifies to limit he removal or prefixes only belonging to the address family IPv4 or IPv6. Only these two values will be accepted.
Values—
ipv4, ipv6

 

vport

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears the Vport scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port-id
Clears information for the specified port
name
Clears information for the specified Vport
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler name

ipoe session

Syntax 
ipoe session [sap sap-id] [interface ip-int-name | ip-address] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [no-inter-dest-id] [ip-address ip-prefix[/prefix-length]] [port port-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sap-session-id sap-session-index]
ipoe session all
Context 
clear>service>id
Description 

This commands clears all identified IPoE sessions for the specified service instance. All associated subscriber hosts will be deleted from the system.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface up to 32 characters in length
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
ip-address[/prefix-length]—
Specifies information for the specified IP address and mask
no-inter-dest-id—
Displays the information about no intermediate destination ID
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
port-id
Displays information about the specified port ID
sap-session-index—
Displays sap-session-index information
service-id
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
service-id
Specifies information for the specified service ID
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

detail—
Displays all IPoE session details
all—
clears all active IPoE sessions for the specified service instance.

9.25.2.3.16. Tools Commands

tools

Syntax 
tools
Context 
root
Description 

The context to enable useful tools for debugging purposes.

Default 

none

Parameters 
dump—
Enables dump tools for the various protocols
perform—
Enables tools to perform specific tasks

avp-match-learned-session-id

Syntax 
avp-match-learned-session-id
Context 
tools>dump>debug>diameter
Description 

This command displays the diameter session IDs that are learned by the AVP value matching in a diameter debug.

Per avp-match id in a diameter peer policy, a single diameter session ID can be learned. "N/A" means no session ID is learned.

Output 

The following is a sample output for the avp-match-learned-session-id command.

Sample output
# tools dump debug diameter avp-match-learned-session-id
===============================================================================
Learned Session-Id
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy             ID Session-Id
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
diameter-peer-policy-1           1  bng.domain.com;1452197100;13
diameter-peer-policy-1           2  N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of AVP matches: 2
===============================================================================

perform

Syntax 
perform
Context 
tools
Description 

This command enters the context to enable tools to perform specific tasks.

Default 

none

credit-reset

Syntax 
credit-reset sap sap-id subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset sap sap-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset svc service-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the credit for an SLA-profile instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-address
Resets the credit for the specified IP address
sub-ident-string
Resets the credit for the specified subscriber identification.
sub-profile-string
Resets the credit for the specified subscriber profile
sla-profile-string
Resets the credit for the specified SLA profile
service-id
Resets the credit for the specified service ID
Values—
service-id: 1 2147483647 svc-name: up to 64 characters maximum.

 

persistence

Syntax 
persistence
Context 
tools>perform
Description 

This command enters the context to configure downgrade parameters.

downgrade

Syntax 
downgrade target-version target [reboot]
Context 
tools>perform>persistence
Description 

This command downgrades persistence files to a previous version.

Parameters 
target
Specifies the downgrade version
reboot—
Specifies to reboot the system after a successful conversion

eval-msap

Syntax 
eval-msap {policy msap-policy-name | msap sap-id}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command re-applies the managed SAP policy to the managed SAP identified by the specified sap-id or to all managed SAPs associated with the specified msap-policy name.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name
Specifies an existing MSAP policy. The MSAP policy will be re-applied to all associated managed SAPs
sap-id
Specifies an MSAP sap-id. The MSAP policy will be re-applied to the specified MSAP
Values—
[port-id | lag-id]:qtag1
[port-id | lag-id]:qtag1.qtag2

 

eval-lease-state

Syntax 
eval-lease-state [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [ip ip-address] [mac mac-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates lease state.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ip-address—
Specifies the a server’s IP address. This address must be unique within the subnet and specified in dotted decimal notation. Allowed values are IP addresses in the range 1.0.0.0 – 223.255.255.255 (with support of /31 subnets).
sub-ident-string—
Specifies the subscriber ID string, up to 32 characters in length
service-id—
Specifies an existing service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

subscriber-mgmt

Syntax 
subscriber-mgmt
Context 
tools>perform
Description 

This command enters the context to configure tools to control subscriber management.

edit-lease-state

Syntax 
edit-lease-state sap sap-id ip ip-address [mac ieee-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string [app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
edit-lease-state svc-id service-id ip ip-address [mac ieee-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string [app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command provides the parameters to edit lease state information.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ip-address
Modifies lease state information for the specified IP address.
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
sub-ident-string
Modifies the lease state information for the specified subscriber identification.
sub-profile-string
Modifies lease state information for the specified subscriber profile.
sla-profile-string
Modifies lease state information for the specified SLA profile.
service-id
Modifies lease state information for the specified service ID.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

coa

Syntax 
coa [nas-port-id attr-string] [framed-ip-addr ip-address] [alc-ipv6-addr ipv6-address] [delegated-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]] [framed-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix [/ipv6-prefix-length]] [alc-serv-id serv-id] [acct-session-id attr-string] [alc-subscr-id attr-string] [alc-brg-id attr-string] [alc-client-hw-addr mac-address] [attr attribute [attribute...(up to 5 max)]] [attr-from-file file-url] [from-server attr-string] [router-or-service attr-string] [debug]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command triggers a Change of Authorization (CoA) on the 7750 SR, 7450 ESS, and 7950 XRS without a RADIUS authentication policy.

This command can be used to spoof a CoA from a configured server for purposes such as testing CoA python scripts. However, spoofing a CoA from a RADIUS server requires the configuration of a RADIUS authentication policy.

Parameters 
nas-port-id attr-string
Specifies the physical access circuit of the NAS with a maximum of 253 characters.
framed-ip-addr ip-address
Specifies the IPv4 host address.
Values—

ipv4-address:

a,b,c,d

 

alc-ipv6-addr ipv6-address
Specifies the IPv6 host address.
Values—

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

 

delegated-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]
Specifies the IPv6 PD host prefix.
Values—

ipv6-prefix:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix-length

[0..128]

 

framed-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]
Specifies the IPv6 SLAAC host prefix.
Values—

ipv6-prefix:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix-length

[0..128]

 

serv-id
Specifies the service ID of the LNS subscriber.
Values—
0 to 4294967295

 

acct-session-id attr-string
Specifies the subscriber accounting session ID to a maximum of 22 characters in length.
alc-subscr-id attr-string
Specifies the subscriber ID to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
alc-brg-id attr-string
Specifies the BRG ID to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
mac-address
Specifies the subscriber host MAC address. in the form xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx.
attribute
Specifies the attributes (RADIUS VSAs) for override. The VSA must be specified in number format. For example, VSA Alc-Subsc-Prof-Str=”1M-prof” is expressed as 6527.12 =“1M-prof”. Up to five attributes can be specified within this command.

For more information on VSAs, refer to the RADIUS Attributes Reference Guide.

Values—

<type>=<value>

<type>:<tag>=<value>

<vendor>,<type>=<value>

e, <type>,<exttyp>=<value> (type=[241|242|243|244])

le,<type>,<exttyp>=<value> (type=[245|246])

evs,<type>,<vendor>,<vendor-type>=<value>

levs,<type>,<vendor>,<vendor-type>=<value>

 

file-url
Specifies the file URL where the VSAs are located.
Values—

local-url

[cflash-id/] [file-path] (200 characters maximum including cflash-id directory length of 99 characters maximum each)

remote-url

[{ftp://|tftp://}login:pswd@remote-locn/][file-path] (255 characters maximum with directory length 99 characters maximum each)

remote-locn

[hostname | ipv4-address | ipv6-address]

ipv4-address:

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x [-interface]

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d[-interface]

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

interface - Specifies the link local addresses, up to 32 characters maximum.

cflash-id

cf1: | cf1-A: | cf1-B: | cf2 :| cf2-A: | cf2-B: | cf3: | cf3-A: | cf3-B:

 

from-server attr-string
Specifies the RADIUS server name that is configured under the router or VPRN service context, to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
router-or-service attr-string
Specifies the router or VPRN service instance where the RADIUS server is configured, to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
debug —
Displays the debug message associated with the CoA command.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management CoA tools information.

Sample Output
Node# tools perform subscriber-mgmt coa alc-subscr-id subscriber-01 attr 6527,13=new-sla-prof debug
===============================================================================
Inject Change-of-Authorization
===============================================================================
SUCCESS: got ACK
  Change of Authorization(43) id 0 len 50 from 0.0.0.0:3799 vrid 1
    VSA [26] 8 Alcatel(6527)
      SUBSC ID STR [11] 6 subscriber-01
    VSA [26] 10 Alcatel(6527)
      SLA PROF STR [13] 8 new-sla-prof
  Hex Packet Dump:
  1a 0e 00 00 19 7f 0b 08 77 69 66 69 2d 31 1a 10 00 00 19 7f 0d 0a 73 6c 61
  2d 70 72 6f 66
  Change of Authorization Ack(44) 0.0.0.0:3799 id 0 len 20 vrid 1
  Hex Packet Dump:

credit-reset

Syntax 
credit-reset sap sap-id subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset sap sap-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset svc service-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the credit for an SLA-profile instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-address
Specifies lease state information for the specified IP address
sub-ident-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified subscriber identification
sub-profile-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified subscriber profile
sla-profile-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified SLA profile
service-id
Specifies lease state information for the specified service ID
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

edit-ppp-session

Syntax 
edit-ppp-session sap sap-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
edit-ppp-session svc-id service-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the PPP session identified with the given MAC address and SAP identifier. Optionally the remote-id and circuit-id can be specified to identify the IPoE session to update.

Note:

The changes take immediate effect.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
sla-profile-string—
Identifies the SLA profile string up to 16 characters in length
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sub-profile-string—
Specifies the subscriber profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
ancp-string—
Specifies the ASCII representation of the up to 63 characters in length
app-profile-string—
Specifies the application profile string up to 16 characters in length

edit-slaac-host

Syntax 
edit-slaac-host sap sap-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
edit-slaac-host svc-id service-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the SLAAC host information.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
sla-profile-string—
Identifies the SLA profile string up to 16 characters in length
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sub-profile-string—
Specifies the subscriber profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
ancp-string—
Specifies the ASCII representation of the up to 63 characters in length
app-profile-string—
Specifies the application profile string up to 16 characters in length

edit-ipoe-session

Syntax 
edit-ipoe-session sap sap-id mac mac-address [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the IPoE session identified with the given MAC address and SAP identifier. Optionally the remote ID and circuit ID can be specified to identify the IPoE session to update.

Note:

The changes take immediate effect.

eval-ipoe-session

Syntax 
eval-ipoe-session [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [mac mac-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command re-evaluates the mapping between authentication strings such as the SLA profile string and the actual profiles for the identified IPoE sessions.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile

eval-ppp-session

Syntax 
eval-ppp-session [svc-id service-id] [user-name user-name] [sap sap-id] [ip ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
eval-ppp-session [svc-id service-id] [user-name user-name] [sap sap-id] mac mac-address [session-id session-id] [ip ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates PPP sessions.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
mac-address—
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

eval-slaac-host

Syntax 
eval-slaac-host [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [ipv6-address ipv6-prefix] [mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates the SLAAC host.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
ipv6-prefix—
Specifies an IPv6 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

 

remap-lease-state

Syntax 
remap-lease-state old-mac ieee-address mac ieee-address
remap-lease-state sap sap-id [mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command allows the remapping of all existing hosts if network card on CMTS/WAC side is changed is required.

When this command is executed, the following restrictions apply:

  1. When sap is taken, all leases associated with the SAP are re-written.
    1. For a SAP with a configured MAC in lease-populate command, this MAC will be taken.
    2. For a SAP without a configured MAC the MAC from tools command will be taken.
    3. For a SAP without a configured MAC and no MAC in tools command no action will be perform.
  2. When using the old-mac option, providing a new MAC ieee-address is mandatory.

This command is applicable only when dealing with DHCP lease states which were instantiated using l2header mode of DHCP operation.

Parameters 
old-mac ieee-address
Specifies the old MAC address to remap
mac ieee-address
Specifies that the provisioned MAC address will be used in the anti-spoofing entries for this SAP when l2-header is enabled. The parameter may be changed mid-session. Existing sessions will not be re-programmed unless a tools perform command is issued for the lease.
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.

When configured, the SAP parameter will remap all MAC addresses of DHCP lease states on the specified SAP. When no optional MAC parameter is specified, the sap sap-id command remaps all MAC addresses of lease states towards the MAC address specified in the l2-header configuration.

re-ident-sub

Syntax 
re-ident-sub old-sub-ident-string to new-sub-ident-string
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command renames a subscriber identification string.

Parameters 
old-sub-ident-string—
Specifies the existing subscriber identification string to be renamed
new-sub-ident-string—
Specifies the new subscriber identification string name

redundancy

Syntax 
redundancy
Context 
tools>dump
Description 

This command enters the context to dump redundancy parameters.

multi-chassis

Syntax 
multi-chassis
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy
Description 

This command enters the context to dump multi-chassis parameters.

mc-endpoint

Syntax 
mc-endpoint peer ip-address
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis endpoint information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address

force-switchover

Syntax 
force-switchover tunnel-group local-group-id
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command manually switches over mc-ipsec mastership of the specified tunnel-group.

Parameters 
local-group-id—
Specifies the local tunnel-group ID configured under the config>redundancy.multichassis>peer>mc-ipsec context

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
mc-ring peer ip-address [ring sync-tag]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
sync-tag
Specifies the ring’s sync-tag created in the config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring context

srrp-sync-database

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps SRRP database information and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
instance instance-id
Dumps information for the specified Subscriber Router Redundancy Protocol instance configured on this system.
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps MCS database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
port-id | lag-id
Indicates the port or LAG ID to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
slot/mda/port or lag-lag-id

 

sync-tag
Specifies a synchronization tag to be used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application
Specifies a particular multi-chassis peer synchronization protocol application
Values—

dhcp-server:

local dhcp server (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

igmp:

Internet group management protocol

igmp-snooping:

igmp-snooping

mc-ring:

multi-chassis ring

mld-snooping:

multicast listener discovery-snooping

srrp:

simple router redundancy protocol (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-host-trk:

subscriber host tracking (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-mgmt:

subscriber management (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

 

type
Indicates the locally deleted or alarmed deleted entries in the MCS database per multi-chassis peer
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

detail—
Displays detailed information

mc-ipsec

Syntax 
mc-ipsec
Context 
tools>perform>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command enters the context to configure mc-ipsec parameters.

mc-endpoint

Syntax 
mc-endpoint peer ip-address
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis endpoint information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
mc-ring peer ip-address [ring sync-tag]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address.
sync-tag
Specifies the ring’s sync-tag created in the config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring context.

srrp-sync-database

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps SRRP database information and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
instance-id
Dumps information for the specified Subscriber Router Redundancy Protocol instance configured on this system.
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps MCS database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
port-id | lag-id
Indicates the port or LAG ID to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
slot/mda/port or lag-lag-id

 

sync-tag
Specifies a synchronization tag to be used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application
Specifies a particular multi-chassis peer synchronization protocol application
Values—

dhcp-server:

local dhcp server (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

igmp:

Internet group management protocol

igmp-snooping:

igmp-snooping

mc-ring:

multi-chassis ring

mld-snooping:

multicast listener discovery-snooping

srrp:

simple router redundancy protocol (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-host-trk:

subscriber host tracking (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-mgmt:

subscriber management (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

 

type
Indicates the locally deleted or alarmed deleted entries in the MCS database per multi-chassis peer
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

detail—
Displays detailed information

forcerenew

Syntax 
forcerenew svc-id service-id {ip ip-address[/mask] | mac ieee-address}
forcerenew {interface interface-name | sap sap-id | sdp sdp-id:vc-id} [ip ip-address[/mask] |mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command forces the renewal of lease state and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR

Parameters 
service-id
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified SAP.
ip-address
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified IP address
ieee-address
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified MAC address
interface-name
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified interface name

local-user-db

Syntax 
local-user-db local-user-db-name
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command provides tools to control the local user database.

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the name of a local user database up to 32 characters in length

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db
Description 

This command provides the tools to control IPoE entries in the local user database.

host-lookup

Syntax 
host-lookup [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id-ascii] [sap-id sap-id] [service-id service-id] [string vso-string] [system-id system-id] [option60 option-60-ascii] [circuit-id circuit-id-ascii] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [option60-hex option60-hex] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [ip-prefix ip-prefix/ip-prefix-length]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe
Description 

This command performs a lookup in the local user database.

Parameters 
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
remote-id
Specifies the information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-ascii—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length in ASCII
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

vso-string—
Specifies a Vendor Specific Option (VSO) string
system-id—
Specifies the system ID
Values—
up to 255 characters maximum

 

option-60-ascii
Specifies the Vendor-Identifying Vendor Option to match against. Option 60 is encoded as Type - Length - Value and must be formatted in ASCII.
option-60-hex
Specifies the Vendor-Identifying Vendor Option to match against. Option 60 is encoded as Type - Length - Value and must be formatted in HEX

ppp

Syntax 
ppp
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db
Description 

This command provides the tools to control PPPoE entries in the local user database.

authentication

Syntax 
authentication user-name user-name password password [circuit-id circuit-id] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [sap-id sap-id] [service-name service-name]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ppp
Description 

This command authenticates the PPPoE user name.

Parameters 
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
password
Specifies the password of this host up to 64 characters in length
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
circuit-id-hex
Specifies the circuit ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 254 hex nibbles)

 

derived-id
Specifies an ASCII string that uniquely identifies a host, and is derived by a Python script from packet content available during a DHCP transaction up to 255 characters in length
ieee-address
Specifies information about the MAC address of the PPP session
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-hex—
Specifies the remote ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 510hex nibbles)

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters in length
service-name
Specifies the service name

host-lookup

Syntax 
host-lookup [circuit-id circuit-id] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [sap-id sap-id] [service-name service-name] [user-name user-name]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ppp
Description 

This command performs a lookup in the local user database.

Parameters 
circuit-id circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID from the Option 82
circuit-id-hex
Specifies the circuit ID in hexadecimal format from the Option 82
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 254 hex nibbles)

 

derived-id
Specifies an ASCII string that uniquely identifies a host, and is derived by a Python script from packet content available during a DHCP transaction
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-hex—
Specifies the remote ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 510hex nibbles)

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters in length
service-name
Specifies a PPP service name up to 253 characters in length
user-name
Specifies a user name up to 128 characters in length

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring data.

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis sync database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Dumps the specified address of the multi-chassis peer
port-id
Dumps the specified port ID of the multi-chassis peer
lag-id
Dumps the specified Link Aggregation Group (LAG) on this system
sync-tag
Dumps the synchronization tag used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application—
Dumps the specified application information that was synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
dhcps, igmp, igmp-snooping, mc-ring, srrp, sub-mgmt, mld-snooping, all

 

detail—
Displays detailed information
type
Filters by the specified entry type
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

sync-database-reconcile

Syntax 
sync-database-reconcile [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id [sync-tag sync-tag]] [application application]
sync-database-reconcile [peer ip-address] [sdp sdp-id [sync-tag sync-tag]] [application application]
Context 
tools>perform>redundancy>multi-chassis>mc-ipsec
Description 

This command provides the parameters to reconcile MCS database entries.

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IP address (in the form of a.b.c.d)
port-id—
Specifies the port ID in the slot/MDA/port format
lag-id—
Specifies the LAG ID
Values—
lag-id: lag-id
lag: keyword
id: 1 to 200

 

syn-tag—
Specifies the syn tag up to 32 characters in length
application—
Specifies the application
Values—
dhcp-server — Specifies the local DHCP server
igmp — Specifies the Internet group management protocol
igmp-snooping — Specifies igmp-snooping
mc-ring — Specifies multi-chassis ring
l2tp — Specifies L2TP
mld — Specifies multicast listener discovery
mld-snooping — Specifies multicast listener discovery-snooping
srrp — Specifies simple router redundancy protocol
sub-host-trk — Specifies subscriber host tracking
sub-mgmt-ipoe — Specifies subscriber management for IPoE
sub-mgmt-pppoe — Specifies subscriber management for PPPoE
mc-ipsec — Specifies multi-chassis IPsec
python — Specifies Python cache
diameter-proxy — Specifies diameter proxy
pim-snpg-sap — Specifies protocol independent multicast snooping for SAPs
pim-snpg-sdp — Specifies protocol independent multicast snooping for SDPs

 

sdp-id—
Specifies the SDP ID
Values—
1 to 17407

 

srrp-sync-data

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis SRRP sync database information.

Parameters 
instance-id—
Specifies the instance ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

ip-address—
Dumps the specified address (in the form of a.b.c.d)

route-downloader

Syntax 
route-downloader start [force]
Context 
tools>perform>aaa
Description 

This command causes the download process to start immediately. If an ongoing download is already in progress then no further action is needed, except if the force keyword is added. In case the force keyword is added, then the current download is aborted and a new one is immediately restarted. If aborting the current download, the internal route table should not be emptied or cleared.

Parameters 
start—
Starts the download process immediately
force—
Causes the current download to be aborted and a new one is immediately restarted

router

Syntax 
router [router-instance]
router service-name service-name
Context 
tools>dump
Description 

This command enters the context for tools dump commands in the specified routing instance.

Parameters 
router-instance—
Specifies the router instance name (Base or management) or service ID
service-name—
Specifies the configured service name for the routing instance

ipoe-session

Syntax 
ipoe-session
Context 
tools>dump>router
Description 

This command enters the context for IPoE session-related tools dump commands in the specified routing instance.

migration

Syntax 
migration [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
tools>dump>router>ipoe-session
Description 

This command displays details on the IPoE session migration progress. It shows per group interface the number of hosts per type (DHCPv4, DHCPv6 and SLAAC) that are associated with an IPoE session or that are not associated with an IPoE session.

Output 

The following is an example of IPoE session migration information.

Sample Output
# tools dump router ipoe-session migration interface group-int-1-1
================================================================================
 Type                Total     IPoE session     Non IPoE session
================================================================================
 Group-interface: group-int-1-1 (IPoE session enabled)
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 DHCPv4              2         1                1
 DHCPv6              3         2                1
 SLAAC               0         0                0
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 IPoE sessions       1
================================================================================

9.25.2.4.16. Debug Commands

diameter

Syntax 
[no] diameter
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command enables debugging for diameter.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

dest-realm

Syntax 
dest-realm realm
no dest-realm
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts the output to a specific destination-realm.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
realm—
Specifies the realm up to 80 characters in length

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level level
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command configures the detail level of debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
level—
Specifies the detail level
Values—
low, medium, high

 

diameter-peer

Syntax 
diameter-peer peer [psm-events]
no diameter-peer
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts output to a specific peer.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
psm-events—
Specifies to restrict output to the peer’s state machine (PSM)

diameter-peer-policy

Syntax 
diameter-peer-policy policy
no diameter-peer-policy policy
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages on peers of a specific diameter peer policy. Up to eight diameter peer policies can be specified.

The no form of the command removes the specified diameter peer policy and all debug statement under this policy from the debug configuration.

Parameters 
policy—
Specifies the diameter peer policy name, up to 32 characters in length

avp-match

Syntax 
avp-match id
no avp-match id
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages within the diameter peer policy that belong to a diameter session identified based on the AVP value matching in a diameter application message.At least the message type and one AVP match criteria must be specified in an avp-match id command.

If a diameter application message matches all criteria within one AVP match ID, then the session ID is learned and all subsequent messages of that diameter session are shown until a relearning occurs. (OR function between avp-match id commands.)

When the session ID is learned in an Answer message, an attempt is made to include the corresponding Request message in the debug output: The Request message should still be available in the system and must pass all debug filters (such as message-type).

By default an avp-match id is disabled and must be configured with the debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match no shutdown to activate.

Parameters 
id—
Specifies the AVP match ID, up to five per diameter peer policy
Values—
1 to 5

 

avp

Syntax 
avp avp-id type type [ascii | hex] value value
no avp avp-id
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command specifies an AVP match criteria for AVP value matching. At least one and up to five AVP match criteria can be specified in an avp-match id command. When multiple AVP match criteria are specified, they must all match to be successful and result in a diameter session ID learning. (AND function between avp avp-id commands.)

The AVP in an AVP match criteria is identified by its AVP ID. The AVP ID is specified as [vendor-id-]avp-code[.avp-id] with nesting up to five levels deep.

The format type of the AVP should match the standard documents in which the AVP is specified. Any AVP can be specified as an octet string in hex format.

Parameters 
avp-id—
Specifies that an AVP is a [vendor-id-]avp-code[.avp-id], up to five levels deep. For example to specify the Multiple-Services-Credit-Control.Quota-Holding-Time AVP, use avp-id = 456.10415-871.
Values—
vendor-id: [1 to 4294967295]
avp-code: [1 to 4294967295]

 

type—
Specifies the format type of the AVP as octets string, integer32, integer64, unsigned32, unsigned64 or address. The type should match the format as specified in the corresponding standard documents. Any AVP can be specified as octet string in hex.
ascii | hex—
Specifies the value format. The ASCII format is default. The hexadecimal format value should start with "0x". For example: 0x0000000a to specify a 4 byte integer value in hexadecimal format.
value—
Specifies the actual value of the AVP that should be matched against (256 characters maximum; 127 characters maximum when specified in hex)

message-type

Syntax 
message-type [ccr] [cca] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
no message-type
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command specifies the message type match criteria for AVP value matching. Only specified diameter application messages are used for AVP value matching. This is a mandatory criteria in an avp-match id command.This command does not restrict the debug output to the specified messages.

Parameters 
ccr—
credit control request
cca—
credit control answer
rar —
re-authentication request
raa —
re-authentication answer
asr —
abort session request
asa —
abort session answer
aar —
aa request
aaa —
aa answer
all —
all message types

shutdown

Syntax 
[no] shutdown
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command enables or disables the avp-match id criteria for filtering debug output based on AVP value matching.A shutdown of the avp-match id clears the learned diameter session ID.

diameter-peer

Syntax 
diameter-peer peer [psm-events]
no diameter-peer
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages on a specific peer within the diameter peer policy. Overrides the debug>diam>diam-peer debug command for the specified diameter peer policy. A single peer can be specified per diameter peer policy.

When no peer is specified at the diameter peer policy level, the debug output is restricted to the peer configured at the debug>diam level.

The no form of the command removes the peer from the debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy debug output.

Parameters 
peer—
Specifies a peer name, up to 32 characters in length
psm-events—
Specifies to include Peer State Machine (PSM) events in the debug output

message-type

Syntax 
message-type [ccr] [cca] [cer] [cea] [dwr] [dwa] [dpr] [dpa] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
no message-type
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
debug>diam
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to the specified message types.

When specified within a diameter peer policy, it overrides the message type configuration at the debug>diam level for messages received and sent on that diameter peer policy.

The no form of the command removes the message type from the debug configuration.

Parameters 
ccr—
credit control request
cca—
credit control answer
cer —
capabilities exchange request
cea —
capabilities exchange answer
dwr —
device watchdog request
dwa —
device watchdog answer
dpr —
disconnect peer request
dpa —
disconnect peer answer
rar —
re-authentication request
raa —
re-authentication answer
asr —
abort session request
asa —
abort session answer
aar —
aa request
aaa —
aa answer
all —
all message types

origin-realm

Syntax 
origin-realm realm
no origin-realm
Context 
debug>diam
Description 

This command restricts output to a specific origin-realm.

arp-host

Syntax 
[no] arp-host
Context 
debug>service>id
Description 

This command enables and configures ARP host debugging.

The no form of the command disables ARP host debugging.

one-time-http-redirection

Syntax 
one-time-http-redirection
Context 
debug>service>id
Description 

This command produces one-time HTTP redirection debug output.

ppp

Syntax 
[no] ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>
Description 

This command enables the PPP debug context.

The no form of the command disables PPP debugging.

event

Syntax 
[no] event
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables the PPP event debug context.

The no form of the command disables PPP event debugging.

dhcp-client

Syntax 
dhcp-client [terminate-only]
no dhcp-client
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enable PPP event debug for DHCP client.

The no form of the command disables PPP event debugging for the DHCP client.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debug for local terminated PPP session

l2tp

Syntax 
l2tp [terminate-only]
no l2tp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables PPP L2TP event debug.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debug for local terminated PPP session

local-address-assignment

Syntax 
local-address-assignment [terminate-only]
no local-address-assignment
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables debugging for local-address-assignment events.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debugging for local address assignment

ppp

Syntax 
ppp [terminate-only]
no ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables PPP event debug.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debugging for local terminated PPP session

mac

Syntax 
[no] mac ieee-address
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command displays PPP packets for a particular MAC address.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

msap

Syntax 
[no] msap msap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables debugging for specific PPP MSAPs.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

packet

Syntax 
[no] packet
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables the PPP packet debug context.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level {low | medium | high}
no detail-level
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command specify the detail level of PPP packet debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
low | medium | high—
Specifies the detail level of PPP packet debug output

dhcp-client

Syntax 
[no] dhcp-client
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables packet debug output for DHCP client of the PPP session

The no form of the command disables debugging.

discovery

Syntax 
discovery [padi] [pado] [padr] [pads] [padt]
no discovery
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables PPP discovery packet debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
[padi] [pado] [padr] [pads] [padt]
Enables the corresponding type of PPP discovery packet

mode

Syntax 
mode {dropped-only | ingr-and-dropped | egr-ingr-and-dropped}
no mode
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command specifies PPP packet debug mode.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
dropped-only—
Displays only dropped packets
ingr-and-dropped—
Displays only ingress packet and dropped packets
egr-ingr-and-dropped—
Displays ingress, egress and dropped packets

ppp

Syntax 
ppp [lcp] [pap] [chap] [ipcp] [ipv6cp]
no ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables PPP discovery packet debug output for the specified PPP protocol.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
[lcp] [pap] [chap] [ipcp] [ipv6cp]
Enables debug for the specified protocol

remote-id

Syntax 
[no] remote-id remote-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables debugging for specific PPP remote-ids.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

sap

Syntax 
[no] sap sap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables PPP debug output for the specified SAP, this command allow multiple instances.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies the SAP ID

username

Syntax 
[no] username username
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified username. since not all PPP packets contain username, so a mac debug filter will be created automatically when system sees a PPP packet contain the specified username.

Multiple username filters can be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
user-name—
Specifies the PPP username

circuit-id

Syntax 
[no] circuit-id circuit-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified circuit-id.

Multiple circuit-id filters can be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
circuit-id —
Specifies the circuit-id in PADI

remote-id

Syntax 
[no] remote-id remote-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified remote-id.

Multiple remote-id filters could be specified in the same debug command.

Parameters 
remote-id—
Specifies the remote-id in PADI

msap

Syntax 
[no] msap msap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified managed SAP.

Multiple msap filters could be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
msap-id—
Specifies the managed SAP ID

authentication

Syntax 
authentication [policy policy-name] [mac-addr ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id]
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command debugs subscriber authentication.

Parameters 
policy-name
Specifies an existing subscriber management authentication policy name
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx or xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx
circuit-id
Specify the circuit-id, up to 256 characters in length

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
[no] sub-ident-policy policy-name
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command debugs subscriber identification policies.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the subscriber identification policy to debug

script-compile-error

Syntax 
[no] script-compile-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command send the traceback of the compile error to the logger. The traceback contains detailed information about where and why the compilation fails. The compilation takes place when the CLI user changes the admin state of the Python URL from shutdown to no-shutdown.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-export-variables

Syntax 
[no] script-export-variables
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the result (the three output variables) of the Python script to the logger when the script ran successfully.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-output

Syntax 
[no] script-output
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the output (such as from 'print' statements) of the Python script to the logger.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-output-on-error

Syntax 
[no] script-output-on-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the output (such as from print statements) of the Python script to the logger, but only when the script fails.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-runtime-error

Syntax 
[no] script-runtime-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the traceback of the Python script failure to the logger.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-all-info

Syntax 
script-all-info
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command enables the script-compile-error, script-export-variables, script-output, script-output-on-error, and script-runtime-error functionalities.

srrp

Syntax 
[no] srrp
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

events

Syntax 
[no] events [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
debug>router>srrp
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

packets

Syntax 
[no] packets [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
debug>router>srrp
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

radius

Syntax 
[no] radius
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enables the debug router RADIUS context.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level {low | medium | high}
no detail-level
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the output detail level of command debug router radius.

Default 

medium

Parameters 
low—
Specifies that the output includes packet type, server address, length, radius-server-policy name
medium—
Specifies all output in low level including the RADIUS attributes in the packet
high—
Specifies all output in medium level including the hex packet dump

packet-type

Syntax 
packet-type [authentication] [accounting] [coa]
no packet-type
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the RADIUS packet type filter of command debug router radius

Default 

authentication accounting coa

Parameters 
authentication—
Specifies the RADIUS authentication packet
accounting—
Specifies the RADIUS accounting packet
coa—
Specifies the RADIUS change of authorization packet

radius-attr

Syntax 
radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction]
radius-attr type attribute-type [transaction] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction] [encoding encoding-type]
radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction] [encoding encoding-type] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
no radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type]
no radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
no radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type]
no radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] {address | hex | integer | string} [0..16777215] attribute-value
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the RADIUS attribute filter of command debug router radius.

Parameters 
attribute-type
Specifies the RADIUS attribute type
Values—
1 to 255

 

attribute-ext-type
Specifies the RADIUS attribute extended type (RFC 6929)
Values—
1 to 255

 

address—
Specifies the value is a IPv4 or IPv6 address/prefix/subnet
string—
Specifies the value is a ASCII string
integer—
Specifies the value is a integer
hex—
Specifies the value is a binary string in hex format, such as “\0xAB01FE”
attribute-value
Specifies the value of the RADIUS attribute
Values—

address

<ipv4-address> | <ipv6-address> | <ipv6-prefix/prefix-length>

ipv4-address

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

ipv6-prefix-length [0 to 128]

hex

[0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (max 506 hex nibbles)]

integer

[0 to 4294967295]

string

ascii-string (max 253 chars)

 

transaction—
Specifies that the system will output both request and response packets in the same session even if the response packet does not include the filter attribute
vendor-id
Specifies the vendor id for the vendor specific attribute
Values—
0 to 16777215

 

encoding-type
Specifies the size of the vendor-type and vendor-length in bytes. It is a two digitals string: “xy”, x is the size of vendor-type, range from 1 to 4; y is the size of vendor-length, range from 0 to 2; it is “11” by default.
Values—
type-size:1 to 4, length-size: 0 to 2

 

wpp

Syntax 
[no] wpp
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enters the context to configure WPP debugging parameters.

packet

Syntax 
[no] packet
Context 
debug>router>wpp
debug>router>wpp>portal
Description 

This command enables WPP packet debugging.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level detail-level
Context 
debug>router>wpp
debug>router>wpp>packet
debug>router>wpp>portal>packet
Description 

This command specifies the detail level of WPP packet debugging.

Parameters 
detail-level—
specifies the detail level of WPP packet debugging
Values—
high — Specifies a high detail level for WPP packet debugging
low — Specifies a low detail for WPP packet debugging

 

portal

Syntax 
[no] portal wpp-portal-name
Context 
debug>router>wpp
Description 

This command enables WPP debugging for the specified WPP portal.

Parameters 
wpp-portal-name—
Specifies the WPP portal name

call-trace

Syntax 
call-trace
Context 
debug
Description 

This command enters the context to set up various call trace debug sessions.

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
debug>call-trace
Description 

This command enters the context to set up call trace debugging for IP over Ethernet (IPoE) sessions.

trace

Syntax 
trace sap sap-id [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace mac ieee-address [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace circuit-id circuit-id [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace remote-id remote-id [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
no trace [sap sap-id] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id]
no trace name trace-name
Context 
debug>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command enables tracing for IPoE sessions specified by the configured parameters. This command can trace a single session or multiple sessions, and can use wildcard characters.

This command can be executed multiple times to start multiple traces. When rules overlap, such as for a wildcard SAP and a specific SAP, the rule that a specific trace will be associated with cannot be guaranteed.

The no form of the command will prevent new traces from being configured and will terminate all trace jobs that were previously started using the trace command.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that is used to filter sessions to trace. The circuit-id and remote-id parameters are mutually exclusive.
ieee-address—
Specifies a MAC address that is used to identify a session to trace, in the format “ab:cd:ef:01:23:45”. A wildcard character can be used to match all remaining octets; for example, the format “ab:cd:ef:*” can be used to filter by OUI.
num—
Specifies the maximum number of jobs that may be started with this rule.
Values—
1 to 50

 

Default—
1
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that is used to filter sessions to trace. The remote-id and circuit-id parameters are mutually exclusive.
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP to trace. The following formats are accepted:
  1. port/lag/pw-port:svlan.cvlan
  2. port/lag/pw-port:vlan
  3. port/lag/pw-port
  4. port/lag/pw-port:vlan.*
  5. port/lag/pw-port:* (also matches *.*)
trace-existing-sessions—
Specifies that existing IPoE sessions will be traced. If this parameter is not included, only new IPoE sessions will be traced.
trace-name—
Specifies the name by which the trace will be referenced, up to 16 characters maximum.
trace-profile-name—
Specifies the name of the trace profile to be applied. The default parameters will be used if a trace profile is not specified.

9.25.2.5.16. Monitor Commands

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sap sap-id sla-profile sla-profile-name [base | ingress-queue-id ingress-queue-id | egress-queue-id egress-queue-id] [interval seconds] [repeat repeat] [absolute | rate]
Context 
monitor>service
Description 

This command monitors statistics for a subscriber.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile to monitor
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
sla-profile-name
Specifies an existing SLA profile
seconds
Configures the interval for each display in seconds
Default—
11
Values—
11 to 60

 

repeat
Configures how many times the command is repeated
Default—
10
Values—
1 to 999

 

absolute—
Specifies that raw statistics are displayed, without processing. No calculations are performed on the delta or rate statistics.
Default—
mode delta
rate —
Specifies that the rate-per-second for each statistic is displayed instead of the delta
base —
Monitors base statistics
ingress-queue-id ingress-queue-id
Monitors statistics for this queue
Values—
1 to 32

 

egress-queue-id egress-queue-id
Monitors statistics for this queue
Values—
1 to 8

 

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber monitor statistics

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 94531                  30704535
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 7332                    2510859
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 87067                   28152288
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 90862                   12995616
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance per Queue statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Ingress Queue 1 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Ingress Queue 2 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 94531                   30704535
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 7332                    2510859
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 87067                   28152288
 
Ingress Queue 3 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Ingress Queue 11 (Multipoint) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 1
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 90862                   12995616
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 2
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 3
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default base rate
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 109099                  35427060
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 8449                    2894798
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 100523                  32489663
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 105578                  15104553
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
At time t = 11 sec (Mode: Rate)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets                  % Port
                                                                        Util.
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0                       0.00
Off. LowPrio          : 1469                    477795                  0.38
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0                       0.00
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0                       0.00
Dro. LowPrio          : 119                     40691                   0.03
For. InProf           : 0                       0                       0.00
For. OutProf          : 1349                    437350                  0.34
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0                       0.00
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0                       0.00
For. InProf           : 1469                    209129                  0.16
For. OutProf          : 0                       0                       0.00
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default ingress-queue-id 1
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Ingress Queue 1 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default egress-queue-id 1
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Egress Queue 1
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 164366                  23506178
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
==============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

host

Syntax 
host [sap sap-id] [wholesaler service-id] [port port-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [detail]
host [sap sap-id] [wholesaler service-id] [port port-id] no-inter-dest-id [detail]
host summary
host [detail] wholesaler service-id (VPRN only)
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays static host information configured on this service.

Parameters 
sap-id
Displays SAP information for the specified SAP ID
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
summary—
Displays summary host information
wholesaler service-id
Specifies the VPRN service ID of the wholesaler. When specified in this context, SAP, SDP, interface, IP address and MAC parameters are ignored. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

Default 

14400 seconds

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the minimum number of seconds a learned ARP entry will be stored in the ARP table, expressed as a decimal integer. A value of zero specifies that the timer is inoperative and learned ARP entries will not be aged.
Values—
0 to 65535

 

lease-populate

Syntax 
lease-populate [nbt-of-entries]
no lease-populate
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>dhcp
Description 

This command enables dynamic host lease state management for SAPs.

For VPLS, DHCP snooping must be explicitly enabled (using the snoop command) at all points where DHCP messages requiring snooping enter the VPLS instance (both from the DHCP server and from the subscribers). Lease state information is extracted from snooped DHCP ACK messages to populate lease state table entries for the MSAP.

The optional number-of-entries parameter is used to define the number lease state table entries allowed for an MSAP or IP interface. If number-of-entries is omitted, only a single entry is allowed. Once the maximum number of entries has been reached, subsequent lease state entries are not allowed and subsequent DHCP ACK messages are discarded.

The retained lease state information representing dynamic hosts may be used to:

  1. Populate an MSAP based anti-spoof filter table to provide dynamic anti-spoof filtering. If the system is unable to populate the dynamic host information in the anti-spoof filter table on the SAP, the DHCP ACK message must be discarded without adding new lease state entry or updating an existing lease state entry.
  2. Generate dynamic ARP replies if arp-reply-agent is enabled.

The no form of the command disables dynamic host lease state management for the MSAP.

Default 

no lease-populate

Parameters 
nbt-of-entries—
Specifies the maximum number of DHCP leases
Values—
1 to 131071

 

export-host-routes

Syntax 
[no] export-host-routes
Context 
config>service>ies>subscriber-interface
config>service>vprn>subscriber-interface
Description 

This command controls the export of subscriber management host routes from a retail service to the corresponding forwarding wholesale VPRN service.

By default, subscriber management host routes are not exported.

The presence of retail subscriber management host routes in the wholesale VPRN service is required for downstream traffic forwarding in multi-chassis redundancy scenario’s with a redundant interface and when the retail subscriber subnets are not leaked in the wholesale VPRN service (allow-unmatching-subnets or unnumbered retail subscriber interface).

This command will fail if the subscriber interface is not associated with a forwarding wholesale service subscriber interface or if the subscriber interface is not configured to support address allocation outside the provisioned subnets (allow-unmatching-subnets or unnumbered subscriber interface)

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no export-host-routes

group-interface

Syntax 
group-interface ip-int-name [create] [type]
group-interface ip-int-name
Context 
config>service>ies>subscriber-interface
config>service>vprn>subscriber-interface
Description 

This command creates a group interface. This interface is designed for triple-play services where multiple SAPs are part of the same subnet. A group interface may contain one or more SAPs.

The no form of the command removes the group interface from the subscriber interface.

Default 

no group interfaces configured

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
Specifies the interface name of a group interface. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on.), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
lns —
Specifies to use LNS
wlangw—
Specifies to use dynamic GRE encapsulation

data-trigger

Syntax 
data-trigger
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure data-triggered subscriber management entities.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress network filter parameters for the interface.

policy-accounting

Syntax 
policy-accounting template-name
no policy-accounting
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ingress
Description 

This command configures the specified policy accounting template.

The no form of the command disables the policy accounting template.

Parameters 
template-name—
Specifies the template name up to 32 characters in length

ip-mtu

Syntax 
ip-mtu octets
no ip-mtu
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command specifies the maximum size of IP packets on this group interface. Packets larger than this are fragmented.

The ip-mtu applies to all IPoE host types (dhcp, arp, static). For PPP/L2TP sessions, the ip-mtu is not taken into account for the MTU negotiation. The ppp-mtu in the ppp-policy should be used instead.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ip-mtu

Parameters 
octets—
Specifies the largest frame size (in octets) that this interface can handle
Values—
512 to 9000

 

enable-ingress-stats

Syntax 
[no] enable-ingress-stats
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enables the collection of ingress interface IP stats. This command is only applicable to IP statistics, and not to uRPF statistics.

If enabled, then the following statistics are collected:

  1. IPv4 offered packets
  2. IPv4 offered octets
  3. IPv6 offered packets
  4. IPv6 offered octets
Note:

Octet statistics for IPv4 and IPv6 bytes at IP interfaces include the layer 2 frame overhead.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no enable-ingress-stats

host-connectivity-verify

Syntax 
host-connectivity-verify [interval interval] [action {remove | alarm}] [timeout retry-timeout] [retry-count count] [family family]
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enables subscriber host connectivity verification on a given SAP within a service. This tool will periodically scan all known hosts (from dhcp-state) and perform UC ARP requests. The subscriber host connectivity verification will maintain state (connected vs. not-connected) for all hosts.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no host-connectivity-verify

Parameters 
interval
Specifies the interval, in minutes, which specifies the time interval which all known sources should be verified. The actual rate is then dependent on the number of known hosts and interval.
Values—
1 to 6000
A zero value can be used by the SNMP agent to disable host-connectivity-verify.

 

action {remove | alarm}—
Defines the action taken on a subscriber host connectivity verification failure for a given host. The remove keyword raises an alarm and removes dhcp-state and releases all allocated resources (queues, table entries and and so on). DHCP-RELEASE will be signaled to corresponding DHCP server. Static hosts will be never removed. The alarm keyword raises an alarm indicating that the host is disconnected.
retry-timeout
Specifies the retry timeout
Values—
10 to 60 seconds

 

count
Specifies the number of retry requests
Values—
2 to 29

 

family
Allows the host connectivity checks to be performed for IPv4 endpoint, IPv6 endpoint or both. With family IPv6 configured, host connectivity checks will be performed on the global unicast address (assigned via SLAAC or DHCPv6 IA_NA) and link-local address of a Layer 3 RG or bridged hosts. In case of SLAAC assignment, host connectivity can only be performed if the /128 is known (via downstream ND). DHCPv6 PD assigned prefixes will be removed if link-local address is determined to be unreachable via host connectivity check” Reachability checks for GUA and link-local address will be done simultaneously.
Values—
ipv4, ipv6, both

 

ipoe-linking

Syntax 
ipoe-linking
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IPoE host linking.

gratuitous-rtr-adv

Syntax 
[no] gratuitous-rtr-adv
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>ipoe-linking
config>service>vprn>sub-if>ipoe-linking
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-linking
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-linking
Description 

This command enables the generation of unsolicited Router-advertisement on creation of v4 host.

The no form of the command disables gratuitous-rtr-adv.

Default 

gratuitous-rtr-adv

ipoe-session

Syntax 
[no] ipoe-session
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IPoE session parameters.

shared-circuit-id

Syntax 
[no] shared-circuit-id
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

If configured, circuit-id in DHCPv4 option-82 is used to authenticate DHCPv6. If DHCPv6 is received before DHCPv4, it is dropped. Also, a SLAAC host is created based on DHCPv4 authentication if RADIUS returns IPv6 framed-prefix. IPv6oE host is deleted if the linked IPv4oE host is deleted due to DHCP release or lease time-out. The linkage between IPv4 and IPv6 is based on SAP and MAC address. The sharing of circuit-id from DHCPv4 for authentication of DHCPv6 (or SLAAC) allows 7750 SR to work around lack of support for LDRA on Access-nodes.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no shared-circuit-id

ipv6

Syntax 
[no] ipv6
Context 
config>service>ies>if
config>service>vprn>if
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IPv6 for an IES interface.

qos-route-lookup

Syntax 
[no] qos-route-lookup
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipv6
Description 

This command enables QoS route lookup for the interface.

The no form of the command reverts to the default (strict) mode.

urpf-check

Syntax 
[no] urpf-check
Context 
config>service>ies>if
config>service>ies>if>ipv6
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipv6
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enables unicast RPF (uRPF) check on this interface.

The no form of the command disables unicast RPF (uRPF) check on this interface.

Default 

no urpf-check

mode

Syntax 
mode {strict | loose | strict-no-ecmp}
no mode
Context 
config>service>ies>if>urfp-check
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipv6>urfp-check
Description 

This command specifies the mode of unicast RPF check.

The no form of the command reverts to the default (strict) mode.

Default 

strict

Parameters 
strict—
When specified, uRPF checks whether incoming packet has a source address that matches a prefix in the routing table, and whether the interface expects to receive a packet with this source address prefix.
loose—
In loose mode, uRPF checks whether incoming packet has source address with a corresponding prefix in the routing table. However, the loose mode does not check whether the interface expects to receive a packet with a specific source address prefix. This object is valid only when urpf-check is enabled.
strict-no-ecmp—
When a packet is received on an interface in this mode and the SA matches an ECMP route the packet is dropped by uRPF

match-circuit-id

Syntax 
[no] match-circuit-id
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>dhcp
Description 

This command enables Option 82 circuit ID on relayed DHCP packet matching. For routed CO, the group interface DHCP relay process is stateful. When packets are relayed to the server the virtual router ID, transaction ID, SAP ID, and client hardware MAC address of the relayed packet are tracked.

When a response is received from the server the virtual router ID, transaction ID, and client hardware MAC address must be matched to determine the SAP on which to send the packet out. In some cases, the virtual router ID, transaction ID, and client hardware MAC address are not guaranteed to be unique.

When the match-circuit-id command is enabled this as part of the key is used to guarantee correctness in our lookup. This is really only needed when dealing with an IP aware DSLAM that proxies the client hardware MAC address.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no match-circuit-id

mac

Syntax 
mac ieee-address
no mac
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command assigns a specific MAC address to a subscriber group interface.

The no form of the command returns the MAC address of the group interface to the default value.

Default 

The physical MAC address associated with the Ethernet interface that the SAP is configured on (the default MAC address assigned to the interface, assigned by the system).

Parameters 
ieee-address—
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.

oper-up-while-empty

Syntax 
[no] oper-up-while-empty
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command allows the subscriber interface to treat this group interface to be operationally enabled without any active SAPs.

This command is typically used with MSAPs where advertising the subnet prior to having a MSAP dynamically created is needed.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no oper-up-while-empty

policy-control

Syntax 
policy-control diameter-policy-name
no policy-control
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command configures a policy-control policy for the interface.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
diameter-policy-name
Specifies the name of an existing diameter policy up to 32 characters in length

proxy-arp-policy

Syntax 
[no] proxy-arp-policy policy-name [policy-name...(up to 5 max)]
Context 
config>service>ies>if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>if
Description 

This command configures a proxy ARP policy for the interface.

The no form of this command disables the proxy ARP capability.

Default 

no proxy-arp-policy

Parameters 
policy-name—
The export route policy name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

The specified name(s) must already be defined.

router-advertisements

Syntax 
[no] router-advertisements
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>ipv6
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipv6
config>service>vprn>sub-if>ipv6
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipv6
Description 

This command enables IPv6 router advertisements for this interface.

The no form of the command disables the router advertisements.

mode

Syntax 
mode mode
Context 
config>card>mda>atm
Description 

This command configures the ATM MDA into a mode with the increased VC scale (16k VCs, as opposed to 8K VCs). ESM is supported only in 16K VCs mode. In 16K VCs mode, there is only one queue allocated to each VC in the ATM MDA. In 8K VCs mode, there are two queues allocated per VC.

The 16K VC mode is supported only on the 4-port oc-3/12c/STM-1/4c and the 16-port ATM oc-3/STM-1 ATM MDA.

Changing the ATM MDA mode requires a reset of the MDA. A warning is issued asking for the confirmation before the command is executed.

Default 

max8k-vc

Parameters 
mode—
Specifies the VC scale
Values—
max8k-vc, max16k-vc

 

agg-rate

Syntax 
[no] agg-rate
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
Description 

This command enters the context to configure aggregation rate parameters. This command is used to control an HQoS aggregate rate limit. It is used in conjunction with the following parameter commands: rate, limit-unused-bandwidth, and queue-frame-based-accounting.

When specified under a Vport, the agg-rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate or port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command.

The no form of the command disables the aggregation rate.

rate

Syntax 
rate {max | rate}
no rate
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport>agg-rate
Description 

This command defines the enforced aggregate rate for all queues associated with the agg-rate context. A rate must be specified for the agg-rate context to be considered to be active on the context’s object (SAP, subscriber, Vport, and so on.).

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no rate

Parameters 
rate —
Specifies the rate limit for the Vport
Values—
max, 1 to 3200000000, max

 

limit-unused-bandwidth

Syntax 
[no] limit-unused-bandwidth
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
Description 

This command enables aggregate rate overrun protection.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no limit-unused-bandwidth

queue-frame-based-accounting

Syntax 
[no] queue-frame-based-accounting
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress>agg-rate
Description 

This command enables frame-based accounting on all queues associated with the agg-rate context. Only supported on Ethernet ports. Not supported on HSMDA Ethernet ports. Packet byte offset settings are not included in the applied rate when queue frame based accounting is configured, however the offsets are applied to the statistics.

The no form of the command disables frame-based accounting.

Default 

no queue-frame-based-accounting

vpi

Syntax 
vpi vpi egress-traffic-desc atm-td-profile-id
no vpi vpi
Context 
config>port>sonet-sdh>path>atm
Description 

This command enables the ATM VP shaper under the ATM port. The type of ATM shaper are CBR or rt/nrt-VBR as defined by the traffic descriptor. It cannot be a UBR service-type.

All VCs within the shaper will degrade into a UBR type service class. For example, when a CBR type VC is associated with the shaper, it will degrade into a UBR type VC. Scheduling traffic amongst VCs within the shaper is based on WRR using the weight parameter.

If the VP shaper is deleted, the VCs that were under it is restored to their original service category.

The VP shaper is statically configured and instantiated upon configuration.

A VP shaper can be seamlessly added to or removed from the active VCs in the system.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
vpi—
Specifies the VP identifier
Values—
0 to 4095

 

atm-td-profile-id—
Specifies the ATM traffic description ID
Values—
1 to 1000

 

traffic-desc

Syntax 
traffic-desc atm-td-profile-id
no traffic-desc
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>atm>egress
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>atm>ingress
Description 

This command references traffic-descriptor id for VPs and VCs. The VP shaper cannot be of service-type UBR.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

Default traffic descriptor (id=1) of UBR type.

Parameters 
atm-td-profile-id—
Specifies the traffic-descriptor ID
Values—
1 to 1000

 

weight

Syntax 
weight weight
no weight
Context 
config>qos>atm-td-profile
Description 

VCs within the VP tunnel are serviced by a single scheduler assigned to each VP tunnel. VCs within the shaped VP tunnel are degraded from the originally assigned service category to a common UBR service category (default traffic descriptor). Scheduling between VCs are based on WRR with a weight parameter that can be explicitly configured in the ATM traffic descriptor profile. If weight is not specifically configured, the defaults are taken.

The explicitly configured weight parameter is honored only on the ATM MDA in the max16k-vc mode. On all other ATM capable MDAs (ASAP or ATM MDA in max8k-vc mode), the weight parameter is ignored.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

VC degraded from CBR = weight 10

VC degraded from rt-VBR = weight 7

VC degraded from nrt-VBR = weight 5

VC degraded from UBR+ = weight 2

VC degraded from UBR = weight 1

Parameters 
weight—
Specifies the weight parameter value
Values—
1 to 255

 

encapsulation

Syntax 
encapsulation [aal5auto | aal5nlpid-ppp | aal5mux-ppp | aal5snap-bridged | aal5mux-bridged-eth-nofcs]
no encapsulation
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vpls>sap>atm
Description 

This command is a SAP level command that either statically sets or enable dynamic detection of the encapsulation.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no encapsulation

Parameters 
aal5auto —
This option is available only in max16k-vc mode on dynamic or static SAPs. Enables automatic detection of one of the four supported encapsulation types.
aal5mux-bridged-eth-nofcs—
This option already exist outside of the ESM context on regular interfaces. Within the ESM context (group-interfaces and capture SAPs), this option is available only in max16K-vc mode. The encapsulation is statically set to VC-MUX bridged Ethernet with no FCS. This is a valid encapsulation only for PPPoEoA.
aal5mux-ppp—
This option is available only in max16k-vc mode on dynamic or static SAPs. The encapsulation is statically set VC-MUX PPP encapsulation. This is a valid encapsulation only for PPPoA.
aal5nlpid-ppp—
dynamic or static SAPs. The encapsulation is statically set to NLPID (LLC) PPP encapsulation. This is a valid encapsulation only for PPPoA.
aal5snap-bridged—
This option already exist outside of the ESM context on regular interfaces. Within the ESM context (group-interfaces and capture SAPs), this option is available only in max16k-vc mode. The encapsulation is statically set to bridged Ethernet with or without FCS. Both PIDs (0x 00-01 and 0x 00-07) are accepted on ingress and use this to determine whether to strip four bytes from the end of the encapsulated Ethernet frame. The inner FCS is not checked. This is a valid encapsulation only for PPPoEoA.
Note:

On ATM, frames with Ethernet FCS or without FCS, are accepted but only frames with no Ethernet FCS are sent.

def-inter-dest-id

Syntax 
def-inter-dest-id string interest-string
def-inter-dest-id {use-top-q | use-vpi}
no def-inter-dest-id
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>sub-sla-mgmt
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy>sub-sla-mgmt
Description 

This command associates the Vport with the subscriber. The association method depends on the configured option.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no def-inter-dest-id

Parameters 
string—
A RADIUS VSA (Alc-Int-Dest-Id-Str, type 28) obtained during the subscriber authentication phase will contain the destination string name that will be matched against the string defined under the Vport. In this fashion the subscriber host will be associated with the corresponding Vport.

Alternatively, the destination string can be defined in LUDB.

use-top-q—
This is applicable only to Ethernet ports.
use-vpi—
VP Identifier (VPI) will be used to make the association between the subscriber and the Vport automatically.

Control Plane will be aware of the VPI during the session initiation phase. This VPI will be used to make the association between the host and the Vport with the same name (VPI number).

Note:

In this case the Vport name under the configure>port>sonet-sdh>path>access>egress context must be the VPI number.

pppoe-user-db

Syntax 
pppoe-user-db ludb-name
no pppoe-user-db
Context 
config>services>vpls>sap
Description 

This command enables LUDB authentication on capture SAPs for PPPoE(oA) clients. If this command is configured along with the authentication-policy command (RADIUS authentication), then the authentication-policy command will take precedence.

Optionally, with a separate command (ppp-user-db) PPPoA clients can be authenticated under a separate LUDB.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no pppoe-user-db

Parameters 
ludb-name—
Specifies the name of the local user database up to 32 characters in length

ppp-user-db

Syntax 
ppp-user-db ludb-name
no ppp-user-db
Context 
config>services>vpls>sap
Description 

This command enables LUDB authentication on capture SAPs for PPPoA clients. If this command is configured along with the authentication-policy command (RADIUS authentication), then the authentication-policy command will take precedence.

Optionally, with a separate command (pppoe-user-db) PPPoE(oA) clients can be authenticated under a separate LUDB.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ppp-user-db

Parameters 
ludb-name—
Specifies the name of local user database up to 256 characters in length

ppp-policy

Syntax 
ppp-policy ppp-pol-name
no ppp-policy
Context 
config>services>vpls>sap
Description 

This command references a ppp-policy that will define session parameters (ppp-mtu, authentication options, and so on) during the session initiation phase. Normally, the PPP policy is referenced under the group-interface hierarchy. But with capture SAP is it not known at the session initiation phase to which group-interface the session belongs. This is why, with the capture SAP, the ppp-policy must be referenced directly under the capture SAP. The ppp-policy referenced under the group-interface must be the same as the ppp-policy referenced under the capture SAP. Otherwise the session will not come up.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ppp-policy

Parameters 
ppp-pol-name—
Specifies the PPP policy name up to 32 characters in length

pppoe-policy

Syntax 
pppoe-policy pppoe-policy-name
no pppoe-policy
Context 
config>services>vpls>sap
Description 

This command references a pppoe-policy that will define session parameters (ppp-mtu, authentication options, and so on) during the session initiation phase. Normally, the PPPoE policy is referenced under the group-interface hierarchy. But with capture SAP is it not known at the session initiation phase to which group-interface the session belongs. This is why, with the capture SAP, the ppp-policy must be referenced directly under the capture SAP. The pppoe-policy referenced under the group-interface must be the same as the pppoe-policy referenced under the capture SAP. Otherwise the session will not come up.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no pppoe-policy

Parameters 
pppoe-policy-name—
Specifies the pppoe-policy name up to 32 characters in length

rtr-solicit-user-db

Syntax 
rtr-solicit-user-db local-user-db
no rtr-solicit-user-db
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
Description 

This command enabled access to LUDB for SLAAC hosts under the capture SAP. The name of this ludb must match the name of ludb configured under the configure>service>vprn/ies>subscrintf>group-intf>ipv6>router-solicit> hierarchy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no rtr-solicit-user-db

Parameters 
local-user-db —
Specifies the name of the local-user-database up to 32 characters in length

vc-range

Syntax 
vc-range num vpi-range vpi-range vci-range vci-range
no vc-range num
Context 
config>services>vpls>sap>atm
Description 

This command configures ATM Virtual Circuit ranges and is supported only in max16k-vc ATM MDA mode. An ATM MDA supports a number of passive (or listening) VCs, of which a subset can be simultaneously active.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no vc-range-num

Parameters 
num—
Specifies the VC range.
Values—
1 to 5 (Five ranges are supported to accommodate non-contiguous ranges of VPI/VCI pairs.

 

vci-range vci-range
Specifies the VCI range
Values—
1, 2, 5 to 65535 (Contiguous VCI ranges in the form of x-y.)

 

vpi-range vpi-range . —
Specifies the VPI range
Values—
0 to 255 for UNI
0 to 4095 for NNI
(Contiguous VPI range in the form of x-y)

 

local-address-assignment

Syntax 
local-address-assignment
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command enters the context t configure the local address assignment.

ipv6

Syntax 
[no] ipv6
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
Description 

This command enters the context to configure IPv6 local address assignment parameters.

client-application

Syntax 
client-application [ppp-v4]
no client-application
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
Description 

This command enables local router DHCP server pool management for PPPoXv4 clients. A pool of IP addresses can be shared between IPoE clients that rely on DHCP protocol (lease renewal process) and PPPoX clients where address allocation is not dependent on DHCP messaging but instead an IP address allocation within the pool is tied to the PPPoX session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no client-application

client-application

Syntax 
client-application [ppp-slaac] [ipoe-wan] [ipoe-slaac]
no client-application
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign>ipv6
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign>ipv6
Description 

This command defines the client application that will use the local address server to perform address assignment. This feature is relies on RADIUS or local-user-database to return a pool name. The pool name is matched again the pools defined in the local-dhcp6-server configuration. The name of the local-dhcp6-server must also be provisioned.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no client-application

Parameters 
ppp-slaac—
This parameter indicates using the local DHCPv6 prefix pool to assign SLAAC prefixes for hosts. The pool name where the prefixes are used for SLAAC prefix assignment are obtained from RADIUS or local-user-database during the authentication process. The RADIUS attribute Alc-slaac-ipv6-pool is used to indicate the SLAAC pool name for PPPoE hosts.
ipoe-wan—
This parameter indicates using the local DHCPv6 pool for IA_NA address assignment and a static pre-defined prefixes for IA_PD. Both the IA_NA pool name and the IA_PD static framed-prefix are either obtained from RADIUS or LUDB during authentication. In the case of RADIUS, it must return both IA_NA Framed-IPv6-Pool and IA_PD Delegated-IPv6-Prefix after a successful authentication. In the case of LUDB, it must have ipv6-wan-address-pool and ipv6-delegated-prefix populated. This feature is specific to this use case and is not required for other combinations of DHCPv6 assignments such as IA_NA and IA_PD address assignment through RADIUS or LUDB.
ipoe-slaac—
This parameter indicates using the local DHCPv6 prefix pool to assign SLAAC prefixes for hosts. The pool name where the prefixes are used for SLAAC prefix assignment are obtained from RADIUS or local-user-database during the authentication process. The RADIUS attribute Alc-slaac-ipv6-pool is used to indicate the SLAAC pool name for PPPoE hosts.

default-pool

Syntax 
default-pool pool-name [secondary pool-name]
no default-pool
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
Description 

This command references a default DHCP address pool for local PPPoX pool management in case that the pool-name is not returned via RADIUS or LUDB.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
pool-name—
Specifies the name of the local router DHCP server pool

server

Syntax 
server server-name
no server
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign
Description 

This command designates a local router DHCPv4 server for local pools management where IPv4 addresses for PPPoXv4 clients will be allocated without the need for the internal router DHCP relay-agent. Those addresses will be tied to PPPoX sessions and they will be de-allocated when the PPPoX session is terminated.

Parameters 
server-name—
The name of the local 7450 ESS or 7750 SR DHCP server

server

Syntax 
server server-name
no server
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign>ipv6
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>lcl-addr-assign>ipv6
Description 

This command designates a local router DHCPv6 server for local pools management where IPv6 prefixes or address for PPPoXv6 clients or IPoEv6 clients will be allocated without the need for the internal router DHCP relay-agent. Those addresses will be tied to PPPoX or IPoE sessions and they will be de-allocated when the PPPoX or IPoE session is terminated.

Parameters 
server-name—
The name of the local router DHCPv6 server.

9.25.2.1.16.1. Layer 3 Subscriber Interfaces SAP Commands

accounting-policy

Syntax 
accounting-policy acct-policy-id
no accounting-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>if>spoke-sdp
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command specifies the policy to use to collect accounting statistics on a subscriber profile.

A maximum of one accounting policy can be associated with a profile at one time.

The no form of this command removes the accounting policy association.

Default 

no accounting policy

Parameters 
acct-policy-id—
Specifies an existing accounting policy ID as configured in the config>log>accounting-policy context
Values—
1 to 99

 

anti-spoof

Syntax 
anti-spoof {ip | ip-mac | nh-mac}
no anti-spoof
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy
Description 

This command configures the anti-spoof type of the MSAP.

The type of anti-spoof filtering defines what information in the incoming packet is used to generate the criteria to lookup an entry in the anti-spoof filter table. The type parameter (ip, ip-mac) defines the anti-spoof filter type enforced by the SAP when anti-spoof filtering is enabled.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Note:

For IES and VPRN subscriber group interfaces, setting no anti-spoof will set the default anti-spoofing type which is ip-mac.

Default 

no anti-spoof

Parameters 
ip—
Configures SAP anti-spoof filtering to use only the source IP address in its lookup. If a static host exists on the SAP without an IP address specified, the anti-spoof type ip command will fail.
Note:

This parameter is not applicable in the config>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy context.

ip-mac—
Configures SAP anti-spoof filtering to use both the source IP address and the source MAC address in its lookup. The anti-spoof type ip-mac command will fail if the default anti-spoof filter type of the SAP is ip-mac and the default is not overridden, or if the SAP does not support Ethernet encapsulation.
nh-mac—
Indicates that the ingress anti-spoof is based on the source MAC and egress anti-spoof is based on the nh-ip-address

app-profile

Syntax 
app-profile app-profile-name
no app-profile
Context 
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command configures the application profile name.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
app-profile-name—
Specifies an existing application profile name configured in the config>app-assure>group>policy context

collect-stats

Syntax 
[no] collect-stats
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

When enabled, the agent collects non-RADIUS accounting statistics on a subscriber profile.

When the no collect-stats command is issued the statistics are still accumulated by the IOM cards. However, the CPU will not obtain the results and write them to the billing file. If a subsequent collect-stats command is issued then the counters written to the billing file include all the traffic while the

collect-stats

default-host

Syntax 
default-host ipv4-prefix/mask | ipv6-prefix/prefix-length next-hop ipv4-address | ipv6-address
no default-host ipv4-prefix/mask | ipv6-prefix/prefix-length
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command configures the default-host. More than one default host can be configured per SAP.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

no lease-populate

Parameters 
ipv64prefix/prefix-length—
Specifies an IPv4 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv4-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

prefix-length - [0 to 128]

 

ipv6-prefix/prefix-length—
Specifies an IPv6 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

prefix-length - [0 to 128]

 

next-hop—
Assigns the next hop IP address

cpu-protection

Syntax 
cpu-protection policy-id [mac-monitoring] | [eth-cfm-monitoring [aggregate] [car]]
no cpu-protection
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command assigns an existing CPU protection policy to the associated group interface. The CPU protection policies are configured in the config>sys>security>cpu-protection>policy cpu-protection-policy-id context.

If no CPU-Protection policy is assigned to a group interface SAP, then the default policy is used to limit the overall-rate. The default policy is policy number 254 for access interfaces and 255 for network interfaces.

The no form of the command removes the association of the CPU protection policy from the associated interface and reverts to the default policy values.

Default 

cpu-protection 254 (for access interfaces)

cpu-protection 255 (for network interfaces)

The configuration of no cpu-protection returns the interface/SAP to the default policies as shown above.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Specifies an existing CPU protection policy
Values—
1 to 255

 

mac-monitoring—
Specifies to enable MAC monitoring
eth-cfm-monitoring
Specifies to enable Ethernet Connectivity Fault Management monitoring
aggregate—
Applies the rate limit to the sum of the per peer packet rates
car—
Applies the Committed Access Rate (CAR). This keyword causes Eth-CFM packets to be ignored when enforcing the overall-rate.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress SAP Quality of Service (QoS) policies and filter policies.

If no sap-egress QoS policy is defined, the system default sap-egress QoS policy is used for egress processing. If no egress filter is defined, no filtering is performed.

filter

Syntax 
filter ip ip-filter-id
filter
no filter [ip ip-filter-id]
no filter
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command associates an IP filter policy with an ingress or egress Service Access Point (SAP). Filter policies control the forwarding and dropping of packets based on the matching criteria.

MAC filters are only allowed on Epipe and Virtual Private LAN Service (VPLS) SAPs.

The filter command is used to associate a filter policy with a specified ip-filter-id with an ingress or egress SAP. The filter policy must already be defined before the filter command is executed. If the filter policy does not exist, the operation will fail and an error message returned.

In general, filters applied to SAPs (ingress or egress) apply to all packets on the SAP. One exception is non-IP packets are not applied to the match criteria, so the default action in the filter policy applies to these packets.

The no form of this command removes any configured filter ID association with the SAP. The filter ID itself is not removed from the system unless the scope of the created filter is set to local. To avoid deletion of the filter ID and only break the association with the service object, use the scope command within the filter definition to change the scope to local or global. The default scope of a filter is local.

Special Cases 
IES—
Only IP filters are supported on an IES IP interface, and the filters only apply to routed traffic
Parameters 
ip—
Keyword indicating the filter policy is an IP filter.
ip-filter-id—
Specifies the ID for the IP filter policy. Allowed values are an integer in the range of 1 and 65535 that corresponds to a previously created IP filter policy in the configure>filter context.

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id
no qos
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

Associates a Quality of Service (QoS) policy with an egress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface.

QoS egress policies are important for the enforcement of SLA agreements. The policy ID must be defined prior to associating the policy with a SAP or IP interface. If the policy-id does not exist, an error will be returned.

The qos command is used to associate egress QoS policies. The qos command only allows egress policies on SAP or IP interface egress. Attempts to associate a QoS policy of the wrong type returns an error.

Only one ingress QoS policy can be associated with a SAP or IP interface at one time. Attempts to associate a second QoS policy of a given type will return an error.

By default, no specific QoS policy is associated with the SAP or IP interface for egress, so the default QoS policy is used.

The normal behavior is for queues to be created per destination.

The no form of this command removes the QoS policy association from the SAP or IP interface, and the QoS policy reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policy-id—
The egress policy ID to associate with SAP or IP interface on egress. The policy ID must already exist.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id [shared-queuing]
no qos
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

Associates a Quality of Service (QoS) policy with an ingress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface.

QoS ingress policies are important for the enforcement of SLA agreements. The policy ID must be defined prior to associating the policy with a SAP or IP interface. If the policy-id does not exist, an error will be returned.

This qos command is used to associate ingress QoS policies. The qos command only allows ingress policies to be associated on SAP or IP interface ingress.

Only one ingress and one egress QoS policy can be associated with a SAP or IP interface at one time. Attempts to associate a second QoS policy of a given type will return an error.

By default, no specific QoS policy is associated with the SAP or IP interface for ingress so the default QoS policy is used.

The normal behavior is for queues to be created per destination. Shared and multipoint shared change this behavior creating either unicast or unicast and mcast shared queues.

The no form of this command removes the QoS policy association from the SAP or IP interface, and the QoS policy reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policy-id—
The ingress policy ID to associate with SAP or IP interface on ingress. The policy ID must already exist.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

shared-queuing—
This keyword can only be specified on SAP ingress. Specify the ingress shared queue policy used by a SAP. When the value of this object is null it means that the SAP will use individual ingress QoS queues, instead of the shared ones.

policer-control-policy

Syntax 
policer-control-policy policy-name
no policer-control-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command is used to create, delete, or modify policer control policies. The policer-control-policy controls the aggregate bandwidth available to a set of child policers. Once created, the policy can be applied to ingress or egress SAPs. The policy can also be applied to the ingress or egress context of a sub-profile.

The no form of the command resets the command to the default setting.

Default 

no policer-control-policy

Parameters 
policy-name
Specifies the policer control policy name. Each policer control policy name must be unique and adhere to the system policy ASCII naming requirements. If the defined policy name already exists, the system enters that policy’s context for editing purposes. If policy-name does not exist, the system will attempt to create a policy with the specified name.

qinq-mark-top-only

Syntax 
[no] qinq-mark-top-only
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
Description 

When the encapsulation type is qinq for the access port for the specified SAP, enabling this command specifies which P-bits or DEI bit to mark during packet egress. Only the P-bits or DEI bit in the top Q tag are marked. When this command is disabled, both sets of P-bits and the DEI bit are marked.

Default 

no qinq-mark-top-only

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
no scheduler-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command applies an existing scheduler policy to an ingress or egress scheduler used by ingress SAP queues or egress SAP policers and queues associated with this multi-service customer site. The schedulers defined in the scheduler policy can only be created once the customer site has been appropriately assigned to a chassis port, channel or slot. Scheduler policies are defined in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context.

The no form of this command removes the configured ingress or egress scheduler policy from the multi-service customer site. When the policy is removed, the schedulers created due to the policy are removed also making them unavailable for the SAP policers or queues associated with the customer site. Policers and queues that lose their parent scheduler association are deemed to be orphaned and are no longer subject to a virtual scheduler. The SAPs that have policers or queues reliant on the removed schedulers enter into an operational state depicting the orphaned status of one or more policers or queues. When the no form of the command executed, the customer site ingress or egress node will not contain an applied scheduler policy.

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name:—
Specifies the scheduler policy name to apply to an existing scheduler policy that was created in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context to create the hierarchy of ingress or egress virtual schedulers. The scheduler names defined within the policy are created and made available to any ingress queues or egress policers and queues created on associated SAPs.
Values—
Any existing valid scheduler policy name.

 

host

Syntax 
host ip ip-address [mac ieee-address]] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile sub-profile-name] [sla-profile sla-profile-name]
no host {[ip ip-address] [mac ieee-address]}
no host all
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>ies>if>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command creates a static subscriber host for the SAP. Static subscriber hosts may be used by the system for various purposes. Applications within the system that make use of static host entries include anti-spoof filters and ARP cache population.

Multiple static hosts may be defined on the SAP. Each host is identified by either a source IP address, a source MAC address or both a source IP and source MAC address. Every static host definition must have at least one address defined, IP or MAC.

Static hosts can exist on the SAP even with anti-spoof and ARP populate features disabled. When enabled, each feature has different requirements for static hosts.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Parameters 
anti-spoof—
When enabled, this feature uses static and dynamic host information to populate entries into an anti-spoof filter table. The anti-spoof filter entries generated will be of the same type as specified in the anti-spoof type parameter. If the SAP anti-spoof filter is defined as ip, each static host definition must specify an IP address. If the SAP anti-spoof filter is defined as ip-mac, each static host definition must specify both an IP address and MAC address. If definition of a static host is attempted without the appropriate addresses specified for the enabled anti-spoof filter, the static host definition will fail.
arp-populate—
When enabled, this feature uses static and dynamic host information to populate entries in the system ARP cache.

Attempting to define a static subscriber host that conflicts with an existing DHCP lease state table entry will fail.

Use the no form of the command to remove a static entry from the system. The specified ip-address and mac-address must match the host’s exact IP and MAC addresses as defined when it was created. When a static host is removed from the SAP, the corresponding anti-spoof entry and/or ARP cache entry is also removed.

ip-address —
Specifies this optional parameter when defining a static host. The IP address must be specified for anti-spoof ip, anti-spoof ip-mac and arp-populate. Only one static host may be configured on the SAP with a given IP address.
mac-address —
Specifies this optional parameter when defining a static host. The MAC address must be specified for anti-spoof ip-mac and arp-populate. Multiple static hosts may be configured with the same MAC address given that each definition is distinguished by a unique IP address.
sub-ident-string —
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing subscriber identification profile to be associated with the static subscriber host. The subscriber identification profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol context. The subscriber information is used by the VPRN SAP arp-reply-agent to determine the proper handling of received ARP requests from subscribers.

For VPRN SAPs with arp-reply-agent enabled with the optional sub-ident parameter, the static subscriber hosts sub-ident-string is used to determine whether an ARP request received on the SAP is sourced from a host belonging to the same subscriber as the destination host. When both the destination and source hosts from the ARP request are known on the SAP and the subscriber identifications do not match, the ARP request may be forwarded to the rest of the VPRN destinations.

If the static subscriber hosts sub-ident string is not defined, the host is not considered to belong to the same subscriber as another host on the SAP.

If source or destination host is unknown, the hosts are not considered to belong to the same subscriber. (ARP messages from unknown hosts are subject to anti-spoof filtering rules applied at the SAP.)

If sub-ident is not enabled on the SAP arp-reply-agent, subscriber identification matching is not performed on ARP requests received on the SAP.

ARP requests are never forwarded back to the same SAP or within the receiving SAP’s Split Horizon Group.

sub-profile-name
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing subscriber profile name to be associated with the static subscriber host. The subscriber profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile context.
sla-profile-name
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing SLA profile name to be associated with the static subscriber host. The SLA profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile context.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress SAP Quality of Service (QoS) policies and filter policies.

If no SAP ingress QoS policy is defined, the system default sap-ingress QoS policy is used for ingress processing. If no ingress filter is defined, no filtering is performed.

multi-service-site

Syntax 
[no] multi-service-site customer-site-name
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command creates a new customer site or edits an existing customer site with the customer-site-name parameter. A customer site is an anchor point to create an ingress and egress virtual scheduler hierarchy. When a site is created, it must be assigned to a chassis slot or port. When scheduler policies are defined for ingress and egress, the scheduler names contained in each policy are created according to the parameters defined in the policy. Multi-service customer sites exist for the sole purpose of creating a virtual scheduler hierarchy and making it available to queues on multiple Service Access Points (SAPs).

The scheduler policy association with the customer site normally prevents the scheduler policy from being deleted until after the scheduler policy is removed from the customer site. The multi-service-site object will generate a log message indicating that the association was deleted due to scheduler policy removal.

When the multi-service customer site is created, an ingress and egress scheduler policy association does not exist. This does not prevent the site from being assigned to a chassis slot or prevent service SAP assignment. After the site has been created, the ingress and egress scheduler policy associations can be assigned or removed at anytime.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
customer-site-name—
Each customer site must have a unique name within the context of the customer. If customer-site-name already exists for the customer ID, the CLI context changes to that site name for the purpose of editing the site scheduler policies or assignment. Any modifications made to an existing site will affect all SAPs associated with the site. Changing a scheduler policy association may cause new schedulers to be created and existing policers and queues on the SAPs to no longer be orphaned. Existing schedulers on the site may cease to exist, causing policers and queues relying on that scheduler to be orphaned.

If the customer-site-name does not exist, it is assumed that an attempt is being made to create a site of that name in the customer ID context. The success of the command execution depends on the following:

The maximum number of customer sites defined for the chassis slot has not been met.

The customer-site-name is valid.

The create keyword is included in the command line syntax (if the system requires it).

When the maximum number of customer sites has been exceeded a configuration error occurs, the command will not execute and the CLI context will not change.

If the customer-site-name is invalid, a syntax error occurs, the command will not execute and the CLI context will not change.

Values—
Valid names consist of any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

 

9.25.2.1.16.1. ATM Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

atm

Syntax 
atm
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command the context to configure ATM-related parameters. This command can only be used when a given context (for example, a channel or SAP) supports ATM functionality such as:

  1. Configuring ATM port or ATM port-related functionality on MDAs supporting ATM functionality
  2. Configuring ATM-related configuration for ATM-based SAPs that exist on MDAs supporting ATM functionality.

If ATM functionality is not supported for a given context, the command returns an error.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress ATM attributes for the SAP.

encapsulation

Syntax 
encapsulation atm-encap-type
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command configures RFC 2684, Multiprotocol Encapsulation over ATM Adaptation Layer 5, encapsulation for an ATM PVCC delimited SAP.

This command specifies the data encapsulation for an ATM PVCC delimited SAP. The definition references RFC 2684 and to the ATM Forum LAN Emulation specification.

Ingress traffic that does not match the configured encapsulation will be dropped.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

The encapsulation is driven by the services for which the SAP is configured. For IES service SAPs, the default is aal5snap-routed.

Parameters 
atm-encap-type—
Specify the encapsulation type
Values—
aal5snap-routed — Routed encapsulation for LLC encapsulated circuit (LLC/SNAP precedes protocol datagram) as defined in RFC 2684.
aal5mux-ip — Routed IP encapsulation for VC multiplexed circuit as defined in RFC 2684

 

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command configures ingress ATM attributes for the SAP.

traffic-desc

Syntax 
traffic-desc traffic-desc-profile-id
no traffic-desc
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
Description 

This command assigns an ATM traffic descriptor profile to a given context (for example, a SAP). When configured under the ingress context, the specified traffic descriptor profile defines the traffic contract in the forward direction. When configured under the egress context, the specified traffic descriptor profile defines the traffic contract in the backward direction.

The no form of the command reverts the traffic descriptor to the default traffic descriptor profile.

Default 

The default traffic descriptor (trafficDescProfileId. = 1) is associated with newly created PVCC-delimited SAPs.

Parameters 
traffic-desc-profile-id—
Specify a defined traffic descriptor profile (see the QoS atm-td-profile command).

oam

Syntax 
oam
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>interface >sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enters the context to configure OAM functionality for a PVCC delimiting a SAP.

The ATM-capable MDAs support F5 end-to-end OAM functionality (AIS, RDI, Loopback):

  1. ITU-T Recommendation I.610 - B-ISDN Operation and Maintenance Principles and Functions version 11/95
  2. GR-1248-CORE - Generic Requirements for Operations of ATM Network Elements (NEs). Issue 3 June 1996
  3. GR-1113-CORE - Bellcore, Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) and ATM Adaptation Layer (AAL) Protocols Generic Requirements, Issue 1, July 1994

alarm-cells

Syntax 
[no] alarm-cells
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
Description 

This command configures AIS/RDI fault management on a PVCC. Fault management allows PVCC termination to monitor and report the status of their connection by propagating fault information through the network and by driving PVCCs operational status.

When alarm-cells functionality is enabled, PVCCs operational status is affected when a PVCC goes into AIS or RDI state because of an AIS/RDI processing (i.e. assuming nothing else affects PVCCs operational status, PVCC goes DOWN, when it enters a fault state and comes back UP, when it exits that fault state) and RDI cell are generated when PVCC is operationally DOWN. No OAM-specific SNMP trap is raised whenever an endpoint enters/exits an AIS or RDI states, however, if as result of an OAM state change, the PVCC changes operational status, then a trap is expected from an entity the PVCC is associated with (for example a SAP).

The no form of the command disables alarm-cells functionality for a PVCC. When alarm-cells functionality is disabled, PVCCs operational status is no longer affected by PVCCs OAM state changes due to AIS/RDI processing (when alarm-cells is disabled, a PVCC will change operational status to UP, if it was DOWN because of the alarm-cell processing) and RDI cells are not generated as result of PVCC going into AIS or RDI state, however, PVCCs OAM status will record OAM faults as described above.

Default 

Enabled for PVCCs delimiting IES SAPs

periodic-loopback

Syntax 
[no] periodic-loopback
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>if >sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enables periodic OAM loopbacks on this SAP. This command is only configurable on IES and VPRN SAPs. When enabled, an ATM OAM loopback cell is transmitted every period as configured in the config>system>atm>oam>loopback-period period context.

If a response is not received and consecutive retry-down retries also result in failure, the endpoint will transition to an alarm indication signal/loss of clock state. Then, an ATM OAM loopback cell will be transmitted every period as configured in the loopback-period period. If a response is received for the periodic loopback and consecutive retry-up retries also each receive a response, the endpoint will transition back to the up state.

The no form of the command sets the value back to the default.

Default 

no periodic-loopback

9.25.2.1.16.2. Redundant Interface Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

redundant-interface

Syntax 
[no] redundant-interface ip-int-name
Context 
config>service>ies
config>service>vprn
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command configures a redundant interface.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface. Interface names can be from 1 to 32 alphanumeric characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

remote-proxy-arp

Syntax 
[no] remote-proxy-arp
Context 
config>service>ies>interface
Description 

This command enables remote proxy ARP on the interface.

The no form of the command disables remote proxy ARP on the interface.

Default 

no remote-proxy-arp

address

Syntax 
address {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask} [remote-ip ip-address]
no address
Context 
config>service>vprn>redundant-interface
Description 

This command assigns an IP address mask or netmask and a remote IP address to the interface.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Parameters 
ip-address/mask—
Assigns an IP address/IP subnet format to the interface
ip-address netmask—
Assigns an IP address netmask to the interface. Specifies a string of 0s and 1s that mask or screen out the network part of an IP address so that only the host computer part of the address remains.
remote-ip ip-address
Assigns a remote IP to the interface

spoke-sdp

Syntax 
[no] spoke-sdp sdp-id
Context 
config>service>vprn
Description 

This command binds a service to an existing Service Distribution Point (SDP).

A spoke SDP is treated like the equivalent of a traditional bridge “port” where flooded traffic received on the spoke SDP is replicated on all other “ports” (other spoke and mesh SDPs or SAPs) and not transmitted on the port it was received.

The SDP has an operational state which determines the operational state of the SDP within the service. For example, if the SDP is administratively or operationally down, the SDP for the service will be down.

The SDP must already be defined in the config>service>sdp context in order to associate an SDP with a VPRN service. If the sdp sdp-id is not already configured, an error message is generated. If the sdp-id does exist, a binding between that sdp-id and the service is created.

SDPs must be explicitly associated and bound to a service. If an SDP is not bound to a service, no far-end 7750 SR devices can participate in the service.

The no form of this command removes the SDP binding from the service. The SDP configuration is not affected; only the binding of the SDP to a service. Once removed, no packets are forwarded to the far-end router.

Special Cases 
VPRN—
Several SDPs can be bound to a VPRN service. Each SDP must be destined to a different 7750 SR OS. If two sdp-id bindings terminate on the same 7750 SR, an error occurs and the second SDP binding is rejected.
Parameters 
sdp-id—
The SDP identifier. Allowed values are integers in the range of 1 and 17407 for existing SDPs
vc-id—
The virtual circuit identifier
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress SDP parameters.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress SDP parameters.

vc-label

Syntax 
vc-label egress-vc-label
no vc-label [egress-vc-label]
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>egress
Description 

This command configures the egress VC label.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no vc-label

Parameters 
vc-label—
A VC egress value that indicates a specific connection
Values—
16 to 1048575

 

vc-label

Syntax 
vc-label ingress-vc-label
no vc-label [ingress-vc-label]
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>ingress
Description 

This command configures the ingress VC label.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no vc-label

Parameters 
vc-label—
A VC ingress value that indicates a specific connection
Values—
2048 to 18431

 

filter

Syntax 
filter {ip ip-filter-id}
no filter
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>ingress
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>egress
Description 

This command associates an IP filter policy with an ingress or egress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface. An IP filter policy can be associated with spoke SDPs.

Filter policies control the forwarding and dropping of packets based on IP or MAC matching criteria.

The filter command is used to associate a filter policy with a specified ip-filter-id with an ingress or egress SAP. The ip-filter-id must already be defined before the filter command is executed. If the filter policy does not exist, the operation will fail and an error message returned.

In general, filters applied to SAPs (ingress or egress) apply to all packets on the SAP. One exception is non-IP packets are not applied to IP match criteria, so the default action in the filter policy applies to these packets.

The no form of this command removes any configured filter ID association with the SAP or IP interface. The filter ID itself is not removed from the system unless the scope of the created filter is set to local. To avoid deletion of the filter ID and only break the association with the service object, use scope command within the filter definition to change the scope to local or global. The default scope of a filter is local.

Default 

no filter

Parameters 
ip-filter-id
Specifies IP filter policy. The filter ID must already exist within the created IP filters
Values—
1 to 65535

 

9.25.2.1.16.3. SDP Binding Commands

binding

Syntax 
binding
Context 
config>service>sdp
Description 

The command enters the context to configure SDP bindings.

port

Syntax 
port [port-id | lag-id]
no ort
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding
Description 

This command specifies the port or lag identifier, to which the PW ports associated with the underlying SDP are bound. If the underlying SDP is re-routed to a port or lag other than the specified one, the PW ports on the SDP are operationally brought down.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
port-id—
The identifier of the port in the slot/mda/port format
lag-id—
Specifies the LAG identifier

pw-port

Syntax 
pw-port pw-port-id [vc-id vc-id] [create]
no pw-port
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding
Description 

This command creates a pseudowire port.

The no form of the command removes the pseudowire port ID from the configuration.

Parameters 
pw-port-id—
Specifies a unique identifier of the pseudowire port
Values—
1 to 10239

 

vc-id vc-id
Specifies a virtual circuit identifier signaled to the peer
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

description

Syntax 
description description-string
no description
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command creates a text description stored in the configuration file for a configuration context.

The description command associates a text string with a configuration context to help identify the content in the configuration file.

The no form of the command removes the string from the configuration.

Default 

no description

Parameters 
description-string—
Specifies the description character string of the configuration context
Values—
Any string up to 80 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

 

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command enters the context to configure PW-port egress side parameters.

encap-type

Syntax 
encap-type {dot1q | qinq}
no encap-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets the encapsulation type for the PW-port as dot1q or qinq.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

dot1q

Parameters 
dot1q—
Specifies dot1q encapsulation type
qinq—
Specifies qinq encapsulation type

shaper

Syntax 
[no] shaper
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress
Description 

This command configures an egress shaping option for use by a PW port.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no shaper

int-dest-id

Syntax 
[no] int-dest-id int-dest-id
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress>shaper
Description 

This command specifies the intermediate destination string configured for dynamic Vport selection.

This command is only valid for PW ports used for enhanced subscriber management (ESM on PW).

The no form of the command removes the configured intermediate destination string.

Default 

no.int-dest-id

Parameters 
int-dest-id—
Specifies a text string that describes the intermediate destination ID

vport

Syntax 
vport vport-name
no vport
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress>shaper
Description 

This command configures the name of the Vport to be used for the PW port.

This command is valid for PW ports used for enhanced subscriber management (ESM on pseudowire) and pseudowire SAPs on Ethernet ports. It is not valid for pseudowire ports on the HSMDA.

The no form of the command removes the configured Vport name.

Default 

no vport

Parameters 
vport-name—
Specifies a text string up to 32 characters in length representing the name of the Vport

vc-type

Syntax 
vc-type {ether | vlan}
no vc-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets the forwarding mode for PW-port. The vc-type is signaled to the peer, and must be configured consistently on both ends of the PW. vc-type VLAN is only configurable with dot1q encapsulation on the PW-port. The tag with vc-type vlan only has significance for transport, and is not used for service delineation or ESM. The top (provider tag) is stripped while forwarding out of the PW, and a configured vlan-tag (for vc-type vlan) is inserted when forwarding into the PW. With vc-type ether, the tags if present (max 2), are transparently preserved when forwarding in our out of the PW.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

ether

Parameters 
ether—
Specifies ether as the virtual circuit (VC) associated with the SDP binding
vlan—
Specifies vlan as the virtual circuit (VC) associated with the SDP binding

vlan-vc-tag

Syntax 
vlan-vc-tag vlan-id
no vc-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets tag relevant for vc-type vlan mode. This tag is inserted in traffic forwarded into the PW.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

0

Parameters 
vlan-id—
Specifies the VLAN ID value
Values—
0 to 4094

 

9.25.2.1.1.1. RIP Commands

rip-policy

Syntax 
rip-policy policy-name [create]
no rip- policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates a RIP policy. This policy is applied to a subscriber IPv4 host to enable the BNG to learn RIP routes from the host. RIP routes are never sent to the hosts.

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the RIP policy name up to 32 characters in length.
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

neighbor

Syntax 
[no] neighbor ip-int-name
Context 
config>router>rip>group
config>service>vprn>rip>group
Description 

This command creates a context for configuring a RIP neighbor interface. By default, group interfaces are not activated with RIP, unless explicitly configured. The BNG will only learn RIP routes from IPv4 host on the group interface. The RIP neighbor group interface will default send to “none”. The send operation is unchangeable for group-interface.

The no form of the command deletes the RIP interface configuration for this group interface. The shutdown command in the config>router>rip>group group-name>neighbor context can be used to disable an interface without removing the configuration for the interface.

Default 

no neighbor

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
The group interface name. Interface names must be unique within the group of defined group interfaces within config service vprn/ies sub-interface grp-interface commands. An interface name cannot be in the form of an IP address. Interface names can be any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes. If the group interface name does not exist, an error message will be returned.

authentication-key

Syntax 
authentication-key [authentication-key | hash-key] [hash | hash2]
no authentication-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rip-policy
Description 

This command configures the BGP authentication key.

Authentication is performed between neighboring routers before setting up the BGP session by verifying the password. Authentication is performed using the MD-5 message-based digest. The authentication key can be any combination of letters or numbers from 1 to 16.

The no form of the command removes the authentication password from the configuration and effectively disables authentication.

Default 

Authentication is disabled and the authentication password is empty.

Parameters 
authentication-key—
The authentication key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 255 characters in length (unencrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).
hash-key—
The hash key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 342 characters in length (encrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).

This is useful when a user must configure the parameter, but, for security purposes, the actual unencrypted key value is not provided.

hash—
Specifies the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.

authentication-type

Syntax 
authentication-type {none | password | message-digest | message-digest-20}
no authentication-type
Context 
config>sub-mgmg>rip-policy>
Description 

This command sets the type of authentication to be used between RIP neighbors. The type and password must match exactly for the RIP message to be considered authentic and processed.

The no form of the command removes the authentication type from the configuration and effectively disables authentication.

Default 

no authentication-type

Parameters 
none—
Disables authentication at a given level (global, group, neighbor). If the command does not exist in the configuration, the parameter is inherited.
password —
Specifies enable simple password (plain text) authentication. If authentication is enabled and no authentication type is specified in the command, simple password authentication is enabled.
message-digest—
Configures 16 byte message digest for MD5 authentication. If this option is configured, then at least one message-digest-key must be configured.
message-digest-20—
Configures 20 byte message digest for MD5 authentication in accordance with RFC 2082, RIP-2 MD5 Authentication. If this option is configured, then at least one message-digest-key must be configured.

retail-svc-id

Syntax 
retail-svc-id service-id
retail-svc-id
Context 
config>service>ies|vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>static-host
Description 

This command specifies the service id of the retailer IES/VPRN service to which the static IPv6 host belongs. A corresponding retailer subscriber interface must exist in the specified service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no retail-svc-id

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies the retailer service ID or retailer service name
Values—
service-id: 1 to 2148007978
svc-name: A string up to 64 characters in length

 

rip

Syntax 
[no] rip
Context 
config>service>vprn
config>service>ies
Description 

This command enables the RIP protocol on the given VPRN IP interface.

The no form of the command disables the RIP protocol from the given VPRN IP interface.

Default 

no rip

group

Syntax 
[no] group group-name
Context 
config>service>vprn>rip
config>service>ies>rip
Description 

This command creates a context for configuring a RIP group of neighbors. RIP groups are a way of logically associating RIP neighbor interfaces to facilitate a common configuration for RIP interfaces.

The no form of the command deletes the RIP neighbor interface group. Deleting the group will also remove the RIP configuration of all the neighbor interfaces currently assigned to this group.

Default 

no group

Parameters 
group-name—
The RIP group name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

9.25.2.1.2.1. Vport Commands

ethernet

Syntax 
ethernet
Context 
config>port
Description 

This command the context to configure Ethernet port attributes.

This context can only be used when configuring Fast Ethernet, gigabit or 10-G Fast Ethernet or Ethernet LAN ports on an appropriate MDA.

egress-scheduler-override

Syntax 
[no] egress-scheduler-override
Context 
config>port>ethernet
Description 

This command applies egress scheduler overrides. When a port scheduler is associated with an egress port, it is possible to override the following parameters:

  1. The max-rate allowed for the scheduler.
  2. The maximum rate for each priority level 8 through 1.
  3. The CIR associated with each priority level 8 through 1.

See the SR OS Quality of Service Guide for command syntax and usage for the port-scheduler-policy command.

The no form of this command removes all override parameters from the egress port or channel scheduler context. Once removed, the port scheduler reverts all rate parameters back to the parameters defined on the port-scheduler-policy associated with the port.

Default 

no egress-scheduler-override

level

Syntax 
level priority-level rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
no level priority-level
Context 
config>port>ethernet>egress-scheduler-override
Description 

This command overrides the maximum and CIR rate parameters for a specific priority level on the port or channel’s port scheduler instance. When the level command is executed for a priority level, the corresponding priority level command in the port-scheduler-policy associated with the port is ignored. The override level command supports the keyword max for the rate and cir parameter. When executing the level override command, at least the rate or cir keywords and associated parameters must be specified for the command to succeed.

The no form of this command removes the local port priority level rate overrides. Once removed, the port priority level will use the port scheduler policies level command for that priority level.

Default 

no level

Parameters 
priority-level—
Identifies which of the eight port priority levels are being overridden
Values—
1 to 8

 

pir-rate
Overrides the port scheduler policy’s maximum level rate and requires either the max keyword or a rate defined in kilobits-per-second to follow
Values—
1 to 40000000, max

 

cir-rate
Overrides the port scheduler policy’s within-cir level rate and requires either the max keyword or a rate defined in kilobits-per-second to follow
Values—
0 to 40000000, max

 

max—
Removes any existing rate limit imposed by the port scheduler policy for the priority level allowing it to use as much total bandwidth as possible

access

Syntax 
access
Context 
config>port>ethernet
Description 

This command configures Ethernet access port parameters.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Ethernet access egress port parameters.

vport

Syntax 
vport name [create]
no vport name
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress
Description 

This command configures a scheduling node, referred to as virtual port, within the context of an egress Ethernet port. The Vport scheduler operates either like a port scheduler with the difference that multiple Vport objects can be configured on the egress context of an Ethernet port, or it can be an aggregate rate when an egress port-scheduler policy is applied to the port.

The Vport is always configured at the port level even when a port is a member of a LAG.

When a port scheduler policy is applied to a Vport the following command is used:

configure>port>ethernet>acess>egress>vport>port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name

The CLI will not allow the user to apply a port scheduler policy to a Vport if one has been applied to the port. Conversely, the CLI will not allow the user to apply a port scheduler policy to the egress of an Ethernet port if one has been applied to any Vport defined on the access egress context of this port. The agg-rate-limit, along with an egress port-scheduler, can be used to ensure that a given Vport does not oversubscribe the port’s rate.

SAP and subscriber host queues can be port-parented to a Vport scheduler in a similar way they port-parent to a port scheduler or can be port-parented directly to the egress port-scheduler if the agg-rate-limit is used.

When the Vport uses an aggregate rate, the following command is used:

configure>port>ethernet>acess>egress>vport>agg-rate-limit

The no form of the command removes the Vport name from the configuration.

Default 

no vport

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the Vport scheduling node and can be up to 32 ASCII characters in length. This does not need to be unique within the system but is unique within the port or a LAG.
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

agg-rate-limit

Syntax 
agg-rate-limit agg-rate
no agg-rate-limit
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command configures an aggregate rate for the Vport. This command is mutually exclusive with the port-scheduler-policy command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no agg-rate-limit

Parameters 
agg-rate
Specifies the rate limit for the Vport
Values—
max, 1 to 10000000

 

egress-rate-modify

Syntax 
[no] egress-rate-modify
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command is used to apply HQoS Adjustment to a Vport. HQoS Adjustment refers to the dynamic adjustment of the rate limit at an QoS enforcement point within router when the multicast traffic stream is disjointed from the unicast traffic stream. This QoS enforcement point within router represents the physical point further down in the access part of the network where the two streams join each other and potentially can cause congestion.

An example would be a PON port which is shared amongst subscriber’s multicast traffic (single copy of each channel) and subscriber’s unicast traffic. The bandwidth control point for this PON port resides in the upstream router BNG node in the form of a Vport. In case that the multicast delivery method in the router BNG utilizes redirection, the multicast traffic in the router BNG will flow outside of the subscriber or the Vport context and thus will bypass any bandwidth enforcement in the router. To correct this, a Vport bandwidth adjustment is necessary in the router that will account for the multicast bandwidth consumption that is bypassing Vport in the router but is present in the PON port whose bandwidth is controlled by Vport.

An estimate of the multicast bandwidth consumption on the PON port can be made at the Vport level based on the IGMP messages sourced from the subscribers behind the PON port. This process is called HQoS Adjustment.

A multicast channel bandwidth is subtracted from or added to the Vport rate limit according to the received IGMP Join/Leave messages and the channel bandwidth definition policy associated with the Vport (indirectly through a group-interface). Since the multicast traffic on the PON port is shared amongst subscribers behind this PON port, only the first IGMP Join or the last IGMP Leave per multicast channel is tracked for the purpose of the Vport bandwidth modification.

The Vport rate that will be affected by this functionality depends on the configuration:

  1. In case the agg-rate-limit within the Vport is configured, its value will be modified based on the IGMP activity associated with the subscriber under this Vport.
  2. In case the port-scheduler-policy within the Vport is referenced, the max-rate defined in the corresponding port-scheduler-policy will be modified based on the IGMP activity associated with the subscriber under this Vport.

The channel bandwidth definition policy is defined in the mcac policy in the configure>router>mcac>policy context. The policy is applied under the group-interface or in case of redirection under the redirected-interface.

The rates in effect can be displayed with the following two commands:

show port 1/1/5 vport name

qos scheduler-hierarchy port port-id vport vport-name

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport, which is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces, is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport, which is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces, is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no egress-rate-modify

host-match

Syntax 
host-match dest destination-string [create]
no host-match dest destination-string
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egr>qgrp
Description 

This command configures host matching for the Ethernet port egress queue-group.

The no form of the command removes the destination string from the configuration.

Parameters 
destination-string
Specify a host match destination string up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword used to create the host match. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context

port-scheduler-policy

Syntax 
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name
no port-scheduler-policy
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command specifies the destination and organization strings to be used for matching subscriber hosts with this Vport.

The parent Vport of a subscriber host queue, which has the port-parent option enabled, is determined by matching the destination string dest string associated with the subscriber and the organization string org string associated with the subscriber host with the strings defined under a Vport on the port associated with the subscriber.

If a given subscriber host policers or queue does not have the port-parent option enabled, it will be foster-parented to the Vport used by this subscriber and which is based on matching the dest string and org string. If the subscriber could not be matched with a Vport on the egress port, the host policer or queue will not be bandwidth controlled and will compete for bandwidth directly based on its own PIR and CIR parameters.

By default, a subscriber host policer or queue with the port-parent option enabled is scheduled within the context of the port’s port scheduler policy.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command. Applying a scheduler policy to a Vport is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces.

The no form of the command removes the port-scheduler-policy-name from the configuration.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no port-scheduler-policy

Parameters 
port-scheduler-policy-name—
Specifies an existing port-scheduler-policy configured in the config>qos context

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
no scheduler-policy
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command specifies a scheduler policy to associate to the Vport. Scheduler policies are configured in the configure>qos>scheduler>policy context. Each scheduler policy is divided up into groups of schedulers based on the tier each scheduler is created under. A tier is used to give structure to the schedulers within a policy and define rules for parent scheduler associations. The policy defines the hierarchy and operating parameters for virtual schedulers.

The no form of this command removes the configured egress scheduler policy from the Vport.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command.

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no scheduler-policy

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name—
The scheduler-policy-name parameter applies an existing scheduler policy that was created in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context to create the hierarchy of egress virtual schedulers.

parent-location

Syntax 
parent-location {default | sla}
no parent-location
Context 
config>qos>sap-egress
Description 

This command determines the expected location of the parent schedulers for queues configured with a parent command within the SAP egress policy. All parent schedulers must be configured within a scheduler policy applied at the location corresponding to the parent-location parameter.

If a parent scheduler name does not exist at the specified location, the queue will not be parented and will be orphaned.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

parent-location default

Parameters 
default—
Specifies that the queues should look for their in the SAP's egress scheduler-policy or the multi-service-site's egress scheduler policy depending on which is configured and Subscriber queues will look for their parents in the subscriber-profile's egress scheduler-policy.When the SAP egress policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the queues must be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the subscriber’s SUB profile. When the SAP egress policy is applied to a SAP, the parent schedulers of the queues need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the SAP or the multi-service site.
sla—
Specifies that the queues should look for their parent in the SLA-profile's egress scheduler-policy; all queues that are not port-parented and to which SLA-profile is not applicable will behave as orphans in this case.When the SAP egress policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the queues must be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the same SLA profile. If this parameter is configured within a SAP egress policy that is applied to any object except of the egress of an SLA profile, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the queues will not be parented and will be orphaned.

parent-location

Syntax 
parent-location {none | sub | vport}
no parent-location
Context 
config>qos>scheduler-policy
Description 

This command determines the expected location of the parent schedulers for the tier 1 schedulers configured with a parent command within the scheduler policy. The parent schedulers must be configured within a scheduler policy applied at the location corresponding to the parent location parameter.

If a parent scheduler name does not exist at the specified location, the schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned.

The configuration of parent-location and frame-based-accounting commands in a scheduler policy is mutually exclusive in to ensure consistency between the different scheduling levels.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

parent-location none

Parameters 
none—
This parameter indicates that the tier 1 schedulers do not have a parent scheduler and the configuration of the parent under a tier 1 scheduler is blocked. Conversely, this parameter is blocked when any tier 1 scheduler has a parent configured.
sub—
When the scheduler policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the tier 1 schedulers need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the subscriber’s SUB profile.

If this parameter is configured within a scheduler policy that is applied to any object except for the egress of an SLA profile, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the tier 1 schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned.

vport—
When the scheduler policy is applied to an SLA profile, a SUB profile for a subscriber or to the egress of a PW SAP, the parent schedulers of the tier 1 schedulers need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the VPORT to which the subscriber will be assigned.

If this parameter is configured within a scheduler policy that is applied to to any object except for the egress of an SLA profile or SUB profile, or to the egress of a PW SAP, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the tier 1 schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned. This parameter is not supported when policers-hqos-manageable is configured in the SAP egress QoS policy.

9.25.2.1.2.1. MLD Policy Commands

mld-policy

Syntax 
mld-policy mld-policy-name [create]
no mld-policy mld-policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to create an MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no mld-policy

Parameters 
mld-policy-name—
Specifies the MLD policy name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

disable-router-alert-check

Syntax 
[no] disable-router-alert-check
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command disables router alert checking for MLD messages received on this interface. The no form of the command enables router alert checking.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no disable-router-alert-check

egress-rate-modify

Syntax 
egress-rate-modify agg-rate-limit
egress-rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
no egress-rate-modify
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the egress rate modification.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

no egress-rate-modify

Parameters 
agg-rate-limit—
Specifies that the maximum total rate for all subscriber egress queues for each subscriber associated with the policy
scheduler-name
Specifies the scheduler to be applied for egress rate modification

fast-leave

Syntax 
[no] fast-leave
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enables fast leave. When fast leave processing is enabled, the router will immediately remove a SAP or SDP from the IP multicast group when it detects an MLD leave on that SAP or SDP. Fast leave processing allows the switch to remove a SAP or SDP that sends a leave from the forwarding table without first sending out group-specific queries to the SAP or SDP, and thus speeds up the process of changing channels (zapping).

Fast leave should only be enabled when there is a single receiver present on the SAP or SDP.

When fast leave is enabled, the configured last-member-query-interval value is ignored.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no fast-leave

import

Syntax 
import policy-name
no import
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command specifies the import routing policy to be used. Only a single policy can be imported at a time.

The no form of the command removes the policy association.

Default 

no import

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the import policy name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes. Routing policies are configured in the config>router>policy-options context The router policy must be defined before it can be imported.

max-num-groups

Syntax 
max-num-groups count
no max-num-groups
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command defines the maximum number of multicast groups that can be joined. If the router receives a join message that would exceed the configured number of groups, the request is ignored.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no max-num-groups

Parameters 
count —
Specifies the maximum number of groups that can be joined
Values—
1 to 1000

 

max-num-grp-sources

Syntax 
max-num-grp-sources [max-num-grp-sources]
no max-num-grp-sources
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of group sources for which MLD can have local receiver information based on received MLD reports on this interface. When this configuration is changed dynamically to a value lower than currently accepted number of group sources, the group sources that are already accepted are not deleted. Only new group sources will not be allowed. When this object has a value of 0, there is no limit to the number of group sources.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no max-num-grp-sources

Parameters 
max-num-grp-sources
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowed to be tracked per group
Values—
1 to 32000

 

max-num-sources

Syntax 
max-num-sources max-num-sources
no max-num-sources
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of multicast sources allowed per group.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
max-num-sources—
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowed per group
Values—
1 to 1000

 

per-host-replication

Syntax 
[no] per-host-replication
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enables per-host-replication. In the per-host-replication mode, multicast traffic is replicated per each host within the subscriber irrespective of the fact that some hosts may be subscribed to the same multicast stream. As a result, in case that multiple hosts within the subscriber are registered for the same multicast group, the multicast streams of that group will be generated. The destination MAC address of multicast streams will be changed to unicast so that each host receives its own copy of the stream. Multicast traffic in the per-host-replication mode can be classified via the existing QoS CLI structure. As such the multicast traffic will flow through the subscriber queues. HQoS Adjustment is not needed in this case.

The alternative behavior for multicast replication in IPoE environment is per-SAP- replication. In this model, only a single copy of the multicast stream is sent per SAP, irrespective of the number of hosts that are subscribed to the same multicast group. This behavior applies to 1:1 connectivity model as well as on 1:N connectivity model (SAP centric behavior as opposed to subscriber centric behavior).

In the per-SAP-replication model the destination MAC address is multicast (as opposed to unicast in the per-host-replication model). Multicast traffic is flowing via the SAP queue which is outside of the subscriber context. The consequence is that multicast traffic is not accounted in the subscriber HQoS. In addition, HQoS Adaptation is not supported in the per SAP replication model.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no per-host-replication

query-interval

Syntax 
query-interval seconds
no query-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command specifies the frequency at which the querier router transmits general host-query messages. Host-query messages solicit group membership information and are sent to the link-scope all-node address, FF02::1. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config> service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no query-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the frequency, in seconds, at which the router transmits general host-query messages
Values—
2 to 1024

 

query-last-listener-interval

Syntax 
query-last-listener-interval seconds
no query-last-listener-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the frequency at which the querier router sends a group-specific query messages, including the messages sent in response to leave-group messages. The shorter the interval, the faster the loss of the last member of a group can be detected. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-last-listener-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config>service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the frequency, in seconds, at which query messages are sent
Values—
1 to 1023

 

query-response-interval

Syntax 
query-response-interval seconds
no query-response-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the query response interval. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-response-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config>service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no query-response-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the length of time that the querier router waits to receive a response to from the host
Values—
1 to 1023

 

redirection-policy

Syntax 
redirection-policy policy-name
no redirection-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command will apply multicast redirection action to the subscriber. The redirection action along with the redirected interface (and possibly service id) is defined in the referenced policy-name. MLD messages will be redirected to an alternate interface if that alternate interface has MLD enabled. The alternate interface does not have to have any multicast groups registered via MLD. Currently all MLD messages are redirected and there is no ability to selectively redirect MLD messages based on match conditions (multicast-group address, source IP address, and so on). Multicast redirection is supported between VPRN services and also between interfaces within the Global Routing Context. Multicast Redirection is not supported between the VRPN services and the Global Routing Table (GRT).

MLD state is maintained per subscriber host and per redirected interface. Traffic is however forwarded only on the redirected interface.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies a redirection policy name up to 32 characters in length. This is a regular policy defined under the configure>router>policy-option>policy-statement context

static

Syntax 
static
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure MLD static group membership parameters.

group

Syntax 
[no] group grp-ipv6-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static
Description 

This command configures a static multicast group.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no group

Parameters 
grp-ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address
Values—
<grp-ipv6-address> : ipv6-address - x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces) x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d
x - [0 to FFFF]H
d - [0 to 255]D
- multicast group IPv6 address

 

source

Syntax 
[no] source ipv6-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static>group
Description 

This command adds or removes a static multicast source.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
grp-ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address
Values—
<grp-ipv6-address> : ipv6-address - x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces) x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d
x - [0 to FFFF]H
d - [0 to 255]D
- multicast group IPv6 address

 

starg

Syntax 
[no] starg
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static>group
Description 

This command adds a static (*,G) entry. This command can only be enabled if no existing source addresses for this group are specified.

The no form of the command removes the starg entry from the configuration.

Default 

no starg

version

Syntax 
version version
no version
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy#
Description 

This command configures the MLD version.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

version 2

Parameters 
version—
Specifies the MLD version
Values—
1, 2

 

9.25.2.1.2.2. IPoE Session Commands

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy policy-name [create]
no ipoe-session-policy policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures an IPoE session policy. The policies are referenced from subscriber interfaces, group interfaces and capture SAPs. Multiple IPoE session policies can be configured.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the IPoE policy name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

circuit-id-from-auth

Syntax 
[no] circuit-id-from-auth
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command takes the circuit ID value from the authentication server to identify the session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no circuit-id-from-auth

description

Syntax 
description description-string
no description
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command takes the circuit-id value from the authentication server when it creates a text description stored in the configuration file for a configuration context.

The description command associates a text string with a configuration context to help identify the context in the configuration file.

The no form of this command removes any description string from the context.

Default 

no description

Parameters 
description-string—
Specifies a text string describing the entity. Allowed values are any string up to 80 characters in length, composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes..

session-key

Syntax 
session-key sap mac [cid] [rid]
no session-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command configures the key to logically group subscriber hosts that belong to the same dual stack end device in an IPoE session.

The SAP and MAC address are always part of the IPoE session key. Optionally the Circuit-Id/Interface-Id or Remote-Id can be added to the session key.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

sap mac

Parameters 
sap —
Includes the SAP as part of the IPoE session key. The sap parameter is mandatory and cannot be removed from the key
mac—
Includes the MAC address as part of the IPoE session key. The mac parameter is mandatory and cannot be removed from the key
cid—
Optionally adds the DHCPv4 Relay Agent Circuit-Id (Option 82, sub Option 1) and DHCPv6 Interface-Id (Option 18) field to the IPoE session key
rid—
Optionally adds the DHCPv4 Relay Agent Remote-Id (Option 82, sub Option 2) and DHCPv6 Remote-Id (Option 37) field to the IPoE session key. For DHCPv6, the enterprise number is excluded from the key.

sap and mac are mandatory parameters while cid and rid are optional and mutually exclusive. Valid IPoE session key parameters are: sap mac, sap mac cid and sap mac rid.

session-timeout

Syntax 
session-timeout timeout
no session-timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command defines the time in seconds between 1 second and 360 days before the IPoE session will be disconnected. The default value is unlimited session timeout.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no session-timeout

Parameters 
timeout—
Specifies the session timeout in seconds
Values—
1 to 31104000

 

sap

Syntax 
sap sap-id [create] [capture-sap]
Context 
config>service>vpls
Description 

This command declares a given SAP as a primary (or secondary) VPLS port.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
capture-sap—
Specifies a capturing SAP in which triggering packets will be sent to the CPM. Non-triggering packets captured by the capture SAP will be dropped. This parameter applies to the 7450 ESS or 7750 SR only.
create—
Specifies to create a SAP instance. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context

ipoe-session

Syntax 
[no] ipoe-session
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
Description 

This command configures IPoE session parameters.

force-auth

Syntax 
force-auth [cid-change] [rid-change]
force-auth disabled
no force-auth
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

By default, if the circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id in the IPoE session re-authentication trigger packet (such as a DHCP renewal) is not empty and different from the circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id stored in the IPoE session data, a forced re-authentication is performed, ignoring the configured min-auth-interval. This default behavior can be changed with this command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default behavior.

Default 

force-auth cid-change rid-change force-auth disabled on wlan-gw group interfaces

Parameters 
cid-change —
Perform a forced re-authentication upon a circuit-id/interface-id change. An empty circuit-id/interface-id is not considered a change
rid-change —
Perform a forced re-authentication upon a remote-id change. an empty remote-id is not considered a change. For DHCPv6, the enterprise number is excluded from the comparison.
disabled —
Specifies that the min-auth-interval never is ignored. The system does not perform a forced re-authentication upon a circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id change.

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy policy-name
no ipoe-session-policy
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the IPoE session policy applicable for this group interface or capture SAP.

On WLAN GW group interfaces, it is not possible to change this value.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ipoe-session-policy ipoe-session-policy default on WLAN GW group interfaces

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the IPoE session policy name up to 32 characters in length

min-auth-interval

Syntax 
min-auth-interval [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
min-auth-interval infinite
no min-auth-interval
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

Re-authentication for IPoE sessions enable dynamic policy changes.

This command configures the maximum frequency of re-authentications by specifying a minimum interval between two non-forced authentications for the same IPoE session.

A forced authentication is by default triggered by a circuit-id, interface-id or remote-id change (see the force-auth command).

Re-authentications are, by default, disabled and can be enabled by configuring a min-auth-interval.

Setting the min-auth-interval to zero seconds will always re-authenticate on each trigger packet.

The no form of the command reverts to the default behavior.

Default 

infinite

Parameters 
days
Specifies the min number of days between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 365

 

hours
Specifies the min number of hours between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 23

 

minutes
Specifies the min number of minutes between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 59

 

seconds
Specifies the min number of seconds between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 59

 

infinite —
Does not perform non-forced re-authentications for IPoE sessions (default)

radius-session-timeout

Syntax 
radius-session-timeout {backwards-compatible | ignore | absolute}
no radius-session-timeout
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies how to interpret the session-timeout coming from a RADIUS VSA in an Access-Accept or CoA message.

The value of this command can only be changed on wlan-gw group interfaces.

The no form of this command to resets the default behavior.

Default 

absolute (backward compatible on wlan-gw group interfaces)

Parameters 
backwards-compatible —
Specifies that the VSA will be interpreted as an IPv4 lease time if the Alc-Lease-Time attribute is not present and an absolute timeout otherwise. The VSA will be treated the same as for non-ipoe session DHCP hosts
ignore —
Specifies that the VSA meaning is irrelevant for IPoE session and should be ignored
absolute —
Specifies that the VSA would be treated as a timeout starting from the moment the IPoE session is set up

sap-session-limit

Syntax 
sap-session-limit sap-session-limit
no sap-session-limit
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the number of IPoE sessions per SAP allowed for this group-interface

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
sap-session-limit —
Specifies the number of allowed IPoE sessions
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071 131071 on wlan-gw group interfaces

 

session-limit

Syntax 
session-limit session-limit
no session-limit
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the number of IPoE sessions allowed for this group interface or retail subscriber interface.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
session-limit—
Specifies the number of allowed IPoE sessions
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071
1 – 500000 (retail subscriber interface)

 

user-db

Syntax 
user-db local-user-db-name
no user-db
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command configures the local user database to use for IPoE session authentication.

When configured on a capture SAP, the group interface must have the same local user database configured.

On a wlan-gw group interface, the no form of this command indicates that the user database will be picked from the following sources in the order shown:

  1. dhcp
  2. ipv6>dhcp6
  3. ipv6>router-solicit

If no user database can be found in any of these locations, processing continues as if no user database was configured. This behavior is for backwards compatibility reasons only; when using a LUDB, it should be explicitly added to the IPoE session configuration.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no user-db

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the local user database name up to 32 characters in length

shutdown

Syntax 
[no] shutdown
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

The shutdown command enables or disables IPoE session management on a group interface or capture SAP.

A shutdown of the IPoE session CLI hierarchy on a group-interface will clear all active IPoE sessions on that interface, resulting in a deletion of all corresponding subscriber hosts.

On wlan-gw group interfaces it is not possible to disable an IPoE session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

shutdown no shutdown on wlan-gw group interfaces

9.25.2.1.3.1. SHCV Policy Commands

shcv-policy

Syntax 
shcv-policy name [create]
no shcv-policy name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures a Subscriber Host Connectivity Verification (SHCV) policy. An SHCV policy can be applied to both the subscriber management group interface and VPLS instances. All SHCV-related features inside a group interface and a VPLS service will follow the configuration specified in the SHCV policy. The SHCV policy and the SHCV configuration on a group interface are mutually exclusive. Only one can be applied to the group interface.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the SHCV policy, up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

layer-3

Syntax 
layer-3
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior parameters for IES and VPRN services.

source-ip-origin

Syntax 
source-ip-origin {interface | vrrp}
no source-ip-origin
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>layer-3
Description 

This command selects the source IP address to be used for SHCV messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
interface—
Specifies to use the interface IP as the source address of SHCV
vrrp—
Specifies to use the VRRP configured IP as the source address of SHCV

periodic

Syntax 
periodic
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure periodic SHCV properties for the subscriber management group-interface. This tool will periodically scan all known DHCP hosts only and perform unicast ARP/NS requests. The subscriber host connectivity verification will maintain state (connected vs. not-connected) for all hosts.

action

Syntax 
action {alarm | remove}
no action
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the action to take when the periodic connectivity verification failed.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

alarm

Parameters 
alarm—
Raises an alarm indicating that the host is disconnected
remove—
Raises an alarm and releases all allocated resources (addresses, prefixes, queues, table entries, and so on). Static hosts are removed.

interval

Syntax 
interval minutes
no interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command specifies the time interval which all known sources should be verified. The actual rate is dependent on the number of known hosts and intervals.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

30 minutes

Parameters 
minutes—
Specifies the interval, in minutes, between periodic connectivity checks
Values—
1 to 6000

 

retry-count

Syntax 
retry-count [count]
no retry-count
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the number of retransmissions.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1 — For trigger-type ip-conflict, host-limit-exceeded and mobility

10 — For trigger-type inactivity and MAC learning

Parameters 
count
Specifies the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification
Values—
2 to 29

 

timeout

Syntax 
timeout seconds
no timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the timeout before a retransmission in triggered connectivity verification.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

10

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the timeout, in seconds, before a retransmission in triggered connectivity verification
Values—
10 to 60

 

trigger

Syntax 
trigger trigger-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enables to context to configure SHCV triggers.

Parameters 
trigger-type—
Specifies the trigger SHCV properties for the subscriber management group-interface.
Values—
ip-conflict — Upon detecting an IP conflict for the new host, a trigger SHCV is sent using a unicast ARP/NS. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
host-limit-exceeded — Upon exceeding the host-limit for (sla-profile, ipoe-session sap-session-limit, ipoe-session session-limit, and arp-host), a trigger SHCV is sent. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
inactivity — A trigger SHCV is sent to the idle host to verify the host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system.
mobility — Detects detects an IP or MAC conflict between different SAPs. Upon detecting a MAC or an IP conflict, a trigger SHCV is sent. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
mac-learning — Specifies the trigger SHCV properties to learn the MAC address of static hosts. Upon a no shutdown, a trigger SHCV is sent to the host to learn the host’s MAC address.

 

retry-count

Syntax 
retry-count [count]
no retry-count
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>trigger
Description 

This command configures the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
count
Specifies the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification
Values—
1 to 29

 

timeout

Syntax 
timeout seconds
no timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>trigger
Description 

This command configures the timeout before a retransmission.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1 for trigger-type ip-conflict, host-limit-exceeded and mobility

2 for trigger-type inactivity and mac-learning

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the retry timeout in seconds
Values—
1 to 60

 

vpls

Syntax 
vpls service-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in VPLS services. Refer to the Layer 2 Service Guide for VPLS service command syntax and descriptions.

vprn

Syntax 
vprn service-id
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in VPRN services. Refer to the Layer 3 Services Guide for VPRN service command syntax and descriptions.

ies

Syntax 
ies service-id
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in IES services. Refer to the Layer 3 Services Guide for IES service command syntax and descriptions.

shcv-policy-ipv4

Syntax 
shcv-policy-ipv4 name
no shcv-policy-ipv4
Context 
config>service>vpls
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>ies>if
config>service>vprn>if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the shcv-policy to be used exclusive for IPv4 subscriber hosts. The shcv-policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

shcv-policy-ipv6

Syntax 
shcv-policy-ipv6 name
no shcv-policy-ipv6
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the SHCV policy to be used exclusive for IPv6 subscriber hosts. The policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

shcv-policy

Syntax 
shcv-policy name
no shcv-policy
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the SHCV policy to be used for both IPv4 and IPv6 subscriber hosts. The policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

source-ip

Syntax 
source-ip ip-address
no source-ip
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>vpls
Description 

This command configures the IPv4 address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no source-ip

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IPv4 address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service

source-mac

Syntax 
source-mac ieee-address
no source-mac
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>vpls
Description 

Specifies the MAC address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no source-mac

Parameters 
ieee-address—
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address in the xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx or xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx format

9.25.2.1.16.1. Show Commands

Note:

The command outputs in the following section are examples only; actual displays may differ depending on supported functionality and user configuration.

diameter-peer-policy

Syntax 
diameter-peer-policy [peer-policy-name]
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name peer peer-name [statistics]
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name client-side-peer-ip ip-address port tcp-port [statistics]
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays diameter peer policy information and diameter peer information and statistics. For the diameter proxy, the incoming peer can be specified with an IP address and port number.

Parameters 
peer-policy-name—
Specifies the diameter peer policy name, up to 32 characters in length
peer-name —
Specifies the diameter peer name, up to 32 characters in length
ip address —
Specifies the IP address of the incoming peer (client side) of a diameter proxy
tcp-port —
Specifies the TCP port number of the incoming peer (client side) of a diameter proxy
statistics —
Displays the diameter peer statistics with details per diameter application, per message type, and per direction (rx/ tx)
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA Diameter peer policy information.

Sample Output
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1
===============================================================================
Last Mgmt Change      : 01/07/2016 20:05:12
Applications          : gy
Role                  : client
Description           : Diamater peer policy - gy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Diameter Config Values
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Origin Host           : bng.domain.com
Origin Realm          : domain.com
Source IPv4 Address   : 192.0.2.51
Source IPv6 Address   : N/A
Router                : Base               Transaction Timer  : 30 (default)
Watchdog Timer        : 30 (default)       Connection Timer   : 30 (default)
Vendor Support        : 3GPP (default)
Python Policy         : py-policy-diam-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Peer Name            Oper  PSM State     Susp  Cooldown  Pref  Order  Pri/Sec
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
peer-1               Yes   I-Open        No    -         30    1      Primary
peer-2               No    Closed        No    -         50    -      -
===============================================================================
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1" peer "peer-1"
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1
===============================================================================
Peer IP address        : 172.16.1.1
Last Mgmt Change       : 01/07/2016 20:05:12
Peer Operational       : Yes              Watchdog Algorithm Active   : Yes
Peer State Machine     : I-Open           Watchdog Answer Pending     : No
Connection Timer  (Tc) : -                Connection Suspended        : No
Transaction Timer (Tt) : -                Cooldown Sequence Pending   : No
Watchdog Timer    (Tw) : 17               Cooldown Sequence Active    : No
Primary/Secondary Peer : Primary          Cooldown Sequence Progress  : -
Preference Order       : 1                Peer Removal Pending        : No
Pending Messages       : 0
===============================================================================
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1" peer "peer-1" statistics
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1 (statistics)
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer             : peer-1
Time statistics cleared   : 01/07/2016 20:05:10
===============================================================================
                                      Request     Answer    Request     Answer
                                           Tx         Rx         Rx         Tx
===============================================================================
Aggregates
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                       1          1          0          0
Failed                                      0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 0 (Base)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Capabilities-Exchange                       1          1          0          0
Disconnect-Peer                             0          0          0          0
Device-Watchdog                             0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 1 (NASREQ)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Authorization-Authentication                0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 4 (Gy)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Credit-Control (Initial)                    0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Update)                     0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Termination)                0          0          0          0
Re-Auth                                     0          0          0          0
Abort-Session                               0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 16777238 (Gx)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Credit-Control (Initial)                    0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Update)                     0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Termination)                0          0          0          0
Re-Auth                                     0          0          0          0
Abort-Session                               0          0          0          0
===============================================================================

Table 87 provides a description of the counters in the output of the show aaa diameter-peer-policy command. and Table 88 provides the failure reasons for the aggregate Failed counter (Request Rx and Answer Rx).

Table 87:  show aaa diameter-peer-policy Field Descriptions 

Counter

Counts  

Aggregates Total

Request Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully transmitted diameter request messages (all applications, all message types)

Answer Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully received diameter answer messages (all applications, all message types)

Request Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully received diameter request messages (all applications, all message types)

Answers Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully transmitted diameter answer messages (all applications, all message types)

Aggregates Failed

Request Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all request messages that could not be sent for internal reasons, such as TCP socket error (for example, congestion), failure reported to application (for example, no retries left)

Dropped by Python — Timeouts (requests for which no answer was received within the configured timeout interval)

Answer Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all Answer messages that failed to be successfully decoded, such as such as invalid header length or a violation against the Command Code Format (CCF) specification.

See Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters for more information.

Request Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all Request messages that failed to be successfully decoded, such as invalid header length or a violation against the Command Code Format (CCF) specification.

See Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters for more information.

Answers Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all answer messages that could not be sent for internal reasons such as TCP socket error (for example, congestion).

Dropped by Python

Application ID id message type

Request Tx

Successfully transmitted diameter request messages for the corresponding application and message type

Answer Rx

Successfully received diameter answer messages for the corresponding application and message type

Request Rx

Successfully received diameter request messages for the corresponding application and message type

Answers Tx

Successfully transmitted diameter answer messages for the corresponding application and message type

Table 88:  Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters 

Role

Failed reasons 

Proxy

Proxy (message length too short / too long / version unsupported)

Consistency check failed: header size, message length, illegal flag combination, AVP header too small, AVP present but not allowed (base RFC messages), and so on

Not a base message

Not a request

Tx overload (message received to be send to client)

Dropped by python

Failed to create answer

No transaction (answer to server, but request is not found - 5 min.)

Diameter base / Diameter application

Message dropped due to result code

Message too big / too small

Dropped by python

Consistency check failed

end-2-end mismatch hop-to-hop command code (answer/request mismatch)

Cool down sequence drop

cc error request

Application id in header error

T bit in header

isa-radius-policy

Syntax 
isa-radius-policy policy-name
isa-radius-policy policy-name associations
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays ISA RADIUS policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information about the specified ISA RADIUS policy
associations—
Displays the information associated with the ISA RADIUS server policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA ISA RADIUS policy information.

Sample Output
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show aaa isa-radius-policy "ZiggoAAA_DRP_ISAPlcy" 
===============================================================================
Status for ISA RADIUS server policy "ZiggoAAA_DRP_ISAPlcy"
===============================================================================
Server 1, group 1, member 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Purposes Up                                     : accounting authentication
Source IP address                               : 172.18.128.33
Acct Tx Requests                                : 2469931
Acct Tx Retries                                 : 320
Acct Tx Timeouts                                : 160
Acct Rx Replies                                 : 2469471
Auth Tx Requests                                : 16417061
Auth Tx Retries                                 : 7169
Auth Tx Timeouts                                : 2922
Auth Rx Replies                                 : 16406973
CoA Rx Requests                                 : 0
 
Table 89:  Subscriber ISA RADIUS Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Purposes Up

Indicates the RADIUS services that are up and running, and fully operational for this server.

Source IP address

Indicates the IP address of the RADIUS server.

Acct Tx Requests

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests transmitted.

Acct TX Retries

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction request retries.

Acct TX Timeouts

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that have timed out.

Acct RX Replies

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction responses received.

Auth Tx Requests

Indicates the number of authentication requests transmitted.

Auth Tx Retries

Indicates the number of authentication request retries.

Auth Tx Timeouts

Indicates the number of RADIUS authentication requests that have timed out for the policy.

CoA RX Requests

Indicates the number of Change-of-Authorization message responses received.

radius-configuration

Syntax 
radius-configuration
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays RADIUS configuration information.

Output 

The following output is an example of AAA RADIUS configuration information.

Sample Output
# show aaa radius-configuration 
===============================================================================
RADIUS configuration
===============================================================================
CoA Port                    : 3799
===============================================================================

Table 89 provides a description of the counters in the output of the show aaa isa-radius-policy command.

Table 90:  AAA ISA RADIUS Policy Field Descriptions  

Label

Description

CoA Port

Displays the RADIUS Change of Authorization (CoA) port.

 

radius-server-policy

Syntax 
radius-server-policy policy-name [acct-on-off]
radius-server-policy policy-name associations
radius-server-policy policy-name msg-buffer-stats
radius-server-policy policy-name statistics
radius-server-policy [acct-on-off]
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays RADIUS server policy configuration information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information for the specified RADIUS server policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the RADIUS server policy.
msg-buffer-stats—
Displays statistics related to the RADIUS messages that are buffered for each specified RADIUS server policy
statistics—
Displays statistics for the specified RADIUS server policy
act-on-off—
Displays the admin state of the acct-on-off feature
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA RADIUS server policy information.

Sample Output
Table 91:  Subscriber RADIUS Server Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Tx transaction requests

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests transmitted.

Rx transaction responses

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction responses received.

Transaction requests timed out

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that have timed out.

Transaction requests send failed

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that could not be transmitted.

Packet retries

Indicates the number of times a RADIUS request packet was retransmitted to a server.

Transaction requests send rejected

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that were not transmitted due to unacceptable configuration.

Authentication requests failed

Indicates the number of authentication failures for this policy.

Accounting requests failed

Indicates the number of accounting failures for this policy.

Ratio of access-reject over auth responses

Indicates the ratio of access-rejects in the auth responses for this policy.

Transaction success ratio

Indicates the transaction success ratio for this policy.

Transaction failure ratio

Indicates the transaction failure ratio for this policy.

Statistics last reset at

Indicated the date and time at which the statistics for this policy were last reset.

*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show aaa radius-server-policy "ZiggoAAA_anycast" statistics 
===============================================================================
RADIUS server policy "ZiggoAAA_anycast" statistics
===============================================================================
Tx transaction requests                         : 24818681
Rx transaction responses                        : 24817329
Transaction requests timed out                  : 1351
Transaction requests send failed                : 0
Packet retries                                  : 12410
Transaction requests send rejected              : 0
Authentication requests failed                  : 303530
Accounting requests failed                      : 0
Ratio of access-reject over auth responses      : 13%
Transaction success ratio                       : 99%
Transaction failure ratio                       : 1%
Statistics last reset at                        : 05/21/2015 01:11:39

wpp

Syntax 
wpp portal-group name
wpp [portal-group name] [host ip-address] hosts
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays information about the specified WPP portal group or the WPP hosts controlled by the WPP portal group.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the WPP portal group up to 32 characters in length
ip-address—
Specifies the IP address of the WPP host
hosts—
Output 

The following output is an example of WPP portal group or WPP host information.

Sample Output
show aaa wpp portal-group "test" 
===============================================================================
wpp portal group "test"
===============================================================================
administrative state                  : in-service
controlled router                     : 500
number of enabled interfaces          : 1
triggered hosts                       : disabled
last management change                : 01/02/2017 19:02:11
===============================================================================

ancp-policy

Syntax 
ancp-policy [policy-name]
ancp-policy policy-name association
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information for the specified ANCP policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the ANCP policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP policy information.

Sample Output
A:cses-E11>config>subscr-mgmt>ancp# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy "test"
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "test"
===============================================================================
I. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
I. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
I. Rate Monitor        : 63360 kbps
I. Rate Monitor Alarm  : Yes
I. Rate Modify         : N/A
 
E. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
E. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
E. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
E. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
E. Rate Modify         : N/A
 
Port Down : N/A
 
Last Mgmt Change: 02/13/2013 19:15:28
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11>config>subscr-mgmt>ancp# 

ancp-string

Syntax 
ancp-string
ancp-string ancp-string
ancp-string customer customer-id site customer-site-name
ancp-string sap sap-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) string information.

Parameters 
ancp-string—
Specifies an Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) string up to 63 characters in length
customer-id
Specifies an existing customer ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

customer-site-name
Specifies an existing customer site name up to 32 characters in length
sap-id
Displays ANCP string information for the specified SAP ID
Values—

<sap-id>

null

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | aps-id>

dot1q

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | aps-id | pw-id>:qtag1

qinq

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | pw-id>:qtag1.qtag2

atm

<port-id | aps-id>[:vpi/vci | vpi | vpi1.vpi2 | cp.conn-prof-id]

cp

keyword

conn-prof-id

[1 to 8000]

frame

<port-id | aps-id>:dlci

cisco-hdlc

slot/mda/port.channel

cem

slot/mda/port.channel

ima-grp

<bundle-id>[:vpi/vci | vpi | vpi1.vpi2 | cp.conn-prof-id]

cp

keyword

conn-prof-id

[1 to 8000]

port-id

slot/mda/port[.channel]

bundle-id

bundle-<type>-slot/mda.<bundle-num>

bundle

keyword

type

ima | fr | ppp

bundle-num

[1 to 336]

bpgrp-id

bpgrp-<type>-<bpgrp-num>

bpgrp

keyword

type

ima | ppp

bpgrp-num

[1 to 2000]

aps-id

aps-<group-id>[.channel]

aps

keyword

group-id

[1 to 64]

ccag-id

ccag-<id>.<path-id>[cc-type]:<cc-id>

ccag

keyword

id

[1 to 8]

path-id

[a | b]

cc-type

[.sap-net |.net-sap]

cc-id

[0 to 4094]

eth-tunnel

eth-tunnel-<id>[:<eth-tun-sap-id>]

id

[1 to 1024]

eth-tun-sap-id

[0 to 4094]

lag-id

lag-<id>

lag

keyword

id

[1 to 800]

pw-id

pw-<id>

pw

keyword

id

[1 to 10239]

qtag1

[0 to 4094]

qtag2

[* | 0 to 4094]

vpi

[0 to 4095] (NNI)

[0 to 255] (UNI)

vci

[1 | 2 | 5 to 65535]

dlci

[16 to 1022]

tunnel-id

tunnel-<id>.<private | public>:<tag>

tunnel

keyword

id

[1 to 16]

tag

[0 to 4094]

 

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP string information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string "ANCP-0000003-0000001"
========================================================================
ANCP-String "ANCP-0000003-0000001"
========================================================================
Type       : SUB - "4AACAHCU74"
State      : Up                 Ancp Policy: N/A
I. Rate    : 129 kbps           E. Rate    : 130 kbps
Adj I. Rate: N/A                Adj E. Rate: N/A
Act I. Rate: N/A                Act E. Rate: N/A
Service Id : 50 (VPRN)
Group      : linux
Neighbor   : 10.0.0.2:34885
Persist Key: N/A
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Actual-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream              : 129 kbits/s
Actual-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream            : 130 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream             : 131 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream           : 132 kbits/s
Attainable-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream          : 133 kbits/s
Attainable-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream        : 134 kbits/s
Maximum-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream             : 135 kbits/s
Maximum-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream           : 136 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Low-Power-Data-Rate-Upstream   : 137 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Low-Power-Data-Rate-Downstream : 138 kbits/s
Maximum-Interleaving-Delay-Upstream        : 139 ms
Actual-Interleaving-Delay-Upstream         : 140 ms
Maximum-Interleaving-Delay-Downstream      : 141 ms
Actual-Interleaving-Delay-Downstream       : 142 ms
DSL-Line-State                             : 2 (IDLE)
Access-Loop-Encapsulation                  : 16909056 (0x01020300)
========================================================================
 

authentication

Syntax 
authentication policy-name association
authentication [policy-name]
authentication [policy-name] statistics
authentication coa-statistics
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber management RADIUS authentication policy information and statistics.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the subscriber management RADIUS authentication policy name, up to 32 characters in length, for which information is requested
association—
Displays SAP, interface, local user database host, AA and L2TP associations of this policy
coa-statistics—
Displays the overall statistics for incoming RADIUS Change of Authorization (CoA) messages and Disconnect Messages. For dropped requests, a counter for different drop reasons is available.
statistics—
Displays a list of policies with basic statistics (without specifying a policy name) or detailed statistics, including per-server statistics for the specified policy-name. These statistics apply only to the legacy RADIUS server configuration method where the servers are directly configured in the authentication policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management authentication information.

Sample Output
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
auth-policy-1                    Radius auth policy - servers
auth-policy-2                    Radius auth policy - radius-server-policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Authentication Policies : 2
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-2" 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy auth-policy-2
===============================================================================
Description          : Radius auth policy - radius-server-policy
Re-authentication    : Yes                 Username Format      : MAC Address
PPPoE Access Method  : PAP/CHAP            Username Mac-Format  : "aa:"
PPP-Username Oper    : None                
PPP-Domain-Name      : N/A
Username Oper        : None                
Domain-Name          : N/A
Acct-Stop-On-Fail    : 
RADIUS Server Policy : "aaa-server-policy-1"
Fallback Action      : deny                
Last Mgmt Change     : 06/24/2013 21:16:50 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include Radius Attributes
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Remote Id            : Yes                 Circuit Id           : Yes
NAS Port Id          : Yes                 NAS Identifier       : Yes
PPPoE Service Name   : Yes                 DHCP Vendor Class Id : Yes
Access Loop Options  : Yes                 MAC Address          : Yes
NAS Port Prefix      : None                NAS Port Suffix      : None
NAS-Port-Type        : Yes (standard)      Acct Session Id      : Host
Calling Station Id   : Yes (sap-string)    Called Station Id    : Yes
Tunnel Server Attr   : Yes                 DHCP Options         : Yes
NAS Port             : Yes                 
NAS Port Bits Spec   : *3s*1m*4p*12o*12i
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Servers
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Router               : management + Base   Source Address       : N/A
Access Algorithm     : Direct              Retry                : 3
Timeout (s)          : 5                   Hold down time (s)   : 30
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Index IP Address      Port  Pend-Req-Limit Out/Overload time (s) Oper State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Radius Servers configured.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Accept Radius Attributes
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Matching Entries
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Script Policies
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Access-Request          : "N/A"
Access-Accept           : "N/A"       
Change-of-Authorization : "N/A"
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-2" association 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy auth-policy-2
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Interface Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 3000 (VPRN)
 - If Name : group-int-ws-1-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db PPPoE Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db : ludb-1
 - Host : host-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db DHCP Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db : ludb-1
 - Host : default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application Assurance Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
No associated L2TP groups found.
No associated L2TP tunnels found.
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication statistics 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy Statistics
===============================================================================
Policy Name                       Subscr. Pkts   Subscr. Pkts   Subscr. Pkts
                                  Authenticated  Rejected       Rejected
                                                                Send Failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
auth-policy-1                     0              0              0
auth-policy-2                     0              0              0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Authentication Policies : 2
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-1" statistics 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy Statistics
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy name                               : auth-policy-1
subscriber packets authenticated          : 0
subscriber packets rejected               : 0
subscriber packets rejected send failed   : 0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
radius server     requests  requests  requests  requests   requests requests
idx IP-address    accepted  rejected  no reply  md5 failed pending  send failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 172.16.1.1      0         0         0         0          0        0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication coa-statistics 
===============================================================================
Radius Notify Statistics    Change-Of-Authorization   Disconnect-Messages
===============================================================================
Requests Received             7                        10
Requests Accepted             5                        6
Requests Rejected             2                        4
Requests Dropped              0                        0
    No Auth Policy found      0                        0
    Invalid message           0                        0
    Out of resources          0                        0
    Authentication failure    0                        0
===============================================================================
 
Table 92:  Subscriber Authentication Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Requests Received

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests received.

Requests Accepted

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests accepted.

Requests Rejected

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected.

Requests Dropped

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests dropped.

No Auth Policy found

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests found.

Invalid message

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected because of decode errors.

Out of resources

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected due to lack of resources.

Authentication Failure

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests which do not have NAS-Port-ID or Framed-IP-Address set or have mismatched subscriber-id.

category-map

Syntax 
category-map [category-map]
category-map category-map subscribers
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays category map information.

With no parameters specified, a summary view of all configured category maps is displayed.

With the optional category-map name parameter specified, the detailed configuration of the specified category map name is displayed.

With the category-map subscribers parameters specified, all subscribers that have the specified category-map associated are displayed.

Parameters 
category-map
Specifies the category map name for which information is displayed
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management category map information.

Sample Output
Node# show subscriber-mgmt category-map "cat-map-1"
===============================================================================
Category Map: cat-map-1
===============================================================================
Description        : gy - time and volume
Credit Type        : volume             Credit Exh. Thresh.: 80%
Activity Thresh.   : 0 kb/s
Gx session level
usage monitoring   : false
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Category: cat-1-time
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Description        : Rating group for Time quota
Credit Type Over.  : none               Rating Group       : 11
OutOfCredit Action : none
Default Credit     : none
Ingress Queues     : 1
Egress Queues      : 1
Ingress Policers   : none
Egress Policers    : none
ExhCrdSvcLvl Pir   : none
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Category: cat-1-volume
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Description        : Rating group for Volume quota
Credit Type Over.  : none               Rating Group       : 12
OutOfCredit Action : none
Default Credit     : none
Ingress Queues     : 1
Egress Queues      : 1
Ingress Policers   : none
Egress Policers    : none
ExhCrdSvcLvl Pir   : 100
===============================================================================

diameter-application-policy

Syntax 
diameter-application-policy [name]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays Diameter application policy information.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be displayed
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management Diameter application policy information

Sample Output
# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
diameter-gx-policy-1             Diameter Gx policy
diameter-gy-policy-1             Diameter Gy policy
diameter-nasreq-policy-1         Diameter NASREQ policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of policies: 3
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Description                 : Diameter NASREQ policy
Session failover            : enabled
Failover handling           : continue
Peer policy                 : diameter-peer-policy-1
Application                 : nasreq
Tx timer (s)                : 10
Last management change      : 02/28/2015 14:53:49
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
NASREQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include AVP                 : nas-port-id
                              nas-port-type
NAS-Port-Id prefix type     : none
NAS-Port-Id suffix type     : user-string
NAS-Port-Id suffix          : @bng1
NAS-Port-Type type          : standard
 
User name format            : mac
User name operation         : no-operation
MAC address format          : aa:
Last management change      : 02/28/2015 14:53:49
===============================================================================
Interfaces using diameter-auth-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Interface-name                   Service-id Type
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
group-int-1-1                    1000       IES
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of interfaces: 1 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
VPLS SAP's with diameter-auth-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service    SAP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10         1/1/4:*.*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of SAP's: 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy "diamapppol_gx"
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policy "diamapppol_gx"
===============================================================================
Description                 : (Not Specified)
Session failover            : enabled
Failover handling           : retry-and-terminate
Peer policy                 : diampeerpol_gx
Application                 : gx
Tx timer (s)                : 10
Last management change      : 05/08/2015 05:55:59
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Gx
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include AVP                 : an-gw-address
Calling-Station-Id type     : mac
NAS-Port bits spec          : 0
NAS-Port-Id prefix type     : user-string
NAS-Port-Id prefix          : Testing
NAS-Port-Id suffix type     : circuit-id
NAS-Port-Type value         : 0
User-Equipment-Info         : mac
 
Subscription-Id-Data origin : subscriber-id
Subscription-Id-Data type   : e164
MAC address format          : aa:
Report IP address event     : enabled
CCR-t replay interval       : 60
Last management change      : 05/08/2015 06:54:27
 

diameter-session

Syntax 
diameter-session
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to display diameter session information.

ccrt-replay

Syntax 
ccrt-replay [session-id session-id] [diameter-application-policy name]
ccrt-replay summary
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>diam-session
Description 

This command displays information about diameter Gx sessions that are in Credit-Control-Request Session-Terminate-Request (CCR-T) replay mode.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be deleted
session-id
Identifies a diameter session ID
summary—
Displays summarized information about CCRT replay
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management CCR-T replay information.

Sample Output
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:21:46 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay session-id ro 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:21:27
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay summary 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Total Count   : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay diameter-application-
policy "diamapppol_gx" 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:18:49
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 

mac

Syntax 
mac all | ieee-address | unknown
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by MAC address.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors starting with the lowest MAC address
ieee-address—
Shows only the error of a specific MAC address
unknown—
Shows errors with unknown MAC addresses, such as for PPPoA subscribers
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management listed by MAC addresses.

Sample Output
*A:eng-BNG-2# show  subscriber-mgmt errors mac all
===============================================================================
Subscriber management errors
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:46.0
Service   : 1000
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:16.0
Service   : 1000
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
===============================================================================

sap

Syntax 
sap all | sap-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by SAP.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors starting with the lowest SAP index
sap-id—
Shows only the error of a specific SAP index
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management errors listed by SAP.

Sample Output
A:BNG-2# show  subscriber-mgmt errors sap all
===============================================================================
Subscriber management errors
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:46.0
Service   : 1000
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:16.0
Service   : 1000
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
===============================================================================

sdp

Syntax 
sdp all | sdp-id:vc-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by SDP.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors beginning with the lowest SDP index
sdp-id:vc-id—
Shows only the error of a specific SDP index

unknown-origin

Syntax 
unknown-origin
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command lists errors of an unknown origin. Errors shown do have a corresponding SAP ID or a SDP ID.

explicit-subscriber-map

Syntax 
explicit-subscriber-map
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays explicit subscriber mappings.

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management explicit subscriber map information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# explicit-subscriber-map
===============================================================================
Explicit Subscriber Map
===============================================================================
Key                              Sub profile
                                 SLA profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_ident_A_1                    sub_prof80
                                 sla_prof80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Explicit Subscriber Mappings : 1
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt#

host-lockout-policy

Syntax 
host-lockout-policy
host-lockout-policy policy-name association
host-lockout-policy policy-name
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state sap sap-id [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [circuit-id circuit-id] [sap sap-id] [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [mac ieee-address] [sap sap-id] [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [remote-id remote-id] [sap sap-id] [summary]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays host lockout policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies a specific subscriber host lockout policy name up to 32 characters
association—
Specifies to display the association of the host lockout policy
lockout-state—
Specifies to display information for hosts in a specific lockout state
Values—
all, active, graceful

 

sap sap-id
Specifies to display SAP ID information
circuit-id circuit-id—
Specifies to display circuit ID information. The circuit-id is 256 characters maximum.
mac ieee-address
Specifies to display MAC address information up to 30 characters in length
remote-id remote-id—
Specifies to display remote ID information up to 256 characters in length
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management host lockout policy information.

Sample Output
*A:cses-E11# show subscriber-mgmt host-lockout-policy
===============================================================================
Host Lockout Policies
===============================================================================
Lockout Policy                   Last Mgmt Change
  Lockout Time Min                 Lockout Time Max
Description
  Lockout Reset Time               Max Lockout Hosts
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
test                             04/20/2012 19:51:02
  10                               3600
test
  60                               100
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11# 
 
 
*A:cses-E11# show subscriber-mgmt host-lockout-policy "test"
===============================================================================
Host Lockout Policy "test"
===============================================================================
Description                        test
Last Mgmt Change                   04/20/2012 19:51:02
Lockout time min                   10
Lockout time max                   3600
Lockout reset time                 60
Max lockout hosts                  100
Host key                           all
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11#

igmp-policy

Syntax 
igmp-policy
igmp-policy policy-name association
igmp-policy policy-name
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays IGMP policy information and only applies to the 7750 SR.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies an existing IGMP policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the IGMP policy
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management IGMP policy information.

Sample Output
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policies
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy                                                                    
  Import Policy                    Admin Version                    
Description                                                                    
  Num Subscribers                  Host Max Groups                  
  Fast Leave                                
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
pol1                                                                           
                                   3
  2                                0
  fast-leave                       
pol2                                                                           
                                   3
  0                                0
  fast-leave                       
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C# 
 
 
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy "pol1" 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy pol1
===============================================================================
Import Policy                         : 
Admin Version                         : 3
Num Subscribers                       : 2
Host Max Group                        : 0
Fast Leave                            : yes
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C#
 
 
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy "pol1" association 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy pol1 Associations
===============================================================================
sub_1                                                                          
sub_2                                                                          
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of subscriber(s): 2
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C#

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy ipoe-session-policy-name [association]
ipoe-session-policy
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays IPoE session policy information.

Parameters 
ipoe-session-policy-name—
Specifies the IPoE session policy name up to 32 characters in length
association—
Displays the interface and captures SAPs that reference the IPoE session policy
Output 

The following output is an example of IPoE session policy information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt ipoe-session-policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
IPoE Session Policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Description           : IPoE policy
Last Mgmt Change      : 02/28/2015 11:51:25
Session Key           : sap-mac
Session Timeout       : unlimited
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt ipoe-session-policy "ipoe-policy-1" association
===============================================================================
IPoE Session Policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPoE Interface Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 1000 (IES)
 - group-int-1-1
Service-Id : 2000 (VPRN)
 - group-int-1-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Capture SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 10 (VPLS)
- 1/1/4:*.*
===============================================================================
 

local-user-db

Syntax 
local-user-db local-user-db-name association [dhcp] [ppp] [12tp] [radius] [pppoe] [dhcp6] [capture-sap] [rtr-solicit] [wpp] [ipoe]
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-all-hosts
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-host ipoe-host-name
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-unmatched-hosts
local-user-db [local-user-db-name]
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-all-hosts
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-host pppoe-host-name
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-unmatched-hosts
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays local user database information.

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the name of a local user database up to 32 characters in length
association—
Displays entities associated with the specified local user database
dhcp—
Displays DHCP information
ppp—
Displays PPP information
l2tp—
Displays L2TP information
radius—
Displays RADIUS information
pppoe—
Displays PPPoE information
dhcp6—
Displays DHCP6 information
capture-sap—
Displays capture SAP information
rt-solicit—
Displays RT solicit information
wpp—
Displays WPP information
ipoe—
Displays IPoE information
ipoe-all-hosts—
Displays IPoE all hosts information
ipoe-host-name
Displays IPoE host name information
ipoe-unmatched-hosts—
Displays IPoE unmatched hosts information
ppp-all-hosts—
Displays information about PPP all hosts
pppoe-hosts—
Displays information about PPPoE hosts
pppoe-unmatched-hosts—
Displays information about PPPoE unmatched hosts
Output 

The following output is an example of local user database information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db
===============================================================================
Local User Databases
===============================================================================
Name                             Admin Host  Description
                                 State Count
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
database01                       Down  1
database02 Provider001/Class0002 Down  0     This is a long testdescription wi*
test                             Down  2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Local User Databases : 3     Number of Hosts : 3
===============================================================================
* indicates that the corresponding row element may have been truncated.
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db database01
===============================================================================
Local User Database "database01"
===============================================================================
Admin State          : Down
Last Mgmt Change     : 11/08/2007 12:27:36
Host Count           : 1
DHCP Match Types     : circ-id
DHCP CircId Mask Pfx : test
DHCP CircId Mask Sfx : N/A
PPPoE Match Types    : N/A
PPPoE CircId Mask Pfx: N/A
PPPoE CircId Mask Sfx: N/A
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db database01 dhcp-all-hosts
===============================================================================
Local User Database "database01" DHCP hosts
===============================================================================
Name                             Admin     Matched objects
                                 State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
host001                          Down      -
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of DHCP Hosts : 1
===============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" dhcp-host host001
===============================================================================
DHCP Host "host001"
===============================================================================
Admin State          : Down
Last Mgmt Change     : 11/08/2007 12:13:42
 
Host Identification
 Circuit Id          : N/A
 Mac Address         : N/A
 Remote Id           : N/A
 Sap Id              : N/A
 Service Id          : N/A
 String              : N/A
 Option 60           : N/A
 System Id           : N/A
 
Matched Objects      : N/A
 
Address              : N/A
 
Identification Strings
 Subscriber Id       : N/A
 SLA Profile String  : N/A
 Sub Profile String  : N/A
 App Profile String  : N/A
 ANCP String         : N/A
 Inter Destination Id: N/A
===============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" dhcp-unmatched-hosts
==============================================================================
Local User Database "database01" DHCP unmatched hosts
==============================================================================
Name                              Reason      Duplicate Host
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
host002                           No match    N/A                             
host003                           Duplicate   host001                         
host004                           No match    N/A                             
host005                           Duplicate   host001                         
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of DHCP Unmatched Hosts : 4
==============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" association
===============================================================================
DHCP Servers where database01 is used
===============================================================================
Server-Name                      Router-Name                                   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
dhcpS1                           vprn1000                                      
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Server(s): 1
===============================================================================
Interfaces where database01 is used for authentication
===============================================================================
Interface-Name                   Service-Id Type                               
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Interface(s): 0
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" association dhcp
===============================================================================
DHCP Servers where database01 is used
===============================================================================
Server-Name                      Router-Name                                   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
dhcpS1                           vprn1000                                      
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Server(s): 1
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
===============================================================================
 
# show subscriber-mgmt local-user-db "ludb-1" association ipoe
===============================================================================
IPoE client interface associations for ludb-1
===============================================================================
Interface-Name                           Svc-Id     Type
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
group-int-1-1                            1000       IES
group-int-1-1                            2000       VPRN
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Interface(s): 2
===============================================================================
===============================================================================
Capture SAP associations for ludb-1
===============================================================================
SAP                              Svc-Id     Type   PPPoE PPP IPoE DHCP DHCP6 RS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4:1202.*                     10         VPLS   y         y    y    y     y
1/1/4:*.*                        10         VPLS   y         y    y    y     y
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of SAP(s): 2
===============================================================================
 

msap-policy

Syntax 
msap-policy [msap-policy-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays Managed SAP policy information.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Displays information about the specifies MSAP policy
association—
Displays information related to the specifies MSAP policy
Output 

The following output is an example of managed SAP policy information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# msap-policy
===============================================================================
Managed SAP Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Num    Description
                                 MSAPs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
test                             0      (Not Specified)
test 1                           0      (Not Specified)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of MSAP Policies : 2
Number of MSAPs         : 0
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 

pcc-rule

Syntax 
pcc-rule
pcc-rule monitoring-key key detail
pcc-rule rule-id id detail
pcc-rule rule-name rule-name
pcc-rule rule-name rule-name detail
pcc-rule summary
pcc-rule monitoring-key key
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays a list of pcc-rules and associated monitoring keys in the system.

Parameters 
key
Displays details about a specific monitoring-key
id
Displays details about a specific pcc-rule
rule-name
Displays information about a specific pcc-rule
summary—
Displays summarized information for a active rules in the system
key
Displays information about a specific monitoring-key
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management PCC rule information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule summary 
===============================================================================
PCC Rules Summary
===============================================================================
Nbr Active PCC Rules    : 26 / 1023
Nbr Active Combinations
  IPv4 Filter           : 2 / 4095
  IPv6 Filter           : 0 / 4095
  Egress Qos            : 1 / 4095
  Ingress Qos           : 1 / 4095
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule 
===============================================================================
                       Id      Dir  ForwardAction         QosAction
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
name      : RULE_egress_FC
monitorKey: -
                       29      egr  -                      fc
name      : RULE_egress_UM
monitorKey: um_RULE_egress_UM
                       34      egr  -                      monitor
name      : RULE_ingress_FC
monitorKey: -
                       37      ingr -                      fc
name      : RULE_ingress_UM
monitorKey: um_RULE_ingress_UM
                       50      ingr -                      monitor
name      : RULE_egress_DROP
monitorKey: -
                       28      egr  drop                  -
name      : RULE_ingress_RDR
monitorKey: -
                       49      ingr fwd nh4               -
name      : RULE_egress_UM_FC
monitorKey: um_RULE_egress_UM_FC
                       35      egr  -                      fc monitor
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule rule-name "RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR" detail 
===============================================================================
PCC Rules
===============================================================================
PCC rule name         : RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
PCC rule id           : 47
Monitoring key        : um_RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
Flow status           : Enabled
Nbr of Flows          : 1 (ingress)
HTTP-Redirect         : -
Next-Hop Redir. IPv4  : 10.10.10.10
Next-Hop Redir. IPv6  : -
QoS Ingr. CIR/PIR     : 1000 kbps / 2000 kbps
QoS Egr. CIR/PIR      : - / -
FC change             : h2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Flows
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Src. IP  : any                                    Src. Port: -
Dst. IP  : 75.24.24.17/32                         Dst. Port: -
Protocol : 6                                      DSCP     : cp60
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
 
 
show service active-subscribers pcc-rule subscriber "1/1/3:1.1|00:00:00:00:00:01" 
===============================================================================
Active Subscribers
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber 1/1/3:1.1|00:00:00:00:00:01 (subprof1)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(1) SLA Profile Instance sap:1/1/3:1.1 - sla:sla1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingr Qos Policy Override : 3:P2
Egr  Qos Policy Override : 2:P2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IP Address
                MAC Address       PPPoE-SID Origin
--------------------------------------------------------
22.1.0.1
                00:00:00:00:00:01 N/A       DHCP
--------------------------------------------------------
Ingr Filter Override : 5:P4
Egr  Filter Override : 6:P5
========================================================
Preference Rule Id   Rule Name
--------------------------------------------------------
0          28        RULE_egress_DROP
0          29        RULE_egress_FC
0          30        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT
0          31        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_FC
0          32        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_UM
0          33        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC
0          34        RULE_egress_UM
0          35        RULE_egress_UM_FC
0          36        RULE_ingress_DROP
0          37        RULE_ingress_FC
0          38        RULE_ingress_FC_HTTP
0          39        RULE_ingress_FC_RDR
0          40        RULE_ingress_HTTP
0          41        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT
0          42        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_FC
0          43        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_FC_RDR
0          44        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_RDR
0          45        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM
0          46        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC
0          47        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
0          48        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_RDR
0          49        RULE_ingress_RDR
0          50        RULE_ingress_UM
0          51        RULE_ingress_UM_FC
0          52        RULE_ingress_UM_FC_RDR
0          53        RULE_ingress_UM_RDR
========================================================
 
 

radius-accounting-policy

Syntax 
radius-accounting-policy name association
radius-accounting-policy [name]
radius-accounting-policy name statistics
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays RADIUS accounting policy information.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the RADIUS accounting policy name
association—
Displays parameters associated with this RADIUS accounting policy
statistics—
Displays statistics associated with this RADIUS accounting policy
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management RADIUS accounting policy information.

Sample Output
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show subscriber-mgmt radius-accounting-policy "ZiggoAcct1813" 
statistics 
===============================================================================
Radius Accounting Policy ZiggoAcct1813 Statistics
===============================================================================
Tx Requests      : 36035966           Rx Responses  : 36035966
Request Timeouts : 0                  Send Retries  : 2713
Send Failed      : 0                  
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Servers
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Index IP Address      Tx Reqs     Rx Resps    Req Timeouts Req Send Failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     172.18.129.36   9012635     9011762     873          0
2     172.18.129.37   9004736     9003814     922          0
3     172.18.129.68   9010236     9009925     311          0
4     172.18.129.69   9011115     9010465     650          0
===============================================================================
Table 93:  Subscriber RADIUS Accounting Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Tx Requests/TX Reqs

Displays the number of accounting requests transmitted for this policy.

Rx Responses/Rx Resps

Displays the number of accounting responses received for this policy.

Request Timeouts/Req Timeouts

Displays the number of accounting requests which have timed out for this policy.

Send Retries

Displays the number of retries to a different server for a single accounting request for this policy.

Send Failed

Req Send Failed

Displays how many accounting requests failed because the packet could not be sent out for this policy.

Radius Servers

Displays a table in which the statistics associated with this RADIUS accounting policy are broken down by individual RADIUS server.

The table columns are:

Index—displays the index number assigned to the RADIUS server. The index determines the sequence in which the servers are queried for authentication requests. Servers are queried in order from lowest to highest index.

IP Address—the address of the RADIUS server.

TX Reqs—see TX Requests in this table.

Rx Resps—see RX Responses in this table.

Req Timeouts—see Request Timeouts in this table.

Req Send Failed—see Send Failed in this table.

sla-profile

Syntax 
sla-profile [sla-profile-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays SLA profile information.

Parameters 
sla-profile-name—
Specifies an existing SLA profile name
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sla-profile-name.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management SLA profile information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile
===============================================================================
SLA Profiles
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sla_default
sla_prof100_VOIP
sla_prof110_VOIP
sla_prof120_VOIP
sla_prof130_VOIP
sla_prof140_VOIP
sla_prof230_VOIP
sla_prof80
sla_prof80_VOIP
sla_prof81_VOIP
sla_prof90_VOIP
sla_profPC1
sla_profPC2
sla_profPC3
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of SLA Profiles : 14
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A# 
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile sla_prof100_VOIP
===============================================================================
SLA Profile sla_prof100_VOIP
===============================================================================
Host Limit           : 3 (Remove Oldest)
Ingress Qos-Policy   : 100                    Egress Qos-Policy : 100
Ingress Queuing Type : Service-queuing
Ingress Filter-Id    : N/A                    Egress Filter-Id  : N/A
Last Mgmt Change     : 07/10/2006 12:55:33
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Queue Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Rate      CIR       HiPrio  CBS     MBS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2     4000      -         -       -       -
3     2500      -         -       -       -
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Queue Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Rate      CIR       HiPrio  CBS     MBS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2     4000      -         -       -       -
3     2500      -         -       -       -
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile sla_prof100_VOIP association
===============================================================================
SLA Profile sla_prof100_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Default-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Static Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Non-Sub-Traffic-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Ident-Policy Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-name : sub_ident_all
 - Key : sla_prof100_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Explicit Subscriber Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

sla-profile

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Displays information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Displays information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Displays information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler stats information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber "sub1" sla-profile "sla-profile.1" sap 1/1/1:1 scheduler 
 
"session-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
Egress Schedulers
 
session-sched                      0                      0
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

port

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
Description 

This command displays the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port port-id
Displays information for the specified port
vport name
Displays information for the specified Vport
scheduler scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
detail —
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler hierarchy information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-hierarchy port 1/1/1 vport "dslam1" scheduler "dslam-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Port 1/1/1
===============================================================================
Scheduler-policy dslam-sched-pol
| slot(1)
|--(S) : subscriber-sched (VPort dslam1 1/1/1)
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->1
|   |   |
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->1
|   |   |
|
|--(S) : subscriber-sched (VPort dslam1 1/1/1)
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->1
|   |   |
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->1
|   |   |
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

vport

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the Vport scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port-id
Displays information for the specified port
name
Displays information for the specified Vport
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-stats port 1/1/1 vport "dslam1" scheduler "dslam-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Schedulers
 
dslam-sched                        0                      0
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

statistics

Syntax 
statistics iom (slot | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics mda (mda | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics port (port-id | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics pw-port (pw-port | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics sla-profiles
statistics sub-profiles
statistics system [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays enhanced subscriber management statistics per port, PW port, MDA, IOM, or system.

For each statistic, there is current value and peak value. Peak value is the highest value since the last reset as a result of a system boot or the clear subscriber-mgmt peakvalue-stats command.

Note:

The peak values can be reset using the clear subscriber-mgmt peakvalue-stats command.

Parameters 
iom slot
Displays specified IOM slot information.
mda mda
Displays specified slot/mda information.
port port-id
Specifies to display information for both the physical port ID and LAG.
pw-port pw-port
Specifies to display information for a pseudowire port ID.
Values—
1 to 10239

 

all—
displays statistics of all IOM or MDA or port or pseudowire port in the system
host—
Displays v4/v6 host statistics only.
session—
Displays PPPoX/LAC/LNS session statistics only.
sla-profiles—
Displays the current and historical statistics for SLA profiles.
sub-profiles—
Displays the current and historical statistics for subscriber profiles.
subscriber—
Displays subscriber statistics only.
summary—
Displays summary statistics only.
non-zero-value-only—
Displays only non-zero value counters.

The following tables describe the counters available in the show subscriber management statistics command output.

The following terminology is used to indicate applicability of the stats:

  1. ESM — Enhanced Subscriber Management. Subscriber traffic forwarded via subscriber queues. Enabled with SAP sub-sla-mgmt in no shutdown state
  2. BSM — Basic Subscriber Management. Subscriber traffic forwarded via SAP queues. SAP sub-sla-mgmt must be in shutdown state. For DHCP, dhcp lease-populate or dhcp6-relay lease-populate must be enabled to count the leases. For IPv4, if anti-spoof is enabled on the SAP, a subscriber host is instantiated.
  3. Routed CO — IES or VPRN service with subscriber interface and group interface constructs
  4. Bridged CO — VPLS service with DHCPv4 lease management enabled (lease-populate)
  5. regular interface — IES or VPRN interface (none subscriber-interface or group-interface)
  6. Host (also subscriber host) — A resource in the system that is used for traffic forwarding and security related actions. The creation of a subscriber host entry is linked to anti-spoof being enabled on a SAP. For ESM, anti-spoof is mandatory and hence every connected {IP/MAC} consumes by default a subscriber host entry. A DHCP6 IA-PD can also be modeled as a managed route. In this case, no subscriber host is instantiated. For BSM, anti-spoof is optional on regular interfaces. An IPv4 static-host and DHCPv4 lease do not result in a subscriber host instantiation when anti-spoof is disabled on the SAP.
    Table 94:  Host And Protocol Statistics  

    Section

    Counter

    Counts

    Applies to

    IPv4

    1. PPP Hosts - IPCP

    IPv4 local terminated PPP hosts (PTA, LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    2. IPOE Hosts - DHCP

    DHCPv4 hosts (lease states)

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    3. IPOE Hosts - ARP

    ARP hosts

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    4. IPOE Hosts – Static

    IPv4 static hosts

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    5. IPOE Hosts BSM - DHCP

    DHCPv4 hosts (lease states: anti-spoof and lease-populate enabled)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    6. IPOE Hosts BSM – Static

    IPv4 static hosts (with anti-spoof enabled)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    7. IPOE BSM - DHCP

    DHCPv4 lease states (with lease-populate enabled, no anti-spoof)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    8. IPOE BSM – Static

    IPv4 static hosts (no anti-spoof)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    IPv6

    PPP Hosts – SLAAC

    Local terminated IPv6 wan-host – SLAAC (PTA, LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Hosts - DHCP6 (PD)

    Local terminated IPv6 pd-host (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-PD leases over PPP (excluding PD as managed route)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Hosts - DHCP6 (NA)

    Local terminated IPv6 wan-host (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-NA leases over PPP

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Mngd Rt - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-PD leases over PPP (PD as managed route only)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – SLAAC

    IPv6 wan-host – SLAAC

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 pd-host – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (excluding PD as managed route)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts - DHCP6 (NA)

    IPv6 wan-host – DHCP6 IA-NA leases

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Mngd Rt - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (PD as managed route only)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – Static (PD)

    IPv6 static hosts with prefix-length shorter than /128

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – Static (WAN)

    IPv6 static hosts with prefix-length equal to /128

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE BSM - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (lease-populate)

    BSM, regular interface

    IPOE BSM - DHCP6 (NA)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-NA leases (lease-populate)

    BSM, regular interface

    Total

    PPP Hosts

    Local terminated PPP hosts (PTA, LNS)

    Sum of counters 1, 9, 10 and 11

    ESM

    IPOE Hosts

    Total IPv4 and IPv6 IPOE hosts.

    Sum of counters 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 13, 14, 15, 17 and 18

    ESM

    IPv4 Hosts

    Total IPv4 hosts. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6

    ESM

    IPv6 Hosts

    Total IPv6 hosts. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17 and 18

    ESM

    IPv6 PD Mngd Routes

    Total DHCP6 IA-PD leases modeled as a managed route. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 12 and 16

    ESM

    L2TP LAC Hosts

    L2TP LAC hosts – single host per single or dual stack PPP session.

    Counter also increases for outgoing LTS sessions.

    ESM, Routed CO

    Internal Hosts

    Subscriber hosts for internal use. For example: LNS redirect hosts (for LTS, an LNS redirect host is also instantiated).

    ESM

    Total (Cont)

    Non-Sub-Traffic L2-Hosts

    Host on a single subscriber SAP in a VPLS service that enables non-IP traffic to be forwarded using the specified SLA profile instance queues.

    Host on a single subscriber SAP attached to an IES/VPRN group-interface that enables traffic normally forwarded via the SAP queues to flow via the specified SLA profile instance queues.

    configure service vpls <service-id> sap <sap-id> sub-sla-mgmt single-sub-parameters non-sub-traffic sub-profile <sub-profile-name> sla-profile <sla-profile-name> [subscriber <sub-ident-string>] [app-profile <app-profile-name>]

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    DHCP leases

    Total number of DHCPv4 lease states.

    Sum of counters 2, 5 and 7

    ESM, BSM

    DHCPv6 leases

    Total number of DHCPv6 lease states.

    Sum of counters 10, 11, 12, 14, 15, 16, 19 and 20

    ESM, BSM

    Subscriber Hosts

    Counter displayed in the output of “show subscriber-mgmt statistics iom | mda | port | pw-port”

    This counter matches the number of hosts accounted for in the per line card limit

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18 and 26

    ESM

    Total (Cont)

    System Hosts Scale

    Counter displayed in the output of “show subscriber-mgmt statistics system”

    This counter matches the number of hosts accounted for in the system wide limit

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, 26 and 27

    ESM

    Table 95:  PPP Session Statistics 

    Section

    Counter

    Counts

    Applies to

    Local

    PPP Sessions - PPPoE

    Local terminated PPPoE sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoEoA

    Local terminated PPPoEoA sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    .PPP Sessions - PPPoA

    Local terminated PPPoA sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - L2TP (LNS)

    Local terminated PPP sessions (L2TP LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    LAC

    PPP Sessions - PPPoE

    Tunneled PPPoE session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoEoA

    Tunneled PPPoEoA session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoA

    Tunneled PPPoA session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - L2TP (LTS)

    Tunneled PPP session (L2TP LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    Total

    PPP Sessions - established

    PPP sessions that are established (at least one active host attached) – PTA/LAC/LTS/LNS

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - in setup

    PPP sessions in setup (session created, host setup in progress) – PTA/LAC/LTS/LNS

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - local

    Local terminated PPPoX sessions (PTA, L2TP LNS)

    Sum of counters 33, 34, 35 and 36

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - LAC

    Tunneled PPPoX session (L2TP LAC, L2TP LTS)

    Sum of counters 37, 38, 39 and 40

    ESM, Routed CO

    L2TP

    L2TP Tunnels - originator

    Number of L2TP Tunnels originated on this node. (LAC/ LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    .L2TP Tunnels - receiver

    Number of L2TP Tunnels terminated on this node. (LNS/LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    Total L2TP Tunnels

    Number of L2TP Tunnels originated or terminated on this node

    Sum of counters 45 and 46

    ESM, Routed CO

Table 96:  IPoE Session Statistics 

Section

Counter

Counts

Applies to

Total

IPOE Sessions - established

IPoE sessions that are established (at least one active host attached).

ESM, Routed CO

IPOE Sessions- in setup

IPoE sessions in setup (session created, host setup in progress).

ESM, Routed CO

Table 97:  Subscriber Statistics 

Section

Counter

Counts

Applies to

Total

Subscribers

Total number of active subscribers.

ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

Table 98:  SubMgmt Statistics Summary 

Section

Counter

Counts

Hosts

IPv4

IPv6

Total IPv4 hosts (counter 23 in tables above)

Total IPv6 hosts (counter 24 in tables above)

Sessions

PPP

IPOE

Total PPP sessions - established (counter 41 in tables above)

Total IPOE sessions – established (counter 48 in tables above)

Subscribers

Total number of active subscribers (counter 50 in tables above)

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management system statistics.

Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics system
===============================================================================
Subscriber Management Statistics for System
===============================================================================
       Type                               Current      Peak      Peak Timestamp
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Host & Protocol Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPv4   PPP Hosts      - IPCP                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP                    0         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       IPOE Hosts     - ARP                     1         1 02/28/2015 13:46:10
       IPOE Hosts     - Static                  0         0
       IPOE Hosts BSM - DHCP                    0         0
       IPOE Hosts BSM - Static                  0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP                    0         0
       IPOE BSM       - Static                  0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPv6   PPP Hosts      - SLAAC                   0         0
       PPP Hosts      - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       PPP Hosts      - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
       PPP Mngd Rt    - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - SLAAC                   0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
       IPOE Mngd Rt   - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - Static (PD)             0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - Static (WAN)            0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  PPP Hosts                                1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPOE Hosts                               1         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       IPv4 Hosts                               2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPv6 Hosts                               0         0
       IPv6 PD Mngd Routes                      0         0
       L2TP LAC Hosts                           0         0
       Internal Hosts                           0         0
       Non-Sub-Traffic L2-Hosts                 0         0
       DHCP Leases                              0         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       DHCPv6 Leases                            0         0
       System Hosts Scale                       2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PPP Session Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local  PPP Sessions  - PPPoE                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoEoA                  0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoA                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - L2TP (LNS)               0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
LAC    PPP Sessions  - PPPoE                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoEoA                  0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoA                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - L2TP (LTS)               0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  PPP Sessions  - established              1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - in setup                 0         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - local                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - LAC                      0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
L2TP   L2TP Tunnels  - originator               0         0
       L2TP Tunnels  - receiver                 0         0
       Total L2TP Tunnels                       0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPOE Session Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  IPOE Sessions - established              0         0
       IPOE Sessions - in setup                 0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  Subscribers                              2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
Peak values last reset at : n/a
 
Sample Output (summary view)
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics port 1/1/4 summary
===============================================================================
SubMgmt Statistics
===============================================================================
                 |       Hosts        |      Sessions      |    Subscribers
Port Id          |   IPv4      IPv6   |    PPP      IPOE   |
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4            |        2         2 |        1         1 |        2   (Curr)
                 |        3         3 |        1         2 |        3   (Peak)
===============================================================================
 
Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics sla-profiles
===============================================================================
SLA Profile Statistics
===============================================================================
SLA-Profile Name                        Current       Peak       Peak Timestamp 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
tv-prof                                       0          0 
hsi-prof                                      1          1  12/29/2016 15:50:50
hsi-iptv--prof                                0          0 
no-prof-1                                     1          1  01/03/2017 20:00:37
hsi-voip-prof                                 0          2  12/29/2016 18:42:44
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                         2
===============================================================================
 
Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics sub-profiles
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile Statistics
===============================================================================
Subscriber-Profile Name                  Current       Peak       Peak Timestamp
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
no-prof                                        2          3  12/29/2016 18:42:44
sub-10M                                        0          0
sub-10M-UPNP                                   0          0
sub-20M                                        0          0
sub-20M-UPNP                                   0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                          2
===============================================================================
 

steering-profile

Syntax 
steering-profile steering-profile-name
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays steering profile information.

Parameters 
steering-profile-name—
Specifies an existing steering profile name.

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
sub-ident-policy [sub-ident-policy-name [association]]
sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name script {primary | secondary | tertiary}
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber identification policy information.

Parameters 
sub-ident-policy-name—
Specifies an existing subscriber identification policy name
association—
Displays information configured with the specified sub-ident-policy-name
script {primary | secondary | tertiary}—
Displays information for the specified identification script
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management subscriber identification policy information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_ident_all
sub_ident_pc
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Subscriber Identification Policies : 2
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Sub Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              Sub profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_prof100                      sub_prof100
sub_prof110                      sub_prof110
sub_prof120                      sub_prof120
sub_prof130                      sub_prof130
sub_prof140                      sub_prof140
sub_prof230                      sub_prof230
sub_prof80                       sub_prof80
sub_prof81                       sub_prof81
sub_prof90                       sub_prof90
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              SLA profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sla_prof100_VOIP                 sla_prof100_VOIP
sla_prof110_VOIP                 sla_prof110_VOIP
sla_prof120_VOIP                 sla_prof120_VOIP
sla_prof130_VOIP                 sla_prof130_VOIP
sla_prof140_VOIP                 sla_prof140_VOIP
sla_prof230_VOIP                 sla_prof230_VOIP
sla_prof80_VOIP                  sla_prof80_VOIP
sla_prof81_VOIP                  sla_prof81_VOIP
sla_prof90_VOIP                  sla_prof90_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Python Scripts
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
#         Admin Oper  Script
          State State Name
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Primary   Down  Down  pyTom.py
Secondary Up    Up    pyTomDebug.py
Tertiary  Up    Up    hardcoded.py
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all association
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 80 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80
Service-Id : 90 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:90
Service-Id : 100 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:100
 - SAP : 1/2/1:101
 - SAP : 1/2/1:102
Service-Id : 110 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:110
 - SAP : 1/2/1:111
 - SAP : 1/2/1:112
Service-Id : 120 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:120
 - SAP : 1/2/1:121
 - SAP : 1/2/1:122
Service-Id : 130 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:130
Service-Id : 140 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:140
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script primary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Primary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/pyTom.py
Admin State : Down                      Oper State : Down
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Script is not active.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script secondary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Secondary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/pyTomDebug.py
Admin State : Up                        Oper State : Up
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      1 import alc
      2 yiaddr = alc.dhcp.yiaddr
      3 # Subscriber ID equals full client IP address.
      4 # Note: IP address 10.10.10.10 yields 'sub-168430090'
      5 # and not 'sub-10.10.10.10'
      6 alc.dhcp.sub_ident = 'sub-' + str(yiaddr)
      7 # DHCP server is configured such that the third byte (field) of the IP
      8 # address indicates the session Profile ID.
      9 alc.dhcp.sla_profile = 'sp-' + str((yiaddr & 0x0000FF00) >> 8)
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script tertiary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Tertiary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/hardcoded.py
Admin State : Up                        Oper State : Up
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      1 from alc import dhcp
      2
      3 dhcp.sub_ident = 'sub_ident_A_1'
      4 dhcp.sub_profile_string = 'sub_prof_B_2'
      5 dhcp.sla_profile_string = 'sla_prof_C_3'
      6
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt#

sub-profile

Syntax 
sub-profile [sub-profile-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber profile information.

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Specifies an existing subscriber profile name
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sub-profile-name
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber profile information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profiles
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_default
sub_prof100
sub_prof110
sub_prof120
sub_prof130
sub_prof140
sub_prof230
sub_prof80
sub_prof81
sub_prof90
sub_profPC1
sub_profPC2
sub_profPC3
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Subscriber Profiles : 13
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile sub_prof100
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile sub_prof100
===============================================================================
I. Sched. Policy : service100
E. Sched. Policy : service100
Acct. Policy     : 1                                Collect Stats : Enabled
Last Mgmt Change : 07/10/2006 12:55:33
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Scheduler Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Scheduler                        Rate      CIR
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv100                          8000      sum
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Scheduler Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Scheduler                        Rate      CIR
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv100                          8000      sum
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              SLA Profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No mappings configured.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile sub_prof100 association
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile sub_prof100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Default-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Static Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Non-Sub-Traffic-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Ident-Policy Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-name : sub_ident_all
 - Key : sub_prof100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Explicit Subscriber Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

pw-port

Syntax 
pw-port [pw-port-id] [detail]
pw-port sdp sdp-id
pw-port sdp none
Context 
show>pw-port
Description 

Displays pseudo-wire port information.

If no optional parameters are specified, the command displays a summary of all defined PW ports. The optional parameters restrict output to only ports matching the specified properties.

Parameters 
pw-port-id
Specifies the pseudo-wire port identifier
Values—
1 to 10239

 

detail—
Displays detailed port information that includes all the pw-port output fields
sdp-id
The SDP ID for which to display matching PW port information
Values—
1 to 17407

 

Output 

The following output is an example of PW port information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1         dot1q          1          1526726657          1
2         qinq           1          1526726658          2
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
4         qinq           1          1526726660          4
============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port 3
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port 3 detail
===============================================================================
PW Port Information
===============================================================================
PW Port            : 3
Encap              : dot1q
SDP                : 1
IfIndex            : 1526726659
VC-Id              : 3
Description        : 1-Gig Ethernet dual fiber
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>config>pw-port$ show pw-port sdp none
 
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
5         dot1q                     1526726661
============================================================================
 
 
*A:ALA-48>config>pw-port$ show pw-port sdp 1
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1         dot1q          1          1526726657          1
2         qinq           1          1526726658          2
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
4         qinq           1          1526726660          4
============================================================================
 

The following table describes show pw-port output fields:

Table 99:  Subscriber Show PW-Port Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

PW Port

The PW port identifier.

Encap

The encapsulation type of the PW port.

SDP

The SDP identifier.

IfIndex

The interface index used for the PW port.

VC-Id

The Virtual Circuit identifier.

Description

The description string for the PW port.

port-scheduler-policy

Syntax 
port-scheduler-policy [port-scheduler-policy-name] [association]
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name network-policy network-queue-policy-name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name sap-egress policy-id
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name sap-egress policy-id
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays scheduler policy information.

Parameters 
port-scheduler-policy-name—
Specifies an existing port scheduler policy name
network-queue-policy-name—
Specifies an existing network queue policy name
policy-id—
Specifies an existing SAP egress policy ID
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS port scheduler policy information.

Sample Output
A:NS072860910>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# info
----------------------------------------------
            max-rate 10000
            group "group1" create
                rate 3000 cir 1000
            exit
            group "group2" create
                rate 2000 cir 500
            exit
            level 7 rate 7000 cir 700 group "group1" weight 3
            level 6 rate 6000 cir 600 group "group1" weight 2
            level 5 rate 5000 cir 500 group "group1" weight 1
            level 2 rate 2000 cir 200 group "group2" weight 2
            level 1 rate 1000 cir 100 group "group2" weight 1
----------------------------------------------
 
A:NS072860910# show qos scheduler-hierarchy port 5/1/2 vport "fred"
========================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Port 5/1/2, Vport "fred"
========================================================================
Port-scheduler-policy psp1
    Port Bandwidth : 1000000    Max Rate : 10000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Within CIR Level 8]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->1
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->1
 
[Within CIR Group "group1"]
    Rate     : 1000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Within CIR Level 7]
        Weight   : 3
        Rate     : 700
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->2
 
    [Within CIR Level 6]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 600
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->3
 
    [Within CIR Level 5]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 500
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->4
 
[Within CIR Level 4]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Within CIR Level 3]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->5
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->5
 
[Within CIR Group "group2"]
    Rate : 500
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Within CIR Level 2]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 200
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->6
 
    [Within CIR Level 1]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 200
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->7
 
[Within CIR Level 0]
    Rate     : 0
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->8
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->8
 
[Above CIR Level 8]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Group "group1"]
    Rate     : 3000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 7]
        Weight   : 3
        Rate     : 7000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 6]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 6000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 5]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 5000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Level 4]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Level 3]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Group "group2"]
    Rate     : 2000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 2]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 2000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 1]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 1000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->1
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->5
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->8
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->1
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->5
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->8
========================================================================
A:NS072860910# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp"
========================================================================
QoS Port Scheduler Policy
========================================================================
Policy-Name       : psp                 
Description       : (Not Specified)
Max Rate          : max                 Last changed      : 04/15/2010 00:37:02
Group             : 1                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 2                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 3                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 4                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Lvl1 PIR          : max                 Lvl1 CIR          : max
Lvl1 Group        : 1                   Lvl1 Grp Weight   : 10
 
Lvl2 PIR          : max                 Lvl2 CIR          : max
Lvl2 Group        : 1                   Lvl2 Grp Weight   : 20
 
Lvl3 PIR          : max                 Lvl3 CIR          : max
Lvl3 Group        : 2                   Lvl3 Grp Weight   : 30
 
Lvl4 PIR          : max                 Lvl4 CIR          : max
Lvl4 Group        : 2                   Lvl4 Grp Weight   : 40
 
Lvl5 PIR          : max                 Lvl5 CIR          : max
Lvl5 Group        : 3                   Lvl5 Grp Weight   : 50
 
Lvl6 PIR          : max                 Lvl6 CIR          : max
Lvl6 Group        : 3                   Lvl6 Grp Weight   : 60
 
Lvl7 PIR          : max                 Lvl7 CIR          : max
Lvl7 Group        : 4                   Lvl7 Grp Weight   : 70
 
Lvl8 PIR          : max                 Lvl8 CIR          : max
Lvl8 Group        : 4                   Lvl8 Grp Weight   : 80
 
Orphan Lvl        : default             Orphan Weight     : default
Orphan CIR-Lvl    : default             Orphan CIR-Weight : default
========================================================================
*A:Bennet-Dut-A>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp" association 
========================================================================
QoS Port Scheduler Policy
========================================================================
Policy-Name       : psp                 
Description       : (Not Specified)
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
------------------------------------------------------------------------
 - Port : 1/1/2 VPort : vp1
========================================================================
*A:B-Dut-A# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp" sap-egress 1000
========================================================================
Compatibility : Port-scheduler Policy psp & Sap Egress Queue 1000
========================================================================
Orphan Queues :
 
None Found
 
Hierarchy     :
 
Root
|
|---(Q) : 1    
|
|---(Q) : 2    
|
|---(Q) : 3    
|
|---(Q) : 4    
|
|---(Q) : 5    
|
|---(Q) : 6                           
|
|---(Q) : 7    
|
|---(Q) : 8    
========================================================================
*A:B-Dut-A# 
 

sap-egress

Syntax 
sap-egress [policy-id] [association | detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays SAP egress policy information.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Displays information for the specified SAP egress policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sap-egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of Qos SAP egress information.

Sample Output
*A:Dut-A# show qos sap-egress
===============================================================================
Sap Egress Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id  Scope     Name                     Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1          Template  default                  Default SAP egress QoS policy.
30         Template                           1 video channel, 1 BE
31         Template                           1 video EF, 2xvideo AF, 1 BE
80         Template                           Limit outgoing 80
100        Template                           User100
110        Template                           User110
120        Template                           User120
130        Template                           User130
140        Template                           User140
901        Template                           User90_1
902        Template                           User90_2
903        Template                           User90_3
904        Template                           User90_4
905        Template                           User90_5
1000       Template                           Service all
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Policies : 15
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-egress 31 detail
===============================================================================
QoS Sap Egress
===============================================================================
Sap Scheduler Policy (31)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-id      : 31                           Scope        : Template
Description    : 1 video EF, 2xvideo AF, 1 BE
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue         CIR Admin PIR Admin CBS     HiPrio  PIR Lvl/Wt    Parent
              CIR Rule  PIR Rule  MBS             CIR Lvl/Wt
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1             0         max       def     def     1/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
2             0         max       def     def     2/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
3             0         max       def     def     3/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC Name               Queue-id    Explicit/Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be                    1           Explicit (0)
af                    2           Explicit (0)
ef                    3           Explicit (0)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 23 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 1
 - SAP : 1/2/2:4000
Service-Id     : 30 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : lag-1
 - SAP : lag-2:5
Service-Id     : 31 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : 1/2/1:31
SLA Profiles :
 - sla_profPC1                      override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Mirror SAPs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Mirror SAPs Found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

sap-ingress

Syntax 
sap-ingress [policy-id] [association | match-criteria | detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays SAP ingress policy information.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Displays information for the specified SAP ingress policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sap-ingress policy
match-criteria—
Displays information about the matching criteria
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS SAP ingress information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-ingress
===============================================================================
Sap Ingress Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id  Scope     Name                     Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1          Template  default                  Default SAP ingress QoS policy.
80         Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
90         Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
100        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
110        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
120        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
130        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
140        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
901        Template                           User90_1
902        Template                           User90_2
903        Template                           User90_3
904        Template                           User90_4
905        Template                           User90_5
1000       Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for all s*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Policies : 14
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
* indicates that the corresponding row element may have been truncated.
*A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-ingress 80 detail
===============================================================================
QoS Sap Ingress
===============================================================================
Sap Ingress Policy (80)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-id      : 80                           Scope        : Template
Default FC     : be                           Priority     : Low
Criteria-type  : IP
Description    :  Dot1p mappings/service for service 80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Mode    CIR Admin PIR Admin CBS     HiPrio  PIR Lvl/Wt    Parent
              CIR Rule  PIR Rule  MBS             CIR Lvl/Wt
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     Prio    0         7000      def     def     1/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
2     Prio    0         3500      def     def     2/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
3     Prio    0         2000      def     def     3/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
11    Prio    0         max       def     def     1/1           None
              closest   closest   def             0/1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC                  UCastQ         MCastQ         BCastQ         UnknownQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be                  1              def            def            def
af                  2              def            def            def
ef                  3              def            def            def
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SubFC                              Profile        In-Remark      Out-Remark
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
af                                 None           None           None
be                                 None           None           None
ef                                 None           None           None
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Dot1p           FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
0               be                               Default
2               af                               Default
5               ef                               Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
DSCP            FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No DSCP-Map Entries Found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Prec Value      FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Prec-Map Entries Found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Match Criteria
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IP Match Criteria
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Entry          : 1
Source IP      : Undefined                    Source Port  : None
Dest. IP       : Undefined                    Dest. Port   : None
Protocol       : None                         DSCP         : None
Fragment       : Off
FC             : Default                      Priority     : Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 80 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 80
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80
 
SLA Profiles :
 - sla_prof80                       override
 - sla_prof80_VOIP                  override
 - sla_prof81_VOIP                  override
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

scheduler-hierarchy

Syntax 
scheduler-hierarchy
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command enters the context to display information about policies that use this scheduler.

customer

Syntax 
customer customer-id site customer-site-name [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the scheduler hierarchy per customer multi-service-site.

Parameters 
customer-id
Displays information for the specified customer ID
customer-site-name
Displays information for the specified multi-service customer
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
ingress—
Displays information for the ingress policy
egress—
Displays information for the egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information

sap

Syntax 
sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the scheduler stats per SAP.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
ingress—
Displays information for the ingress policy
egress—
Displays information for the egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
Description 

This command displays the scheduler hierarchy rooted at the SLA profile scheduler.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Displays information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Displays information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Displays information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
detail —
Displays detailed information
Note:

If the SLA profile scheduler is orphaned (that is when the scheduler has a parent which does not exist) then the hierarchy is only shown when the show command includes the sla-profile and sap parameters.

Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber "sub1" sla-profile "sla-profile.1" sap 1/1/1:1 scheduler "session-sched" 
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber sub1 SLA-Profile sla-profile.1 SAP 1/1/1:1
===============================================================================
Egress Scheduler Policy : session-sched-pol
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
session-sched (Egr)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->3
|
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->2
|
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->1
|
 
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber nokia_100 scheduler serv_all
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
serv_all (Ing)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:101->11 MCast
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->11 MCast
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->11 MCast
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->3
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 1/2
|   |
...
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber nokia_100 scheduler serv_all detail
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
Legend :
(U) - Unrestricted     (P) - Provisioned
(A) - Administrative   (O) - Operational
MIR - Measured Info Rate
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv_all (Ing)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:101->11 MCast
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:4            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):7000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):1000000      PIR (O):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :1280
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:256
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->11 MCast
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:4            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):7000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):1000000      PIR (O):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :1280
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:256
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->1
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:1            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :1687
|   |    PIR (P):1690         PIR (U):3510
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/1
|   |   |
|   |   |    PIR Lvl:1            PIR Wt :1
|   |   |    CIR Lvl:1            CIR Wt :1
|   |   |
|   |   |    MIR    :0
|   |   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):1830
|   |   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |   |
|   |   |    PIR (A):7000         PIR (O):1850
|   |   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :64
|   |   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:8
|   |
...
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->3
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:3            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):2000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):2000         PIR (O):2000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :64
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:8
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#

scheduler-name

Syntax 
scheduler-name scheduler-name
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays information about the specified scheduler name.

Parameters 
scheduler-name—
Displays information about the specified scheduler

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy [scheduler-policy-name] [association | sap-ingress policy-id | sap-egress policy-id]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays information about the specified scheduler policy.

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name—
Displays information for the specified scheduler policy
policy-id
Displays information for the ingress policy
policy-id
Displays information for the egress policy
association—
Displays the information currently configured with the specified scheduler-policy-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler policy information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy
===============================================================================
Sap Scheduler Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id                        Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
maximum_4000_1xEF_1xBE
maximum_8000_1xEF_2xAF_1xBE
multiservice-site
root
scheduler-7Mbps
service100
service110
service120
service130
service140
service80
service90
service_all
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy root association
===============================================================================
QoS Scheduler Policy
===============================================================================
Policy-Name    : root
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy association
===============================================================================
QoS Scheduler Policy
===============================================================================
Policy-Name    : maximum_4000_1xEF_1xBE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : maximum_8000_1xEF_2xAF_1xBE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 23 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 1
 - SAP : 1/3/2:4000 (Egr)
Service-Id     : 30 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : lag-1 (Egr)
 - SAP : lag-2:5 (Egr)
Policy-Name    : multiservice-site
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 90 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 90
 - SAP : 1/1/12:95 (Ing) (Egr) MSS : site1
 - SAP : 1/1/20:94 (Ing) (Egr) MSS : site1
 
 - Customer : 2         MSS : site1  (Ing) (Egr)
 - Customer : 90        MSS : site1  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : root
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : scheduler-7Mbps
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : service100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 100 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 100
 - SAP : 1/2/1:100 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:101 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:102 (Ing) (Egr)
 
 - Customer : 100       MSS : site100  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof100 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service110
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 110 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 110
 - SAP : 1/2/1:110 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:111 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:112 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof110 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service120
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 120 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 120
 - SAP : 1/2/1:120 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:121 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:122 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof120 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service130
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 130 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 130
 - SAP : 1/2/1:130 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof130 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service140
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 140 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 140
 - SAP : 1/2/1:140 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof140 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 80 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 80
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80 (Ing) (Egr)
 
 - Customer : 80        MSS : site80  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof80 (Ing) (Egr)
 - sub_prof81 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service90
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 90 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 90
 - SAP : 1/2/1:90 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof90 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service_all
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_default (Ing) (Egr)
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#

scheduler-stats

Syntax 
scheduler-stats
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command enters the context to display scheduler statistics information.

Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler stats information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Schedulers
root                               112777                 25218126
serv_all                           112777                 25218126
Egress Schedulers
root                               113781                 26008462
serv_all                           113781                 26008462
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber nokia_100 scheduler root
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Schedulers
root                               0                      0
Egress Schedulers
root                               0                      0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A# 

shared-queue

Syntax 
shared-queue [shared-queue-policy-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays shared policy information.

Parameters 
shared-queue-policy-name—
Specifies the name of a shared-queue
detail—
Displays detailed information about the shared queue policy
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS shared queue information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos shared-queue
===============================================================================
Shared Queue Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id                        Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
default                          Default Shared Queue Policy
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos shared-queue detail
===============================================================================
QoS Network Queue Policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Shared Queue Policy (default)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy         : default
Description    : Default Shared Queue Policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue CIR       PIR       CBS     MBS     HiPrio  Multipoint
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     0         100       1       50      10      FALSE
2     25        100       3       50      10      FALSE
3     25        100       10      50      10      FALSE
4     25        100       3       25      10      FALSE
5     100       100       10      50      10      FALSE
6     100       100       10      50      10      FALSE
7     10        100       3       25      10      FALSE
8     10        100       3       25      10      FALSE
9     0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
10    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
11    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
12    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
13    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
14    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
15    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
16    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
17    0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
18    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
19    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
20    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
21    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
22    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
23    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
24    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
25    0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
26    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
27    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
28    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
29    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
30    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
31    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
32    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC    UCastQ    MCastQ    BCastQ  UnknownQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be    1         9         17      25
l2    2         10        18      26
af    3         11        19      27
l1    4         12        20      28
h2    5         13        21      29
ef    6         14        22      30
h1    7         15        23      31
nc    8         16        24      32
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:101 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:102 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:103 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:104 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:105 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:106 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:107 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:108 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:109 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:110 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:111 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:112 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:113 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:114 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:115 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:116 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:117 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:118 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:119 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:120 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:121 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:122 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:123 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/5:279 (shared Q)
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

accu-stats

Syntax 
accu-stats subscriber subscriber-id
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command displays the accumulated statistics for both online and offline statistics.

Parameters 
subscriber-id—
Specifies the subscriber ID, to a maximum of 32 characters.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber statistics.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats subscriber home-1
===============================================================================
Subscriber accumulated statistics for “home-1”
===============================================================================
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber accumulated statistics ingress queue 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     packets                octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Offered high priority                0                      0        
Offered low priority                 0                      0        
Dropped high priority                0                      0    
Dropped low priority                 0                      0        
Forwarded in-profile                 0                      0   
Forwarded out-of-profile             0                      0   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber accumulated statistics egress queue 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     packets                octets
Forwarded in-profile                 0                      0   
Forwarded out-of-profile             0                      0   
Dropped in-profile                   0                      0   
Dropped out-of--profile              0                      0   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================

accu-stats-policy

Syntax 
accu-stats-policy
accu-stats-policy policy-name [associations]
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command displays the configuration of the accumulated statistics policy for the subscriber profile that referenced the accumulated statistics policy.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the policy name, to a maximum of 32 characters.
associations—
Lists the sub-profile that referenced the policy.
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management accumulated statistics information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-policy “accu-stats-policy-01”
===============================================================================
Subscriber accumulated statistics policy accu-stats-policy-01
===============================================================================
Description                          : (Not Specified)         
Last management change               : 09/23/2016 16:48:46
===============================================================================
 
===============================================================================
Entries
===============================================================================
Direction Type     Id
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ingress   queue    1     
egress    queue    1     
===============================================================================
Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-policy “accu-stats-policy-01” associations
===============================================================================
Subscriber profile associations
===============================================================================
no-prof                         
sub-prof
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
No. of subscriber profiles: 2
===============================================================================

accu-stats-subscribers

Syntax 
accu-stats-subscribers [subscriber sub-ident] [sub-profile name]
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command lists all subscribers on the system that had referenced an accumulated statistics policy. The list contains subscribers that are currently referencing an accu-stats-policy as well as subscribers that no longer reference an accu-stats-policy (due to removal of the policy from the subscriber profile).

Parameters 
sub-ident—
Specifies a specific subscriber ID, to a maximum of 32 characters.
sub-profile name
Lists all subscribers that are referencing the specified subscriber profile, to a maximum of 32 characters.
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management accumulated statistics information.

Sample Output
*DUT# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-subscribers    
===============================================================================
Subscribers with accumulated statistics
===============================================================================
Subscriber                            : home-1
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : accu-stats-policy-01
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber                            : home-2
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : accu-stats-policy-02
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber                            : twamp-host
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : (Unknown)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Subscribers with accumulated statistics: 3
===============================================================================
Sample Output

The show subscriber-mgmt status system command shows the number of subscribers using accumulated statistics and whether the statistics usage has reached the peak value.

*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt status system 
===============================================================================
Subscriber Management System Status
===============================================================================
Chassis 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Memory usage high                                       : No
DHCP message processing overload                        : No
Statistics usage high                                   : Yes
Number of subscribers using statistics                  : 131072
Data-trigger statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Packets received                                        : 0
Packets dropped                                         : 0
Packets in queue (actual)                               : 0
Packets in queue (peak)                                 : 0
Bridged Residential Gateway statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
BRG initialized                                         : 0
BRG operational                                         : 0
BRG in connectivity verification                        : 0
BRG on hold                                             : 0
BRG authenticated by proxy                              : 0
===============================================================================

ancp-policy

Syntax 
ancp-policy [policy-name]
Context 
show>subscriber-management
Description 

This command displays subscriber ANCP policy information.

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP policy information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy
===============================================================================
ANCP Policies
===============================================================================
adsl-operator1
vdsl-operator1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of ANCP policies : 2
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy adsl-operator1
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "adsl-operator1"
===============================================================================
I. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
I. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
I. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
I. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
I. Rate Modify         : scheduler "root"
 
E. Rate Reduction      : 10 kbps
E. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
E. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
E. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
E. Rate Modify         : scheduler "root"
Port Down : N/A
Last Mgmt Change: 01/26/2007 17:10:51
================================================================================
A:active#
 
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy adsl-operator1 association
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "adsl-operator1" associations 
===============================================================================
SAP Static Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- SAP     : 1/1/3                             Svc-id  : 333 (VPLS)
     String : "ANCP-String-1"
     String : "ANCP-String-2"
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MSS Static Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Cust-id : 1                                 MSS-name: mss1
     String : "ANCP-String-3"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
Number of associations : 3
===============================================================================
A:active#

ancp-string

Syntax 
ancp-string
ancp-string ancp-string
ancp-string customer customer-id site customer-site-name
ancp-string sap sap-id
Context 
show>subscriber-management
Description 

This command displays subscriber ANCP string information.

Parameters 
ancp-string—
Specify the ASCII representation of the DSLAM circuit-id name
customer-id
Specify the associated existing customer name
customer-site-name
Specify the associated customer’s configured MSS name
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management ANCP string information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string
===============================================================================
ANCP-Strings
===============================================================================
ANCP-String                                                Assoc State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
"ANCP-String-1"                                            SAP   Up
"ANCP-String-2"                                            SAP   Down
"ANCP-String-3"                                            MSS   Up
"ANCP-String-4"                                            MSS   Unknown
"ANCP-String-5"                                            ANCP  Up
"ANCP-String-6"                                            MSS   Unknown
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of ANCP-Strings : 6
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string hpolSub43
===============================================================================
ANCP-String "hpolSub43"
===============================================================================
Type       : SUB - "hpolSub43"
State      : Up                 Ancp Policy: ancpPol
I. Rate    : 100 kbps           E. Rate    : 200 kbps
Adj I. Rate: N/A                Adj E. Rate: 200 kbps
Act I. Rate: N/A                Act E. Rate: 182 kbps
Service Id : 1 (VPRN)
Group      : Alu
Neighbor   : 100.100.100.1:49063
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-C# 

Other applicable show command output:

A:active# show service id 333 sap 1/1/3 detail 
===============================================================================
Service Access Points(SAP)
===============================================================================
Service Id         : 333
SAP                : 1/1/3                    Encap             : null
...
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ANCP Override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ing Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 100 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-1"
Egr Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 100 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
...
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
 
A:active# show service customer 1 site mss1
===============================================================================
Customer  1
===============================================================================
Customer-ID        : 1
Description        : Default customer
...
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ANCP Override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egr Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 90 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-3"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service Association
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Service Association Found.
===============================================================================
A:active#

radius-proxy-server

Syntax 
radius-proxy-server server-name
radius-proxy-server server-name cache
radius-proxy-server server-name cache hex-key hex-string
radius-proxy-server server-name cache string-key string
radius-proxy-serverserver-name cache summary
radius-proxy-server server-name statistics
radius-proxy-server
Context 
show>router
Description 

This command displays RADIUS proxy server information.

Parameters 
server-name—
Specifies the default RADIUS proxy server name created in the config>router>radius-proxy context
cache—
Displays cached information
hex-string
Displays the hex key string
Values—
[0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (max 64 hex nibbles)]

 

string
Displays the packet type of the RADIUS messages to use to generate the key for the cache of this RADIUS proxy server
summary—
Displays summarized information
statistics—
Displays statistics for the specified RADIUS proxy server
Output 
Table 100:  Subscriber RADIUS Proxy Server Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Invalid response Authenticator Rx packet

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx Access-Request

Displays the number of Access-Request packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx Accounting-Request

Displays the number of Accounting-Request packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx dropped

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server but dropped.

Retransmit

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they are retransmitted.

Wrong purpose

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the value of tmnxRadProxSrvPurpose is set to a value not matching the type of packet.

No UE MAC to cache

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the UE MAC address was not present in the packet.

Client context limit reached

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the limit of client contexts was reached. For each RADIUS transaction a client context is created, and will be deleted once the transaction is finished.

No ISA RADIUS policy configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it has no ISA RADIUS server policy configured for that type of packet.

Server admin down

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it is administratively shut down.

No RADIUS policy configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it has no RADIUS server policy configured for that type of packet.

No load-balance-key configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the selected RADIUS server policy's algorithm is set to hashBased and no load balance key is configured.

Invalid length

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because their length was invalid.

Invalid Code field

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they had an invalid Code field.

Invalid attribute encoding

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because one of the attributes was incorrectly encoded.

Invalid User-Name

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid User-Name attribute.

Invalid password

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the User-Password attribute could not be decoded.

Invalid accounting Authenticator

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Authenticator field.

Invalid Message-Authenticator

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Message-Authenticator attribute.

Management core overload

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because the ISA management core is not able to process any new RADIUS requests because of overload.

No memory

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because there was not enough memory to store them.

Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Acct-Status-Type attribute.

Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained no Acct-Status-Type attribute.

Registered user overload

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because the registered user indicated to be in overload.

Dropped by Python

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server but dropped by Python.

Tx Access-Accept

Displays the number of Access-Accept packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Access-Reject

Displays the number of Access-Reject packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Access-Challenge

Displays the number of Access-Challenge packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Accounting-Response

Displays the number of Accounting-Response packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx dropped

Displays the number of packets dropped by this RADIUS proxy server before transmission.

No key to cache

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the key information was not present in the packet.

Cache key too long

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the key information present in the packet was too long.

Cache attributes too long

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the total length of the attributes is too long.

Reached maximum number of cache entries

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the limit has been reached.

No memory

Displays the number of packets that could not be transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server because there was not enough memory.

Server timeout

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS servers have timed out.

Server authentication failure

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet which failed authentication (invalid response Authenticator or Message Authenticator attribute).

Server invalid Code

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet with an invalid Code field.

Invalid attribute encoding

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet with an invalid attribute.

Registered user overload

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the registered user indicated to be in overload.

No RADIUS server configured

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the RADIUS server policy has no servers configured.

RADIUS server send failure

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the packet could not get transmitted to one of the servers in the RADIUS server policy.

Dropped by Python

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the packet was dropped by the Python script.

Invalid response Authenticator

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet which failed authentication

Sample Output
 
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show router radius-proxy-server "ZiggoRadiusProxyAnyCast" statistics
===============================================================================
RADIUS Proxy server statistics for "ZiggoRadiusProxyAnyCast"
===============================================================================
Rx packet                                                : 28454097
Rx Access-Request                                        : 24846521
Rx Accounting-Request                                    : 3607576
Rx dropped                                               : 22986
  Retransmit                                             : 22986
  Server admin down                                      : 0
  No RADIUS policy configured                            : 0
  No load-balance-key configured                         : 0
  Invalid length                                         : 0
  Invalid Code field                                     : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Invalid User-Name                                      : 0
  Invalid password                                       : 0
  Invalid accounting Authenticator                       : 0
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 0
  No memory                                              : 0
  Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type       : 0
  Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type            : 0
  Registered user overload                               : 0
  Dropped by Python                                      : 0
 
Tx Access-Accept                                         : 1929725
Tx Access-Reject                                         : 302354
Tx Access-Challenge                                      : 22598950
Tx Accounting-Response                                   : 3598730
Tx dropped                                               : 1351
  No key to cache                                        : 0
  Cache key too long                                     : 0
  Cache attributes too long                              : 0
  Reached maximum number of cache entries                : 0
  No memory                                              : 0
  Server timeout                                         : 1351
  Server authentication failure                          : 0
  Server invalid Code                                    : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Registered user overload                               : 0
  No RADIUS server configured                            : 0
  RADIUS server send failure                             : 0
  Dropped by Python                                      : 0
===============================================================================
 
 
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show router radius-proxy-server "ZiggoRadiusDRPProxyanyCast-LEG" statistics 
===============================================================================
ISA RADIUS Proxy server statistics for "ZiggoRadiusDRPProxyanyCast-LEG"
===============================================================================
Group 1 member 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Rx packet                                                : 72250262
Rx Access-Request                                        : 61457394
Rx Accounting-Request                                    : 10792868
Rx dropped                                               : 1525690
  Retransmit                                             : 28470
  Wrong purpose                                          : 0
  No UE MAC to cache                                     : 1497212
  Client context limit reached                           : 0
  No ISA RADIUS policy configured                        : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Invalid password                                       : 0
  Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type       : 0
  Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type            : 0
  Invalid accounting Authenticator                       : 0
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 8
  Management core overload                               : 0
 
Tx Access-Accept                                         : 5830313
Tx Access-Reject                                         : 743060
Tx Access-Challenge                                      : 54844862
Tx Accounting-Response                                   : 9294168
Tx dropped                                               : 12226
  Server timeout                                         : 12169
  Invalid response Authenticator                         : 57
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  RADIUS server send failure                             : 0
 

wpp

Syntax 
wpp
wpp [portal wpp-portal-name] [host ip-address] hosts
wpp portal wpp-portal-name
wpp statistics
Context 
show>router
Description 

This command displays WPP port-related information in the specified routing instance.

Parameters 
wpp-portal-name
Specifies the name of this WPP portal
ip-address
Specifies the host IP address
hosts—
Displays the hosts enabled on the portal
Output 

The following output is an example of router WPP information.

Sample Output
show router wpp
===============================================================================
WPP portals
===============================================================================
Portal                           Address         Controlled-Rtr      Num-Itf
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
svr1                             1.1.1.1         0                   0
svr2                             2.2.2.2         0                   0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of portals: 2
===============================================================================
 
 
show router wpp portal "svr1" 
===============================================================================
WPP Portal "svr1"
===============================================================================
Address                               : 1.1.1.1
Controlled router                     : 0
Number of enabled interfaces          : 0
Triggered hosts                       : disabled
Last management change                : 01/27/2014 00:48:45
===============================================================================
 
 

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays IPoE information.

session

Syntax 
session [sap sap-id] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [interface ip-int-name | ip-address] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [no-inter-dest-id] [ip-address ip-prefix[/prefix-length]] [port port-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sap-session-id sap-session-index] [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
Context 
show>service>id>ipoe
Description 

This command displays the identified IPoE session details active on the specified service instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length.
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length.
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface up to 32 characters in length.
ip-address[/prefix-length]—
Specifies information for the specified IP address and mask.
no-inter-dest-id—
Displays the information about no intermediate destination ID.
port-id
Displays information about the specified port ID.
sap-session-index—
Displays sap-session-index information.
service-id
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

 

intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length.
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile.
detail—
Displays all IPoE session details.
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the router advertisement policy, up to 32 characters in length.
Output 

The following output is an example of service IPoE session information.

Sample Output
# show service id 4000 ipoe session
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for svc-id 4000
===============================================================================
Sap Id                           Mac Address         Up Time         MC-Stdby
    Subscriber-Id
        [CircuitID] | [RemoteID]
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4:1201.27                    00:51:00:00:00:0c   0d 00:00:18
    ipoe-session-001
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
CID | RID displayed when included in session-key
Number of sessions : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
# show service id 4000 ipoe session detail
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for service 4000
===============================================================================
SAP                     : 1/1/4:1201.27
Mac Address             : 00:51:00:00:00:0c
Circuit-Id              : circuit-id-1
Remote-Id               : remote-id-1
Session Key             : sap-mac
 
MC-Standby              : No
 
Subscriber-interface    : sub-int-1
Group-interface         : group-int-1
 
Up Time                 : 0d 00:01:01
Session Time Left       : N/A
Last Auth Time          : 02/28/2015 01:01:09
Min Auth Intvl (left)   : 0d 00:05:00 (0d 00:03:59)
Persistence Key         : N/A
 
Subscriber              : "ipoe-session-001"
Sub-Profile-String      : "sub-profile-1"
SLA-Profile-String      : "sla-profile-1"
ANCP-String             : ""
Int-Dest-Id             : ""
App-Profile-String      : ""
Category-Map-Name       : ""
Acct-Session-Id         : "144DFF0000001354D806D5"
Sap-Session-Index       : 1
 
IP Address              : 10.10.1.201/24
IP Origin               : Radius
Primary DNS             : N/A
Secondary DNS           : N/A
Primary NBNS            : N/A
Secondary NBNS          : N/A
Address-Pool            : N/A
 
IPv6 Prefix             : 2001:db8:a:111::/64
IPv6 Prefix Origin      : Radius
IPv6 Prefix Pool        : ""
IPv6 Del.Pfx.           : 2001:db8:a001:a100::/56
IPv6 Del.Pfx. Origin    : Radius
IPv6 Del.Pfx. Pool      : ""
IPv6 Address            : 2001:db8:a:101::aaa:1
IPv6 Address Origin     : Radius
IPv6 Address Pool       : ""
Primary IPv6 DNS        : N/A
Secondary IPv6 DNS      : N/A
 
Radius Session-TO       : N/A
Radius Class            :
Radius User-Name        : 00:51:00:00:00:0c
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of sessions : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-A# show service id 13 ipoe session router-advertisement-policy ra-policy-01
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for svc-id 13
===============================================================================
Sap Id                           Mac Address         Up Time         MC-Stdby
    Subscriber-Id                                                    
        [CircuitID] | [RemoteID]                                     
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:13   0d 00:13:06     
    Belgacom
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:14   0d 00:08:03     
    Belgacom
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:15   0d 00:06:23     
    Belgacom
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
CID | RID displayed when included in session-key
Number of sessions : 3
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# 

summary

Syntax 
summary
Context 
show>service>id>ipoe
Description 

This command displays a summary of IPoE information.

managed-hosts

Syntax 
managed-hosts type {aaa | data-triggered} [ip ip-address] [mac ieee-address]
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays information about hosts that are not yet linked to an in-band control plane protocol, such as DHCP or DHCPv6. Examples include hosts installed by data-triggers and hosts installed by RADIUS.

Parameters 
aaa—
Displays information about managed hosts installed and removed only by RADIUS
data-triggered—
Displays information about managed hosts installed by data-triggers
ip-address—
Displays information about a managed host with the specified IPv4 or IPv6 address
ieee-address—
Displays information about a managed host with the specified MAC address
Output 

The following output is an example of managed host information.

Sample Output
# show service id 100 managed-hosts type data-triggered
===============================================================================
Managed data-triggered hosts
===============================================================================
IP address                                MAC address
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10.0.0.9/32                               fa:ac:a6:02:11:01
2001:a:b:5::1/128                         fa:ac:a6:02:11:01
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Managed hosts: 2
===============================================================================

slaac

Syntax 
slaac
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays SLAAC information.

host

Syntax 
host [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host interface interface-name [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host mac ieee-address [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host ipv6-address ipv6-prefix [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host sap sap-id [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
Context 
show>service>id>slaac
Description 

This command displays SLAAC host related information.

Parameters 
detail—
Specifies to display detailed SLAAC host related information.
service-id—
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler.
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

session—
Specifies to display information about SLAAC hosts that are associated with an IPoE session or a PPP session.
Values—
none, ipoe, ppp

 

interface-name—
Specifies the interface name, up to a maximum of 32 characters.
ieee-address—
Specifies the MAC address for which to display SLAAC host information.
ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address for which to display SLACC host information.
sap-id—
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the router advertisement policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of detailed SLAAC host information.

Sample Output
*A:eng-BNG-2# show service id 1000 slaac host detail
===============================================================================
SLAAC hosts for service 1000
===============================================================================
Service ID           : 1000
Prefix               : 2001:1000:bad:beef::/64
Interface Id         : N/A
Mac Address          : 00:00:10:10:12:12
Subscriber-interface : sub-int-01
Group-interface      : grp-int-01
SAP                  : 1/1/20:841
Termination Type     : local
Creation Time        : 2017/02/13 22:05:03
Persistence Key      : N/A
Router adv. policy   : ra-policy-01
IPoE|PPP session     : No
Radius sub-if prefix : N/A
IPoE Trigger         : rtr-solicit
Last Auth Time       : 2017/02/13 22:05:03
Inactivity Timer     : N/A
Sub-Ident            : "host-1"
Sub-Profile-String   : "no-prof"
SLA-Profile-String   : "no-prof"
App-Profile-String   : ""
ANCP-String          : ""
Int Dest Id          : ""
Category-Map-Name    : ""
Info origin          : radius
Pool                 : ""
Primary-Dns          : N/A
Secondary-Dns        : N/A
Circuit Id           : N/A
Remote Id            : N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of hosts : 1
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# show service id 13 slaac host router-advertisement-policy ra-policy-01
===============================================================================
SLAAC hosts for service 13
===============================================================================
Prefix                      Mac Address          Sap Id                MC-Stdby
  IntId                                                                
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2013:bad:beef:1::/64        00:00:00:00:00:13    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
2013:bad:beef:2::/64        00:00:00:00:00:14    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
2013:bad:beef:3::/64        00:00:00:00:00:15    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of hosts : 3
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# 

summary

Syntax 
summary
Context 
show>service>id>slaac
Description 

This command displays a summary of all SLAAC hosts.

call-trace

Syntax 
call-trace
Context 
show
Description 

This command enters the context to display information related to the call-trace module.

files

Syntax 
files [running | finished] [detail]
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command gives an overview of all the files in use by the call-trace module, either for running or finished jobs.

Parameters 
running—
Displays the active jobs that are tracing events triggered by the host being monitored
finished—
Displays the jobs that have already finished and not tracing events generated by the host anymore
detail—
Displays detailed information about the files
Output 

The following output displays call trace local log files information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace files
===============================================================================
Call trace files of running jobs
===============================================================================
File path                                                             File size
                                                                        (bytes)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
cf1-A:/calltrace/running/mac_00-02-00-00-00-19_160119_1557.pcap            1575
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace files of running jobs: 1
===============================================================================
===============================================================================
Call trace files of finished jobs
===============================================================================
File path                                                             File size
                                                                        (bytes)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace files of finished jobs: 0
===============================================================================

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command enters the context to display IP over Ethernet (IPoE) call trace information.

session

Syntax 
session [name trace-name] [detail]
session sap sap mac mac [{circuit-id circuit-id | remote-id remote-id}] [detail]
Context 
show>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command displays call trace information for the active IPoE session.

Configuring this command with a specific IPoE session key will display information for the specified trace job only.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that identifies an IPoE session.
detail—
Displays detailed information.
mac—
Specifies a MAC address that identifies an IPoE session.
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that identifies an IPoE session
trace-name—
Specifies the name of the trace that triggered the job.
sap—
Specifies a SAP that identifies an IPoE session.
Output 

The following output displays call trace information for the active IPoE session.

Sample Output
Node # show call-trace ipoe session
=========================================================
Call trace IPoE session
=========================================================
IEEE address Status No. of messages
Trace name
---------------------------------------------------------
00:02:00:00:00:19 running 10
default
---------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace IPoE debug jobs: 1
=========================================================
 
 
Node# show call-trace ipoe session detail
===============================================================================
Call trace IPoE session
===============================================================================
SAP ID : 4/1/ 2
IEEE address: 00:02:00:00:00:19
Trace name : default Status : running
Size limit : 10 MB Time limit : 86400 sec
Live output
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Destination : none
Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Started : 2017/01/11 15:34:08UTC
No. of captured msgs : 10
Size of captured msgs : 2575 B
===============================================================================

trace

Syntax 
trace [name trace-name]
Context 
show>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command displays information about all traces and associated parameters that are currently enabled on the system. Including the trace-name parameter will limit the output to the specified trace only.

Parameters 
trace-name—
Specifies the name of the trace to be displayed.
Output 

The following output displays call trace information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace ipoe trace
===============================================================================
Call trace trace
===============================================================================
Trace name : default Type : ipoe
SAP ID :
IEEE address: 00:02:00:00:00:19
Maximum jobs: 1
===============================================================================

status

Syntax 
status
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command gives a router-wide overview of call-trace operational data, such as number of configured profile, number of jobs and status of the compact flash.

Output 

The following output displays call trace status information.

Sample Output
===============================================================================
Call trace status
===============================================================================
No. of trace profiles: 1
No. of trace jobs    : 0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Primary CF           : CF1              Max files number     : 200
CF1 state            : enabled          CF1 volume limit     : 1000 MB
CF2 state            : enabled          CF2 volume limit     : 1000 MB

trace-profile

Syntax 
trace-profile [detail]
trace-profile profile-name
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command provides an overview of all configured profiles or details of a specific profile. If the detail option is specified the full information for all configured profiles will be displayed.

Parameters 
detail—
Displays detailed trace profile information.
Output 

The following output displays call-trace trace-profile information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace trace-profile "default" 
===============================================================================
Call-trace  trace profile
===============================================================================
Profile name              : default
Description                : none
Live output                : none
Format                       : pcap
Size limit                   : 10 MB
Time limit                  : 86400 secs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of profiles : 1
===============================================================================
 

9.25.2.2.16.1. Clear Commands

session

Syntax 
session sap sap mac mac [{circuit-id circuit-id | remote-id remote-id}]
Context 
clear>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command clears the trace job identified by this session.

The sap, mac, circuit-id, and remote-id parameters cannot use wildcard characters, and must match the IPoE session key. This command does not affect any of the debug trace commands, and new jobs can still be executed for other IPoE sessions.

After a session is cleared, tracing for the session will not be restarted by any configured trace. Only explicitly starting a new trace with the trace-existing-sessions parameter can restart tracing for the session.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that identifies an IPoE session.
mac—
Specifies a MAC address that identifies an IPoE session.
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that identifies an IPoE session
sap—
Specifies a SAP that identifies an IPoE session.

trace

Syntax 
trace trace-name
Context 
clear>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command clears all trace jobs started by the specified trace. This command does not affect the trace command itself, and new jobs can still be executed for other IPoE sessions.

After a session is cleared, tracing for the session will not be restarted by any configured trace. Only explicitly starting a new trace with the trace-existing-sessions parameter can restart tracing for the session.

Parameters 
trace-name—
Specifies the configured name of the trace.

accu-stats

Syntax 
accu-stats active-subs no-accu-stats-policy
accu-stats active-subs sub-profile profile-name
accu-stats inactive-subs
accu-stats subscriber subscriber-id
Context 
clear>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command removes the accumulated statistics for a subscriber.

Parameters 
active-subs no accu-stats-policy—
Removes the accumulated statistics that are no longer associated with an accu-stats-policy. These are active subscribers that are referencing a subscriber profile that removed an accu-stats-policy.
active-subs sub-profile profile-name
Removes the accumulated statistics for the specified subscriber profile.
inactive-subs—
Removes the accumulated statistics from all inactive subscribers.
profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile, to a maximum of 32 characters.
subscriber-id—
Specifies the subscriber, to a maximum of 32 characters.

ancp-sub-string

Syntax 
ancp-sub-string string
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp
Description 

This command clears subscriber ANCP data.

Parameters 
string—
Clears the ANCP string corresponding to this subscriber ID

arp

Syntax 
arp {all | ip-address}
arp interface [ip-int-name | ip-address]
Context 
clear>router
Description 

This command clears all or specific ARP entries.

The scope of ARP cache entries cleared depends on the command line option(s) specified.

Parameters 
all—
Clears all ARP cache entries
ip-addr—
Clears the ARP cache entry for the specified IP address
ip-int-name
Clears all ARP cache entries for the interface with the specified name
ip-addr
Clears all ARP cache entries for the specified interface with the specified address

authentication

Syntax 
authentication [policy-name]
authentication coa-statistics
Context 
clear
Description 

This command clears subscriber authentication data.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Clears the specifies existing authentication policy name
coa-statistics—
Clears statistics for incoming RADIUS Change of Authorization requests

diameter-session

Syntax 
diameter-session
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command clears diameter session data.

ccrt-replay

Syntax 
ccrt-replay diameter-application-policy name
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt>diam-session
Description 

This command clears diameter Gx sessions that are in CCR Terminate replay mode.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be deleted

errors

Syntax 
errors
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command clears all errors in the circular buffer.

idle-only-msap

Syntax 
idle-only-msap msap-policy-name
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command removes all idle MSAPs associated with the MSAP policy.This command only removes idle MSAPs without active subscribers. This command is considered safer than the clear>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy msap-policy-name idle-only command because in that command, the parameter idle-only is optional. Not specifying idle-only will delete MSAPs with active subscribers.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Specifies the MSAP policy for which all associated idle MSAPs will be cleared

msap-policy

Syntax 
msap-policy msap-policy-name [idle-only]
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command deletes Managed SAPs (MSAPs) created by the MSAP policy.

This command can remove an MSAP with active subscribers still associated with the MSAP. Use the idle-only parameter to remove only MSAPs in an idle state.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Specifies an existing managed SAP policy name. A string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
idle-only—
Specifies to remove only the MSAPs in an idle state

peakvalue-stats

Syntax 
peakvalue-stats iom (slot | all) [recursive]
peakvalue-stats mda (mda | all) [recursive]
peakvalue-stats port (port-id | all)
peakvalue-stats pw-port (pw-port | all)
peakvalue-stats system [recursive]
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the most recent peak counter.

Note:

Clearing one counter will not impact other counters. For example, clearing one IOM’s most recent peak value will not impact chassis peak value.

Parameters 
slot
Clears IOM host peak value statistics for the specified IOM
mda
Clears MDA host peak value statistics for the specified MDA
port-id
Clears port host peak value statistics for the specified port ID
pw-port
Clears pseudowire port host peak value statistics for the specified port
Values—
1 to 10239

 

system —
Clears system host peak value statistics
all—
Clears all host peak value statistics
recursive—
Resets the sub-level counters. For example, clearing IOM counters with the recursive keyword will also clear counters of all ports counters on that IOM

radius-accounting

Syntax 
radius-accounting [policy-name]
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command clears RADIUS accounting data for the specified policy.

Parameters 
policy-name—
The name of the policy. The string is case sensitive and limited to 32 ASCII 7-bit printable characters with no spaces.

statistics

Syntax 
statistics sub-profile {sub-profile-name | all}
statistics sla-profile {sla-profile-name | all}
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command clears the current and historical statistics.

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Clears the statistics for a specific subscriber profile, limited to 32 characters.
sub-profile all—
Clears all subscriber profile statistics.
sla-profile-name—
Clears the statistics for a specific SLA profile, limited to 32 characters.
sla-profile all—
Clears all SLA profile statistics.

scheduler-stats

Syntax 
scheduler-stats
Context 
clear>qos
Description 

This command clears scheduler statistics.

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears scheduler stats per subscriber.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string—
Clears information for the subscriber profile name
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler-name
egress—
Clears egress information for the subscriber
ingress
Clears ingress information for the subscriber

sla-profile

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Clears information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Clears information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Clears information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler-name

srrp

Syntax 
srrp
Context 
clear>router
Description 

This command enters the context to clear and reset SRRP virtual router instances.

interface

Syntax 
interface subscriber-interface [id srrp-id]
Context 
clear>router>srrp
Description 

This command clears and resets SRRP interface instances.

Parameters 
subscriber-interface—
Specifies an existing subscriber interface name up to 32 characters in length
srrp-id
Specifies an existing SRRP ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

statistics

Syntax 
statistics interface subscriber-interface [id srrp-id]
Context 
clear>router>srrp
Description 

This command clears statistics for SRRP instances.

Parameters 
subscriber-interface—
Specifies an existing subscriber interface name up to 32 characters in length
srrp-id
Specifies an existing SRRP ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

route-downloader

Syntax 
route-downloader name [vprn vprn] [family family]
Context 
clear>aaa
Description 

This command clears all the radius-downloaded routes from the internal downloader cache (or protocol RIB/db) (and thus eventually from the RTM itself). The parameters vprn and/or family allow to restrict the deletion of those routes learned in a particular address family (IPv4 or IPv6) and/or a particular VPRN.

By default, all VPRNs and both IPv4 and IPv6 families are affected.

Note:

A clear of the internal protocol DB means the corresponding prefix that were deleted should be removed from the RTM (and from any other exports) as well.

Parameters 
vprn
Specifies to limit the removal of prefixes to only the specific VPRN. The parameter can be either the service-id or service-name that identifies a VPRN
family
Specifies to limit he removal or prefixes only belonging to the address family IPv4 or IPv6. Only these two values will be accepted.
Values—
ipv4, ipv6

 

vport

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears the Vport scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port-id
Clears information for the specified port
name
Clears information for the specified Vport
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler name

ipoe session

Syntax 
ipoe session [sap sap-id] [interface ip-int-name | ip-address] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [no-inter-dest-id] [ip-address ip-prefix[/prefix-length]] [port port-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sap-session-id sap-session-index]
ipoe session all
Context 
clear>service>id
Description 

This commands clears all identified IPoE sessions for the specified service instance. All associated subscriber hosts will be deleted from the system.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface up to 32 characters in length
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
ip-address[/prefix-length]—
Specifies information for the specified IP address and mask
no-inter-dest-id—
Displays the information about no intermediate destination ID
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
port-id
Displays information about the specified port ID
sap-session-index—
Displays sap-session-index information
service-id
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
service-id
Specifies information for the specified service ID
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

detail—
Displays all IPoE session details
all—
clears all active IPoE sessions for the specified service instance.

9.25.2.3.16.1. Tools Commands

tools

Syntax 
tools
Context 
root
Description 

The context to enable useful tools for debugging purposes.

Default 

none

Parameters 
dump—
Enables dump tools for the various protocols
perform—
Enables tools to perform specific tasks

avp-match-learned-session-id

Syntax 
avp-match-learned-session-id
Context 
tools>dump>debug>diameter
Description 

This command displays the diameter session IDs that are learned by the AVP value matching in a diameter debug.

Per avp-match id in a diameter peer policy, a single diameter session ID can be learned. "N/A" means no session ID is learned.

Output 

The following is a sample output for the avp-match-learned-session-id command.

Sample output
# tools dump debug diameter avp-match-learned-session-id
===============================================================================
Learned Session-Id
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy             ID Session-Id
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
diameter-peer-policy-1           1  bng.domain.com;1452197100;13
diameter-peer-policy-1           2  N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of AVP matches: 2
===============================================================================

perform

Syntax 
perform
Context 
tools
Description 

This command enters the context to enable tools to perform specific tasks.

Default 

none

credit-reset

Syntax 
credit-reset sap sap-id subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset sap sap-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset svc service-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the credit for an SLA-profile instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-address
Resets the credit for the specified IP address
sub-ident-string
Resets the credit for the specified subscriber identification.
sub-profile-string
Resets the credit for the specified subscriber profile
sla-profile-string
Resets the credit for the specified SLA profile
service-id
Resets the credit for the specified service ID
Values—
service-id: 1 2147483647 svc-name: up to 64 characters maximum.

 

persistence

Syntax 
persistence
Context 
tools>perform
Description 

This command enters the context to configure downgrade parameters.

downgrade

Syntax 
downgrade target-version target [reboot]
Context 
tools>perform>persistence
Description 

This command downgrades persistence files to a previous version.

Parameters 
target
Specifies the downgrade version
reboot—
Specifies to reboot the system after a successful conversion

eval-msap

Syntax 
eval-msap {policy msap-policy-name | msap sap-id}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command re-applies the managed SAP policy to the managed SAP identified by the specified sap-id or to all managed SAPs associated with the specified msap-policy name.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name
Specifies an existing MSAP policy. The MSAP policy will be re-applied to all associated managed SAPs
sap-id
Specifies an MSAP sap-id. The MSAP policy will be re-applied to the specified MSAP
Values—
[port-id | lag-id]:qtag1
[port-id | lag-id]:qtag1.qtag2

 

eval-lease-state

Syntax 
eval-lease-state [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [ip ip-address] [mac mac-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates lease state.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ip-address—
Specifies the a server’s IP address. This address must be unique within the subnet and specified in dotted decimal notation. Allowed values are IP addresses in the range 1.0.0.0 – 223.255.255.255 (with support of /31 subnets).
sub-ident-string—
Specifies the subscriber ID string, up to 32 characters in length
service-id—
Specifies an existing service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

subscriber-mgmt

Syntax 
subscriber-mgmt
Context 
tools>perform
Description 

This command enters the context to configure tools to control subscriber management.

edit-lease-state

Syntax 
edit-lease-state sap sap-id ip ip-address [mac ieee-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string [app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
edit-lease-state svc-id service-id ip ip-address [mac ieee-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string [app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command provides the parameters to edit lease state information.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ip-address
Modifies lease state information for the specified IP address.
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
sub-ident-string
Modifies the lease state information for the specified subscriber identification.
sub-profile-string
Modifies lease state information for the specified subscriber profile.
sla-profile-string
Modifies lease state information for the specified SLA profile.
service-id
Modifies lease state information for the specified service ID.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

coa

Syntax 
coa [nas-port-id attr-string] [framed-ip-addr ip-address] [alc-ipv6-addr ipv6-address] [delegated-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]] [framed-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix [/ipv6-prefix-length]] [alc-serv-id serv-id] [acct-session-id attr-string] [alc-subscr-id attr-string] [alc-brg-id attr-string] [alc-client-hw-addr mac-address] [attr attribute [attribute...(up to 5 max)]] [attr-from-file file-url] [from-server attr-string] [router-or-service attr-string] [debug]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command triggers a Change of Authorization (CoA) on the 7750 SR, 7450 ESS, and 7950 XRS without a RADIUS authentication policy.

This command can be used to spoof a CoA from a configured server for purposes such as testing CoA python scripts. However, spoofing a CoA from a RADIUS server requires the configuration of a RADIUS authentication policy.

Parameters 
nas-port-id attr-string
Specifies the physical access circuit of the NAS with a maximum of 253 characters.
framed-ip-addr ip-address
Specifies the IPv4 host address.
Values—

ipv4-address:

a,b,c,d

 

alc-ipv6-addr ipv6-address
Specifies the IPv6 host address.
Values—

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

 

delegated-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]
Specifies the IPv6 PD host prefix.
Values—

ipv6-prefix:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix-length

[0..128]

 

framed-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]
Specifies the IPv6 SLAAC host prefix.
Values—

ipv6-prefix:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix-length

[0..128]

 

serv-id
Specifies the service ID of the LNS subscriber.
Values—
0 to 4294967295

 

acct-session-id attr-string
Specifies the subscriber accounting session ID to a maximum of 22 characters in length.
alc-subscr-id attr-string
Specifies the subscriber ID to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
alc-brg-id attr-string
Specifies the BRG ID to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
mac-address
Specifies the subscriber host MAC address. in the form xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx.
attribute
Specifies the attributes (RADIUS VSAs) for override. The VSA must be specified in number format. For example, VSA Alc-Subsc-Prof-Str=”1M-prof” is expressed as 6527.12 =“1M-prof”. Up to five attributes can be specified within this command.

For more information on VSAs, refer to the RADIUS Attributes Reference Guide.

Values—

<type>=<value>

<type>:<tag>=<value>

<vendor>,<type>=<value>

e, <type>,<exttyp>=<value> (type=[241|242|243|244])

le,<type>,<exttyp>=<value> (type=[245|246])

evs,<type>,<vendor>,<vendor-type>=<value>

levs,<type>,<vendor>,<vendor-type>=<value>

 

file-url
Specifies the file URL where the VSAs are located.
Values—

local-url

[cflash-id/] [file-path] (200 characters maximum including cflash-id directory length of 99 characters maximum each)

remote-url

[{ftp://|tftp://}login:pswd@remote-locn/][file-path] (255 characters maximum with directory length 99 characters maximum each)

remote-locn

[hostname | ipv4-address | ipv6-address]

ipv4-address:

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x [-interface]

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d[-interface]

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

interface - Specifies the link local addresses, up to 32 characters maximum.

cflash-id

cf1: | cf1-A: | cf1-B: | cf2 :| cf2-A: | cf2-B: | cf3: | cf3-A: | cf3-B:

 

from-server attr-string
Specifies the RADIUS server name that is configured under the router or VPRN service context, to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
router-or-service attr-string
Specifies the router or VPRN service instance where the RADIUS server is configured, to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
debug —
Displays the debug message associated with the CoA command.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management CoA tools information.

Sample Output
Node# tools perform subscriber-mgmt coa alc-subscr-id subscriber-01 attr 6527,13=new-sla-prof debug
===============================================================================
Inject Change-of-Authorization
===============================================================================
SUCCESS: got ACK
  Change of Authorization(43) id 0 len 50 from 0.0.0.0:3799 vrid 1
    VSA [26] 8 Alcatel(6527)
      SUBSC ID STR [11] 6 subscriber-01
    VSA [26] 10 Alcatel(6527)
      SLA PROF STR [13] 8 new-sla-prof
  Hex Packet Dump:
  1a 0e 00 00 19 7f 0b 08 77 69 66 69 2d 31 1a 10 00 00 19 7f 0d 0a 73 6c 61
  2d 70 72 6f 66
  Change of Authorization Ack(44) 0.0.0.0:3799 id 0 len 20 vrid 1
  Hex Packet Dump:

credit-reset

Syntax 
credit-reset sap sap-id subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset sap sap-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset svc service-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the credit for an SLA-profile instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-address
Specifies lease state information for the specified IP address
sub-ident-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified subscriber identification
sub-profile-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified subscriber profile
sla-profile-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified SLA profile
service-id
Specifies lease state information for the specified service ID
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

edit-ppp-session

Syntax 
edit-ppp-session sap sap-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
edit-ppp-session svc-id service-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the PPP session identified with the given MAC address and SAP identifier. Optionally the remote-id and circuit-id can be specified to identify the IPoE session to update.

Note:

The changes take immediate effect.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
sla-profile-string—
Identifies the SLA profile string up to 16 characters in length
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sub-profile-string—
Specifies the subscriber profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
ancp-string—
Specifies the ASCII representation of the up to 63 characters in length
app-profile-string—
Specifies the application profile string up to 16 characters in length

edit-slaac-host

Syntax 
edit-slaac-host sap sap-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
edit-slaac-host svc-id service-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the SLAAC host information.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
sla-profile-string—
Identifies the SLA profile string up to 16 characters in length
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sub-profile-string—
Specifies the subscriber profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
ancp-string—
Specifies the ASCII representation of the up to 63 characters in length
app-profile-string—
Specifies the application profile string up to 16 characters in length

edit-ipoe-session

Syntax 
edit-ipoe-session sap sap-id mac mac-address [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the IPoE session identified with the given MAC address and SAP identifier. Optionally the remote ID and circuit ID can be specified to identify the IPoE session to update.

Note:

The changes take immediate effect.

eval-ipoe-session

Syntax 
eval-ipoe-session [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [mac mac-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command re-evaluates the mapping between authentication strings such as the SLA profile string and the actual profiles for the identified IPoE sessions.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile

eval-ppp-session

Syntax 
eval-ppp-session [svc-id service-id] [user-name user-name] [sap sap-id] [ip ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
eval-ppp-session [svc-id service-id] [user-name user-name] [sap sap-id] mac mac-address [session-id session-id] [ip ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates PPP sessions.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
mac-address—
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

eval-slaac-host

Syntax 
eval-slaac-host [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [ipv6-address ipv6-prefix] [mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates the SLAAC host.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
ipv6-prefix—
Specifies an IPv6 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

 

remap-lease-state

Syntax 
remap-lease-state old-mac ieee-address mac ieee-address
remap-lease-state sap sap-id [mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command allows the remapping of all existing hosts if network card on CMTS/WAC side is changed is required.

When this command is executed, the following restrictions apply:

  1. When sap is taken, all leases associated with the SAP are re-written.
    1. For a SAP with a configured MAC in lease-populate command, this MAC will be taken.
    2. For a SAP without a configured MAC the MAC from tools command will be taken.
    3. For a SAP without a configured MAC and no MAC in tools command no action will be perform.
  2. When using the old-mac option, providing a new MAC ieee-address is mandatory.

This command is applicable only when dealing with DHCP lease states which were instantiated using l2header mode of DHCP operation.

Parameters 
old-mac ieee-address
Specifies the old MAC address to remap
mac ieee-address
Specifies that the provisioned MAC address will be used in the anti-spoofing entries for this SAP when l2-header is enabled. The parameter may be changed mid-session. Existing sessions will not be re-programmed unless a tools perform command is issued for the lease.
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.

When configured, the SAP parameter will remap all MAC addresses of DHCP lease states on the specified SAP. When no optional MAC parameter is specified, the sap sap-id command remaps all MAC addresses of lease states towards the MAC address specified in the l2-header configuration.

re-ident-sub

Syntax 
re-ident-sub old-sub-ident-string to new-sub-ident-string
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command renames a subscriber identification string.

Parameters 
old-sub-ident-string—
Specifies the existing subscriber identification string to be renamed
new-sub-ident-string—
Specifies the new subscriber identification string name

redundancy

Syntax 
redundancy
Context 
tools>dump
Description 

This command enters the context to dump redundancy parameters.

multi-chassis

Syntax 
multi-chassis
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy
Description 

This command enters the context to dump multi-chassis parameters.

mc-endpoint

Syntax 
mc-endpoint peer ip-address
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis endpoint information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address

force-switchover

Syntax 
force-switchover tunnel-group local-group-id
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command manually switches over mc-ipsec mastership of the specified tunnel-group.

Parameters 
local-group-id—
Specifies the local tunnel-group ID configured under the config>redundancy.multichassis>peer>mc-ipsec context

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
mc-ring peer ip-address [ring sync-tag]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
sync-tag
Specifies the ring’s sync-tag created in the config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring context

srrp-sync-database

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps SRRP database information and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
instance instance-id
Dumps information for the specified Subscriber Router Redundancy Protocol instance configured on this system.
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps MCS database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
port-id | lag-id
Indicates the port or LAG ID to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
slot/mda/port or lag-lag-id

 

sync-tag
Specifies a synchronization tag to be used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application
Specifies a particular multi-chassis peer synchronization protocol application
Values—

dhcp-server:

local dhcp server (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

igmp:

Internet group management protocol

igmp-snooping:

igmp-snooping

mc-ring:

multi-chassis ring

mld-snooping:

multicast listener discovery-snooping

srrp:

simple router redundancy protocol (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-host-trk:

subscriber host tracking (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-mgmt:

subscriber management (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

 

type
Indicates the locally deleted or alarmed deleted entries in the MCS database per multi-chassis peer
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

detail—
Displays detailed information

mc-ipsec

Syntax 
mc-ipsec
Context 
tools>perform>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command enters the context to configure mc-ipsec parameters.

mc-endpoint

Syntax 
mc-endpoint peer ip-address
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis endpoint information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
mc-ring peer ip-address [ring sync-tag]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address.
sync-tag
Specifies the ring’s sync-tag created in the config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring context.

srrp-sync-database

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps SRRP database information and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
instance-id
Dumps information for the specified Subscriber Router Redundancy Protocol instance configured on this system.
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps MCS database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
port-id | lag-id
Indicates the port or LAG ID to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
slot/mda/port or lag-lag-id

 

sync-tag
Specifies a synchronization tag to be used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application
Specifies a particular multi-chassis peer synchronization protocol application
Values—

dhcp-server:

local dhcp server (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

igmp:

Internet group management protocol

igmp-snooping:

igmp-snooping

mc-ring:

multi-chassis ring

mld-snooping:

multicast listener discovery-snooping

srrp:

simple router redundancy protocol (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-host-trk:

subscriber host tracking (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-mgmt:

subscriber management (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

 

type
Indicates the locally deleted or alarmed deleted entries in the MCS database per multi-chassis peer
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

detail—
Displays detailed information

forcerenew

Syntax 
forcerenew svc-id service-id {ip ip-address[/mask] | mac ieee-address}
forcerenew {interface interface-name | sap sap-id | sdp sdp-id:vc-id} [ip ip-address[/mask] |mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command forces the renewal of lease state and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR

Parameters 
service-id
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified SAP.
ip-address
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified IP address
ieee-address
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified MAC address
interface-name
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified interface name

local-user-db

Syntax 
local-user-db local-user-db-name
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command provides tools to control the local user database.

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the name of a local user database up to 32 characters in length

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db
Description 

This command provides the tools to control IPoE entries in the local user database.

host-lookup

Syntax 
host-lookup [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id-ascii] [sap-id sap-id] [service-id service-id] [string vso-string] [system-id system-id] [option60 option-60-ascii] [circuit-id circuit-id-ascii] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [option60-hex option60-hex] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [ip-prefix ip-prefix/ip-prefix-length]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe
Description 

This command performs a lookup in the local user database.

Parameters 
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
remote-id
Specifies the information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-ascii—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length in ASCII
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

vso-string—
Specifies a Vendor Specific Option (VSO) string
system-id—
Specifies the system ID
Values—
up to 255 characters maximum

 

option-60-ascii
Specifies the Vendor-Identifying Vendor Option to match against. Option 60 is encoded as Type - Length - Value and must be formatted in ASCII.
option-60-hex
Specifies the Vendor-Identifying Vendor Option to match against. Option 60 is encoded as Type - Length - Value and must be formatted in HEX

ppp

Syntax 
ppp
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db
Description 

This command provides the tools to control PPPoE entries in the local user database.

authentication

Syntax 
authentication user-name user-name password password [circuit-id circuit-id] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [sap-id sap-id] [service-name service-name]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ppp
Description 

This command authenticates the PPPoE user name.

Parameters 
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
password
Specifies the password of this host up to 64 characters in length
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
circuit-id-hex
Specifies the circuit ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 254 hex nibbles)

 

derived-id
Specifies an ASCII string that uniquely identifies a host, and is derived by a Python script from packet content available during a DHCP transaction up to 255 characters in length
ieee-address
Specifies information about the MAC address of the PPP session
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-hex—
Specifies the remote ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 510hex nibbles)

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters in length
service-name
Specifies the service name

host-lookup

Syntax 
host-lookup [circuit-id circuit-id] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [sap-id sap-id] [service-name service-name] [user-name user-name]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ppp
Description 

This command performs a lookup in the local user database.

Parameters 
circuit-id circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID from the Option 82
circuit-id-hex
Specifies the circuit ID in hexadecimal format from the Option 82
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 254 hex nibbles)

 

derived-id
Specifies an ASCII string that uniquely identifies a host, and is derived by a Python script from packet content available during a DHCP transaction
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-hex—
Specifies the remote ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 510hex nibbles)

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters in length
service-name
Specifies a PPP service name up to 253 characters in length
user-name
Specifies a user name up to 128 characters in length

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring data.

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis sync database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Dumps the specified address of the multi-chassis peer
port-id
Dumps the specified port ID of the multi-chassis peer
lag-id
Dumps the specified Link Aggregation Group (LAG) on this system
sync-tag
Dumps the synchronization tag used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application—
Dumps the specified application information that was synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
dhcps, igmp, igmp-snooping, mc-ring, srrp, sub-mgmt, mld-snooping, all

 

detail—
Displays detailed information
type
Filters by the specified entry type
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

sync-database-reconcile

Syntax 
sync-database-reconcile [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id [sync-tag sync-tag]] [application application]
sync-database-reconcile [peer ip-address] [sdp sdp-id [sync-tag sync-tag]] [application application]
Context 
tools>perform>redundancy>multi-chassis>mc-ipsec
Description 

This command provides the parameters to reconcile MCS database entries.

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IP address (in the form of a.b.c.d)
port-id—
Specifies the port ID in the slot/MDA/port format
lag-id—
Specifies the LAG ID
Values—
lag-id: lag-id
lag: keyword
id: 1 to 200

 

syn-tag—
Specifies the syn tag up to 32 characters in length
application—
Specifies the application
Values—
dhcp-server — Specifies the local DHCP server
igmp — Specifies the Internet group management protocol
igmp-snooping — Specifies igmp-snooping
mc-ring — Specifies multi-chassis ring
l2tp — Specifies L2TP
mld — Specifies multicast listener discovery
mld-snooping — Specifies multicast listener discovery-snooping
srrp — Specifies simple router redundancy protocol
sub-host-trk — Specifies subscriber host tracking
sub-mgmt-ipoe — Specifies subscriber management for IPoE
sub-mgmt-pppoe — Specifies subscriber management for PPPoE
mc-ipsec — Specifies multi-chassis IPsec
python — Specifies Python cache
diameter-proxy — Specifies diameter proxy
pim-snpg-sap — Specifies protocol independent multicast snooping for SAPs
pim-snpg-sdp — Specifies protocol independent multicast snooping for SDPs

 

sdp-id—
Specifies the SDP ID
Values—
1 to 17407

 

srrp-sync-data

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis SRRP sync database information.

Parameters 
instance-id—
Specifies the instance ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

ip-address—
Dumps the specified address (in the form of a.b.c.d)

route-downloader

Syntax 
route-downloader start [force]
Context 
tools>perform>aaa
Description 

This command causes the download process to start immediately. If an ongoing download is already in progress then no further action is needed, except if the force keyword is added. In case the force keyword is added, then the current download is aborted and a new one is immediately restarted. If aborting the current download, the internal route table should not be emptied or cleared.

Parameters 
start—
Starts the download process immediately
force—
Causes the current download to be aborted and a new one is immediately restarted

router

Syntax 
router [router-instance]
router service-name service-name
Context 
tools>dump
Description 

This command enters the context for tools dump commands in the specified routing instance.

Parameters 
router-instance—
Specifies the router instance name (Base or management) or service ID
service-name—
Specifies the configured service name for the routing instance

ipoe-session

Syntax 
ipoe-session
Context 
tools>dump>router
Description 

This command enters the context for IPoE session-related tools dump commands in the specified routing instance.

migration

Syntax 
migration [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
tools>dump>router>ipoe-session
Description 

This command displays details on the IPoE session migration progress. It shows per group interface the number of hosts per type (DHCPv4, DHCPv6 and SLAAC) that are associated with an IPoE session or that are not associated with an IPoE session.

Output 

The following is an example of IPoE session migration information.

Sample Output
# tools dump router ipoe-session migration interface group-int-1-1
================================================================================
 Type                Total     IPoE session     Non IPoE session
================================================================================
 Group-interface: group-int-1-1 (IPoE session enabled)
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 DHCPv4              2         1                1
 DHCPv6              3         2                1
 SLAAC               0         0                0
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 IPoE sessions       1
================================================================================

9.25.2.4.16.1. Debug Commands

diameter

Syntax 
[no] diameter
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command enables debugging for diameter.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

dest-realm

Syntax 
dest-realm realm
no dest-realm
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts the output to a specific destination-realm.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
realm—
Specifies the realm up to 80 characters in length

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level level
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command configures the detail level of debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
level—
Specifies the detail level
Values—
low, medium, high

 

diameter-peer

Syntax 
diameter-peer peer [psm-events]
no diameter-peer
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts output to a specific peer.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
psm-events—
Specifies to restrict output to the peer’s state machine (PSM)

diameter-peer-policy

Syntax 
diameter-peer-policy policy
no diameter-peer-policy policy
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages on peers of a specific diameter peer policy. Up to eight diameter peer policies can be specified.

The no form of the command removes the specified diameter peer policy and all debug statement under this policy from the debug configuration.

Parameters 
policy—
Specifies the diameter peer policy name, up to 32 characters in length

avp-match

Syntax 
avp-match id
no avp-match id
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages within the diameter peer policy that belong to a diameter session identified based on the AVP value matching in a diameter application message.At least the message type and one AVP match criteria must be specified in an avp-match id command.

If a diameter application message matches all criteria within one AVP match ID, then the session ID is learned and all subsequent messages of that diameter session are shown until a relearning occurs. (OR function between avp-match id commands.)

When the session ID is learned in an Answer message, an attempt is made to include the corresponding Request message in the debug output: The Request message should still be available in the system and must pass all debug filters (such as message-type).

By default an avp-match id is disabled and must be configured with the debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match no shutdown to activate.

Parameters 
id—
Specifies the AVP match ID, up to five per diameter peer policy
Values—
1 to 5

 

avp

Syntax 
avp avp-id type type [ascii | hex] value value
no avp avp-id
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command specifies an AVP match criteria for AVP value matching. At least one and up to five AVP match criteria can be specified in an avp-match id command. When multiple AVP match criteria are specified, they must all match to be successful and result in a diameter session ID learning. (AND function between avp avp-id commands.)

The AVP in an AVP match criteria is identified by its AVP ID. The AVP ID is specified as [vendor-id-]avp-code[.avp-id] with nesting up to five levels deep.

The format type of the AVP should match the standard documents in which the AVP is specified. Any AVP can be specified as an octet string in hex format.

Parameters 
avp-id—
Specifies that an AVP is a [vendor-id-]avp-code[.avp-id], up to five levels deep. For example to specify the Multiple-Services-Credit-Control.Quota-Holding-Time AVP, use avp-id = 456.10415-871.
Values—
vendor-id: [1 to 4294967295]
avp-code: [1 to 4294967295]

 

type—
Specifies the format type of the AVP as octets string, integer32, integer64, unsigned32, unsigned64 or address. The type should match the format as specified in the corresponding standard documents. Any AVP can be specified as octet string in hex.
ascii | hex—
Specifies the value format. The ASCII format is default. The hexadecimal format value should start with "0x". For example: 0x0000000a to specify a 4 byte integer value in hexadecimal format.
value—
Specifies the actual value of the AVP that should be matched against (256 characters maximum; 127 characters maximum when specified in hex)

message-type

Syntax 
message-type [ccr] [cca] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
no message-type
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command specifies the message type match criteria for AVP value matching. Only specified diameter application messages are used for AVP value matching. This is a mandatory criteria in an avp-match id command.This command does not restrict the debug output to the specified messages.

Parameters 
ccr—
credit control request
cca—
credit control answer
rar —
re-authentication request
raa —
re-authentication answer
asr —
abort session request
asa —
abort session answer
aar —
aa request
aaa —
aa answer
all —
all message types

shutdown

Syntax 
[no] shutdown
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command enables or disables the avp-match id criteria for filtering debug output based on AVP value matching.A shutdown of the avp-match id clears the learned diameter session ID.

diameter-peer

Syntax 
diameter-peer peer [psm-events]
no diameter-peer
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages on a specific peer within the diameter peer policy. Overrides the debug>diam>diam-peer debug command for the specified diameter peer policy. A single peer can be specified per diameter peer policy.

When no peer is specified at the diameter peer policy level, the debug output is restricted to the peer configured at the debug>diam level.

The no form of the command removes the peer from the debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy debug output.

Parameters 
peer—
Specifies a peer name, up to 32 characters in length
psm-events—
Specifies to include Peer State Machine (PSM) events in the debug output

message-type

Syntax 
message-type [ccr] [cca] [cer] [cea] [dwr] [dwa] [dpr] [dpa] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
no message-type
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
debug>diam
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to the specified message types.

When specified within a diameter peer policy, it overrides the message type configuration at the debug>diam level for messages received and sent on that diameter peer policy.

The no form of the command removes the message type from the debug configuration.

Parameters 
ccr—
credit control request
cca—
credit control answer
cer —
capabilities exchange request
cea —
capabilities exchange answer
dwr —
device watchdog request
dwa —
device watchdog answer
dpr —
disconnect peer request
dpa —
disconnect peer answer
rar —
re-authentication request
raa —
re-authentication answer
asr —
abort session request
asa —
abort session answer
aar —
aa request
aaa —
aa answer
all —
all message types

origin-realm

Syntax 
origin-realm realm
no origin-realm
Context 
debug>diam
Description 

This command restricts output to a specific origin-realm.

arp-host

Syntax 
[no] arp-host
Context 
debug>service>id
Description 

This command enables and configures ARP host debugging.

The no form of the command disables ARP host debugging.

one-time-http-redirection

Syntax 
one-time-http-redirection
Context 
debug>service>id
Description 

This command produces one-time HTTP redirection debug output.

ppp

Syntax 
[no] ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>
Description 

This command enables the PPP debug context.

The no form of the command disables PPP debugging.

event

Syntax 
[no] event
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables the PPP event debug context.

The no form of the command disables PPP event debugging.

dhcp-client

Syntax 
dhcp-client [terminate-only]
no dhcp-client
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enable PPP event debug for DHCP client.

The no form of the command disables PPP event debugging for the DHCP client.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debug for local terminated PPP session

l2tp

Syntax 
l2tp [terminate-only]
no l2tp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables PPP L2TP event debug.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debug for local terminated PPP session

local-address-assignment

Syntax 
local-address-assignment [terminate-only]
no local-address-assignment
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables debugging for local-address-assignment events.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debugging for local address assignment

ppp

Syntax 
ppp [terminate-only]
no ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables PPP event debug.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debugging for local terminated PPP session

mac

Syntax 
[no] mac ieee-address
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command displays PPP packets for a particular MAC address.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

msap

Syntax 
[no] msap msap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables debugging for specific PPP MSAPs.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

packet

Syntax 
[no] packet
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables the PPP packet debug context.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level {low | medium | high}
no detail-level
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command specify the detail level of PPP packet debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
low | medium | high—
Specifies the detail level of PPP packet debug output

dhcp-client

Syntax 
[no] dhcp-client
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables packet debug output for DHCP client of the PPP session

The no form of the command disables debugging.

discovery

Syntax 
discovery [padi] [pado] [padr] [pads] [padt]
no discovery
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables PPP discovery packet debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
[padi] [pado] [padr] [pads] [padt]
Enables the corresponding type of PPP discovery packet

mode

Syntax 
mode {dropped-only | ingr-and-dropped | egr-ingr-and-dropped}
no mode
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command specifies PPP packet debug mode.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
dropped-only—
Displays only dropped packets
ingr-and-dropped—
Displays only ingress packet and dropped packets
egr-ingr-and-dropped—
Displays ingress, egress and dropped packets

ppp

Syntax 
ppp [lcp] [pap] [chap] [ipcp] [ipv6cp]
no ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables PPP discovery packet debug output for the specified PPP protocol.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
[lcp] [pap] [chap] [ipcp] [ipv6cp]
Enables debug for the specified protocol

remote-id

Syntax 
[no] remote-id remote-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables debugging for specific PPP remote-ids.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

sap

Syntax 
[no] sap sap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables PPP debug output for the specified SAP, this command allow multiple instances.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies the SAP ID

username

Syntax 
[no] username username
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified username. since not all PPP packets contain username, so a mac debug filter will be created automatically when system sees a PPP packet contain the specified username.

Multiple username filters can be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
user-name—
Specifies the PPP username

circuit-id

Syntax 
[no] circuit-id circuit-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified circuit-id.

Multiple circuit-id filters can be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
circuit-id —
Specifies the circuit-id in PADI

remote-id

Syntax 
[no] remote-id remote-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified remote-id.

Multiple remote-id filters could be specified in the same debug command.

Parameters 
remote-id—
Specifies the remote-id in PADI

msap

Syntax 
[no] msap msap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified managed SAP.

Multiple msap filters could be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
msap-id—
Specifies the managed SAP ID

authentication

Syntax 
authentication [policy policy-name] [mac-addr ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id]
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command debugs subscriber authentication.

Parameters 
policy-name
Specifies an existing subscriber management authentication policy name
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx or xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx
circuit-id
Specify the circuit-id, up to 256 characters in length

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
[no] sub-ident-policy policy-name
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command debugs subscriber identification policies.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the subscriber identification policy to debug

script-compile-error

Syntax 
[no] script-compile-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command send the traceback of the compile error to the logger. The traceback contains detailed information about where and why the compilation fails. The compilation takes place when the CLI user changes the admin state of the Python URL from shutdown to no-shutdown.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-export-variables

Syntax 
[no] script-export-variables
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the result (the three output variables) of the Python script to the logger when the script ran successfully.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-output

Syntax 
[no] script-output
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the output (such as from 'print' statements) of the Python script to the logger.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-output-on-error

Syntax 
[no] script-output-on-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the output (such as from print statements) of the Python script to the logger, but only when the script fails.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-runtime-error

Syntax 
[no] script-runtime-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the traceback of the Python script failure to the logger.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-all-info

Syntax 
script-all-info
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command enables the script-compile-error, script-export-variables, script-output, script-output-on-error, and script-runtime-error functionalities.

srrp

Syntax 
[no] srrp
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

events

Syntax 
[no] events [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
debug>router>srrp
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

packets

Syntax 
[no] packets [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
debug>router>srrp
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

radius

Syntax 
[no] radius
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enables the debug router RADIUS context.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level {low | medium | high}
no detail-level
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the output detail level of command debug router radius.

Default 

medium

Parameters 
low—
Specifies that the output includes packet type, server address, length, radius-server-policy name
medium—
Specifies all output in low level including the RADIUS attributes in the packet
high—
Specifies all output in medium level including the hex packet dump

packet-type

Syntax 
packet-type [authentication] [accounting] [coa]
no packet-type
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the RADIUS packet type filter of command debug router radius

Default 

authentication accounting coa

Parameters 
authentication—
Specifies the RADIUS authentication packet
accounting—
Specifies the RADIUS accounting packet
coa—
Specifies the RADIUS change of authorization packet

radius-attr

Syntax 
radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction]
radius-attr type attribute-type [transaction] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction] [encoding encoding-type]
radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction] [encoding encoding-type] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
no radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type]
no radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
no radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type]
no radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] {address | hex | integer | string} [0..16777215] attribute-value
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the RADIUS attribute filter of command debug router radius.

Parameters 
attribute-type
Specifies the RADIUS attribute type
Values—
1 to 255

 

attribute-ext-type
Specifies the RADIUS attribute extended type (RFC 6929)
Values—
1 to 255

 

address—
Specifies the value is a IPv4 or IPv6 address/prefix/subnet
string—
Specifies the value is a ASCII string
integer—
Specifies the value is a integer
hex—
Specifies the value is a binary string in hex format, such as “\0xAB01FE”
attribute-value
Specifies the value of the RADIUS attribute
Values—

address

<ipv4-address> | <ipv6-address> | <ipv6-prefix/prefix-length>

ipv4-address

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

ipv6-prefix-length [0 to 128]

hex

[0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (max 506 hex nibbles)]

integer

[0 to 4294967295]

string

ascii-string (max 253 chars)

 

transaction—
Specifies that the system will output both request and response packets in the same session even if the response packet does not include the filter attribute
vendor-id
Specifies the vendor id for the vendor specific attribute
Values—
0 to 16777215

 

encoding-type
Specifies the size of the vendor-type and vendor-length in bytes. It is a two digitals string: “xy”, x is the size of vendor-type, range from 1 to 4; y is the size of vendor-length, range from 0 to 2; it is “11” by default.
Values—
type-size:1 to 4, length-size: 0 to 2

 

wpp

Syntax 
[no] wpp
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enters the context to configure WPP debugging parameters.

packet

Syntax 
[no] packet
Context 
debug>router>wpp
debug>router>wpp>portal
Description 

This command enables WPP packet debugging.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level detail-level
Context 
debug>router>wpp
debug>router>wpp>packet
debug>router>wpp>portal>packet
Description 

This command specifies the detail level of WPP packet debugging.

Parameters 
detail-level—
specifies the detail level of WPP packet debugging
Values—
high — Specifies a high detail level for WPP packet debugging
low — Specifies a low detail for WPP packet debugging

 

portal

Syntax 
[no] portal wpp-portal-name
Context 
debug>router>wpp
Description 

This command enables WPP debugging for the specified WPP portal.

Parameters 
wpp-portal-name—
Specifies the WPP portal name

call-trace

Syntax 
call-trace
Context 
debug
Description 

This command enters the context to set up various call trace debug sessions.

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
debug>call-trace
Description 

This command enters the context to set up call trace debugging for IP over Ethernet (IPoE) sessions.

trace

Syntax 
trace sap sap-id [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace mac ieee-address [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace circuit-id circuit-id [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace remote-id remote-id [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
no trace [sap sap-id] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id]
no trace name trace-name
Context 
debug>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command enables tracing for IPoE sessions specified by the configured parameters. This command can trace a single session or multiple sessions, and can use wildcard characters.

This command can be executed multiple times to start multiple traces. When rules overlap, such as for a wildcard SAP and a specific SAP, the rule that a specific trace will be associated with cannot be guaranteed.

The no form of the command will prevent new traces from being configured and will terminate all trace jobs that were previously started using the trace command.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that is used to filter sessions to trace. The circuit-id and remote-id parameters are mutually exclusive.
ieee-address—
Specifies a MAC address that is used to identify a session to trace, in the format “ab:cd:ef:01:23:45”. A wildcard character can be used to match all remaining octets; for example, the format “ab:cd:ef:*” can be used to filter by OUI.
num—
Specifies the maximum number of jobs that may be started with this rule.
Values—
1 to 50

 

Default—
1
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that is used to filter sessions to trace. The remote-id and circuit-id parameters are mutually exclusive.
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP to trace. The following formats are accepted:
  1. port/lag/pw-port:svlan.cvlan
  2. port/lag/pw-port:vlan
  3. port/lag/pw-port
  4. port/lag/pw-port:vlan.*
  5. port/lag/pw-port:* (also matches *.*)
trace-existing-sessions—
Specifies that existing IPoE sessions will be traced. If this parameter is not included, only new IPoE sessions will be traced.
trace-name—
Specifies the name by which the trace will be referenced, up to 16 characters maximum.
trace-profile-name—
Specifies the name of the trace profile to be applied. The default parameters will be used if a trace profile is not specified.

9.25.2.5.16.1. Monitor Commands

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sap sap-id sla-profile sla-profile-name [base | ingress-queue-id ingress-queue-id | egress-queue-id egress-queue-id] [interval seconds] [repeat repeat] [absolute | rate]
Context 
monitor>service
Description 

This command monitors statistics for a subscriber.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile to monitor
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
sla-profile-name
Specifies an existing SLA profile
seconds
Configures the interval for each display in seconds
Default—
11
Values—
11 to 60

 

repeat
Configures how many times the command is repeated
Default—
10
Values—
1 to 999

 

absolute—
Specifies that raw statistics are displayed, without processing. No calculations are performed on the delta or rate statistics.
Default—
mode delta
rate —
Specifies that the rate-per-second for each statistic is displayed instead of the delta
base —
Monitors base statistics
ingress-queue-id ingress-queue-id
Monitors statistics for this queue
Values—
1 to 32

 

egress-queue-id egress-queue-id
Monitors statistics for this queue
Values—
1 to 8

 

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber monitor statistics

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 94531                  30704535
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 7332                    2510859
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 87067                   28152288
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 90862                   12995616
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance per Queue statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Ingress Queue 1 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Ingress Queue 2 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 94531                   30704535
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 7332                    2510859
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 87067                   28152288
 
Ingress Queue 3 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Ingress Queue 11 (Multipoint) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 1
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 90862                   12995616
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 2
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 3
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default base rate
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 109099                  35427060
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 8449                    2894798
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 100523                  32489663
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 105578                  15104553
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
At time t = 11 sec (Mode: Rate)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets                  % Port
                                                                        Util.
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0                       0.00
Off. LowPrio          : 1469                    477795                  0.38
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0                       0.00
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0                       0.00
Dro. LowPrio          : 119                     40691                   0.03
For. InProf           : 0                       0                       0.00
For. OutProf          : 1349                    437350                  0.34
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0                       0.00
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0                       0.00
For. InProf           : 1469                    209129                  0.16
For. OutProf          : 0                       0                       0.00
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default ingress-queue-id 1
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Ingress Queue 1 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default egress-queue-id 1
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Egress Queue 1
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 164366                  23506178
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
==============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

host

Syntax 
host [sap sap-id] [wholesaler service-id] [port port-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [detail]
host [sap sap-id] [wholesaler service-id] [port port-id] no-inter-dest-id [detail]
host summary
host [detail] wholesaler service-id (VPRN only)
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays static host information configured on this service.

Parameters 
sap-id
Displays SAP information for the specified SAP ID
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
summary—
Displays summary host information
wholesaler service-id
Specifies the VPRN service ID of the wholesaler. When specified in this context, SAP, SDP, interface, IP address and MAC parameters are ignored. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

Default 

collect-stats

default-host

Syntax 
default-host ipv4-prefix/mask | ipv6-prefix/prefix-length next-hop ipv4-address | ipv6-address
no default-host ipv4-prefix/mask | ipv6-prefix/prefix-length
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command configures the default-host. More than one default host can be configured per SAP.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

no lease-populate

Parameters 
ipv64prefix/prefix-length—
Specifies an IPv4 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv4-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

prefix-length - [0 to 128]

 

ipv6-prefix/prefix-length—
Specifies an IPv6 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

prefix-length - [0 to 128]

 

next-hop—
Assigns the next hop IP address

cpu-protection

Syntax 
cpu-protection policy-id [mac-monitoring] | [eth-cfm-monitoring [aggregate] [car]]
no cpu-protection
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command assigns an existing CPU protection policy to the associated group interface. The CPU protection policies are configured in the config>sys>security>cpu-protection>policy cpu-protection-policy-id context.

If no CPU-Protection policy is assigned to a group interface SAP, then the default policy is used to limit the overall-rate. The default policy is policy number 254 for access interfaces and 255 for network interfaces.

The no form of the command removes the association of the CPU protection policy from the associated interface and reverts to the default policy values.

Default 

cpu-protection 254 (for access interfaces)

cpu-protection 255 (for network interfaces)

The configuration of no cpu-protection returns the interface/SAP to the default policies as shown above.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Specifies an existing CPU protection policy
Values—
1 to 255

 

mac-monitoring—
Specifies to enable MAC monitoring
eth-cfm-monitoring
Specifies to enable Ethernet Connectivity Fault Management monitoring
aggregate—
Applies the rate limit to the sum of the per peer packet rates
car—
Applies the Committed Access Rate (CAR). This keyword causes Eth-CFM packets to be ignored when enforcing the overall-rate.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress SAP Quality of Service (QoS) policies and filter policies.

If no sap-egress QoS policy is defined, the system default sap-egress QoS policy is used for egress processing. If no egress filter is defined, no filtering is performed.

filter

Syntax 
filter ip ip-filter-id
filter
no filter [ip ip-filter-id]
no filter
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command associates an IP filter policy with an ingress or egress Service Access Point (SAP). Filter policies control the forwarding and dropping of packets based on the matching criteria.

MAC filters are only allowed on Epipe and Virtual Private LAN Service (VPLS) SAPs.

The filter command is used to associate a filter policy with a specified ip-filter-id with an ingress or egress SAP. The filter policy must already be defined before the filter command is executed. If the filter policy does not exist, the operation will fail and an error message returned.

In general, filters applied to SAPs (ingress or egress) apply to all packets on the SAP. One exception is non-IP packets are not applied to the match criteria, so the default action in the filter policy applies to these packets.

The no form of this command removes any configured filter ID association with the SAP. The filter ID itself is not removed from the system unless the scope of the created filter is set to local. To avoid deletion of the filter ID and only break the association with the service object, use the scope command within the filter definition to change the scope to local or global. The default scope of a filter is local.

Special Cases 
IES—
Only IP filters are supported on an IES IP interface, and the filters only apply to routed traffic
Parameters 
ip—
Keyword indicating the filter policy is an IP filter.
ip-filter-id—
Specifies the ID for the IP filter policy. Allowed values are an integer in the range of 1 and 65535 that corresponds to a previously created IP filter policy in the configure>filter context.

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id
no qos
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

Associates a Quality of Service (QoS) policy with an egress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface.

QoS egress policies are important for the enforcement of SLA agreements. The policy ID must be defined prior to associating the policy with a SAP or IP interface. If the policy-id does not exist, an error will be returned.

The qos command is used to associate egress QoS policies. The qos command only allows egress policies on SAP or IP interface egress. Attempts to associate a QoS policy of the wrong type returns an error.

Only one ingress QoS policy can be associated with a SAP or IP interface at one time. Attempts to associate a second QoS policy of a given type will return an error.

By default, no specific QoS policy is associated with the SAP or IP interface for egress, so the default QoS policy is used.

The normal behavior is for queues to be created per destination.

The no form of this command removes the QoS policy association from the SAP or IP interface, and the QoS policy reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policy-id—
The egress policy ID to associate with SAP or IP interface on egress. The policy ID must already exist.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

qos

Syntax 
qos policy-id [shared-queuing]
no qos
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

Associates a Quality of Service (QoS) policy with an ingress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface.

QoS ingress policies are important for the enforcement of SLA agreements. The policy ID must be defined prior to associating the policy with a SAP or IP interface. If the policy-id does not exist, an error will be returned.

This qos command is used to associate ingress QoS policies. The qos command only allows ingress policies to be associated on SAP or IP interface ingress.

Only one ingress and one egress QoS policy can be associated with a SAP or IP interface at one time. Attempts to associate a second QoS policy of a given type will return an error.

By default, no specific QoS policy is associated with the SAP or IP interface for ingress so the default QoS policy is used.

The normal behavior is for queues to be created per destination. Shared and multipoint shared change this behavior creating either unicast or unicast and mcast shared queues.

The no form of this command removes the QoS policy association from the SAP or IP interface, and the QoS policy reverts to the default.

Parameters 
policy-id—
The ingress policy ID to associate with SAP or IP interface on ingress. The policy ID must already exist.
Values—
1 to 65535

 

shared-queuing—
This keyword can only be specified on SAP ingress. Specify the ingress shared queue policy used by a SAP. When the value of this object is null it means that the SAP will use individual ingress QoS queues, instead of the shared ones.

policer-control-policy

Syntax 
policer-control-policy policy-name
no policer-control-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command is used to create, delete, or modify policer control policies. The policer-control-policy controls the aggregate bandwidth available to a set of child policers. Once created, the policy can be applied to ingress or egress SAPs. The policy can also be applied to the ingress or egress context of a sub-profile.

The no form of the command resets the command to the default setting.

Default 

no policer-control-policy

Parameters 
policy-name
Specifies the policer control policy name. Each policer control policy name must be unique and adhere to the system policy ASCII naming requirements. If the defined policy name already exists, the system enters that policy’s context for editing purposes. If policy-name does not exist, the system will attempt to create a policy with the specified name.

qinq-mark-top-only

Syntax 
[no] qinq-mark-top-only
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
Description 

When the encapsulation type is qinq for the access port for the specified SAP, enabling this command specifies which P-bits or DEI bit to mark during packet egress. Only the P-bits or DEI bit in the top Q tag are marked. When this command is disabled, both sets of P-bits and the DEI bit are marked.

Default 

no qinq-mark-top-only

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
no scheduler-policy
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>ingress
Description 

This command applies an existing scheduler policy to an ingress or egress scheduler used by ingress SAP queues or egress SAP policers and queues associated with this multi-service customer site. The schedulers defined in the scheduler policy can only be created once the customer site has been appropriately assigned to a chassis port, channel or slot. Scheduler policies are defined in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context.

The no form of this command removes the configured ingress or egress scheduler policy from the multi-service customer site. When the policy is removed, the schedulers created due to the policy are removed also making them unavailable for the SAP policers or queues associated with the customer site. Policers and queues that lose their parent scheduler association are deemed to be orphaned and are no longer subject to a virtual scheduler. The SAPs that have policers or queues reliant on the removed schedulers enter into an operational state depicting the orphaned status of one or more policers or queues. When the no form of the command executed, the customer site ingress or egress node will not contain an applied scheduler policy.

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name:—
Specifies the scheduler policy name to apply to an existing scheduler policy that was created in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context to create the hierarchy of ingress or egress virtual schedulers. The scheduler names defined within the policy are created and made available to any ingress queues or egress policers and queues created on associated SAPs.
Values—
Any existing valid scheduler policy name.

 

host

Syntax 
host ip ip-address [mac ieee-address]] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile sub-profile-name] [sla-profile sla-profile-name]
no host {[ip ip-address] [mac ieee-address]}
no host all
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>ies>if>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command creates a static subscriber host for the SAP. Static subscriber hosts may be used by the system for various purposes. Applications within the system that make use of static host entries include anti-spoof filters and ARP cache population.

Multiple static hosts may be defined on the SAP. Each host is identified by either a source IP address, a source MAC address or both a source IP and source MAC address. Every static host definition must have at least one address defined, IP or MAC.

Static hosts can exist on the SAP even with anti-spoof and ARP populate features disabled. When enabled, each feature has different requirements for static hosts.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Parameters 
anti-spoof—
When enabled, this feature uses static and dynamic host information to populate entries into an anti-spoof filter table. The anti-spoof filter entries generated will be of the same type as specified in the anti-spoof type parameter. If the SAP anti-spoof filter is defined as ip, each static host definition must specify an IP address. If the SAP anti-spoof filter is defined as ip-mac, each static host definition must specify both an IP address and MAC address. If definition of a static host is attempted without the appropriate addresses specified for the enabled anti-spoof filter, the static host definition will fail.
arp-populate—
When enabled, this feature uses static and dynamic host information to populate entries in the system ARP cache.

Attempting to define a static subscriber host that conflicts with an existing DHCP lease state table entry will fail.

Use the no form of the command to remove a static entry from the system. The specified ip-address and mac-address must match the host’s exact IP and MAC addresses as defined when it was created. When a static host is removed from the SAP, the corresponding anti-spoof entry and/or ARP cache entry is also removed.

ip-address —
Specifies this optional parameter when defining a static host. The IP address must be specified for anti-spoof ip, anti-spoof ip-mac and arp-populate. Only one static host may be configured on the SAP with a given IP address.
mac-address —
Specifies this optional parameter when defining a static host. The MAC address must be specified for anti-spoof ip-mac and arp-populate. Multiple static hosts may be configured with the same MAC address given that each definition is distinguished by a unique IP address.
sub-ident-string —
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing subscriber identification profile to be associated with the static subscriber host. The subscriber identification profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-pol context. The subscriber information is used by the VPRN SAP arp-reply-agent to determine the proper handling of received ARP requests from subscribers.

For VPRN SAPs with arp-reply-agent enabled with the optional sub-ident parameter, the static subscriber hosts sub-ident-string is used to determine whether an ARP request received on the SAP is sourced from a host belonging to the same subscriber as the destination host. When both the destination and source hosts from the ARP request are known on the SAP and the subscriber identifications do not match, the ARP request may be forwarded to the rest of the VPRN destinations.

If the static subscriber hosts sub-ident string is not defined, the host is not considered to belong to the same subscriber as another host on the SAP.

If source or destination host is unknown, the hosts are not considered to belong to the same subscriber. (ARP messages from unknown hosts are subject to anti-spoof filtering rules applied at the SAP.)

If sub-ident is not enabled on the SAP arp-reply-agent, subscriber identification matching is not performed on ARP requests received on the SAP.

ARP requests are never forwarded back to the same SAP or within the receiving SAP’s Split Horizon Group.

sub-profile-name
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing subscriber profile name to be associated with the static subscriber host. The subscriber profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sub-profile context.
sla-profile-name
Specify this optional parameter to specify an existing SLA profile name to be associated with the static subscriber host. The SLA profile is configured in the config>subscr-mgmt>sla-profile context.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress SAP Quality of Service (QoS) policies and filter policies.

If no SAP ingress QoS policy is defined, the system default sap-ingress QoS policy is used for ingress processing. If no ingress filter is defined, no filtering is performed.

multi-service-site

Syntax 
[no] multi-service-site customer-site-name
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command creates a new customer site or edits an existing customer site with the customer-site-name parameter. A customer site is an anchor point to create an ingress and egress virtual scheduler hierarchy. When a site is created, it must be assigned to a chassis slot or port. When scheduler policies are defined for ingress and egress, the scheduler names contained in each policy are created according to the parameters defined in the policy. Multi-service customer sites exist for the sole purpose of creating a virtual scheduler hierarchy and making it available to queues on multiple Service Access Points (SAPs).

The scheduler policy association with the customer site normally prevents the scheduler policy from being deleted until after the scheduler policy is removed from the customer site. The multi-service-site object will generate a log message indicating that the association was deleted due to scheduler policy removal.

When the multi-service customer site is created, an ingress and egress scheduler policy association does not exist. This does not prevent the site from being assigned to a chassis slot or prevent service SAP assignment. After the site has been created, the ingress and egress scheduler policy associations can be assigned or removed at anytime.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
customer-site-name—
Each customer site must have a unique name within the context of the customer. If customer-site-name already exists for the customer ID, the CLI context changes to that site name for the purpose of editing the site scheduler policies or assignment. Any modifications made to an existing site will affect all SAPs associated with the site. Changing a scheduler policy association may cause new schedulers to be created and existing policers and queues on the SAPs to no longer be orphaned. Existing schedulers on the site may cease to exist, causing policers and queues relying on that scheduler to be orphaned.

If the customer-site-name does not exist, it is assumed that an attempt is being made to create a site of that name in the customer ID context. The success of the command execution depends on the following:

The maximum number of customer sites defined for the chassis slot has not been met.

The customer-site-name is valid.

The create keyword is included in the command line syntax (if the system requires it).

When the maximum number of customer sites has been exceeded a configuration error occurs, the command will not execute and the CLI context will not change.

If the customer-site-name is invalid, a syntax error occurs, the command will not execute and the CLI context will not change.

Values—
Valid names consist of any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

 

9.25.2.1.16.2. ATM Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

atm

Syntax 
atm
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap
config>service>vprn>if>sap
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap
Description 

This command the context to configure ATM-related parameters. This command can only be used when a given context (for example, a channel or SAP) supports ATM functionality such as:

  1. Configuring ATM port or ATM port-related functionality on MDAs supporting ATM functionality
  2. Configuring ATM-related configuration for ATM-based SAPs that exist on MDAs supporting ATM functionality.

If ATM functionality is not supported for a given context, the command returns an error.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress ATM attributes for the SAP.

encapsulation

Syntax 
encapsulation atm-encap-type
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command configures RFC 2684, Multiprotocol Encapsulation over ATM Adaptation Layer 5, encapsulation for an ATM PVCC delimited SAP.

This command specifies the data encapsulation for an ATM PVCC delimited SAP. The definition references RFC 2684 and to the ATM Forum LAN Emulation specification.

Ingress traffic that does not match the configured encapsulation will be dropped.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

The encapsulation is driven by the services for which the SAP is configured. For IES service SAPs, the default is aal5snap-routed.

Parameters 
atm-encap-type—
Specify the encapsulation type
Values—
aal5snap-routed — Routed encapsulation for LLC encapsulated circuit (LLC/SNAP precedes protocol datagram) as defined in RFC 2684.
aal5mux-ip — Routed IP encapsulation for VC multiplexed circuit as defined in RFC 2684

 

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command configures ingress ATM attributes for the SAP.

traffic-desc

Syntax 
traffic-desc traffic-desc-profile-id
no traffic-desc
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>ingress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>egress
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>ingress
Description 

This command assigns an ATM traffic descriptor profile to a given context (for example, a SAP). When configured under the ingress context, the specified traffic descriptor profile defines the traffic contract in the forward direction. When configured under the egress context, the specified traffic descriptor profile defines the traffic contract in the backward direction.

The no form of the command reverts the traffic descriptor to the default traffic descriptor profile.

Default 

The default traffic descriptor (trafficDescProfileId. = 1) is associated with newly created PVCC-delimited SAPs.

Parameters 
traffic-desc-profile-id—
Specify a defined traffic descriptor profile (see the QoS atm-td-profile command).

oam

Syntax 
oam
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
config>service>vprn>interface >sap>atm
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enters the context to configure OAM functionality for a PVCC delimiting a SAP.

The ATM-capable MDAs support F5 end-to-end OAM functionality (AIS, RDI, Loopback):

  1. ITU-T Recommendation I.610 - B-ISDN Operation and Maintenance Principles and Functions version 11/95
  2. GR-1248-CORE - Generic Requirements for Operations of ATM Network Elements (NEs). Issue 3 June 1996
  3. GR-1113-CORE - Bellcore, Asynchronous Transfer Mode (ATM) and ATM Adaptation Layer (AAL) Protocols Generic Requirements, Issue 1, July 1994

alarm-cells

Syntax 
[no] alarm-cells
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
Description 

This command configures AIS/RDI fault management on a PVCC. Fault management allows PVCC termination to monitor and report the status of their connection by propagating fault information through the network and by driving PVCCs operational status.

When alarm-cells functionality is enabled, PVCCs operational status is affected when a PVCC goes into AIS or RDI state because of an AIS/RDI processing (i.e. assuming nothing else affects PVCCs operational status, PVCC goes DOWN, when it enters a fault state and comes back UP, when it exits that fault state) and RDI cell are generated when PVCC is operationally DOWN. No OAM-specific SNMP trap is raised whenever an endpoint enters/exits an AIS or RDI states, however, if as result of an OAM state change, the PVCC changes operational status, then a trap is expected from an entity the PVCC is associated with (for example a SAP).

The no form of the command disables alarm-cells functionality for a PVCC. When alarm-cells functionality is disabled, PVCCs operational status is no longer affected by PVCCs OAM state changes due to AIS/RDI processing (when alarm-cells is disabled, a PVCC will change operational status to UP, if it was DOWN because of the alarm-cell processing) and RDI cells are not generated as result of PVCC going into AIS or RDI state, however, PVCCs OAM status will record OAM faults as described above.

Default 

Enabled for PVCCs delimiting IES SAPs

periodic-loopback

Syntax 
[no] periodic-loopback
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>if >sap>atm>oam
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>atm
Description 

This command enables periodic OAM loopbacks on this SAP. This command is only configurable on IES and VPRN SAPs. When enabled, an ATM OAM loopback cell is transmitted every period as configured in the config>system>atm>oam>loopback-period period context.

If a response is not received and consecutive retry-down retries also result in failure, the endpoint will transition to an alarm indication signal/loss of clock state. Then, an ATM OAM loopback cell will be transmitted every period as configured in the loopback-period period. If a response is received for the periodic loopback and consecutive retry-up retries also each receive a response, the endpoint will transition back to the up state.

The no form of the command sets the value back to the default.

Default 

no periodic-loopback

9.25.2.1.16.3. Redundant Interface Commands

Note:

The commands described in this section apply only to the 7750 SR.

redundant-interface

Syntax 
[no] redundant-interface ip-int-name
Context 
config>service>ies
config>service>vprn
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command configures a redundant interface.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface. Interface names can be from 1 to 32 alphanumeric characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

remote-proxy-arp

Syntax 
[no] remote-proxy-arp
Context 
config>service>ies>interface
Description 

This command enables remote proxy ARP on the interface.

The no form of the command disables remote proxy ARP on the interface.

Default 

no remote-proxy-arp

address

Syntax 
address {ip-address/mask | ip-address netmask} [remote-ip ip-address]
no address
Context 
config>service>vprn>redundant-interface
Description 

This command assigns an IP address mask or netmask and a remote IP address to the interface.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Parameters 
ip-address/mask—
Assigns an IP address/IP subnet format to the interface
ip-address netmask—
Assigns an IP address netmask to the interface. Specifies a string of 0s and 1s that mask or screen out the network part of an IP address so that only the host computer part of the address remains.
remote-ip ip-address
Assigns a remote IP to the interface

spoke-sdp

Syntax 
[no] spoke-sdp sdp-id
Context 
config>service>vprn
Description 

This command binds a service to an existing Service Distribution Point (SDP).

A spoke SDP is treated like the equivalent of a traditional bridge “port” where flooded traffic received on the spoke SDP is replicated on all other “ports” (other spoke and mesh SDPs or SAPs) and not transmitted on the port it was received.

The SDP has an operational state which determines the operational state of the SDP within the service. For example, if the SDP is administratively or operationally down, the SDP for the service will be down.

The SDP must already be defined in the config>service>sdp context in order to associate an SDP with a VPRN service. If the sdp sdp-id is not already configured, an error message is generated. If the sdp-id does exist, a binding between that sdp-id and the service is created.

SDPs must be explicitly associated and bound to a service. If an SDP is not bound to a service, no far-end 7750 SR devices can participate in the service.

The no form of this command removes the SDP binding from the service. The SDP configuration is not affected; only the binding of the SDP to a service. Once removed, no packets are forwarded to the far-end router.

Special Cases 
VPRN—
Several SDPs can be bound to a VPRN service. Each SDP must be destined to a different 7750 SR OS. If two sdp-id bindings terminate on the same 7750 SR, an error occurs and the second SDP binding is rejected.
Parameters 
sdp-id—
The SDP identifier. Allowed values are integers in the range of 1 and 17407 for existing SDPs
vc-id—
The virtual circuit identifier
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure egress SDP parameters.

ingress

Syntax 
ingress
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp
Description 

This command enters the context to configure ingress SDP parameters.

vc-label

Syntax 
vc-label egress-vc-label
no vc-label [egress-vc-label]
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>egress
Description 

This command configures the egress VC label.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no vc-label

Parameters 
vc-label—
A VC egress value that indicates a specific connection
Values—
16 to 1048575

 

vc-label

Syntax 
vc-label ingress-vc-label
no vc-label [ingress-vc-label]
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>ingress
Description 

This command configures the ingress VC label.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no vc-label

Parameters 
vc-label—
A VC ingress value that indicates a specific connection
Values—
2048 to 18431

 

filter

Syntax 
filter {ip ip-filter-id}
no filter
Context 
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>ingress
config>service>vprn>red-if>spoke-sdp>egress
Description 

This command associates an IP filter policy with an ingress or egress Service Access Point (SAP) or IP interface. An IP filter policy can be associated with spoke SDPs.

Filter policies control the forwarding and dropping of packets based on IP or MAC matching criteria.

The filter command is used to associate a filter policy with a specified ip-filter-id with an ingress or egress SAP. The ip-filter-id must already be defined before the filter command is executed. If the filter policy does not exist, the operation will fail and an error message returned.

In general, filters applied to SAPs (ingress or egress) apply to all packets on the SAP. One exception is non-IP packets are not applied to IP match criteria, so the default action in the filter policy applies to these packets.

The no form of this command removes any configured filter ID association with the SAP or IP interface. The filter ID itself is not removed from the system unless the scope of the created filter is set to local. To avoid deletion of the filter ID and only break the association with the service object, use scope command within the filter definition to change the scope to local or global. The default scope of a filter is local.

Default 

no filter

Parameters 
ip-filter-id
Specifies IP filter policy. The filter ID must already exist within the created IP filters
Values—
1 to 65535

 

9.25.2.1.16.4. SDP Binding Commands

binding

Syntax 
binding
Context 
config>service>sdp
Description 

The command enters the context to configure SDP bindings.

port

Syntax 
port [port-id | lag-id]
no ort
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding
Description 

This command specifies the port or lag identifier, to which the PW ports associated with the underlying SDP are bound. If the underlying SDP is re-routed to a port or lag other than the specified one, the PW ports on the SDP are operationally brought down.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
port-id—
The identifier of the port in the slot/mda/port format
lag-id—
Specifies the LAG identifier

pw-port

Syntax 
pw-port pw-port-id [vc-id vc-id] [create]
no pw-port
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding
Description 

This command creates a pseudowire port.

The no form of the command removes the pseudowire port ID from the configuration.

Parameters 
pw-port-id—
Specifies a unique identifier of the pseudowire port
Values—
1 to 10239

 

vc-id vc-id
Specifies a virtual circuit identifier signaled to the peer
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

description

Syntax 
description description-string
no description
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command creates a text description stored in the configuration file for a configuration context.

The description command associates a text string with a configuration context to help identify the content in the configuration file.

The no form of the command removes the string from the configuration.

Default 

no description

Parameters 
description-string—
Specifies the description character string of the configuration context
Values—
Any string up to 80 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

 

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command enters the context to configure PW-port egress side parameters.

encap-type

Syntax 
encap-type {dot1q | qinq}
no encap-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets the encapsulation type for the PW-port as dot1q or qinq.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

dot1q

Parameters 
dot1q—
Specifies dot1q encapsulation type
qinq—
Specifies qinq encapsulation type

shaper

Syntax 
[no] shaper
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress
Description 

This command configures an egress shaping option for use by a PW port.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

no shaper

int-dest-id

Syntax 
[no] int-dest-id int-dest-id
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress>shaper
Description 

This command specifies the intermediate destination string configured for dynamic Vport selection.

This command is only valid for PW ports used for enhanced subscriber management (ESM on PW).

The no form of the command removes the configured intermediate destination string.

Default 

no.int-dest-id

Parameters 
int-dest-id—
Specifies a text string that describes the intermediate destination ID

vport

Syntax 
vport vport-name
no vport
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port>egress>shaper
Description 

This command configures the name of the Vport to be used for the PW port.

This command is valid for PW ports used for enhanced subscriber management (ESM on pseudowire) and pseudowire SAPs on Ethernet ports. It is not valid for pseudowire ports on the HSMDA.

The no form of the command removes the configured Vport name.

Default 

no vport

Parameters 
vport-name—
Specifies a text string up to 32 characters in length representing the name of the Vport

vc-type

Syntax 
vc-type {ether | vlan}
no vc-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets the forwarding mode for PW-port. The vc-type is signaled to the peer, and must be configured consistently on both ends of the PW. vc-type VLAN is only configurable with dot1q encapsulation on the PW-port. The tag with vc-type vlan only has significance for transport, and is not used for service delineation or ESM. The top (provider tag) is stripped while forwarding out of the PW, and a configured vlan-tag (for vc-type vlan) is inserted when forwarding into the PW. With vc-type ether, the tags if present (max 2), are transparently preserved when forwarding in our out of the PW.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

ether

Parameters 
ether—
Specifies ether as the virtual circuit (VC) associated with the SDP binding
vlan—
Specifies vlan as the virtual circuit (VC) associated with the SDP binding

vlan-vc-tag

Syntax 
vlan-vc-tag vlan-id
no vc-type
Context 
config>service>sdp>binding>pw-port
Description 

This command sets tag relevant for vc-type vlan mode. This tag is inserted in traffic forwarded into the PW.

The no form of the command reverts to the default value.

Default 

0

Parameters 
vlan-id—
Specifies the VLAN ID value
Values—
0 to 4094

 

9.25.2.1.17. RIP Commands

rip-policy

Syntax 
rip-policy policy-name [create]
no rip- policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command creates a RIP policy. This policy is applied to a subscriber IPv4 host to enable the BNG to learn RIP routes from the host. RIP routes are never sent to the hosts.

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the RIP policy name up to 32 characters in length.
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

neighbor

Syntax 
[no] neighbor ip-int-name
Context 
config>router>rip>group
config>service>vprn>rip>group
Description 

This command creates a context for configuring a RIP neighbor interface. By default, group interfaces are not activated with RIP, unless explicitly configured. The BNG will only learn RIP routes from IPv4 host on the group interface. The RIP neighbor group interface will default send to “none”. The send operation is unchangeable for group-interface.

The no form of the command deletes the RIP interface configuration for this group interface. The shutdown command in the config>router>rip>group group-name>neighbor context can be used to disable an interface without removing the configuration for the interface.

Default 

no neighbor

Parameters 
ip-int-name—
The group interface name. Interface names must be unique within the group of defined group interfaces within config service vprn/ies sub-interface grp-interface commands. An interface name cannot be in the form of an IP address. Interface names can be any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes. If the group interface name does not exist, an error message will be returned.

authentication-key

Syntax 
authentication-key [authentication-key | hash-key] [hash | hash2]
no authentication-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>rip-policy
Description 

This command configures the BGP authentication key.

Authentication is performed between neighboring routers before setting up the BGP session by verifying the password. Authentication is performed using the MD-5 message-based digest. The authentication key can be any combination of letters or numbers from 1 to 16.

The no form of the command removes the authentication password from the configuration and effectively disables authentication.

Default 

Authentication is disabled and the authentication password is empty.

Parameters 
authentication-key—
The authentication key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 255 characters in length (unencrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).
hash-key—
The hash key. The key can be any combination of ASCII characters up to 342 characters in length (encrypted). If spaces are used in the string, enclose the entire string in quotation marks (“ ”).

This is useful when a user must configure the parameter, but, for security purposes, the actual unencrypted key value is not provided.

hash—
Specifies the key is entered in an encrypted form. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified
hash2—
Specifies the key is entered in a more complex encrypted form that involves more variables than the key value alone, meaning that the hash2 encrypted variable cannot be copied and pasted. If the hash or hash2 parameter is not used, the key is assumed to be in an unencrypted, clear text form. For security, all keys are stored in encrypted form in the configuration file with the hash or hash2 parameter specified.

authentication-type

Syntax 
authentication-type {none | password | message-digest | message-digest-20}
no authentication-type
Context 
config>sub-mgmg>rip-policy>
Description 

This command sets the type of authentication to be used between RIP neighbors. The type and password must match exactly for the RIP message to be considered authentic and processed.

The no form of the command removes the authentication type from the configuration and effectively disables authentication.

Default 

no authentication-type

Parameters 
none—
Disables authentication at a given level (global, group, neighbor). If the command does not exist in the configuration, the parameter is inherited.
password —
Specifies enable simple password (plain text) authentication. If authentication is enabled and no authentication type is specified in the command, simple password authentication is enabled.
message-digest—
Configures 16 byte message digest for MD5 authentication. If this option is configured, then at least one message-digest-key must be configured.
message-digest-20—
Configures 20 byte message digest for MD5 authentication in accordance with RFC 2082, RIP-2 MD5 Authentication. If this option is configured, then at least one message-digest-key must be configured.

retail-svc-id

Syntax 
retail-svc-id service-id
retail-svc-id
Context 
config>service>ies|vprn>sub-if>grp-if>sap>static-host
Description 

This command specifies the service id of the retailer IES/VPRN service to which the static IPv6 host belongs. A corresponding retailer subscriber interface must exist in the specified service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no retail-svc-id

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies the retailer service ID or retailer service name
Values—
service-id: 1 to 2148007978
svc-name: A string up to 64 characters in length

 

rip

Syntax 
[no] rip
Context 
config>service>vprn
config>service>ies
Description 

This command enables the RIP protocol on the given VPRN IP interface.

The no form of the command disables the RIP protocol from the given VPRN IP interface.

Default 

no rip

group

Syntax 
[no] group group-name
Context 
config>service>vprn>rip
config>service>ies>rip
Description 

This command creates a context for configuring a RIP group of neighbors. RIP groups are a way of logically associating RIP neighbor interfaces to facilitate a common configuration for RIP interfaces.

The no form of the command deletes the RIP neighbor interface group. Deleting the group will also remove the RIP configuration of all the neighbor interfaces currently assigned to this group.

Default 

no group

Parameters 
group-name—
The RIP group name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.

9.25.2.1.18. Vport Commands

ethernet

Syntax 
ethernet
Context 
config>port
Description 

This command the context to configure Ethernet port attributes.

This context can only be used when configuring Fast Ethernet, gigabit or 10-G Fast Ethernet or Ethernet LAN ports on an appropriate MDA.

egress-scheduler-override

Syntax 
[no] egress-scheduler-override
Context 
config>port>ethernet
Description 

This command applies egress scheduler overrides. When a port scheduler is associated with an egress port, it is possible to override the following parameters:

  1. The max-rate allowed for the scheduler.
  2. The maximum rate for each priority level 8 through 1.
  3. The CIR associated with each priority level 8 through 1.

See the SR OS Quality of Service Guide for command syntax and usage for the port-scheduler-policy command.

The no form of this command removes all override parameters from the egress port or channel scheduler context. Once removed, the port scheduler reverts all rate parameters back to the parameters defined on the port-scheduler-policy associated with the port.

Default 

no egress-scheduler-override

level

Syntax 
level priority-level rate pir-rate [cir cir-rate]
no level priority-level
Context 
config>port>ethernet>egress-scheduler-override
Description 

This command overrides the maximum and CIR rate parameters for a specific priority level on the port or channel’s port scheduler instance. When the level command is executed for a priority level, the corresponding priority level command in the port-scheduler-policy associated with the port is ignored. The override level command supports the keyword max for the rate and cir parameter. When executing the level override command, at least the rate or cir keywords and associated parameters must be specified for the command to succeed.

The no form of this command removes the local port priority level rate overrides. Once removed, the port priority level will use the port scheduler policies level command for that priority level.

Default 

no level

Parameters 
priority-level—
Identifies which of the eight port priority levels are being overridden
Values—
1 to 8

 

pir-rate
Overrides the port scheduler policy’s maximum level rate and requires either the max keyword or a rate defined in kilobits-per-second to follow
Values—
1 to 40000000, max

 

cir-rate
Overrides the port scheduler policy’s within-cir level rate and requires either the max keyword or a rate defined in kilobits-per-second to follow
Values—
0 to 40000000, max

 

max—
Removes any existing rate limit imposed by the port scheduler policy for the priority level allowing it to use as much total bandwidth as possible

access

Syntax 
access
Context 
config>port>ethernet
Description 

This command configures Ethernet access port parameters.

egress

Syntax 
egress
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access
Description 

This command enters the context to configure Ethernet access egress port parameters.

vport

Syntax 
vport name [create]
no vport name
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress
Description 

This command configures a scheduling node, referred to as virtual port, within the context of an egress Ethernet port. The Vport scheduler operates either like a port scheduler with the difference that multiple Vport objects can be configured on the egress context of an Ethernet port, or it can be an aggregate rate when an egress port-scheduler policy is applied to the port.

The Vport is always configured at the port level even when a port is a member of a LAG.

When a port scheduler policy is applied to a Vport the following command is used:

configure>port>ethernet>acess>egress>vport>port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name

The CLI will not allow the user to apply a port scheduler policy to a Vport if one has been applied to the port. Conversely, the CLI will not allow the user to apply a port scheduler policy to the egress of an Ethernet port if one has been applied to any Vport defined on the access egress context of this port. The agg-rate-limit, along with an egress port-scheduler, can be used to ensure that a given Vport does not oversubscribe the port’s rate.

SAP and subscriber host queues can be port-parented to a Vport scheduler in a similar way they port-parent to a port scheduler or can be port-parented directly to the egress port-scheduler if the agg-rate-limit is used.

When the Vport uses an aggregate rate, the following command is used:

configure>port>ethernet>acess>egress>vport>agg-rate-limit

The no form of the command removes the Vport name from the configuration.

Default 

no vport

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the Vport scheduling node and can be up to 32 ASCII characters in length. This does not need to be unique within the system but is unique within the port or a LAG.
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

agg-rate-limit

Syntax 
agg-rate-limit agg-rate
no agg-rate-limit
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command configures an aggregate rate for the Vport. This command is mutually exclusive with the port-scheduler-policy command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no agg-rate-limit

Parameters 
agg-rate
Specifies the rate limit for the Vport
Values—
max, 1 to 10000000

 

egress-rate-modify

Syntax 
[no] egress-rate-modify
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command is used to apply HQoS Adjustment to a Vport. HQoS Adjustment refers to the dynamic adjustment of the rate limit at an QoS enforcement point within router when the multicast traffic stream is disjointed from the unicast traffic stream. This QoS enforcement point within router represents the physical point further down in the access part of the network where the two streams join each other and potentially can cause congestion.

An example would be a PON port which is shared amongst subscriber’s multicast traffic (single copy of each channel) and subscriber’s unicast traffic. The bandwidth control point for this PON port resides in the upstream router BNG node in the form of a Vport. In case that the multicast delivery method in the router BNG utilizes redirection, the multicast traffic in the router BNG will flow outside of the subscriber or the Vport context and thus will bypass any bandwidth enforcement in the router. To correct this, a Vport bandwidth adjustment is necessary in the router that will account for the multicast bandwidth consumption that is bypassing Vport in the router but is present in the PON port whose bandwidth is controlled by Vport.

An estimate of the multicast bandwidth consumption on the PON port can be made at the Vport level based on the IGMP messages sourced from the subscribers behind the PON port. This process is called HQoS Adjustment.

A multicast channel bandwidth is subtracted from or added to the Vport rate limit according to the received IGMP Join/Leave messages and the channel bandwidth definition policy associated with the Vport (indirectly through a group-interface). Since the multicast traffic on the PON port is shared amongst subscribers behind this PON port, only the first IGMP Join or the last IGMP Leave per multicast channel is tracked for the purpose of the Vport bandwidth modification.

The Vport rate that will be affected by this functionality depends on the configuration:

  1. In case the agg-rate-limit within the Vport is configured, its value will be modified based on the IGMP activity associated with the subscriber under this Vport.
  2. In case the port-scheduler-policy within the Vport is referenced, the max-rate defined in the corresponding port-scheduler-policy will be modified based on the IGMP activity associated with the subscriber under this Vport.

The channel bandwidth definition policy is defined in the mcac policy in the configure>router>mcac>policy context. The policy is applied under the group-interface or in case of redirection under the redirected-interface.

The rates in effect can be displayed with the following two commands:

show port 1/1/5 vport name

qos scheduler-hierarchy port port-id vport vport-name

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport, which is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces, is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport, which is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces, is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no egress-rate-modify

host-match

Syntax 
host-match dest destination-string [create]
no host-match dest destination-string
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egr>qgrp
Description 

This command configures host matching for the Ethernet port egress queue-group.

The no form of the command removes the destination string from the configuration.

Parameters 
destination-string
Specify a host match destination string up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword used to create the host match. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context

port-scheduler-policy

Syntax 
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name
no port-scheduler-policy
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command specifies the destination and organization strings to be used for matching subscriber hosts with this Vport.

The parent Vport of a subscriber host queue, which has the port-parent option enabled, is determined by matching the destination string dest string associated with the subscriber and the organization string org string associated with the subscriber host with the strings defined under a Vport on the port associated with the subscriber.

If a given subscriber host policers or queue does not have the port-parent option enabled, it will be foster-parented to the Vport used by this subscriber and which is based on matching the dest string and org string. If the subscriber could not be matched with a Vport on the egress port, the host policer or queue will not be bandwidth controlled and will compete for bandwidth directly based on its own PIR and CIR parameters.

By default, a subscriber host policer or queue with the port-parent option enabled is scheduled within the context of the port’s port scheduler policy.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command. Applying a scheduler policy to a Vport is only applicable to Ethernet interfaces.

The no form of the command removes the port-scheduler-policy-name from the configuration.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no port-scheduler-policy

Parameters 
port-scheduler-policy-name—
Specifies an existing port-scheduler-policy configured in the config>qos context

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
no scheduler-policy
Context 
config>port>ethernet>access>egress>vport
Description 

This command specifies a scheduler policy to associate to the Vport. Scheduler policies are configured in the configure>qos>scheduler>policy context. Each scheduler policy is divided up into groups of schedulers based on the tier each scheduler is created under. A tier is used to give structure to the schedulers within a policy and define rules for parent scheduler associations. The policy defines the hierarchy and operating parameters for virtual schedulers.

The no form of this command removes the configured egress scheduler policy from the Vport.

The agg-rate rate, port-scheduler-policy and scheduler-policy commands are mutually exclusive. Changing between the use of a scheduler policy and the use of an agg-rate/port-scheduler-policy involves removing the existing command and applying the new command.

The configuration of a scheduler policy under a Vport is mutually exclusive with the configuration of the egress-rate-modify parameter.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no scheduler-policy

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name—
The scheduler-policy-name parameter applies an existing scheduler policy that was created in the config>qos>scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name context to create the hierarchy of egress virtual schedulers.

parent-location

Syntax 
parent-location {default | sla}
no parent-location
Context 
config>qos>sap-egress
Description 

This command determines the expected location of the parent schedulers for queues configured with a parent command within the SAP egress policy. All parent schedulers must be configured within a scheduler policy applied at the location corresponding to the parent-location parameter.

If a parent scheduler name does not exist at the specified location, the queue will not be parented and will be orphaned.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

parent-location default

Parameters 
default—
Specifies that the queues should look for their in the SAP's egress scheduler-policy or the multi-service-site's egress scheduler policy depending on which is configured and Subscriber queues will look for their parents in the subscriber-profile's egress scheduler-policy.When the SAP egress policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the queues must be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the subscriber’s SUB profile. When the SAP egress policy is applied to a SAP, the parent schedulers of the queues need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the SAP or the multi-service site.
sla—
Specifies that the queues should look for their parent in the SLA-profile's egress scheduler-policy; all queues that are not port-parented and to which SLA-profile is not applicable will behave as orphans in this case.When the SAP egress policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the queues must be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the same SLA profile. If this parameter is configured within a SAP egress policy that is applied to any object except of the egress of an SLA profile, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the queues will not be parented and will be orphaned.

parent-location

Syntax 
parent-location {none | sub | vport}
no parent-location
Context 
config>qos>scheduler-policy
Description 

This command determines the expected location of the parent schedulers for the tier 1 schedulers configured with a parent command within the scheduler policy. The parent schedulers must be configured within a scheduler policy applied at the location corresponding to the parent location parameter.

If a parent scheduler name does not exist at the specified location, the schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned.

The configuration of parent-location and frame-based-accounting commands in a scheduler policy is mutually exclusive in to ensure consistency between the different scheduling levels.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

parent-location none

Parameters 
none—
This parameter indicates that the tier 1 schedulers do not have a parent scheduler and the configuration of the parent under a tier 1 scheduler is blocked. Conversely, this parameter is blocked when any tier 1 scheduler has a parent configured.
sub—
When the scheduler policy is applied to an SLA profile for a subscriber, the parent schedulers of the tier 1 schedulers need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the subscriber’s SUB profile.

If this parameter is configured within a scheduler policy that is applied to any object except for the egress of an SLA profile, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the tier 1 schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned.

vport—
When the scheduler policy is applied to an SLA profile, a SUB profile for a subscriber or to the egress of a PW SAP, the parent schedulers of the tier 1 schedulers need to be configured in the scheduler policy applied to the VPORT to which the subscriber will be assigned.

If this parameter is configured within a scheduler policy that is applied to to any object except for the egress of an SLA profile or SUB profile, or to the egress of a PW SAP, the configured parent schedulers will not be found and so the tier 1 schedulers will not be parented and will be orphaned. This parameter is not supported when policers-hqos-manageable is configured in the SAP egress QoS policy.

9.25.2.1.18.1. MLD Policy Commands

mld-policy

Syntax 
mld-policy mld-policy-name [create]
no mld-policy mld-policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to create an MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no mld-policy

Parameters 
mld-policy-name—
Specifies the MLD policy name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

disable-router-alert-check

Syntax 
[no] disable-router-alert-check
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command disables router alert checking for MLD messages received on this interface. The no form of the command enables router alert checking.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no disable-router-alert-check

egress-rate-modify

Syntax 
egress-rate-modify agg-rate-limit
egress-rate-modify scheduler scheduler-name
no egress-rate-modify
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the egress rate modification.

The no form of the command removes the values from the configuration.

Default 

no egress-rate-modify

Parameters 
agg-rate-limit—
Specifies that the maximum total rate for all subscriber egress queues for each subscriber associated with the policy
scheduler-name
Specifies the scheduler to be applied for egress rate modification

fast-leave

Syntax 
[no] fast-leave
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enables fast leave. When fast leave processing is enabled, the router will immediately remove a SAP or SDP from the IP multicast group when it detects an MLD leave on that SAP or SDP. Fast leave processing allows the switch to remove a SAP or SDP that sends a leave from the forwarding table without first sending out group-specific queries to the SAP or SDP, and thus speeds up the process of changing channels (zapping).

Fast leave should only be enabled when there is a single receiver present on the SAP or SDP.

When fast leave is enabled, the configured last-member-query-interval value is ignored.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no fast-leave

import

Syntax 
import policy-name
no import
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command specifies the import routing policy to be used. Only a single policy can be imported at a time.

The no form of the command removes the policy association.

Default 

no import

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the import policy name. Allowed values are any string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes. Routing policies are configured in the config>router>policy-options context The router policy must be defined before it can be imported.

max-num-groups

Syntax 
max-num-groups count
no max-num-groups
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command defines the maximum number of multicast groups that can be joined. If the router receives a join message that would exceed the configured number of groups, the request is ignored.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no max-num-groups

Parameters 
count —
Specifies the maximum number of groups that can be joined
Values—
1 to 1000

 

max-num-grp-sources

Syntax 
max-num-grp-sources [max-num-grp-sources]
no max-num-grp-sources
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of group sources for which MLD can have local receiver information based on received MLD reports on this interface. When this configuration is changed dynamically to a value lower than currently accepted number of group sources, the group sources that are already accepted are not deleted. Only new group sources will not be allowed. When this object has a value of 0, there is no limit to the number of group sources.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Default 

no max-num-grp-sources

Parameters 
max-num-grp-sources
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowed to be tracked per group
Values—
1 to 32000

 

max-num-sources

Syntax 
max-num-sources max-num-sources
no max-num-sources
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the maximum number of multicast sources allowed per group.

The no form of the command removes the value from the configuration.

Parameters 
max-num-sources—
Specifies the maximum number of multicast sources allowed per group
Values—
1 to 1000

 

per-host-replication

Syntax 
[no] per-host-replication
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enables per-host-replication. In the per-host-replication mode, multicast traffic is replicated per each host within the subscriber irrespective of the fact that some hosts may be subscribed to the same multicast stream. As a result, in case that multiple hosts within the subscriber are registered for the same multicast group, the multicast streams of that group will be generated. The destination MAC address of multicast streams will be changed to unicast so that each host receives its own copy of the stream. Multicast traffic in the per-host-replication mode can be classified via the existing QoS CLI structure. As such the multicast traffic will flow through the subscriber queues. HQoS Adjustment is not needed in this case.

The alternative behavior for multicast replication in IPoE environment is per-SAP- replication. In this model, only a single copy of the multicast stream is sent per SAP, irrespective of the number of hosts that are subscribed to the same multicast group. This behavior applies to 1:1 connectivity model as well as on 1:N connectivity model (SAP centric behavior as opposed to subscriber centric behavior).

In the per-SAP-replication model the destination MAC address is multicast (as opposed to unicast in the per-host-replication model). Multicast traffic is flowing via the SAP queue which is outside of the subscriber context. The consequence is that multicast traffic is not accounted in the subscriber HQoS. In addition, HQoS Adaptation is not supported in the per SAP replication model.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no per-host-replication

query-interval

Syntax 
query-interval seconds
no query-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command specifies the frequency at which the querier router transmits general host-query messages. Host-query messages solicit group membership information and are sent to the link-scope all-node address, FF02::1. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config> service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no query-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the frequency, in seconds, at which the router transmits general host-query messages
Values—
2 to 1024

 

query-last-listener-interval

Syntax 
query-last-listener-interval seconds
no query-last-listener-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the frequency at which the querier router sends a group-specific query messages, including the messages sent in response to leave-group messages. The shorter the interval, the faster the loss of the last member of a group can be detected. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-last-listener-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config>service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the frequency, in seconds, at which query messages are sent
Values—
1 to 1023

 

query-response-interval

Syntax 
query-response-interval seconds
no query-response-interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command configures the query response interval. If nothing is configured, by default, the query-response-interval takes the value defined in the config>router>mld context or in the config>service>vprn>mld context. It is highly recommended that all three query intervals be configured together on each MLD policy.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no query-response-interval

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the length of time that the querier router waits to receive a response to from the host
Values—
1 to 1023

 

redirection-policy

Syntax 
redirection-policy policy-name
no redirection-policy
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command will apply multicast redirection action to the subscriber. The redirection action along with the redirected interface (and possibly service id) is defined in the referenced policy-name. MLD messages will be redirected to an alternate interface if that alternate interface has MLD enabled. The alternate interface does not have to have any multicast groups registered via MLD. Currently all MLD messages are redirected and there is no ability to selectively redirect MLD messages based on match conditions (multicast-group address, source IP address, and so on). Multicast redirection is supported between VPRN services and also between interfaces within the Global Routing Context. Multicast Redirection is not supported between the VRPN services and the Global Routing Table (GRT).

MLD state is maintained per subscriber host and per redirected interface. Traffic is however forwarded only on the redirected interface.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies a redirection policy name up to 32 characters in length. This is a regular policy defined under the configure>router>policy-option>policy-statement context

static

Syntax 
static
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure MLD static group membership parameters.

group

Syntax 
[no] group grp-ipv6-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static
Description 

This command configures a static multicast group.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no group

Parameters 
grp-ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address
Values—
<grp-ipv6-address> : ipv6-address - x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces) x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d
x - [0 to FFFF]H
d - [0 to 255]D
- multicast group IPv6 address

 

source

Syntax 
[no] source ipv6-address
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static>group
Description 

This command adds or removes a static multicast source.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
grp-ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address
Values—
<grp-ipv6-address> : ipv6-address - x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces) x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d
x - [0 to FFFF]H
d - [0 to 255]D
- multicast group IPv6 address

 

starg

Syntax 
[no] starg
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy>static>group
Description 

This command adds a static (*,G) entry. This command can only be enabled if no existing source addresses for this group are specified.

The no form of the command removes the starg entry from the configuration.

Default 

no starg

version

Syntax 
version version
no version
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>mld-policy#
Description 

This command configures the MLD version.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

version 2

Parameters 
version—
Specifies the MLD version
Values—
1, 2

 

9.25.2.1.18.2. IPoE Session Commands

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy policy-name [create]
no ipoe-session-policy policy-name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures an IPoE session policy. The policies are referenced from subscriber interfaces, group interfaces and capture SAPs. Multiple IPoE session policies can be configured.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the IPoE policy name up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

circuit-id-from-auth

Syntax 
[no] circuit-id-from-auth
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command takes the circuit ID value from the authentication server to identify the session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no circuit-id-from-auth

description

Syntax 
description description-string
no description
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command takes the circuit-id value from the authentication server when it creates a text description stored in the configuration file for a configuration context.

The description command associates a text string with a configuration context to help identify the context in the configuration file.

The no form of this command removes any description string from the context.

Default 

no description

Parameters 
description-string—
Specifies a text string describing the entity. Allowed values are any string up to 80 characters in length, composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters excluding double quotes. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes..

session-key

Syntax 
session-key sap mac [cid] [rid]
no session-key
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command configures the key to logically group subscriber hosts that belong to the same dual stack end device in an IPoE session.

The SAP and MAC address are always part of the IPoE session key. Optionally the Circuit-Id/Interface-Id or Remote-Id can be added to the session key.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

sap mac

Parameters 
sap —
Includes the SAP as part of the IPoE session key. The sap parameter is mandatory and cannot be removed from the key
mac—
Includes the MAC address as part of the IPoE session key. The mac parameter is mandatory and cannot be removed from the key
cid—
Optionally adds the DHCPv4 Relay Agent Circuit-Id (Option 82, sub Option 1) and DHCPv6 Interface-Id (Option 18) field to the IPoE session key
rid—
Optionally adds the DHCPv4 Relay Agent Remote-Id (Option 82, sub Option 2) and DHCPv6 Remote-Id (Option 37) field to the IPoE session key. For DHCPv6, the enterprise number is excluded from the key.

sap and mac are mandatory parameters while cid and rid are optional and mutually exclusive. Valid IPoE session key parameters are: sap mac, sap mac cid and sap mac rid.

session-timeout

Syntax 
session-timeout timeout
no session-timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>ipoe-policy
Description 

This command defines the time in seconds between 1 second and 360 days before the IPoE session will be disconnected. The default value is unlimited session timeout.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no session-timeout

Parameters 
timeout—
Specifies the session timeout in seconds
Values—
1 to 31104000

 

sap

Syntax 
sap sap-id [create] [capture-sap]
Context 
config>service>vpls
Description 

This command declares a given SAP as a primary (or secondary) VPLS port.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
capture-sap—
Specifies a capturing SAP in which triggering packets will be sent to the CPM. Non-triggering packets captured by the capture SAP will be dropped. This parameter applies to the 7450 ESS or 7750 SR only.
create—
Specifies to create a SAP instance. The create keyword requirement can be enabled/disabled in the environment>create context

ipoe-session

Syntax 
[no] ipoe-session
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if
config>service>vprn>sub-if
Description 

This command configures IPoE session parameters.

force-auth

Syntax 
force-auth [cid-change] [rid-change]
force-auth disabled
no force-auth
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

By default, if the circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id in the IPoE session re-authentication trigger packet (such as a DHCP renewal) is not empty and different from the circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id stored in the IPoE session data, a forced re-authentication is performed, ignoring the configured min-auth-interval. This default behavior can be changed with this command.

The no form of the command reverts to the default behavior.

Default 

force-auth cid-change rid-change force-auth disabled on wlan-gw group interfaces

Parameters 
cid-change —
Perform a forced re-authentication upon a circuit-id/interface-id change. An empty circuit-id/interface-id is not considered a change
rid-change —
Perform a forced re-authentication upon a remote-id change. an empty remote-id is not considered a change. For DHCPv6, the enterprise number is excluded from the comparison.
disabled —
Specifies that the min-auth-interval never is ignored. The system does not perform a forced re-authentication upon a circuit-id/interface-id or remote-id change.

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy policy-name
no ipoe-session-policy
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the IPoE session policy applicable for this group interface or capture SAP.

On WLAN GW group interfaces, it is not possible to change this value.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no ipoe-session-policy ipoe-session-policy default on WLAN GW group interfaces

Parameters 
policy-name —
Specifies the IPoE session policy name up to 32 characters in length

min-auth-interval

Syntax 
min-auth-interval [days days] [hrs hours] [min minutes] [sec seconds]
min-auth-interval infinite
no min-auth-interval
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

Re-authentication for IPoE sessions enable dynamic policy changes.

This command configures the maximum frequency of re-authentications by specifying a minimum interval between two non-forced authentications for the same IPoE session.

A forced authentication is by default triggered by a circuit-id, interface-id or remote-id change (see the force-auth command).

Re-authentications are, by default, disabled and can be enabled by configuring a min-auth-interval.

Setting the min-auth-interval to zero seconds will always re-authenticate on each trigger packet.

The no form of the command reverts to the default behavior.

Default 

infinite

Parameters 
days
Specifies the min number of days between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 365

 

hours
Specifies the min number of hours between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 23

 

minutes
Specifies the min number of minutes between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 59

 

seconds
Specifies the min number of seconds between two non-forced authentications for IPoE sessions
Values—
0 to 59

 

infinite —
Does not perform non-forced re-authentications for IPoE sessions (default)

radius-session-timeout

Syntax 
radius-session-timeout {backwards-compatible | ignore | absolute}
no radius-session-timeout
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies how to interpret the session-timeout coming from a RADIUS VSA in an Access-Accept or CoA message.

The value of this command can only be changed on wlan-gw group interfaces.

The no form of this command to resets the default behavior.

Default 

absolute (backward compatible on wlan-gw group interfaces)

Parameters 
backwards-compatible —
Specifies that the VSA will be interpreted as an IPv4 lease time if the Alc-Lease-Time attribute is not present and an absolute timeout otherwise. The VSA will be treated the same as for non-ipoe session DHCP hosts
ignore —
Specifies that the VSA meaning is irrelevant for IPoE session and should be ignored
absolute —
Specifies that the VSA would be treated as a timeout starting from the moment the IPoE session is set up

sap-session-limit

Syntax 
sap-session-limit sap-session-limit
no sap-session-limit
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the number of IPoE sessions per SAP allowed for this group-interface

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
sap-session-limit —
Specifies the number of allowed IPoE sessions
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071 131071 on wlan-gw group interfaces

 

session-limit

Syntax 
session-limit session-limit
no session-limit
Context 
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command specifies the number of IPoE sessions allowed for this group interface or retail subscriber interface.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
session-limit—
Specifies the number of allowed IPoE sessions
Note:

The operational maximum value may be smaller due to equipped hardware dependencies.

Values—
1 to 131071
1 – 500000 (retail subscriber interface)

 

user-db

Syntax 
user-db local-user-db-name
no user-db
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

This command configures the local user database to use for IPoE session authentication.

When configured on a capture SAP, the group interface must have the same local user database configured.

On a wlan-gw group interface, the no form of this command indicates that the user database will be picked from the following sources in the order shown:

  1. dhcp
  2. ipv6>dhcp6
  3. ipv6>router-solicit

If no user database can be found in any of these locations, processing continues as if no user database was configured. This behavior is for backwards compatibility reasons only; when using a LUDB, it should be explicitly added to the IPoE session configuration.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no user-db

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the local user database name up to 32 characters in length

shutdown

Syntax 
[no] shutdown
Context 
config>service>vpls>sap> ipoe-session
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if>ipoe-session
Description 

The shutdown command enables or disables IPoE session management on a group interface or capture SAP.

A shutdown of the IPoE session CLI hierarchy on a group-interface will clear all active IPoE sessions on that interface, resulting in a deletion of all corresponding subscriber hosts.

On wlan-gw group interfaces it is not possible to disable an IPoE session.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

shutdown no shutdown on wlan-gw group interfaces

9.25.2.1.19. SHCV Policy Commands

shcv-policy

Syntax 
shcv-policy name [create]
no shcv-policy name
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command configures a Subscriber Host Connectivity Verification (SHCV) policy. An SHCV policy can be applied to both the subscriber management group interface and VPLS instances. All SHCV-related features inside a group interface and a VPLS service will follow the configuration specified in the SHCV policy. The SHCV policy and the SHCV configuration on a group interface are mutually exclusive. Only one can be applied to the group interface.

The no form of the command removes the policy name from the configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the SHCV policy, up to 32 characters in length
create—
Keyword required to create the configuration context

layer-3

Syntax 
layer-3
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior parameters for IES and VPRN services.

source-ip-origin

Syntax 
source-ip-origin {interface | vrrp}
no source-ip-origin
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>layer-3
Description 

This command selects the source IP address to be used for SHCV messages.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Parameters 
interface—
Specifies to use the interface IP as the source address of SHCV
vrrp—
Specifies to use the VRRP configured IP as the source address of SHCV

periodic

Syntax 
periodic
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure periodic SHCV properties for the subscriber management group-interface. This tool will periodically scan all known DHCP hosts only and perform unicast ARP/NS requests. The subscriber host connectivity verification will maintain state (connected vs. not-connected) for all hosts.

action

Syntax 
action {alarm | remove}
no action
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the action to take when the periodic connectivity verification failed.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

alarm

Parameters 
alarm—
Raises an alarm indicating that the host is disconnected
remove—
Raises an alarm and releases all allocated resources (addresses, prefixes, queues, table entries, and so on). Static hosts are removed.

interval

Syntax 
interval minutes
no interval
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command specifies the time interval which all known sources should be verified. The actual rate is dependent on the number of known hosts and intervals.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

30 minutes

Parameters 
minutes—
Specifies the interval, in minutes, between periodic connectivity checks
Values—
1 to 6000

 

retry-count

Syntax 
retry-count [count]
no retry-count
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the number of retransmissions.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1 — For trigger-type ip-conflict, host-limit-exceeded and mobility

10 — For trigger-type inactivity and MAC learning

Parameters 
count
Specifies the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification
Values—
2 to 29

 

timeout

Syntax 
timeout seconds
no timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>periodic
Description 

This command configures the timeout before a retransmission in triggered connectivity verification.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

10

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the timeout, in seconds, before a retransmission in triggered connectivity verification
Values—
10 to 60

 

trigger

Syntax 
trigger trigger-type
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enables to context to configure SHCV triggers.

Parameters 
trigger-type—
Specifies the trigger SHCV properties for the subscriber management group-interface.
Values—
ip-conflict — Upon detecting an IP conflict for the new host, a trigger SHCV is sent using a unicast ARP/NS. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
host-limit-exceeded — Upon exceeding the host-limit for (sla-profile, ipoe-session sap-session-limit, ipoe-session session-limit, and arp-host), a trigger SHCV is sent. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
inactivity — A trigger SHCV is sent to the idle host to verify the host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system.
mobility — Detects detects an IP or MAC conflict between different SAPs. Upon detecting a MAC or an IP conflict, a trigger SHCV is sent. The request will verify the old host’s connectivity to the BNG. An unresponsive host will be removed from the system, allowing the new host to connect. The new host must resend its address request in order to be created as an ESM host in the system.
mac-learning — Specifies the trigger SHCV properties to learn the MAC address of static hosts. Upon a no shutdown, a trigger SHCV is sent to the host to learn the host’s MAC address.

 

retry-count

Syntax 
retry-count [count]
no retry-count
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>trigger
Description 

This command configures the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1

Parameters 
count
Specifies the number of retransmissions in periodic connectivity verification
Values—
1 to 29

 

timeout

Syntax 
timeout seconds
no timeout
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>trigger
Description 

This command configures the timeout before a retransmission.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

1 for trigger-type ip-conflict, host-limit-exceeded and mobility

2 for trigger-type inactivity and mac-learning

Parameters 
seconds—
Specifies the retry timeout in seconds
Values—
1 to 60

 

vpls

Syntax 
vpls service-id
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in VPLS services. Refer to the Layer 2 Service Guide for VPLS service command syntax and descriptions.

vprn

Syntax 
vprn service-id
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in VPRN services. Refer to the Layer 3 Services Guide for VPRN service command syntax and descriptions.

ies

Syntax 
ies service-id
Context 
config>service
Description 

This command enters the context to configure SHCV behavior in IES services. Refer to the Layer 3 Services Guide for IES service command syntax and descriptions.

shcv-policy-ipv4

Syntax 
shcv-policy-ipv4 name
no shcv-policy-ipv4
Context 
config>service>vpls
config>service>vpls>sap
config>service>ies>if
config>service>vprn>if
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the shcv-policy to be used exclusive for IPv4 subscriber hosts. The shcv-policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

shcv-policy-ipv6

Syntax 
shcv-policy-ipv6 name
no shcv-policy-ipv6
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the SHCV policy to be used exclusive for IPv6 subscriber hosts. The policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

shcv-policy

Syntax 
shcv-policy name
no shcv-policy
Context 
config>service>vprn>sub-if>grp-if
config>service>ies>sub-if>grp-if
Description 

This command references the SHCV policy to be used for both IPv4 and IPv6 subscriber hosts. The policy name must already exist in the config>subscr-mgmt context.

The no form of this command removes the policy name from the service configuration.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies an existing SHCV policy name up to 32 characters in length

source-ip

Syntax 
source-ip ip-address
no source-ip
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>vpls
Description 

This command configures the IPv4 address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no source-ip

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IPv4 address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service

source-mac

Syntax 
source-mac ieee-address
no source-mac
Context 
config>subscr-mgmt>shcv-policy>vpls
Description 

Specifies the MAC address to be used as source address for connectivity verification in a VPLS service.

The no form of the command reverts to the default.

Default 

no source-mac

Parameters 
ieee-address—
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address in the xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx or xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx format

9.25.2.2. Show Commands

Note:

The command outputs in the following section are examples only; actual displays may differ depending on supported functionality and user configuration.

diameter-peer-policy

Syntax 
diameter-peer-policy [peer-policy-name]
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name peer peer-name [statistics]
diameter-peer-policy peer-policy-name client-side-peer-ip ip-address port tcp-port [statistics]
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays diameter peer policy information and diameter peer information and statistics. For the diameter proxy, the incoming peer can be specified with an IP address and port number.

Parameters 
peer-policy-name—
Specifies the diameter peer policy name, up to 32 characters in length
peer-name —
Specifies the diameter peer name, up to 32 characters in length
ip address —
Specifies the IP address of the incoming peer (client side) of a diameter proxy
tcp-port —
Specifies the TCP port number of the incoming peer (client side) of a diameter proxy
statistics —
Displays the diameter peer statistics with details per diameter application, per message type, and per direction (rx/ tx)
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA Diameter peer policy information.

Sample Output
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1
===============================================================================
Last Mgmt Change      : 01/07/2016 20:05:12
Applications          : gy
Role                  : client
Description           : Diamater peer policy - gy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Diameter Config Values
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Origin Host           : bng.domain.com
Origin Realm          : domain.com
Source IPv4 Address   : 192.0.2.51
Source IPv6 Address   : N/A
Router                : Base               Transaction Timer  : 30 (default)
Watchdog Timer        : 30 (default)       Connection Timer   : 30 (default)
Vendor Support        : 3GPP (default)
Python Policy         : py-policy-diam-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Peer Name            Oper  PSM State     Susp  Cooldown  Pref  Order  Pri/Sec
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
peer-1               Yes   I-Open        No    -         30    1      Primary
peer-2               No    Closed        No    -         50    -      -
===============================================================================
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1" peer "peer-1"
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1
===============================================================================
Peer IP address        : 172.16.1.1
Last Mgmt Change       : 01/07/2016 20:05:12
Peer Operational       : Yes              Watchdog Algorithm Active   : Yes
Peer State Machine     : I-Open           Watchdog Answer Pending     : No
Connection Timer  (Tc) : -                Connection Suspended        : No
Transaction Timer (Tt) : -                Cooldown Sequence Pending   : No
Watchdog Timer    (Tw) : 17               Cooldown Sequence Active    : No
Primary/Secondary Peer : Primary          Cooldown Sequence Progress  : -
Preference Order       : 1                Peer Removal Pending        : No
Pending Messages       : 0
===============================================================================
# show aaa diameter-peer-policy "diameter-peer-policy-1" peer "peer-1" statistics
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy : diameter-peer-policy-1 (statistics)
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer             : peer-1
Time statistics cleared   : 01/07/2016 20:05:10
===============================================================================
                                      Request     Answer    Request     Answer
                                           Tx         Rx         Rx         Tx
===============================================================================
Aggregates
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                       1          1          0          0
Failed                                      0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 0 (Base)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Capabilities-Exchange                       1          1          0          0
Disconnect-Peer                             0          0          0          0
Device-Watchdog                             0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 1 (NASREQ)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Authorization-Authentication                0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 4 (Gy)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Credit-Control (Initial)                    0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Update)                     0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Termination)                0          0          0          0
Re-Auth                                     0          0          0          0
Abort-Session                               0          0          0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application ID 16777238 (Gx)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Credit-Control (Initial)                    0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Update)                     0          0          0          0
Credit-Control (Termination)                0          0          0          0
Re-Auth                                     0          0          0          0
Abort-Session                               0          0          0          0
===============================================================================

Table 87 provides a description of the counters in the output of the show aaa diameter-peer-policy command. and Table 88 provides the failure reasons for the aggregate Failed counter (Request Rx and Answer Rx).

Table 87:  show aaa diameter-peer-policy Field Descriptions 

Counter

Counts  

Aggregates Total

Request Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully transmitted diameter request messages (all applications, all message types)

Answer Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully received diameter answer messages (all applications, all message types)

Request Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully received diameter request messages (all applications, all message types)

Answers Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all successfully transmitted diameter answer messages (all applications, all message types)

Aggregates Failed

Request Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all request messages that could not be sent for internal reasons, such as TCP socket error (for example, congestion), failure reported to application (for example, no retries left)

Dropped by Python — Timeouts (requests for which no answer was received within the configured timeout interval)

Answer Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all Answer messages that failed to be successfully decoded, such as such as invalid header length or a violation against the Command Code Format (CCF) specification.

See Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters for more information.

Request Rx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all Request messages that failed to be successfully decoded, such as invalid header length or a violation against the Command Code Format (CCF) specification.

See Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters for more information.

Answers Tx

Aggregated counter — Sum of all answer messages that could not be sent for internal reasons such as TCP socket error (for example, congestion).

Dropped by Python

Application ID id message type

Request Tx

Successfully transmitted diameter request messages for the corresponding application and message type

Answer Rx

Successfully received diameter answer messages for the corresponding application and message type

Request Rx

Successfully received diameter request messages for the corresponding application and message type

Answers Tx

Successfully transmitted diameter answer messages for the corresponding application and message type

Table 88:  Aggregate Failed Request Rx and Answer Rx counters 

Role

Failed reasons 

Proxy

Proxy (message length too short / too long / version unsupported)

Consistency check failed: header size, message length, illegal flag combination, AVP header too small, AVP present but not allowed (base RFC messages), and so on

Not a base message

Not a request

Tx overload (message received to be send to client)

Dropped by python

Failed to create answer

No transaction (answer to server, but request is not found - 5 min.)

Diameter base / Diameter application

Message dropped due to result code

Message too big / too small

Dropped by python

Consistency check failed

end-2-end mismatch hop-to-hop command code (answer/request mismatch)

Cool down sequence drop

cc error request

Application id in header error

T bit in header

isa-radius-policy

Syntax 
isa-radius-policy policy-name
isa-radius-policy policy-name associations
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays ISA RADIUS policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information about the specified ISA RADIUS policy
associations—
Displays the information associated with the ISA RADIUS server policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA ISA RADIUS policy information.

Sample Output
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show aaa isa-radius-policy "ZiggoAAA_DRP_ISAPlcy" 
===============================================================================
Status for ISA RADIUS server policy "ZiggoAAA_DRP_ISAPlcy"
===============================================================================
Server 1, group 1, member 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Purposes Up                                     : accounting authentication
Source IP address                               : 172.18.128.33
Acct Tx Requests                                : 2469931
Acct Tx Retries                                 : 320
Acct Tx Timeouts                                : 160
Acct Rx Replies                                 : 2469471
Auth Tx Requests                                : 16417061
Auth Tx Retries                                 : 7169
Auth Tx Timeouts                                : 2922
Auth Rx Replies                                 : 16406973
CoA Rx Requests                                 : 0
 
Table 89:  Subscriber ISA RADIUS Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Purposes Up

Indicates the RADIUS services that are up and running, and fully operational for this server.

Source IP address

Indicates the IP address of the RADIUS server.

Acct Tx Requests

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests transmitted.

Acct TX Retries

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction request retries.

Acct TX Timeouts

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that have timed out.

Acct RX Replies

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction responses received.

Auth Tx Requests

Indicates the number of authentication requests transmitted.

Auth Tx Retries

Indicates the number of authentication request retries.

Auth Tx Timeouts

Indicates the number of RADIUS authentication requests that have timed out for the policy.

CoA RX Requests

Indicates the number of Change-of-Authorization message responses received.

radius-configuration

Syntax 
radius-configuration
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays RADIUS configuration information.

Output 

The following output is an example of AAA RADIUS configuration information.

Sample Output
# show aaa radius-configuration 
===============================================================================
RADIUS configuration
===============================================================================
CoA Port                    : 3799
===============================================================================

Table 89 provides a description of the counters in the output of the show aaa isa-radius-policy command.

Table 90:  AAA ISA RADIUS Policy Field Descriptions  

Label

Description

CoA Port

Displays the RADIUS Change of Authorization (CoA) port.

 

radius-server-policy

Syntax 
radius-server-policy policy-name [acct-on-off]
radius-server-policy policy-name associations
radius-server-policy policy-name msg-buffer-stats
radius-server-policy policy-name statistics
radius-server-policy [acct-on-off]
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays RADIUS server policy configuration information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information for the specified RADIUS server policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the RADIUS server policy.
msg-buffer-stats—
Displays statistics related to the RADIUS messages that are buffered for each specified RADIUS server policy
statistics—
Displays statistics for the specified RADIUS server policy
act-on-off—
Displays the admin state of the acct-on-off feature
Output 

The following output is an example of AAA RADIUS server policy information.

Sample Output
Table 91:  Subscriber RADIUS Server Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Tx transaction requests

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests transmitted.

Rx transaction responses

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction responses received.

Transaction requests timed out

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that have timed out.

Transaction requests send failed

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that could not be transmitted.

Packet retries

Indicates the number of times a RADIUS request packet was retransmitted to a server.

Transaction requests send rejected

Indicates the number of RADIUS transaction requests that were not transmitted due to unacceptable configuration.

Authentication requests failed

Indicates the number of authentication failures for this policy.

Accounting requests failed

Indicates the number of accounting failures for this policy.

Ratio of access-reject over auth responses

Indicates the ratio of access-rejects in the auth responses for this policy.

Transaction success ratio

Indicates the transaction success ratio for this policy.

Transaction failure ratio

Indicates the transaction failure ratio for this policy.

Statistics last reset at

Indicated the date and time at which the statistics for this policy were last reset.

*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show aaa radius-server-policy "ZiggoAAA_anycast" statistics 
===============================================================================
RADIUS server policy "ZiggoAAA_anycast" statistics
===============================================================================
Tx transaction requests                         : 24818681
Rx transaction responses                        : 24817329
Transaction requests timed out                  : 1351
Transaction requests send failed                : 0
Packet retries                                  : 12410
Transaction requests send rejected              : 0
Authentication requests failed                  : 303530
Accounting requests failed                      : 0
Ratio of access-reject over auth responses      : 13%
Transaction success ratio                       : 99%
Transaction failure ratio                       : 1%
Statistics last reset at                        : 05/21/2015 01:11:39

wpp

Syntax 
wpp portal-group name
wpp [portal-group name] [host ip-address] hosts
Context 
show>aaa
Description 

This command displays information about the specified WPP portal group or the WPP hosts controlled by the WPP portal group.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the name of the WPP portal group up to 32 characters in length
ip-address—
Specifies the IP address of the WPP host
hosts—
Output 

The following output is an example of WPP portal group or WPP host information.

Sample Output
show aaa wpp portal-group "test" 
===============================================================================
wpp portal group "test"
===============================================================================
administrative state                  : in-service
controlled router                     : 500
number of enabled interfaces          : 1
triggered hosts                       : disabled
last management change                : 01/02/2017 19:02:11
===============================================================================

ancp-policy

Syntax 
ancp-policy [policy-name]
ancp-policy policy-name association
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Displays information for the specified ANCP policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the ANCP policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP policy information.

Sample Output
A:cses-E11>config>subscr-mgmt>ancp# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy "test"
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "test"
===============================================================================
I. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
I. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
I. Rate Monitor        : 63360 kbps
I. Rate Monitor Alarm  : Yes
I. Rate Modify         : N/A
 
E. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
E. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
E. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
E. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
E. Rate Modify         : N/A
 
Port Down : N/A
 
Last Mgmt Change: 02/13/2013 19:15:28
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11>config>subscr-mgmt>ancp# 

ancp-string

Syntax 
ancp-string
ancp-string ancp-string
ancp-string customer customer-id site customer-site-name
ancp-string sap sap-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) string information.

Parameters 
ancp-string—
Specifies an Access Node Control Protocol (ANCP) string up to 63 characters in length
customer-id
Specifies an existing customer ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

customer-site-name
Specifies an existing customer site name up to 32 characters in length
sap-id
Displays ANCP string information for the specified SAP ID
Values—

<sap-id>

null

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | aps-id>

dot1q

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | aps-id | pw-id>:qtag1

qinq

<port-id | bundle-id | bpgrp-id | lag-id | pw-id>:qtag1.qtag2

atm

<port-id | aps-id>[:vpi/vci | vpi | vpi1.vpi2 | cp.conn-prof-id]

cp

keyword

conn-prof-id

[1 to 8000]

frame

<port-id | aps-id>:dlci

cisco-hdlc

slot/mda/port.channel

cem

slot/mda/port.channel

ima-grp

<bundle-id>[:vpi/vci | vpi | vpi1.vpi2 | cp.conn-prof-id]

cp

keyword

conn-prof-id

[1 to 8000]

port-id

slot/mda/port[.channel]

bundle-id

bundle-<type>-slot/mda.<bundle-num>

bundle

keyword

type

ima | fr | ppp

bundle-num

[1 to 336]

bpgrp-id

bpgrp-<type>-<bpgrp-num>

bpgrp

keyword

type

ima | ppp

bpgrp-num

[1 to 2000]

aps-id

aps-<group-id>[.channel]

aps

keyword

group-id

[1 to 64]

ccag-id

ccag-<id>.<path-id>[cc-type]:<cc-id>

ccag

keyword

id

[1 to 8]

path-id

[a | b]

cc-type

[.sap-net |.net-sap]

cc-id

[0 to 4094]

eth-tunnel

eth-tunnel-<id>[:<eth-tun-sap-id>]

id

[1 to 1024]

eth-tun-sap-id

[0 to 4094]

lag-id

lag-<id>

lag

keyword

id

[1 to 800]

pw-id

pw-<id>

pw

keyword

id

[1 to 10239]

qtag1

[0 to 4094]

qtag2

[* | 0 to 4094]

vpi

[0 to 4095] (NNI)

[0 to 255] (UNI)

vci

[1 | 2 | 5 to 65535]

dlci

[16 to 1022]

tunnel-id

tunnel-<id>.<private | public>:<tag>

tunnel

keyword

id

[1 to 16]

tag

[0 to 4094]

 

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP string information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string "ANCP-0000003-0000001"
========================================================================
ANCP-String "ANCP-0000003-0000001"
========================================================================
Type       : SUB - "4AACAHCU74"
State      : Up                 Ancp Policy: N/A
I. Rate    : 129 kbps           E. Rate    : 130 kbps
Adj I. Rate: N/A                Adj E. Rate: N/A
Act I. Rate: N/A                Act E. Rate: N/A
Service Id : 50 (VPRN)
Group      : linux
Neighbor   : 10.0.0.2:34885
Persist Key: N/A
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Actual-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream              : 129 kbits/s
Actual-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream            : 130 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream             : 131 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream           : 132 kbits/s
Attainable-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream          : 133 kbits/s
Attainable-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream        : 134 kbits/s
Maximum-Net-Data-Rate-Upstream             : 135 kbits/s
Maximum-Net-Data-Rate-Downstream           : 136 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Low-Power-Data-Rate-Upstream   : 137 kbits/s
Minimum-Net-Low-Power-Data-Rate-Downstream : 138 kbits/s
Maximum-Interleaving-Delay-Upstream        : 139 ms
Actual-Interleaving-Delay-Upstream         : 140 ms
Maximum-Interleaving-Delay-Downstream      : 141 ms
Actual-Interleaving-Delay-Downstream       : 142 ms
DSL-Line-State                             : 2 (IDLE)
Access-Loop-Encapsulation                  : 16909056 (0x01020300)
========================================================================
 

authentication

Syntax 
authentication policy-name association
authentication [policy-name]
authentication [policy-name] statistics
authentication coa-statistics
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber management RADIUS authentication policy information and statistics.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the subscriber management RADIUS authentication policy name, up to 32 characters in length, for which information is requested
association—
Displays SAP, interface, local user database host, AA and L2TP associations of this policy
coa-statistics—
Displays the overall statistics for incoming RADIUS Change of Authorization (CoA) messages and Disconnect Messages. For dropped requests, a counter for different drop reasons is available.
statistics—
Displays a list of policies with basic statistics (without specifying a policy name) or detailed statistics, including per-server statistics for the specified policy-name. These statistics apply only to the legacy RADIUS server configuration method where the servers are directly configured in the authentication policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management authentication information.

Sample Output
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
auth-policy-1                    Radius auth policy - servers
auth-policy-2                    Radius auth policy - radius-server-policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Authentication Policies : 2
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-2" 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy auth-policy-2
===============================================================================
Description          : Radius auth policy - radius-server-policy
Re-authentication    : Yes                 Username Format      : MAC Address
PPPoE Access Method  : PAP/CHAP            Username Mac-Format  : "aa:"
PPP-Username Oper    : None                
PPP-Domain-Name      : N/A
Username Oper        : None                
Domain-Name          : N/A
Acct-Stop-On-Fail    : 
RADIUS Server Policy : "aaa-server-policy-1"
Fallback Action      : deny                
Last Mgmt Change     : 06/24/2013 21:16:50 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include Radius Attributes
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Remote Id            : Yes                 Circuit Id           : Yes
NAS Port Id          : Yes                 NAS Identifier       : Yes
PPPoE Service Name   : Yes                 DHCP Vendor Class Id : Yes
Access Loop Options  : Yes                 MAC Address          : Yes
NAS Port Prefix      : None                NAS Port Suffix      : None
NAS-Port-Type        : Yes (standard)      Acct Session Id      : Host
Calling Station Id   : Yes (sap-string)    Called Station Id    : Yes
Tunnel Server Attr   : Yes                 DHCP Options         : Yes
NAS Port             : Yes                 
NAS Port Bits Spec   : *3s*1m*4p*12o*12i
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Servers
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Router               : management + Base   Source Address       : N/A
Access Algorithm     : Direct              Retry                : 3
Timeout (s)          : 5                   Hold down time (s)   : 30
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Index IP Address      Port  Pend-Req-Limit Out/Overload time (s) Oper State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Radius Servers configured.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Accept Radius Attributes
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Matching Entries
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Script Policies
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Access-Request          : "N/A"
Access-Accept           : "N/A"       
Change-of-Authorization : "N/A"
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-2" association 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy auth-policy-2
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Interface Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 3000 (VPRN)
 - If Name : group-int-ws-1-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db PPPoE Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db : ludb-1
 - Host : host-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db DHCP Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local-User-Db : ludb-1
 - Host : default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Application Assurance Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
No associated L2TP groups found.
No associated L2TP tunnels found.
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication statistics 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy Statistics
===============================================================================
Policy Name                       Subscr. Pkts   Subscr. Pkts   Subscr. Pkts
                                  Authenticated  Rejected       Rejected
                                                                Send Failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
auth-policy-1                     0              0              0
auth-policy-2                     0              0              0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Authentication Policies : 2
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication "auth-policy-1" statistics 
===============================================================================
Authentication Policy Statistics
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy name                               : auth-policy-1
subscriber packets authenticated          : 0
subscriber packets rejected               : 0
subscriber packets rejected send failed   : 0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
radius server     requests  requests  requests  requests   requests requests
idx IP-address    accepted  rejected  no reply  md5 failed pending  send failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1 172.16.1.1      0         0         0         0          0        0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
# show subscriber-mgmt authentication coa-statistics 
===============================================================================
Radius Notify Statistics    Change-Of-Authorization   Disconnect-Messages
===============================================================================
Requests Received             7                        10
Requests Accepted             5                        6
Requests Rejected             2                        4
Requests Dropped              0                        0
    No Auth Policy found      0                        0
    Invalid message           0                        0
    Out of resources          0                        0
    Authentication failure    0                        0
===============================================================================
 
Table 92:  Subscriber Authentication Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Requests Received

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests received.

Requests Accepted

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests accepted.

Requests Rejected

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected.

Requests Dropped

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests dropped.

No Auth Policy found

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests found.

Invalid message

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected because of decode errors.

Out of resources

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests rejected due to lack of resources.

Authentication Failure

Indicates the number of notify Change-of-Authorization requests which do not have NAS-Port-ID or Framed-IP-Address set or have mismatched subscriber-id.

category-map

Syntax 
category-map [category-map]
category-map category-map subscribers
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays category map information.

With no parameters specified, a summary view of all configured category maps is displayed.

With the optional category-map name parameter specified, the detailed configuration of the specified category map name is displayed.

With the category-map subscribers parameters specified, all subscribers that have the specified category-map associated are displayed.

Parameters 
category-map
Specifies the category map name for which information is displayed
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management category map information.

Sample Output
Node# show subscriber-mgmt category-map "cat-map-1"
===============================================================================
Category Map: cat-map-1
===============================================================================
Description        : gy - time and volume
Credit Type        : volume             Credit Exh. Thresh.: 80%
Activity Thresh.   : 0 kb/s
Gx session level
usage monitoring   : false
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Category: cat-1-time
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Description        : Rating group for Time quota
Credit Type Over.  : none               Rating Group       : 11
OutOfCredit Action : none
Default Credit     : none
Ingress Queues     : 1
Egress Queues      : 1
Ingress Policers   : none
Egress Policers    : none
ExhCrdSvcLvl Pir   : none
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Category: cat-1-volume
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Description        : Rating group for Volume quota
Credit Type Over.  : none               Rating Group       : 12
OutOfCredit Action : none
Default Credit     : none
Ingress Queues     : 1
Egress Queues      : 1
Ingress Policers   : none
Egress Policers    : none
ExhCrdSvcLvl Pir   : 100
===============================================================================

diameter-application-policy

Syntax 
diameter-application-policy [name]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays Diameter application policy information.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be displayed
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management Diameter application policy information

Sample Output
# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
diameter-gx-policy-1             Diameter Gx policy
diameter-gy-policy-1             Diameter Gy policy
diameter-nasreq-policy-1         Diameter NASREQ policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of policies: 3
===============================================================================
 
 
# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Description                 : Diameter NASREQ policy
Session failover            : enabled
Failover handling           : continue
Peer policy                 : diameter-peer-policy-1
Application                 : nasreq
Tx timer (s)                : 10
Last management change      : 02/28/2015 14:53:49
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
NASREQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include AVP                 : nas-port-id
                              nas-port-type
NAS-Port-Id prefix type     : none
NAS-Port-Id suffix type     : user-string
NAS-Port-Id suffix          : @bng1
NAS-Port-Type type          : standard
 
User name format            : mac
User name operation         : no-operation
MAC address format          : aa:
Last management change      : 02/28/2015 14:53:49
===============================================================================
Interfaces using diameter-auth-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Interface-name                   Service-id Type
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
group-int-1-1                    1000       IES
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of interfaces: 1 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
VPLS SAP's with diameter-auth-policy "diameter-nasreq-policy-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service    SAP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10         1/1/4:*.*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of SAP's: 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-application-policy "diamapppol_gx"
===============================================================================
DIAMETER application policy "diamapppol_gx"
===============================================================================
Description                 : (Not Specified)
Session failover            : enabled
Failover handling           : retry-and-terminate
Peer policy                 : diampeerpol_gx
Application                 : gx
Tx timer (s)                : 10
Last management change      : 05/08/2015 05:55:59
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Gx
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Include AVP                 : an-gw-address
Calling-Station-Id type     : mac
NAS-Port bits spec          : 0
NAS-Port-Id prefix type     : user-string
NAS-Port-Id prefix          : Testing
NAS-Port-Id suffix type     : circuit-id
NAS-Port-Type value         : 0
User-Equipment-Info         : mac
 
Subscription-Id-Data origin : subscriber-id
Subscription-Id-Data type   : e164
MAC address format          : aa:
Report IP address event     : enabled
CCR-t replay interval       : 60
Last management change      : 05/08/2015 06:54:27
 

diameter-session

Syntax 
diameter-session
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command enters the context to display diameter session information.

ccrt-replay

Syntax 
ccrt-replay [session-id session-id] [diameter-application-policy name]
ccrt-replay summary
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>diam-session
Description 

This command displays information about diameter Gx sessions that are in Credit-Control-Request Session-Terminate-Request (CCR-T) replay mode.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be deleted
session-id
Identifies a diameter session ID
summary—
Displays summarized information about CCRT replay
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management CCR-T replay information.

Sample Output
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:21:46 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay session-id ro 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:21:27
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay summary 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Total Count   : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt diameter-session ccrt-replay diameter-application-
policy "diamapppol_gx" 
===============================================================================
Diameter Sessions in CCR-t Replay Mode
===============================================================================
Session-id                                                  Replay Time Left
    Diameter Application Policy                         
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
router.workstation.be;1431089354;13
    diamapppol_gx                                           0d 21:18:49
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Matching Entries: 1
===============================================================================
 

mac

Syntax 
mac all | ieee-address | unknown
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by MAC address.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors starting with the lowest MAC address
ieee-address—
Shows only the error of a specific MAC address
unknown—
Shows errors with unknown MAC addresses, such as for PPPoA subscribers
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management listed by MAC addresses.

Sample Output
*A:eng-BNG-2# show  subscriber-mgmt errors mac all
===============================================================================
Subscriber management errors
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:46.0
Service   : 1000
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:16.0
Service   : 1000
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
===============================================================================

sap

Syntax 
sap all | sap-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by SAP.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors starting with the lowest SAP index
sap-id—
Shows only the error of a specific SAP index
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management errors listed by SAP.

Sample Output
A:BNG-2# show  subscriber-mgmt errors sap all
===============================================================================
Subscriber management errors
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP       : 1/1/20:841
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:46.0
Service   : 1000
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
Time      : 2016/06/23 17:35:16.0
Service   : 1000
MAC       : 00:00:10:10:12:13
Error     : No Offer from DHCP server after Discover from DHCP client
Extra     : DHCPv4
===============================================================================

sdp

Syntax 
sdp all | sdp-id:vc-id
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command sorts all the subscriber errors by SDP.

Parameters 
all—
Shows all errors beginning with the lowest SDP index
sdp-id:vc-id—
Shows only the error of a specific SDP index

unknown-origin

Syntax 
unknown-origin
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt>errors
Description 

This command lists errors of an unknown origin. Errors shown do have a corresponding SAP ID or a SDP ID.

explicit-subscriber-map

Syntax 
explicit-subscriber-map
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays explicit subscriber mappings.

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management explicit subscriber map information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# explicit-subscriber-map
===============================================================================
Explicit Subscriber Map
===============================================================================
Key                              Sub profile
                                 SLA profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_ident_A_1                    sub_prof80
                                 sla_prof80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Explicit Subscriber Mappings : 1
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt#

host-lockout-policy

Syntax 
host-lockout-policy
host-lockout-policy policy-name association
host-lockout-policy policy-name
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state sap sap-id [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [circuit-id circuit-id] [sap sap-id] [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [mac ieee-address] [sap sap-id] [summary]
host-lockout-policy policy-name lockout-state [remote-id remote-id] [sap sap-id] [summary]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays host lockout policy information.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies a specific subscriber host lockout policy name up to 32 characters
association—
Specifies to display the association of the host lockout policy
lockout-state—
Specifies to display information for hosts in a specific lockout state
Values—
all, active, graceful

 

sap sap-id
Specifies to display SAP ID information
circuit-id circuit-id—
Specifies to display circuit ID information. The circuit-id is 256 characters maximum.
mac ieee-address
Specifies to display MAC address information up to 30 characters in length
remote-id remote-id—
Specifies to display remote ID information up to 256 characters in length
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management host lockout policy information.

Sample Output
*A:cses-E11# show subscriber-mgmt host-lockout-policy
===============================================================================
Host Lockout Policies
===============================================================================
Lockout Policy                   Last Mgmt Change
  Lockout Time Min                 Lockout Time Max
Description
  Lockout Reset Time               Max Lockout Hosts
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
test                             04/20/2012 19:51:02
  10                               3600
test
  60                               100
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11# 
 
 
*A:cses-E11# show subscriber-mgmt host-lockout-policy "test"
===============================================================================
Host Lockout Policy "test"
===============================================================================
Description                        test
Last Mgmt Change                   04/20/2012 19:51:02
Lockout time min                   10
Lockout time max                   3600
Lockout reset time                 60
Max lockout hosts                  100
Host key                           all
===============================================================================
*A:cses-E11#

igmp-policy

Syntax 
igmp-policy
igmp-policy policy-name association
igmp-policy policy-name
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays IGMP policy information and only applies to the 7750 SR.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies an existing IGMP policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the IGMP policy
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management IGMP policy information.

Sample Output
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policies
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy                                                                    
  Import Policy                    Admin Version                    
Description                                                                    
  Num Subscribers                  Host Max Groups                  
  Fast Leave                                
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
pol1                                                                           
                                   3
  2                                0
  fast-leave                       
pol2                                                                           
                                   3
  0                                0
  fast-leave                       
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C# 
 
 
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy "pol1" 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy pol1
===============================================================================
Import Policy                         : 
Admin Version                         : 3
Num Subscribers                       : 2
Host Max Group                        : 0
Fast Leave                            : yes
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C#
 
 
*B:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt igmp-policy "pol1" association 
===============================================================================
IGMP Policy pol1 Associations
===============================================================================
sub_1                                                                          
sub_2                                                                          
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of subscriber(s): 2
===============================================================================
*B:Dut-C#

ipoe-session-policy

Syntax 
ipoe-session-policy ipoe-session-policy-name [association]
ipoe-session-policy
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays IPoE session policy information.

Parameters 
ipoe-session-policy-name—
Specifies the IPoE session policy name up to 32 characters in length
association—
Displays the interface and captures SAPs that reference the IPoE session policy
Output 

The following output is an example of IPoE session policy information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt ipoe-session-policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
IPoE Session Policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
Description           : IPoE policy
Last Mgmt Change      : 02/28/2015 11:51:25
Session Key           : sap-mac
Session Timeout       : unlimited
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt ipoe-session-policy "ipoe-policy-1" association
===============================================================================
IPoE Session Policy "ipoe-policy-1"
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPoE Interface Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 1000 (IES)
 - group-int-1-1
Service-Id : 2000 (VPRN)
 - group-int-1-1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Capture SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 10 (VPLS)
- 1/1/4:*.*
===============================================================================
 

local-user-db

Syntax 
local-user-db local-user-db-name association [dhcp] [ppp] [12tp] [radius] [pppoe] [dhcp6] [capture-sap] [rtr-solicit] [wpp] [ipoe]
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-all-hosts
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-host ipoe-host-name
local-user-db local-user-db-name ipoe-unmatched-hosts
local-user-db [local-user-db-name]
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-all-hosts
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-host pppoe-host-name
local-user-db local-user-db-name pppoe-unmatched-hosts
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays local user database information.

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the name of a local user database up to 32 characters in length
association—
Displays entities associated with the specified local user database
dhcp—
Displays DHCP information
ppp—
Displays PPP information
l2tp—
Displays L2TP information
radius—
Displays RADIUS information
pppoe—
Displays PPPoE information
dhcp6—
Displays DHCP6 information
capture-sap—
Displays capture SAP information
rt-solicit—
Displays RT solicit information
wpp—
Displays WPP information
ipoe—
Displays IPoE information
ipoe-all-hosts—
Displays IPoE all hosts information
ipoe-host-name
Displays IPoE host name information
ipoe-unmatched-hosts—
Displays IPoE unmatched hosts information
ppp-all-hosts—
Displays information about PPP all hosts
pppoe-hosts—
Displays information about PPPoE hosts
pppoe-unmatched-hosts—
Displays information about PPPoE unmatched hosts
Output 

The following output is an example of local user database information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db
===============================================================================
Local User Databases
===============================================================================
Name                             Admin Host  Description
                                 State Count
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
database01                       Down  1
database02 Provider001/Class0002 Down  0     This is a long testdescription wi*
test                             Down  2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Local User Databases : 3     Number of Hosts : 3
===============================================================================
* indicates that the corresponding row element may have been truncated.
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db database01
===============================================================================
Local User Database "database01"
===============================================================================
Admin State          : Down
Last Mgmt Change     : 11/08/2007 12:27:36
Host Count           : 1
DHCP Match Types     : circ-id
DHCP CircId Mask Pfx : test
DHCP CircId Mask Sfx : N/A
PPPoE Match Types    : N/A
PPPoE CircId Mask Pfx: N/A
PPPoE CircId Mask Sfx: N/A
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db database01 dhcp-all-hosts
===============================================================================
Local User Database "database01" DHCP hosts
===============================================================================
Name                             Admin     Matched objects
                                 State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
host001                          Down      -
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of DHCP Hosts : 1
===============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" dhcp-host host001
===============================================================================
DHCP Host "host001"
===============================================================================
Admin State          : Down
Last Mgmt Change     : 11/08/2007 12:13:42
 
Host Identification
 Circuit Id          : N/A
 Mac Address         : N/A
 Remote Id           : N/A
 Sap Id              : N/A
 Service Id          : N/A
 String              : N/A
 Option 60           : N/A
 System Id           : N/A
 
Matched Objects      : N/A
 
Address              : N/A
 
Identification Strings
 Subscriber Id       : N/A
 SLA Profile String  : N/A
 Sub Profile String  : N/A
 App Profile String  : N/A
 ANCP String         : N/A
 Inter Destination Id: N/A
===============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" dhcp-unmatched-hosts
==============================================================================
Local User Database "database01" DHCP unmatched hosts
==============================================================================
Name                              Reason      Duplicate Host
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
host002                           No match    N/A                             
host003                           Duplicate   host001                         
host004                           No match    N/A                             
host005                           Duplicate   host001                         
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of DHCP Unmatched Hosts : 4
==============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" association
===============================================================================
DHCP Servers where database01 is used
===============================================================================
Server-Name                      Router-Name                                   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
dhcpS1                           vprn1000                                      
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Server(s): 1
===============================================================================
Interfaces where database01 is used for authentication
===============================================================================
Interface-Name                   Service-Id Type                               
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Interface(s): 0
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 
 
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# local-user-db "database01" association dhcp
===============================================================================
DHCP Servers where database01 is used
===============================================================================
Server-Name                      Router-Name                                   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
dhcpS1                           vprn1000                                      
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Server(s): 1
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
===============================================================================
 
# show subscriber-mgmt local-user-db "ludb-1" association ipoe
===============================================================================
IPoE client interface associations for ludb-1
===============================================================================
Interface-Name                           Svc-Id     Type
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
group-int-1-1                            1000       IES
group-int-1-1                            2000       VPRN
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Interface(s): 2
===============================================================================
===============================================================================
Capture SAP associations for ludb-1
===============================================================================
SAP                              Svc-Id     Type   PPPoE PPP IPoE DHCP DHCP6 RS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4:1202.*                     10         VPLS   y         y    y    y     y
1/1/4:*.*                        10         VPLS   y         y    y    y     y
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of SAP(s): 2
===============================================================================
 

msap-policy

Syntax 
msap-policy [msap-policy-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays Managed SAP policy information.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Displays information about the specifies MSAP policy
association—
Displays information related to the specifies MSAP policy
Output 

The following output is an example of managed SAP policy information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt# msap-policy
===============================================================================
Managed SAP Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Num    Description
                                 MSAPs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
test                             0      (Not Specified)
test 1                           0      (Not Specified)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of MSAP Policies : 2
Number of MSAPs         : 0
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>show>subscr-mgmt#
 

pcc-rule

Syntax 
pcc-rule
pcc-rule monitoring-key key detail
pcc-rule rule-id id detail
pcc-rule rule-name rule-name
pcc-rule rule-name rule-name detail
pcc-rule summary
pcc-rule monitoring-key key
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays a list of pcc-rules and associated monitoring keys in the system.

Parameters 
key
Displays details about a specific monitoring-key
id
Displays details about a specific pcc-rule
rule-name
Displays information about a specific pcc-rule
summary—
Displays summarized information for a active rules in the system
key
Displays information about a specific monitoring-key
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management PCC rule information.

Sample Output
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule summary 
===============================================================================
PCC Rules Summary
===============================================================================
Nbr Active PCC Rules    : 26 / 1023
Nbr Active Combinations
  IPv4 Filter           : 2 / 4095
  IPv6 Filter           : 0 / 4095
  Egress Qos            : 1 / 4095
  Ingress Qos           : 1 / 4095
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule 
===============================================================================
                       Id      Dir  ForwardAction         QosAction
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
name      : RULE_egress_FC
monitorKey: -
                       29      egr  -                      fc
name      : RULE_egress_UM
monitorKey: um_RULE_egress_UM
                       34      egr  -                      monitor
name      : RULE_ingress_FC
monitorKey: -
                       37      ingr -                      fc
name      : RULE_ingress_UM
monitorKey: um_RULE_ingress_UM
                       50      ingr -                      monitor
name      : RULE_egress_DROP
monitorKey: -
                       28      egr  drop                  -
name      : RULE_ingress_RDR
monitorKey: -
                       49      ingr fwd nh4               -
name      : RULE_egress_UM_FC
monitorKey: um_RULE_egress_UM_FC
                       35      egr  -                      fc monitor
===============================================================================
 
 
show subscriber-mgmt pcc-rule rule-name "RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR" detail 
===============================================================================
PCC Rules
===============================================================================
PCC rule name         : RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
PCC rule id           : 47
Monitoring key        : um_RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
Flow status           : Enabled
Nbr of Flows          : 1 (ingress)
HTTP-Redirect         : -
Next-Hop Redir. IPv4  : 10.10.10.10
Next-Hop Redir. IPv6  : -
QoS Ingr. CIR/PIR     : 1000 kbps / 2000 kbps
QoS Egr. CIR/PIR      : - / -
FC change             : h2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Flows
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Src. IP  : any                                    Src. Port: -
Dst. IP  : 75.24.24.17/32                         Dst. Port: -
Protocol : 6                                      DSCP     : cp60
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
 
 
show service active-subscribers pcc-rule subscriber "1/1/3:1.1|00:00:00:00:00:01" 
===============================================================================
Active Subscribers
===============================================================================
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber 1/1/3:1.1|00:00:00:00:00:01 (subprof1)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(1) SLA Profile Instance sap:1/1/3:1.1 - sla:sla1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingr Qos Policy Override : 3:P2
Egr  Qos Policy Override : 2:P2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IP Address
                MAC Address       PPPoE-SID Origin
--------------------------------------------------------
22.1.0.1
                00:00:00:00:00:01 N/A       DHCP
--------------------------------------------------------
Ingr Filter Override : 5:P4
Egr  Filter Override : 6:P5
========================================================
Preference Rule Id   Rule Name
--------------------------------------------------------
0          28        RULE_egress_DROP
0          29        RULE_egress_FC
0          30        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT
0          31        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_FC
0          32        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_UM
0          33        RULE_egress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC
0          34        RULE_egress_UM
0          35        RULE_egress_UM_FC
0          36        RULE_ingress_DROP
0          37        RULE_ingress_FC
0          38        RULE_ingress_FC_HTTP
0          39        RULE_ingress_FC_RDR
0          40        RULE_ingress_HTTP
0          41        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT
0          42        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_FC
0          43        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_FC_RDR
0          44        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_RDR
0          45        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM
0          46        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC
0          47        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_FC_RDR
0          48        RULE_ingress_RATE_LIMIT_UM_RDR
0          49        RULE_ingress_RDR
0          50        RULE_ingress_UM
0          51        RULE_ingress_UM_FC
0          52        RULE_ingress_UM_FC_RDR
0          53        RULE_ingress_UM_RDR
========================================================
 
 

radius-accounting-policy

Syntax 
radius-accounting-policy name association
radius-accounting-policy [name]
radius-accounting-policy name statistics
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays RADIUS accounting policy information.

Parameters 
name—
Specifies the RADIUS accounting policy name
association—
Displays parameters associated with this RADIUS accounting policy
statistics—
Displays statistics associated with this RADIUS accounting policy
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management RADIUS accounting policy information.

Sample Output
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show subscriber-mgmt radius-accounting-policy "ZiggoAcct1813" 
statistics 
===============================================================================
Radius Accounting Policy ZiggoAcct1813 Statistics
===============================================================================
Tx Requests      : 36035966           Rx Responses  : 36035966
Request Timeouts : 0                  Send Retries  : 2713
Send Failed      : 0                  
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Radius Servers
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Index IP Address      Tx Reqs     Rx Resps    Req Timeouts Req Send Failed
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     172.18.129.36   9012635     9011762     873          0
2     172.18.129.37   9004736     9003814     922          0
3     172.18.129.68   9010236     9009925     311          0
4     172.18.129.69   9011115     9010465     650          0
===============================================================================
Table 93:  Subscriber RADIUS Accounting Policy Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Tx Requests/TX Reqs

Displays the number of accounting requests transmitted for this policy.

Rx Responses/Rx Resps

Displays the number of accounting responses received for this policy.

Request Timeouts/Req Timeouts

Displays the number of accounting requests which have timed out for this policy.

Send Retries

Displays the number of retries to a different server for a single accounting request for this policy.

Send Failed

Req Send Failed

Displays how many accounting requests failed because the packet could not be sent out for this policy.

Radius Servers

Displays a table in which the statistics associated with this RADIUS accounting policy are broken down by individual RADIUS server.

The table columns are:

Index—displays the index number assigned to the RADIUS server. The index determines the sequence in which the servers are queried for authentication requests. Servers are queried in order from lowest to highest index.

IP Address—the address of the RADIUS server.

TX Reqs—see TX Requests in this table.

Rx Resps—see RX Responses in this table.

Req Timeouts—see Request Timeouts in this table.

Req Send Failed—see Send Failed in this table.

sla-profile

Syntax 
sla-profile [sla-profile-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays SLA profile information.

Parameters 
sla-profile-name—
Specifies an existing SLA profile name
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sla-profile-name.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management SLA profile information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile
===============================================================================
SLA Profiles
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sla_default
sla_prof100_VOIP
sla_prof110_VOIP
sla_prof120_VOIP
sla_prof130_VOIP
sla_prof140_VOIP
sla_prof230_VOIP
sla_prof80
sla_prof80_VOIP
sla_prof81_VOIP
sla_prof90_VOIP
sla_profPC1
sla_profPC2
sla_profPC3
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of SLA Profiles : 14
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A# 
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile sla_prof100_VOIP
===============================================================================
SLA Profile sla_prof100_VOIP
===============================================================================
Host Limit           : 3 (Remove Oldest)
Ingress Qos-Policy   : 100                    Egress Qos-Policy : 100
Ingress Queuing Type : Service-queuing
Ingress Filter-Id    : N/A                    Egress Filter-Id  : N/A
Last Mgmt Change     : 07/10/2006 12:55:33
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Queue Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Rate      CIR       HiPrio  CBS     MBS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2     4000      -         -       -       -
3     2500      -         -       -       -
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Queue Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Rate      CIR       HiPrio  CBS     MBS
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2     4000      -         -       -       -
3     2500      -         -       -       -
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sla-profile sla_prof100_VOIP association
===============================================================================
SLA Profile sla_prof100_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Default-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Static Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Non-Sub-Traffic-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Ident-Policy Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-name : sub_ident_all
 - Key : sla_prof100_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Explicit Subscriber Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

sla-profile

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Displays information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Displays information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Displays information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler stats information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber "sub1" sla-profile "sla-profile.1" sap 1/1/1:1 scheduler 
 
"session-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
Egress Schedulers
 
session-sched                      0                      0
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

port

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
Description 

This command displays the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port port-id
Displays information for the specified port
vport name
Displays information for the specified Vport
scheduler scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
detail —
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler hierarchy information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-hierarchy port 1/1/1 vport "dslam1" scheduler "dslam-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Port 1/1/1
===============================================================================
Scheduler-policy dslam-sched-pol
| slot(1)
|--(S) : subscriber-sched (VPort dslam1 1/1/1)
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:2->1
|   |   |
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub2:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:2->1
|   |   |
|
|--(S) : subscriber-sched (VPort dslam1 1/1/1)
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.2 200->1/1/1:1->1
|   |   |
|   |
|   |--(S) : session-sched
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->3
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->2
|   |   |
|   |   |--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->1
|   |   |
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

vport

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the Vport scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port-id
Displays information for the specified port
name
Displays information for the specified Vport
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-stats port 1/1/1 vport "dslam1" scheduler "dslam-sched"
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Schedulers
 
dslam-sched                        0                      0
===============================================================================
*A:BNG#

statistics

Syntax 
statistics iom (slot | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics mda (mda | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics port (port-id | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics pw-port (pw-port | all) [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
statistics sla-profiles
statistics sub-profiles
statistics system [host | session | subscriber | summary] [non-zero-value-only]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays enhanced subscriber management statistics per port, PW port, MDA, IOM, or system.

For each statistic, there is current value and peak value. Peak value is the highest value since the last reset as a result of a system boot or the clear subscriber-mgmt peakvalue-stats command.

Note:

The peak values can be reset using the clear subscriber-mgmt peakvalue-stats command.

Parameters 
iom slot
Displays specified IOM slot information.
mda mda
Displays specified slot/mda information.
port port-id
Specifies to display information for both the physical port ID and LAG.
pw-port pw-port
Specifies to display information for a pseudowire port ID.
Values—
1 to 10239

 

all—
displays statistics of all IOM or MDA or port or pseudowire port in the system
host—
Displays v4/v6 host statistics only.
session—
Displays PPPoX/LAC/LNS session statistics only.
sla-profiles—
Displays the current and historical statistics for SLA profiles.
sub-profiles—
Displays the current and historical statistics for subscriber profiles.
subscriber—
Displays subscriber statistics only.
summary—
Displays summary statistics only.
non-zero-value-only—
Displays only non-zero value counters.

The following tables describe the counters available in the show subscriber management statistics command output.

The following terminology is used to indicate applicability of the stats:

  1. ESM — Enhanced Subscriber Management. Subscriber traffic forwarded via subscriber queues. Enabled with SAP sub-sla-mgmt in no shutdown state
  2. BSM — Basic Subscriber Management. Subscriber traffic forwarded via SAP queues. SAP sub-sla-mgmt must be in shutdown state. For DHCP, dhcp lease-populate or dhcp6-relay lease-populate must be enabled to count the leases. For IPv4, if anti-spoof is enabled on the SAP, a subscriber host is instantiated.
  3. Routed CO — IES or VPRN service with subscriber interface and group interface constructs
  4. Bridged CO — VPLS service with DHCPv4 lease management enabled (lease-populate)
  5. regular interface — IES or VPRN interface (none subscriber-interface or group-interface)
  6. Host (also subscriber host) — A resource in the system that is used for traffic forwarding and security related actions. The creation of a subscriber host entry is linked to anti-spoof being enabled on a SAP. For ESM, anti-spoof is mandatory and hence every connected {IP/MAC} consumes by default a subscriber host entry. A DHCP6 IA-PD can also be modeled as a managed route. In this case, no subscriber host is instantiated. For BSM, anti-spoof is optional on regular interfaces. An IPv4 static-host and DHCPv4 lease do not result in a subscriber host instantiation when anti-spoof is disabled on the SAP.
    Table 94:  Host And Protocol Statistics  

    Section

    Counter

    Counts

    Applies to

    IPv4

    1. PPP Hosts - IPCP

    IPv4 local terminated PPP hosts (PTA, LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    2. IPOE Hosts - DHCP

    DHCPv4 hosts (lease states)

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    3. IPOE Hosts - ARP

    ARP hosts

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    4. IPOE Hosts – Static

    IPv4 static hosts

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    5. IPOE Hosts BSM - DHCP

    DHCPv4 hosts (lease states: anti-spoof and lease-populate enabled)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    6. IPOE Hosts BSM – Static

    IPv4 static hosts (with anti-spoof enabled)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    7. IPOE BSM - DHCP

    DHCPv4 lease states (with lease-populate enabled, no anti-spoof)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    8. IPOE BSM – Static

    IPv4 static hosts (no anti-spoof)

    BSM, Routed CO, Bridged CO, regular interface

    IPv6

    PPP Hosts – SLAAC

    Local terminated IPv6 wan-host – SLAAC (PTA, LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Hosts - DHCP6 (PD)

    Local terminated IPv6 pd-host (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-PD leases over PPP (excluding PD as managed route)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Hosts - DHCP6 (NA)

    Local terminated IPv6 wan-host (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-NA leases over PPP

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Mngd Rt - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 (PTA, LNS) – DHCP6 IA-PD leases over PPP (PD as managed route only)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – SLAAC

    IPv6 wan-host – SLAAC

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 pd-host – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (excluding PD as managed route)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts - DHCP6 (NA)

    IPv6 wan-host – DHCP6 IA-NA leases

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Mngd Rt - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (PD as managed route only)

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – Static (PD)

    IPv6 static hosts with prefix-length shorter than /128

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE Hosts – Static (WAN)

    IPv6 static hosts with prefix-length equal to /128

    ESM, Routed CO

    IPOE BSM - DHCP6 (PD)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-PD leases (lease-populate)

    BSM, regular interface

    IPOE BSM - DHCP6 (NA)

    IPv6 – DHCP6 IA-NA leases (lease-populate)

    BSM, regular interface

    Total

    PPP Hosts

    Local terminated PPP hosts (PTA, LNS)

    Sum of counters 1, 9, 10 and 11

    ESM

    IPOE Hosts

    Total IPv4 and IPv6 IPOE hosts.

    Sum of counters 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 13, 14, 15, 17 and 18

    ESM

    IPv4 Hosts

    Total IPv4 hosts. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 6

    ESM

    IPv6 Hosts

    Total IPv6 hosts. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17 and 18

    ESM

    IPv6 PD Mngd Routes

    Total DHCP6 IA-PD leases modeled as a managed route. PPP (PTA, LNS) and IPOE.

    Sum of counters 12 and 16

    ESM

    L2TP LAC Hosts

    L2TP LAC hosts – single host per single or dual stack PPP session.

    Counter also increases for outgoing LTS sessions.

    ESM, Routed CO

    Internal Hosts

    Subscriber hosts for internal use. For example: LNS redirect hosts (for LTS, an LNS redirect host is also instantiated).

    ESM

    Total (Cont)

    Non-Sub-Traffic L2-Hosts

    Host on a single subscriber SAP in a VPLS service that enables non-IP traffic to be forwarded using the specified SLA profile instance queues.

    Host on a single subscriber SAP attached to an IES/VPRN group-interface that enables traffic normally forwarded via the SAP queues to flow via the specified SLA profile instance queues.

    configure service vpls <service-id> sap <sap-id> sub-sla-mgmt single-sub-parameters non-sub-traffic sub-profile <sub-profile-name> sla-profile <sla-profile-name> [subscriber <sub-ident-string>] [app-profile <app-profile-name>]

    ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

    DHCP leases

    Total number of DHCPv4 lease states.

    Sum of counters 2, 5 and 7

    ESM, BSM

    DHCPv6 leases

    Total number of DHCPv6 lease states.

    Sum of counters 10, 11, 12, 14, 15, 16, 19 and 20

    ESM, BSM

    Subscriber Hosts

    Counter displayed in the output of “show subscriber-mgmt statistics iom | mda | port | pw-port”

    This counter matches the number of hosts accounted for in the per line card limit

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18 and 26

    ESM

    Total (Cont)

    System Hosts Scale

    Counter displayed in the output of “show subscriber-mgmt statistics system”

    This counter matches the number of hosts accounted for in the system wide limit

    Sum of counters 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 9, 10, 11, 13, 14, 15, 17, 18, 26 and 27

    ESM

    Table 95:  PPP Session Statistics 

    Section

    Counter

    Counts

    Applies to

    Local

    PPP Sessions - PPPoE

    Local terminated PPPoE sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoEoA

    Local terminated PPPoEoA sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    .PPP Sessions - PPPoA

    Local terminated PPPoA sessions (PTA)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - L2TP (LNS)

    Local terminated PPP sessions (L2TP LNS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    LAC

    PPP Sessions - PPPoE

    Tunneled PPPoE session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoEoA

    Tunneled PPPoEoA session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - PPPoA

    Tunneled PPPoA session (L2TP LAC)

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - L2TP (LTS)

    Tunneled PPP session (L2TP LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    Total

    PPP Sessions - established

    PPP sessions that are established (at least one active host attached) – PTA/LAC/LTS/LNS

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - in setup

    PPP sessions in setup (session created, host setup in progress) – PTA/LAC/LTS/LNS

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - local

    Local terminated PPPoX sessions (PTA, L2TP LNS)

    Sum of counters 33, 34, 35 and 36

    ESM, Routed CO

    PPP Sessions - LAC

    Tunneled PPPoX session (L2TP LAC, L2TP LTS)

    Sum of counters 37, 38, 39 and 40

    ESM, Routed CO

    L2TP

    L2TP Tunnels - originator

    Number of L2TP Tunnels originated on this node. (LAC/ LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    .L2TP Tunnels - receiver

    Number of L2TP Tunnels terminated on this node. (LNS/LTS)

    ESM, Routed CO

    Total L2TP Tunnels

    Number of L2TP Tunnels originated or terminated on this node

    Sum of counters 45 and 46

    ESM, Routed CO

Table 96:  IPoE Session Statistics 

Section

Counter

Counts

Applies to

Total

IPOE Sessions - established

IPoE sessions that are established (at least one active host attached).

ESM, Routed CO

IPOE Sessions- in setup

IPoE sessions in setup (session created, host setup in progress).

ESM, Routed CO

Table 97:  Subscriber Statistics 

Section

Counter

Counts

Applies to

Total

Subscribers

Total number of active subscribers.

ESM, Routed CO, Bridged CO

Table 98:  SubMgmt Statistics Summary 

Section

Counter

Counts

Hosts

IPv4

IPv6

Total IPv4 hosts (counter 23 in tables above)

Total IPv6 hosts (counter 24 in tables above)

Sessions

PPP

IPOE

Total PPP sessions - established (counter 41 in tables above)

Total IPOE sessions – established (counter 48 in tables above)

Subscribers

Total number of active subscribers (counter 50 in tables above)

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management system statistics.

Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics system
===============================================================================
Subscriber Management Statistics for System
===============================================================================
       Type                               Current      Peak      Peak Timestamp
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Host & Protocol Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPv4   PPP Hosts      - IPCP                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP                    0         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       IPOE Hosts     - ARP                     1         1 02/28/2015 13:46:10
       IPOE Hosts     - Static                  0         0
       IPOE Hosts BSM - DHCP                    0         0
       IPOE Hosts BSM - Static                  0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP                    0         0
       IPOE BSM       - Static                  0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPv6   PPP Hosts      - SLAAC                   0         0
       PPP Hosts      - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       PPP Hosts      - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
       PPP Mngd Rt    - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - SLAAC                   0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
       IPOE Mngd Rt   - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - Static (PD)             0         0
       IPOE Hosts     - Static (WAN)            0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP6 (PD)              0         0
       IPOE BSM       - DHCP6 (NA)              0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  PPP Hosts                                1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPOE Hosts                               1         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       IPv4 Hosts                               2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       IPv6 Hosts                               0         0
       IPv6 PD Mngd Routes                      0         0
       L2TP LAC Hosts                           0         0
       Internal Hosts                           0         0
       Non-Sub-Traffic L2-Hosts                 0         0
       DHCP Leases                              0         2 02/28/2015 12:38:58
       DHCPv6 Leases                            0         0
       System Hosts Scale                       2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
PPP Session Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Local  PPP Sessions  - PPPoE                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoEoA                  0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoA                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - L2TP (LNS)               0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
LAC    PPP Sessions  - PPPoE                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoEoA                  0         0
       PPP Sessions  - PPPoA                    0         0
       PPP Sessions  - L2TP (LTS)               0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  PPP Sessions  - established              1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - in setup                 0         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - local                    1         1 02/28/2015 16:25:43
       PPP Sessions  - LAC                      0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
L2TP   L2TP Tunnels  - originator               0         0
       L2TP Tunnels  - receiver                 0         0
       Total L2TP Tunnels                       0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IPOE Session Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  IPOE Sessions - established              0         0
       IPOE Sessions - in setup                 0         0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total  Subscribers                              2         2 02/28/2015 16:25:43
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
Peak values last reset at : n/a
 
Sample Output (summary view)
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics port 1/1/4 summary
===============================================================================
SubMgmt Statistics
===============================================================================
                 |       Hosts        |      Sessions      |    Subscribers
Port Id          |   IPv4      IPv6   |    PPP      IPOE   |
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4            |        2         2 |        1         1 |        2   (Curr)
                 |        3         3 |        1         2 |        3   (Peak)
===============================================================================
 
Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics sla-profiles
===============================================================================
SLA Profile Statistics
===============================================================================
SLA-Profile Name                        Current       Peak       Peak Timestamp 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
tv-prof                                       0          0 
hsi-prof                                      1          1  12/29/2016 15:50:50
hsi-iptv--prof                                0          0 
no-prof-1                                     1          1  01/03/2017 20:00:37
hsi-voip-prof                                 0          2  12/29/2016 18:42:44
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                         2
===============================================================================
 
Sample Output
A:PE-1# show subscriber-mgmt statistics sub-profiles
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile Statistics
===============================================================================
Subscriber-Profile Name                  Current       Peak       Peak Timestamp
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
no-prof                                        2          3  12/29/2016 18:42:44
sub-10M                                        0          0
sub-10M-UPNP                                   0          0
sub-20M                                        0          0
sub-20M-UPNP                                   0          0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Total                                          2
===============================================================================
 

steering-profile

Syntax 
steering-profile steering-profile-name
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays steering profile information.

Parameters 
steering-profile-name—
Specifies an existing steering profile name.

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
sub-ident-policy [sub-ident-policy-name [association]]
sub-ident-policy sub-ident-policy-name script {primary | secondary | tertiary}
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber identification policy information.

Parameters 
sub-ident-policy-name—
Specifies an existing subscriber identification policy name
association—
Displays information configured with the specified sub-ident-policy-name
script {primary | secondary | tertiary}—
Displays information for the specified identification script
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management subscriber identification policy information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policies
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_ident_all
sub_ident_pc
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Subscriber Identification Policies : 2
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Sub Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              Sub profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_prof100                      sub_prof100
sub_prof110                      sub_prof110
sub_prof120                      sub_prof120
sub_prof130                      sub_prof130
sub_prof140                      sub_prof140
sub_prof230                      sub_prof230
sub_prof80                       sub_prof80
sub_prof81                       sub_prof81
sub_prof90                       sub_prof90
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              SLA profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sla_prof100_VOIP                 sla_prof100_VOIP
sla_prof110_VOIP                 sla_prof110_VOIP
sla_prof120_VOIP                 sla_prof120_VOIP
sla_prof130_VOIP                 sla_prof130_VOIP
sla_prof140_VOIP                 sla_prof140_VOIP
sla_prof230_VOIP                 sla_prof230_VOIP
sla_prof80_VOIP                  sla_prof80_VOIP
sla_prof81_VOIP                  sla_prof81_VOIP
sla_prof90_VOIP                  sla_prof90_VOIP
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Python Scripts
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
#         Admin Oper  Script
          State State Name
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Primary   Down  Down  pyTom.py
Secondary Up    Up    pyTomDebug.py
Tertiary  Up    Up    hardcoded.py
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all association
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
SAP Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id : 80 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80
Service-Id : 90 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:90
Service-Id : 100 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:100
 - SAP : 1/2/1:101
 - SAP : 1/2/1:102
Service-Id : 110 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:110
 - SAP : 1/2/1:111
 - SAP : 1/2/1:112
Service-Id : 120 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:120
 - SAP : 1/2/1:121
 - SAP : 1/2/1:122
Service-Id : 130 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:130
Service-Id : 140 (VPLS)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:140
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script primary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Primary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/pyTom.py
Admin State : Down                      Oper State : Down
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Script is not active.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script secondary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Secondary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/pyTomDebug.py
Admin State : Up                        Oper State : Up
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      1 import alc
      2 yiaddr = alc.dhcp.yiaddr
      3 # Subscriber ID equals full client IP address.
      4 # Note: IP address 10.10.10.10 yields 'sub-168430090'
      5 # and not 'sub-10.10.10.10'
      6 alc.dhcp.sub_ident = 'sub-' + str(yiaddr)
      7 # DHCP server is configured such that the third byte (field) of the IP
      8 # address indicates the session Profile ID.
      9 alc.dhcp.sla_profile = 'sp-' + str((yiaddr & 0x0000FF00) >> 8)
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# 
 
 
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt# sub-ident-policy sub_ident_all script tertiary
===============================================================================
Subscriber Identification Policy sub_ident_all
===============================================================================
Tertiary Script
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
URL         : ftp://xxx:yyy@a.b.c.d/hardcoded.py
Admin State : Up                        Oper State : Up
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Source (dumped from memory)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      1 from alc import dhcp
      2
      3 dhcp.sub_ident = 'sub_ident_A_1'
      4 dhcp.sub_profile_string = 'sub_prof_B_2'
      5 dhcp.sla_profile_string = 'sla_prof_C_3'
      6
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A>show>subscr-mgmt#

sub-profile

Syntax 
sub-profile [sub-profile-name [association]]
Context 
show>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command displays subscriber profile information.

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Specifies an existing subscriber profile name
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sub-profile-name
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber profile information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profiles
===============================================================================
Name                             Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
sub_default
sub_prof100
sub_prof110
sub_prof120
sub_prof130
sub_prof140
sub_prof230
sub_prof80
sub_prof81
sub_prof90
sub_profPC1
sub_profPC2
sub_profPC3
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Subscriber Profiles : 13
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile sub_prof100
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile sub_prof100
===============================================================================
I. Sched. Policy : service100
E. Sched. Policy : service100
Acct. Policy     : 1                                Collect Stats : Enabled
Last Mgmt Change : 07/10/2006 12:55:33
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Scheduler Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Scheduler                        Rate      CIR
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv100                          8000      sum
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egress Scheduler Overrides
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Scheduler                        Rate      CIR
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv100                          8000      sum
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Map
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Key                              SLA Profile
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No mappings configured.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show subscriber-mgmt sub-profile sub_prof100 association
===============================================================================
Subscriber Profile sub_prof100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Default-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Static Host Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SAP Non-Sub-Traffic-Profile Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub-Ident-Policy Profile Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-name : sub_ident_all
 - Key : sub_prof100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Explicit Subscriber Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

pw-port

Syntax 
pw-port [pw-port-id] [detail]
pw-port sdp sdp-id
pw-port sdp none
Context 
show>pw-port
Description 

Displays pseudo-wire port information.

If no optional parameters are specified, the command displays a summary of all defined PW ports. The optional parameters restrict output to only ports matching the specified properties.

Parameters 
pw-port-id
Specifies the pseudo-wire port identifier
Values—
1 to 10239

 

detail—
Displays detailed port information that includes all the pw-port output fields
sdp-id
The SDP ID for which to display matching PW port information
Values—
1 to 17407

 

Output 

The following output is an example of PW port information.

Sample Output
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1         dot1q          1          1526726657          1
2         qinq           1          1526726658          2
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
4         qinq           1          1526726660          4
============================================================================
 
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port 3
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>config>service# show pw-port 3 detail
===============================================================================
PW Port Information
===============================================================================
PW Port            : 3
Encap              : dot1q
SDP                : 1
IfIndex            : 1526726659
VC-Id              : 3
Description        : 1-Gig Ethernet dual fiber
===============================================================================
*A:ALA-48>config>pw-port$ show pw-port sdp none
 
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
5         dot1q                     1526726661
============================================================================
 
 
*A:ALA-48>config>pw-port$ show pw-port sdp 1
============================================================================
PW Port Information
============================================================================
PW Port   Encap          SDP        IfIndex             VC-Id
----------------------------------------------------------------------------
1         dot1q          1          1526726657          1
2         qinq           1          1526726658          2
3         dot1q          1          1526726659          3
4         qinq           1          1526726660          4
============================================================================
 

The following table describes show pw-port output fields:

Table 99:  Subscriber Show PW-Port Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

PW Port

The PW port identifier.

Encap

The encapsulation type of the PW port.

SDP

The SDP identifier.

IfIndex

The interface index used for the PW port.

VC-Id

The Virtual Circuit identifier.

Description

The description string for the PW port.

port-scheduler-policy

Syntax 
port-scheduler-policy [port-scheduler-policy-name] [association]
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name network-policy network-queue-policy-name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name sap-egress policy-id
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name
port-scheduler-policy port-scheduler-policy-name scheduler-policy scheduler-policy-name sap-egress policy-id
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays scheduler policy information.

Parameters 
port-scheduler-policy-name—
Specifies an existing port scheduler policy name
network-queue-policy-name—
Specifies an existing network queue policy name
policy-id—
Specifies an existing SAP egress policy ID
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS port scheduler policy information.

Sample Output
A:NS072860910>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# info
----------------------------------------------
            max-rate 10000
            group "group1" create
                rate 3000 cir 1000
            exit
            group "group2" create
                rate 2000 cir 500
            exit
            level 7 rate 7000 cir 700 group "group1" weight 3
            level 6 rate 6000 cir 600 group "group1" weight 2
            level 5 rate 5000 cir 500 group "group1" weight 1
            level 2 rate 2000 cir 200 group "group2" weight 2
            level 1 rate 1000 cir 100 group "group2" weight 1
----------------------------------------------
 
A:NS072860910# show qos scheduler-hierarchy port 5/1/2 vport "fred"
========================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Port 5/1/2, Vport "fred"
========================================================================
Port-scheduler-policy psp1
    Port Bandwidth : 1000000    Max Rate : 10000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Within CIR Level 8]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->1
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->1
 
[Within CIR Group "group1"]
    Rate     : 1000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Within CIR Level 7]
        Weight   : 3
        Rate     : 700
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->2
 
    [Within CIR Level 6]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 600
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->3
 
    [Within CIR Level 5]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 500
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->4
 
[Within CIR Level 4]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Within CIR Level 3]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->5
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->5
 
[Within CIR Group "group2"]
    Rate : 500
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Within CIR Level 2]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 200
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->6
 
    [Within CIR Level 1]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 200
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->7
 
[Within CIR Level 0]
    Rate     : 0
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->8
    (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->8
 
[Above CIR Level 8]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Group "group1"]
    Rate     : 3000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 7]
        Weight   : 3
        Rate     : 7000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 6]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 6000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 5]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 5000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Level 4]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Level 3]
    Rate     : max
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
[Above CIR Group "group2"]
    Rate     : 2000
    Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 2]
        Weight   : 2
        Rate     : 2000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
    [Above CIR Level 1]
        Weight   : 1
        Rate     : 1000
        Consumed : 0          Offered : 0
 
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->1
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->5
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:1->8
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->1
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->2
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->3
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->4
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->5
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->6
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->7
        (Q) : 1->5/1/2:2->8
========================================================================
A:NS072860910# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp"
========================================================================
QoS Port Scheduler Policy
========================================================================
Policy-Name       : psp                 
Description       : (Not Specified)
Max Rate          : max                 Last changed      : 04/15/2010 00:37:02
Group             : 1                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 2                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 3                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Group             : 4                   
Group PIR         : 80000               Group CIR         : max
 
Lvl1 PIR          : max                 Lvl1 CIR          : max
Lvl1 Group        : 1                   Lvl1 Grp Weight   : 10
 
Lvl2 PIR          : max                 Lvl2 CIR          : max
Lvl2 Group        : 1                   Lvl2 Grp Weight   : 20
 
Lvl3 PIR          : max                 Lvl3 CIR          : max
Lvl3 Group        : 2                   Lvl3 Grp Weight   : 30
 
Lvl4 PIR          : max                 Lvl4 CIR          : max
Lvl4 Group        : 2                   Lvl4 Grp Weight   : 40
 
Lvl5 PIR          : max                 Lvl5 CIR          : max
Lvl5 Group        : 3                   Lvl5 Grp Weight   : 50
 
Lvl6 PIR          : max                 Lvl6 CIR          : max
Lvl6 Group        : 3                   Lvl6 Grp Weight   : 60
 
Lvl7 PIR          : max                 Lvl7 CIR          : max
Lvl7 Group        : 4                   Lvl7 Grp Weight   : 70
 
Lvl8 PIR          : max                 Lvl8 CIR          : max
Lvl8 Group        : 4                   Lvl8 Grp Weight   : 80
 
Orphan Lvl        : default             Orphan Weight     : default
Orphan CIR-Lvl    : default             Orphan CIR-Weight : default
========================================================================
*A:Bennet-Dut-A>config>qos>port-sched-plcy# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp" association 
========================================================================
QoS Port Scheduler Policy
========================================================================
Policy-Name       : psp                 
Description       : (Not Specified)
------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
------------------------------------------------------------------------
 - Port : 1/1/2 VPort : vp1
========================================================================
*A:B-Dut-A# 
 
 
*A:B-Dut-A# show qos port-scheduler-policy "psp" sap-egress 1000
========================================================================
Compatibility : Port-scheduler Policy psp & Sap Egress Queue 1000
========================================================================
Orphan Queues :
 
None Found
 
Hierarchy     :
 
Root
|
|---(Q) : 1    
|
|---(Q) : 2    
|
|---(Q) : 3    
|
|---(Q) : 4    
|
|---(Q) : 5    
|
|---(Q) : 6                           
|
|---(Q) : 7    
|
|---(Q) : 8    
========================================================================
*A:B-Dut-A# 
 

sap-egress

Syntax 
sap-egress [policy-id] [association | detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays SAP egress policy information.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Displays information for the specified SAP egress policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sap-egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of Qos SAP egress information.

Sample Output
*A:Dut-A# show qos sap-egress
===============================================================================
Sap Egress Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id  Scope     Name                     Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1          Template  default                  Default SAP egress QoS policy.
30         Template                           1 video channel, 1 BE
31         Template                           1 video EF, 2xvideo AF, 1 BE
80         Template                           Limit outgoing 80
100        Template                           User100
110        Template                           User110
120        Template                           User120
130        Template                           User130
140        Template                           User140
901        Template                           User90_1
902        Template                           User90_2
903        Template                           User90_3
904        Template                           User90_4
905        Template                           User90_5
1000       Template                           Service all
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Policies : 15
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-egress 31 detail
===============================================================================
QoS Sap Egress
===============================================================================
Sap Scheduler Policy (31)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-id      : 31                           Scope        : Template
Description    : 1 video EF, 2xvideo AF, 1 BE
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue         CIR Admin PIR Admin CBS     HiPrio  PIR Lvl/Wt    Parent
              CIR Rule  PIR Rule  MBS             CIR Lvl/Wt
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1             0         max       def     def     1/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
2             0         max       def     def     2/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
3             0         max       def     def     3/1           limit_8000
              closest   closest   def             0/1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC Name               Queue-id    Explicit/Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be                    1           Explicit (0)
af                    2           Explicit (0)
ef                    3           Explicit (0)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 23 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 1
 - SAP : 1/2/2:4000
Service-Id     : 30 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : lag-1
 - SAP : lag-2:5
Service-Id     : 31 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : 1/2/1:31
SLA Profiles :
 - sla_profPC1                      override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Mirror SAPs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Mirror SAPs Found.
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

sap-ingress

Syntax 
sap-ingress [policy-id] [association | match-criteria | detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays SAP ingress policy information.

Parameters 
policy-id—
Displays information for the specified SAP ingress policy
association—
Displays the information configured with the specified sap-ingress policy
match-criteria—
Displays information about the matching criteria
detail—
Displays detailed information
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS SAP ingress information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-ingress
===============================================================================
Sap Ingress Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id  Scope     Name                     Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1          Template  default                  Default SAP ingress QoS policy.
80         Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
90         Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
100        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
110        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
120        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
130        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
140        Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for servi*
901        Template                           User90_1
902        Template                           User90_2
903        Template                           User90_3
904        Template                           User90_4
905        Template                           User90_5
1000       Template                           Dot1p mappings/service for all s*
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of Policies : 14
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
* indicates that the corresponding row element may have been truncated.
*A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos sap-ingress 80 detail
===============================================================================
QoS Sap Ingress
===============================================================================
Sap Ingress Policy (80)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy-id      : 80                           Scope        : Template
Default FC     : be                           Priority     : Low
Criteria-type  : IP
Description    :  Dot1p mappings/service for service 80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue Mode    CIR Admin PIR Admin CBS     HiPrio  PIR Lvl/Wt    Parent
              CIR Rule  PIR Rule  MBS             CIR Lvl/Wt
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     Prio    0         7000      def     def     1/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
2     Prio    0         3500      def     def     2/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
3     Prio    0         2000      def     def     3/1           serv80
              closest   closest   def             0/1
11    Prio    0         max       def     def     1/1           None
              closest   closest   def             0/1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC                  UCastQ         MCastQ         BCastQ         UnknownQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be                  1              def            def            def
af                  2              def            def            def
ef                  3              def            def            def
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SubFC                              Profile        In-Remark      Out-Remark
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
af                                 None           None           None
be                                 None           None           None
ef                                 None           None           None
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Dot1p           FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
0               be                               Default
2               af                               Default
5               ef                               Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
DSCP            FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No DSCP-Map Entries Found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Prec Value      FC                               Priority
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Prec-Map Entries Found.
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Match Criteria
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
IP Match Criteria
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Entry          : 1
Source IP      : Undefined                    Source Port  : None
Dest. IP       : Undefined                    Dest. Port   : None
Protocol       : None                         DSCP         : None
Fragment       : Off
FC             : Default                      Priority     : Default
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 80 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 80
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80
 
SLA Profiles :
 - sla_prof80                       override
 - sla_prof80_VOIP                  override
 - sla_prof81_VOIP                  override
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

scheduler-hierarchy

Syntax 
scheduler-hierarchy
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command enters the context to display information about policies that use this scheduler.

customer

Syntax 
customer customer-id site customer-site-name [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the scheduler hierarchy per customer multi-service-site.

Parameters 
customer-id
Displays information for the specified customer ID
customer-site-name
Displays information for the specified multi-service customer
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
ingress—
Displays information for the ingress policy
egress—
Displays information for the egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information

sap

Syntax 
sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
show>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command displays the scheduler stats per SAP.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
ingress—
Displays information for the ingress policy
egress—
Displays information for the egress policy
detail—
Displays detailed information

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress] [detail]
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos>scheduler-hierarchy
Description 

This command displays the scheduler hierarchy rooted at the SLA profile scheduler.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Displays information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Displays information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Displays information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Displays information for the specified scheduler-name
detail —
Displays detailed information
Note:

If the SLA profile scheduler is orphaned (that is when the scheduler has a parent which does not exist) then the hierarchy is only shown when the show command includes the sla-profile and sap parameters.

Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler information.

Sample Output
*A:BNG# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber "sub1" sla-profile "sla-profile.1" sap 1/1/1:1 scheduler "session-sched" 
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber sub1 SLA-Profile sla-profile.1 SAP 1/1/1:1
===============================================================================
Egress Scheduler Policy : session-sched-pol
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
session-sched (Egr)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->3
|
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->2
|
|--(Q) : Sub=sub1:sla-profile.1 200->1/1/1:1->1
|
 
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber nokia_100 scheduler serv_all
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
serv_all (Ing)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:101->11 MCast
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->11 MCast
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->11 MCast
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->2 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->1 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:100->3
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:100->3 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/2
|   |
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 1/1
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 3/2
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->2 1/2
|   |
...
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-hierarchy subscriber nokia_100 scheduler serv_all detail
===============================================================================
Scheduler Hierarchy - Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
Legend :
(U) - Unrestricted     (P) - Provisioned
(A) - Administrative   (O) - Operational
MIR - Measured Info Rate
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
serv_all (Ing)
| slot(1)
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:101->11 MCast
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:4            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):7000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):1000000      PIR (O):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :1280
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:256
|
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->11 MCast
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:4            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):7000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):1000000      PIR (O):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :1280
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:256
|
|--(S) : AccessIngress:Sub=6:1 100->1/2/1:102->1
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:1            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :1687
|   |    PIR (P):1690         PIR (U):3510
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):7000
|   |    CIR (A):0
|   |
|   |--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->1 1/1
|   |   |
|   |   |    PIR Lvl:1            PIR Wt :1
|   |   |    CIR Lvl:1            CIR Wt :1
|   |   |
|   |   |    MIR    :0
|   |   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):1830
|   |   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |   |
|   |   |    PIR (A):7000         PIR (O):1850
|   |   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :64
|   |   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:8
|   |
...
|--(Q) : Sub=nokia_100:sla_default 100->1/2/1:102->3
|   |
|   |    PIR Lvl:3            PIR Wt :1
|   |    CIR Lvl:0            CIR Wt :1
|   |
|   |    MIR    :0
|   |    PIR (P):0            PIR (U):2000
|   |    CIR (P):0            CIR (U):0
|   |
|   |    PIR (A):2000         PIR (O):2000
|   |    CIR (A):0            CIR (O):0
|   |    CBS    :0            MBS    :64
|   |    Depth  :0            Hi Prio:8
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#

scheduler-name

Syntax 
scheduler-name scheduler-name
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays information about the specified scheduler name.

Parameters 
scheduler-name—
Displays information about the specified scheduler

scheduler-policy

Syntax 
scheduler-policy [scheduler-policy-name] [association | sap-ingress policy-id | sap-egress policy-id]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays information about the specified scheduler policy.

Parameters 
scheduler-policy-name—
Displays information for the specified scheduler policy
policy-id
Displays information for the ingress policy
policy-id
Displays information for the egress policy
association—
Displays the information currently configured with the specified scheduler-policy-name
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler policy information.

Sample Output
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy
===============================================================================
Sap Scheduler Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id                        Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
maximum_4000_1xEF_1xBE
maximum_8000_1xEF_2xAF_1xBE
multiservice-site
root
scheduler-7Mbps
service100
service110
service120
service130
service140
service80
service90
service_all
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy root association
===============================================================================
QoS Scheduler Policy
===============================================================================
Policy-Name    : root
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#
 
 
B:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-policy association
===============================================================================
QoS Scheduler Policy
===============================================================================
Policy-Name    : maximum_4000_1xEF_1xBE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : maximum_8000_1xEF_2xAF_1xBE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 23 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 1
 - SAP : 1/3/2:4000 (Egr)
Service-Id     : 30 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 2
 - SAP : lag-1 (Egr)
 - SAP : lag-2:5 (Egr)
Policy-Name    : multiservice-site
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 90 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 90
 - SAP : 1/1/12:95 (Ing) (Egr) MSS : site1
 - SAP : 1/1/20:94 (Ing) (Egr) MSS : site1
 
 - Customer : 2         MSS : site1  (Ing) (Egr)
 - Customer : 90        MSS : site1  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : root
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : scheduler-7Mbps
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Association Found.
 
Policy-Name    : service100
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 100 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 100
 - SAP : 1/2/1:100 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:101 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:102 (Ing) (Egr)
 
 - Customer : 100       MSS : site100  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof100 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service110
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 110 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 110
 - SAP : 1/2/1:110 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:111 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:112 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof110 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service120
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 120 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 120
 - SAP : 1/2/1:120 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:121 (Ing) (Egr)
 - SAP : 1/2/1:122 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof120 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service130
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 130 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 130
 - SAP : 1/2/1:130 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof130 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service140
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 140 (VPLS)                   Customer-Id  : 140
 - SAP : 1/2/1:140 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof140 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service80
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 80 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 80
 - SAP : 1/2/1:80 (Ing) (Egr)
 
 - Customer : 80        MSS : site80  (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof80 (Ing) (Egr)
 - sub_prof81 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service90
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service-Id     : 90 (VPLS)                    Customer-Id  : 90
 - SAP : 1/2/1:90 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_prof90 (Ing) (Egr)
 
Policy-Name    : service_all
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Sub Profiles :
 - sub_default (Ing) (Egr)
===============================================================================
B:Dut-A#

scheduler-stats

Syntax 
scheduler-stats
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command enters the context to display scheduler statistics information.

Output 

The following output is an example of QoS scheduler stats information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Schedulers
root                               112777                 25218126
serv_all                           112777                 25218126
Egress Schedulers
root                               113781                 26008462
serv_all                           113781                 26008462
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos scheduler-stats subscriber nokia_100 scheduler root
===============================================================================
Scheduler Stats
===============================================================================
Scheduler                          Forwarded Packets      Forwarded Octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ingress Schedulers
root                               0                      0
Egress Schedulers
root                               0                      0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A# 

shared-queue

Syntax 
shared-queue [shared-queue-policy-name] [detail]
Context 
show>qos
Description 

This command displays shared policy information.

Parameters 
shared-queue-policy-name—
Specifies the name of a shared-queue
detail—
Displays detailed information about the shared queue policy
Output 

The following output is an example of QoS shared queue information.

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# show qos shared-queue
===============================================================================
Shared Queue Policies
===============================================================================
Policy-Id                        Description
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
default                          Default Shared Queue Policy
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# show qos shared-queue detail
===============================================================================
QoS Network Queue Policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Shared Queue Policy (default)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Policy         : default
Description    : Default Shared Queue Policy
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Queue CIR       PIR       CBS     MBS     HiPrio  Multipoint
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1     0         100       1       50      10      FALSE
2     25        100       3       50      10      FALSE
3     25        100       10      50      10      FALSE
4     25        100       3       25      10      FALSE
5     100       100       10      50      10      FALSE
6     100       100       10      50      10      FALSE
7     10        100       3       25      10      FALSE
8     10        100       3       25      10      FALSE
9     0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
10    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
11    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
12    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
13    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
14    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
15    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
16    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
17    0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
18    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
19    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
20    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
21    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
22    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
23    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
24    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
25    0         100       1       50      10      TRUE
26    25        100       3       50      10      TRUE
27    25        100       10      50      10      TRUE
28    25        100       3       25      10      TRUE
29    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
30    100       100       10      50      10      TRUE
31    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
32    10        100       3       25      10      TRUE
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
FC    UCastQ    MCastQ    BCastQ  UnknownQ
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
be    1         9         17      25
l2    2         10        18      26
af    3         11        19      27
l1    4         12        20      28
h2    5         13        21      29
ef    6         14        22      30
h1    7         15        23      31
nc    8         16        24      32
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:101 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:102 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:103 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:104 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:105 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:106 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:107 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:108 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:109 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:110 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:111 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:112 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:113 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:114 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:115 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:116 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:117 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:118 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:119 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:120 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:121 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:122 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/4:123 (shared Q)
Service : 10            SAP : 1/1/5:279 (shared Q)
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

accu-stats

Syntax 
accu-stats subscriber subscriber-id
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command displays the accumulated statistics for both online and offline statistics.

Parameters 
subscriber-id—
Specifies the subscriber ID, to a maximum of 32 characters.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber statistics.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats subscriber home-1
===============================================================================
Subscriber accumulated statistics for “home-1”
===============================================================================
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber accumulated statistics ingress queue 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     packets                octets
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Offered high priority                0                      0        
Offered low priority                 0                      0        
Dropped high priority                0                      0    
Dropped low priority                 0                      0        
Forwarded in-profile                 0                      0   
Forwarded out-of-profile             0                      0   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber accumulated statistics egress queue 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                     packets                octets
Forwarded in-profile                 0                      0   
Forwarded out-of-profile             0                      0   
Dropped in-profile                   0                      0   
Dropped out-of--profile              0                      0   
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================

accu-stats-policy

Syntax 
accu-stats-policy
accu-stats-policy policy-name [associations]
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command displays the configuration of the accumulated statistics policy for the subscriber profile that referenced the accumulated statistics policy.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the policy name, to a maximum of 32 characters.
associations—
Lists the sub-profile that referenced the policy.
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management accumulated statistics information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-policy “accu-stats-policy-01”
===============================================================================
Subscriber accumulated statistics policy accu-stats-policy-01
===============================================================================
Description                          : (Not Specified)         
Last management change               : 09/23/2016 16:48:46
===============================================================================
 
===============================================================================
Entries
===============================================================================
Direction Type     Id
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ingress   queue    1     
egress    queue    1     
===============================================================================
Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-policy “accu-stats-policy-01” associations
===============================================================================
Subscriber profile associations
===============================================================================
no-prof                         
sub-prof
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
===============================================================================
No. of subscriber profiles: 2
===============================================================================

accu-stats-subscribers

Syntax 
accu-stats-subscribers [subscriber sub-ident] [sub-profile name]
Context 
show>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command lists all subscribers on the system that had referenced an accumulated statistics policy. The list contains subscribers that are currently referencing an accu-stats-policy as well as subscribers that no longer reference an accu-stats-policy (due to removal of the policy from the subscriber profile).

Parameters 
sub-ident—
Specifies a specific subscriber ID, to a maximum of 32 characters.
sub-profile name
Lists all subscribers that are referencing the specified subscriber profile, to a maximum of 32 characters.
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management accumulated statistics information.

Sample Output
*DUT# show subscriber-mgmt accu-stats-subscribers    
===============================================================================
Subscribers with accumulated statistics
===============================================================================
Subscriber                            : home-1
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : accu-stats-policy-01
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber                            : home-2
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : accu-stats-policy-02
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber                            : twamp-host
Subscriber profile                    : no-prof
Accumulated-stats policy              : (Unknown)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Subscribers with accumulated statistics: 3
===============================================================================
Sample Output

The show subscriber-mgmt status system command shows the number of subscribers using accumulated statistics and whether the statistics usage has reached the peak value.

*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt status system 
===============================================================================
Subscriber Management System Status
===============================================================================
Chassis 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Memory usage high                                       : No
DHCP message processing overload                        : No
Statistics usage high                                   : Yes
Number of subscribers using statistics                  : 131072
Data-trigger statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Packets received                                        : 0
Packets dropped                                         : 0
Packets in queue (actual)                               : 0
Packets in queue (peak)                                 : 0
Bridged Residential Gateway statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
BRG initialized                                         : 0
BRG operational                                         : 0
BRG in connectivity verification                        : 0
BRG on hold                                             : 0
BRG authenticated by proxy                              : 0
===============================================================================

ancp-policy

Syntax 
ancp-policy [policy-name]
Context 
show>subscriber-management
Description 

This command displays subscriber ANCP policy information.

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management ANCP policy information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy
===============================================================================
ANCP Policies
===============================================================================
adsl-operator1
vdsl-operator1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of ANCP policies : 2
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy adsl-operator1
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "adsl-operator1"
===============================================================================
I. Rate Reduction      : 0 kbps
I. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
I. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
I. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
I. Rate Modify         : scheduler "root"
 
E. Rate Reduction      : 10 kbps
E. Rate Adjustment     : 100 percent
E. Rate Monitor        : 0 kbps
E. Rate Monitor Alarm  : no
E. Rate Modify         : scheduler "root"
Port Down : N/A
Last Mgmt Change: 01/26/2007 17:10:51
================================================================================
A:active#
 
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-policy adsl-operator1 association
===============================================================================
ANCP Policy "adsl-operator1" associations 
===============================================================================
SAP Static Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- SAP     : 1/1/3                             Svc-id  : 333 (VPLS)
     String : "ANCP-String-1"
     String : "ANCP-String-2"
------------------------------------------------------------------------------
MSS Static Map Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
- Cust-id : 1                                 MSS-name: mss1
     String : "ANCP-String-3"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Subscriber Associations
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No associations found.
Number of associations : 3
===============================================================================
A:active#

ancp-string

Syntax 
ancp-string
ancp-string ancp-string
ancp-string customer customer-id site customer-site-name
ancp-string sap sap-id
Context 
show>subscriber-management
Description 

This command displays subscriber ANCP string information.

Parameters 
ancp-string—
Specify the ASCII representation of the DSLAM circuit-id name
customer-id
Specify the associated existing customer name
customer-site-name
Specify the associated customer’s configured MSS name
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
Output 

The following output displays subscriber management ANCP string information.

Sample Output
A:active# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string
===============================================================================
ANCP-Strings
===============================================================================
ANCP-String                                                Assoc State
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
"ANCP-String-1"                                            SAP   Up
"ANCP-String-2"                                            SAP   Down
"ANCP-String-3"                                            MSS   Up
"ANCP-String-4"                                            MSS   Unknown
"ANCP-String-5"                                            ANCP  Up
"ANCP-String-6"                                            MSS   Unknown
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of ANCP-Strings : 6
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
 
*A:Dut-C# show subscriber-mgmt ancp-string hpolSub43
===============================================================================
ANCP-String "hpolSub43"
===============================================================================
Type       : SUB - "hpolSub43"
State      : Up                 Ancp Policy: ancpPol
I. Rate    : 100 kbps           E. Rate    : 200 kbps
Adj I. Rate: N/A                Adj E. Rate: 200 kbps
Act I. Rate: N/A                Act E. Rate: 182 kbps
Service Id : 1 (VPRN)
Group      : Alu
Neighbor   : 100.100.100.1:49063
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-C# 

Other applicable show command output:

A:active# show service id 333 sap 1/1/3 detail 
===============================================================================
Service Access Points(SAP)
===============================================================================
Service Id         : 333
SAP                : 1/1/3                    Encap             : null
...
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ANCP Override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Ing Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 100 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-1"
Egr Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 100 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-1"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
...
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:active#
 
 
A:active# show service customer 1 site mss1
===============================================================================
Customer  1
===============================================================================
Customer-ID        : 1
Description        : Default customer
...
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
ANCP Override
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Egr Sched Name: root
- PIR    : 90 kbps
- String : "ANCP-String-3"
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Service Association
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No Service Association Found.
===============================================================================
A:active#

radius-proxy-server

Syntax 
radius-proxy-server server-name
radius-proxy-server server-name cache
radius-proxy-server server-name cache hex-key hex-string
radius-proxy-server server-name cache string-key string
radius-proxy-serverserver-name cache summary
radius-proxy-server server-name statistics
radius-proxy-server
Context 
show>router
Description 

This command displays RADIUS proxy server information.

Parameters 
server-name—
Specifies the default RADIUS proxy server name created in the config>router>radius-proxy context
cache—
Displays cached information
hex-string
Displays the hex key string
Values—
[0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (max 64 hex nibbles)]

 

string
Displays the packet type of the RADIUS messages to use to generate the key for the cache of this RADIUS proxy server
summary—
Displays summarized information
statistics—
Displays statistics for the specified RADIUS proxy server
Output 
Table 100:  Subscriber RADIUS Proxy Server Field Descriptions 

Label

Description  

Invalid response Authenticator Rx packet

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx Access-Request

Displays the number of Access-Request packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx Accounting-Request

Displays the number of Accounting-Request packets received by this RADIUS proxy server.

Rx dropped

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server but dropped.

Retransmit

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they are retransmitted.

Wrong purpose

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the value of tmnxRadProxSrvPurpose is set to a value not matching the type of packet.

No UE MAC to cache

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the UE MAC address was not present in the packet.

Client context limit reached

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the limit of client contexts was reached. For each RADIUS transaction a client context is created, and will be deleted once the transaction is finished.

No ISA RADIUS policy configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it has no ISA RADIUS server policy configured for that type of packet.

Server admin down

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it is administratively shut down.

No RADIUS policy configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because it has no RADIUS server policy configured for that type of packet.

No load-balance-key configured

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the selected RADIUS server policy's algorithm is set to hashBased and no load balance key is configured.

Invalid length

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because their length was invalid.

Invalid Code field

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they had an invalid Code field.

Invalid attribute encoding

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because one of the attributes was incorrectly encoded.

Invalid User-Name

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid User-Name attribute.

Invalid password

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because the User-Password attribute could not be decoded.

Invalid accounting Authenticator

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Authenticator field.

Invalid Message-Authenticator

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Message-Authenticator attribute.

Management core overload

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because the ISA management core is not able to process any new RADIUS requests because of overload.

No memory

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because there was not enough memory to store them.

Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained an invalid Acct-Status-Type attribute.

Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type

Displays the number of accounting packets received by this RADIUS proxy server that were rejected because they contained no Acct-Status-Type attribute.

Registered user overload

Displays the number of packets that were rejected by this RADIUS server because the registered user indicated to be in overload.

Dropped by Python

Displays the number of packets received by this RADIUS proxy server but dropped by Python.

Tx Access-Accept

Displays the number of Access-Accept packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Access-Reject

Displays the number of Access-Reject packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Access-Challenge

Displays the number of Access-Challenge packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx Accounting-Response

Displays the number of Accounting-Response packets transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server.

Tx dropped

Displays the number of packets dropped by this RADIUS proxy server before transmission.

No key to cache

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the key information was not present in the packet.

Cache key too long

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the key information present in the packet was too long.

Cache attributes too long

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the total length of the attributes is too long.

Reached maximum number of cache entries

Displays the number of packets that could not be cached by this RADIUS proxy server because the limit has been reached.

No memory

Displays the number of packets that could not be transmitted by this RADIUS proxy server because there was not enough memory.

Server timeout

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS servers have timed out.

Server authentication failure

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet which failed authentication (invalid response Authenticator or Message Authenticator attribute).

Server invalid Code

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet with an invalid Code field.

Invalid attribute encoding

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet with an invalid attribute.

Registered user overload

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the registered user indicated to be in overload.

No RADIUS server configured

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the RADIUS server policy has no servers configured.

RADIUS server send failure

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the packet could not get transmitted to one of the servers in the RADIUS server policy.

Dropped by Python

Displays the number of packets that were dropped by this RADIUS server because the packet was dropped by the Python script.

Invalid response Authenticator

Displays the number of packets that were dropped because the RADIUS server replied with a packet which failed authentication

Sample Output
 
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show router radius-proxy-server "ZiggoRadiusProxyAnyCast" statistics
===============================================================================
RADIUS Proxy server statistics for "ZiggoRadiusProxyAnyCast"
===============================================================================
Rx packet                                                : 28454097
Rx Access-Request                                        : 24846521
Rx Accounting-Request                                    : 3607576
Rx dropped                                               : 22986
  Retransmit                                             : 22986
  Server admin down                                      : 0
  No RADIUS policy configured                            : 0
  No load-balance-key configured                         : 0
  Invalid length                                         : 0
  Invalid Code field                                     : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Invalid User-Name                                      : 0
  Invalid password                                       : 0
  Invalid accounting Authenticator                       : 0
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 0
  No memory                                              : 0
  Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type       : 0
  Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type            : 0
  Registered user overload                               : 0
  Dropped by Python                                      : 0
 
Tx Access-Accept                                         : 1929725
Tx Access-Reject                                         : 302354
Tx Access-Challenge                                      : 22598950
Tx Accounting-Response                                   : 3598730
Tx dropped                                               : 1351
  No key to cache                                        : 0
  Cache key too long                                     : 0
  Cache attributes too long                              : 0
  Reached maximum number of cache entries                : 0
  No memory                                              : 0
  Server timeout                                         : 1351
  Server authentication failure                          : 0
  Server invalid Code                                    : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Registered user overload                               : 0
  No RADIUS server configured                            : 0
  RADIUS server send failure                             : 0
  Dropped by Python                                      : 0
===============================================================================
 
 
*B:asd-tr0610-dr421# show router radius-proxy-server "ZiggoRadiusDRPProxyanyCast-LEG" statistics 
===============================================================================
ISA RADIUS Proxy server statistics for "ZiggoRadiusDRPProxyanyCast-LEG"
===============================================================================
Group 1 member 1
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Rx packet                                                : 72250262
Rx Access-Request                                        : 61457394
Rx Accounting-Request                                    : 10792868
Rx dropped                                               : 1525690
  Retransmit                                             : 28470
  Wrong purpose                                          : 0
  No UE MAC to cache                                     : 1497212
  Client context limit reached                           : 0
  No ISA RADIUS policy configured                        : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  Invalid password                                       : 0
  Accounting-Request with invalid Acct-Status-Type       : 0
  Accounting-Request with no Acct-Status-Type            : 0
  Invalid accounting Authenticator                       : 0
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 8
  Management core overload                               : 0
 
Tx Access-Accept                                         : 5830313
Tx Access-Reject                                         : 743060
Tx Access-Challenge                                      : 54844862
Tx Accounting-Response                                   : 9294168
Tx dropped                                               : 12226
  Server timeout                                         : 12169
  Invalid response Authenticator                         : 57
  Invalid Message-Authenticator                          : 0
  Invalid attribute encoding                             : 0
  RADIUS server send failure                             : 0
 

wpp

Syntax 
wpp
wpp [portal wpp-portal-name] [host ip-address] hosts
wpp portal wpp-portal-name
wpp statistics
Context 
show>router
Description 

This command displays WPP port-related information in the specified routing instance.

Parameters 
wpp-portal-name
Specifies the name of this WPP portal
ip-address
Specifies the host IP address
hosts—
Displays the hosts enabled on the portal
Output 

The following output is an example of router WPP information.

Sample Output
show router wpp
===============================================================================
WPP portals
===============================================================================
Portal                           Address         Controlled-Rtr      Num-Itf
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
svr1                             1.1.1.1         0                   0
svr2                             2.2.2.2         0                   0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of portals: 2
===============================================================================
 
 
show router wpp portal "svr1" 
===============================================================================
WPP Portal "svr1"
===============================================================================
Address                               : 1.1.1.1
Controlled router                     : 0
Number of enabled interfaces          : 0
Triggered hosts                       : disabled
Last management change                : 01/27/2014 00:48:45
===============================================================================
 
 

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays IPoE information.

session

Syntax 
session [sap sap-id] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [interface ip-int-name | ip-address] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [no-inter-dest-id] [ip-address ip-prefix[/prefix-length]] [port port-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sap-session-id sap-session-index] [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
Context 
show>service>id>ipoe
Description 

This command displays the identified IPoE session details active on the specified service instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length.
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length.
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface up to 32 characters in length.
ip-address[/prefix-length]—
Specifies information for the specified IP address and mask.
no-inter-dest-id—
Displays the information about no intermediate destination ID.
port-id
Displays information about the specified port ID.
sap-session-index—
Displays sap-session-index information.
service-id
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

 

intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length.
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile.
detail—
Displays all IPoE session details.
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the router advertisement policy, up to 32 characters in length.
Output 

The following output is an example of service IPoE session information.

Sample Output
# show service id 4000 ipoe session
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for svc-id 4000
===============================================================================
Sap Id                           Mac Address         Up Time         MC-Stdby
    Subscriber-Id
        [CircuitID] | [RemoteID]
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/4:1201.27                    00:51:00:00:00:0c   0d 00:00:18
    ipoe-session-001
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
CID | RID displayed when included in session-key
Number of sessions : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
# show service id 4000 ipoe session detail
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for service 4000
===============================================================================
SAP                     : 1/1/4:1201.27
Mac Address             : 00:51:00:00:00:0c
Circuit-Id              : circuit-id-1
Remote-Id               : remote-id-1
Session Key             : sap-mac
 
MC-Standby              : No
 
Subscriber-interface    : sub-int-1
Group-interface         : group-int-1
 
Up Time                 : 0d 00:01:01
Session Time Left       : N/A
Last Auth Time          : 02/28/2015 01:01:09
Min Auth Intvl (left)   : 0d 00:05:00 (0d 00:03:59)
Persistence Key         : N/A
 
Subscriber              : "ipoe-session-001"
Sub-Profile-String      : "sub-profile-1"
SLA-Profile-String      : "sla-profile-1"
ANCP-String             : ""
Int-Dest-Id             : ""
App-Profile-String      : ""
Category-Map-Name       : ""
Acct-Session-Id         : "144DFF0000001354D806D5"
Sap-Session-Index       : 1
 
IP Address              : 10.10.1.201/24
IP Origin               : Radius
Primary DNS             : N/A
Secondary DNS           : N/A
Primary NBNS            : N/A
Secondary NBNS          : N/A
Address-Pool            : N/A
 
IPv6 Prefix             : 2001:db8:a:111::/64
IPv6 Prefix Origin      : Radius
IPv6 Prefix Pool        : ""
IPv6 Del.Pfx.           : 2001:db8:a001:a100::/56
IPv6 Del.Pfx. Origin    : Radius
IPv6 Del.Pfx. Pool      : ""
IPv6 Address            : 2001:db8:a:101::aaa:1
IPv6 Address Origin     : Radius
IPv6 Address Pool       : ""
Primary IPv6 DNS        : N/A
Secondary IPv6 DNS      : N/A
 
Radius Session-TO       : N/A
Radius Class            :
Radius User-Name        : 00:51:00:00:00:0c
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of sessions : 1
===============================================================================
 
 
*A:Dut-A# show service id 13 ipoe session router-advertisement-policy ra-policy-01
===============================================================================
IPoE sessions for svc-id 13
===============================================================================
Sap Id                           Mac Address         Up Time         MC-Stdby
    Subscriber-Id                                                    
        [CircuitID] | [RemoteID]                                     
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:13   0d 00:13:06     
    Belgacom
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:14   0d 00:08:03     
    Belgacom
1/1/1:13                         00:00:00:00:00:15   0d 00:06:23     
    Belgacom
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
CID | RID displayed when included in session-key
Number of sessions : 3
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# 

summary

Syntax 
summary
Context 
show>service>id>ipoe
Description 

This command displays a summary of IPoE information.

managed-hosts

Syntax 
managed-hosts type {aaa | data-triggered} [ip ip-address] [mac ieee-address]
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays information about hosts that are not yet linked to an in-band control plane protocol, such as DHCP or DHCPv6. Examples include hosts installed by data-triggers and hosts installed by RADIUS.

Parameters 
aaa—
Displays information about managed hosts installed and removed only by RADIUS
data-triggered—
Displays information about managed hosts installed by data-triggers
ip-address—
Displays information about a managed host with the specified IPv4 or IPv6 address
ieee-address—
Displays information about a managed host with the specified MAC address
Output 

The following output is an example of managed host information.

Sample Output
# show service id 100 managed-hosts type data-triggered
===============================================================================
Managed data-triggered hosts
===============================================================================
IP address                                MAC address
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
10.0.0.9/32                               fa:ac:a6:02:11:01
2001:a:b:5::1/128                         fa:ac:a6:02:11:01
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of Managed hosts: 2
===============================================================================

slaac

Syntax 
slaac
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays SLAAC information.

host

Syntax 
host [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host interface interface-name [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host mac ieee-address [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host ipv6-address ipv6-prefix [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
host sap sap-id [detail] [wholesaler service-id] [session {none | ipoe | ppp}] [router-advertisement-policy policy-name]
Context 
show>service>id>slaac
Description 

This command displays SLAAC host related information.

Parameters 
detail—
Specifies to display detailed SLAAC host related information.
service-id—
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler.
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

session—
Specifies to display information about SLAAC hosts that are associated with an IPoE session or a PPP session.
Values—
none, ipoe, ppp

 

interface-name—
Specifies the interface name, up to a maximum of 32 characters.
ieee-address—
Specifies the MAC address for which to display SLAAC host information.
ipv6-address—
Specifies the IPv6 address for which to display SLACC host information.
sap-id—
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
policy-name—
Specifies the name of the router advertisement policy.
Output 

The following output is an example of detailed SLAAC host information.

Sample Output
*A:eng-BNG-2# show service id 1000 slaac host detail
===============================================================================
SLAAC hosts for service 1000
===============================================================================
Service ID           : 1000
Prefix               : 2001:1000:bad:beef::/64
Interface Id         : N/A
Mac Address          : 00:00:10:10:12:12
Subscriber-interface : sub-int-01
Group-interface      : grp-int-01
SAP                  : 1/1/20:841
Termination Type     : local
Creation Time        : 2017/02/13 22:05:03
Persistence Key      : N/A
Router adv. policy   : ra-policy-01
IPoE|PPP session     : No
Radius sub-if prefix : N/A
IPoE Trigger         : rtr-solicit
Last Auth Time       : 2017/02/13 22:05:03
Inactivity Timer     : N/A
Sub-Ident            : "host-1"
Sub-Profile-String   : "no-prof"
SLA-Profile-String   : "no-prof"
App-Profile-String   : ""
ANCP-String          : ""
Int Dest Id          : ""
Category-Map-Name    : ""
Info origin          : radius
Pool                 : ""
Primary-Dns          : N/A
Secondary-Dns        : N/A
Circuit Id           : N/A
Remote Id            : N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of hosts : 1
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# show service id 13 slaac host router-advertisement-policy ra-policy-01
===============================================================================
SLAAC hosts for service 13
===============================================================================
Prefix                      Mac Address          Sap Id                MC-Stdby
  IntId                                                                
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
2013:bad:beef:1::/64        00:00:00:00:00:13    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
2013:bad:beef:2::/64        00:00:00:00:00:14    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
2013:bad:beef:3::/64        00:00:00:00:00:15    1/1/1:13              
  N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of hosts : 3
===============================================================================
*A:Dut-A# 

summary

Syntax 
summary
Context 
show>service>id>slaac
Description 

This command displays a summary of all SLAAC hosts.

call-trace

Syntax 
call-trace
Context 
show
Description 

This command enters the context to display information related to the call-trace module.

files

Syntax 
files [running | finished] [detail]
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command gives an overview of all the files in use by the call-trace module, either for running or finished jobs.

Parameters 
running—
Displays the active jobs that are tracing events triggered by the host being monitored
finished—
Displays the jobs that have already finished and not tracing events generated by the host anymore
detail—
Displays detailed information about the files
Output 

The following output displays call trace local log files information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace files
===============================================================================
Call trace files of running jobs
===============================================================================
File path                                                             File size
                                                                        (bytes)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
cf1-A:/calltrace/running/mac_00-02-00-00-00-19_160119_1557.pcap            1575
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace files of running jobs: 1
===============================================================================
===============================================================================
Call trace files of finished jobs
===============================================================================
File path                                                             File size
                                                                        (bytes)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace files of finished jobs: 0
===============================================================================

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command enters the context to display IP over Ethernet (IPoE) call trace information.

session

Syntax 
session [name trace-name] [detail]
session sap sap mac mac [{circuit-id circuit-id | remote-id remote-id}] [detail]
Context 
show>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command displays call trace information for the active IPoE session.

Configuring this command with a specific IPoE session key will display information for the specified trace job only.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that identifies an IPoE session.
detail—
Displays detailed information.
mac—
Specifies a MAC address that identifies an IPoE session.
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that identifies an IPoE session
trace-name—
Specifies the name of the trace that triggered the job.
sap—
Specifies a SAP that identifies an IPoE session.
Output 

The following output displays call trace information for the active IPoE session.

Sample Output
Node # show call-trace ipoe session
=========================================================
Call trace IPoE session
=========================================================
IEEE address Status No. of messages
Trace name
---------------------------------------------------------
00:02:00:00:00:19 running 10
default
---------------------------------------------------------
No. of call trace IPoE debug jobs: 1
=========================================================
 
 
Node# show call-trace ipoe session detail
===============================================================================
Call trace IPoE session
===============================================================================
SAP ID : 4/1/ 2
IEEE address: 00:02:00:00:00:19
Trace name : default Status : running
Size limit : 10 MB Time limit : 86400 sec
Live output
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Destination : none
Statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Started : 2017/01/11 15:34:08UTC
No. of captured msgs : 10
Size of captured msgs : 2575 B
===============================================================================

trace

Syntax 
trace [name trace-name]
Context 
show>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command displays information about all traces and associated parameters that are currently enabled on the system. Including the trace-name parameter will limit the output to the specified trace only.

Parameters 
trace-name—
Specifies the name of the trace to be displayed.
Output 

The following output displays call trace information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace ipoe trace
===============================================================================
Call trace trace
===============================================================================
Trace name : default Type : ipoe
SAP ID :
IEEE address: 00:02:00:00:00:19
Maximum jobs: 1
===============================================================================

status

Syntax 
status
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command gives a router-wide overview of call-trace operational data, such as number of configured profile, number of jobs and status of the compact flash.

Output 

The following output displays call trace status information.

Sample Output
===============================================================================
Call trace status
===============================================================================
No. of trace profiles: 1
No. of trace jobs    : 0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Primary CF           : CF1              Max files number     : 200
CF1 state            : enabled          CF1 volume limit     : 1000 MB
CF2 state            : enabled          CF2 volume limit     : 1000 MB

trace-profile

Syntax 
trace-profile [detail]
trace-profile profile-name
Context 
show>call-trace
Description 

This command provides an overview of all configured profiles or details of a specific profile. If the detail option is specified the full information for all configured profiles will be displayed.

Parameters 
detail—
Displays detailed trace profile information.
Output 

The following output displays call-trace trace-profile information.

Sample Output
Node# show call-trace trace-profile "default" 
===============================================================================
Call-trace  trace profile
===============================================================================
Profile name              : default
Description                : none
Live output                : none
Format                       : pcap
Size limit                   : 10 MB
Time limit                  : 86400 secs
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
Number of profiles : 1
===============================================================================
 

9.25.2.3. Clear Commands

session

Syntax 
session sap sap mac mac [{circuit-id circuit-id | remote-id remote-id}]
Context 
clear>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command clears the trace job identified by this session.

The sap, mac, circuit-id, and remote-id parameters cannot use wildcard characters, and must match the IPoE session key. This command does not affect any of the debug trace commands, and new jobs can still be executed for other IPoE sessions.

After a session is cleared, tracing for the session will not be restarted by any configured trace. Only explicitly starting a new trace with the trace-existing-sessions parameter can restart tracing for the session.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that identifies an IPoE session.
mac—
Specifies a MAC address that identifies an IPoE session.
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that identifies an IPoE session
sap—
Specifies a SAP that identifies an IPoE session.

trace

Syntax 
trace trace-name
Context 
clear>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command clears all trace jobs started by the specified trace. This command does not affect the trace command itself, and new jobs can still be executed for other IPoE sessions.

After a session is cleared, tracing for the session will not be restarted by any configured trace. Only explicitly starting a new trace with the trace-existing-sessions parameter can restart tracing for the session.

Parameters 
trace-name—
Specifies the configured name of the trace.

accu-stats

Syntax 
accu-stats active-subs no-accu-stats-policy
accu-stats active-subs sub-profile profile-name
accu-stats inactive-subs
accu-stats subscriber subscriber-id
Context 
clear>subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command removes the accumulated statistics for a subscriber.

Parameters 
active-subs no accu-stats-policy—
Removes the accumulated statistics that are no longer associated with an accu-stats-policy. These are active subscribers that are referencing a subscriber profile that removed an accu-stats-policy.
active-subs sub-profile profile-name
Removes the accumulated statistics for the specified subscriber profile.
inactive-subs—
Removes the accumulated statistics from all inactive subscribers.
profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile, to a maximum of 32 characters.
subscriber-id—
Specifies the subscriber, to a maximum of 32 characters.

ancp-sub-string

Syntax 
ancp-sub-string string
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt>ancp>ancp
Description 

This command clears subscriber ANCP data.

Parameters 
string—
Clears the ANCP string corresponding to this subscriber ID

arp

Syntax 
arp {all | ip-address}
arp interface [ip-int-name | ip-address]
Context 
clear>router
Description 

This command clears all or specific ARP entries.

The scope of ARP cache entries cleared depends on the command line option(s) specified.

Parameters 
all—
Clears all ARP cache entries
ip-addr—
Clears the ARP cache entry for the specified IP address
ip-int-name
Clears all ARP cache entries for the interface with the specified name
ip-addr
Clears all ARP cache entries for the specified interface with the specified address

authentication

Syntax 
authentication [policy-name]
authentication coa-statistics
Context 
clear
Description 

This command clears subscriber authentication data.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Clears the specifies existing authentication policy name
coa-statistics—
Clears statistics for incoming RADIUS Change of Authorization requests

diameter-session

Syntax 
diameter-session
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command clears diameter session data.

ccrt-replay

Syntax 
ccrt-replay diameter-application-policy name
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt>diam-session
Description 

This command clears diameter Gx sessions that are in CCR Terminate replay mode.

Parameters 
name
Specifies the application policy up to 32 characters in length for which orphaned Gx sessions will be deleted

errors

Syntax 
errors
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command clears all errors in the circular buffer.

idle-only-msap

Syntax 
idle-only-msap msap-policy-name
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command removes all idle MSAPs associated with the MSAP policy.This command only removes idle MSAPs without active subscribers. This command is considered safer than the clear>subscr-mgmt>msap-policy msap-policy-name idle-only command because in that command, the parameter idle-only is optional. Not specifying idle-only will delete MSAPs with active subscribers.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Specifies the MSAP policy for which all associated idle MSAPs will be cleared

msap-policy

Syntax 
msap-policy msap-policy-name [idle-only]
Context 
clear>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command deletes Managed SAPs (MSAPs) created by the MSAP policy.

This command can remove an MSAP with active subscribers still associated with the MSAP. Use the idle-only parameter to remove only MSAPs in an idle state.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name—
Specifies an existing managed SAP policy name. A string up to 32 characters long composed of printable, 7-bit ASCII characters. If the string contains special characters (#, $, spaces, and so on), the entire string must be enclosed within double quotes.
idle-only—
Specifies to remove only the MSAPs in an idle state

peakvalue-stats

Syntax 
peakvalue-stats iom (slot | all) [recursive]
peakvalue-stats mda (mda | all) [recursive]
peakvalue-stats port (port-id | all)
peakvalue-stats pw-port (pw-port | all)
peakvalue-stats system [recursive]
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the most recent peak counter.

Note:

Clearing one counter will not impact other counters. For example, clearing one IOM’s most recent peak value will not impact chassis peak value.

Parameters 
slot
Clears IOM host peak value statistics for the specified IOM
mda
Clears MDA host peak value statistics for the specified MDA
port-id
Clears port host peak value statistics for the specified port ID
pw-port
Clears pseudowire port host peak value statistics for the specified port
Values—
1 to 10239

 

system —
Clears system host peak value statistics
all—
Clears all host peak value statistics
recursive—
Resets the sub-level counters. For example, clearing IOM counters with the recursive keyword will also clear counters of all ports counters on that IOM

radius-accounting

Syntax 
radius-accounting [policy-name]
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command clears RADIUS accounting data for the specified policy.

Parameters 
policy-name—
The name of the policy. The string is case sensitive and limited to 32 ASCII 7-bit printable characters with no spaces.

statistics

Syntax 
statistics sub-profile {sub-profile-name | all}
statistics sla-profile {sla-profile-name | all}
Context 
clear> subscriber-mgmt
Description 

This command clears the current and historical statistics.

Parameters 
sub-profile-name—
Clears the statistics for a specific subscriber profile, limited to 32 characters.
sub-profile all—
Clears all subscriber profile statistics.
sla-profile-name—
Clears the statistics for a specific SLA profile, limited to 32 characters.
sla-profile all—
Clears all SLA profile statistics.

scheduler-stats

Syntax 
scheduler-stats
Context 
clear>qos
Description 

This command clears scheduler statistics.

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string [scheduler scheduler-name] [ingress | egress]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears scheduler stats per subscriber.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string—
Clears information for the subscriber profile name
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler-name
egress—
Clears egress information for the subscriber
ingress
Clears ingress information for the subscriber

sla-profile

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name sap sap-id [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears the subscriber’s SLA profile scheduler stats.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Clears information for the specified subscriber profile name
sla-profile-name
Clears information for the specified sla-profile-name
sap-id
Clears information for the specified SAP
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler-name

srrp

Syntax 
srrp
Context 
clear>router
Description 

This command enters the context to clear and reset SRRP virtual router instances.

interface

Syntax 
interface subscriber-interface [id srrp-id]
Context 
clear>router>srrp
Description 

This command clears and resets SRRP interface instances.

Parameters 
subscriber-interface—
Specifies an existing subscriber interface name up to 32 characters in length
srrp-id
Specifies an existing SRRP ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

statistics

Syntax 
statistics interface subscriber-interface [id srrp-id]
Context 
clear>router>srrp
Description 

This command clears statistics for SRRP instances.

Parameters 
subscriber-interface—
Specifies an existing subscriber interface name up to 32 characters in length
srrp-id
Specifies an existing SRRP ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

route-downloader

Syntax 
route-downloader name [vprn vprn] [family family]
Context 
clear>aaa
Description 

This command clears all the radius-downloaded routes from the internal downloader cache (or protocol RIB/db) (and thus eventually from the RTM itself). The parameters vprn and/or family allow to restrict the deletion of those routes learned in a particular address family (IPv4 or IPv6) and/or a particular VPRN.

By default, all VPRNs and both IPv4 and IPv6 families are affected.

Note:

A clear of the internal protocol DB means the corresponding prefix that were deleted should be removed from the RTM (and from any other exports) as well.

Parameters 
vprn
Specifies to limit the removal of prefixes to only the specific VPRN. The parameter can be either the service-id or service-name that identifies a VPRN
family
Specifies to limit he removal or prefixes only belonging to the address family IPv4 or IPv6. Only these two values will be accepted.
Values—
ipv4, ipv6

 

vport

Syntax 
port port-id vport name [scheduler scheduler-name]
Context 
clear>qos>scheduler-stats
Description 

This command clears the Vport scheduler stats.

Parameters 
port-id
Clears information for the specified port
name
Clears information for the specified Vport
scheduler-name
Clears information for the specified scheduler name

ipoe session

Syntax 
ipoe session [sap sap-id] [interface ip-int-name | ip-address] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [no-inter-dest-id] [ip-address ip-prefix[/prefix-length]] [port port-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sap-session-id sap-session-index]
ipoe session all
Context 
clear>service>id
Description 

This commands clears all identified IPoE sessions for the specified service instance. All associated subscriber hosts will be deleted from the system.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-int-name—
Specifies the name of the IP interface up to 32 characters in length
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
ip-address[/prefix-length]—
Specifies information for the specified IP address and mask
no-inter-dest-id—
Displays the information about no intermediate destination ID
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
port-id
Displays information about the specified port ID
sap-session-index—
Displays sap-session-index information
service-id
Specifies the service ID of the wholesaler. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
service-id
Specifies information for the specified service ID
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

detail—
Displays all IPoE session details
all—
clears all active IPoE sessions for the specified service instance.

9.25.2.4. Tools Commands

tools

Syntax 
tools
Context 
root
Description 

The context to enable useful tools for debugging purposes.

Default 

none

Parameters 
dump—
Enables dump tools for the various protocols
perform—
Enables tools to perform specific tasks

avp-match-learned-session-id

Syntax 
avp-match-learned-session-id
Context 
tools>dump>debug>diameter
Description 

This command displays the diameter session IDs that are learned by the AVP value matching in a diameter debug.

Per avp-match id in a diameter peer policy, a single diameter session ID can be learned. "N/A" means no session ID is learned.

Output 

The following is a sample output for the avp-match-learned-session-id command.

Sample output
# tools dump debug diameter avp-match-learned-session-id
===============================================================================
Learned Session-Id
===============================================================================
Diameter Peer Policy             ID Session-Id
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
diameter-peer-policy-1           1  bng.domain.com;1452197100;13
diameter-peer-policy-1           2  N/A
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
No. of AVP matches: 2
===============================================================================

perform

Syntax 
perform
Context 
tools
Description 

This command enters the context to enable tools to perform specific tasks.

Default 

none

credit-reset

Syntax 
credit-reset sap sap-id subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset sap sap-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset svc service-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the credit for an SLA-profile instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-address
Resets the credit for the specified IP address
sub-ident-string
Resets the credit for the specified subscriber identification.
sub-profile-string
Resets the credit for the specified subscriber profile
sla-profile-string
Resets the credit for the specified SLA profile
service-id
Resets the credit for the specified service ID
Values—
service-id: 1 2147483647 svc-name: up to 64 characters maximum.

 

persistence

Syntax 
persistence
Context 
tools>perform
Description 

This command enters the context to configure downgrade parameters.

downgrade

Syntax 
downgrade target-version target [reboot]
Context 
tools>perform>persistence
Description 

This command downgrades persistence files to a previous version.

Parameters 
target
Specifies the downgrade version
reboot—
Specifies to reboot the system after a successful conversion

eval-msap

Syntax 
eval-msap {policy msap-policy-name | msap sap-id}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command re-applies the managed SAP policy to the managed SAP identified by the specified sap-id or to all managed SAPs associated with the specified msap-policy name.

Parameters 
msap-policy-name
Specifies an existing MSAP policy. The MSAP policy will be re-applied to all associated managed SAPs
sap-id
Specifies an MSAP sap-id. The MSAP policy will be re-applied to the specified MSAP
Values—
[port-id | lag-id]:qtag1
[port-id | lag-id]:qtag1.qtag2

 

eval-lease-state

Syntax 
eval-lease-state [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [ip ip-address] [mac mac-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates lease state.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ip-address—
Specifies the a server’s IP address. This address must be unique within the subnet and specified in dotted decimal notation. Allowed values are IP addresses in the range 1.0.0.0 – 223.255.255.255 (with support of /31 subnets).
sub-ident-string—
Specifies the subscriber ID string, up to 32 characters in length
service-id—
Specifies an existing service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

subscriber-mgmt

Syntax 
subscriber-mgmt
Context 
tools>perform
Description 

This command enters the context to configure tools to control subscriber management.

edit-lease-state

Syntax 
edit-lease-state sap sap-id ip ip-address [mac ieee-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string [app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
edit-lease-state svc-id service-id ip ip-address [mac ieee-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [app-profile-string [app-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command provides the parameters to edit lease state information.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.
ip-address
Modifies lease state information for the specified IP address.
ieee-address —
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
sub-ident-string
Modifies the lease state information for the specified subscriber identification.
sub-profile-string
Modifies lease state information for the specified subscriber profile.
sla-profile-string
Modifies lease state information for the specified SLA profile.
service-id
Modifies lease state information for the specified service ID.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

coa

Syntax 
coa [nas-port-id attr-string] [framed-ip-addr ip-address] [alc-ipv6-addr ipv6-address] [delegated-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]] [framed-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix [/ipv6-prefix-length]] [alc-serv-id serv-id] [acct-session-id attr-string] [alc-subscr-id attr-string] [alc-brg-id attr-string] [alc-client-hw-addr mac-address] [attr attribute [attribute...(up to 5 max)]] [attr-from-file file-url] [from-server attr-string] [router-or-service attr-string] [debug]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command triggers a Change of Authorization (CoA) on the 7750 SR, 7450 ESS, and 7950 XRS without a RADIUS authentication policy.

This command can be used to spoof a CoA from a configured server for purposes such as testing CoA python scripts. However, spoofing a CoA from a RADIUS server requires the configuration of a RADIUS authentication policy.

Parameters 
nas-port-id attr-string
Specifies the physical access circuit of the NAS with a maximum of 253 characters.
framed-ip-addr ip-address
Specifies the IPv4 host address.
Values—

ipv4-address:

a,b,c,d

 

alc-ipv6-addr ipv6-address
Specifies the IPv6 host address.
Values—

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

 

delegated-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]
Specifies the IPv6 PD host prefix.
Values—

ipv6-prefix:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix-length

[0..128]

 

framed-ipv6-pfx ipv6-prefix[/ipv6-prefix-length]
Specifies the IPv6 SLAAC host prefix.
Values—

ipv6-prefix:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix-length

[0..128]

 

serv-id
Specifies the service ID of the LNS subscriber.
Values—
0 to 4294967295

 

acct-session-id attr-string
Specifies the subscriber accounting session ID to a maximum of 22 characters in length.
alc-subscr-id attr-string
Specifies the subscriber ID to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
alc-brg-id attr-string
Specifies the BRG ID to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
mac-address
Specifies the subscriber host MAC address. in the form xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx.
attribute
Specifies the attributes (RADIUS VSAs) for override. The VSA must be specified in number format. For example, VSA Alc-Subsc-Prof-Str=”1M-prof” is expressed as 6527.12 =“1M-prof”. Up to five attributes can be specified within this command.

For more information on VSAs, refer to the RADIUS Attributes Reference Guide.

Values—

<type>=<value>

<type>:<tag>=<value>

<vendor>,<type>=<value>

e, <type>,<exttyp>=<value> (type=[241|242|243|244])

le,<type>,<exttyp>=<value> (type=[245|246])

evs,<type>,<vendor>,<vendor-type>=<value>

levs,<type>,<vendor>,<vendor-type>=<value>

 

file-url
Specifies the file URL where the VSAs are located.
Values—

local-url

[cflash-id/] [file-path] (200 characters maximum including cflash-id directory length of 99 characters maximum each)

remote-url

[{ftp://|tftp://}login:pswd@remote-locn/][file-path] (255 characters maximum with directory length 99 characters maximum each)

remote-locn

[hostname | ipv4-address | ipv6-address]

ipv4-address:

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address:

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x [-interface]

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d[-interface]

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

interface - Specifies the link local addresses, up to 32 characters maximum.

cflash-id

cf1: | cf1-A: | cf1-B: | cf2 :| cf2-A: | cf2-B: | cf3: | cf3-A: | cf3-B:

 

from-server attr-string
Specifies the RADIUS server name that is configured under the router or VPRN service context, to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
router-or-service attr-string
Specifies the router or VPRN service instance where the RADIUS server is configured, to a maximum of 32 characters in length.
debug —
Displays the debug message associated with the CoA command.
Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber management CoA tools information.

Sample Output
Node# tools perform subscriber-mgmt coa alc-subscr-id subscriber-01 attr 6527,13=new-sla-prof debug
===============================================================================
Inject Change-of-Authorization
===============================================================================
SUCCESS: got ACK
  Change of Authorization(43) id 0 len 50 from 0.0.0.0:3799 vrid 1
    VSA [26] 8 Alcatel(6527)
      SUBSC ID STR [11] 6 subscriber-01
    VSA [26] 10 Alcatel(6527)
      SLA PROF STR [13] 8 new-sla-prof
  Hex Packet Dump:
  1a 0e 00 00 19 7f 0b 08 77 69 66 69 2d 31 1a 10 00 00 19 7f 0d 0a 73 6c 61
  2d 70 72 6f 66
  Change of Authorization Ack(44) 0.0.0.0:3799 id 0 len 20 vrid 1
  Hex Packet Dump:

credit-reset

Syntax 
credit-reset sap sap-id subscriber sub-ident-string sla-profile sla-profile-name {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset sap sap-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
credit-reset svc service-id ip ip-address {category category-name | all-categories}
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command resets the credit for an SLA-profile instance.

Parameters 
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
ip-address
Specifies lease state information for the specified IP address
sub-ident-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified subscriber identification
sub-profile-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified subscriber profile
sla-profile-string
Specifies lease state information for the specified SLA profile
service-id
Specifies lease state information for the specified service ID
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum

 

edit-ppp-session

Syntax 
edit-ppp-session sap sap-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
edit-ppp-session svc-id service-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the PPP session identified with the given MAC address and SAP identifier. Optionally the remote-id and circuit-id can be specified to identify the IPoE session to update.

Note:

The changes take immediate effect.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
sla-profile-string—
Identifies the SLA profile string up to 16 characters in length
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sub-profile-string—
Specifies the subscriber profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
ancp-string—
Specifies the ASCII representation of the up to 63 characters in length
app-profile-string—
Specifies the application profile string up to 16 characters in length

edit-slaac-host

Syntax 
edit-slaac-host sap sap-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
edit-slaac-host svc-id service-id [user-name user-name] [mac mac-address] [session-id session-id] [ip-address ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the SLAAC host information.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
sla-profile-string—
Identifies the SLA profile string up to 16 characters in length
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sub-profile-string—
Specifies the subscriber profile string up to 16 characters in length
sub-profile-name—
Specifies the subscriber profile name up to 32 characters in length
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
ancp-string—
Specifies the ASCII representation of the up to 63 characters in length
app-profile-string—
Specifies the application profile string up to 16 characters in length

edit-ipoe-session

Syntax 
edit-ipoe-session sap sap-id mac mac-address [subscriber sub-ident-string] [sub-profile-string sub-profile-string] [sla-profile-string sla-profile-string] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [ancp-string ancp-string] [app-profile-string app-profile-string] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command updates the data of the IPoE session identified with the given MAC address and SAP identifier. Optionally the remote ID and circuit ID can be specified to identify the IPoE session to update.

Note:

The changes take immediate effect.

eval-ipoe-session

Syntax 
eval-ipoe-session [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [mac mac-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command re-evaluates the mapping between authentication strings such as the SLA profile string and the actual profiles for the identified IPoE sessions.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
mac-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile

eval-ppp-session

Syntax 
eval-ppp-session [svc-id service-id] [user-name user-name] [sap sap-id] [ip ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
eval-ppp-session [svc-id service-id] [user-name user-name] [sap sap-id] mac mac-address [session-id session-id] [ip ip-address] [subscriber sub-ident-string]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates PPP sessions.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
mac-address—
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
session-id
Specifies information about the ID of the PPP session
Values—
1 to 65535

 

eval-slaac-host

Syntax 
eval-slaac-host [svc-id service-id] [sap sap-id] [subscriber sub-ident-string] [ipv6-address ipv6-prefix] [mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command evaluates the SLAAC host.

Parameters 
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
sub-ident-string —
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers
ipv6-prefix—
Specifies an IPv6 prefix and prefix length
Values—

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

 

remap-lease-state

Syntax 
remap-lease-state old-mac ieee-address mac ieee-address
remap-lease-state sap sap-id [mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command allows the remapping of all existing hosts if network card on CMTS/WAC side is changed is required.

When this command is executed, the following restrictions apply:

  1. When sap is taken, all leases associated with the SAP are re-written.
    1. For a SAP with a configured MAC in lease-populate command, this MAC will be taken.
    2. For a SAP without a configured MAC the MAC from tools command will be taken.
    3. For a SAP without a configured MAC and no MAC in tools command no action will be perform.
  2. When using the old-mac option, providing a new MAC ieee-address is mandatory.

This command is applicable only when dealing with DHCP lease states which were instantiated using l2header mode of DHCP operation.

Parameters 
old-mac ieee-address
Specifies the old MAC address to remap
mac ieee-address
Specifies that the provisioned MAC address will be used in the anti-spoofing entries for this SAP when l2-header is enabled. The parameter may be changed mid-session. Existing sessions will not be re-programmed unless a tools perform command is issued for the lease.
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition.

When configured, the SAP parameter will remap all MAC addresses of DHCP lease states on the specified SAP. When no optional MAC parameter is specified, the sap sap-id command remaps all MAC addresses of lease states towards the MAC address specified in the l2-header configuration.

re-ident-sub

Syntax 
re-ident-sub old-sub-ident-string to new-sub-ident-string
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command renames a subscriber identification string.

Parameters 
old-sub-ident-string—
Specifies the existing subscriber identification string to be renamed
new-sub-ident-string—
Specifies the new subscriber identification string name

redundancy

Syntax 
redundancy
Context 
tools>dump
Description 

This command enters the context to dump redundancy parameters.

multi-chassis

Syntax 
multi-chassis
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy
Description 

This command enters the context to dump multi-chassis parameters.

mc-endpoint

Syntax 
mc-endpoint peer ip-address
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis endpoint information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address

force-switchover

Syntax 
force-switchover tunnel-group local-group-id
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command manually switches over mc-ipsec mastership of the specified tunnel-group.

Parameters 
local-group-id—
Specifies the local tunnel-group ID configured under the config>redundancy.multichassis>peer>mc-ipsec context

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
mc-ring peer ip-address [ring sync-tag]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
sync-tag
Specifies the ring’s sync-tag created in the config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring context

srrp-sync-database

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps SRRP database information and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
instance instance-id
Dumps information for the specified Subscriber Router Redundancy Protocol instance configured on this system.
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps MCS database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
port-id | lag-id
Indicates the port or LAG ID to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
slot/mda/port or lag-lag-id

 

sync-tag
Specifies a synchronization tag to be used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application
Specifies a particular multi-chassis peer synchronization protocol application
Values—

dhcp-server:

local dhcp server (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

igmp:

Internet group management protocol

igmp-snooping:

igmp-snooping

mc-ring:

multi-chassis ring

mld-snooping:

multicast listener discovery-snooping

srrp:

simple router redundancy protocol (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-host-trk:

subscriber host tracking (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-mgmt:

subscriber management (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

 

type
Indicates the locally deleted or alarmed deleted entries in the MCS database per multi-chassis peer
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

detail—
Displays detailed information

mc-ipsec

Syntax 
mc-ipsec
Context 
tools>perform>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command enters the context to configure mc-ipsec parameters.

mc-endpoint

Syntax 
mc-endpoint peer ip-address
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis endpoint information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
mc-ring peer ip-address [ring sync-tag]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address.
sync-tag
Specifies the ring’s sync-tag created in the config>redundancy>mc>peer>mcr>ring context.

srrp-sync-database

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps SRRP database information and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
instance-id
Dumps information for the specified Subscriber Router Redundancy Protocol instance configured on this system.
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps MCS database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Specifies the peer’s IP address
port-id | lag-id
Indicates the port or LAG ID to be synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
slot/mda/port or lag-lag-id

 

sync-tag
Specifies a synchronization tag to be used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application
Specifies a particular multi-chassis peer synchronization protocol application
Values—

dhcp-server:

local dhcp server (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

igmp:

Internet group management protocol

igmp-snooping:

igmp-snooping

mc-ring:

multi-chassis ring

mld-snooping:

multicast listener discovery-snooping

srrp:

simple router redundancy protocol (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-host-trk:

subscriber host tracking (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

sub-mgmt:

subscriber management (7450 ESS and 7750 SR only)

 

type
Indicates the locally deleted or alarmed deleted entries in the MCS database per multi-chassis peer
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

detail—
Displays detailed information

forcerenew

Syntax 
forcerenew svc-id service-id {ip ip-address[/mask] | mac ieee-address}
forcerenew {interface interface-name | sap sap-id | sdp sdp-id:vc-id} [ip ip-address[/mask] |mac ieee-address]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command forces the renewal of lease state and only applies to the 7450 ESS and 7750 SR

Parameters 
service-id
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

sap-id
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified SAP.
ip-address
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified IP address
ieee-address
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified MAC address
interface-name
Forces renewal of the lease state for the specified interface name

local-user-db

Syntax 
local-user-db local-user-db-name
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command provides tools to control the local user database.

Parameters 
local-user-db-name—
Specifies the name of a local user database up to 32 characters in length

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db
Description 

This command provides the tools to control IPoE entries in the local user database.

host-lookup

Syntax 
host-lookup [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id-ascii] [sap-id sap-id] [service-id service-id] [string vso-string] [system-id system-id] [option60 option-60-ascii] [circuit-id circuit-id-ascii] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [option60-hex option60-hex] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [ip-prefix ip-prefix/ip-prefix-length]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ipoe
Description 

This command performs a lookup in the local user database.

Parameters 
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address for the static ARP in the form aa:bb:cc:dd:ee:ff or aa-bb-cc-dd-ee-ff where aa, bb, cc, dd, ee, and ff are hexadecimal numbers. Allowed values are any non-broadcast, non-multicast MAC and non-IEEE reserved MAC addresses.
remote-id
Specifies the information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-ascii—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length in ASCII
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters maximum
service-id—
Specifies an existing subscriber service ID
Values—
1 to 2147483647

 

vso-string—
Specifies a Vendor Specific Option (VSO) string
system-id—
Specifies the system ID
Values—
up to 255 characters maximum

 

option-60-ascii
Specifies the Vendor-Identifying Vendor Option to match against. Option 60 is encoded as Type - Length - Value and must be formatted in ASCII.
option-60-hex
Specifies the Vendor-Identifying Vendor Option to match against. Option 60 is encoded as Type - Length - Value and must be formatted in HEX

ppp

Syntax 
ppp
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db
Description 

This command provides the tools to control PPPoE entries in the local user database.

authentication

Syntax 
authentication user-name user-name password password [circuit-id circuit-id] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [sap-id sap-id] [service-name service-name]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ppp
Description 

This command authenticates the PPPoE user name.

Parameters 
user-name
Specifies the PPP user name up to 253 characters in length
password
Specifies the password of this host up to 64 characters in length
circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID up to 127 characters in length
circuit-id-hex
Specifies the circuit ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 254 hex nibbles)

 

derived-id
Specifies an ASCII string that uniquely identifies a host, and is derived by a Python script from packet content available during a DHCP transaction up to 255 characters in length
ieee-address
Specifies information about the MAC address of the PPP session
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-hex—
Specifies the remote ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 510hex nibbles)

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters in length
service-name
Specifies the service name

host-lookup

Syntax 
host-lookup [circuit-id circuit-id] [circuit-id-hex circuit-id-hex] [derived-id derived-id] [mac ieee-address] [remote-id remote-id] [remote-id-hex remote-id-hex] [sap-id sap-id] [service-name service-name] [user-name user-name]
Context 
tools>perform>subscr-mgmt>loc-user-db>ppp
Description 

This command performs a lookup in the local user database.

Parameters 
circuit-id circuit-id—
Specifies the circuit ID from the Option 82
circuit-id-hex
Specifies the circuit ID in hexadecimal format from the Option 82
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 254 hex nibbles)

 

derived-id
Specifies an ASCII string that uniquely identifies a host, and is derived by a Python script from packet content available during a DHCP transaction
remote-id—
Specifies that information that goes into the remote-id sub-option in the DHCP relay packet, up to 255 characters in length
remote-id-hex—
Specifies the remote ID in hexadecimal format
Values—
0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (maximum 510hex nibbles)

 

sap-id—
Specifies a SAP ID, up to 255 characters in length
service-name
Specifies a PPP service name up to 253 characters in length
user-name
Specifies a user name up to 128 characters in length

mc-ring

Syntax 
mc-ring
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis ring data.

sync-database

Syntax 
sync-database [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id] [sync-tag sync-tag] [application application] [detail] [type type]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis sync database information.

Parameters 
ip-address
Dumps the specified address of the multi-chassis peer
port-id
Dumps the specified port ID of the multi-chassis peer
lag-id
Dumps the specified Link Aggregation Group (LAG) on this system
sync-tag
Dumps the synchronization tag used while synchronizing this port with the multi-chassis peer
application—
Dumps the specified application information that was synchronized with the multi-chassis peer
Values—
dhcps, igmp, igmp-snooping, mc-ring, srrp, sub-mgmt, mld-snooping, all

 

detail—
Displays detailed information
type
Filters by the specified entry type
Values—
alarm-deleted, local-deleted

 

sync-database-reconcile

Syntax 
sync-database-reconcile [peer ip-address] [port port-id | lag-id [sync-tag sync-tag]] [application application]
sync-database-reconcile [peer ip-address] [sdp sdp-id [sync-tag sync-tag]] [application application]
Context 
tools>perform>redundancy>multi-chassis>mc-ipsec
Description 

This command provides the parameters to reconcile MCS database entries.

Parameters 
ip-address—
Specifies the IP address (in the form of a.b.c.d)
port-id—
Specifies the port ID in the slot/MDA/port format
lag-id—
Specifies the LAG ID
Values—
lag-id: lag-id
lag: keyword
id: 1 to 200

 

syn-tag—
Specifies the syn tag up to 32 characters in length
application—
Specifies the application
Values—
dhcp-server — Specifies the local DHCP server
igmp — Specifies the Internet group management protocol
igmp-snooping — Specifies igmp-snooping
mc-ring — Specifies multi-chassis ring
l2tp — Specifies L2TP
mld — Specifies multicast listener discovery
mld-snooping — Specifies multicast listener discovery-snooping
srrp — Specifies simple router redundancy protocol
sub-host-trk — Specifies subscriber host tracking
sub-mgmt-ipoe — Specifies subscriber management for IPoE
sub-mgmt-pppoe — Specifies subscriber management for PPPoE
mc-ipsec — Specifies multi-chassis IPsec
python — Specifies Python cache
diameter-proxy — Specifies diameter proxy
pim-snpg-sap — Specifies protocol independent multicast snooping for SAPs
pim-snpg-sdp — Specifies protocol independent multicast snooping for SDPs

 

sdp-id—
Specifies the SDP ID
Values—
1 to 17407

 

srrp-sync-data

Syntax 
srrp-sync-database [instance instance-id] [peer ip-address]
Context 
tools>dump>redundancy>multi-chassis
Description 

This command dumps multi-chassis SRRP sync database information.

Parameters 
instance-id—
Specifies the instance ID
Values—
1 to 4294967295

 

ip-address—
Dumps the specified address (in the form of a.b.c.d)

route-downloader

Syntax 
route-downloader start [force]
Context 
tools>perform>aaa
Description 

This command causes the download process to start immediately. If an ongoing download is already in progress then no further action is needed, except if the force keyword is added. In case the force keyword is added, then the current download is aborted and a new one is immediately restarted. If aborting the current download, the internal route table should not be emptied or cleared.

Parameters 
start—
Starts the download process immediately
force—
Causes the current download to be aborted and a new one is immediately restarted

router

Syntax 
router [router-instance]
router service-name service-name
Context 
tools>dump
Description 

This command enters the context for tools dump commands in the specified routing instance.

Parameters 
router-instance—
Specifies the router instance name (Base or management) or service ID
service-name—
Specifies the configured service name for the routing instance

ipoe-session

Syntax 
ipoe-session
Context 
tools>dump>router
Description 

This command enters the context for IPoE session-related tools dump commands in the specified routing instance.

migration

Syntax 
migration [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
tools>dump>router>ipoe-session
Description 

This command displays details on the IPoE session migration progress. It shows per group interface the number of hosts per type (DHCPv4, DHCPv6 and SLAAC) that are associated with an IPoE session or that are not associated with an IPoE session.

Output 

The following is an example of IPoE session migration information.

Sample Output
# tools dump router ipoe-session migration interface group-int-1-1
================================================================================
 Type                Total     IPoE session     Non IPoE session
================================================================================
 Group-interface: group-int-1-1 (IPoE session enabled)
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 DHCPv4              2         1                1
 DHCPv6              3         2                1
 SLAAC               0         0                0
--------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 IPoE sessions       1
================================================================================

9.25.2.5. Debug Commands

diameter

Syntax 
[no] diameter
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command enables debugging for diameter.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

dest-realm

Syntax 
dest-realm realm
no dest-realm
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts the output to a specific destination-realm.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
realm—
Specifies the realm up to 80 characters in length

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level level
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command configures the detail level of debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
level—
Specifies the detail level
Values—
low, medium, high

 

diameter-peer

Syntax 
diameter-peer peer [psm-events]
no diameter-peer
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts output to a specific peer.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
psm-events—
Specifies to restrict output to the peer’s state machine (PSM)

diameter-peer-policy

Syntax 
diameter-peer-policy policy
no diameter-peer-policy policy
Context 
debug>diameter
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages on peers of a specific diameter peer policy. Up to eight diameter peer policies can be specified.

The no form of the command removes the specified diameter peer policy and all debug statement under this policy from the debug configuration.

Parameters 
policy—
Specifies the diameter peer policy name, up to 32 characters in length

avp-match

Syntax 
avp-match id
no avp-match id
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages within the diameter peer policy that belong to a diameter session identified based on the AVP value matching in a diameter application message.At least the message type and one AVP match criteria must be specified in an avp-match id command.

If a diameter application message matches all criteria within one AVP match ID, then the session ID is learned and all subsequent messages of that diameter session are shown until a relearning occurs. (OR function between avp-match id commands.)

When the session ID is learned in an Answer message, an attempt is made to include the corresponding Request message in the debug output: The Request message should still be available in the system and must pass all debug filters (such as message-type).

By default an avp-match id is disabled and must be configured with the debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match no shutdown to activate.

Parameters 
id—
Specifies the AVP match ID, up to five per diameter peer policy
Values—
1 to 5

 

avp

Syntax 
avp avp-id type type [ascii | hex] value value
no avp avp-id
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command specifies an AVP match criteria for AVP value matching. At least one and up to five AVP match criteria can be specified in an avp-match id command. When multiple AVP match criteria are specified, they must all match to be successful and result in a diameter session ID learning. (AND function between avp avp-id commands.)

The AVP in an AVP match criteria is identified by its AVP ID. The AVP ID is specified as [vendor-id-]avp-code[.avp-id] with nesting up to five levels deep.

The format type of the AVP should match the standard documents in which the AVP is specified. Any AVP can be specified as an octet string in hex format.

Parameters 
avp-id—
Specifies that an AVP is a [vendor-id-]avp-code[.avp-id], up to five levels deep. For example to specify the Multiple-Services-Credit-Control.Quota-Holding-Time AVP, use avp-id = 456.10415-871.
Values—
vendor-id: [1 to 4294967295]
avp-code: [1 to 4294967295]

 

type—
Specifies the format type of the AVP as octets string, integer32, integer64, unsigned32, unsigned64 or address. The type should match the format as specified in the corresponding standard documents. Any AVP can be specified as octet string in hex.
ascii | hex—
Specifies the value format. The ASCII format is default. The hexadecimal format value should start with "0x". For example: 0x0000000a to specify a 4 byte integer value in hexadecimal format.
value—
Specifies the actual value of the AVP that should be matched against (256 characters maximum; 127 characters maximum when specified in hex)

message-type

Syntax 
message-type [ccr] [cca] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
no message-type
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command specifies the message type match criteria for AVP value matching. Only specified diameter application messages are used for AVP value matching. This is a mandatory criteria in an avp-match id command.This command does not restrict the debug output to the specified messages.

Parameters 
ccr—
credit control request
cca—
credit control answer
rar —
re-authentication request
raa —
re-authentication answer
asr —
abort session request
asa —
abort session answer
aar —
aa request
aaa —
aa answer
all —
all message types

shutdown

Syntax 
[no] shutdown
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy>avp-match
Description 

This command enables or disables the avp-match id criteria for filtering debug output based on AVP value matching.A shutdown of the avp-match id clears the learned diameter session ID.

diameter-peer

Syntax 
diameter-peer peer [psm-events]
no diameter-peer
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to messages on a specific peer within the diameter peer policy. Overrides the debug>diam>diam-peer debug command for the specified diameter peer policy. A single peer can be specified per diameter peer policy.

When no peer is specified at the diameter peer policy level, the debug output is restricted to the peer configured at the debug>diam level.

The no form of the command removes the peer from the debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy debug output.

Parameters 
peer—
Specifies a peer name, up to 32 characters in length
psm-events—
Specifies to include Peer State Machine (PSM) events in the debug output

message-type

Syntax 
message-type [ccr] [cca] [cer] [cea] [dwr] [dwa] [dpr] [dpa] [rar] [raa] [asr] [asa] [aar] [aaa]
message-type all
no message-type
Context 
debug>diam>diam-peer-plcy
debug>diam
Description 

This command restricts the debug output to the specified message types.

When specified within a diameter peer policy, it overrides the message type configuration at the debug>diam level for messages received and sent on that diameter peer policy.

The no form of the command removes the message type from the debug configuration.

Parameters 
ccr—
credit control request
cca—
credit control answer
cer —
capabilities exchange request
cea —
capabilities exchange answer
dwr —
device watchdog request
dwa —
device watchdog answer
dpr —
disconnect peer request
dpa —
disconnect peer answer
rar —
re-authentication request
raa —
re-authentication answer
asr —
abort session request
asa —
abort session answer
aar —
aa request
aaa —
aa answer
all —
all message types

origin-realm

Syntax 
origin-realm realm
no origin-realm
Context 
debug>diam
Description 

This command restricts output to a specific origin-realm.

arp-host

Syntax 
[no] arp-host
Context 
debug>service>id
Description 

This command enables and configures ARP host debugging.

The no form of the command disables ARP host debugging.

one-time-http-redirection

Syntax 
one-time-http-redirection
Context 
debug>service>id
Description 

This command produces one-time HTTP redirection debug output.

ppp

Syntax 
[no] ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>
Description 

This command enables the PPP debug context.

The no form of the command disables PPP debugging.

event

Syntax 
[no] event
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables the PPP event debug context.

The no form of the command disables PPP event debugging.

dhcp-client

Syntax 
dhcp-client [terminate-only]
no dhcp-client
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enable PPP event debug for DHCP client.

The no form of the command disables PPP event debugging for the DHCP client.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debug for local terminated PPP session

l2tp

Syntax 
l2tp [terminate-only]
no l2tp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables PPP L2TP event debug.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debug for local terminated PPP session

local-address-assignment

Syntax 
local-address-assignment [terminate-only]
no local-address-assignment
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables debugging for local-address-assignment events.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debugging for local address assignment

ppp

Syntax 
ppp [terminate-only]
no ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>event
Description 

This command enables PPP event debug.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
terminate-only—
Enables debugging for local terminated PPP session

mac

Syntax 
[no] mac ieee-address
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command displays PPP packets for a particular MAC address.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

msap

Syntax 
[no] msap msap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables debugging for specific PPP MSAPs.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

packet

Syntax 
[no] packet
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables the PPP packet debug context.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level {low | medium | high}
no detail-level
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command specify the detail level of PPP packet debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
low | medium | high—
Specifies the detail level of PPP packet debug output

dhcp-client

Syntax 
[no] dhcp-client
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables packet debug output for DHCP client of the PPP session

The no form of the command disables debugging.

discovery

Syntax 
discovery [padi] [pado] [padr] [pads] [padt]
no discovery
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables PPP discovery packet debug output.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
[padi] [pado] [padr] [pads] [padt]
Enables the corresponding type of PPP discovery packet

mode

Syntax 
mode {dropped-only | ingr-and-dropped | egr-ingr-and-dropped}
no mode
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command specifies PPP packet debug mode.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
dropped-only—
Displays only dropped packets
ingr-and-dropped—
Displays only ingress packet and dropped packets
egr-ingr-and-dropped—
Displays ingress, egress and dropped packets

ppp

Syntax 
ppp [lcp] [pap] [chap] [ipcp] [ipv6cp]
no ppp
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp>packet
Description 

This command enables PPP discovery packet debug output for the specified PPP protocol.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
[lcp] [pap] [chap] [ipcp] [ipv6cp]
Enables debug for the specified protocol

remote-id

Syntax 
[no] remote-id remote-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables debugging for specific PPP remote-ids.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

sap

Syntax 
[no] sap sap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enables PPP debug output for the specified SAP, this command allow multiple instances.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
sap-id—
Specifies the SAP ID

username

Syntax 
[no] username username
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified username. since not all PPP packets contain username, so a mac debug filter will be created automatically when system sees a PPP packet contain the specified username.

Multiple username filters can be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
user-name—
Specifies the PPP username

circuit-id

Syntax 
[no] circuit-id circuit-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified circuit-id.

Multiple circuit-id filters can be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
circuit-id —
Specifies the circuit-id in PADI

remote-id

Syntax 
[no] remote-id remote-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified remote-id.

Multiple remote-id filters could be specified in the same debug command.

Parameters 
remote-id—
Specifies the remote-id in PADI

msap

Syntax 
[no] msap msap-id
Context 
debug>service>id>ppp
Description 

This command enable PPP debug for the specified managed SAP.

Multiple msap filters could be specified in the same debug command.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
msap-id—
Specifies the managed SAP ID

authentication

Syntax 
authentication [policy policy-name] [mac-addr ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id]
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command debugs subscriber authentication.

Parameters 
policy-name
Specifies an existing subscriber management authentication policy name
ieee-address
Specifies the 48-bit MAC address xx:xx:xx:xx:xx:xx or xx-xx-xx-xx-xx-xx
circuit-id
Specify the circuit-id, up to 256 characters in length

sub-ident-policy

Syntax 
[no] sub-ident-policy policy-name
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt
Description 

This command debugs subscriber identification policies.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

Parameters 
policy-name—
Specifies the subscriber identification policy to debug

script-compile-error

Syntax 
[no] script-compile-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command send the traceback of the compile error to the logger. The traceback contains detailed information about where and why the compilation fails. The compilation takes place when the CLI user changes the admin state of the Python URL from shutdown to no-shutdown.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-export-variables

Syntax 
[no] script-export-variables
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the result (the three output variables) of the Python script to the logger when the script ran successfully.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-output

Syntax 
[no] script-output
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the output (such as from 'print' statements) of the Python script to the logger.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-output-on-error

Syntax 
[no] script-output-on-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the output (such as from print statements) of the Python script to the logger, but only when the script fails.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-runtime-error

Syntax 
[no] script-runtime-error
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command sends the traceback of the Python script failure to the logger.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

script-all-info

Syntax 
script-all-info
Context 
debug>subscr-mgmt>sub-ident-plcy
Description 

This command enables the script-compile-error, script-export-variables, script-output, script-output-on-error, and script-runtime-error functionalities.

srrp

Syntax 
[no] srrp
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

events

Syntax 
[no] events [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
debug>router>srrp
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

packets

Syntax 
[no] packets [interface ip-int-name]
Context 
debug>router>srrp
Description 

This command enables debugging for SRRP packets.

The no form of the command disables debugging.

radius

Syntax 
[no] radius
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enables the debug router RADIUS context.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level {low | medium | high}
no detail-level
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the output detail level of command debug router radius.

Default 

medium

Parameters 
low—
Specifies that the output includes packet type, server address, length, radius-server-policy name
medium—
Specifies all output in low level including the RADIUS attributes in the packet
high—
Specifies all output in medium level including the hex packet dump

packet-type

Syntax 
packet-type [authentication] [accounting] [coa]
no packet-type
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the RADIUS packet type filter of command debug router radius

Default 

authentication accounting coa

Parameters 
authentication—
Specifies the RADIUS authentication packet
accounting—
Specifies the RADIUS accounting packet
coa—
Specifies the RADIUS change of authorization packet

radius-attr

Syntax 
radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction]
radius-attr type attribute-type [transaction] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction] [encoding encoding-type]
radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] [transaction] [encoding encoding-type] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
no radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type]
no radius-attr type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] {address | hex | integer | string} value attribute-value
no radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type]
no radius-attr vendor vendor-id type attribute-type [extended-type attribute-ext-type] {address | hex | integer | string} [0..16777215] attribute-value
Context 
debug>router>radius
Description 

This command specifies the RADIUS attribute filter of command debug router radius.

Parameters 
attribute-type
Specifies the RADIUS attribute type
Values—
1 to 255

 

attribute-ext-type
Specifies the RADIUS attribute extended type (RFC 6929)
Values—
1 to 255

 

address—
Specifies the value is a IPv4 or IPv6 address/prefix/subnet
string—
Specifies the value is a ASCII string
integer—
Specifies the value is a integer
hex—
Specifies the value is a binary string in hex format, such as “\0xAB01FE”
attribute-value
Specifies the value of the RADIUS attribute
Values—

address

<ipv4-address> | <ipv6-address> | <ipv6-prefix/prefix-length>

ipv4-address

a.b.c.d

ipv6-address

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

ipv6-prefix

x:x:x:x:x:x:x:x (eight 16-bit pieces)

x:x:x:x:x:x:d.d.d.d

x - [0 to FFFF]H

d - [0 to 255]D

ipv6-prefix-length [0 to 128]

hex

[0x0 to 0xFFFFFFFF (max 506 hex nibbles)]

integer

[0 to 4294967295]

string

ascii-string (max 253 chars)

 

transaction—
Specifies that the system will output both request and response packets in the same session even if the response packet does not include the filter attribute
vendor-id
Specifies the vendor id for the vendor specific attribute
Values—
0 to 16777215

 

encoding-type
Specifies the size of the vendor-type and vendor-length in bytes. It is a two digitals string: “xy”, x is the size of vendor-type, range from 1 to 4; y is the size of vendor-length, range from 0 to 2; it is “11” by default.
Values—
type-size:1 to 4, length-size: 0 to 2

 

wpp

Syntax 
[no] wpp
Context 
debug>router
Description 

This command enters the context to configure WPP debugging parameters.

packet

Syntax 
[no] packet
Context 
debug>router>wpp
debug>router>wpp>portal
Description 

This command enables WPP packet debugging.

detail-level

Syntax 
detail-level detail-level
Context 
debug>router>wpp
debug>router>wpp>packet
debug>router>wpp>portal>packet
Description 

This command specifies the detail level of WPP packet debugging.

Parameters 
detail-level—
specifies the detail level of WPP packet debugging
Values—
high — Specifies a high detail level for WPP packet debugging
low — Specifies a low detail for WPP packet debugging

 

portal

Syntax 
[no] portal wpp-portal-name
Context 
debug>router>wpp
Description 

This command enables WPP debugging for the specified WPP portal.

Parameters 
wpp-portal-name—
Specifies the WPP portal name

call-trace

Syntax 
call-trace
Context 
debug
Description 

This command enters the context to set up various call trace debug sessions.

ipoe

Syntax 
ipoe
Context 
debug>call-trace
Description 

This command enters the context to set up call trace debugging for IP over Ethernet (IPoE) sessions.

trace

Syntax 
trace sap sap-id [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace mac ieee-address [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id] [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace circuit-id circuit-id [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
trace remote-id remote-id [profile trace-profile-name] [trace-existing-sessions] [max-jobs num] [name trace-name]
no trace [sap sap-id] [mac ieee-address] [circuit-id circuit-id] [remote-id remote-id]
no trace name trace-name
Context 
debug>call-trace>ipoe
Description 

This command enables tracing for IPoE sessions specified by the configured parameters. This command can trace a single session or multiple sessions, and can use wildcard characters.

This command can be executed multiple times to start multiple traces. When rules overlap, such as for a wildcard SAP and a specific SAP, the rule that a specific trace will be associated with cannot be guaranteed.

The no form of the command will prevent new traces from being configured and will terminate all trace jobs that were previously started using the trace command.

Parameters 
circuit-id—
Specifies a circuit ID that is used to filter sessions to trace. The circuit-id and remote-id parameters are mutually exclusive.
ieee-address—
Specifies a MAC address that is used to identify a session to trace, in the format “ab:cd:ef:01:23:45”. A wildcard character can be used to match all remaining octets; for example, the format “ab:cd:ef:*” can be used to filter by OUI.
num—
Specifies the maximum number of jobs that may be started with this rule.
Values—
1 to 50

 

Default—
1
remote-id—
Specifies a remote ID that is used to filter sessions to trace. The remote-id and circuit-id parameters are mutually exclusive.
sap-id—
Specifies a SAP to trace. The following formats are accepted:
  1. port/lag/pw-port:svlan.cvlan
  2. port/lag/pw-port:vlan
  3. port/lag/pw-port
  4. port/lag/pw-port:vlan.*
  5. port/lag/pw-port:* (also matches *.*)
trace-existing-sessions—
Specifies that existing IPoE sessions will be traced. If this parameter is not included, only new IPoE sessions will be traced.
trace-name—
Specifies the name by which the trace will be referenced, up to 16 characters maximum.
trace-profile-name—
Specifies the name of the trace profile to be applied. The default parameters will be used if a trace profile is not specified.

9.25.2.6. Monitor Commands

subscriber

Syntax 
subscriber sub-ident-string sap sap-id sla-profile sla-profile-name [base | ingress-queue-id ingress-queue-id | egress-queue-id egress-queue-id] [interval seconds] [repeat repeat] [absolute | rate]
Context 
monitor>service
Description 

This command monitors statistics for a subscriber.

Parameters 
sub-ident-string
Specifies an existing subscriber identification profile to monitor
sap-id
Specifies the physical port identifier portion of the SAP definition
sla-profile-name
Specifies an existing SLA profile
seconds
Configures the interval for each display in seconds
Default—
11
Values—
11 to 60

 

repeat
Configures how many times the command is repeated
Default—
10
Values—
1 to 999

 

absolute—
Specifies that raw statistics are displayed, without processing. No calculations are performed on the delta or rate statistics.
Default—
mode delta
rate —
Specifies that the rate-per-second for each statistic is displayed instead of the delta
base —
Monitors base statistics
ingress-queue-id ingress-queue-id
Monitors statistics for this queue
Values—
1 to 32

 

egress-queue-id egress-queue-id
Monitors statistics for this queue
Values—
1 to 8

 

Output 

The following output is an example of subscriber monitor statistics

Sample Output
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 94531                  30704535
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 7332                    2510859
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 87067                   28152288
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 90862                   12995616
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance per Queue statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Ingress Queue 1 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Ingress Queue 2 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 94531                   30704535
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 7332                    2510859
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 87067                   28152288
 
Ingress Queue 3 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Ingress Queue 11 (Multipoint) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 1
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 90862                   12995616
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 2
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
 
Egress Queue 3
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default base rate
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 109099                  35427060
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 8449                    2894798
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 100523                  32489663
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 105578                  15104553
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
At time t = 11 sec (Mode: Rate)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
SLA Profile Instance statistics
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets                  % Port
                                                                        Util.
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0                       0.00
Off. LowPrio          : 1469                    477795                  0.38
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0                       0.00
 
Queueing Stats (Ingress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0                       0.00
Dro. LowPrio          : 119                     40691                   0.03
For. InProf           : 0                       0                       0.00
For. OutProf          : 1349                    437350                  0.34
 
Queueing Stats (Egress QoS Policy 1000)
Dro. InProf           : 0                       0                       0.00
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0                       0.00
For. InProf           : 1469                    209129                  0.16
For. OutProf          : 0                       0                       0.00
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default ingress-queue-id 1
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Ingress Queue 1 (Unicast) (Priority)
Off. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Off. LowPrio          : 0                       0
Off. Uncolor          : 0                       0
Dro. HiPrio           : 0                       0
Dro. LowPrio          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 0                       0
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
===============================================================================
A:Dut-A#
 
 
A:Dut-A# monitor service subscriber nokia_100 sap 1/2/1:101 sla-profile sla_default egress-queue-id 1
===============================================================================
Monitor statistics for Subscriber nokia_100
===============================================================================
At time t = 0 sec (Base Statistics)
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                        Packets                 Octets
Egress Queue 1
Dro. InProf           : 880                     127660
Dro. OutProf          : 0                       0
For. InProf           : 164366                  23506178
For. OutProf          : 0                       0
==============================================================================
A:Dut-A#

host

Syntax 
host [sap sap-id] [wholesaler service-id] [port port-id] [inter-dest-id intermediate-destination-id] [detail]
host [sap sap-id] [wholesaler service-id] [port port-id] no-inter-dest-id [detail]
host summary
host [detail] wholesaler service-id (VPRN only)
Context 
show>service>id
Description 

This command displays static host information configured on this service.

Parameters 
sap-id
Displays SAP information for the specified SAP ID
intermediate-destination-id—
Specifies the intermediate destination identifier which is encoded in the identification strings up to 32 characters in length
summary—
Displays summary host information
wholesaler service-id
Specifies the VPRN service ID of the wholesaler. When specified in this context, SAP, SDP, interface, IP address and MAC parameters are ignored. This parameter applies only to the 7750 SR.
Values—

service-id:

1 to 2147483647

svc-name:

64 characters maximum